New Books
ovember December January February March April May
2011
Issue 1
Taylor & Francis Routledge CRC Press Psychology Press Garland Science
About this Catalogue
1
Nursing and Allied Health
Humanities Philosophy Religion History Archaeology and Museum Studies Classical Studies Media, Communication and Cultural Studies Literature English Language & Linguistics Language Learning Theatre and Performance Studies Music
2 7 9 15 16 18 28 34 40 45 48
Education Early Years & Childhood Studies Teaching and Learning Special Needs Post-Compulsory and Higher Education Research Methods Education Theory
50 52 64 66 69 70
Social Sciences Politics Military and Strategic Studies Asian Studies Middle East Studies Law Criminology (Willan) Business & Management Economics Geography and GIS Anthropology Sociology Sports Science, Leisure Studies, and Culture
83 98 104 114 118 129 145 163 171 176 177 188
Behavioural Sciences Psychology Clinical Psychology and Psychiatry Psychotherapy and Counselling Couples & Family Therapy Psychoanalysis Jung/Analytical Psychology Child & Adolescent Mental Health Creative Arts Therapies
Contents
192 199 201 205 206 209 210 213
Nursing Medical Sociology & Health Studies Alternative Medicine Social Work & Social Policy
215 217 219 219
Medicine
221
Life Sciences Biological Sciences Biotechnology Pharmaceutical Sciences Neuroscience Forensic Science Food Science
222 226 231 233 233 238
Built Environment Architecture Planning Civil Engineering Building Environmental Engineering
244 248 251 253 256
Science and Technology Ergonomics and Human Factors Environmental Science GIS & Remote Sensing Electrical, Chemical, and Mechanical Engineering Industrial Engineering, and Management Mathematics and Statistics Computer Science and Computer Engineering Information Technology Geotechnology, Mining, and Petroleum Engineering Physics, Chemistry and Materials Science Water Management and Technology
259 260 262
Library Reference
316
263 274 277 289 293 298 300 314
Routledge Trade/General Interest 356 Routledge Paperbacks Direct
364
Index Agents and Distribution
374 398
Front Cover Photograph: taken from The Continental Aesthetics Reader
www.tandf.co.uk/books
Welcome to the Taylor & Francis New Titles catalogue Our catalogue Our New Titles catalogue is designed to bring you the most current and accurate information about our new books. It covers a range of subject groups including: • Humanities • Education • Social Sciences • Psychology • Nursing • Architecture & Engineering • Science & Technology • Library Reference • Routledge Paperbacks Direct programme. If you require any further information, please contact your local sales representative who will be happy to assist you (details to be found at the end of this catalogue).
Our history Over two centuries ago, the foundations of the company were laid in pioneering fashion when in 1798 Richard Taylor launched the Philosophical Magazine, one of the first scientific journals produced by an independent company. It was the start of much close collaboration with scholarly societies. Dr William Francis, a chemist, joined Richard Taylor in 1852 and continued the tradition of the close links between the academic community and the company. Today, we continue to be fully committed to the publication of academic and scholarly information of the highest quality and this remains our primary goal. Taylor & Francis has grown rapidly to become a leading international, academic publisher. With offices across the globe, the Taylor & Francis Group now publishes more than 1,500 journals and 3,200 new books each year; with a books backlist in excess of 50,000 specialist titles. * denotes a previously announced title. Prices featured are correct at time of going to press but are subject to change without notice.
Book orders should be addressed to the Taylor & Francis Customer Services Department at Bookpoint, or the appropriate overseas agent. UK/RoW
USA
Bookpoint Ltd 130 Milton Park Abingdon OX14 4SB Tel: +44 (0)1235 400524 Fax: +44 (0)1235 400525 e-mail: book.orders@tandf.co.uk
7625 Empire Dr. Florence KY 41042 Tel: 800-634-7064 email: orders@taylorandfrancis.com
If you would like to receive books on our pre-selective standing order system, please contact your local sales representative or our Customer Services Department: Tel: +44 (0) 1235 400524 e-mail: tandf@bookpoint.co.uk Further information about Taylor & Francis and our products can be found at:
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
www.tandf.co.uk/books http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
2
philosophy
Contemporary French Philosophy Iris Murdoch, Gender A Study in Norms and Values and Philosophy Colin Smith
Sabina Lovibond, University of Oxford, UK
Series: Routledge Revivals First published in 1964, this is not just a chronicle or encyclopaedia, but deals thoroughly in turn with meaning, view about reason, and views about values, particularly moral values. The author’s knowledge of French literature is extensive and thorough, and a feature of the book is his analysis of the philosophical implications of literary works by Sartre, Paul Valery, Camus and others.
Routledge «Market: French Philosophy December 2010: 216x138: 270pp Hb: 978-0-415-61070-4: £70.00/03
Iris Murdoch was one of the best-known philosophers and novelists of the post-war period. Her leanings towards feminism can be detected in her most famous novels, but her philosophy suggests an ambivalence about sexual equality. In this book, Sabina Lovibond explores the tangled and controversial issue of Murdoch’s stance towards gender and feminism. Lovibond analyses Murdoch’s most famous novels and her key philosophical works, exploring themes such as philosophy and literature; the Platonic struggle in much of her philosophy; theories of education; and the clash between religious and secular ethics. She argues that many of these issues need to be set against the greater context of a ‘social imaginary’ in which Murdoch’s work takes place. The first book to properly explore Murdoch and gender, Iris Murdoch, Gender and Philosophy is essential reading for anyone interested in Murdoch’s writing, and debates in feminist philosophy and gender studies. Routledge «Market: Philosophy / Literature March 2011: 234x156: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-42998-6: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-42999-3: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83001-7: £65.00/14
textbook
2nd Edition textbook
Critical Thinking *
Ethics
An Appeal to Reason
A Contemporary Introduction
Peg Tittle
Harry Gensler, John Carroll University, USA
Routledge «Market: Critical Thinking / Philosophy March 2011: 254x203: 480pp Hb: 978-0-415-99713-3: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-99714-0: £33.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-84161-7: £75.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Ethics introduces the issues and controversies of contemporary moral philosophy. It relates these to practical issues, especially racism, moral education, and abortion. It gives a practical method for thinking about moral issues, a method based largely on the golden rule. This second edition adds chapters on virtue ethics and natural law. It also updates the companion EthiCola instructional computer program.
Routledge «Market: Philosophy / Ethics / Moral Philosophy March 2011: 235x156 Hb: 978-0-415-80386-1: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-80388-5: £18.99/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
In Critical Thinking: An Appeal to Reason, Peg Tittle empowers students with a solid grounding in the lifelong skills of considered analysis and argumentation – skills that should underpin every student’s education. Starting with the building blocks of a good argument rather than with the pitfalls to avoid, this comprehensive new textbook offers a full course in critical thinking. It includes chapters on the nature and structure of argument, truth, generalizations, the role of relevance, and the subtleties of verbal and visual language. Throughout the text there are extended sample arguments from books, journals, magazines, television, and the internet for students to analyze. With an interactive companion website and a comprehensive instructor’s manual, Critical Thinking is the ideal textbook for a course in the fundamentals of sound reasoning.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
philosophy
Lectures on Psychical Research
Self-Knowledge *
Incorporating the Perrott Lectures Given in Cambridge University in 1959 and 1960
Brie Gertler, University of Virginia, USA Series: New Problems of Philosophy
C.D. Broad
In this outstanding introduction Brie Gertler assesses the leading theoretical approaches to self-knowledge, explaining the work of many of the key figures in the field: from Descartes and Kant, through to Bertrand Russell and Gareth Evans, as well as recent work by Tyler Burge, David Chalmers, William Lycan and Sydney Shoemaker. Including helpful chapter summaries, annotated further reading and a glossary, Self-Knowledge is essential reading for students of philosophy of mind, epistemology, and metaphysics.
Series: Routledge Revivals This book, first published in 1962, is based on a series of lectures first given at Cambridge University in 1959 and 1960, dealing with ‘psychical research’ – i.e. the scientific investigation of ostensibly paranormal phenomena. Split into three sections, Professor Broad’s study examines numerous issues relating to psychical theory, including guessing, hallucinatory quasi-perception, and trance-mediumship.
Routledge «Market: Philosophy December 2010: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-40525-6: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-40526-3: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83567-8: £75.00/14
Routledge December 2010: 216x138: 464pp Hb: 978-0-415-61072-8: £85.00/03
student reference
reader
Metaphysics: The Key Concepts *
Philosophy of Probability: Contemporary Readings *
Helen Beebee and Nikk Effingham, both at University of Birmingham, UK and Philip Goff, University of Herfordshire, UK Series: Routledge Key Guides Ever wondered about Gunk, Brains in a Vat or Frankfurt’s Nefarious Neurosurgeon? With complete explanations of these terms and more Metaphysics: The Key Concepts is an engaging introduction to the most widely studied and challenging concepts in metaphysics. The authors define and discuss key terms and concepts under the themes of:
Edited by Antony Eagle, University of Oxford, UK Series: Routledge Contemporary Readings in Philosophy Philosophy of Probability: Contemporary Readings is the first anthology to collect the essential readings in this important area of philosophy. Featuring the work leading philosophers in the field such as Carnap, Hájek, Howson, Lewis, Loewer, Popper, Ramsey, Russell, Schaffer, von Mises and many others, the book looks in depth at the following key topics:
• Time
• Subjectivist views
• Particulars & Universals
• logical and classical probability
• Realism & Antirealism
• frequentist probability
• Free Will
• propensity and chance
• Personal Identity
• conditionalization and reflection
• Causation and Laws. Arranged in an easy to use A-Z format, each concept is explored and illustrated with engaging and memorable examples, and provides an up-to-date guide to further reading. Fully cross-referenced throughout, this remarkable reference guide is essential reading for students of philosophy.
for e-mail updates in your field
@
• confirmation theory • conditional probability • the theoretical role of chance: credence and determinism. Each section includes a helpful introduction by the editor, ensuring that this broad-ranging exploration of the subject is also highly accessible, making it ideal for any student of logic, philosophy of mathematics, or philosophy of science. Routledge «Market: Philosophy November 2010: 234x156: 560pp Hb: 978-0-415-48386-5: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-48387-2: £24.99/04
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Philosophy November 2010: 216x138: 368pp Hb: 978-0-415-55927-0: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-55928-7: £16.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83525-8: £65.00/14
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
3
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
4
philosophy
2nd Edition reader
new in paperback
The Continental Aesthetics Reader *
The Routledge Companion to Epistemology
Edited by Clive Cazeaux, University of Wales Institute, Cardiff
Edited by Sven Bernecker and Duncan Pritchard, University of Edinburgh, UK
The Continental Aesthetics Reader collects together classic writings on art and aesthetics from the major figures in Continental thought. The second edition is clearly divided into seven sections:
Series: Routledge Philosophy Companions Epistemology, the philosophy of knowledge, is at the core of many of the central debates and issues in philosophy, interrogating the notions of truth, objectivity, trust, belief and perception. The Routledge Companion to Epistemology provides a comprehensive and the up-to-date survey of epistemology, charting its history, providing a thorough account of its key thinkers and movements, and addressing enduring questions and contemporary research in the field. Organized thematically, the Companion is divided into nine sections: Foundational Issues, The Analysis of Knowledge, The Structure of Knowledge, Kinds of Knowledge, Skepticism, Responses to Skepticism, Knowledge and Knowledge Attributions, Formal Epistemology, The History of Epistemology, and Metaepistemological Issues. Seventy-eight chapters, each between 5000 and 7000 words and written by the world’s leading epistemologists, provide students with an outstanding and accessible guide to the field.
• Nineteenth-Century German Aesthetics • Phenomenology and Hermeneutics • Marxism and Critical Theory • Embodiment and Technology • Excess and Affect • Poststructuralism and Postmodernism • Aesthetic Ontologies. Each section is placed in its historical and philosophical context with introductions by Clive Cazeaux. An updated list of readings for this edition includes selections from Rancière, Badiou, and Zizek. Ideal for introductory courses in aesthetics, Continental philosophy, art, and visual studies, The Continental Aesthetics Reader provides a thorough introduction to some of the most influential writings on art and aesthetics from Kant to Derrida. Routledge «Market: Philosophy Art / Visual Culture February 2011: 246x174: 672pp Pb: 978-0-415-48184-7: £24.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-20054-7
Routledge «Market: Philosophy February 2011: 246x174: 896pp Hb: 978-0-415-96219-3: £110.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83906-5: £125.00/14
textbook
Semantic Externalism
Theories of Ethics *
Series: New Problems of Philosophy Semantic externalism is the view that the meaning of a term, and the understanding of a language in general, is relational; determined by factors external to the speaker and bound up with our environment. In this long-needed book, Jesper Kallestrup provides an invaluable map of the problem. Beginning with a thorough introduction to the theories of descriptivism and referentialism and the work of Frege and Kripke, Kallestrup moves on to analyse Putnam’s ‘Twin Earth’ argument. He also discusses how semantic externalism is at the heart of important topics such as narrow and wide content, self-knowledge, and mental causation. Including chapter summaries, a glossary of terms, and an annotated guide to further reading, Semantic Externalism an ideal guide for students studying philosophy of language and philosophy of mind. Routledge «Market: Philosophy March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-44996-0: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-44997-7: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83002-4: £75.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
An Introduction to Moral Philosophy with a Selection of Classic Readings Gordon Graham, Princeton Theological Seminary, USA This book offers a comprehensive survey of the major schools and figures in moral philosophy, from Socrates to the present day. Written entirely in non-technical language, it aims to be introductory without being elementary, so that readers may quickly engage with selected readings from classic sources. The writings of major philosophers are explained in a structured exploration of recurrently important issues about right and wrong, good and evil, and social relations and religious meaning. Primary sources include those from Aristotle, Camus, Hume, Kant, Locke, Mill, Leopold, Lovelock, Nietzsche, Plato, Reid, and Sartre. Routledge «Market: Ethics / Moral Philosophy January 2011: 254x178: 352pp Hb: 978-0-415-99946-5: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-99947-2: £21.99/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83512-8: £65.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Jesper Kallestrup, University of Edinburgh, UK
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
philosophy
The Routledge Companion to Philosophy and Film
The Routledge Companion to Philosophy and Music
Edited by Paisley Livingston, Lingnan University, Hong Kong and Carl Plantinga, Calvin College, USA
Edited by Andrew Kania, Trinity University, USA and Theodore Gracyk, Minnesota State University, USA
Series: Routledge Philosophy Companions
Series: Routledge Philosophy Companions
‘A fascinating, rich volume offering dazzling insights and incisive commentary on every page, the book not only covers a wide range of concerns and concepts but is also organized and presented in a clear, straightforward manner. Every serious student of film will want this book, which could also serve as a text in advanced film-theory classes. Summing Up: Highly recommended.’ – CHOICE
Each chapter includes a section of annotated further reading and is cross-referenced to related entries. The Routledge Companion to Philosophy and Film is essential reading for anyone interested in philosophy of film, aesthetics, and cinema studies.
çè
Routledge «Market: Philosophy / Film February 2011: 246x174: 704pp Pb: 978-0-415-49394-9: £29.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-87932-0: £125.00/14
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
The Routledge Companion to Philosophy and Music is an outstanding guide and reference source to the key topics, subjects, thinkers and debates in philosophy and music. Over fifty entries by an international team of contributors are organised into six clear sections: • general issues • emotion • history • figures • kinds of music • music, philosophy and related disciplines. The Routledge Companion to Philosophy and Music is essential reading for anyone interested in philosophy, music and musicology. Routledge «Market: Philosophy / Music March 2011: 246x174: 704pp Hb: 978-0-415-48603-3: £110.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83037-6: £125.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
The Routledge Companion to Philosophy and Film explores the main themes, topics, thinkers and issues in philosophy and film. Sixty specially commissioned chapters from international scholars are divided into four clear parts: issues and concepts; authors and trends; genres; and film as philosophy.
5
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
philosophy
Contrastivism in Philosophy * Edited by Martijn Blaauw, Vrije Universiteit Amsterdam, the Netherlands Series: Routledge Studies in Contemporary Philosophy This volume brings together state-of-the-art research on the contrastive treatment of philosophical concepts and questions, including knowledge, belief, free will, moral luck, Bayesian confirmation theory, causation, and explanation. Routledge «Market: Philosophy February 2011: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-87860-9: £75.00/08
Dialectics, Politics, and the Contemporary Value of Hegel’s Practical Philosophy Andrew Buchwalter, University of North Florida, USA Series: Routledge Studies in Nineteenth Century Philosophy This book explores and details the actuality (Aktualität) of Hegel’s social and political philosophy – its relevance, topicality, presence, and contemporary validity. Routledge «Market: Philosophy February 2011: 229x152: 260pp Hb: 978-0-415-80610-7: £75.00/08
Epistemology and the Regress Problem * Scott Aikin, Vanderbilt University, USA Series: Routledge Studies in Contemporary Philosophy In this new study, Aikin presents a full case for infinitism as a response to the issue of the regress of reasons. The most defensible form of infinitism, he argues, is that of a mixed theory – that is, epistemic infinitism must be consistent with and even rely on other solutions to the regress problem. Routledge «Market: Philosophy January 2011: 229x152: 216pp Hb: 978-0-415-87800-5: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83324-7: £75.00/14
Philosophical Delusion and its Therapy *
The Ethics of Forgiveness
Outline of a Philosophical Revolution
Series: Routledge Studies in Ethics and Moral Theory
Eugen Fischer, University of East Anglia, UK
We are often pressed to forgive or in need of forgiveness. Communicating about forgiveness is particularly urgent in cases of civil war and crimes against humanity inside a community. But who should forgive whom for what? The papers collected here explore answers to this question.
Series: Routledge Studies in Contemporary Philosophy This book provides new foundations and methods for the revolutionary project of philosophical therapy pioneered by Ludwig Wittgenstein. With the help of concepts adapted from different branches of cognitive science – cognitive linguistics, cognitive and clinical psychology – the book explains where and why therapy is called for in philosophy, and develops techniques to actually carry it out. Routledge «Market: Philosophy January 2011: 229x152: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-33179-1: £80.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-39789-3: £80.00/08
Philosophy, Ethics and A Common Humanity Essays in Honour of Raimond Gaita Edited by Christopher Cordner, University of Melbourne, Australia The work of Raimond Gaita, in books such as Good and Evil: An Absolute Conception, A Common Humanity and The Philosopher’s Dog, has made an outstanding and controversial contribution to philosophy. In this superb collection an international team of contributors examine the full range of Gaita’s thought, including philosophy and biography, the unthinkable, Plato and ancient philosophy, animals, Wittgenstein, the religious dimensions of Gaita’s work, Aboriginal reconciliation in Australia, and psychology and ethics. Routledge «Market: Philosophy March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-54638-6: £60.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83000-0: £60.00
The Assumption of Agency Theory Kate Forbes-Pitt Series: Ontological Explorations Routledge «Market: Philosophy March 2011: 234x156 Hb: 978-0-415-78211-1: £85.00/03
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
Edited by Christel Fricke, University of Oslo, Norway
Routledge «Market: Philosophy February 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-88543-0: £80.00/08
Vanishing Matter and the Laws of Nature * Descartes and Beyond Edited by Peter Anstey, University of Otago, New Zealand and Dana Jalobeanu, Western University ‘Vasile Goldis,’ Romania Series: Routledge Studies in Seventeenth Century Philosophy In the early modern period the nature of matter was a deeply vexing problem for philosophers. This volume examines various attempts by leading philosophers to come to terms with the nature of matter, with special, though not exclusive, attention given to Descartes, Newton and Leibniz. Routledge «Market: Philosophy January 2011: 229x152: 264pp Hb: 978-0-415-88266-8: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83338-4: £75.00/14
Causation and Modern Philosophy Edited by Keith Allen and Tom Stoneham, both at University of York, UK Series: Routledge Advances in the History of Philosophy This volume brings together a collection of new essays by leading scholars on the subject of causation in the early modern period, from Descartes to Lady Mary Shepherd. Routledge «Market: Philosophy January 2011: 229x152: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-88355-9: £85.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83011-6: £85.00/14
çè
6
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
religion textbook
2nd Edition student reference
AQA Religious Ethics for AS and A2 *
Islam: The Basics
Jill Oliphant, Angley School, UK
Colin Turner, Durham University, UK Series: The Basics This book provides an introduction to the Islamic faith, examining the doctrines of the religion, the practises of Muslims and the history and significance of Islam in modern contexts. Key topics covered include:
Edited by Jon Mayled, Freelance Editor and Writer, UK and Anne Tunley, Gateways School, UK AQA Religious Ethics for AS and A2 is the definitive textbook for students of Advanced Subsidiary or Advanced Level courses, structured directly around the specification of the AQA. The book covers all the topics for Religious Ethics in an enjoyable student-friendly fashion. Each chapter includes:
• the Qur’an and its teachings • the life of the Prophet Muhammad • gender, women and Islam • Sufism and Shi’ism
• a list of key issues, to introduce students to the topic • an AQA specification checklist • explanations of key terminology • exam practice questions • self-test review questions • helpful summaries. To maximise students’ chances of exam success, the book includes a chapter dedicated to answering examination questions. The book comes complete with illustrations and diagrams, a comprehensive glossary, a full bibliography and a companion website.
• Islam and the western world • non-Muslim approaches to Islam. With updated further reading and an expanded chronology of turning points in the Islamic world, this book is essential reading for students of religious studies and all those new to the subject of Islam. Routledge «Market: Religion / Islam March 2011: 198x129: 220pp Hb: 978-0-415-58491-3: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58492-0: £11.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-34106-6
Routledge «Market: Religious Studies / A Level March 2011: 246x189: 384pp Pb: 978-0-415-54933-2: £21.99/04
Japanese Religions on the Internet Innovation, Representation, and Authority Edited by Erica Baffelli, University of Otago, New Zealand, Ian Reader, University of Lancaster, UK and Birgit Staemmler, University of Tübingen, Germany Series: Routledge Research in Religion, Media and Culture This book identifies and analyzes some of the contours of the ‘Japanese Internet’ in the context of religion and offers suggestions about wider issues related to religion and the Internet. In particular, the editors identify three key issues that are important in assessing the Internet in religious terms: innovation, representation, and authority. While examining various claims that have been made about the potential of the Internet in religious contexts and assessing the impact of the Internet in relation to other media forms, the essays in this volume explore the tensions that arise through the emergence of web developments and the different types of religious representation found within these developments, including personal blogs and sites run by individuals as well as those established and run by religious organizations.
for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Religion March 2011: 229x152: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-88643-7: £70.00/08
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
7
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
history 8
TOP TEN BESTSELLERS
religion
1.
6. British Civilization
The European World 1500–1800
An Introduction
An Introduction to Early Modern History
John Oakland
Edited by Beat Kümin
2006: 246x174: 336pp Pb: 978-0-415-36522-2: £17.99/04
2009: 246x174: 400pp Pb: 978-0-415-43253-5: £19.99/04
6th Edition
2.
7. 5th Edition
2nd Edition
American Civilization
The Oral History Reader
An Introduction
Edited by Robert Perks and Alistair Thomson
David C. Mauk and John Oakland
2006: 246x174: 592pp Pb: 978-0-415-34303-9: £23.99/04
2009: 246x174: 424pp Pb: 978-0-415-48162-5: £17.99/04
3.
8. 2nd Edition
2nd Edition
International History of the Twentieth Century and Beyond
Modern South Asia History, Culture, Political Economy 2003: 234x156: 272pp Pb: 978-0-415-30787-1: £19.99/04
Antony Best, Jussi M. Hanhimäki, Joseph A. Maiolo and Kirsten E. Schulze 2008: 246x189: 640pp Pb: 978-0-415-43896-4: £24.99/04
4.
9. A History of Popular Culture
2nd Edition
Europe 1783–1914
Raymond F. Betts
2009: 246x189: 480pp Pb: 978-0-415-47066-7: £22.99/04
2004: 234x156: 192pp Pb: 978-0-415-22128-3: £19.99/04
5.
10. Introduction to Medieval Europe 300–1550
3rd Edition
Wim Blockmans and Peter Hoppenbrouwers
Edited by Mike Storry and Peter Childs
2007: 246x189: 392pp Pb: 978-0-415-34699-3: £23.99/04
2007: 246x174: 320pp Pb: 978-0-415-42460-8: £19.99/04
( +44 (0)1235 400524
British Cultural Identities
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
order now!
More of Everything, Faster and Brighter
William Simpson and Martin Jones
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
history
American History Goes to the Movies Hollywood and the American Experience W. Bryan Rommel Ruiz, The Colorado College in Colorado Springs, USA What should movies teach us about American history? A lesson about pristine American exceptionalism or a history that includes the tragedies as well as the triumphs that define the American experience? American History Goes to the Movies explores both of these questions to find the meaning of the American experience through the films that represent this history to a general audience such as JFK, The Exorcist, The Last of the Mohicans, The Crucible, Glory , and many more. Written in accessible language for students, scholars, and film history buffs, American History Goes to the Movies weaves historiography with cultural significance to show readers how historical narratives are built, and makes the perfect introduction to the study of American history on film. Routledge «Market: American History / Film Studies January 2011: 229x152: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-80219-2: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-80220-8: £18.99/04
9
Calvin Michael Mullett, Lancaster University, UK Series: Routledge Historical Biographies John Calvin is one of the most important figures in religious history. Sitting at the cusp of the medieval and early modern world, he was centre stage during the huge schism that split the early modern church. This new biography not only ties his life together with that of Martin Luther, but also stresses his individual contribution and influence. In examining his life and work, Mullett also explores the many significant influences on Calvin and his work, and the relationships that he formed along his ‘reforming’ path. As well as exploring the impact of Calvin throughout the early modern period and the importance of his work to contemporaries, Mullett also assesses the impact that Calvin’s works have had in shaping the modern world, and the relevance that they still have today. Routledge «Market: European History / Religious Studies March 2011: 198x129: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-47698-0: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-47699-7: £14.99/04
7th Edition textbook
British Civilization * Chemical Warfare during the Vietnam War
An Introduction John Oakland The seventh edition of this highly-praised textbook has been substantially updated and revised to provide students of British Studies with the perfect introduction to Britain. It includes:
Riot Control Agents in Combat D. Hank Ellison, Cerberus & Associates, Grosse Ile, Michigan, USA
çè
Routledge «Market: History / Military Studies November 2010: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-87644-5: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87645-2: £24.99/04
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
• discussion of recent developments and areas of topical interest in British society such as immigration, the recession, devolution and coverage of the 2010 election • new full colour illustrations • exercises and questions to stimulate class discussion • insights into the attitudes of British people today towards important issues • updated suggestions for further reading and useful websites • a fully updated companion website featuring quiz questions and links to video clips. British Civilization is a vital introduction to the crucial and complex identities of Britain. Routledge «Market: British Studies and History December 2010: 246x174: 336pp Hb: 978-0-415-58327-5: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58328-2: £19.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83581-4: £75.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-36522-2
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Chemical Warfare during the Vietnam War documents the use of antipersonnel chemical weapons throughout the Vietnam War, and explores their effectiveness under the wide variety of circumstances in which they were employed. The short, readable account follows the US program and also presents the efforts of the North Vietnamese to both counter US chemical operations and to develop a chemical capability of their own. This largely overlooked facet of the Vietnam War provides an opportunity for students and scholars to examine many of the potential issues surrounding the use of chemical agents in modern military operations, and serves as a backdrop to discussion of broader issues associated with chemical warfare, including the power of public perception. Chemical Warfare during the Vietnam War is a comprehensive and thoroughly fascinating examination of riot-control agents during the Vietnam War.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
10 history
Converging Worlds
Crime and the Rise of Modern America
Communities and Cultures in Colonial America Edited by Louise A. Breen, Kansas State University, USA
A History from 1865–1941
Providing a survey of colonial American history both regionally broad and ‘Atlantic’ in coverage, Converging Worlds presents the most recent research in an accessible manner for undergraduate students.
Kristofer Allerfeldt, University of Exeter, UK Crime and the Rise of Modern America is a thematic history of crime in the USA from the time of Lee’s surrender at Appomattox to Japan’s attack on Pearl Harbor. Kristofer Allerfeldt takes the period of American history where the country was changing into a truly modern, unified nation, and examines the roles crime and criminality have played in the growth of the nation. He’s categorized crime into accessible, exciting, and concise chapters covering such topics as hate crime, crime in the American West, drink and drug related crimes, prostitution and sex crimes, political crime, business crime, and more. Crime and the Rise of Modern America provides a window into America’s past to show both how far the United States has come as a nation, and how some things never change.
With chapters written by top-notch scholars, Converging Worlds is unique in providing not only a comprehensive chronological approach to colonial history with attention to thematic details, but a window into the relevant historiography. Each historian also selected several documents to accompany their chapter, found in the companion primary source reader. With its synthesis of both broad time periods and specific themes, Converging Worlds is ideal for students of the colonial period, and provides a fascinating glimpse into the diverse foundations of America. For additional information and classroom resources please visit the Converging Worlds companion website at www.routledge.com/ textbooks/ConvergingWorlds.
Routledge «Market: American History / Criminology April 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-80044-0: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-80045-7: £19.99/04
Routledge «Market: American History March 2011: 235x156: 416pp Hb: 978-0-415-96498-2: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-96499-9: £21.99/04
textbook reader
2nd Edition
Converging Worlds
Childhood in World History *
Communities and Cultures in Colonial America, A Sourcebook
Peter N. Stearns, George Mason University, USA Series: Themes in World History
Edited by Louise A. Breen, Kansas State University, USA
Routledge «Market: American History March 2011: 235x156: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-96496-8: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-96497-5: £24.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Now fully up to date, this second edition of Childhood in World History highlights the gains but also the divisions and losses for children across the millennia, providing an accessible and concise overview. Updates include: • an expanded discussion of the theory and methodology involved in a global history of childhood • expanded coverage of childhood in Africa and South Asia • extra material on religious change, including more discussion of Judaism and Islam • new material on the role of the state • a brand new comparative chapter on happiness and childhood. Routledge «Market: History / World History November 2010: 234x156: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-59808-8: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59809-5: £18.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83975-1: £65.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-35233-8
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
The field of colonial American history is an incredibly exciting area of study, but one that is often difficult for undergraduates to grasp, as there is so much going on. Over the last 25 years, there have been increasingly specialized studies done on particular colonial regions or themes, but there is no consensus on the narrative of early America, which makes the study of the period seemingly disjointed for students. This book is the document sourcebook accompanying The Colonial American World course book. Each chapter author of the text has hand-picked five documents that go along with the chapter they’ve written for the text. However, it would be just as easy for an instructor to use the sourcebook on its own, since there will also be a general introduction and section introductions framing the documents.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
history 11
International Economic Relations since 1945 Catherine Schenk Series: The Making of the Contemporary World The international economy since 1945 has endured dramatic changes in its balance of power, from the early period of prosperity for industrialised nations, to the 2008/9 global crisis. In this volume Catherine Schenk outlines these huge changes, examines how the world’s economic leaders have tried to organise and influence the international economy and presents the key frameworks in which international economic relations have developed. Routledge «Market: Economic History February 2011: 216x138: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-57076-3: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57078-7: £16.99/04
Modernity’s End Time and History in the Discursive Condition Elizabeth Deeds Ermarth, Trent University, Canada Elizabeth Deeds Ermarth’s bold new book argues that modernity had its roots in the Renaissance and traces the history of modernity and postmodernity in Western culture from that time. She provides a new, clear definition of modernity and a clear statement of the broadly established challenges to modernity, and the most important practical implications of those challenges for such basic things as individuality, political agency, creativity, the nature of time, the role of method. After decades of conflicting work on related issues, this succinct, lucid and wide-ranging discussion of what is at stake is much needed. Drawing on a wide range of intellectual history from Homer to Hayden White and from the arts to physics, philosophy and politics, this book defines a new stage in the history of ideas. Routledge «Market: History / Philosophy February 2011: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-78218-0: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-78219-7: £22.99/04
3rd Edition textbook
Modern South Asia History, Culture, Political Economy Sugata Bose, Harvard University, USA and Ayesha Jalal, Tufts University, USA Drawing on the newest and most sophisticated historical research and scholarship in the field, Modern South Asia provides a challenging insight for those with an intellectual curiosity about the region. This third edition brings the coverage up to the present day, looking at the closer integration of South Asia with the global economy, the impact of developments in Afghanistan on the region as a whole, the large implications of Benazir Bhutto’s assassination and the fresh challenges to South Asia’s nation-states.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
David Hipshon, St James Independent School, UK Series: Routledge Historical Biographies This new biography takes a nuanced view of the life and reign of one of England’s most controversial monarchs, placing the scandals and mysteries that are so readily associated with Richard III in the wider context of the period in which he lived, and of the ever growing debate over his character. Analysing the influences of those around him, his faith, literary interests and devotion to chivalric ideals, David Hipshon defines Richard’s character as being central to the analysis of his actions. Incorporating new research on the feud between the Stanley and the Harrington families and previously unpublished material from the Duchy of Lancaster archives, this biography sheds new light on a man who was very much a product of the time of change and complexity in which he lived. Routledge «Market: History / British History December 2010: 198x129: 264pp Hb: 978-0-415-46280-8: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-46281-5: £15.99/04
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: History and Asian Studies January 2011: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-77942-5: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-77943-2: £19.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-30787-1
Richard III *
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
12 history
The British and the Grand Tour
The Historical Revolution *
Jeremy Black
English Historical Writing and Thought 1580–1640
Series: Routledge Revivals
Frank Smith Fussner First published in 1985, this is a history of the Grand Tour, undertaken by young men in the eighteenth century to complete their education – a tour usually to France, Italy and Switzerland, and sometimes encompassing Germany. Rather than being another popular treatment of the theme, this is a scholarly analysis of the motives, purposes, activities and achievements of those who made the Grand Tour.
The book considers to what extent the Grand Tour did fulfil its theoretical educational function, or whether travellers merely parroted the observations of their guidebooks. It also indicates the importance of the Grand Tour in introducing foreign customs into Britain and extending the cosmopolitanism of the European upper classes. Routledge «Market: History November 2010: 216x138: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-60976-0: £75.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83244-8: £75.00/14
Series: Routledge Revivals First published in 1962, Frank Smith Fussner’s introduction to the revolution in English historical writing and thought during the period of the renaissance and reformation (1580–1640) is an influential and thoroughly-researched work. It offers an introduction not only to the context of the period and the important English historians of the era, but also provides a thorough historiographical approach which deals with the purpose, method, content, style and significance of these historians within the framework of this ‘historical revolution’. Routledge «Market: History October 2010: 216x138: 370pp Hb: 978-0-415-60242-6: £80.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83554-8: £80.00/14
reader
The English Press in the Eighteenth Century
The History of Sexuality in Europe *
Jeremy Black
A Sourcebook and Reader
Series: Routledge Revivals
Edited by Anna Clark, University of Minnesota, USA First published in 1987, this is a comprehensive analysis of the rise of the British Press in the eighteenth century, as a component of the understanding of eighteenth century political and social history. Professor Black considers the reasons for the growth of the ‘print culture’ and the relations of newspapers to magazines and pamphlets; the mechanics of circulation; and chronological developments.
Extensively illustrated with quotations from newspapers of the time, the book is a lively as well as original and informative treatment of a topic that must remain of first importance for the literate historian. Routledge «Market: History November 2010: 216x138: 340pp Hb: 978-0-415-60977-7: £75.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83243-1: £75.00/14
Series: Routledge Readers in History The History of Sexuality in Europe: A Sourcebook and Reader is a dynamic introduction to the latest debates in the history of Sexuality in Europe. It begins with an introduction that introduces the new concept of sexual grammar. The Reader focuses on the modern age, but has three chapters on the ancient and medieval world to demonstrate their very different cultures of sexuality. Each section of the Reader pairs the latest chapters and articles by experts with primary sources, addressing questions such as: • Were Victorians sexually repressed? • How did nonwestern cultures change some Europeans’ ideas about sex? • Does regulating prostitution protect or punish women who sell sex? • Were 60s feminists pro or anti sex? An essential collection for all students of the history of sexuality.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: History of Sexuality December 2010: 246x174: 336pp Hb: 978-0-415-78139-8: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-78140-4: £26.99/04
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
history 13
The Routledge History of the Holocaust *
Women in European Culture and Society *
Edited by Jonathan C. Friedman, West Chester University, USA
Gender, Skill and Identity from 1700
Series: Routledge Histories
Deborah Simonton, University of Southern Denmark
The genocide of Jewish and non-Jewish civilians perpetrated by the German regime during World War Two continues to confront scholars with elusive questions even after nearly seventy years and hundreds of studies. This multi-contributory work is a landmark publication that sees experts renowned in their field addressing these questions in light of current research. Serving as a comprehensive introduction to the history of the Holocaust, this volume also adds depth to current debate, both geographically and topically, assessing the Final Solution as the German occupation instituted it across Europe and covering issues which have previously been under-investigated, such as the problem of prosecuting war crimes, gender and Holocaust experience, the persecution of non-Jewish victims, and the Holocaust in post-war culture.
A new and major contribution to the field, Women in European Culture and Society is a transnational history of women in Europe that pushes women’s history beyond national studies to create an integrated view of three hundred years of women in Europe. Using a longue durée, the book disentangles the accounts of industrialisation and bourgeois femininity which tend to dominate women’s studies, and questions the dominant narratives of history. Drawing on women’s own writing and cultural production, it presents women as agents of change as well as exploring cultural perceptions of women and the ways in which women have been represented by these discourses. Women in European Culture and Society is an invaluable and essential guide to the conditions, circumstances and understandings of how women lived throughout Europe.
Routledge «Market: Jewish History / Modern History November 2010: 246x174: 512pp Hb: 978-0-415-77956-2: £120.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83744-3: £120.00/14
Routledge «Market: History / Women’s Studies December 2010: 234x156: 352pp Hb: 978-0-415-21307-3: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-21308-0: £22.99/04
5th Edition student reference
reader
The Routledge Atlas of British History
Work and Struggle
Martin Gilbert
Edited by Paul Le Blanc, La Roche College
Series: Routledge Historical Atlases
Work and Struggle: Voices from US Labor Radicalism focuses on the history of US labor with an emphasis on radical currents, which have been essential elements in the labor movements – particularly the working-class movement from the mid-19th century to the late 20th century. Showcasing some of labor’s most important leaders, Work and Struggle offers students and instuctors a variety of voices to learn from – each telling their story through their own words – through memoirs and speeches, transcribed and introduced here by Paul Le Blanc, for use in the classroom alongside or instead of a text.
This thoroughly updated Atlas charts the changing story of the British Isles from the eve of the Roman conquest to the aftermath of the 2010 general election. The key themes covered are: • Politics: from the Saxon kingdoms to the Jacobites, through to the political challenges of 2010 • War and Conflict – from Viking attacks to today’s Wars in Afghanistan and the War in Iraq • Trade and Industry – from the postNorman economy to the present day • Religion – from the Saxon Church to modern times • Society and Economics – from civilian life in Roman Britain to the General Strike, unemployment, homelessness, government expenditure and overseas aid
Voices from US Labor Radicalism
Routledge «Market: American History / Labor January 2011: 235x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-87746-6: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87824-1: £24.99/04
• Immigration – the growth of immigrant communities; the wide range of countries from which immigrants came; how that is changing in contemporary Britain.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: History / British Politics January 2011: 246x174: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-60875-6: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-60876-3: £16.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-39551-9
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
14 history Belonging in Europe – The African Diaspora and Work
Music and Globalization in History
Edited by Caroline Bressey and Hakim Adi, both at University College London, UK
This book contextualizes a globalization process that has since ancient times involved the creation, use, and world-wide movement of song, instrumental music, musical drama, music with dance, concert, secular, popular and religious music. Music and Globalization in History provides connectivity between the people and the activities and events in which music is used and the means by which it moves from one place to another.
Although often assumed to have begun with post-war immigration, the black presence in Europe in fact pre-dates the forced migrations of trans-Atlantic slavery. This volume seeks to not only mark these early histories, but to examine the lives of those who made their lives in Europe before 1945. This book was originally published as a special issue of Immigrants and Minorities . Routledge «Market: History / Migration / Black Studies November 2010: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-48870-9: £80.00/08
Richard Wetzel, Ohio University, USA
Routledge «Market: History April 2011: 229x152: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-87475-5: £70.00/08
The Politics and Memory of Democratic Transition The Spanish Model Edited by Diego Muro and Gregorio Alonso, both at University of London, UK Series: Routledge/Canada Blanch Studies on Contemporary Spain This collection of essays focuses on the social, political and cultural transformations witnessed in Spain in the late 1970s. By combining top-down and bottom-up approaches, the volume offers a renewed approach to the peaceful (re-)birth of Spanish democracy and to those actors and factors that made it possible. Routledge «Market: History December 2010: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-99720-1: £70.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83483-1: £70.00/14
Foundations of Modernity
Statistics and the Public Sphere, 1750–2000
Human Agency and the Imperial State
Numbers and the People in Modern Britain
Isa Blumi, Georgia State University, USA
Edited by Thomas H. Crook, Memory Assessment Clinics and Glen O’Hara, Oxford Brookes University, UK
Women in the United States Military
Series: Routledge Studies in Modern British History
An Annotated Bibliography
Contemporary life in Britain would be unthinkable without statistics. Numbers attract criticism on the grounds of their veracity and utility. There are no works which aim to analyse the historical entanglement of the two; this book addresses this neglected area of historiography, and places the present in historical perspective.
Judith Bellafaire
Series: Routledge Studies in Modern History Investigating how a number of modern empires transform over the long 19th century (1789–1914) as a consequence of their struggle for ascendancy in the Eastern Mediterranean and Middle East, Foundations of Modernity: Human Agency and the Imperial State moves the study of the modern empire towards a comparative, trans-regional analysis of events along the Ottoman frontiers: the Balkans, the Persian Gulf, and the Red Sea. This inter-disciplinary approach of studying events at different ends of the Ottoman Empire challenges previous emphasis on Europe as the only source of change and highlights the progression of modern imperial states.
Routledge «Market: History February 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-87894-4: £70.00/08
Routledge «Market: History May 2011: 229x152: 250pp Hb: 978-0-415-88464-8: £70.00/08
Series: Routledge Research Guides to American Military Studies Women’s participation in the U.S. Armed Forces has grown over time in response to the national need for their services. Throughout each era of American history, patriotic women volunteered to serve their country in a wide variety of official and unofficially sanctioned capacities. When there was a call to duty, the United States Armed Forces always relied upon women to be a part of the effort. Women in the United States Military: An Annotated Bibliography is the most complete and up to date listing of resources to help students and scholars understand the effect women have had on the wars that have shaped the United States. Covering everything from the American Revolution to Operations in Iraq, Women in the United States Military is essential for all academic and research libraries.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Military Studies / Reference November 2010: 229x152: 144pp Hb: 978-0-415-80146-1: £95.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83509-8: £95.00/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
archaeology and museum studies 15
Iron Age Myth and Materiality An Archaeology of Scandinavia AD 400–1000 Lotte Hedeager, University of Oslo, Norway Iron Age Myth and Materiality: an Archaeology of Scandinavia AD 400–1000 considers the relationship between myth and materiality in Scandinavia from the beginning of the post-Roman era and the European Migrations around AD 400 up until the coming of Christianity around AD 1000. It pursues an interdisciplinary interpretation of text and material culture and examines how the documentation of an oral past relates to its material embodiment. Old Norse myths are explored with particular attention to one of the central mythical narratives of the Old Norse canon, the mythic cycle of Odin, king of the Norse pantheon. No other study provides such a broad ranging and authoritative study of the relationship of myth to the archaeology of Scandinavia. Routledge «Market: Archaeology February 2011: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-60602-8: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-60604-2: £24.99/04
An Archaeology of Materials
Museum Gallery Interpretation and Material Culture
Representing Enslavement and Abolition in Museums
Chantal Conneller, University of Manchester, UK
Edited by Juliette Fritsch, Victoria and Albert Museum, UK
Series: Routledge Studies in Archaeology
Series: Routledge Research in Museum Studies
Edited by Laurajane Smith, Geoff Cubitt, Kalliopi Fouseki and Ross Wilson, all at University of York, UK
This book challenges current understandings of materials and offers an alternative approach. Conneller argues that the properties of materials emerge through practice. Case studies from Early Prehistory are used to reveal that, rather than being a minor part of technical practice, materials tell us something more fundamental about past worlds.
Museum Gallery Interpretation and Material Culture will publish the proceedings of the first annual Sackler Centre for Arts Education conference at the Victoria and Albert Museum (V&A) in London. The conference launched the annual series by addressing the question of how gallery interpretation design and management can help museum visitors learn about art and material culture. The book will feature a range of papers by leading academics, museum learning professionals, graduate researchers and curators from Europe, the USA and Canada.
Substantial Transformations in Early Prehistoric Europe
Routledge «Market: Archaeology January 2011: 229x152: 168pp Hb: 978-0-415-88130-2: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83372-8: £75.00/14
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Museum Studies April 2011: 229x152: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-88575-1: £70.00/08
Series: Routledge Research in Museum Studies This book – which uniquely draws together contributions from academic commentators, museum professionals, community activists and artists who had an involvement with the bicentenary – reflects on the complexity and difficulty of museums’ experiences in presenting and interpreting the histories of slavery and abolition, and to place these experiences in the broader context of debates over the bicentenary’s significance and the lessons to be learnt from it. Routledge «Market: Museum Studies April 2011: 229x152: 232pp Hb: 978-0-415-88504-1: £70.00/08
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
16 classical studies 2nd Edition textbook
4th Edition textbook
Ancient Cities *
The Greek World 479–323 BC
The Archaeology of Urban Life in the Ancient Near East and Egypt, Greece and Rome
Simon Hornblower, University College London, UK
Charles Gates, Bilkent University, Turkey
The Greek World 479–323 BC has been the benchmark text for students of this important period of Greek history since its first publication. Simon Hornblower has brought the book up-to-date with modern scholarship to ensure that it retains that position. Now more than ever the book provides a holistic assessment of Greece and its neighbours in the fifth and fourth centuries BC. While there is close examination of Athens, Sparta and the other great city-states Greece, the broader Mediterranean from the beginning of the fifth century onwards is detailed from available sources such as Pindar and Bacchylides. The Greek World 479–323 BC is written in erudite yet lively prose and is organized to ensure ease of comprehension. Providing a rich range of sources material, it a necessity for those wishing to study this fascinating era of Greek history.
This brings to life the physical world of ancient city dwellers. The urban form of the cities, and the architecture and geography that created it are examined, as well as non-urban features such as religious sanctuaries and burial grounds – places and institutions that were a familiar part of the city dweller’s experience. It is unusual in presenting this wide range of Old World cultures in such detail, giving equal weight to the Preclassical and Classical periods, and in showing the links between these ancient cultures. Features include: • clear and accessible language, assuming no background knowledge • lavishly illustrated with nearly 300 line drawings, maps and photos • a companion website with extra images and material • summaries, further reading arranged by topic, a consolidated bibliography and comprehensive index. Routledge «Market: Classical Studies and Archaeology March 2011: 246x174: 464pp Hb: 978-0-415-49865-4: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-49864-7: £22.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-12182-8
Classical Literature * An Introduction Edited by Neil Croally and Roy Hyde Series: Aspects of Classical Civilization Classical Literature: An Introduction provides an overview of the essential aspects of Greek and Latin literature. In conjunction with contextualising introductions the material is presented chronologically, by genre and where appropriate by author. The book ranges from Homer to the Roman Empire. Features include: • a chronology of ancient literature
Series: The Routledge History of the Ancient World
Routledge «Market: Classical Studies and Greek History February 2011: 234x156: 416pp Hb: 978-0-415-60291-4: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-60292-1: £23.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-16326-2
Roman Urban Street Networks Alan Kaiser, University of Evansville, USA Series: Routledge Studies in Archaeology Roman Urban Street Networks is the first volume to sift through the ancient literature to determine how authors used the Latin vocabulary for streets, and determine what that tells us about how the Romans perceived their streets. Author Alan Kaiser offers a methodology for describing the role of a street within the broader urban transportation network in such a way that one can compare both individual streets and street networks from one site to another. Kaiser suggests that streets provided the organizing principle for ancient Roman cities, offering an exciting new way of describing and comparing Roman street networks. This book will certainly lead to an expanded discussion of approaches to and understandings of Roman streetscapes and urbanism. Routledge «Market: Archaeology March 2011: 229x152: 216pp Hb: 978-0-415-88657-4: £70.00/08
• maps • lists of Greek and Roman authors • suggestions for further reading.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Classical Studies / Literary Criticism March 2011: 234x156: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-46812-1: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-46813-8: £21.99/04
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
media, communication & cultural studies
TOP TEN BESTSELLERS
1.
6. Gender Trouble
3rd Edition
Cinema Studies: The Key Concepts
Feminism and the Subversion of Identity Judith Butler 2006: 198x129: 272pp Pb: 978-0-415-38955-6: £13.99/04
Susan Hayward 2006: 216x138: 608pp Pb: 978-0-415-36782-0: £15.99/04
2.
7. 3rd Edition 2010 update
5th Edition
Media Today
The Media Student’s Book
An Introduction to Mass Communication
Gill Branston and Roy Stafford
Joseph Turow
2010: 246x189: 488pp Pb: 978-0-415-55842-6: £24.99/04
2010: 279x216: 712pp Pb: 978-0-415-87606-3: £52.50/04
3.
8. 2nd Edition
4th Edition
New Media
The Dynamics of Persuasion
A Critical Introduction
Communication and Attitudes in the 21st Century
Martin Lister, Jon Dovey, Seth Giddings, Iain Grant and Kieran Kelly
Richard M. Perloff
2008: 246x189: 464pp Pb: 978-0-415-43161-3: £21.99/04
4.
2010: 235x187: 448pp Pb: 978-0-415-80568-1: £39.99/04
9. 3rd Edition
2nd Edition
Strategic Planning for Public Relations
AS Film Studies
Ronald D. Smith
Sarah Casey Benyahia, Freddie Gaffney and John White
The Essential Introduction
2009: : 456pp Pb: 978-0-415-99422-4: £35.99/04
5.
2008: 246x174: 424pp Pb: 978-0-415-45433-9: £18.99/04
10. Cases in Public Relations Management
4th Edition
Photography: A Critical Introduction
Patricia Swann 2010: 235x156: 400pp Pb: 978-0-415-87893-7: £38.99/04
Edited by Liz Wells
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
2009: 246x189: 416pp Pb: 978-0-415-46087-3: £24.99/04
çè
classical studies 17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
18 media, communication & cultural studies
Cross-Cultural Issues in Art *
Fashion In Focus *
Frames for Understanding
Concepts, Practices and Politics
Steven Leuthold, Northern Michigan University, USA
Tim Edwards, University of Leicester, UK
This book provides an engaging introduction to aesthetic concepts, expanding the discussion beyond the usual Western theorists and Western examples. Steven Leuthold discusses both contemporary and historical issues and examples, incorporating a range of detailed case studies from African, Asian, European, Latin American, Middle Eastern and Native American art. Individual chapters address broad intercultural issues in art, considering certain themes as constructs that frame our understanding of art. This book draws upon ideas and case studies from cultural and critical studies, art history, ethno-aesthetics and area studies, visual anthropology, and philosophy, and will be useful for undergraduate and postgraduate courses in these fields.
The study of fashion has exploded in recent decades, yet quite what this all means, quite where it might take us, is not clear. This new book helps to bring fashion into focus, with a comprehensive guide to the key theories, perspectives and developments in the field. Tim Edwards includes coverage of all the major theories of fashion, including recent scholarship, alongside subcultural analysis and an in-depth look at production. Fashion in Focus is the ideal companion for students in the arts and social sciences, especially those studying issues such as fashion, gender, sexuality and consumer culture.
Routledge «Market: Cultural Studies / Art November 2010: 234x156: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-57799-1: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57800-4: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83516-6: £80.00/14
Routledge «Market: Fashion & Popular Culture November 2010: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-44793-5: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-44794-2: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83688-0: £70.00/14
textbook
2nd Edition
A2 Media Studies *
Advertising and Public Relations Law *
Antony Bateman, Peter Bennett, University of Wolverhampton, UK, Sarah Casey Benyahia, Film and Media Studies and Peter Wall, Chair of Examiners for GCE Media Studies & Communication Studies Series: Essentials A2 Media Studies: The Essential Introduction for WJEC is the perfect guide for the new WJEC A2 Media Studies syllabus. Developing key topics in depth and introducing students to the notion of independent study, this full colour, highly illustrated textbook is designed to support students through the transition from AS to A2. Individual chapters cover the following key areas: Research and Production Skills; Passing MS3: Media Investigation and Production; Developing Textual Analysis; Issues and Debates; and Passing MS4: Media- Text, Industry and Audience. Specially designed to be user-friendly, A2 Media Studies: The Essential Introduction for WJEC includes activities, key terms, case studies and sample exam questions. Routledge «Market: Media Studies and Cultural Studies December 2010: 246x174: 304pp Pb: 978-0-415-58659-7: £18.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83566-1: £37.99/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Roy l. Moore, Middle Tennessee State University, USA, Carmen Maye and Erik L. Collins, both at University of South Carolina, USA Series: Routledge Communication Series Addressing a critical need, Advertising and Public Relations Law illustrates the variety of issues and ideas that affect the regulation of advertising and public relations speech, including the categorization of different kinds of speech afforded different levels of First Amendment protection; court-created tests for laws and regulations of speech; and non content-based restrictions on speech and expression. Selected Contents: Section 1: The Commercial Speech Doctrine Section 2: Governmental and Industry Regulation of Commercial Speech Section 3: Commercial Speech Torts Section 4: Intellectual Property Appendices A. Professional Codes B. The Judicial System (charts) C. The Judicial Process D. Arbitration, Mediation and Other Alternative Dispute Resolution Mechanisms (overview) E. Copyright Registration Forms F. Trademark Registration Forms G. Model Releases Routledge «Market: Media Law September 2010: 229x152: 480pp Hb: 978-0-8058-5346-9: £125.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-96548-4: £42.95/04 eBook: 978-0-203-84587-5: £125.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8058-1679-2
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
The Essential Introduction for WJEC
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
media, communication & cultural studies 19
Changing the News
Global Design History
The Forces Shaping Journalism in Uncertain Times
Edited by Glenn Adamson, Victoria & Albert Museum, UK, Giorgio Riello, University of Warwick, UK and Sarah Teasley, Royal College of Art, UK
Edited by Wilson Lowrey, The University of Alabama, USA and Peter J. Gade, The University of Oklahoma Series: Routledge Communication Series Changing the News examines the difficulties in changing news processes and practices in response to the evolving circumstances and struggles of the journalism industry. The editors have put together this volume to demonstrate why the prescriptions employed to salvage the journalism industry to date haven’t worked, and to explain how constraints and pressures have influenced the field’s responses to challenges in an uncertain, changing environment. If journalism is to adjust and thrive, the following questions need answers: Why do journalists and news organizations respond to uncertainties in the ways they do? What forces and structures constrain these responses? What social and cultural contexts should we take into account when we judge whether or not journalism successfully responds and adapts? The book tackles these questions from varying perspectives and levels of analysis, through chapters by scholars of news sociology and media management. Changing the News details the forces that shape and challenge journalism and journalistic culture, and explains why journalists and their organizations respond to troubles, challenges and uncertainties in the way they do. Routledge «Market: Journalism May 2011: 229x152: 280pp Hb: 978-0-415-87157-0: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87158-7: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-86857-7: £80.00/14
Design history has evolved over recent decades through engagement with issues of gender and consumption; investigations of business practice; an extension of the field’s chronological coverage and theoretical engagements with a wide array of cognate disciplines such as art history, literary criticism, cultural history, sociology, anthropology and the history of science. Global Design History gathers together a number of leading design historians whose research points the way forward, aiming to address and promote changes to design history. It offers statements about specific contexts within the field of global design history, such as the influence of Ottoman art and architecture on Europe, Persia and India; the European adoption of Asian aesthetic forms; the Latin American adoption of Asian and European decorative solutions; and the role of capital cities in creating international design. Routledge «Market: Art & Visual Culture / Design History January 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-57285-9: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57287-3: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83197-7: £75.00/14
textbook
An Introduction to Nineteenth Century Art
textbook
Doing Ethics in Media
Michelle Facos, Indiana University, USA Using the tools of the ‘new’ art history (feminism, Marxism, social context, etc.) An Introduction to Nineteenth Century Art offers a richly textured, yet clear and logical introduction to 19th century art and culture. Key pedagogical features include:
Theories and Practical Applications Jay Black, University of South Florida and Chris Roberts
çè
Routledge «Market: Media March 2011: 235x187: 400pp Hb: 978-0-415-88150-0: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88154-8: £44.99/04
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
• Data Boxes provide statistics, timelines, charts and historical information about the period to further situate artworks • Text Boxes highlight extracts from original sources, citing the ideas of artists and their contemporaries, including historians, philosophers, critics and theorists • beautifully illustrated with over 250 colour images • Online Resources at www.routledge.com/textbook/facos with access to a wealth of information, including original source documents, contemporary criticism, timelines and maps. Routledge «Market: Art History April 2011: 254x190: 544pp Hb: 978-0-415-78070-4: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-78072-8: £29.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83307-0: £80.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Providing an accessible examination of ethics, Doing Ethics in Media introduces students to ethical theory and provides a grounded discussion of ethics in the context of today’s media outlets. Emphasizing the understanding of ethics, the text will help readers ‘do ethics’ expeditiously, honestly, and efficiently when they enter the workplace and need to make critical ethical decisions on deadline. Organized around six decision-making questions, and cases demonstrate the application of these questions to real-world scenarios, each chapter focuses on a specific ethical theory or issue, with a thorough discussion of the key points accompanied by practical applications. Written for undergraduate and graduate students studying media ethics.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
20 media, communication & cultural studies
Handbook of Comparative Communication Research
Journalism Studies A critical introduction Andrew Calcutt, University of East London, UK and Philip Hammond, London Southbank University, UK
Edited by Frank Esser and Thomas Hanitzsch Series: ICA Handbook Series The Handbook of Comparative Communication Research aims at providing a comprehensive understanding of comparative communication research. It fills an obvious gap in the literature and offers an extensive and interdisciplinary discussion of the general approach of comparative research, its prospect and problems as well as its applications in crucial sub-fields of communications. The first part of the volume charts the state of the art in the field; the second section introduces relevant areas of communication studies where the comparative approach has been successfully applied in recent years; the third part offers an analytical review of conceptual and methodological issues; and the last section proposes a roadmap for future research.
Journalism Studies is a polemical textbook, aiming to rethink the field of journalism studies for the contemporary era. Not only has journalism itself changed, but the broader world of politics and public affairs has been transformed beyond recognition in the past two decades. Yet the study of news and journalism often seems stuck with ideas and debates which have lost much of their critical purchase. This book offers a reassessment of conventional themes in the academic analysis of journalism, and sets out a positive proposal for what we should be studying. Organised into three sections – Ownership, Objectivity and The Public – it addresses the contexts in which journalism is produced, practised and disseminated. This is a concise and accessible introduction to contemporary journalism studies.
Routledge May 2011: 254x178: 600pp Hb: 978-0-415-80271-0: £110.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-80275-8: £40.00/04
Routledge «Market: Media Studies / Journalism January 2011: 234x156: 216pp Hb: 978-0-415-55430-5: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-55431-2: £19.99/04
reader
2nd Edition
Key Readings in Journalism
Interviewing for Radio
Edited by Elliot King and Jane Chapman, University of Lincoln, UK
Jim Beaman, University of Gloucestershire, UK
Key Readings in Journalism brings together the essential writings that every student of journalism should know. The volume presents forty of the most important works about journalism arranged thematically to enable students to think deeply and broadly about journalism – its social impact, its history, key individuals and institutions, its practice, and its future. Each reading is introduced with a headnote that provides context and points to key concepts discussed in the selection. Key Readings in Journalism is designed to be used as a primary text in undergraduate Introduction to Journalism and Journalism and Society courses, and the selections have been carefully chosen to reflect the needs of today’s journalism classroom.
Interviewing for Radio is a thorough introduction to the techniques and skills of the radio interview. It offers advice on how to ask the right question and elicit a response and guides the reader through the use of equipment, the mechanics of recording, the studio environment, live broadcasts, presentation and pronunciation, and editing material. Written by an experienced producer and instructor, Interviewing for Radio includes the history of the radio interview and the importance of its role today; practical exercises which introduce successful interview and technical skills; case studies and hypothetical scenarios to help you prepare for potential difficulties; and a discussion of ethics, risk assessment, codes of conduct and regulations.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Routledge «Market: Journalism and Media Studies March 2011: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-56169-3: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56170-9: £17.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83452-7: £65.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-22910-4
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge February 2011: 254x178: 400pp Hb: 978-0-415-88027-5: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88028-2: £29.99/04
Series: Media Skills
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
media, communication & cultural studies 21
Horror Noire
Media Perspectives for the 21st Century
Blackness and Horror Films Robin R. Means Coleman The boundary-pushing genre of the horror film has always been a site for provocative explorations of race in American popular culture. Horror Noire presents a critical history of blackness and American horror, from early cinema to the present. Robin R. Means Coleman traces the history of notable characterizations of blackness in horror cinema, examines key levels of black paricipation on screen and behind the camera, and unpacks the genre’s racialized imagery and narratives that make up popular culture’s commentary on race. Routledge April 2011: 229x152: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-88019-0: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88020-6: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-84767-1: £80.00/14
An Introduction to Mass Communication Joseph Turow, University of Pennsylvania, USA Completely revised with updated examples, case studies, and media resources, the third edition of this innovative mass communication textbook is built upon a media systems approach that gives students an insider’s perspective on how mass media industries operate. By making students more knowledgeable about the influences that guide media organizations, Media Today builds media literacy skills to make students sensitive to ways of seeing media content as a means of learning about culture. Joseph Turow emphasizes throughout the many ways in which media convergence has blurred distinctions between and among various media. Each chapter guides students through the essential history of media industries; examines the current forces shaping their creation, distribution and exhibition; and explores the impact of emerging trends in media and society from globalization to social networking to video games. Routledge «Market: Mass Communication / Media Studies February 2011: 279x216: 640pp Hb: 978-0-415-87607-0: £110.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87608-7: £52.50/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83651-4: £110.00 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-96059-5
çè
Series: Communication and Society This book brings together key international scholars to explore concepts, topics and issues concerning the communication environment in contemporary democratic societies. It combines qualitative and quantitative approaches to provide an interdisciplinary and truly global perspective that reflects the trends, theories and issues in current media and communication research. The collection raises significant questions about the study of the media by challenging approaches to major media and societal issues, and analyses in more depth the range of concerns that shape both the present and the future media landscape and the issues these can create for communication. Chapters deal with various dimensions of media from a number of different perspectives and socio-political contexts, covering a wide range of topics including Social Networking, Political Communication, Public Journalism, Global Infotainment and Consumer Culture.
@
2nd Edition
Media Effects and Society Elizabeth M. Perse, University of Delaware and Jennifer Lambe Series: Routledge Communication Series This text presents media effects theory at an introductory level. It provides a broad theoretical overview and integrates social, political, and related social scientific research in a clear and accessible presentation.
Routledge «Market: Media March 2011: 254x178: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-87819-7: £140.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88591-1: £39.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85469-3: £140.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8058-2506-0
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Media Today
for e-mail updates in your field
Edited by Stylianos Papathanassopoulos, University of Athens, Greece
Routledge «Market: Media Studies / Communication December 2010: 234x156: 264pp Hb: 978-0-415-57498-3: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57499-0: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83407-7: £70.00/14
4th Edition textbook
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
Concepts, Topics and Issues
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
22 media, communication & cultural studies
Paranormal Media *
Popular Media and Health Communication
Audiences, Spirits and Magic in Popular Culture Annette Hill, University of Westminster, UK
Kimberly N. Kline, University of Texas at San Antonio, USA and Jay Baglia
Paranormal Media offers a unique, timely exploration of the extraordinary, unexplained and supernatural in popular culture, looking in unusual places in order to understand this phenomenon. Through a popular cultural ethnography, and critical analysis in social and cultural theory, this ground-breaking book by Annette Hill presents an original and rigorous examination of people’s experiences of spirits and magic. In popular culture, people are players in an orchestral movement about what happens to us when we die. In a very real sense the audience is the show. This book is the story of audiences and their participation in a show about matters of life and death. It will be a highly interesting read for undergraduate and postgraduate students, as well as academics, on a wide range of television, media, cultural studies, and sociology courses.
Series: Routledge Communication Series Recognizing the power of popular media (TV, film, internet, music, et al) to highlight health issues in the public forum and to set agendas in public policy, health communication scholars acknowledge that the media must be a part of their research program, and that they must identify the manner in which discourse impinges on the meanings and behaviors related to health and illness, through various methodologies and perspectives. Responding to that need, this book provides a comprehensive discussion of the theory and methodological considerations in the study of popular media and health communication. Routledge «Market: Communication April 2011: 229x152: 320pp Pb: 978-0-8058-6259-1: £17.99/04
Routledge «Market: Media Studies November 2010: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-54462-7: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-54463-4: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83639-2: £75.00/14
2nd edition textbook
Public Relations in Global Cultural Contexts
Movie History: A Survey Douglas Gomery, University of East London, UK and Clara Pafort-Overduin How can we understand the history of film? Historical facts don’t answer the basic questions of film history. History, as this fascinating book shows, is more than the simple accumulation of film titles, facts and figures. This is a survey of over 100 years of cinema history, from its beginnings in 1895, to its current state in the 21st century. An accessible, introductory text, Movie History: A Survey looks at not only the major films, filmmakers, and cinema institutions throughout the years, but also extends to the production, distribution, exhibition, technology and reception of films. The textbook is divided chronologically into four sections, using the timeline of technological changes Written by two highly respected film scholars and experienced teachers, Movie History is the ideal textbook for students studying film history.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Edited by Nilanjana Bardhan, Southern Illinois University, USA and C. Kay Weaver, Waikato University, New Zealand Series: Routledge Communication Series Reflecting the current state of public relations practice, which has become increasingly globalized, this volume emphasizes theories and concepts that highlight global interconnectedness through a range of interpretative and critical approaches to understanding the global significance and impacts of public relations.
Routledge «Market: Public Relations January 2011: 229x152: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-87285-0: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87286-7: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-86615-3: £80.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Film Studies April 2011: 254x190: 544pp Hb: 978-0-415-77544-1: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-77545-8: £24.99/04
Multi-paradigmatic Perspectives
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
media, communication & cultural studies 23
Public Relations, Society & Culture Race and News Theoretical and Empirical Explorations
Critical Perspectives
Edited by Lee Edwards, University of Manchester, UK and Caroline E.M. Hodges, Bournemouth University, UK
Christopher P. Campbell, University of Southern Mississippi, USA, Rockell A. Brown, Texas Southern University, USA, Cheryl D. Jenkins and Kim LeDuff, both at University of Southern Mississippi, USA
This edited collection adds momentum to the emergent interest in the socio-cultural role of public relations by bringing together a range of alternative theoretical and methodological approaches, including anthropology, diversity, storytelling, pragmatism and Latin American studies. These are interspersed with narratives and interview extracts, resulting in an engaging text which provides new inspiration whilst further contributing to our understanding of the relationship between public relations, society and culture. Public Relations, Society and Culture draws on insights from a wide range of disciplines including sociology, cultural studies, post-colonialism, political economy, ecological studies, feminism and critical race theory. It illustrates the effects of the public relations profession on its environment, and will provide students and scholars with an essential grounding in both the traditional and the progressive perspectives of public relations. Routledge «Market: Public Relations January 2011: 234x156: 168pp Hb: 978-0-415-57273-6: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57274-3: £17.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83213-4: £65.00/14
Race and News: Critical Perspectives offers essays and case studies that examine how issues related to race and racism are represented in contemporary news coverage in the United States. The first section of this text examines the journalistic routine – how news organizations from newspapers to network news to new media make decisions about what, how, and why stories related are covered with (or without) relation to race. The second section is comprised of case studies exploring how coverage of national stories such as the election of Barack Obama, Hurricane Katrina, and immigrants rights has affected the national dialogue on race and racism. This book will be ideal for courses on race and news media, and it will also be valuable to professional journalists and journalism students who seek to improve the diversity and sensitivity of their journalistic practice. Routledge «Market: Journalism March 2011: 229x152: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-80096-9: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-80097-6: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-87685-5: £80.00/14
textbook
Theory and Practice Rebekah Modrak, University of Michigan, USA and Bill Anthes, Pitzer College, USA Intended for both beginning and advanced students, and for both art and non-art majors, Reframing Photography provides an integrated introduction to the historical, theoretical and technical aspects of photography. • ‘How to’ sections provide students with illustrated, step by step guides to different photographic methods, alongside related theory • case studies: profiles of contemporary and historical artists • glossary: definitions of critical and technical vocabulary • a companion website will update information on equipment and provide further activities, information and links to related sites www.routledge.com/textbooks/reframingphotography • lavishly illustrated, including images depicting artists’ work and examples of photographic processes, many in colour.
çè
Routledge «Market: Photography November 2010: 246x189: 480pp Hb: 978-0-415-77919-7: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-77920-3: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-84759-6: £80.00/14
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Research Methods for Studying Groups Edited by Andrea Hollingshead and Marshall Scott Poole This volume provides an overview of the methodological issues and challenges inherent in the study of small groups from the perspective of seasoned researchers in communication, psychology and other fields in the behavioral and social sciences. It summarizes the current state of group methods in a format that is readable, insightful, and useful for both new and experienced group researchers. This collection of essays will inspire new and established researchers alike to look beyond their current methodological approaches, covering both traditional and new methods for studying groups and exploring the full range of groups in face-to-face and online settings. Routledge «Market: Organizational Communication / Organizational Studies March 2011: 229x152: 400pp Hb: 978-0-415-80632-9: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-80633-6: £29.99/04
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Reframing Photography *
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
24 media, communication & cultural studies
Techno Politics in Presidential Campaigning
2nd Edition
Routledge Handbook of Health Communication
New Voices, New Technologies, and New Voters Edited by John Allen Hendricks and Lynda Lee Kaid, University of Florida, USA
Edited by Teresa L. Thompson, University of Dayton, Roxanne Parrott and Jon F. Nussbaum, both at Pennsylvania State University
The 2008 US presidential campaign saw politicians utilizing all types of new media – Facebook, MySpace, YouTube, Twitter, e-mail, and cell phone texting – to reach voters of all ages, ethnicities, socioeconomic backgrounds, and sexual orientations. This volume examines the use of these media and considers the effectiveness of reaching voters through these channels. It explores not only the use of new media and technologies but also the role these tactics played in attracting new voters and communicating with the electorate during the 2008 presidential debates. Chapters focus on how the technologies were used by candidates, the press, and voters.
Series: Routledge Communication Series This handbook summarizes the research on communicative processes as they relate to health and health care, and provides directions for future research. For scholars & professionals in health communication, public health, psychology & related areas.
Routledge «Market: Communication Studies April 2011: 254x178: 784pp Hb: 978-0-415-88314-6: £150.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88315-3: £60.00/04 eBook: 978-0-203-84606-3: £150.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8058-3858-9
Routledge «Market: Communication / Political Science December 2010: 229x152: 324pp Hb: 978-0-415-87978-1: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87979-8: £32.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85126-5: £95.00/14
Strategic Conflict
The Enchanted Screen
Daniel J. Canary, Arizona State University, USA and Sandra Lakey
The Unknown History of Fairy-Tale Films Jack Zipes, University of Minnesota, USA
Series: Routledge Communication Series This text offers a research-based, accessible analysis of how people can manage conflict productively. Moving beyond the basics of conflict, it examines interpersonal situations in which conflict occurs and promotes strategic communicative responses, based on communication research. Authors Daniel J. Canary and Sandra Lakey base the principles for conflict management on the latest theoretical research, and add personal observations, media examples, and samples of actual interaction to provide concrete illustrations of the research findings.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Routledge «Market: Film Studies February 2011: 254x178: 496pp Hb: 978-0-415-99062-2: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-99061-5: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-92749-6: £80.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Communication April 2011: 229x152: 288pp Hb: 978-0-8058-5063-5: £40.99/03 Pb: 978-0-8058-5064-2: £18.99/04
In The Enchanted Screen, Jack Zipes looks at the long history and special relationship between fairy tales and cinema, examining how and why so many films have adapted fairy tale narratives, whether directly or indirectly. Zipes guides us through this vast array of films by tracing the adaptations of major fairy tales, including Little Red Riding Hood, Cinderella, Snow White, Peter Pan, and many more, from their earliest cinematic appearances to today. Essential reading for fairy tale fans and cinema buffs alike, The Enchanted Screen is lavishly illustrated and features an extensive filmography and bibliography for future viewing and reading suggestions.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
media, communication & cultural studies 25
The Sound Handbook
Westerns *
Tim Crook, University of London, UK
John White, Anglia Ruskin University, UK
Series: Media Practice
Series: Routledge Film Guidebooks
The Sound Handbook is an essential practice and theory guide that sets out the best methods in producing sound for multimedia, and the academic theories that underpin the history and analysis of sound expression. It teaches how qualitative sound can be produced for drama, documentary and journalism in radio, theatrical stage production, television and film, online, animation, videogames and sound art installation. At the same time the theoretical debates that constitute textual and contextual academic study of sound in these media platforms are explored. The Sound Handbook is unique in endeavouring to identify the practical and theoretical common ground in the production and expression of sound in what have been seen previously as discrete media practice and academic disciplines.
It is a common assertion that the history of America is written in its Westerns, but how true is this? In this guidebook John White discusses the evolution of the Western through history and looks at theoretical and critical approaches to Westerns such as genre analysis, semiotics, representation, ideology, discourse analysis, narrative, realism, auteur and star theory, psychoanalytical theory, postmodernism and audience response. The book includes case studies of key western films, including Stagecoach, My Darling Clementine, Shane, The Good, The Bad and the Ugly, McCabe and Mrs Miller, Unforgiven, Brokeback Mountain and The Assassination of Jesse James by the Coward Robert Ford.
Routledge «Market: Media Studies March 2011: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-55150-2: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-55152-6: £24.99/04
Including a chronology of significant events for the Western genre, a glossary and further reading, this introduction to an important genre in film studies is a great guide for students. Routledge «Market: Film Studies November 2010: 198x129: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-55812-9: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-55813-6: £16.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83531-9: £60.00/14
2nd Edition
reader
The Business of Sports
The New Media and Technocultures Reader
Mark Conrad, Fordham University This book explores the business aspect of sports with an orientation to those topics that are most relevant to journalists, providing the foundation for understanding the various parts of the sports business. Moving beyond sports writing, this text offers a distinct perspective on professional, college, and international sports organizations – structure, governance, labor issues, and other business factors within the sports community. Written clearly and compellingly, The Business of Sports includes cases (historical, current, and hypothetical) to illustrate how business concerns play a role in the reporting of sports. This second editions include updates throughout, including disciplinary policies throughout the major sports leagues, expanded discussion of intellectual property issues and merchandising, and new sections on ethical issues in sports, aimed at journalists.
çè
Routledge «Market: Journalism / Sports Studies February 2011: 229x152: 368pp Hb: 978-0-415-87652-0: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87653-7: £26.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-99638-9
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Edited by Seth Giddings and Martin Lister, both at University of the West of England, UK The New Media & Technoculture Reader offers students further reading on key issues and debates raised in the introductory textbook New Media: A Critical Introduction, and explication of these debates through the selected texts. The Reader critically and theoretically contextualises the various disciplinary stances (visual culture; media and cultural history; media theory; media production; philosophy and the history of the sciences; political economy and sociology, etc.), offering students a rich and interdisciplinary resource. Critical editorial commentary guides the reader through the debates, and between the extracts. Routledge «Market: Media Studies February 2011: 246x174: 448pp Hb: 978-0-415-46913-5: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-46914-2: £24.99/04
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
A Primer for Journalists
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
26 media, communication & cultural studies The Politics of Loss and Trauma in Contemporary Israeli Cinema Raz Yosef, Tel Aviv University, Israel Series: Routledge Advances in Film Studies This book examines for the first time the new ideological and aesthetic trends in contemporary Israeli cinema along the axes of gender, sexuality, race and ethnicity. Routledge «Market: Film / Media Studies June 2011: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-87688-9: £75.00/08
Disability and New Media Katie Ellis, Murdoch University, Australia and Mike Kent, Curtin University of Technology, Australia Series: Routledge Studies in New Media and Cyberculture It has been argued that the Internet will not be fully accessible until disability is considered a cultural identity in the same way that class, gender and sexuality are. Kent and Ellis build on this notion and apply it to more recent Web 2.0 phenomena, social networking sites, virtual worlds and file sharing. Routledge «Market: Media / Disability Studies January 2011: 229x152: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-87135-8: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83191-5: £75.00/14
Creating Second Lives Community, Identity and Spatiality as Constructions of the Virtual Edited by Astrid Ensslin and Eben Muse, both at Bangor University, UK Series: Routledge Studies in New Media and Cyberculture This book aims to provide insights into how ‘second lives’ in the sense of virtual identities and communities are constructed textually, semiotically and discursively, specifically in the online environment Second Life and Massively Multiplayer Online Games such as World of Warcraft. Routledge «Market: Media Studies March 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-88420-4: £80.00/08
Distributing Silent Film Serials * Local Practices, Changing Forms, Cultural Transformation Rudmer Canjels, VU University Amsterdam, the Netherlands Series: Routledge Advances in Film Studies In this book, Canjels offers a highly relevant case study of transnational, transcultural and transmedia relations in the twentieth century. Tracing the international consumption, distribution, and cultural importance of silent film serials, Canjels provides a new understanding of the cultural dimension and the cultural transformation and circulation of media forms. Routledge «Market: Media Studies / Film January 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-87714-5: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83258-5: £75.00/14
Emerging Practices in Science and Technology Librarianship Edited by Amy Besnoy, University of San Diego, USA This book investigates the emerging practices of science and technology librarians specific to maintaining collections, providing access to resources, and ensuring that informed decisions are made regarding limited financial resources. This book was published as a special issue of the Journal of Library Administration. Routledge «Market: Library & Information Sciences November 2010: 246x174: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-60432-1: £80.00/08
Emotion, Genre, and Justice in Film and Television
Hollywood Melodrama and the New Deal Public Daydreams Anna Siomopoulos, Bentley College, USA Series: Routledge Advances in Film Studies This book considers the many different ways that Hollywood melodramas of the New Deal era addressed the fundamental concepts of the burgeoning welfare state, ideas such as liberal empathy, consumer citizenship, the refeudalization of the state, and, above all, the welfare state ideal of minimal economic redistribution. Routledge «Market: Film / Media Studies March 2011: 229x152: 244pp Hb: 978-0-415-88293-4: £80.00/08
Journalism Education, Training and Employment * Edited by Bob Franklin, Cardiff University, UK and Donica Mensing, University of Nevada, Reno, USA Series: Routledge Research in Journalism This edited volume addresses the needs of journalism educators grappling with rapid change. Written by internationally distinguished scholars, these research-based essays examine how educators are responding to change in areas such as pedagogy, standards, diversity, training and employment, and include case studies from Africa, Australia, Sweden, Turkey and the U.S. Routledge «Market: Journalism / Communications February 2011: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-88425-9: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83234-9: £75.00/08
Journalists, Sources, and Credibility *
Deidre Pribram, Molloy College, USA
New Perspectives
Series: Routledge Research in Cultural and Media Studies
Edited by Bob Franklin, Cardiff University, UK and Matt Carlson, Saint Louis University, USA
In this study, emotions are considered from the perspective of the specific ways they function in media texts to frame and maintain complex cultural notions such as law, justice, and injustice.
Series: Routledge Research in Journalism
Routledge «Market: Media Studies / Criminology February 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-99828-4: £75.00/08
This volume revisits what we know about the relationship between journalists and their sources. By asking new questions, employing novel methodologies, and confronting sweeping changes to journalism and media, the contributors reinvigorate the conversation about who gets to speak through the news and why this continues to matter.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Journalism / Communications December 2010: 229x152: 160pp Hb: 978-0-415-88426-6: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83570-8: £75.00/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
media, communication & cultural studies 27 Korea’s Occupied Cinemas
Parody and Taste in Postwar American Television Culture *
Transmedia Television
Ethan Thompson, Texas A&M University, USA
Elizabeth Evans, University of Nottingham, UK
Series: Routledge Advances in Television Studies
Series: Routledge Advances in Television Studies
Parody and Taste in Postwar American Television Culture examines the boom in socially relevant humor that took place alongside the birth of television, analyzing and theorizing the production and consumption of television, parody, and satire through case studies of Sick Comedy, MAD and Playboy magazines, and television personalities Ernie Kovacs and Oscar Levant.
Elizabeth Evans uses empirical audience research to explore attitudes towards the dramatic changes that television has undergone since the turn of the twenty-first century due to the development of digital technologies. She asks to what extent audiences are embracing these changes and what ‘television’ means in a multiplatform media landscape.
Routledge «Market: Media January 2011: 229x152: 184pp Hb: 978-0-415-88638-3: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83293-6: £75.00/14
Routledge «Market: Television / New Media March 2011: 229x152: 244pp Hb: 978-0-415-88292-7: £75.00/08
Routledge «Market: Film Studies / Cultural History June 2011: 229x152: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-99538-2: £70.00/08
Serials Collection Management in Recessionary Times
Transparency, Public Relations and the Mass Media
Network Journalism *
Edited by Karen G. Lawson, Iowa State University Library, USA
Brian Yecies, Centre for Asia Pacific Social Transformation Studies, Australia and Ae-Gyung Shim Series: Routledge Advances in Film Studies This project compares and contrasts the development of cinema in Korea during the Japanese occupation (1910–1945) and US Army Military (1945–1948) periods within the larger context of cinemas in occupied territories. By avoiding a comprehensive application of Western theory to the Korean situation, the project investigates key moments in Korea’s cinematic history and touches directly upon the themes of nation building, national identity, colonial modernity, propaganda and cultural protectionism as well as the sensitive subject of collaboration.
Journalistic Practice in Interactive Spheres Ansgard Heinrich, University of Groningen, the Netherlands Series: Routledge Research in Journalism Heinrich here analyzes the interplay between journalistic practice and processes of globalization and digitalization. She argues that a new kind of journalism – ’network journalism’ – is emerging, characterized by an increasingly global flow of news as well as a growing number of news deliverers.
This book offers a wide variety of insights on the strengths, weaknesses, threats and opportunities involved with serials collection management in recessionary times, written by practitioners in the library sector. This book was published as a special issue of The Serials Librarian. Routledge «Market: Library & Information Sciences / March 2011: 246x174: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-58961-1: £80.00/08
Combating Media Bribery Worldwide Katerina Tsetsura, University of Oklahoma, USA and Dean Kruckeberg, University of North Carolina, Charlotte, USA Series: Routledge Research in Public Relations This book provides a theoretical framework for understanding media transparency and its antithesis – media opacity – by analyzing extensive empirical data that the authors have collected from more than 60 countries. Routledge «Market: Journalism / Public Relations / Mass Media April 2011: 229x152: 228pp Hb: 978-0-415-88424-2: £75.00/08
Sports Media
Routledge «Market: Journalism / Media Studies February 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-88270-5: £80.00/08
Audiences, New Media, and Daily Life
Transformation, Integration, Consumption Edited by Andrew C. Billings, Clemson University, USA Series: Electronic Media Research Series Sports Media examines sports media scholarship and its role in facilitating understanding of the increasingly complex world of sports media. Developed for the Broadcast Education Association’s Electronic Media Research series, this volume will be required reading for graduate and undergraduate students in communication studies, sociology, marketing, and sports management, and will serve as a valuable reference for future research in sports media.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Media / Sociology of Sports March 2011: 229x152: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-88368-9: £70.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83279-0: £70.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
28 literature
Experiences of Freedom in Postcolonial Literatures and Cultures
Gerard Manley Hopkins * Angus Easson, University of Salford, UK Series: Routledge Guides to Literature Gerard Manley Hopkins was an experimental and idiosyncratic writer whose innovative work remains important for any student of Victorian literature. This guidebook offers:
Annalisa Oboe, University of Padua, Italy and Shaul Bassi, Ca’ Foscari University, Italy Modern ideas of freedom and human rights have been repeatedly contested and are hotly debated at the beginning of the third millennium in response to new theories, needs, and changes in the world today. This volume offers culturally diverse responses to the contemporary idea of ‘freedom’ from the literatures and the arts of the postcolonial world. The book is divided into five sections that consider: • resisting history and colonialism • the right to move and to belong • how to move beyond the borders of bodies • the right to believe in free futures • imaginative freedom and critical engagement. Each section opens with an original piece of creative writing directly connected to the topics from writers such as Alexis Wright, Caryl Philips, Chris Abani and Anita Desai. Routledge «Market: Postcolonial Studies February 2011: 234x156: 400pp Hb: 978-0-415-59191-1: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59192-8: £27.99/04
2nd Edition student reference
Poetry: The Basics
• an extensive introduction to the contexts and critical history of his work, from composition to the present • annotated extracts from key contextual documents, reviews, and critical works • cross-references between sections of the guide, suggesting links between texts, contexts and criticism • suggestions for further reading. Part of the Routledge Guides to Literature series, this volume is essential reading for all those beginning detailed study of Hopkins’ work and seeking not only a guide to the poems, but a way through the wealth of contextual and critical material that surrounds them. Routledge «Market: Literary Studies December 2010: 216x138: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-27323-7: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-27324-4: £14.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83518-0: £55.00/14
Reading Native American Literature Joseph L. Coulombe, Rowan University, USA Native American Literature crosses divides between public and private cultures, ethnicities and experience. In this volume, Joseph Coulombe argues that Native American writers use diverse narrative strategies to engage with readers and are ‘writing for connection’ with both Native and non-Native audiences. Beginning with a historical overview, this book presents focused readings of key texts including:
Jeffrey Wainwright, Manchester Metropolitan University, UK Series: The Basics This book demystifies the world of poetry, its traditions and forms for all those who find it daunting or bewildering. Covering a wide range of poetic voices from Chaucer to children’s rhymes, song lyrics and the words of contemporary poets, this book will help readers to appreciate poetry by examining:
• N. Scott Momaday’s House Made of Dawn
• how technical aspects such as rhythm and measure work
• Leslie Marmon Silko’s Ceremony
• how different tones of voice affect a poem
• Gerald Vizenor’s Bearheart
• how poetic language relates to everyday language
• James Welch’s Fool’s Crow • Sherman Alexie’s The Lone Ranger and Tonto Fistfight in Heaven
• how different types of poetry work, from sonnets to free verse
• Linda Hogan’s Power.
• how the form and ‘space’ of a poem contributes to its meaning.
Suggesting new ways towards a sensitive engagement with tribal cultures, this book provides not only a comprehensive introduction to Native American Literature but also a critical framework through which it may be read.
Routledge «Market: English Literature / Poetry February 2011: 198x129: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-56615-5: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56616-2: £11.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-09286-6: £55.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-28763-0
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Routledge «Market: Native American Literature January 2011: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-57942-1: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57943-8: £17.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83290-5: £65.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
A must read for all those wishing to get to grips with reading and writing poetry.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
literature 29
Reading the Cantos
The Elizabethan Dumb Show
A Study of Meaning in Ezra Pound
The History of a Dramatic Convention
Noel Stock
Dieter Mehl
Series: Routledge Revivals
Series: Routledge Revivals First published in 1967, this is a study which tackles the central problem of meaning within Ezra Pound’s The Cantos.
It deals with important critical issues and questions of interpretation and understanding. Students of modern poetry will derive great benefit from this vigorous and lucid analysis of Pound’s masterpiece. Noel Stock’s finding is radical: that The Cantos is not really a poem at all, but rather notes towards a poem. It is a collection of fragments of varying quality – some of extraordinary power and beauty – but in no sense formed into a work of art. Routledge «Market: Literature November 2010: 216x138: 132pp Hb: 978-0-415-60935-7: £60.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83246-2: £60.00/14
First published in English in 1965, this book discusses the roots and development of the dumb show as a device in Elizabethan drama. The work provides not only a useful manual for those who wish to check the occurrence of dumb shows and the uses to which they are put; it also makes a real contribution to a better understanding of the progress of Elizabethan drama, and sheds new light on some of the lesser known plays of the period. Routledge «Market: Theatre December 2010: 216x138: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-61078-0: £70.00/03
2nd Edition
Sexuality * Joseph Bristow, UCLA, USA Series: The New Critical Idiom Theories of sexuality and desire are vital elements of the debate in literary and cultural studies. In this illuminating study Joseph Bristow introduces readers to the fundamental critical debates surrounding the topic. This fully updated second edition includes:
The Middle English Romances of the Thirteenth and Fourteenth Centuries Mehl Dieter Series: Routledge Revivals First published in English in 1968, this book provides a critical guide to the wide field of the Middle English Romances and gives a helpful survey of the contemporary state of scholarship. Dr. Mehl traces the development of Middle English Romances from the thirteenth to the end of the fourteenth century, and interprets a number of these romances. The emphasis is literary, on their form and dominant themes, rather than on source-material or language.
• a historical account of theories of sexuality from the Victorians to the present • discussions of the most influential theorists including Freud, Lacan, Bataille, Baudrillard, Cixous, Deleuze, Irigaray and Kristeva • a new and extended discussion of queer and transgender theory, race, ethnicity, and desire • a new preface summarising changes in the field since the first edition Considering all of the major movements in the field, this new edition is the ideal guide for students of literary and cultural studies.
çè
Routledge «Market: Literary Theory November 2010: 198x129: 264pp Hb: 978-0-415-29928-2: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-29929-9: £12.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83583-8: £55.00/14
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Routledge «Market: Medieval Literature December 2010: 216x138: 312pp Hb: 978-0-415-61079-7: £75.00/03
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
• a new glossary, and annotated further reading section.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
30 literature
The Routledge Companion to The Routledge Concise Anglophone Caribbean Literature History of Science Fiction Edited by Michael A. Bucknor, University of the West Indies, Jamaica and Alison Donnell, University of Reading, UK
Dr Mark Bould, University of the West of England, UK and Sherryl Vint, Brock University, Canada
Series: Routledge Literature Companions
Science fiction is one of the most significant areas of popular culture, measured both through the range of creative texts it encompasses and the number of academic publications it provokes. While ‘science fiction’ has an established common usage, close examination reveals that writers, fans, editors, scholars, and publishers use the term inconsistently and have always done so. The Routledge Concise History of Science Fiction provides students with an accessible overview of the genre that explores how it emerged through competing, multifarious versions and the struggle to define its limits. Discussing the place of key works and looking forward to the future of the genre, this book is the ideal starting point for students and all those seeking a better understanding of science fiction.
This Companion is divided into six sections that provide an introduction to and critical history of the field, discussions of key texts and critical debate on major topics such as the nation, race, gender and migration. In the final section contributors examine the material dissemination of Caribbean literature and point towards the new directions that Caribbean literature and criticism are taking. This volume is an essential text, bringing together three generations of Caribbean scholars from foundational critics to new emerging voices. The interdisciplinary nature and clarity of writing will provide an excellent resource and springboard to further research for those working in literature and cultural studies, postcolonial and diaspora studies as well as Caribbean studies, history and geography.
The Routledge Concise History of Canadian Literature Richard J. Lane, Vancouver Island University, Canada Series: Routledge Concise Histories of Literature
Routledge «Market: Science Fiction February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-43570-3: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-43571-0: £15.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83016-1: £55.00/14
The Routledge Concise History of Nineteenth Century Literature * Josephine Guy, University of Nottingham, UK and Ian Small, University of Birmingham, UK Series: Routledge Concise Histories of Literature The Nineteenth Century saw the beginning of Queen Victoria’s reign and the collapse of the slave trade; medicine, science and technology developed rapidly, creating an era of discovery and invention with huge global impact. In their clear and accessible manner, Josephine Guy and Ian Small:
This volume introduces the fiction, poetry and drama of Canada in its historical, political and cultural contexts. Richard Lane outlines: • the history of Canadian literature from colonial times to the present • the impact of English translation, regional literatures, and the Canadian immigrant experience
• examine the work of writers from Austen and the Brontës, to Melville, Dickinson, Chekov and Wilde
• critical themes such as landscape, ethnicity, orality, textuality, war and nationhood • contemporary debate on the canon, feminism, postcoloniality, queer theory, and cultural and ethnic diversity • the work of canonical and lesser-known writers from Catherine Parr and Susan Moodie to Robert Service, Maria Campbell and Douglas Copeland. Written in an engaging and accessible style and offering a glossary and annotated further reading sections, this guidebook is a crucial resource for students working in the field of Canadian Literature. Routledge «Market: Canadian Literature February 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-47045-2: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-47046-9: £15.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
• look at issues of sexual politics, consumerism, commodity culture, nationalism and colonialism • chart the move from Romanticism to Modernism • introduce crucial debates on form, style, genre, editing and bibliography. Both introducing the literature of the nineteenth century in its historical and critical contexts, and also discussing and debating the issue of ‘periodization’ itself, this innovative guide is a must read for both students and researchers. Routledge «Market: Literature November 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-48710-8: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-48711-5: £15.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83941-6: £55.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Caribbean Literature February 2011: 246x174: 560pp Hb: 978-0-415-48577-7: £110.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83035-2: £125.00/14 Rising to £125.00/03 three months after publication
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
literature 31
The Routledge Guide to William Shakespeare * Robert Shaughnessy, University of Kent, UK William Shakespeare is perhaps the most culturally significant writer of all time, and his language and thought remain interwoven through popular reference and imaginings of the Western canon. This concise, structured guide:
Travel Writing * The New Critical Idiom Thompson Carl, Nottingham Trent University, UK Series: The New Critical Idiom An increasingly popular genre, addressing issues of space, language, colonialism, globalization and politics, travel writing offers the reader a movement between the familiar and the unknown. In this volume, Carl Thompson:
• introduces Shakespeare’s life and works, providing crucial historical background
• introduces the genre, outlining competing definitions and key debates
• considers each play in terms of context, critical and performance history
• provides a broad historical survey from the medieval period to the present day
• discusses twentieth-century criticism and performance, exploring how our contemporary understanding of Shakespeare has been shaped
• considers contemporary issues of tourism, migration and displacement
• incorporates cross-references between sections of the guide to suggest links between texts, contexts and criticism
• looks both at canonical and more marginal works in women’s writing, colonial and postcolonial writing
• provides an annotated further reading section and detailed chronologies.
• examines the place of travel writing in the construction of ‘pioneering’ narratives of America.
Demystifying and contextualising Shakespeare for the twenty-first century, this book offers an introduction to the subject for beginners and an invaluable resource for more experienced scholars.
Concise and practical, Travel Writing is the ideal introduction for those new to the subject, as well as a crucial overview of the terminology, history and debates within the field.
Routledge «Market: Literary Studies December 2010: 246x174: 448pp Hb: 978-0-415-27539-2: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-27540-8: £18.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83523-4: £75.00/14
Routledge «Market: Literary Studies March 2011: 198x129: 160pp Hb: 978-0-415-44464-4: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-44465-1: £12.99/04
Theory After ‘Theory’ * Edited by Jane Elliott and Derek Attridge, both at University of York, UK Arguing that theory, far from being dead, is coming to terms with the most urgent cultural and political questions of today, this volume: • includes essays by leading theorists on affect, biopolitics, biophilosophy, aesthetics, and neoliberalism • re-examines established areas including subaltern studies, postcolonialism, and ethics • considers influential figures including Agamben, Arendt, and Badiou. Divided into clear sections that place the work in context, this volume speculates on theory’s future while demonstrating its current diversity. Contributors: Amanda Anderson, Ray Brassier, Adriana Cavarero, Eva Cherniavsky, Rey Chow, Claire Colebrook, Laurent Dubreuil, Roberto Esposito, Simon Gikandi, Martin Hagglünd, Peter Hallward, Brian Massumi, Peter Osborne, Elizabeth Povinelli, William Rasch, Henry Staten, Bernard Stiegler, Eugene Thacker, Cary Wolfe, Linda Zerilli.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Literary Theory January 2011: 246x174: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-48418-3: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-48419-0: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83116-8: £75.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
32 literature Audiobooks, Sound Studies, and Literature
Environmental Criticism for the Twenty-First Century
Edited by Matthew Rubery
Edited by Stephanie LeMenager, Teresa Shewry and Ken Hiltner, all at University of California, Santa Barbara, USA
Series: Routledge Research in Cultural and Media Studies This is the first scholarly work to examine the cultural significance of the ‘talking book,’ from the earliest adaptations of printed texts into sound by Dickens, Hardy, and other novelists from the nineteenth century to recordings by Toni Morrison and Barack Obama at the turn of the twenty-first century. Routledge «Market: Literature March 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-88352-8: £80.00/08
Contemporary English-Language Indian Children’s Literature Representations of Nation, Culture, and the New Indian Girl Michelle Superle, York University, Canada Series: Children’s Literature and Culture This book examines the ways Indian children’s writers have represented childhood in relation to nation, cultural identity, and girlhood. From a framework of postcolonial and feminist theories, children’s novels published in India are compared with those from the United Kingdom and North America, considering the differing ideologies and the current textual constructions of childhood at play in each. Routledge «Market: Literature April 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-88634-5: £80.00/08
Domesticity and Design in American Women’s Lives and Literature Stowe, Alcott, Cather, and Wharton Writing Home
Series: Routledge Interdisciplinary Perspectives on Literature This volume maps out the recent explosive expansion of environmental criticism, focusing on its active transformation of three areas of broad interest in contemporary literary and cultural studies: history, scale, and science. Contributors include Cheryll Glotfelty, Timothy Morton, and Elaine Scarry. Foreword by Lawrence Buell. Routledge «Market: Literature April 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-88630-7: £80.00/08
Humor in Contemporary Junior Literature * Julie Cross Series: Children’s Literature and Culture This book explores the changing content, forms and functions of humor in junior texts since the 1960s. These changes have produced new compounds of seemingly paradoxical high and low forms of humor, which reflect and contribute to contemporary western society’s hesitant and uneven acceptance of the emergent paradigm of children’s rights, abilities and empowerment. Routledge «Market: Literature January 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-88267-5: £80.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83294-3: £80.00/14
Italo Calvino’s Architecture of Lightness The Utopian Imagination in An Age of Urban Crisis Letizia Modena, Villanova University, USA
Caroline Hellman, New York City College of Technology, USA Series: Routledge Studies in Nineteenth Century Literature This book considers the ways Cather, Stowe, Wharton, and Alcott inhabited domestic space and portrayed it in their work. Exploring authors who had intriguing and autonomous relationships with home, Hellman undertakes a dual treatment of domesticity, synthesizing a more complete understanding of the relationships between social history and literary accomplishment.
Series: Routledge Studies in Twentieth-Century Literature Modena draws on untranslated Italian- and French-language materials about urban planning, architecture, and utopian architecture to argue that Calvino’s work in fact introduces readers to the material history of urban renewal in Italy, France, and the U.S. in the 1960s, as well as the multidisciplinary core of cultural life in that decade. Routledge «Market: Literature March 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-88038-1: £75.00/08
Moral Play and Counterpublic Ineke Murakami, State University of New York, Albany, USA Series: Routledge Studies in Renaissance Literature and Culture This book argues that the popular English ‘morality play’ functioned not as a cloistered form, but as a volatile public forum. Readings of plays from 1465 to 1599 reveal how moral dramatists deployed apparently inert literary and performance conventions to veil and articulate social criticism, and rouse politically aware, non-elite publics. Routledge «Market: Literature March 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-88631-4: £75.00/08
Postapartheid Literature Mourning and the Reinvention of Community Sam Durrant, University of Leeds, UK Series: Routledge Research in Postcolonial Literatures This book explores the ways in which postapartheid literature reinvents South African mourning traditions. In the postapartheid era, writers have been expected to produce a literature of national reconciliation, but while a literature of reconciliation might appear to allow for more imaginative possibilities than protest literature, it is still driven by a particular politics of memory. Durrant explores the ways in which postapartheid literature has acceded to and/or resisted this politics of memory and asks what literary resistance might mean in a postapartheid context. Routledge «Market: Literature April 2011: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-99629-7: £80.00/08
Postcolonial Tourism * Literature, Culture, and Environment Anthony Carrigan, Keele University, UK Series: Routledge Research in Postcolonial Literatures Looking at the cultural and ecological effects of mass tourism development in states that are still grappling with the legacies of ‘western’ colonialism, Carrigan argues that postcolonial writers not only dramatize the industry’s most exploitative operations but also provide blueprints toward sustainable tourism futures. Routledge «Market: Literature January 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-88273-6: £80.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83209-7: £80.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Literature April 2011: 229x152: 244pp Hb: 978-0-415-88272-9: £75.00/08
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
literature 33 Representations of Eve in Antiquity and the English Middle Ages *
The Postcolonial City and Its Subjects *
Travel Writing and Ethics
John Flood, Oxford University, UK
London, Nairobi, Bombay
Series: Routledge Studies in Medieval Religion and Culture
Rashmi Varma, Warwick University, UK.
Edited by Charles Forsdick, University of Liverpool, UK, Corinne Fowler, Lancaster University, UK and Ludmilla Kostova, University of Veliko Turnovo, Bulgaria
In this wide-ranging and erudite study, Flood looks at the ways in which Eve was represented in antiquity and the English Middle Ages, relating these understandings to female social roles. Routledge «Market: Literature January 2011: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-87796-1: £80.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83264-6: £80.00/08
Theory and Practice
Series: Routledge Research in Postcolonial Literatures Varma here offers a reading of both historical and contemporary debates on urbanism – looking specifically at London, Nairobi, and Bombay – through the filter of postcolonial fictions and the cultural fields surrounding and containing them. Routledge «Market: Literature December 2010: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-88039-8: £90.00/08
Shakespeare, Trauma and Contemporary Performance * Performances on Stage and Screen
Theorizing a Colonial Caribbean-Atlantic Imaginary
Catherine Silverstone, University of London, UK
Sugar and Obeah
Series: Routledge Studies in Shakespeare
Keith Sandiford, Louisiana State University, USA
This study explores the relationship between performances of Shakespeare’s plays and the ways in which they engage with traumatic events and histories. It investigates the ethical and political implications of attempts to represent trauma in performance, and interrogates a range of narratives about Shakespeare, gender, sexuality, ethnicity, colonization and violence.
Series: Routledge Research in Atlantic Studies
Routledge «Market: Literature April 2011: 229x152: 144pp Hb: 978-0-415-95645-1: £80.00/08
Nineteenth-century Women Novelists and Byronism
Aliki Varvogli, University of Dundee, Scotland
This study focuses on the dynamic interaction between Byron and Madame de Staël, Lady Morgan, Mary Shelley and Jane Austen; and the reaction to Byronism of the Brontës and Harriet Beecher Stowe. It thus challenges previous critics’ segregation of the male Romantic poets from their female peers, whose agenda was perceived to be different: domestic and social.
çè
@
Routledge «Market: Literature March 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-99539-9: £75.00/08
Transnationalism and American Serial Fiction Patricia Okker, University of Missouri, USA Series: Routledge Transnational Perspectives on American Literature Spanning the 1820s through the 1960s, this collection analyzes serial fiction published in English, French, Spanish, German, Swedish, Italian, Polish, Norwegian, Yiddish, and Chinese, considering the ways in which serials function within minority communities. Routledge «Market: Literature April 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-88886-8: £80.00/08
Looking at such authors as Eggers, Banks, Tan, and Foer, this book offers a critical study and analysis of American novels that quite literally ‘go outward’: it discusses books whose protagonists go abroad, and concentrates on narratives that take place mainly away from the US’s geographical borders. Routledge «Market: Literature April 2011: 229x152: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-99582-5: £75.00/08
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Series: Routledge Studies in Romanticism
Routledge «Market: Literature October 2010: 229x152: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-99541-2: £75.00/08
Drawing from the disciplines of anthropology, linguistics, literary studies and modern languages, the contributors in this volume apply themselves to a number of key theoretical questions pertaining to travel writing and ethics, ranging from travelas-commoditisation to encounters with minority languages under threat. Taken collectively, the essays assess the critical legacies from parallel disciplines to the debate so far, such as anthropological theory and postcolonial criticism.
Series: Routledge Transnational Perspectives on American Literature
Caroline Franklin, University of Wales, UK
for e-mail updates in your field
Routledge «Market: Literature December 2010: 229x152: 245pp Hb: 978-0-415-87689-6: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83508-1: £75.00/14
Travel and Dislocation in Contemporary American Fiction
The Female Romantics
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
This book theorizes a Caribbean-Atlantic imaginary that names the specific orders of ontology and knowledge in which the consciousnesses of Amerindians, Africans and Europeans found expression in the colonial West Indies.
Series: Routledge Research in Travel Writing
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
34 english language & linguistics
Alternative Approaches to Second Language Acquisition
Exploring Classroom Discourse Language in Action Steve Walsh, University of Newcastle, UK
Edited by Dwight Atkinson, Purdue University, USA
Series: Routledge Introductions to Applied Linguistics
This volume presents seven alternative approaches to studying second language acquisition – ‘alternative’ in the sense that they contrast with and/or complement the cognitivism pervading the field. All seven approaches – sociocultural, complexity theory, conversation analysis, identity, language socialization, sociocognitive, and ecological are authored by leading advocates for the way of thinking described. Each chapter follows the same format, with the same set of headings for ease of use on courses. Introductory and commentary chapters round out this volume. With an editor’s introduction and a conclusion by Lourdes Ortega, this is an essential volume for those studying or teaching second language acquisition.
The new Routledge Introductions to Applied Linguistics series features introductory textbooks covering the key topics in Applied Linguistics. This book looks particularly at the relationship between language, interaction and learning. Providing a comprehensive account of current perspectives on classroom discourse, the book aims to promote a fuller understanding of interaction, regarded as being central to effective teaching and introduces the concept of classroom interactional competence (CIC). Adopting the back-tofront approach of the RIAL series, the book focuses first on problems and practices in teaching and learning in classroom discourse, moves onto engagement with these problems, considering both traditional and alternative approaches to analyzing classroom discourse and then in the final section draws out the theoretical implications.
Routledge «Market: Applied Linguistics March 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-54924-0: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-54925-7: £19.99/04
Routledge «Market: Applied Linguistics March 2011: 216x138: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-57066-4: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57067-1: £18.99/04
2nd Edition textbook
In Other Words
Exploring English Language Teaching
A Coursebook on Translation Mona Baker, University of Manchester, UK
Language in Action
In Other Words is the definitive coursebook for anyone studying translation studies. Assuming no knowledge of foreign languages or linguistics, it offers both a practical and theoretical guide to the area, and provides an important foundation for training professional translators. The second edition has been fully revised to reflect recent changes in the field and new features include:
Graham Hall, University of Northumbria, UK Series: Routledge Introductions to Applied Linguistics
• a new chapter that addresses issues of ethics and morality • coverage of new genres such as audiovisual translation, scientific translation, oral interpreting and news/media translation • project-driven exercises designed to support MA dissertation work in each chapter • updated references and further reading • further coverage of Spanish and Chinese. Accompanied by a companion website featuring further examples and tasks, this widely respected text, written by an eminent author in the field, is the perfect coursebook for any student studying translation.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Routledge «Market: Applied Linguistics March 2011: 216x138: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-58413-5: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58415-9: £22.99/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Translation Studies January 2011: 246x174: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-46753-7: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-46754-4: £19.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83292-9: £65.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-03086-1
The new Routledge Introductions to Applied Linguistics series features introductory textbooks covering the key topics in Applied Linguistics. Exploring English Language Teaching provides a single volume introduction to the field of ELT from an applied linguistics perspective. The ‘back to front’ structure of the book provides an opportunity to move from real-world problems and practices which readers will recognise from their own language teaching (and learning) experience to an exploration of how such issues link to and inform theoretical understandings. The book guides readers through relevant questions and issues related to classroom language learning and teaching in ELT with numerous tasks and activities throughout the text to support this. Exploring English Language Teaching is an essential textbook for language teachers, post-graduate/graduate students and advanced undergraduates studying in the areas of Applied Linguistics, Language Teacher Education, ELT/TESOL.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
english language & linguistics 35
Internet Linguistics A Student Guide David Crystal, Honorary Professor, Bangor University, UK The Internet is now an integral part of contemporary life and linguists are increasingly concerned with how it is impacting on language. In this studentfriendly guidebook, leading language authority Professor David Crystal follows on from his landmark bestseller, Language and the Internet and takes things one step further. This book presents the area as a new field: Internet linguistics. In his engaging trademark style, Crystal investigates how so much junk email gets past the spam filter- and more importantly how to stop it, looks at why we (over)use exclamation marks in online communication, analyses the phenomenon of Twitter from a linguistic standpoint and much more. He addresses the online linguistic issues that affect us on a daily basis and incorporates real-life examples and data drawn from his own studies. Including activities and suggestions for further research, this is the essential guidebook to this critical new field for undergraduates of English language and linguistics. Routledge «Market: English Language and Applied Linguistics January 2011: 216x138: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-60268-6: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-60271-6: £16.99/04
Language and Learning in the Digital Age James Paul Gee and Elisabeth Hayes, both at Arizona State University, USA In the context of moral panics surrounding social media, the internet and video games and concerns over how digital media are affecting the young and their ability to learn and communicate effectively, leading educationalists James Paul Gee and Elisabeth Hayes put forward arguments for how digital media is transforming language, literacy and education and how essential it is to embrace these new forms of communication. The authors examine how each new form of communication results in similar moral panics and explore how new forms of learning are at the heart of digital media, and the relationship between digital media and language and literacy. This is both essential reading for undergraduate and postgraduate/graduate students in language, linguistics, communication studies and education and a key contribution to the ‘New Literacy studies’ socio-cultural approach to language and literacy. Routledge «Market: English Language and Linguistics / Education / Media Studies May 2011: 216x138: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-60276-1: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-60277-8: £18.99/04
textbook
2nd Edition textbook
Introducing Pragmatics in Use
Introducing Sociolinguistics
Anne O’Keeffe and Brian Clancy, both at University of Limerick, Ireland and Svenja Adolphs, University of Nottingham, UK
Miriam Meyerhoff, University of Auckland, New Zealand
çè
Routledge «Market: English Language and Applied Linguistics February 2011: 246x189: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-45092-8: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-45091-1: £19.99/04
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Giving a comprehensive overview of sociolinguistic methods and areas of investigation, this engaging and practical second edition covers all issues of major concern in the field. Updated to include the latest research it provides everything a sociolinguistics student needs. Pedagogical features include exercises, boxes connecting sociolinguistics and linguistic or social theory, key terms, chapter summaries and lively add-ons. The new edition links to the Routledge Sociolinguistics Reader and a website with web- and video-links, interactive exercises and glossary. Selected Contents: 1. Introduction 2. Variation and Language 3. Variation and style 4. Language Attitudes 5. Politeness 6. Multilingualism and Code-Switching 7. Real and Apparent Time 8. Social Class 9. Networks and Communities of Practice 10. Gender 11. Contact 12. Conclusion Routledge «Market: Applied Linguistics February 2011: 246x189: 352pp Hb: 978-0-415-55005-5: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-55006-2: £19.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-87419-6: £65.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-39948-7
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Introducing Pragmatics in Use is a lively and accessible introduction to pragmatics, which both covers theory and applies it to real spoken and written data. Pragmatics is the study of language in context, yet most textbooks rely on invented language examples. This innovative textbook systematically draws on language corpora to illustrate features such as creativity in small talk or how we apologise in English. It also looks at the pragmatic implications of the globalisation of the English language and focuses on the applications of pragmatics for teaching languages. In addition, there is a chapter on researching pragmatics aimed at developing students’ research skills. With a range of lively tasks and further reading, this is the ideal textbook for advanced undergraduate or postgraduate students of pragmatics and corpus linguistics within applied language/linguistics or TEFL/TESOL degrees.
‘A great book … easy to read and by far the most accessible introductory text for sociolinguistics.‘ – Nana Haug Hilton, University of York
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
36 english language & linguistics 3rd Edition textbook
textbook
Language, Society and Power *
Mapping Applied Linguistics
An Introduction
A Guide for Students and Practitioners
Annabelle Mooney, Roehampton University, UK, Jean Stilwell Peccei, formerly Roehampton University, UK, Suzanne LaBelle, Berit Engøy Henriksen, Eva Eppler and Satori Soden, all at Roehampton University, UK, Pia Pichler, University of London, UK, Anthea Irwin, Glasgow Caledonian University, UK and Sian Preece, Institute of Education, UK
Christopher Hall, York St John University, UK, Patrick H. Smith, University of Texas at El Paso, USA and Rachel Wicaksono, York St John University, UK
While it can be used as a stand-alone text, this edition of Language, Society and Power has also been fully cross-referenced with the new companion title: The Language, Society and Power Reader. Routledge «Market: English Language and Linguistics / Media and Communication Studies / Education December 2010: 246x174: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-57658-1: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57659-8: £18.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83654-5: £60.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-30394-1
reader
The Language and Intercultural Communication Reader
• language teaching and education, literacy and language disorders • language variation and world Englishes • language policy and planning • lexicography and forensic linguistics • multilingualism and translation. Featuring further reading, fieldwork suggestions and a full glossary, there is also an interactive companion website. This is essential reading for students of applied linguistics, TESOL, general linguistics, and education at the advanced undergraduate or master’s level, as well as practitioners interested in the wider scope of the field. Routledge «Market: Applied Linguistics February 2011: 246x174: 416pp Hb: 978-0-415-55912-6: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-55913-3: £22.99/04
The Language of Colour An Introduction Theo Van Leeuwen, University of Technology, Australia The Language of Colour provides a fresh approach to the study of colour. Moving on from the meanings of single colours, Theo van Leeuwen develops the theory that many different features shape the way we attach meaning to the colours we see in front of us, and the idea that colour schemes are more important than individual colours.
Edited by Zhu Hua, Birbeck, University of London, UK Language is key to understanding culture, and culture is an essential part of studying language. This Reader focuses on the interplay between Language and Intercultural Communication. Divided into six parts, it covers: Culture, language and thought; Cultural approaches to discourse and pragmatics; Communication patterns across cultures; Teaching and learning cultural variations of language use; Interculturality and Intercultural Communication in professional contexts . With chapters by eminent authorities in the field as well as cutting-edge materials representing current developments, the Reader explores the breadth and depth of the subject as well as providing an essential overview for both students and researchers. Routledge «Market: Applied Linguistics / Communication Studies January 2011: 246x174: 448pp Hb: 978-0-415-54912-7: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-54913-4: £25.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Spanning a range of examples from graphic design to the visual arts, this title presents a contemporary and accessible overview of the use of colour in a wide variety of situations and cultural and historical contexts. Covering both traditional and cutting-edge theory and supplemented by questions and ideas for projects at the end of every chapter, The Language of Colour is the ideal textbook for students of Multimodality and Language and Communication within Applied Linguistics, communication studies, art and design and cultural studies. Routledge «Market: Applied Linguistics December 2010: 246x174: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-49537-0: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-49538-7: £24.99/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
This third edition of this bestselling book has been completely revised to include recent developments in theory and research and offers:a range of new and engaging international examples drawn from everyday life; new activities designed to give students a real understanding of the topic; an additional chapter covering Student Projects – giving readers suggestions on how to further explore the topics covered in the book; updated and expanded further reading sections for each chapter and a glossary.
This is an innovative and wide-ranging introduction to the full scope of applied linguistics. Incorporating both sociocultural and cognitive perspectives, the book maps the diverse and constantly expanding range of theories, methods and issues faced by students and practitioners alike. There is in-depth coverage of:
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
english language & linguistics 37
The Language of Displayed Art Michael O’Toole The Language of Displayed Art, first published in 1994, is a seminal work in the field of Multimodality and one of the few to be entirely dedicated to the analysis and interpretation of works of art.This book explores the ‘grammar’ of the visual arts of painting, sculpture and architecture.The 2nd edition features: two new chapters; an extended discussion of Chapter 5 ‘Why Semiotics’; and an extended version of Chapter 7 with more illustrations of language forms, discourse norms and genres, as well as non-art visual modes. The book is now accompanied by a CD, created by the author and features a virtual gallery of 28 additional paintings with questions to encourage analysis and interpretation, and model answers to these questions in the book’s appendix. The CD also includes a notebook for readers to record their own observations and ideas. The Language of Displayed Art 2nd edition is an indispensable text for those studying multimodality, Applied Linguistics, language and art. Routledge «Market: Applied Linguistics / Media and Communication / Art and Design December 2010: 234x156: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-59526-1: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59527-8: £34.99/04
The Routledge Handbook of Applied Linguistics James Simpson, University of Leeds, UK Series: Routledge Handbooks in Applied Linguistics The flagship title in the Routledge Handbooks in Applied Linguistics series, this volume serves as an introduction and reference point to the key areas in the dynamic evolving field of applied linguistics. It is characterised by its wide-reaching scope and broad relevance, a strong social engagement, and clear, authoritative chapters. Comprising of a detailed introduction and 47 newly commissioned chapters from leading international researchers and academics in the field, the Handbook is divided into five sections covering: applied linguistics in action; language learning, language education; language, culture and identity; perspectives on language in use; and descriptions of language for applied linguistics. This Handbook is key reading for all engaged in studying or teaching Applied Linguistics. Routledge «Market: Applied Linguistics December 2010: 246x174: 680pp Hb: 978-0-415-49067-2: £110.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83565-4: £110.00/14 Rising to £125.00/03 three months after publication
reader
The Pragmatics Reader
True to the Language Game
Edited by Peter Grundy, University of Northumbria, UK and Dawn Archer, University of Central Lancashire, UK
African American Discourse, Cultural Politics, and Pedagogy
The Pragmatics Reader is the indispensable set of readings for all students studying Pragmatics at advanced undergraduate and postgraduate levels. Combining key classic texts with newer extracts covering current developments in contemporary Pragmatics, each reading has been carefully selected to both showcase the best thinking and latest research and also to reflect the international nature of the field. The 30 varied readings, including four specially commissioned papers, have been organised into eight themed sections. Each of these sections is supported and enhanced by substantial editorial commentaries, pre-reading, in-reading and post-reading activities and suggestions for further reading, both in print and online. The book also features a general introduction, a glossary of key terms, and a conclusion that explores the relationship between pragmatic theory and practice before anticipating the future directions of the subject.
Keith Gilyard, one of the major African American figures to emerge in language and cultural studies, makes his most seminal work available in one volume. This collection of new and previously published essays contains Gilyard’s most relevant scholarly contributions to deliberations about linguistic diversity, cultural identity, critical literacy, writing instruction, literary texts, and popular culture. The volume also features contemporary treatises on such timely topics as ‘students’ right to their own language,’ code-switching pedagogy, and political discourse surrounding the rise of Barack Obama. Gilyard weaves together serious analysis, theoretical work, policy discussions, and personal reflections on the interplay of language, literacy, and social justice to make this book essential reading for students and scholars in rhetorical studies, composition studies, applied linguistics, and education.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Routledge «Market: Linguistics / English Language Studies / Rhetoric April 2011: 229x152: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-88716-8: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88717-5: £26.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83461-9: £95.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: English Language and Linguistics January 2011: 246x174: 560pp Hb: 978-0-415-54659-1: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-54660-7: £26.99/04
Keith Gilyard
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
38 english language & linguistics
Michael Farrelly, University of Birmingham, UK Series: Routledge Critical Studies in Discourse This critical examination of democracy in advanced liberal nations combines close analysis of discourse with theories of democracy and the State. Building on the work of Fairclough and others, the book analyses the paradox of pervasive reference to democracy in legitimizing political action versus the weakening of actual democratic practice. Routledge «Market: Linguistics March 2011: 229x152: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-87235-5: £85.00/08
Language, Ideology and Identity in Serial Killer Narratives Christiana Gregoriou, University of Leeds, UK Series: Routledge Studies in Rhetoric and Stylistics Gregoriou explores the linguistic portrayal of the serial killer identity and its related ideology across crime narratives, including detective fiction, true crime genres and media journalism. In doing so, she investigates how the criminal consciousness is portrayed, how killing is justified, and whether the language across these genres is distinctive. Routledge «Market: Linguistics / Communications January 2011: 229x152: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-87229-4: £80.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83265-3: £80.00/14
Multilingualism, Discourse, and Ethnography
Regimes of Derivation in Syntax and Morphology
Edited by Marilyn Martin-Jones and Sheena Gardner, both at University of Birmingham, UK
Edwin Williams, Princeton University, USA
Series: Routledge Critical Studies in Multilingualism In this volume, contributors both look at the range of approaches to description and analysis which are currently employed within research on multilingualism, and consider the methodological issues which arise in particular kinds of studies in particular sociolinguistic spaces. Routledge «Market: Linguistics April 2011: 229x152: 356pp Hb: 978-0-415-87494-6: £95.00/08
Multimodality, Cognition, and Experimental Literature * Alison Gibbons, University of Nottingham, UK Series: Routledge Studies in Multimodality Drawing on cognitive linguistics, cognitive psychology, neuroscience, semiotics, visual perception, visual communication, and multimodal analysis, Gibbons engages with visual and multimodal devices in twenty-first century literature, exploring canonical authors like Mark Z. Danielewski and Jonathan Safran Foer alongside experimental fringe writers such as Steve Tomasula, to uncover an embodied textual aesthetics in the information age. Routledge «Market: Linguistics / Literature April 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-87361-1: £80.00/08
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
Series: Routledge Leading Linguists This book presents a novel conception of syntactic derivation coupled with a novel syntax/morphology interface that together provide architectural explanations for a range of linguistic puzzles, including scopes of affixes, reconstruction, remnant movement, improper movement, scrambling/scope interactions, islands, and the different embedding properties of clauses and DPs. Routledge «Market: Linguistics February 2011: 229x152: 160pp Hb: 978-0-415-88723-6: £85.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83079-6: £85.00/14
Multimodal Studies Exploring Issues and Domains Edited by Kay O’Halloran and Bradley A. Smith, both at National University of Singapore Series: Routledge Studies in Multimodality This volume presents a range of works by an impressive international roster of contributors who both explore issues arising from the study of multimodality and explore the scope of this emerging field within specific domains of multimodal phenomena. Routledge «Market: Linguistics / Media January 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-88822-6: £90.00/08
çè
Discourse and Democracy
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
language learning
TOP TEN BESTSELLERS
english language & linguistics 39
1.
6. Modern Mandarin Chinese Grammar
2nd Edition
A Practical Guide
Portuguese: An Essential Grammar
Claudia Ross and Jing-Heng Sheng Ma
Amelia P. Hutchinson and Janet Lloyd
2006: 246x174: 432pp Pb: 978-0-415-70010-8: £24.99/04
2003: 234x156: 288pp Pb: 978-0-415-30817-5: £22.99/04
2.
7. The Routledge Advanced Chinese Multimedia Course
2nd Edition
New Routledge Dutch Dictionary
Crossing Cultural Boundaries
R. Hempelman and N. Osselton
Kun-shan Carolyn Lee, Hsin-Hsin Liang, Liwei Jiao and Julian Wheatley
2003: 198x129: 928pp Pb: 978-0-415-30041-4: £22.99/04
3.
2009: 178x254: 384pp Pb: 978-0-415-77407-9: £35.00/04
8. Thinking Arabic Translation
Greek: An Essential Grammar of the Modern Language
A Course in Translation Method: Arabic to English James Dickins, Sándor Hervey and Ian Higgins
David Holton, Peter Mackridge and Irene Philippaki-Warburton
2002: 234x156: 272pp Pb: 978-0-415-25065-8: £24.99/04
2003: 234x156: 296pp Pb: 978-0-415-23210-4: £22.99/04
4.
9. Basic Korean
2nd Edition
A Grammar and Workbook
Finnish: An Essential Grammar
Andrew Sangpil Byon
Fred Karlsson
2008: 234x156: 256pp Pb: 978-0-415-77487-1: £20.99/04
2007: 234x156: 416pp Pb: 978-0-415-43914-5: £22.99/04
5.
10. 2nd Edition
2nd Edition
Thinking Spanish Translation
Chinese: An Essential Grammar
A Course in Translation Method: Spanish to English
Yip Po-Ching and Don Rimmington 2006: 234x156: 240pp Pb: 978-0-415-37261-9: £22.99/04
Louise Haywood, Michael Thompson and Sándor Hervey
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
2009: 234x156: 304pp Pb: 978-0-415-48130-4: £24.99/04
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
40 language learning
500 Common Chinese Idioms *
A Frequency Dictionary of Czech *
An Annotated Frequency Dictionary
Core Vocabulary for Learners
Liwei Jiao, University of Pennsylvania, USA, Cornelius C. Kubler, Williams College, USA and Weiguo Zhang, Woosung University, Republic of Korea
Frantisek Cermak and Michal Kren, both at Charles University Prague, Czech Republic
500 Common Chinese Idioms is a unique tool for learners. Presenting the 500 most commonly used Chinese idioms or ‘chengyu’, this dictionary presents:
Series: Routledge Frequency Dictionaries
The dictionary offers a step-by-step approach to gaining greater fluency through a grasp of the most common idioms in the language, making it the ideal resource for the intermediate learner of Chinese and for Chinese language teachers.
A Frequency Dictionary of Czech is an invaluable tool for all learners of Czech, providing a list of the 5,000 most frequently used words in the language. All entries in the rank frequency list feature the English equivalent, a sample sentence with English translation and an indication of register variation. The dictionary also contains twenty thematically organised and frequency-ranked lists of words on a variety of topics, such as family, food and drink and transport. A CD of the text is available to purchase separately and is designed for use by corpus and computational linguists in a format that researchers can process and turn into suitable lists for their own research work.
Routledge «Market: Chinese Language November 2010: 246x174: 368pp Hb: 978-0-415-59893-4: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-77682-0: £29.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83914-0: £85.00/04
Routledge «Market: Language Learning November 2010: 246x174: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-57661-1: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57662-8: £25.99/04 CD: 978-0-415-57663-5: £99.99/14
• the idiom in both simplified and traditional characters • the idiom in pinyin romanisation • a literal English translation and English equivalents • two suitable example sentences, plus explanations and usage notes.
A Frequency Dictionary of Arabic * A Frequency Dictionary Core Vocabulary for Learners of Mandarin Chinese Series: Routledge Frequency Dictionaries An invaluable tool for learners of Arabic, this Frequency Dictionary provides a list of the 5000 most commonly used words in the language. Based on a thiry million word corpus of Arabic which includes both written and spoken material, this dictionary provides detailed information for each of the 5000 entries, including the English equivalent, a sample sentence, and an indication of major register variation (including regional and dialectal). Pronunciation indicators are also given in the form of diacritics for MSA words and Romanized pronunciation for colloquial terms. A CD version of the text is available to purchase separately. Designed for use by corpus and computational linguists, it present the corpus in a format that researchers can process and turn into suitable lists for their own research work. Routledge «Market: Language Learning October 2010: 246x174: 384pp Hb: 978-0-415-59543-8: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-44434-7: £29.99/04 CD: 978-0-415-60030-9: £99.99/14 eBook: 978-0-203-88328-0: £35.95/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Core Vocabulary for Learners Richard Xiao, Edge Hill University, UK, Paul Rayson and Tony McEnery, University of Lancaster, UK A Frequency Dictionary of Mandarin Chinese is an invaluable tool for all learners and users of Mandarin Chinese, providing a list of the 5,000 words and the 2,000 Chinese characters (simplified) most commonly used in the language. Based on a fifty-million-word corpus composed of spoken, fiction, non-fiction and news texts in current use, the dictionary provides the user with a detailed frequency-based list along with the English equivalent and a sample sentence with English translation. This CD version has been specifically designed for use by corpus and computational linguists. It provides the frequency corpus in a tab delimited format allowing users the flexibility to process the material for their own research purposes. Routledge «Market: Chinese Language January 2011 CD: 978-0-415-60106-1: £99.99/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Tim Buckwalter, University of Pennsylvania, USA and Dilworth Parkinson, Brigham Young University, Utah, USA
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
language learning 41 2nd Edition
3rd Edition
Cantonese: A Comprehensive Grammar *
Colloquial Hungarian
Stephen Matthews, The University of Hong Kong and Virginia Yip, The Chinese University of Hong Kong Series: Comprehensive Grammars
The Complete Course for Beginners Carol Rounds, Columbia University, USA and Erika Sólyom, New York Series: Colloquial Series Colloquial Hungarian is the ideal introduction to the Hungarian Language. Specially written by experienced teachers, the course offers a step-by-step approach to written and spoken Hungarian and covers a variety of modern everyday situations. Colloquial Hungarian provides:
‘Cantonese: A Comprehensive Grammar represents the latest effort in writing a dialectal grammar, a grammar that aims to serve language students, teachers, and linguists alike with both challenge and elegance.’ – Professor Samuel H.N. Cheung, International Review of Chinese Linguistics Cantonese: A Comprehensive Grammar is a complete reference guide to Cantonese as spoken by native speakers in Hong Kong. It presents a fresh and accessible description of the language, concentrating on the real patterns of use in current Cantonese. This makes it the ideal reference source for all learners and users of Cantonese, irrespective of level. Routledge «Market: Language Learning December 2010: 234x156: 576pp Hb: 978-0-415-47130-5: £125.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-47131-2: £39.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83501-2: £125.00/03
3rd Edition
Colloquial Czech The Complete Course for Beginners James Naughton, University of Oxford, UK Series: Colloquial Series Specially written by an experienced teacher for self-study or class use, the course offers a step-by-step approach to written and spoken Czech. No prior knowledge of the language is required. What makes Colloquial Czech your best choice in personal language learning?
• emphasis on up-to-date, conversational language • comprehensive vocabulary lists (Hungarian-English and English-Hungarian) • useful reference grammar notes • dialogues and cultural notes provide an introduction to Hungarian culture. By the end of this rewarding course students will be able to communicate confidently and effectively in Hungarian in a broad range of everyday situations, both formal and informal. Routledge «Market: Hungarian Language Learners March 2011: 216x138: 336pp Pack: 978-0-415-56741-1: £39.99/06 Pb: 978-0-415-56740-4: £21.99/06 CD-ROM: 978-0-415-56742-8: £23.99/06 eBook: 978-0-203-86035-9: £33.99/06 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-24256-1
2nd Edition
Colloquial Lithuanian The Complete Course for Beginners Meilute Ramoniene and Ian Press Series: Colloquial Series Specially written by experienced teachers for self-study or class use, the course offers a step-by-step approach to written and spoken Lithuanian. No prior knowledge of the language is required. What makes Colloquial Lithuanian the best choice in personal language learning?
• interactive – wide range of stimulating exercises for regular practice • clear – concise grammar notes • practical – useful vocabulary and pronunciation guide
• interactive – lots of exercises for regular practice
• complete – including answer key and reference section.
çè
Routledge «Market: Language Learning / East European Studies October 2010: 216x138: 480pp Pack: 978-0-415-49632-2: £29.99/06 Pb: 978-0-415-49631-5: £16.99/06 CD-ROM: 978-0-415-49633-9: £18.99/06 eBook: 978-0-203-87827-9: £33.99/06 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-16134-3
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
• clear – concise grammar notes • practical – useful vocabulary and pronunciation guide • complete – including answer key and reference section. Routledge «Market: Language Learning / Lithuanian October 2010: 216x138: 480pp Pack: 978-0-415-56092-4: £45.93/06 Pb: 978-0-415-56091-7: £24.99/06 CD-ROM: 978-0-415-56093-1: £23.99/06 eBook: 978-0-203-86549-1: £49.99/06 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-42708-1
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
By the end of this rewarding course, you will be able to communicate confidently and effectively in Czech in a broad range of everyday situations.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
42 language learning 3rd Edition
2nd Edition
Colloquial Persian
Concise Compendium of the World’s Languages *
Abdi Rafiee Series: Colloquial Series Colloquial Persian is easy to use and completely up to date! Whether you’re a business traveller, or about to take up a daring challenge in adventure tourism, you may be studying to teach or even looking forward to a holiday – if you’d like to get up and running with Persian this rewarding course will take you from complete beginner to confidently putting your language skills to use in a wide range of everyday situations Two 60-minute CDs or MP3s are available to purchase separately or together with the paperback in the great value Colloquial Pack. Recorded by native speakers, these complement the book and will help develop your listening and pronunciation skills. Routledge «Market: Language Learning Persian November 2010: 216x138: 320pp Pack: 978-0-415-55409-1: £39.99/06 Pb: 978-0-415-56045-0: £19.99/06 CD-ROM: 978-0-415-56046-7: £23.99/06 eBook: 978-0-203-86589-7: £43.99/06
George L. Campbell and Gareth King This second edition of The Concise Compendium of the World’s Languages has been completely revised to provide up-to-date and accurate descriptions of a wide cross-section of natural-language systems. All cultural and historical notes as well as statistical data for each language have been checked, updated and in many cases expanded. Using the wealth of recent developments and research in language typology and broadened availability of descriptive data, this new incarnation of the Concise Compendium brings a much-loved survey emphatically into the twenty-first century for a new generation of readers. The Concise Compendium of the World’s Languages remains the ideal compact reference for all interested linguists and professionals alike. Routledge «Market: Languages November 2010: 234x156: 672pp Hb: 978-0-415-47841-0: £135.00/13 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-11392-2
3rd Edition
2nd Edition
Colloquial Polish
English: An Essential Grammar *
The Complete Course for Beginners
Gerald Nelson, The Chinese University of Hong Kong
B.W. Mazur, formerly at SSEES, University of London
Series: Essential Grammars English: An Essential Grammar is a concise and user-friendly guide to the grammar of modern English, written specifically for native speakers and based on genuine samples of contemporary spoken and written English. In four chapters, the book covers the essentials of English grammar, begining with the basics and going on to deal with phrase, clause and sentence structure. A fifth chapter deals with English word formation and spelling, including problem spellings and British and American spelling variants. Features include:
Series: Colloquial Series This new edition of the best-selling Polish course for beginners has been completely rewritten to make learning the language easier and more enjoyable than before. Written by an experienced teacher and author, Colloquial Polish offers a step-bystep approach to the language as it is spoken and written today. No previous knowledge of Polish is required. Features include: • lively dialogues • lots of exercises with full answer key • jargon-free grammar notes and a quick reference grammar
• discussion of points which often cause problems • guidance on sentence building and composition
• extensive Polish-English and English-Polish word lists.
• practical spelling guidelines
With all the language support you’ll need, Colloquial Polish will soon have you speaking, reading and writing Polish with confidence.
• explanation of grammatical terms
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
• a set of exercises at the end of each chapter • appendix of irregular verbs. Routledge «Market: Language Learning October 2010: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-58295-7: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58296-4: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-84938-5: £85.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-22450-5
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Language Learning / Polish November 2010: 216x138: 352pp Pack: 978-0-415-58198-1: £27.63/06 Pb: 978-0-415-55947-8: £18.99/06 CD-ROM: 978-0-415-56046-7: £23.99/06 eBook: 978-0-203-84997-2: £33.99/06 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-15752-0
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
language learning 43
Hiyaku: An Intermediate Japanese Course
Modern Brazilian Portuguese Grammar Workbook *
Shigeru Eguchi, Fumiko Nazikian, Mihara Nittono, Keiko Okamoto and Jisuk Park
John Whitlam Series: Modern Grammar Workbooks
Hiyaku: An Intermediate Japanese Course provides a high-quality and progressive intermediate course in Japanese, incorporating modern teaching methods and practicing all four language skills. Hiyaku provides content-based instruction, with authentic and semi-authentic dialogues and readings, all carefully selected to instruct and inspire students as they learn Japanese. Key features of the textbook include: • highly structured chapters, beginning with warm-up exercises followed by focused practice of each of the four skills • content taken from original Japanese sources such as movies, books, television, magazines and newspapers • extensive audio material provided as FREE MP3 files on companion website • instructor’s materials, including PowerPoint presentations provided through companion site. Routledge «Market: Language Learning March 2011: 246x174: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-77747-6: £85.00/04 Pb: 978-0-415-60897-8: £29.99/04
Modern Brazilian Portuguese Grammar Workbook is an innovative book of exercises and language tasks for all learners of Brazilian Portuguese. The book is divided into two sections: • Part A provides exercises based on essential grammatical structures • Part B practises everyday functions (e.g making social contact, asking questions and expressing needs). A comprehensive answer key at the back of the book enables you to check on your progress. Modern Brazilian Grammar Workbook is ideal for all learners who have a basic knowledge of Brazilian Portuguese, including undergraduates taking Brazilian Portuguese as a major or minor part of their studies, as well as intermediate and advanced students in schools and adult education. It can be used independently or in conjunction with Modern Brazilian Portuguese Grammar: A Practical Guide. Routledge «Market: Brazilian Portuguese October 2010: 246x174: 168pp Pb: 978-0-415-56646-9: £18.99/04
Korean: A Comprehensive Grammar
Modern Russian Grammar Workbook
Jaehoon Yeon and Lucien Brown both at SOAS, University of London, UK
John Dunn, University of Glasgow, UK and Shamil Khairov, Trinity College Dublin, Ireland
Series: Comprehensive Grammars
Series: Modern Grammar Workbooks
Korean: A Comprehensive Grammar is a complete reference guide to Korean grammar. It presents a thorough yet accessible overview of the language, concentrating on the real patterns of use in modern Korean. The book moves from the alphabet and pronunciation through morphology and word classes to a detailed analysis of sentence structures and semantic features such as aspect, tense, speech styles and negation. Features include: • detailed treatment of the common grammatical structures and parts of speech
Modern Russian Grammar Workbook is an innovative book of exercises and language tasks for all learners of Russian. The book is divided into two parts. • Section 1 provides exercises based on essential grammatical structures • Section 2 practises everyday functions such as making introductions, apologizing, expressing needs A comprehensive answer key at the back of the book enables students to check on their progress. Main features include: • exercises graded according to level of difficulty • cross referencing to the related Modern Russian Grammar
• clear, jargon-free explanations
• topical exercises which develop students’ vocabulary base.
• particular attention to areas of confusion and difficulty
Routledge «Market: Language / Reference December 2010: 246x174: 256pp Pb: 978-0-415-42554-4: £23.99/03 eBook: 978-0-203-08801-2: £50.00/14
• Korean-English parallels highlighted throughout.
çè
Routledge «Market: Language Learning January 2011: 234x156: 480pp Hb: 978-0-415-60384-3: £125.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-60385-0: £40.00/04
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
• extensive and wide-ranging use of examples
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
44 language learning
Polish: A Comprehensive Grammar The Routledge Contemporary Iwona Sadowska, Georgetown University, USA Turkish Reader Series: Comprehensive Grammars Political and Cultural Articles
Polish: A Comprehensive Grammar is a complete reference guide to the grammar system for intermediate to advanced learners of Polish. It presents an accessible and systematic description of the language, focusing on real patterns of use in contemporary language. The book is organised in such a way to promote a thorough understanding of Polish at all levels of structure; the sound system, formation of word and phrases and sentence construction. It offers a stimulating analysis of the complexities of language, providing clear explanations and examples of each point. Polish: A Comprehensive Grammar is the essential reference work on Polish grammar for all learners and users of the language.
Senel Simsek The Routledge Contemporary Turkish Reader: Political and Cultural Articles has been specially designed for intermediate and advanced learners of Turkish and comprises a broad selection of graded readings. Written by prominent Turkish academics and journalists, the collection of modern texts presented here have been specifically selected to ensure students receive maximum exposure to current political and cultural issues related to Turkey; from gender, ethnicity, religion and social class through to arts and history. Each reading is fully supported by an introduction written by an expert in the related field, a vocabulary list with English translation and vocabulary in context, short grammar explanations of any difficult structures encountered in the text and comprehension questions directly text related, language exercises and subject specific questions to generate class-discussion and essay writing in Turkish.
Routledge «Market: Language Reference March 2011: 234x156: 500pp Hb: 978-0-415-47540-2: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-47541-9: £35.00/04
Routledge «Market: Turkish Language March 2011: 246x174: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-56816-6: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56817-3: £22.99/04
2nd Edition new in paperback
2nd Edition
Routledge Encyclopedia of Translation Studies
The World’s Major Languages Edited by Bernard Comrie
Edited by Mona Baker, University of Manchester, UK and Gabriela Saldanha, The University of Birmingham, UK Delivering a thoroughly revised and updated version of the most authoritative reference work in the field, this new and expanded edition of the Routledge Encyclopedia of Translation Studies now available in paperback draws on the expertise of over ninety contributors from all over the world, providing an unparalleled global perspective which makes this volume unique. With all entries alphabetically arranged, extensively cross-referenced and including suggestions for further reading, this text combines clarity with scholarly accuracy and depth, defining and discussing key terms in context to ensure maximum understanding and ease of use. Including approximately thirty new entries, the Encyclopedia presents a genuinely comprehensive overview of the rich and complex academic discipline of translation studies.
This volume features over fifty of the world’s languages and language families. The featured languages have been chosen based on the number of speakers, their role as official languages and their cultural and historical importance. Each language is looked at in depth, and the chapters provide information on both grammatical features and on salient features of the language’s history and cultural role. This second edition has been updated and revised. Two new languages, Amharic and Javanese, have been included. This accessible volume will appeal to anyone with an interest in linguistics. Routledge «Market: Reference January 2011: 246x174: 928pp Pb: 978-0-415-60902-9: £40.00/03
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Translation Studies / Linguistics and Literature January 2011: 246x174: 704pp Pb: 978-0-415-60984-5: £39.99/13 eBook: 978-0-203-87206-2: £250.00/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
language learning 45
The Routledge Dictionary of French Cultural References MIchael Mould The Routledge Dictionary of french Cultural References reveals the hidden cultural dimension of contemporary French, as used in the press, going beyond the limited and purely lexical approach of the traditional bilingual dictionary. Even foreign learners of French who possess a good level of French often have difficulty in fully understanding French articles, not because of any linguistic shortcomings on their part but because of their inadequate knowledge of the cultural references. This cultural dictionary of French provides the reader with clear and concise explanations of the crucial cultural dimension behind the most frequently used words and phrases found in contemporary French press. This is the ideal reference for all undergraduate and postgraduate students of French seeking to enhance their understanding of the French language. It will also be of interest to teachers, translators and Francophiles alike. Routledge «Market: French January 2011: 234x156: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-59792-0: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59794-4: £24.99/04
The Routledge Spanish Bilingual Dictionary of Psychology and Psychiatry Steven M. Kaplan The Routledge Spanish Bilingual Dictionary of Psychology and Psychiatry contains over 100,000 entries making this the most comprehensive and up-to-date dictionary of its kind. The Dictionary provides concise, comprehensive and current coverage of every word or phrase used in the study and practice of psychiatry and psychology. This valuable reference tool covers all disciplines and sub-disciplines, both research-based and clinical. This is a vital resource to those in the healthcare professions, to academicians and to those who work in translation and/or interpretation, healthcare and the law who are in contact with the English and Spanish speaking communities. Routledge «Market: Dictionaries / Spanish January 2011: 234x156: 1000pp Hb: 978-0-415-58774-7: £175.00/08
theatre & performance
Black & Asian Theatre In Britain
Performing Remains
Colin Chambers
Art and War in Times of Theatrical Reenactment Colin Chambers’ timely study traces the history of ‘the other’ in British theatre from the early representations of the 16th century and blackface through to the emergence of black actors and Black and Asian theatre in their own right. The different, diverse and often contradictory aspects of this history are drawn together to provide a background to the work of diasporic companies and practitioners from Africa, Asian and the Carribbean who underpinned the flourishing of black and Asian theatre at the turn of the 21st century.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Performing Remains is a collection of essays from one of Performance Studies’ leading scholars, exploring the role of the fake, the false and the faux in contemporary theatre. Rebecca Schneider questions the view that performance is ‘ephemeral’ and instead argues that rather than being about what disappears, performance is defined by what remains. Divided into seven essays, this book examines both contemporary and historical performance with a wide scope. It qestions the importance of representation and reassessing the ritual value of failure to recreate the ‘original’ or to pass as the object of imitation. Routledge «Market: Theatre Studies January 2011: 234x156: 296pp Hb: 978-0-415-40441-9: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-40442-6: £19.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85287-3: £75.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Drama and Theatre Studies March 2011: 216x138: 248pp Hb: 978-0-415-36513-0: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-37598-6: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-01654-1: £55.00/16
Rebecca Schneider
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
46 theatre & performance 2nd Edition student reference
reader
Fifty Contemporary Choreographers *
The Vakhtangov Sourcebook * Edited by Andrei Malaev-Babel, Florida State University, USA Yevgeny Vakhtangov was the creator of Fantastic Realism, credited with reconciling Meyerhold’s bold experiments with Stanislavski’s naturalist technique. The Vakhtangov Sourcebook compiles new translations of his key writings on the art of theatre, making it the primary source of first hand material on master of theatre in the English speaking world. Vakhtangov’s essays and articles are accompanied by:
Edited by Martha Bremser, Channing School, UK and Lorna Sanders, Royal Ballet School, UK Series: Routledge Key Guides A unique and authoritative guide to the lives and work of prominent contemporary choreographers, this fully updated new edition includes many new names in the field of choreography, alongside those considered masters of the modern age. Representing a wide range of dance genres, each entry locates the individual in the context of modern dance theatre and explores their impact. Those studied include: Jerome Bel, Richard Alston, Doug Varone, William Forsyth, Phillippe Decoufle, Ohad Naharin, Itzik Gallili, Merce Cunningham and Wim Vandekeybus. With an updated introduction by Deobrah Jowitt and further reading and references throughout, this text is an invaluable resource for all students and critics of dance, and all those interested in the fascinating world of choreography. Routledge «Market: Dance and Performance Studies March 2011: 216x138: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-38081-2: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-38082-9: £14.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-10364-0
• diary excerpts on popular theatre • his 1914 Lectures to the Vakhtangov Studio • accounts of Vakhtangov in rehearsal • production photographs and sketches • extensive bibliographies • director’s notes on key performances. An extensive introductory overview from editor Andrei Malaev-Babel explains the Vakhtangov‘s creative life, his groundbreaking theatrical concepts and influential directorial works. Routledge «Market: Drama and Theatre Studies March 2011: 216x138: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-47268-5: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-48257-8: £19.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85291-0: £60.00/14
Radical Performance Pedagogy
Social Works
Exercises for Rebel Artists and Border Crossers
Performing Arts, Supporting Publics
Guillermo Gomez-Pena and Roberto Sifuentes
Shannon Jackson, University of California, Berkeley, USA
In Radical Performance Pedagogy, Guillermo Gomez-Pena and Roberto Sifuentes use their extensive teaching and performance experience with La Pocha Nostra to help students and practitioners to create ‘border art’. The book features: • detailed exercises for using Pocha Nostra methods in workshops
• a step-by-step guide for large-scale group performance • new, unpublished photos of the Pocha Nostra method in practice. Radical Performance Pedagogy advocates teaching as an important form of activism and as an extension of the performance aesthetic. It is an essential text for anyone who wants to learn how use performance to both challenge and change. Routledge «Market: Drama and Theatre Studies March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-54922-6: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-54923-3: £16.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Routledge «Market: Drama and Theatre Studies February 2011: 216x138: 280pp Hb: 978-0-415-48600-2: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-48601-9: £19.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85289-7: £65.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
• inspirational approaches for anyone creating, producing or teaching radical performance
At a time when art world critics and curators heavily debate the social, at a time when community organizers and civic activists are reconsidering the role of aesthetics in social reform, this book makes explicit some of the contradictions and competing stakes of contemporary experimental art-making. Social Works is a radically interdisciplinary approach to the forms, goals and histories of innovative social practice in both contemporary performance and visual art. Shannon Jackson uses a range of case studies and contemporary methodologies to mediate between the fields of visual and performance studies. The result is a brilliant analysis that not only incorporates current political and aesthetic discourses but also provides a practical understanding of social practice.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
theatre & performance 47 textbook
reader
Voice: Onstage and Off
William Forsythe and the Practice of Choreography
Robert Barton, University of Oregon, USA and Rocco dal Vera, University of Cincinnati, Ohio, USA Voice: Onstage and Off is a comprehensive guide to the process of building, mastering and fine-tuning the voice for performance. Every aspect of vocal work is covered, from the initial speech impulse, right through to refining for different types of performance. This 2nd edition is accompanied by a new interactive website, which includes: • extensive teacher guides including sample syllabi, scheduling options, and ways of adapting to teaching circumstances • ‘Karaoke’ versions of the exercises with coaching directions or simple piano tones to guide work • before and after examples of student’s voices • videos of the vocal folds in action and showing how the body breathes. Voice coach, voice shrink and voice doctor characters are on hand throughout the book and the website to ensure a holistic approach to voice training. This highly adaptable course empowers performers of all levels to evolve their onstage and offstage voices. Routledge «Market: Drama and Theatre Studies January 2011: 246x174: 352pp Hb: 978-0-415-58557-6: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58558-3: £19.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83519-7: £60.00/14
It Starts From Any Point Steven Spier William Forsythe is one of, if not the most, important choreographers of the last 25 years. As director of the Frankfurt Ballet (1984–2004) he has been lauded for reinvigorating the language of classical ballet (often referred to as Balanchine’s heir) in a fearless and comprehensive examination of its most fundamental assumptions and precepts. Forsythe has created a crossover audience with his far-ranging references and insistence that ballet is a contemporary medium. This gives this edited collection of essays interdisciplinary appeal – extending beyond the ballet and dance communities. Routledge «Market: Dance February 2011: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-97822-4: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-97823-1: £18.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83223-3: £60.00/14
The Theatre of Richard Maxwell and the New York City Players
Nineteenth-Century Theatre and the Imperial Encounter
Sarah Gorman, Roehampton University, UK
Marty Gould, University of South Florida, US
Series: Routledge Advances in Theatre & Performance Studies
Series: Routledge Advances in Theatre & Performance Studies
In this timely study about Richard Maxwell and the New York City Players, Gorman, in consultation with Maxwell, surveys the plays written and performances directed since 1996, providing scholars with an important overview of a key figure in contemporary drama.
In this study, Gould argues that it was in the imperial capital’s theatrical venues that the public was put into contact with the places and peoples of empire. Nineteenth-century playwrights helped forge an idea of empire that, though largely imaginary, entertained, informed, and molded the theatregoing British public.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
Routledge «Market: Theatre & Performance Studies February 2011: 229x152: 260pp Hb: 978-0-415-88984-1: £75.00/08
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Theater May 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-99092-9: £75.00/08
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
48 music
Music in the Human Experience
Women, Music, Culture
An Introduction to Music Psychology
An Introduction
Donald A. Hodges, University of North Carolina at Greensboro, USA and Donald Conrad Sebald, University of Texas at San Antonio, USA
Julie C. Dunbar, Edgewood College, USA This textbook covers the history of women involved in the world of music, including producers, consumers, performers, educators, and listeners. It includes a wide array of pedagogical aids, photographs, an Audio CD, and a companion website.
Music in the Human Experience is a textbook for college courses in music psychology, primarily geared to students of music. It incorporates several other disciplines to provide an explanation for why and how we make sense of music and respond to it cognitively, physically, and emotionally. Selected Contents: Part I: Introducing Music Psychology 1. What is Music Psychology? 2. Philosophical Issues in Music Psychology 3. How We Came to be Musical 4. Music Around the World and Across Time Part II: Perceiving, Understanding and Responding to Music 5. Acoustical Foundations of Music 6. Musical Hearing 7. Psychoacoustics and the Perception of Music 8. Music Cognition 9. Music and the Brain 10. Bodily Responses to Music 11. Musical Emotions 12. The Musical Person 13. Music Performance 14. Music Teaching and Learning 15. Music and Health 16. Music in Social Contexts Routledge «Market: Music February 2011: 235x187: 488pp Hb: 978-0-415-88185-2: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88186-9: £39.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83497-8: £85.00/14
Selected Contents: Part 1. Telling Musical Stories 1. Exploring Music in Context 2. Medieval Liturgical Roots and the Western Canon 3. World Music Part 2. Gender Spheres In Art Music 4. The Renaissance and Beyond 5. Baroque Keyboard and Vocal Genres 6. Romantic-Era Performer/Composers Part 3. Visual Images in an Aural World 7. American Popular Music 8. Gospel and Blues 9. Visual Media and the Marketing of Women Performers Part 4. The Impact of Education on Women’s Art Music Activity 10. Gender Integration in 20 th Century Instrumental Ensembles 11. Twentieth-Century Large-Scale Works 12. Contemporary Music and Experimental Voices Part 5. No Longer ‘One of the Boys’ 13. Instrumental to Jazz 14. Music Technology in the Hands of Women 16. Taking Charge in the Mass Music Market Routledge «Market: Music March 2011: 235x187: 336pp Hb: 978-0-415-87562-2: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87563-9: £39.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83477-0: £85.00/14
textbook
Using Music to Enhance Student Learning A Practical Guide for Elementary Classroom Teachers Mollie Gregory Tower, Texas State University, San Marcos, USA and Jana Fallin, Kansas State University, USA Written for both current and future teachers with little or no previous experience in music, this textbook offers strategies for integrating musical activities in the elementary school classroom. The ultimate goal is for elementary school children to leave the classroom with an appreciation of music in a joyful, creative environment, and perhaps wanting to broaden their understanding.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Selected Contents: I. Getting Started 1. Organizing for Successful Teaching 2. A Framework for Teaching and Learning 3. INSIDE the Music: The Basic Elements of Music II. Somos Músicos: Doing What Musicians Do 4. Listening 5. Performing 6. Creating III. Integrating Music Into the Curriculum 7. Using Music to Enhance Learning in Language Arts 8. Using Music to Enhance Learning in Science 9. Using Music to Enhance Learning in Math 10. Using Music to Enhance Learning in Social Studies 11. Relating Music to the Other Arts 12. Favorite Teaching Tips Routledge «Market: Music February 2011 Pb: 978-0-415-87823-4: £55.00/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83861-7: £55.00/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
music 49 2nd Edition
2nd Edition
2nd Edition
Choral Music
Gabriel Fauré
Johannes Brahms
A Research and Information Guide
A Research and Information Guide
Edited by Heather Platt, Ball State University, USA
Avery T. Sharp and James Michael Floyd, both at Baylor University, USA
Edward R. Phillips
Series: Routledge Music Bibliographies
Series: Routledge Music Bibliographies
Series: Routledge Music Bibliographies
This annotated bibliography is a compact source of information concerning both the nature of primary sources related to Gabriel Faure and the scope and significance of the secondary sources which deal with him, his compositions, and his influence.
This is an annotated bibliography concerning both the nature of primary sources related to the composer and the scope and significance of the secondary sources which deal with him, his compositions, and his influence as a composer and performer. The second edition includes research published since the publication of the first edition and provides electronic resources.
This is an annotated bibliography of books, recordings, videos, and websites on choral music. This book will serve as an excellent tool for librarians, researchers, and scholars in sorting through the massive amount of new material that has appeared since publication of the previous edition. Routledge «Market: Music Reference February 2011: 229x152: 464pp Hb: 978-0-415-99419-4: £90.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-89121-6: £90.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8240-5944-6
Routledge «Market: Music Reference May 2011: 229x152: 348pp Hb: 978-0-415-99885-7: £90.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-88154-5: £90.00/08 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8240-7073-1
Routledge «Market: Music Reference February 2011: 229x152: 576pp Hb: 978-0-415-99456-9: £90.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-89049-3: £90.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8153-3850-5
Gustav Holst A Research and Information Guide Mary Christison Huismann, University of Minnesota, USA Series: Routledge Music Bibliographies Gustav Holst: A Research and Information Guide is an annotated bibliography of all substantial, relevant published resources relating to this important composer.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Music Reference May 2011: 229x152: 352pp Hb: 978-0-415-99525-2: £60.00/08
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
50 early years & childhood studies Taylor & Francis is the official distributor for Guilford Press books in the UK, Europe and Israel. Customers from the USA, Canada and the rest of the world should purchase Guilford Press titles (indicated below) via www.guilford.com
Exploring Children’s Creative Narratives
Developing Emotional Intelligence in the Primary School
Edited by Dorothy Faulkner, The Open University, UK and Elizabeth Coates, University of Warwick, UK
Sue Colverd and Bernard Hodgkin, University of Gloucestershire, UK
This collection of international research offers fresh perspectives on children’s creative processes and the expression of their creative imagination together with informed theoretical critiques of current educational practice. Drawing on detailed research evidence from innovative educational initiatives in different countries, Exploring Children’s Creative Narratives develops new theoretical and practical insights that challenge traditional educational thinking about children’s creativity. This broad yet coherent collection of fresh perspectives on creativity in childhood is essential reading for students, researchers and policy makers in early childhood as well as for Early Years Professionals with a particular interest in creativity.
Do you want to promote sociability and positive behaviour in your classroom? Is having an ‘emotionally intelligent classroom’ one of your teaching goals? Developing Emotional Intelligence in the Primary School is an essential text for supporting children’s emotional preparation for learning in the long term, fostering the development both of self belief and permanent and crucial resilience. This book allows teachers to review their practice and approach to teaching and to re-assess how they view their pupils. Using practical drama frames that the teacher can develop for themselves, it gives a background and framework to build emotional intelligence in a child and generate a culture of openness to learning in the classroom. This introduction to emotional intelligence will be of great interest to all primary school teachers looking to further understanding of pupils social and emotional development through learning.
Bringing the Froebel Approach to Your Early Years Practice Helen Tovey, Roehampton University, UK Series: Bringing ... to your Early Years Practice Bringing a Froebelian Approach to your Early Years Setting looks at the founder of the kindergarten and his profound influence on provision and practice for young children today. The Froebelian approach is not a method but includes distinctive principles which shape and guide practice. This book includes:
Routledge «Market: Education / PHSE January 2011: 246x174: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-56943-9: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56946-0: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83316-2: £75.00/14
Introducing Bruner A Guide for Practitioners and Students in Early Years Education Sandra Smidt, Freelance Educational Consultant, UK This book takes the reader on a journey through some of Bruner’s key concepts in relation to early learning and teaching. It makes explicit the links between these concepts and discusses each one in a way which makes sometimes-difficult ideas accessible to all readers. Topics explored in this accessible companion include: early language acquisition; intersubjectivity: how infants come to ‘read’ the minds of others; play and the importance of narrative; links to Reggio Emilia; and scaffolding and agency: the influence of Vygotsky.
• a discussion of key Froebelian principles such as play, imagination, creativity, learning through self activity and making connections • an examination of block play and how this can be used in contemporary settings • Froebel’s ideas on nature and outdoor play and why these are fundamental to young children’s learning • examples of innovative practice and ideas for further reflection. This convenient guide will help Early Years practitioners, students and parents to really understand what the Froebelian approach can offer their setting and children. Routledge «Market: Early Years February 2011: 210x148: 112pp Hb: 978-0-415-56730-5: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56731-2: £12.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
This fascinating insight in to the life and work of a key figure in Early Years Education is essential reading for anyone concerned with the learning and development of young children, especially those concerned with the impact of society, community, culture and interaction. Routledge «Market: Education / Early Years February 2011: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-57420-4: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57421-1: £17.99/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Early Childhood Education / Creativity March 2011: 234x156: 232pp Hb: 978-0-415-56562-2: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56563-9: £24.99/04
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
early years & childhood studies 51 3rd Edition
2nd Edition
Planning an Appropriate Curriculum in the Early Years
Behaviour in the Early Years *
A Guide for Students, Teachers and Assistants
Angela Glenn, Early Years Consultant, UK, Jacquie Cousins, L and J Training and Consultancy, UK and Alicia Helps, Educational Psychologist, UK
Rosemary Roger, Early Year’s Consultant and Trainer, UK
Series: Tried and Tested Strategies
This book provides a comprehensive guide for early years practitioners and students on how to plan and implement an appropriate curriculum for the under fives. It examines the key roles and responsibilities of practitioners working in early years settings and those with responsibility for leading and managing provision for EYFS in primary schools. Fully completely revised and updated in line with the Early Foundation Stage and the latest research evidence this third edition covers all aspects of the curriculum. With case studies of good practice and questions for reflective practice and group work, Planning an Appropriate Curriculum for the Under Fives will be welcomed by students and practitioners looking to provide high quality learning experiences for the under fives. Routledge «Market: Education / Early Years February 2011: 246x174: 216pp Hb: 978-0-415-58303-9: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58304-6: £21.99/04
Behaviour in the Early Years provides hands-on tried and tested strategies to help you respond instantly and effectively to behaviour problems. This second edition has been updated and revised to include additional guidance on managing the outdoor environment, communicating with parents, the transition from home to nursery and safeguarding children. Features include: • helpful explanations of responsibilities in relation to the Code of Practice and SENDA • photocopiable record sheets • social and emotional development checklists • a wide range of case studies to illustrate how strategies work in practice. This book is essential reading for practitioners in all early years settings looking for effective ways to deal with challenging behaviour.
Parallel Learning of Reading and Writing in Early Childhood
Routledge «Market: Education / Early Years December 2010: 297x210: 80pp Pb: 978-0-415-58435-7: £17.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83506-7: £17.99/14 Prev. Ed: 978-1-8431-2104-6
Mary Shea, Canisius College, USA Parallel Learning of Reading and Writing in Early Childhood explores why it’s important to provide a balanced language learning environment for young children and offers approaches for children to practice and explore language. Through analysis of writing samples, research, and principles of best practices, Shea outlines the essential ingredients and a developmentally appropriate approach for early language learning. Throughout the chapters, Shea integrates discussion of assessment, classroom environment, instructional/ teacher scaffolding, and differentiating instruction across developmental levels along with the supporting theory. Special features include the following and more: vignettes and descriptions of Pre-K, K, and Grade 1 classrooms, artifacts of children’s writing, and a companion website with lesson ideas and abundant writing samples from a wide range of demographic, cultural, and language contexts for readers to view, analyze, and discuss.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Education May 2011: 254x178: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-88298-9: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88299-6: £18.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-84118-1: £90.00/10
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
52 teaching and learning
35 Strategies for Guiding Readers Bridging the Transition from through Informational Texts * Primary to Secondary School Barbara Moss and Virginia S. Loh, both at San Diego State University, USA
Edited by Alan Howe and Val Richards, both at Bath Spa University, UK
’The strategies work because the authors help teachers understand the ‘what,’ ‘when,’ ‘how,’ and ‘why’ of strategy use in today’s multidimensional classrooms. That is why this book will make a decided difference in the professional lives of teachers. Moss and Loh have ‘hit one out of the park’ with this book.’ – Richard T. Vacca, Kent State University, USA
Guilford Press «Market: Literacy October 2010: : 176pp Pb: 978-1-60623-926-1: £16.00/01
2nd Edition
A Teaching Assistant’s Guide to Child Development and Psychology in the Classroom Susan Bentham, Bognor Regis Community College, UK This accessible text, provides informative, down-to-earth commentary with clear examples of how to apply the knowledge in everyday practice. Topics include:
• managing social and emotional changes • issues of changing self-identity • the continuity of pedagogy and curriculum • using ICT for a common approach • health issues in early adolescence • physical education and self-esteem • international perspectives on school transition. With a wealth of guidance on the educational and social needs of children in transition, this book is essential reading for all undergraduate and postgraduate education students. Routledge «Market: Education / Primary-Secondary Transitions February 2011: 246x174: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-57546-1: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57547-8: £21.99/04
2nd Edition
Athletics Challenges A Resource Pack for Teaching Athletics Kevin Morgan, University of Wales, UK ’Without hesitation I can state that this is the best received resource material in our programme and our physical education students enthuse about their capacity to take the ideas from the resource and transfer them into successful and effective physical education lessons.’ – John Sproule, University of Edinburgh, UK
• how to support learning • how to identify and cater for different learning styles • teaching children with additional needs • how to manage behaviour to support learning • how to help children with their self-esteem and independence. This new edition includes references to up-to-date research in child development and psychology, lively case studies, questions for selfassessment and a handy appendix mapping the content of the book against the National Occupational Standards for Teaching Assistants (2007). This is an invaluable companion for every Teaching Assistant and others working in a supporting role in education. Routledge «Market: Educational Psychology / Teaching Assistants January 2011: 216x138: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-56922-4: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56923-1: £18.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-31108-3
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Athletics Challenges is a practical kit of ready-to-use resources designed to support a motivating and inclusive approach to track and field athletics in schools and sports clubs. Containing over 100 ready-to-use photocopiable activities covering all the track and field events, this complete kit is an essential resource for all student and practising physical education teachers, heads of departments, as well as training and practising professional sports coaches. Routledge «Market: Physical Education March 2011: 297x210: 192pp Pack: 978-0-415-58442-5: £45.00/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
This practical guide presents inspiring, research-based activities for teaching students in grades K-12 how to read and think critically about informational texts. With five essential types of strategies, seasoned and preservice teachers learn ways to help students select engaging, challenging reading materials; develop their knowledge of history, science, and other content areas; master vocabulary that aids understanding; build essential comprehension skills across the curriculum; and write effectively about texts they have read.
The transition from primary to secondary school can be a difficult time for children, and managing the transition smoothly has proved problematic for teachers. Mind the Gap offers an insight into children’s development during this period, building a framework for delivering appropriate and relevant educational experiences. Structured around the five ‘transitionbridges’ recommended by the Rose Review of Primary Education, chapters cover:
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
teaching and learning 53
Becoming a Teacher Researcher Case Studies in Language in Literacy Teaching and Learning Curriculum Design Strategies and Tools for the Inquiry Process
Concepts and Approaches in Action Around the World
Edited by Christine C. Pappas, University of Illinois at Chicago, USA and Eli Tucker-Raymond, Chèche Konnen Center at TERC
Edited by I.S.P. Nation and John Macalister, both at Victoria University of Wellington, New Zealand
Practical, engaging, and informed by current thinking on teacher research, this text provides background information on teacher research; covers the ‘how-to’ strategies of the teacher research process from the initial proposal to writing up the report as publishable or presentable work; illustrates a range of literacy topics and grade levels; features 12 reports by teacher researchers who have gone through the process; and helps teachers understand how knowledge is constructed socially in their classrooms so that they can create instructional communities that promote all students’ learning.
Series: ESL & Applied Linguistics Professional Series
Addressing the importance of teacher research for better instruction, reform, and political action, this text emphasizes strategies teachers can use to support and strengthen their voices as they dialogue with others in the educational community, so that their ideas and perspectives may have an impact on educational practice both locally in their schools and districts and more broadly. Routledge «Market: Education March 2011: 254x178: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-99620-4: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-99621-1: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83609-5: £80.00/14
Children’s Literature in the Classroom * Engaging Lifelong Readers Diane M. Barone, University of Nevada, Reno, USA
Case studies are a powerful pedagogical tool for illuminating constructs and models in real-life contexts. Covering a wide range of teaching-learning contexts and offering in-depth analyses of ESL/ELT language curriculum design issues, this casebook is distinctive and unique in that each case draws on and is clearly linked to a single model of presented in Nation and Macalister’s Language Curriculum Design (www.routledge.com/9780415806060). This gives the book a high degree of coherence. Each case is followed a short commentary by the editors highlighting features of note and/ or issues arising from it. The book is designed to work as a companion to Language Curriculum Design (adding meaning and depth to the model presented there by relating it to a range of applications), as a stand-alone text, or as a resource for professionals in the field. Routledge «Market: Education March 2011: 229x152: 216pp Hb: 978-0-415-88231-6: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88232-3: £25.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-84785-5: £95.00
Coaching Emotional Intelligence in the Classroom * A Practical Guide for 7–14 Steve Bowkett, Educational Consultant, UK and Simon Percival, Independent Coaching Consultant UK
Series: Solving Problems in the Teaching of Literacy
çè
Guilford Press «Market: Literacy November 2010: 254x178: 242pp Hb: 978-1-60623-939-1: £34.00/01 Pb: 978-1-60623-938-4: £19.00/01
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Coaching Emotional Intelligence in the Classroom is a practical resource to help Key Stage 2 and Key Stage 3 teachers fully explore and understand the range of ‘emotional intelligences’ they may experience in the classroom. With links to SEAL, PLTS and Every Child Matters agendas, activities, coaching methods and schemes of work are suggested throughout to help pupils become independent, creative and effective learners able to generate ideas, solve problems and arrive at reasoned decisions. Providing the necessary tools to help pupils build life and people skills which will extend beyond school and into adulthood, this book will be of interest to all practising teachers, teaching assistants and school counsellors working with young people. Routledge «Market: Education December 2010: 246x174: 144pp Hb: 978-0-415-57779-3: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57780-9: £19.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83337-7: £80.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Many reading programs today overlook an essential component of literacy instruction – helping children develop an enduring love of reading. This authoritative and accessible guide provides a wealth of ideas for incorporating high-quality children’s books of all kinds into K-6 classrooms. Numerous practical strategies are presented for engaging students with picture books, fiction, nonfiction, and nontraditional texts. Lively descriptions of recommended books and activities are interspersed with invaluable tips for fitting authentic reading experiences into the busy school day. Every chapter concludes with reflection questions and suggestions for further reading. The volume also features reproducible worksheets and forms.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
54 teaching and learning
Cross-Curricular Teaching and Learning in the Secondary School... Mathematics *
Cross-Curricular Teaching and Learning in the Secondary School… The Arts *
Robert Ward-Penny, University of Warwick, UK
Drama, Visual Art, Music and Design
Series: Cross-Curricular Teaching and Learning in...
Martin Fautley and Jonathan Savage, Manchester Metropolitan University, UK
Cross-curricular approaches have much to offer the modern mathematics classroom. They can help teachers to present mathematics as a growing, relevant discipline that is central to much of modern life, and help learners to make sense of what they are doing and why. New contexts, new technology and new qualifications all make this an exciting time to be a cross-curricular teacher of mathematics. Part of the Cross-Curricular Teaching and Learning in the Secondary School series, this book is essential reading for all students on Initial Teacher Training courses and practising teachers looking to holistically introduce cross-curricular themes and practices into their mathematics teaching. Routledge «Market: Secondary Education / Mathematics December 2010: 246x174: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-57203-3: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57204-0: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83563-0: £80.00/14
2nd Edition
Developing Physical Health and Well-being through Gymnastic Activity (5–7) *
Series: Cross-Curricular Teaching and Learning in... This new indispensable text book brings together ongoing debates about personalised learning, creativity and ICT in education, with a cross-curricular focus, and establishes a principled framework for cross-curricular teaching and learning in the arts. Examining case studies from a range of innovative secondary schools, and interrogating the use of crosscurricular approaches in UK schools, Cross Curricular Teaching and Learning in the Arts constructs a research based pedagogy with practical steps for students and teachers as they consider how cross-curricular approaches can be implemented in their own subject areas. International projects and case studies are also considered in relation to cross curricular themes. Language and ICT are discussed as mediating tools, and the principle benefits of cross-curricular teaching for pupils’ learning are assessed. Routledge «Market: Secondary Education / Arts December 2010: 246x174: 184pp Hb: 978-0-415-55044-4: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-55045-1: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83490-9: £80.00/14
A Session-by-Session Approach
Developmental Cognitive Science Goes to School *
Maggie Carroll and Jackie Hannay, both at University of Brighton, UK
Edited by Nancy L. Stein and Stephen Raudenbush, both at The University of Chicago, USA
This easy-to-use teacher’s guide adopts a session-by-session approach to teaching physical and motor skill development and health and well-being through gymnastics for the 5–7 age range. Fully updated with the most current schemes of work to use at Key Stage 1, it sets out a series of sessions over the three year span, ensuring progression from year to year. It has been updated to incorporate the latest developments of the EYFS, the National Curriculum and the QCDA Programmes of Study and provides teachers with the latest thinking in this very important area of their work.
This book addresses core issues related to school learning and the use of developmental/cognitive science models to improve school-based instruction. The contributors comprise a veritable ‘who’s who’ of leading researchers in developmental psychology, cognitive science, economics, sociology, statistics, and physical science, and who are using basic learning theories from their respective disciplines to create better learning environments in school settings. This is a must-read volume for all researchers, students, and professionals interested in evidence-based practices and issues related to domain-specific teaching and learning.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Routledge «Market: Education January 2011: 229x152: 384pp Hb: 978-0-415-98883-4: £100.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-98884-1: £35.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83753-5: £100.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Education December 2010: 246x189: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-59107-2: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59106-5: £19.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83663-7: £75.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-7507-0007-8
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
teaching and learning 55
Drama Sessions for Primary Schools and Drama Clubs Ages 5–11 Alison Day, Director of Drama Vision, UK Drama Sessions for Primary Schools and Drama Clubs is a pick up and go weekly drama session manual with guided time allocations and explanations as to what these exercises should achieve with the children. As well as the 33 sessions themselves this resource also includes: • curriculum links • troubleshooting tips • notes on ‘performance’ • health and safety • extra sessions for use in smaller spaces • explanations of the pedagogical benefits of every exercise. Clubs play a crucial part in meeting the requirements of the extended services programme and this guide is a unique and practical resource that every primary school should have, providing a fool-proof blue-print to running a successful and fun drama club for all pupils. Routledge «Market: Education / Drama March 2011: 297x210: 96pp Pb: 978-0-415-60338-6: £24.99/04
Doing History Investigating With Children in Elementary and Middle Schools Linda S. Levstik, University of Kentucky, USA and Keith C. Barton, Indiana University, USA Now in its fourth edition, this popular text offers a unique perspective on teaching and learning history in the elementary and middle grades. Through case studies of teachers and students in diverse classrooms and from diverse backgrounds, it shows children engaging in authentic historical investigations, often in the context of an integrated social studies curriculum. The authors begin with the assumption that children can engage in valid forms of historical inquiry-collecting and analyzing data, examining the perspectives of people in the past, considering multiple interpretations, and creating evidence-based historical accounts. In each chapter, the authors explain how the teaching demonstrated in the vignettes reflects basic principles of contemporary learning theory; thus they not only provide specific examples of successful activities, but place them in a theoretical context that allows teachers to adapt and apply them in a wide variety of settings.
Edited by Rob Toplis, Brunel University, UK How Science Works provides student and practising teachers with a comprehensive introduction to one of the most dramatic changes to the secondary science curriculum. With chapters structured around three key themes – why How Science Works, what it is and how to teach it – expert contributors explore issues including the need for curriculum change, arguments for scientific literacy for all, school students’ views about science, what we understand about scientific methods, types of scientific enquiry, and, importantly, effective pedagogies and their implications for practice. How Science Works is a source of guidance for all student, new and experienced teachers of secondary science, interested in investigating how the curriculum can provide creativity and engagement for all school students. Routledge «Market: Education / Secondary Science December 2010: 246x174: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-56279-9: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56280-5: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83826-6: £75.00/14
@
How to Teach Poetry Writing: Workshops for Ages 5–9 * Michaela Morgan, Poet, Children’s Author and Writer, UK Series: Writers’ Workshop Now in a fully revised and extended second edition, How to Teach Poetry Writing: Workshops for Ages 5–9 is a practical, activity based resource of poetry writing workshops for teachers of primary age children. Each workshop provides enjoyable activities for pupils aimed at building a thorough understanding of what poetry is and how to write it. Aiming to encourage speaking and listening skills, this book includes: • three new workshops – Feelings, Licensed to Thrill and The Jumblies • redrafting and revising activities • poetry writing frames • traditional and contemporary poems from varied cultures • children’s’ own poems on their favourite subjects • guidance on how to write poems • word games and notes on performing poetry • an A-Z Guide to Poetry. Routledge «Market: Primary Education / Literacy December 2010: 297x210: 96pp Pb: 978-0-415-59013-6: £19.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83368-1: £40.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-1-8534-6918-3
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Education November 2010: 279x216: 272pp Pb: 978-0-415-87301-7: £30.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83493-0: £30.99/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8058-5072-7
for e-mail updates in your field
Exploring effective pedagogy and practice
2nd Edition
4th Edition textbook
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
How Science Works *
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
56 teaching and learning
Improving Learning through the Lifecourse *
Improving Research through User Engagement *
Learning Lives
Mark Rickinson and Anne Edwards, both at University of Oxford, UK and Judy Sebba, University of Sussex, UK
Series: Improving Learning Lifelong learning has become a mantra, but what does learning mean and do in the lives of adults? How has it changed over time and across generations? What are the connections with the changing worlds of work, the family and communities? What difference does it make to life chances? How do we learn from life, and how do we learn for life? How can people’s prospects of learning be improved? Incorporating data from one of the largest and most ambitious research projects into lifelong learning in recent years, this book offers an invaluable step towards answering these important questions. Together the authors collected over three years of information, tracking the lives of over 120 adults from across Britain and undertaking 528 in-depth interviews, asking people about their life histories and the place of learning in their lives. Routledge «Market: Education / Lifelong Learning January 2011: 216x138: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-57372-6: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57373-3: £22.99/04
2nd Edition
ICT for Teaching Assistants John Galloway, and Hilary Norton, both at London Borough of Tower Hamlets The role of ICT in enhancing both teaching and learning in classrooms continues to develop, no more so than when in the hands of effective practitioners. This book outlines the many ways in which it can be used, both as a subject, and as a tool to support learning across the curriculum. This second edition has been fully updated to take into account the recent changes in the Primary and Secondary National Curricula, developments in ICT and the revised National Occupational Standards. With links throughout to the National Occupational Standards for Teaching Assistants at Levels 2 and 3, this accessible and easy-to-use book is essential for teaching assistants who wish to develop their confidence in ICT. Routledge «Market: Education / Teaching Assistants March 2011: 246x189: 160pp Hb: 978-0-415-58306-0: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58307-7: £19.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-1-8431-2203-6
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Series: Improving Learning User engagement has become a key part of discussions about the nature and purpose of social science research. In this book the authors provide an authoritative overview of recent theoretical and practical developments relating to working with users at different stages in the processes of research. The book draws primarily on issues, examples and frameworks that have arisen specifically within educational research. The implications of different forms of user engagement for the design of educational research are explored in detail. By examining the researcher-user interface and evaluating inputs from academics, practitioners, policy-makers and those involved in the mediation of research evidence the book gives a new synthesis that will provide a coherent way forward for research collaborations in the future. Routledge «Market: Education / Research Merthods January 2011: 216x138: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-46168-9: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-46169-6: £21.99/04
Instructional Strategies for Middle and Secondary Social Studies Methods, Assessment, and Classroom Management Bruce E. Larson and Timothy A. Keiper, both at Western Washington University, USA Written explicitly for pre-service social studies teachers, this exciting methodsbased text integrates an in-depth look at seven distinct teaching strategies with appropriate management and assessment techniques. Special features include clear, step-by-step descriptions of the seven strategies, practical ways to manage the learning environment and assess student learning for each of the strategies, and rich, detailed and social studies-specific examples. Also included are guidelines for deciding how each strategy might allow for diverse learners and clear and concrete guidelines for setting course goals and objectives as well as writing unit plans and lesson plans. For any aspiring social studies teacher who wants to make the most informed decisions about day-to-day instructional strategies, the unique integration and contextualization of curriculum, instruction, assessment, and classroom management that this textbook offers will make this an invaluable resource. Routledge «Market: Education April 2011: 229x152: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-87705-3: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87706-0: £29.99/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Gert Biesta and John Field, both at University of Stirling, UK, Ivor F. Goodson, University of Brighton, UK, Phil Hodkinson and Flora J. Macleod
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
teaching and learning 57
Intelligence and Intelligence Testing John Hattie, University of Auckland, New Zealand and Richard B Fletcher, Massey University, New Zealand Have you ever wondered what IQ is and how it is measured? Indeed, why is there such a premium placed on high IQ? What do we mean by intelligence? What is your IQ? What does your IQ score mean? Chapters include coverage of: • intelligence and schooling • cultural differences in views of intelligence • the history of IQ testing • IQ as predictor of educational and occupational outcomes • psychometrics and measurement of intelligence • the future of intelligence research. Written in a clear and accessible style, this textbook will be invaluable for all undergraduate and Masters level students studying the theory of intelligence and the impact of testing on educational and other outcomes. Detailed and annotated further reading lists and a glossary of terms are also included.
Mathematics Teacher Noticing Seeing Through Teachers’ Eyes Edited by Miriam Sherin, Northwestern University, USA, Vicki Jacobs and Randy Philipp, both at CRMSE, USA Series: Studies in Mathematical Thinking and Learning Series Mathematics Teacher Noticing is the first book to examine research in this remarkable new topic. In the midst of all that is happening in a classroom, where do mathematics teachers look, what do they see, and what sense do they make of it? This book explores issues related to teacher noticing in four main sections. The first introductory section provides an overview of the construct of noticing and how it is addressed in each of the chapters. The second section focuses on the historical, theoretical, and methodological perspectives on teacher noticing. The third section focuses on studies of mathematics teacher noticing in the context of teaching and learning. The concluding section highlights the consequential nature of noticing and suggests links to other constructs integral to teaching. By collecting the work of leaders in the field of noticing in one volume, the authors present the current state of research and provide ideas for how future work could further the field.
Routledge «Market: Educational Psychology January 2011: 234x156: 144pp Hb: 978-0-415-60091-0: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-60092-7: £19.99/04
Routledge «Market: Education April 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-87862-3: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87863-0: £30.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83271-4: £90.00/14
Making Music in the Primary School *
Mentoring and Coaching in Schools
Whole Class Instrumental and Vocal Teaching
Collaborative Professional Learning Inquiry for Teachers
Edited by Nick Beach, Trinity College London, UK, Julie Evans, Canterbury Christ Church University, UK and Gary Spruce, Open University, UK
Suzanne Burley and Cathy Pomphrey, both at London Metropolitan University, UK
Making Music in the Primary School is an essential guide for all student and practising primary school teachers, instrumental teachers and community musicians involved in music with children. It explores teaching and learning music with the whole class and provides a framework for successful musical experiences with large groups of children. Illustrated throughout with carefully designed activities to try out in the classroom, the guidance in this book will help you support and develop children’s musical experience, whatever your musical or teaching background.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Routledge «Market: Education / Mentoring and Coaching February 2011: 246x174: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-56361-1: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56363-5: £22.99/04
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Education / Music December 2010: 246x189: 160pp Hb: 978-0-415-56129-7: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56130-3: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83457-2: £75.00/14
There is a growing emphasis on continuing professional development for those working in learning environments, and schools are taking increasing responsibility for the career development of teaching practitioners, often with little support. Coaching and Mentoring in the Secondary School provides guidance on developing coaching and mentoring relationships to help teachers with different levels of experience bring about changes in professional practice. Taking an enquiry-based approach, this book covers all aspects of mentoring and coaching, from building an initial relationship, to recording evidence in a Professional Learning Journal. Throughout the book, the focus on enquiry-based practice and action research is supported by a series of professional learning tasks. This book will be valuable reading for mentors in secondary schools, teachers undertaking continuing professional development and students on coaching and mentoring courses.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
58 teaching and learning
Psychology for the Classroom: E-Learning *
Research on Second Language Teacher Education
John Woollard, University of Southampton, UK
Edited by Karen E. Johnson, Pennsylvania State University, USA and Paula R. Golombek, University of Florida, USA
Series: Psychology for the Classroom
Series: ESL & Applied Linguistics Professional Series
Psychology for the Classroom: E-learning provides a lively and accessible introduction to the the developing nature of technologysupported teaching and learning and the educational psychology associated with those developments. The author provides a broad, unbiased and practical analysis of e-learning theory and practice, with a particular focus on the developing theories and practice of cybergogy as well as an interpretation of conventional theories of behaviourism, cognitivism and constructivism in the light of e-learning. Appealing to practising teachers and students alike, this book provides a valuable and practical guide to the theory and application of e-learning, and is applicable to all those responsible for providing effective teaching and learning.
Embracing a sociocultural perspective and employing an array of methodological tools for data collection and analysis, this volume documents the complexities of second language teachers’ professional development in diverse L2 teacher education programs around the world and traces that development both over time and within the broader cultural, historical and institutional settings and circumstances of teachers’ work. This systematic examination of teacher professional development illuminates the discursive practices that shape teachers’ knowing, thinking, and doing and provides a window into how alternative mediational means can create opportunities for teachers to move toward more theoretically and pedagogically sound instructional practices within the settings and circumstances of their work.
Routledge «Market: Educational Psychology February 2011: 234x156: 144pp Hb: 978-0-415-59092-1: £75.00/05 Pb: 978-0-415-59093-8: £18.99/04
Routledge «Market: Education / Second Language Teachers / Professional Development January 2011: 229x152: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-88332-0: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88333-7: £32.99/03 eBook: 978-0-203-84499-1: £95.00/03
2nd Edition
Teaching and Learning through Reflective Practice *
Teaching Economics in Troubled Times *
A Practical Guide for Positive Action Tony Ghaye, Reflective Learning, UK Now in its second edition, Teaching and Learning through Reflective Practice is a practical guide to enable all those involved in educational activities to learn through the practices of reflection. The book highlights the power that those responsible for teaching and learning have to appraise, understand and positively transform their teaching. Seeing the teacher as a reflective learner, the book emphasises a strengths-based approach in which positivity, resilience, optimism and high performance can help invigorate teaching, enhance learning and allow the teacher to reach their full potential. This approach busts the myth that reflection on problems and deficits is the only way to better performance. This book will be a must have for undergraduate and PGCE students on initial teacher training programmes. It will also interest practising teachers, teacher educators and those on continuing professional development courses.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Edited by Mark C. Schug, University of Wisconsin-Milwaukee, USA and William C. Wood, James Madison University, USA This book is a one-stop collection that helps pre- and in-service social studies teachers to foster an understanding of classic content as well as recent economic developments. Part I offers clear and teachable overviews of the nature of today’s complex economic crisis. Part II provides both detailed best practices for teaching economics in the social studies classroom and frameworks for teaching economics within different contexts. Part III concludes with effective strategies for teaching at the elementary and secondary school levels based on current research on economic education. From advice on what every economics teacher should know, to tips for best education practices, to investigations into what research tells us about teaching economics, this collection provides a wealth of contextual background and teaching ideas for today’s economics and social studies educators. Routledge «Market: Education January 2011: 229x152: 232pp Hb: 978-0-415-87771-8: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87772-5: £23.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83887-7: £95.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Primary Education / Reflective Practice December 2010: 246x174: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-57096-1: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57095-4: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83332-2: £24.99/14 Prev. Ed: 978-1-8534-6548-2
Theory and Practice for Secondary Social Studies
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
teaching and learning 59
Teaching Grammar in Second Language Classrooms
Teaching Mathematics Creatively *
Integrating Form-Focused Instruction in Communicative Context
Linda Pound, Education Consultant, UK and Trisha Lee, Artistic Director of Make-Believe Arts, UK
Hossein Nassaji, University of Victoria, British Columbia, Canada and Sandra S. Fotos, Senshu University, Japan
Series: Learning to Teach in the Primary School Series
Series: ESL & Applied Linguistics Professional Series Recent SLA research recognizes the necessity of attention to grammar and demonstrates that form-focused instruction is especially effective when it is incorporated into a meaningful communicative context. Designed specifically for second-language teachers, this text identifies and explores the various options for integrating a focus on grammar and a focus on communication in classroom contexts and offers concrete examples of teaching activities for each option. Each chapter includes a description of the option, its theoretical and empirical background, examples of activities illustrating in a non-technical manner how it can be implemented in the classroom, questions for reflection, and a list of useful resources that teachers can consult for further information. Routledge «Market: Education January 2011: 229x152: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-80204-8: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-80205-5: £29.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85096-1: £95.00/03
Teaching in a Nutshell Navigating Your Teacher Education Program Clare Kosnik and Clive Beck, University of Toronto, Canada Designed to help student teachers develop an approach to teaching that is both theoretical and practical, this text focuses on key aspects of teaching rather than trying to ‘cover the waterfront.’ Based on extensive research, their own long experience as teacher educators, and other sources, the authors recommend 7 priorities for teaching and teacher education. Each chapter deals in turn with one of these priorities. This text is a companion to the authors’ 2009 book for teacher educators, Priorities in Teacher Education: The 7 Key Elements of Pre-Service Preparation. By making these priorities and related knowledge explicit, it helps student teachers gain essential knowledge and skills for the demanding work of teaching.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Routledge «Market: Education / Classroom Practice / Mathematics November 2010: 246x174: 168pp Hb: 978-0-415-57591-1: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57592-8: £19.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-84050-4: £75.00/14
Teaching Modern Foreign Languages in the Primary School Sally Maynard Teaching Modern Foreign Languages in the Primary School supports student and practising teachers – whether generalist or specialist – to have the confidence and skills to successfully incorporate modern foreign languages into teaching. Based on the author’s extensive experience of both teaching across Key Stage 1 and Key Stage 2 and delivering initial teacher education, this book provides comprehensive guidance on the essential theory and pedagogy that underpins language teaching, together with strategies and tools that can be easily implemented in the classroom. Illustrated with ideas for lessons and case studies of language teaching in practice, Teaching Modern Foreign Languages in the Primary School , is an essential, complete guide for all student and practising teachers in the primary school. Routledge «Market: Education February 2011: 246x174: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-55741-2: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-55742-9: £19.99/04
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge April 2011 Hb: 978-0-415-88806-6: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88807-3: £20.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83269-1: £95.00
Teaching Mathematics Creatively offers a range of strategies to enable trainee and practising teachers to take an innovative, playful and creative approach to mathematics teaching. It promotes creativity as a key element of practice and offers ideas to involve your students and let them develop knowledge, understanding and enjoyment of mathematics. Exploring fresh approaches to teaching mathematics, it explains the role of play in bringing the subject alive for children and teachers alike. This book identifies the power of storytelling in supporting mathematical thinking, examines cross-curricular teaching and preparation for teaching creatively. Teaching Mathematics Creatively includes a wealth of innovative ideas to enthuse teachers and enrich maths teaching. This book is an essential purchase for any professional who wishes to employ creative approaches to teaching in their classroom.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
60 teaching and learning
Teaching Secondary English as if the Planet Matters *
Teaching Science Creatively * Dan Davies, Bath Spa University, UK Series: Learning to Teach in the Primary School Series
Sasha Matthewman, University of Bristol, UK
Teaching Science Creatively contains everything teachers need to know about making science lessons fun, engaging and memorable. Key themes addressed include:
Series: Teaching... as if the Planet Matters The true worth of a school subject is revealed in how far it can account for and respond to the major issues of the time. Teaching English as if the Planet Matters provides detailed and practical advice on how English teachers can develop approaches to curriculum and learning which help students understand the nature of the contemporary world. The book looks at how English can be taught with a commitment to education for sustainable development drawing on ecocritical theory and classroom practice and offers inspiration for teaching English lessons with criticial environmental awareness.
• teachers’ and students’ attitudes towards science • the relationship between the nature of science, teacher’s pedagogy and children’s learning • theories of learning and young children’s creative development • play, schemas, science and how we treat children’s ideas • covering traditional topics in a creative way • investigating science with new technologies • using the outdoors creatively.
Routledge «Market: Education / Secondary English December 2010: 246x174: 200pp Hb: 978-0-415-56146-4: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-47204-3: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83453-4: £75.00/14
Under-pinned by theory and research, this book is an essential purchase for both trainee and practising Science teachers who want to develop their teaching. Routledge «Market: Education December 2010: 246x174: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-56131-0: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56132-7: £19.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83998-0: £75.00/14
Teaching Secondary Geography as if the Planet Matters *
Teaching the Arts to Engage English Language Learners
John Morgan Series: Teaching... as if the Planet Matters Teaching Geography as if the Planet Matters provides detailed and practical advice on how Geography teachers can develop approaches to curriculum and learning which help students understand the nature of the contemporary world. It allows teachers to examine existing approaches, and draw upon the insights of geography as a discipline to deepen students’ understanding of urban futures, climate change, ‘geographies of food’ and the ‘geographies of the credit crunch’. • examples of suggested teaching activities • detailed case studies • sources of further reading and information • chapter summaries • discussion questions. This book addresses issues of the environment cutting across subject boundaries with an interdisciplinary response. It will appeal to all those in a secondary context who wish to teach geography in a way which is current. Routledge «Market: Secondary Education / English March 2011: 246x189: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-56387-1: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56388-8: £21.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Series: Teaching English Language Learners across the Curriculum Written for prospective and practicing visual arts, music, drama, and dance educators, Teaching the Arts to Engage English Language Learners offers guidance for engaging ELLs, alongside all learners, through artistic thinking. By paying equal attention to visual art, music, drama, and dance education, this book articulates how arts classrooms can create rich and supportive contexts for ELLs to grow socially, academically, and personally. Special features include generative texts such as films, poems, and performances that function as springboards for arts educators to adapt according to the needs of their classroom; teaching tips, formative assessment practices, and related instructional tables and resources; an annotated list of internet sites, reader-friendly research articles, and instructional materials; and a glossary for readers’ reference. Routledge «Market: Education February 2011: 254x178: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-87385-7: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87386-4: £26.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83723-8: £95.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Features include:
Margaret Macintyre Latta and Elaine Chan, both at University of Nebraska-Lincoln, USA
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
teaching and learning 61
The Media Teacher’s Handbook * The Essential Guide to Edited by Elaine Scarratt and Jon Davison Online Course Design The Media Studies Teacher’s Handbook is an indispensible guide for all teachers delivering Media Studies and media education in school and college. Written by experts involved in the teaching, training and examination of media studies, chapters cover: • the key concepts and pedagogy underpinning media education • practical ways into teaching and learning the key media concepts • using the internet and computer games in the classroom • an introduction to the A Level and GCSE specifications • the 14-19 Creative & Media Diploma and vocational media courses • approaches to production and editing activities • taking your career further. This handbook is an essential guide to the theory, pedagogy, and practice of media education that will help ensure all trainee and practising teachers can deliver the curriculum with confidence.
A Standards-Based Approach
Marjorie Vai, Freelance Consultant and Writer, USA and Kristen Sosulski, New York University, USA In spite of the proliferation of online learning in higher education, creating online courses can still evoke a good deal of frustration, negativity, and wariness in those who need to create them. The Essential Guide to Online Course Design takes a fresh, thoughtfully designed, step-by-step approach to online course development. At its core is a set of standards that are based on best practices in the field of online learning and teaching. Pedagogical, organizational and visual design principles are presented and modeled throughout the book and users will quickly learn from the guide’s hands-on approach. The course design process begins with the elements of a classroom syllabus which, after a series of guided steps, easily evolve into an online course outline.
Routledge «Market: Education March 2011: 246x174: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-49993-4: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-49994-1: £22.99/04
Routledge «Market: Education February 2011: 254x178: 160pp Hb: 978-0-415-87299-7: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87300-0: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83831-0: £95.00/14
2nd Edition
2nd Edition
Teaching with Emotional Intelligence
The Effective Teacher’s Guide *
A Step-by-Step Guide for Higher and Further Education Professionals Alan Mortiboys, University of Central England, UK The way emotions are handled by the individual and by others is central to the success of learning. Teaching with Emotional Intelligence shows how to manage this influential but neglected area of learning. Taking the reader step by step through the learning process and looking at the relationship from the perspectives of both the teacher and the learner, this book will help the reader to: plan the emotional environment; learn how to relate to learners; listen to learners effectively; read and respond to the feelings of individuals and groups; develop self-awareness as a teacher; recognize prejudices and preferences in oneself; and improve non-verbal communication. Featuring lots of activities, checklists and points for deeper reflection, the guidance in this book will help teachers encourage their learners to become more engaged, creative and motivated.
@
This popular guide offers a wealth of innovative, research-based strategies for making K-12 classrooms the best learning environments they can be. Easy-toimplement best practices are presented for establishing a classroom management plan, organizing procedures and materials, building a respectful community, fostering peer collaboration, and engaging students in interactive learning. Each of the 50 strategies includes step-by-step instructions, the amount of time needed to implement, and the recommended grade level. In a large-size format for easy photocopying, the book features ready-to-use reproducibles. New to this edition: • strategies for using technology to promote interactive learning • explains a gradual release-of-responsibility model of instruction to support self-motivated learning • additional topics: vocabulary development, enhancing writing skills, and building peer partnerships.
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
for e-mail updates in your field
Nancy Frey, San Diego State University, USA
Guilford Press «Market: Literacy November 2010: : 160pp Pb: 978-1-60623-971-1: £16.00/01 Prev. Ed: 978-1-60623-428-0
Routledge «Market: Education / Training March 2011: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-57138-8: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57140-1: £23.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-35088-4
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
50 Ways to Engage Students and Promote Interactive Learning
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
62 teaching and learning
What Does Understanding Science Learning and Instruction Advantage of Technology Mathematics Mean for Teachers? Taking to Promote Knowledge Integration Relationship as a Metaphor for Knowing
Marcia C. Linn and Bat-Sheva Eylon
Yuichi Handa, California State University, Chico
Describing advances in understanding the nature of science learning and their implications for the design of science instruction, this book shows how design patterns, design principles, and professional development opportunities coalesce to create and sustain effective instruction in each primary scientific domain. Calling for deeper coverage of science topics in order to accomplish knowledge integration, it highlights the importance of designing the instructional materials, the examples that are used in them, and the professional development that accompanies these materials. It argues that all these efforts must be made simultaneously for science learning outcomes to improve. The book also addresses how many policies, including curriculum, standards, guidelines, and standardized tests, work against the goal of integrative understanding, and discusses opportunities to rethink science education policies based on research findings from instruction emphasizing such understanding.
Series: Studies in Curriculum Theory Series In French, to know in the savoir sense is to know things, facts, names, how and why things work, and so on, whereas to know in the connaître sense is to know a person, a place, or even a thing – namely, an other – in such a way that one is familiar with, or in relationship with this other. In mathematics education the focus tends to be on how learners and teachers know mathematics in the savoir sense. Primarily through phenomenological reflection with a touch of empirical input, this book fleshes out an image for what a person’s connaître knowing of mathematics might mean, turning to mathematics teachers and teacher educators to help clarify this image. It opens up alternative ways of thinking and talking about ways in which a person can ‘know’ a subject, leading to a reconsideration of what it may mean to be a teacher of that subject. Routledge «Market: Education March 2011: 229x152: 168pp Hb: 978-0-415-88597-3: £95.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83743-6: £95.00/14
Routledge «Market: Education May 2011: 229x152 Hb: 978-0-8058-6054-2: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-8058-6055-9: £26.99/04 eBook: 978-1-4106-1508-4: £85.00/03
Cultural Validity in Assessment
2nd Edition
Addressing Linguistic and Cultural Diversity
Cultures of Curriculum
Edited by Maria del Rosario Basterra, Mid-Atlantic Equity Consortium, Inc., USA, Elise Trumbull, Education Consultant and Guillermo Solano-Flores, University of Colorado, Boulder, USA
Edited by Pamela Bolotin Joseph, University of Washington – Bothell, USA
Series: Language, Culture, and Teaching Series
Series: Studies in Curriculum Theory Series
What is assessment and how is it a cultural practice? How does failure to account for linguistic and cultural variation among students jeopardize assessment validity? What is required to achieve cultural validity in assessment? This resource for practicing and prospective teachers – as well as others concerned with fair and valid assessment – provides a thorough grounding in relevant theory, research, and practice. The book lays out criteria for culturally valid assessment and recommends specific strategies that teachers can use to design and implement culturally valid classroom assessments. Assessment plays a powerful role in the process of education in the U.S. and has a disproportionately negative impact on students who do not come from mainstream, middle-class backgrounds. Given the significance of testing in education today, cultural validity in assessment is an urgent issue facing educators. This book is essential reading for addressing this important, relevant topic.
Using ‘cultures of curriculum’ as a lens, this clear, compelling text reveals and critically examines the belief systems and classroom practices of curricular orientations in contemporary American society. It is designed to foster awareness, examination, and deliberation about the curricula planned for and carried out in classrooms and schools; to inspire conversations about theory and practice as well as political, social, and moral issues; and to expand critical consciousness about approaches to curriculum and practice. Readers are encouraged to give serious attention to the issues this book raises for them, and to join with their colleagues, students, and communities in considering how to create curricula with purpose and congruent practices and to reculture classrooms and schools. A framework of inquiry is presented to facilitate such reflection and to accomplish these goals.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Routledge «Market: Education January 2011: 229x152: 336pp Hb: 978-0-415-99186-5: £100.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-99187-2: £35.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83727-6: £100.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Education January 2011: 229x152: 336pp Pb: 978-0-415-99980-9: £32.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85095-4: £95.00/03
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
teaching and learning 63
Literacy, Power, and the Schooled Body
Teaching the Literature of Today’s Middle East
Learning in Time and Space
Allen Webb, Western Michigan University, USA
Kerryn Dixon, University of Witwatersrand, South Africa
Introducing the literature of today’s Middle East and showing teachers how to make it authentic, powerful, and relevant to students, this book: brings to the reader a wide diversity of teachable texts by Middle Eastern writers; takes a thematic approach that allows students to understand and engage with the region and address key issues; includes stories from the author’s own classroom and shares student insight and reactions; utilizes contemporary teaching methods, including cultural studies, lit circles, blogs, YouTube, class speakers, and film analysis; and directly and powerfully models how to address controversial issues in the region.
What effects do space and time have on classroom management, discipline, and regulation? How do teachers’ practices create schooled and literate students? To explore these questions, this book looks at early childhood classrooms, charting the shifts and continuities as 4 year old children begin preschool and move through to the end of primary school at 9 years. The literacy classroom is used as a specific site in which to examine how children’s bodies are disciplined to become literate. Working from a Foucaultian premise that discipline is directed onto children’s bodies, this book moves from theory to practice. Photographs, transcripts, interviews, and children’s work show how teachers’ practices are enacted on children’s bodies, offering teachers examples from which to think about their own classroom practice, and to reflect on what works, why it works, and what can be changed. Routledge «Market: Education October 2010: 229x152: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-87962-0: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87963-7: £23.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85148-7: £95.00/14
The Reflexive Teacher Educator in TESOL Roots and Wings Julian Edge, University of Manchester, UK In this book Julian Edge explores the construct of reflexivity in teacher education, differentiating it from, while locating it in, reflective practice. Augmenting the field in important ways, The Reflexive Teacher Educator in TESOL: develops the concept of praxis as it resolves the usual theory/ practice dichotomy of teacher education; introduces a framework (Copying, Applying, Theorising, Reflecting, Acting) that allows present and prospective teacher educators to become reflexive individuals; and uses a narrative, autobiographical voice that explicates the concepts involved, while also offering practical methodological procedures for teacher education. Written with clarity and style, scholarly yet personal, dealing with reflexivity in an accessible yet non-trivial way, this book – a first in the field, distinctive in terms of what the story is and how it is told – is a gift to the profession of TESOL teacher education.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Routledge «Market: Education June 2011: 229x152: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-87437-3: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87438-0: £27.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83255-4: £95.00/14
Teacher Preparation for Bilingual Student Populations Educar para Transformar Edited by Belinda Bustos Flores, University of Texas at San Antonio, USA, Rosa Hernández Sheets, Texas Tech University, USA and Ellen Riojas Clark, University of Texas at San Antonio, USA The growing number of bilingual students in public schools coupled with a critical shortage of teachers specially prepared to serve this population calls for a critical examination of policies and practices in bilingual and ESL teacher preparation. This volume focuses on understanding the structural, substantive, and contextual elements of preparation programs, and provides transformative guidelines for creating Educar signature programs. Designed to improve the practice of teacher preparation by promoting dialogic conversations and applications of praxis in the preparation of bilingual/ESL teacher candidates, it emphasizes that exemplary teacher preparation requires transformative teacher educators. Simultaneously organizing the scholarship in the field and advancing new understandings, this book is must-have resource for current and future teacher educators. Routledge «Market: Education January 2011: 229x152: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-87739-8: £100.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87740-4: £35.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85097-8: £100.00/03
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Education January 2011: 229x152: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-88250-7: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88251-4: £24.99/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83289-9: £95.00/14
This theoretically informed and academically smart text, highly relevant across the field of literacy education, offers teachers a much needed resource for helping students to think deeply and critically about the politics and culture of the Middle East through literary engagements.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
64 special needs
The SENCO Survival Guide *
The Irregular School *
The Nuts and Bolts of Everything You Need to Know
Exclusion, Schooling and Inclusive Education
Sylvia Edwards, SEN Support Services, East Riding of Yorkshire, UK
Roger Slee, University of London, UK
Series: David Fulton / Nasen
The Irregular School explores the foundations of the current controversies and argues that continuing to think in terms of the regular school or the special school obstructs progress towards inclusive education. This book contends that we need to build a better understanding of exclusion, of the foundations of the division between special and regular education and of school reform as a precondition for more inclusive schooling in the future. Schooling ought to be an apprenticeship in democracy and inclusion is a prerequisite of a democratic education. Written by a leading scholar in the field, The Irregular School builds on existing research and literature to argue for a comprehensive understanding of exclusion, a more innovative and aggressive conception of inclusive education and a genuine commitment to school reform that steps aside from the troubled and troubling notions of regular schools and special schools.
• explore recent initiatives and terminology in the context of the ‘Inclusion Development Programme’ and ‘Narrowing the Gap’ • examine the implications for school policy and practice • link together related SEN/LDD development • help schools to develop co-ordinated systems that enable all learners with SEN/LDD to meet their potential and aspirations. Routledge «Market: Education / Special Educational Needs December 2010: 234x156: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-59280-2: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59281-9: £17.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83406-0: £65.00/14
6th Edition textbook
Commonsense Methods for Children with Special Educational Needs * Peter Westwood, University of Macau, Macau This book provides teachers with an immediate and comprehensive source of practical strategies for meeting children’s special needs in regular classrooms. This fully revised and updated fifth edition includes expanded chapters on:
Routledge «Market: Special / Inclusive Education December 2010: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-47989-9: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-47990-5: £24.99/04
What’s the Buzz? Games and Activities to Improve Social Skills: A 16-lesson Plan for Primary Schools Mark Le Messurier, Education Consultant, Australia and Madhavi Nawana Parker Some children and young adolescents find it much harder to learn and flexibly use social skills. What’s the Buzz? is an easy-to-implement, 16 lesson play-based social skills training program that will improve student confidence, relationships and reduce conflict. Written for teachers who support children and adolescents who may struggle with life for a variety of reasons, this book will help them to:
• learning difficulties • effective instruction • behaviour management • self-regulation
• expand their socialisation skills
• the teaching of literacy and numeracy skills • differentiation across the curriculum. In addition, the book includes new chapters on the learning characteristics and specific needs of students with intellectual, physical or sensory disabilities. In all cases the practical advice the author gives is embedded within a clear theoretical context supported by current research and classroom practice. Routledge «Market: Education / Special Educational Needs December 2010: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-58376-3: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58375-6: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83664-4: £75.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-41582-8
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
• understand their feelings and develop an emotional resiliency • learn ‘how-to’ read the feelings of others • value positive thinking • participate in play-based activities and games. Designed for use in schools, What’s the Buzz? is an essential resource for teachers, school counsellors, special needs co-ordinators, teaching assistants, parents and allied health professionals. Routledge «Market: Education / Inclusion and SEN / SEAL January 2011: 297x210: 132pp Pb: 978-0-415-58382-4: £22.99/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
This book is intended for SENCOs and other staff, working from the Foundation stage to Key Stage 4 with management responsibility for SEN/LDD systems in schools. The book will:
Series: Foundations and Futures of Education
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
special needs 65 2nd Edition
2nd Edition
The Effective Teacher’s Guide to Behavioural and Emotional Disorders *
The Effective Teacher’s Guide to Sensory and Physical Impairments *
Disruptive Behaviour Disorders, Anxiety Disorders and Depressive Disorders, and Attention Deficit Hyperactivity Disorder
Sensory, Orthopaedic, Motor and Health Impairments, and Traumatic Brain Injury
Michael Farrell, Independent Education Consultant, UK
Series: The Effective Teacher’s Guides
Series: The Effective Teacher’s Guides
Fully updated with the latest research and advice on best practice, this new edition covers a range of conditions that cause learning difficulties for children, including epilepsy, Tourette syndrome and PraderWilli syndrome, and much greater detail than before on a range of physical and sensory disabilities. Writing in his popular accessible style, Michael Farrell suggests the best ways of dealing with a variety of conditions, always with practical classroom situations in mind. In each section, the book: Sets out the definitions of the condition Explains the legal contexts Looks at the range of provision Suggests intervention and support strategies Gives example case studies, points for reflection and suggested further reading
Fully updated with the latest research and advice on best practice, this new edition covers a range of conditions, including disruptive behaviour, anxiety and depressive disorders. The theoretical underpinning is fully updated but also condensed in this edition to make way for more practical strategies for teachers. Writing in his popular accessible style, Michael Farrell suggests the best ways of dealing with a variety of conditions. In each section, the book: • sets out the definitions of the condition • explains the legal contexts • looks at the range of provision • suggests intervention and support strategies • gives example case studies, points for reflection and suggested further reading. Highly accessible and authoritative, this book provides teachers with an invaluable resource to help you create a truly inclusive classroom. Routledge «Market: Education / Inclusion and Special Needs December 2010: 216x138: 128pp Hb: 978-0-415-56569-1: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56568-4: £18.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83435-0: £70.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-36038-8
Michael Farrell, Independent Education Consultant, UK
Highly accessible and authoritative, this book provides teachers with an invaluable resource to help you create a truly inclusive classroom. Routledge «Market: Education / Inclusion and Special Needs December 2010: 216x138: 144pp Hb: 978-0-415-56567-7: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56565-3: £18.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83431-2: £70.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-36042-5
International Case Studies of Dyslexia Edited by Peggy L. Anderson, Metropolitan State College of Denver, USA and Regine Meier-Hedde Series: Routledge Research in Education Dyslexia is a disability that exists in all countries that have high expectations for literacy. The inability to read in spite of normal intellectual potential represents one of the most puzzling educational challenges for literate societies, regardless of the culture or language. This book examines medical, psychological, educational, and sociological data from comprehensive case studies of preteen dyslexic children, in order to profile the disability as it occurs in eighteen different nations. Interviews with the children and their parents reveal how children with dyslexia are identified and treated around the world, and provide a look at various perceptions of dyslexia and its challenges. Researchers and health practitioners will find this casebook to be an excellent tool for understanding the condition from an international perspective.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Education April 2011: 229x152: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-88437-2: £75.00/08
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
66 post-compulsory & higher education
Higher Education Law
Developing Cultural Capability in International Higher Education *
Policy and Perspectives Klinton Alexander, Vanderbilt University, USA and Kern Alexander, University of Illinois at Urbana, USA
A Narrative Inquiry
Higher Education Law is a comprehensive and accessible guide to the law of higher education. Drawing from real-life cases on United States campuses, the authors equip readers with the tools and knowledge to effectively respond in an environment of increasing litigation. Addressing a clear gap in the literature currently available, this text provides: an explanation of the point of law, case examples, rules of law, case notes, and ‘context setting.’ This innovative approach weaves law into its historical, political and sociological context, and is designed to help students and professors better understand the law as it applies to colleges and universities. It also provides higher education administrators in student affairs, development, philanthropy, and financial affairs with clear guidance on the legal responsibilities of their respective offices. Routledge «Market: Education January 2011: 254x178: 816pp Hb: 978-0-415-80030-3: £100.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-80031-0: £64.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-84694-0: £100.00/14
Routledge «Market: Higher Education December 2010: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-57238-5: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57239-2: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83400-8: £75.00/14
Developing Inquiry for Learning
Mark A. Kretovics, Kent State University, USA Business Practices in Higher Education is a breakthrough guide offering higher education and student affairs professionals an understanding of the fundamental business nature of colleges and universities. The author discusses the practical applications of business concepts and models and how these applications can contribute to the overall efficiency and effectiveness of higher education institutions. Useful examples from a wide range of institutions, including small privates, large publics and community colleges, illustrate these concepts. Business practices pervade the academic, student affairs, and administrative sides of higher education. This book affords readers a greater understanding of the true nature of higher education and an appreciation for how the academy effectively incorporates business practices into everyday work lives.
Reflection, Collaboration and Assessment in Higher Education Peter Ovens, University of Cumbria, UK, Frances Wells, Patricia Wallis and Cyndy Hawkins, both at Nottingham Trent University, UK Inquiry for Learning shows how university tutors can help students to improve their abilities to learn and to become professional inquirers. Participation in higher education is widening and students have increasingly diverse needs and learning styles and many bring powerful expectations that learning tends to be a passive process. University tutors required to teach ever larger groups are finding increasing difficulty to meet these needs and help people to become more independently motivated and more collaborative learners. In the innovative and proven approach developed by the authors however, students are guided to perform action research into their learning practices, actions and reflections. Routledge «Market: Educational Research March 2011: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-59876-7: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59877-4: £24.99/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
( +44 (0)1235 400524
• learning, teaching and assessment as a cultural product of higher educationPersonal and professional interactions between staff and students
• methodological and ethical considerations when conducting research across cultures.
A Guide for Today’s Administrators
order now!
To function in the diverse world of the 21st century requires a crucial ability to navigate its international and interconnected environments effectively. Such a skill may be defined as cultural capability and developing it is at the forefront of this book, as it guides readers in considering their own experiences of learning and teaching in culturally varied contexts of higher education. Using information that builds upon data gained from several years of practice, across a range of countries and institutions the author considers in detail four main themes:
• the political and personal dimensions of the internationalisation of higher education
Business Practices in Higher Education
Routledge «Market: Education February 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-87401-4: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87402-1: £32.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83862-4: £95.00/14
Sheila Trahar, University of Bristol, UK
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
post-compulsory & higher education 67
Innovations in Lifelong Learning * Managing the Critical Perspectives on Diversity, Entrepreneurial University Participation and Vocational Learning Edited by Sue Jackson, University of London, UK This book opens up ways to engage critically with what counts as innovatory practice in lifelong learning today, locating its discussion of innovations in lifelong learning within an international and comparative framework. Innovations in Lifelong Learning engages first hand with issues and concerns from around the globe, offering an international perspective on current trends through its range of contributions from across the UK, Australia, New Zealand and the US. The broad focus allows for diverse information on the nature of these changes to come together under an assortment of empirical, theoretical and methodological approaches. Routledge «Market: Education & Lifelong Learning December 2010: 234x156: 264pp Hb: 978-0-415-54878-6: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-54879-3: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83395-7: £75.00/14
Masculinities in Higher Education Theoretical and Practical Considerations Edited by Jason Laker, Queen’s University, Canada and Tracy Davis, Western Illinois University, USA Masculinities in Higher Education provides empirical evidence, theoretical support, and developmental interventions for educators working with college men both in and out of the classroom. The critical philosophical perspective of the text challenges the status-quo and offers theoretically sound educational strategies to successfully promote men’s learning and development. Contesting dominant discourses and binary notions of privilege and oppression, contributors examine the development and identity of men in higher education today. This edited collection analyzes the nuances and intersections of lived identities, the ways that individuals participate in co-constructing identities, and how these identities influence culture. Practical advice and resources for student development professionals are offered through a theory-to-practice focus.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
J. Douglas Toma, University of Georgia, USA An appropriate text for administrators and future higher education professionals who are studying Higher Education law, Managing the Entrepreneurial University considers the range of legal issues relevant to managing the contemporary American university, college, and community college. It explores the trends, issues and legal difficulties that face entrepreneurial institutions and provides thoughtful strategies toward preventing or mitigating legal challenges. Readers will find that it explains, in clear, non-technical language, the basic concepts of higher education law, grounding them in contemporary challenges in higher education management, particularly those associated across institution types with increased interaction with external markets. Routledge «Market: Education March 2011: 254x178: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-87242-3: £100.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87245-4: £27.99/04
Rethinking Widening Participation in Higher Education The Role of Social Networks Edited by Alison Fuller, Brenda Johnston and Sue Heath, all at University of Southampton, UK Extending higher education to people from diverse backgrounds and widening participation is a current international priority. This study, based on empirical data, is the first of its kind examining why people choose not to enter higher education. Using interview data from the standpoint of adult decision making across the life-course, conclusions are drawn about the social dimensions of educational participation. Building a comprehensive assessment of the historical, personal and collective, network-based aspects of participation decisions, the contributors: • provide conceptual frameworks for understanding network-based decision-making • research socially embedded narratives of ‘ordinary people’ • discuss the policy and practice implications of network-based approaches to widening participation. Appealing to all those studying higher education and participation, this book is a valuable contribution to understanding how people make decisions about higher education. Routledge «Market: Higher Education February 2011: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-57563-8: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57564-5: £22.99/04
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Education April 2011: 229x152: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-87463-2: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87464-9: £29.95/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83305-6: £80.00/14
Legal Issues and Commercial Realities
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
68 post-compulsory & higher education
Towards Fairer University Assessment *
The Fundamentals of Workplace Learning *
Recognizing the Concerns of Students
Understanding How People Learn in Working Life
Nerilee R.A. Flint and Bruce Johnson, both at University of South Australia, Australia
Knud Illeris, Danish University of Education, Denmark A comprehensive guide to how people learn in the workplace, and the issues and challenges involved. Examining the essential aspects of workplace learning and unravelling the various influences which affect the success of work-based learners, Knud Illeris presents a holistic model to explain how diverse individuals can be encouraged and invited to learn at work. Approaching workplace learning from the perspective of learners with social and psychological needs, this book examines key issues, including:
This book is about a long ignored determinant of student satisfaction, concerning the perception of how fairly students are judged, marked, ranked and rewarded for demonstrating their capabilities at university. In the high stakes competitive field of higher education, students are increasingly positioned as customers whose views on their university experience are considered vitally important. Yet paradoxically, little research has been undertaken to find out more about how students decide whether they have been treated fairly and what they do about it. This book fills a major gap in our understanding of these issues. In doing so, this book goes beyond the superficial consideration of university assessment as a ‘necessary requirement’ by unravelling the underlying issues that really count – what is considered fair assessment and what is not.
• the workplace environment as a learning space • Work vs. Learning • models of workplace learning • levels of support • interaction between formal and informal environments • challenges presented by specific groups.
Routledge «Market: Education / Assessment December 2010: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-57812-7: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57813-4: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83670-5: £75.00/14
Presenting suggestions for successful workplace learning and possibilities for the future, this book will appeal to everyone involved in improving learning in the workplace. Routledge «Market: Post Compulsory Education December 2010: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-57906-3: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57907-0: £22.99/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83652-1: £80.00/14
2nd Edition
E-Learning in the 21st Century A Framework for Research and Practice D. Randy Garrison, University of Calgary, Canada The second edition of E-Learning in the 21st Century provides a coherent, comprehensive, and empirically-based framework for understanding e-learning in higher education. Garrison draws on his decades of experience and extensive research in the field to explore the technological, pedagogical, and organizational implications of e-learning. Most importantly, he provides practical models that educators can use to realize the full potential of e-learning. This book is unique in that it focuses less on the long list ever-evolving technologies and more on the search for an understanding of these technologies from an educational perspective. This edition has been fully revised and updated throughout and includes discussions of social media and mobile learning applications as well as other emerging technologies in today’s classrooms. This book is an invaluable resource for courses on e-learning in higher education as well as for researchers, practitioners and senior administrators.
Universities and Global Diversity Preparing Educators for Tomorrow Edited by Beverly Lindsay, Pennsylvania State University, USA and Wanda J. Blanchett, UMKC School of Education, USA Series: Routledge Research in Education This volume seeks to critically examine the nexus between globalization and diversity as it affects the preparation of professional educators on several continents, taking into account the extensive changes in economic, sociopolitical, and cultural dynamics within nations and regions that have occurred in the last decade. Routledge «Market: Education February 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-88287-3: £70.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83969-0: £70.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Education May 2010: 229x152: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-88582-9: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88583-6: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83876-1: £95.00/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
research methods 69
Research Methods in Education Louis Cohen, Loughborough University, UK, Lawrence Manion and Keith Morrison, Macau University of Science and Technology, Macau This rewritten, expanded and updated 7th edition of the long-running bestseller Research Methods in Education encompasses the whole range of methods currently employed by educational research at all stages. It offers plentiful and rich practical advice, underpinned by clear theoretical foundations, research evidence and up-to-date references. Research Methods in Education is essential reading for both the professional researcher and students of education at undergraduate and postgraduate level, who need to understand how to plan, conduct, analyse and use research.
çè
Routledge «Market: Education / Research Methods March 2011: 246x189: 768pp Hb: 978-0-415-58335-0: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58336-7: £28.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-36878-0
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Research in Applied Linguistics Becoming a Discerning Consumer Fred L. Perry, Jr., American University in Cairo, Egypt Newly updated and revised, this popular text provides a solid introduction to the foundations of research methods, with the goal of enabling students and professionals in the field of applied linguistics to become not just casual consumers of research who passively read a research article, but discerning consumers able to effectively use published research for practical purposes in educational settings. All issues important for understanding and using published research for these purposes are covered. Key principles are illustrated with research studies published in refereed journals across a wide spectrum of applied linguistics. Exercises throughout encourage readers to engage interactively with what they are reading at the point when the information is fresh in their minds. Designed for MATESOL/TEFL and applied linguistics programs, this text provides a strong framework in which to promote student interaction and discussion on important issues in research methodology Routledge «Market: Education April 2011: 229x152: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-88570-6: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88571-3: £29.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83902-7: £95.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
7th Edition textbook
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
etically conceptualise
UK’s TLRP, this book brings to examine the assumptions eaching and learning practices. to extend opportunity by ntexts, including schools,
Beyond the School Gates
Changing Schools
Questioning the Extended Schools and Full Service Agendas
Alternative Approaches to Make a World of Difference
Alan Dyson, University of Manchester, UK, Liz Todd, University of Newcastle Upon Tyne, UK and Colleen Cummings, University of Newcastle, UK
Edited by Robert Lingard, University of Queensland, Australia, Pat Thomson, University of Nottingham, UK and Terry Wrigley
BEYOND THE SCHOOL GATES QUESTIONING THE EXTENDED SCHOOLS AND FULL SERvICE AGENDAS
on at the Stirling Institute of
Technology in the Open ogy, UK.
EDITED BY RICHARD EDWARDS GERT BIESTA AND MARY THORPE
he Stirling Institute of isiting Professor at Örebro den.
ALAN DYSON LIZ TODD AND COLLEEN CUMMINGS
This book is essential reading for anyone interested in the role of full service and extended schools – those offering new services to students, families and communities beyond regular school hours. The authors draw on their extensive international evaluations of this radical new phenomenon to ask: • What do extended or full service schools hope to achieve, and why should services based on schools be any more effective than services operating from other community bases?
This book presents new thinking and practice for progressing school change CHANGING today, drawn from the works of authors SCHOOLS ALTERNATIVE APPROACHES around the world. Educational policyTO MAKE AWORLD OF DIFFERENCE making has been dominated by particular human capital oriented theories of school improvement, formulated and implemented in neo-liberal political environments. This book seeks to challenge this dominance. It draws both on contemporary innovations in practice and theory and long standing traditions of alternative thinking and practice. Linking together and articulating other ways of conceiving of and implementing school change, it bases its findings on values of equality and global citizenship. It shows how schools can work to make different knowledges, languages, narratives, truths and ways of being integral to mainstream curriculum, pedagogy, assessment and school cultures and structures. EDITED BY ROBERT LINGARD PAT THOMSON AND TERRY WRIGLEY
• What pattern of services and activities is most effective? • What does extended schooling mean for children and families who are not highly disadvantaged, or for schools outside the most disadvantaged areas? • How can schools lead extended services at the same time as doing their ‘day job’ of teaching children?
Routledge «Market: Education Policy & Politics May 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-55859-4: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-55860-0: £22.99/04
Routledge «Market: Education / School Effectiveness January 2011: 234x156: 168pp Hb: 978-0-415-54866-3: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-54875-5: £22.99/04
3rd Edition
2nd Edition
Academic Writing
An Introduction to Critical Discourse Analysis in Education
A Handbook for International Students Stephen Bailey, University of Nottingham, UK Most international students need to write essays and reports for exams and coursework. Yet writing good academic English is one of the most demanding tasks students face. This new edition of Academic Writing has been fully revised to help students reach this goal. Clearly organised, the course explains the writing process from start to finish. Each stage of the writing process is demonstrated and practised, from selecting suitable sources, reading, note-making and planning through to re-writing and proofreading. The four main parts of Academic Writing allow teachers and students to find the help they need with all writing tasks easily. Each part is divided into short sections which contain examples, explanations and exercises, for use in the classroom or self-study. All international students wanting to maximise their academic potential will find this practical and easy-touse book a valuable guide. Routledge «Market: Study Guides / Writing Skills January 2011: 246x189: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-59580-3: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59581-0: £19.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-38420-9
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Edited by Rebecca Rogers, University of Missouri – St. Louis, USA Accessible yet theoretically rich, this landmark text introduces key concepts and issues in critical discourse analysis and situates these within the field of educational research. The book invites readers to consider the theories and methods of three major traditions in critical discourse studies – discourse analysis, critical discourse analysis and multimodal discourse analysis – through the empirical work of leading scholars in the field. Beyond providing a useful overview, it contextualizes CDA in a wide range of learning environments and identifies how CDA can shed new insights on learning and social change. Detailed analytic procedures are included. Routledge «Market: Education March 2011: 229x152: 352pp Hb: 978-0-415-87428-1: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87429-8: £27.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83614-9: £85.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8058-4818-2
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
? f learners for learning? erent learning contexts? tively mobilise learning across
RETHINKING CONTEXTS FOR LEARNING AND TEACHING
fewide, what specifically sultant consequences for fic contexts? Drawing upon ng Contexts for Learning nt means of understanding contexts, the issues they and research. It specifically
70 education theory
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
education theory 71
Critical Curriculum Leadership
Debates in English Teaching
A Framework for Progressive Education
Edited by Jon Davison, Caroline Daly, University of London, UK and John Moss, Canterbury Christ Church University, UK
Rose M. Ylimaki, University of Arizona, USA Critical Curriculum Leadership is an examination of curriculum leadership in the wake of US testing mandates and school reforms, all of which seem to support a particular set of conservative ideologies. Drawing from the author’s longitudinal ethnographic study and from existing literature and research in the field, Ylimaki explores the formation of curriculum leadership in relation to broader cultural and political shifts. She shows how traditional leadership frameworks have come up short, and makes the case for an alternative leadership theory at the intersection of educational leadership and curriculum studies. She provides analytical tools that inspire progressive education and offers critical theories, strategies, research examples, problem-posing cases, and research ideas essential for curriculum leadership in the present conservative era. Routledge «Market: Education February 2011: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-87621-6: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87622-3: £27.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83505-0: £95.00/14
Series: Debates in Subjects Teaching Debates in English Teaching encourages student and practising teachers to engage with and reflect on key topics, concepts and debates in subject teaching. Specially commissioned, up-to-date, comprehensive chapters support busy student and practising teachers as they develop their awareness of key issues. Coverage includes: • attitudes to correctness in grammar and standard English • functional English; media and new technologies • the nature and importance of world Englishes • social class and education achievement • positive connections between citizenship and English. A much-needed source of knowledge, experience and debate, Debates in English Teaching will be essential reading for all students studying at Masters Level and Education Studies students considering subject teaching in depth. Routledge «Market: Education December 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-56915-6: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56916-3: £22.99/04
3rd Edition
Chicano School Failure and Success Debates in History Teaching Past, Present, and Future
Edited by Ian Davies, University of York, UK
Edited by Richard R. Valencia, The University of Texas, Austin, USA
Series: Debates in Subjects Teaching
Richly informative and accessibly written, Chicano School Failure and Success, Third Edition includes completely revised and updated chapters that incorporate recent scholarship and research on the current realities of the Chicano school experience. Committed to understanding the plight and improvement of schooling for Chicanos, this timely new edition addresses all the latest issues in Chicano education and will be a valued resource for students, educators, researchers, policy makers, and community activists alike.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Routledge «Market: Education December 2010: 234x156: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-57161-6: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57162-3: £22.99/04
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Educational Leadership January 2011: 254x178: 384pp Hb: 978-0-415-88060-2: £100.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88061-9: £35.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83598-2: £100.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-25774-9
Debates in History Teaching encourages teachers to engage with and reflect on key issues, concepts and debates in their subject. It supports you in reaching your own informed judgements, enabling you to discuss and argue your point of view with deeper theoretical knowledge and understanding. Experts in the field consider the subject and its definition, perennial and new debates in the subject, the knowledge required to teach in the classroom, the philosophy of education and the subject, and the case for the subject in the curriculum. Issues are tackled comprehensively and in-depth, from several angles, through debate and counterarguments, providing a critical examination and a variety of perspectives on each chapter. Carefully annotated further reading and reflective questions in each chapter can be used as a starting point for research assignments and essays at Masters Level.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
72 education theory
Debates in Religious Education Teaching
Designing Better Schools for Culturally and Linguistically Diverse Children
Edited by Philip Barnes, King’s College London, UK Series: Debates in Subjects Teaching
A Science of Performance Model for Research
Debates in Religious Education encourages student and practising teachers to engage with and reflect on key topics, concepts and debates in subject teaching. It aims to enable teachers to reach their own informed judgements and argue their point of view with deeper theoretical knowledge and understanding. Taking account of recent controversy, and challenging assumptions about the place of religion in education, expert contributors cover key topics such as: effective pedagogy in RE teaching; exploring thinking skills and truth claims; the relationship of science and religion in the classroom; the place of school worship in contemporary society; the role of RE in spiritual and moral development; and diversity in the RE classroom.
Stuart McNaughton, University of Auckland, New Zealand How can schools be better designed to enable equitable academic outcomes for culturally and linguistically diverse children – the children from communities who are not economically, politically and socially powerful? This book focuses on the research evidence about how to make schools more effective and the role of educational research. It uses the research evidence which supports both pessimistic and optimistic views of what schools can achieve to lay out a robust model of school change. The ‘science of performance’ model is based on a specified process of research and development in local contexts and is built on assumptions about both teachers (problem solvers and adaptive experts) and teaching, as well as about research. It proposes processes required by researchers collaborating with schools to meet a set of rigorous criteria for judging effectiveness, including concepts of accelerated achievement patterns and matched distributions of achievement.
Debates in Religious Education is for all student teachers, and practising teachers engaged in CPD. Routledge «Market: Education May 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-58392-3: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58391-6: £22.99/04
Routledge «Market: Education May 2011: 229x152: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-88659-8: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88660-4: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83582-1: £95.00/14
2nd Edition
Doing Multicultural Education for Achievement and Equity Carl A. Grant, University of Wisconsin-Madison, USA and Christine E. Sleeter, California State University, Montery Bay, USA This is a hands-on, reader-friendly multicultural education textbook that aims to actively engage education students in critical reflection and self examination as they prepare to teach in increasingly diverse classrooms. As it promotes an understanding of the history of and need for multicultural education in US schools, Carl Grant and Christine Sleeter’s book connects multicultural education to pre-service teachers’ personal and professional spaces and, further, to an understanding of equity in school and society.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Edited by Christine Rubie-Davies, University of Auckland, New Zealand Educational Psychology: Concepts, Research and Challenges brings together the latest research across many areas of educational psychology, introducing and reporting on the most effective methodologies for studying teachers and learners and providing overviews of current debates within the field. This book is a must-read for academics, researchers, undergraduate and graduate students who recognize the substantial contribution of educational psychology to increasing our understanding of students and their learning, teachers and their teaching. Routledge «Market: Educational Psychology November 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-56263-8: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56264-5: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83888-4: £80.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Selected Contents: 1. Becoming a Fantastic Teacher 2. Students and Achievement 3. The Quest for Equity in School and Society 4. Building a Caring Classroom that Supports Achievement 5. Using Students’ Assets to Facilitate High Achievement 6. Developing Curriculum that is Multicultural 7. Testing and Assessment 8. Taking Action in the Classroom and Beyond Routledge «Market: Education / Sociology of Education April 2011: 254x178: 280pp Hb: 978-0-415-88056-5: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88057-2: £27.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-95184-5
Educational Psychology: Concepts, Research and Challenges *
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
education theory 73
Engendering Curriculum History Petra Hendry, Louisiana State University, USA Series: Studies in Curriculum Theory Series How can curriculum history be re-envisioned from a feminist, poststructuralist perspective? This book disrupts dominant notions of history as linear, as inevitable progress, and as embedded in the individual. Rejecting a compensatory approach which leaves dominant historical categories and periodization intact, Hendry examines how the narrative structures of curriculum histories are implicated in the construction of gendered subjects. Five central chapters take up a particular discourse (wisdom, the body, colonization, progressivism and pragmatism) to excavate the subject identities made possible across time and space. Curriculum history is understood as an emergent, not a finished process as an unending dialogue that creates spaces for conversation in which multiple, conflicting, paradoxical and contradictory interpretations can be generated as a means to stimulate more questions, not grand narratives. Routledge «Market: Education May 2011: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-88566-9: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88567-6: £32.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83900-3: £95.00/14
Epistemology and Science Education Understanding the Evolution vs. Intelligent Design Controversy Edited by Roger Taylor, Vanderbilt University, USA and Michel Ferrari, University of Toronto, Canada How is epistemology related to the issue of teaching science and evolution in the schools? This book explores core epistemological differences between proponents of Intelligent Design and evolutionary scientists, as well as the critical role of epistemological beliefs in learning science. Preeminent scholars empirical research and/or make a theoretical contribution, with a particular emphasis on the controversy over whether Intelligent Design deserves to be considered a science alongside Darwinian Evolution. This pioneering book coordinates and provides a complete picture of the intersections in the study of evolution, epistemology, and science education, in order to allow a deeper understanding of the Intelligent Design vs. evolution controversy. This is a very timely book for teachers and policymakers wrestling with issues of how to teach biology and evolution within a cultural context where Intelligent Design has been and is likely to remain a challenge for the foreseeable future. Routledge «Market: Education January 2011: 229x152: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-96379-4: £100.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-96380-0: £29.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83963-8: £100.00/14
Ethnography and Language Policy Handbook of Adolescent Edited by Teresa L. McCarty, Arizona State University, USA Transition Education Illuminating, through ethnographic inquiry,
Edited by Michael L. Wehmeyer, University of Kansas, USA and Kristine W. Webb, University of North Florida, USA
Routledge «Market: Education December 2010: 229x152: 336pp Hb: 978-0-415-80139-3: £100.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-80140-9: £35.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83606-4: £100.00/14
Routledge «Market: Education September 2011: 254x178: 600pp Hb: 978-0-415-87278-2: £185.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87279-9: £72.00/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83732-0: £185.00/14
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Transition from secondary education to adulthood represents a period during which adolescents with disabilities face multiple responsibilities and changing roles that include establishing independence, attending post-secondary education or training, developing social networks, choosing a career, participating in their communities, and managing healthcare and financial affairs. Sponsored by the Division of Career Development and Transition (DCDT) of the Council of Exceptional Children, this Handbook serves as a comprehensive resource for the communities of educators, related service and agency personnel, families, caretakers, counselors, and other stakeholders who facilitate these complex transitions to adulthood for adolescents with disabilities.
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
how individual agents ‘make’ language policy in everyday social practice, this volume advances the growing field of language planning and policy using a critical sociocultural approach. From this perspective, language policy is conceptualized not only as official acts and documents, but as language-regulating modes of human interaction, negotiation, and production mediated by relations of power. Using this conceptual framework, the volume addresses the impacts of globalization, diaspora, and transmigration on language practices and policies; language endangerment, revitalization, and maintenance; medium-of-instruction policies; literacy and biliteracy; language and ethnic/national identity; and the ethical tensions in conducting critical ethnographic language policy research. These issues are contextualized in case studies and reflective commentaries by leading scholars in the field.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
74 education theory
Handbook of Asian Education Edited by Yong Zhao, Michigan State University, USA and Jing Lei, Syracuse University, USA, Guofang Li, Michigan State University, USA, Ming Fang He, Georgia Southern University, USA, Kaori Okano, La Trobe University, Australia, Nagwa Megahed, Ain Shams University, Egypt, David Gamage, The University of Newcastle, Australia, Hema Ramanathan, University of West Georgia (Co-Editors) Comprehensive and authoritative, this Handbook provides a nuanced description and analysis of educational systems, practices, and policies in Asian countries and explains and interprets these practices from cultural, social, historical, and economical perspectives. Using a culture-based framework, the volume is organized in five sections, each devoted to educational practices in one civilization in Asia: Sinic, Japanese, Islamic, Buddhist, and Hindu. Culture and culture identities essentially are civilization identities; the major differences among civilizations are rooted in their different cultures. This framework offers a novel approach to capturing the essence of the diverse educational systems and practices in Asia. The Handbook of Asian Education is a must-have resource for education researchers, graduate students, and professionals in global and comparative education, sociocultural foundations of education, and Asian studies. Routledge «Market: Education January 2011: 254x178: 568pp Hb: 978-0-8058-6445-8: £190.00/03 Pb: 978-0-8058-6444-1: £84.99/04 eBook: 978-1-4106-1874-0: £190.00/03
Handbook of Research on Learning and Instruction Edited by Richard E. Mayer, University of California, Santa Barbara, USA and Patricia A. Alexander, University of Maryland, College Park, USA Series: Educational Psychology Handbook During the past twenty years researchers have made exciting progress in the science of learning (i.e., how people learn) and the science of instruction (i.e., how to help people learn). This handbook examines learning and instruction in a variety of classroom and non-classroom environments and with a variety of learners, both K-16 students and adult learners. The book is divided into two sections: learning and instruction. The learning section consists of chapters on how people learn in reading, writing, history, and mathematics, as well as learning to move effectively, think critically, learning to self-monitor, and learning with motivation. The instruction section consists of chapters on effective instructional methods – feedback, examples, self-explanation, peer interaction, cooperative learning, inquiry, discussion, tutoring, visualizations, and computer simulations. Routledge «Market: Education January 2011: 254x178: 560pp Hb: 978-0-415-80460-8: £160.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-80461-5: £85.00/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83908-9: £160.00/14
3rd Edition
Handbook of Research Handbook of Research in Second on Teaching the English Language Teaching and Learning Language Arts Edited by Eli Hinkel, Seattle University, USA Series: ESL & Applied Linguistics Professional Series This landmark volume provides a broadbased, comprehensive, state-of-the-art overview of current knowledge and research into second language teaching and learning. All authors are leading authorities in their areas of expertise. Fifty-seven chapters, all completely new for Volume II , are organized in 8 thematic sections. Volume II is an essential resource for researchers, faculty, teachers, and students in MA-TESL and applied linguistics programs, as well as curriculum and material developers. Routledge «Market: Education January 2011: 254x178: 1088pp Hb: 978-0-415-99871-0: £199.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-99872-7: £84.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83650-7: £199.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Co-Sponsored by the International Reading Association and the National Council of Teachers of English Edited by Diane Lapp and Doug Fisher, both at San Diego State University, USA Now in its third edition, the Handbook of Research on Teaching the English Language Arts offers an integrated perspective on the teaching of the English language arts and a comprehensive overview of research in the field. The Third Edition is restructured, updated, and includes many new contributors. More emphasis is given in this edition to the learner, multiple texts, learning, and sharing one’s knowledge. A Companion Website, new for this edition, includes among other features interactive tools, Powerpoints, and several videos. Routledge «Market: Education January 2011: 279x216: 448pp Hb: 978-0-415-87735-0: £160.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87736-7: £85.00/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83971-3: £160.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8058-4518-1
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Volume 2
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
education theory 75
Handbook of Self-Regulation of Learning and Performance
Knowledge That Counts in a Global Community
Edited by Barry J. Zimmerman, City University of New York, USA and Dale H. Schunk, University of North Carolina, Greensboro, USA
Exploring the Contribution of Integrated Curriculum
Series: Educational Psychology Handbook Self-regulated learning (or self-regulation) refers to the process whereby learners personally activate and sustain cognitions, affects, and behaviours that are systematically oriented toward the attainment of learning goals. Part of the impetus for studying academic self-regulation came from research showing that learners’ skills and abilities did not fully explain differences in student achievement. Research indicated that other factors such as self-regulation and motivation are also quite important. This is the first volume to integrate into a single volume all aspects of the field of self regulation of learning and performance: basic domains, applications to content areas, instructional issues, methodological issues, and individual differences.
Leonie Rennie, Curtin University, Australia, Grady Venville, University of Western Australia, Australia and John Wallace, University of Toronto, Canada As we move inexorably towards the second decade of this millennium, there is increasing urgency about questions relating to the process of schooling, the nature of its curricula and the consequences for student engagement, learning and future citizenship. This book explores the potential contribution of curriculum integration in a context where school curricula segregated by discipline remain the norm, despite the fact that most, if not all, of the world’s problems are interdisciplinary. If school education is to develop citizens who can at least understand the issues which presently challenge our political leaders, it can only be done by integrating at least some parts of current school curricula. Informed citizens, who can think broadly across disciplines, will be those who can contribute to sensible action for local problems with a global flow-on.
Routledge «Market: Education May 2011: 254x178: 576pp Hb: 978-0-415-87111-2: £185.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87112-9: £70.00/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83901-0: £185.00/14
Routledge «Market: Education / Policy and Politics January 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-57337-5: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57338-2: £23.99/04
Integrated Children’s Centres *
Learning Futures
Overcoming Barriers to Truly Integrated Services
Imagining the Educational World to Come
Carole Beaty, National College of School Leadership, UK
Keri Facer, Manchester Metropolitan University, UK
Integrated Children’s Centres looks at the way in which the Children’s Centre development has built upon research and experience of initiatives such as the HeadStart programme in America and the SureStart programme. It explores the component elements of truly integrative services and the key players in ensuring positive outcomes: families, the local authority, PCT, private and voluntary sectors, and faith groups. Key issues covered include:
Drawing on ten years of research into educational innovation, incorporating scientists, teachers, students, industry professionals and policy makers, this book challenges the often adopted notion of a single, linear educational future. Considering alternative strategies for conceptualising the future of education, Facer takes into account the challenges that future decades may face, including:
• the challenges faced by children’s centres
• socio-technical developments relevant to educators
• the effects of climate change on technologies
• tackling social issues through the medium of children’s centres • how to achieve effective multi-agency working.
• changing relationships between humans and machines
This highly topical book will be of interest to nursery and children’s centres managers and early years practitioners enrolled on the NPQICL or EYPS programmes, as well as students working towards a degree in Early Childhood Studies or MA in Early Years.
• ageing populations and intergenerational relationships
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
With international examples and utilising research undertaken by the author while running The UK’s FutureLab this book brings the future into focus. An important contribution to the debates surrounding educational futures, this book is compelling reading for all professionals involved in education. Routledge «Market: Higher Education April 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-58142-4: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58143-1: £19.99/04
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Education / Multi-Agency Approaches October 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-47914-1: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-47915-8: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-84702-2: £70.00/14
• the theoretical and practical knowledge needed.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
76 education theory
Schooling Internationally *
Researching Young Children’s Perspectives
Globalisation, Internationalisation and the Future for International Schools Edited by Richard Bates, Deakin University, Australia The emergence of international schools in significant numbers across the globe SCHOOLING demands analysis of their purposes, their INTERNATIONALLY GLOBALISATION, practices and outcomes, as well as an INTERNATIONALISATION AND THE FUTURE FOR examination of their connections to global, INTERNATIONAL SCHOOLS economic, social and cultural movements. This book sets out to provide a critical perspective on the current issues facing international schooling, particularly the conflict between ‘internationalising’ and ‘globalising’ tendencies and to explore these as they affect teachers, students, learning, curriculum, pedagogy and assessment as well as the contribution international schools might make to the achievement of global citizenship. The well-known international contributors to this book move beyond simply describing the issues, and instead suggest ways in which the complex and often contradictory tensions within the world of international schooling and its global contexts must be examined critically.
Debating the Ethics and Dilemmas of Educational Research with Children Edited by Deborah Harcourt, Australian Catholic University, Australia, Bob Perry, Charles Sturt University, Austalia and Tim Waller, Wolverhampton University, UK Researching Young Children’s Perspectives critically examines the challenges and complexities of rights based, participatory research with children. Rather than approaching these dilemmas as problematic issues, this book positions them as important topics for discussion and reflection. Each chapter poses points for consideration that will inform and challenge both the novice and experienced researcher, such as: • How ‘participatory’ can research be with infants under eighteen months?
RICHARD BATES
Routledge «Market: Comparative Education Research November 2010: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-58927-7: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58928-4: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83480-0: £80.00/14
• When should listening through observation stand alone? • What is the distinction between methodologies and methods? • How can all young children be assured of a voice in research? If you are a student at undergraduate level and above, this book will give you all the confidence you need to conduct your own high quality research with children. Routledge «Market: Education February 2011: 234x156: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-60490-1: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-60494-9: £22.99/04
2nd edition
Promoting Diversity and Social Justice
Rethinking Schools
Educating People from Privileged Groups Diane Goodman
Improved Educational Outcomes for All?
Series: Teaching/Learning Social Justice
Christopher Chapman, University of Manchester, UK
Promoting Diversity and Social Justice gives theory, perspectives, and strategies that are useful for working with adults from privileged groups on diversity and social justice issues. The revised edition offers educational and psychological perspectives to inform practice and increase options in addressing conflict situations. Features to this new edition include: a new chapter on ‘unlearning racism’ highlights specific ways people from privileged groups benefit from unlearning oppression and from creating greater equity; a new chapter on Allies and Action gives focus and guidance on how people from privileged groups can constructively be involved in social change efforts; and updated Appendix of additional resources.
Systems must continue to evolve in order to meet the needs of students and particularly those in the most challenging circumstances. In this book, Chris Chapman reflects on a range of Emerging Structural Arrangements (ESAs) that have begun to appear across a number of systems. The features of ESAs include: increased involvement of the private sector and other interested parties (including charities and faith groups); radical redesign of buildings; the blurring and erosion of organisational boundaries; redefinition of ‘teachers’ and ‘teaching’; and the involvement of an extended range of services stakeholders within the schooling process.
Routledge «Market: Education May 2011: 229x152: 270pp Hb: 978-0-415-87287-4: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87288-1: £22.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
This book represents a unique addition to the literature presenting new research in this emerging area of international importance. It will be of interest to all those with an interest in leadership, policy, school improvement and educational change. Routledge «Market: Educational Research February 2011: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-55848-8: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-55849-5: £22.99/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
This book is an excellent resource for group facilitators, counselors, teachers, community educators, and those involved with educating others about diversity and equity.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
education theory 77
Sourcebook of Experiential Education
Teacher Education Policy in the United States
Key Thinkers and Their Contributions
Perspectives and Controversy
Edited by Thomas E. Smith, Raccoon Institute, USA and Clifford E. Knapp, Northern Illinois University, USA, Emeritus
Edited by Penelope Earley, George Mason University, USA, David G. Imig, University of Maryland, USA and Nicholas M. Michelli, City University of New York, USA
This sourcebook provides a much-needed overview and foundations for the field of experiential education through portraits of philosophers, educators, and other practitioners in the field whose contributions exemplify a biographical and historical model for reaching a deeper understanding of experiential education. Following brief snapshots of John Dewey and Kurt Hahn, each chapter focuses on an individual whose work is relevant to understanding this philosophy and methodology for building knowledge, developing skills, and clarifying values by engaging learners in direct experience and focused reflection. An appendix includes short biographical sketches of 45 additional people whose contributions to experiential education deserve a closer look. Routledge «Market: Education January 2011: 254x178: 336pp Hb: 978-0-415-88441-9: £100.00/04 Pb: 978-0-415-88442-6: £39.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83898-3: £100.00/14
Strategic Management of Human Capital in Education Improving Instructional Practice and Student Learning in Schools
çè
Routledge «Market: Education April 2011: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-88665-9: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88666-6: £27.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83569-2: £90.00/14
@
3rd Edition
The Literate Classroom * Now in its third edition, The Literate Classroom offers essential information and advice from leading experts about the teaching of primary English to students, NQTs and less confident teachers of literacy. Presenting a range of refreshing and challenging viewpoints from experienced classroom practitioners, this book describes how the theory behind key areas of literacy teaching can be transformed into realistic learning experiences within the classroom. This accessible and informative collection is a must-have for all trainee and practising teachers, as well as Teaching Assistants and support workers, looking to enhance literacy learning in the primary classroom. Routledge «Market: Primary / Literacy December 2010: 246x174: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-58407-4: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58408-1: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83473-2: £80.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Strategic Management of Human Capital in Education offers a comprehensive and strategic approach to address what has become labeled as ‘talent and human capital.’ Grounded in extensive research and examples of leading edge districts, this book shows how the entire human resource system in schools – from recruitment, to selection/placement, induction, professional development, performance management and evaluation, compensation, and career progression – can be reformed and restructured to boost teacher and principal effectiveness in ways that dramatically improve instructional practice and student learning. Drawing from cases, experiences, and deliberations from a national task force, this book outlines a comprehensive framework for how to transform current human resource management practices into authentic, strategic talent management systems in order to improve student achievement.
for e-mail updates in your field
Routledge «Market: Education May 2011: 229x152: 280pp Hb: 978-0-415-88360-3: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88361-0: £35.99/03 eBook: 978-0-203-84359-8: £100.00/03
Edited by Prue Goodwin
Allan R. Odden, University of Wisconsin, Madison
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
Interest in teacher education policy is growing as educators and policy makers recognize the deep connection between excellent teaching and student achievement. Recent federal education policy is based on a very narrow definition of teacher quality, putting pressure on state agencies to change teacher licensure and program approval policies in response to federal mandates. This has led to tension over what constitutes a high quality teacher education program and what standards teacher candidates should meet before receiving their teaching credential. Against this backdrop, this book is designed to provide readers with deep understanding of the nature and sources of policy affecting the preparation of teachers and the conflicts or interconnections of these policies with the broader field of education policy.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
78 education theory
Sociocultural Dimensions of American Schoolbooks Edited by Eugene F. Provenzo, Jr., University of Miami, Annis Shaver, Cedarville University, USA and Manuel Bello, Miami-Dade Community College, USA The central assumption of The Textbook as Discourse is this: Interpreted in the flow of history, textbooks can provide important insights into the nature and meaning of a culture and the social and political discourses in which it is engaged. This book is about the social, political and cultural content of elementary and secondary textbooks in American education. It focuses on the nature of the discourses – the content and context – that represent what is included in textbooks. The term ‘discourse’ provides the conceptual framework for the book, drawing on the work of the French social theorist Michel Foucault. The volume includes classic articles and book chapters as well as three original chapters written by the editors. To enhance its usefulness as a course text, each chapter includes an Overview, Key Concepts, and Questions for Reflection. Routledge «Market: Education January 2011: 229x152: 368pp Hb: 978-0-415-88646-8: £100.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88647-5: £35.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83602-6: £100.00/14
textbook
The Politics of American Education Joel Spring, City University of New York, USA Series: Sociocultural, Political, and Historical Studies in Education Turning his distinctive analytical lens to the politics of American education, Joel Spring looks at contemporary educational policy issues from theoretical, practical, and historical perspectives. This comprehensive overview documents and explains who influences educational policy and how, bringing to life the realities of schooling in the 21st century and revealing the ongoing ideological struggles at play. Ranging from a theoretical discussion of the political nature of American education to the nitty-gritty practicalities and complexities of political control at all levels local, district, state, and federal, this text is timely and useful for understanding the big picture and the micro-level intricacies of the multiple forces at work in controlling U.S. public schools. Thought-provoking, original in its conceptual framework, and rich with engaging examples from the real world, it is the text of choice for any course that covers or addresses the politics of American education. Routledge «Market: Education / Politics of American Education January 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-88439-6: £100.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88440-2: £32.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83899-0: £100.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
The Routledge International Handbook of Creative Learning Edited by Julian Sefton-Green and Pat Thomson, both at University of Nottingham, UK, Liora Bresler, University of Illinois at Urbana-Champaign, USA and Ken Jones, University of Keele, UK Series: Routledge International Handbooks of Education The concept of creative learning extends far beyond Arts-based learning or the development of individual creativity. It covers a range of processes and initiatives throughout the world that share common values, systems and practices aimed at making learning more creative. This applies at individual, classroom or whole school level, always with the aim of fully realising young people’s potential. Until now there has been no single text bringing together the significant literature that explores the dimensions of creative learning, despite the work of artists in schools and the development of a cadre of creative teaching and learning specialists. Containing a mixture of newly commissioned chapters, reprints and updated versions of previous publications, this book brings together major theorists and current research. This book will appeal to those involved in initial and continuing teacher education, as well as research academics and policy specialists. Routledge «Market: Education / Creativity April 2011: 246x174: 512pp Hb: 978-0-415-54889-2: £125.00/03
The Struggle for the History of Education * Gary McCulloch, University of London, UK Series: Foundations and Futures of Education In The Struggle for History Education, Gary McCulloch sets out a vision for a future of study in the history of education which contributes to education, history and social sciences alike. Over the past century the history of education has passed through a number of approaches, more recently splintering into a number of different areas with sub-fields such as curriculum, teaching and gender; losing sight of a common cause. In this book McCulloch contextualizes the struggle for educational history, explaining and making suggestions for the future on a number of topics. Routledge «Market: History of Education January 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-56534-9: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56535-6: £24.99/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
The Textbook as Discourse
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
education theory 79
Using Effectiveness Data for School Improvement * Developing and Utilizing Metrics Anthony Kelly and Christopher Downey, both at University of Southampton, UK Data metrics in schools are becoming increasingly complex, but despite their best efforts, teachers and academics generally find them something of a ‘black-box’. This book lifts the lid on that box, exploring the provenance and problematization of existing techniques and developing new algorithms for measuring the more oblique aspects of in-school performance. Using contextual value-added measures in England as a foundation – they have become the template of choice for policy makers around the world and a basis for some excellent school effectiveness research – the book explores the potential of performance and progress data to guide student and teacher self-evaluation, to set targets and allocate resources, to evaluate initiatives and identify good practice, to assess and reward staff responsibility, and to inform policy in relation to emerging issues like school choice, equality of opportunity and post-compulsory progression.
Edited by Valsa Koshy and Jean Murray, University of East London, UK Now in an updated second edition Unlocking Mathematics is a comprehensive guide to teaching mathematics in the primary school. Combining theory and practice, the contributors outline the current context of mathematics education, providing strategies, activities and examples to develop readers understanding and confidence in delivering the curriculum. Key features include: advice on teaching mathematics to high and low attainers; guidance on teaching mental maths; ideas for incorporating ICT; guidance on assessment in mathematics education; teaching problem solving; numerical and non-numerical examples; and fully updated references, taking into account the Williams report. An accessible blend of subject knowledge and pedagogy, this book is essential reading for all primary education students and practising teachers looking to increase their confidence and effectiveness in delivering the mathematics curriculum. Routledge «Market: Primary Education / Mathematics February 2011: 246x174: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-57929-2: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57928-5: £22.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-1-8534-6835-3
çè
Series: World Yearbook of Education The World Yearbook of Education 2011 aims to bring together contributions from around the world that analyse and reflect on the way curriculum is configuring and reconfiguring that world. The theme of this volume, Curriculum in Today’s World, brings together new approaches to curriculum today and insights from different parts of the world which discuss: What kind of world is being represented in curriculum?; What are the ways of knowing this world that curriculum extends to students?; and What is influencing, directing and being produced from those ways of doing curriculum? Routledge «Market: Education / Curriculum January 2011: 234x156: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-57582-9: £85.00/03
A Guide for the Early Childhood Student or Professional Marianne Jones and Marilyn Shelton, both at California State University, Fresno, USA Portfolios aren’t just for documenting the work of young children – they can also be powerful resources for early childhood educators’ professional training and development. Veteran teacher educators Jones and Shelton provide practical and comprehensive guidance on developing a portfolio specific to the needs of pre- and in-service teachers of young children. This updated edition features new material on the portfolio planning and organizational stage and additional coverage on writing rationales. A companion website accompanies this edition, featuring instructor and student resources such as PowerPoint slides, printable templates, and activities for improving students’ portfolio skills. Both theoretical and practical, this valuable resource addresses issues related to process and product, instruction and guidance techniques, the role of reflection, and assessment strategies. With concrete examples, rubrics, tips, and exercises, this book provides a step-bystep guide to creating a professional teaching portfolio. Routledge «Market: Education / Career Development June 2011: 279x216: 160pp Hb: 978-0-415-80051-8: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-80052-5: £16.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83503-6: £80.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Unlocking Mathematics Teaching
@
Edited by Lyn Yates, University of Melbourne, Australia and Madeleine Grumet, University of Chapel Hill, North Carolina, USA
Developing Your Portfolio – Enhancing Your Learning and Showing Your Stuff
2nd Edition
for e-mail updates in your field
Curriculum in Today’s World: Configuring Knowledge, Identities, Work and Politics
2nd Edition
Routledge «Market: Education December 2010: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-56277-5: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56278-2: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83436-7: £75.00/14
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
World Yearbook of Education 2011
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
80 education theory Beyond Binaries in Education Research
Commitment, Character, and Citizenship
Equity and Excellence in Education
Edited by Patrick Alan Danaher, University of Southern Queensland, Australia, Warren Midgley, University of South Queensland, Australia, Mark A. Tyler, University of South Queensland, Australia and Alison Mander, University of Southern Queensland, Australia
Religious Schooling in Liberal Democracy
Towards Maximal Learning Opportunities for All Students
Series: Routledge Research in Education This book seeks to explore the ethical, methodological, and social justice questions that arise in education research that is founded on conceptualizations of binary opposites. In education research these dualisms may include ability-disability, academic-vocational, adult-child, domestic-foreign, formal and informal learning, health-illness, majority-minority, male-female, practitioner-educator, public-private, qualitativequantitative research, research-practice, researcher-participant, sedentary-itinerant, West-East, and young-old.
Edited by Hanan Alexander and Ayman K. Agbaria, both at Haifa University, Israel Series: Routledge Research in Education This book draws together leading educationalists, philosophers, theologians, and social scientists to explore issues, problems, and tensions concerning religious education in a variety of international settings. The contributors explore the possibilities and limitations of religious education in preparing citizens in multicultural and multi-religious democratic societies. Routledge «Market: Education April 2011: 229x152: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-87974-3: £70.00/08
Education and Sustainability
Routledge «Market: Education April 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-88512-6: £75.00/08
Learning Across the Diaspora, Indigenous, Minority Divide
Boys’ Experience of Schooling
Series: Routledge Research in Education
Seonaigh MacPherson, British Columbia Institute of Technology, Canada
Becoming Someone Else John Whelen, Monash University, Australia Series: Routledge Research in Education This book re-evaluates the debate over why so many boys are failing at school, moving it from a focus on gender construction and the panic about achievement to the broader question of what it is to experience being schooled as a boy in the new liberal educational environment. Routledge «Market: Education April 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-87917-0: £70.00/08
This book critically explores the impact of migration, education, development, and the spread of English on global bio-linguistic and cultural diversity, examining the overlapping and distinctive sustainability challenges facing Indigenous and minority communities when they are connected by and within diasporas. Routledge «Market: Education March 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-88215-6: £70.00/08
Education, Professionalism and the Quest for Accountability
Edited by Kris Van den Branden, Katholieke Universiteit Leuven, Belgium, Piet Van Avermaet and Mieke Van Houtte, Ghent University, Belgium Series: Routledge Research in Education Taking an international perspective, this volume explores numerous issues – gender, socioeconomic and linguistic background, teachers’ expectations, pedagogical approaches, parental support, educational policies (e.g. priority policies, multilingual policies, early start policies – and their effects on equity in education. Routledge «Market: Education February 2011: 229x152: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-88501-0: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83233-2: £75.00/14
From Testing to Productive Student Learning Implementing Formative Assessment in Confucian-Heritage Settings David Carless, University of Hong Kong Series: Routledge Research in Education Formative assessment is a major driver of teacher and student actions in all educational systems, and it is an increasingly high-profile topic. This book scrutinises the relationship between testing and learning, as well as the role of cultural context in influencing assessment options, by using data from schools in the Confucian-heritage setting of Hong Kong. Routledge «Market: Education April 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-88082-4: £70.00/08
Hitting the Target but Missing the Point Jane Green, London University, UK Series: Routledge International Studies in the Philosophy of Education Today, workers based in institutions designed to serve the public – teachers, nurses, social workers, community officers, librarians, civil servants, etc. – are expected to reorganize their thoughts and practice in accordance with a ‘performance’ management model of accountability which encourages a rigid bureaucracy, one which translates regulation and monitoring procedures into inflexible and obligatory compliance. This book shows how and why this performance model may be expected, paradoxically, to make practices less accountable – and, in the case of education, less educative.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Education February 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-87925-5: £70.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83256-1: £70.00/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
education theory 81 Foucault and Educational Leadership
Global Pathways to Abolishing Physical Punishment
Disciplining the Principal
Realizing Children’s Rights
Richard Niesche, Griffith University, UK
Edited by Joan E. Durrant, University of Manitoba, Canada and Anne B. Smith, University of Otago, New Zealand
This book argues that the work of educational leadership needs more sophisticated theorisation in order to better understand the complexities that face many school principals. This book draws upon the work of Michel Foucault to provoke new thought into how the principalship is lived and ‘disciplined’ in ways that produce both contradictions and tensions for school principals. This book is distinctive from other educational leadership titles in that it: • provides a well theorised analysis of leadership practices • acknowledges the messy reality of life for school principals • provides key insights to the ‘real’ work that principals undertake every day • examines the production of principals’ subjectivities in education, foregrounding issues of gender and race • includes the principals’ voices through rich interview data. Routledge «Market: Education January 2011: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-57170-8: £75.00/03
Series: Routledge Research in Education This book describes the unfolding of a global phenomenon: the legal prohibition of physical punishment of children. Documenting the stories of countries that have either prohibited corporal punishment of children or who are moving in that direction, this volume will serve as a sourcebook for scholars and advocates around the world who are interested in the many dimensions of physical punishment and its elimination.
This book brings together essays from education scholars who are studying the interconnections between pedagogy and memory in the context of social themes and social inquiry within educational research. Routledge «Market: Education January 2011: 229x152: 296pp Hb: 978-0-415-88380-1: £70.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83558-6: £70.00/14
Islamic Education and Indoctrination
Series: Routledge Studies in Education and Neoliberalism
Edited by Philip E. Kovacs, University of Alabama in Huntsville, USA
Charlene Tan, Nanyang Technological University, Singapore Series: Routledge Research in Education This book critically examines the concept of indoctrination within the Western liberal traditions and analyses case studies of indoctrination in some Muslim societies. It offers suggestions to counter religious indoctrination and highlights the key tensions, challenges and prospects of Islamic education in a modern and multicultural world.
@
Series: Routledge Research in Education
The Gates Foundation and the Future of US ‘Public’ Schools
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
for e-mail updates in your field
Edited by Claudia Mitchell and Teresa StrongWilson, both at McGill University, Canada, Kathleen Pithouse, University of KwaZuluNatal, South Africa and Susann Allnutt, McGill University, Canada
Routledge «Market: Education February 2011: 229x152: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-87920-0: £70.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83968-3: £70.00/14
Routledge «Market: Education April 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-87976-7: £70.00/08
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
Memory and Pedagogy *
What are the implications when the educational policy and priority of public schools are concentrated in ways that foster de-unionization and teacher de-skilling while homogenizing school models and curriculum? This volume addresses this crucial, unanswered question while investigating the impact of the Gates Foundation on education. Routledge «Market: Education December 2010: 229x152: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-87334-5: £70.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83494-7: £70.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
politics
TOP TEN BESTSELLERS
82 politics
1.
6. Security Studies
6th Edition
An Introduction
The Politics of Bureaucracy
Edited by Paul D. Williams
An Introduction to Comparative Public Administration
2008: 246x174: 568pp Pb: 978-0-415-42562-9: £25.99/04
B. Guy Peters 2009: 246x174: 400pp Pb: 978-0-415-34210-0: £25.99/04
2.
7. Global Politics
2nd Edition
A New Introduction
Genocide
Edited by Jenny Edkins and Maja Zehfuss
A Comprehensive Introduction
2008: 246x189: 568pp Pb: 978-0-415-43131-6: £26.99/04
Adam Jones 2010: 246x174: 680pp Pb: 978-0-415-48619-4: £24.99/04
3.
8. 5th Edition
2nd Edition
Politics in the Republic of Ireland
Global Terrorism Brenda J. Lutz and James M. Lutz 2008: 246x189: 360pp Pb: 978-0-415-77247-1: £23.99/04
Edited by John Coakley and Michael Gallagher 2009: 234x156: 512pp Pb: 978-0-415-47672-0: £21.99/04
4.
9. Global Finance in Crisis
3rd Edition
International Relations Theory
The Politics of International Regulatory Change
A Critical Introduction
Edited by Eric Helleiner, Stefano Pagliari and Hubert Zimmermann
Cynthia Weber 2009: 246x174: 264pp Pb: 978-0-415-77842-8: £22.99/04
5.
2009: 234x156: 216pp Pb: 978-0-415-56438-0: £23.99/04
10. Global Political Islam
3rd Edition
An Introduction to African Politics
Peter Mandaville 2007: 234x156: 408pp Pb: 978-0-415-32607-0: £23.99/04
Alex Thomson
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
2010: 246x174: 312pp Pb: 978-0-415-48287-5: £22.99/04
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
politics 83
Andre Gunder Frank and Autobiographical Global Development: Visions, International Relations * Remembrances, and Explorations I, IR Edited by Patrick Manning and Barry K. Gills, University of Newcastle, UK Series: Rethinking Globalizations This book focuses on the ideas and influence of Andre Gunder Frank, one of the founding figures and leading analysts of political economy at the global level. The book contains previously unpublished material by Frank and his co-authors.
Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60273-0: £80.00/08 Pb: 978-0-415-60274-7: £23.99/04
Edited by Naeem Inayatullah, Ithaca College, USA Series: Interventions In this collection scholars write about how life events brought them to their subject matter, placing narratives in the larger context of world politics, culture, and history. Autobiographical International Relations believes that the fictive distancing associated with academic prose creates disaffection in both readers and writers. In contrast, these essays demonstrate how to reengage the ‘I’ while simultaneously sustaining theoretical precision and historical awareness. Authors highlight their motives, their desires, and their wounds. By working within the overlap between theory, history, and autobiography, these scholars increase the clarity, urgency, and meaningfulness of academic work, and move the field towards greater candidness about how personal narrative influences theoretical articulations. No such volume currently exists in international relations. Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations / Global Governance November 2010: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-78142-8: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-78143-5: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83722-1: £75.00/14
6th Edition textbook
Political Development and Institutional Change Cal Jillson, Southern Methodist University, USA To gain a fuller understanding of American politics today, students need to learn how it has evolved, from its founding principles to its contemporary practices. This text fosters this understanding by providing insights into how institutions, avenues of participation, and policies have changed over time to produce today’s political environment in the United States.
çè
Selected Contents: 1. The Origins of American Political Principles 2. The Revolution and the Constitution 3. Federalism and American Political Development 4. Political Socialization and Public Opinion 5. The Mass Media and the Political Agenda 6. Interest Groups 7. Political Parties 8. Voting, Campaigns, and Elections 9. Congress 10. The President 11. Bureaucracy 12. The Federal Courts 13. Civil Liberties 14. Civil Rights 15. Government, the Economy, and Domestic Policy 16. America’s Place in a Dangerous World Routledge «Market: American Politics March 2011: 235x187: 608pp Pb: 978-0-415-88157-9: £44.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83807-5: £90.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-99570-2
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Barack Obama and the Politics of Redemption Stanley A. Renshon, City University of New York Graduate Center, USA Based on extensive biographical, psychological, and political research and analysis, noted political psychologist Stanley Renshon follows Obama’s presidency through the first year. He digs into the question of who the real Obama is and assesses the advantages and limitations that he brings to the presidency. Selected Contents: 1. Perhaps a Great President: The Promise and Perils of ObamaMania 2. Early Obama: Peripatetic Sojourner 3. Searching for his Father, Hoping to Find Himself 4. Coming of Age: An Incomplete Identity 5. The Search for Community and the Turn to Politics 6. Obama on the Way: Ambition Looks Ahead 7. Giant Killer: The Race for the Presidency 8. Irresistible Force (Obama) meets Immovable Object (America’s still deep political divisions and skepticism) 9. Governing America: ObamaMania and its Limits Routledge «Market: Politics / Current Affairs April 2011: 229x152: 448pp Hb: 978-0-415-87394-9: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87395-6: £19.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-86413-5: £90.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
American Government
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
84 politics
A Whole New Ballgame? Dennis W. Johnson, George Washington University, USA This book analyzes the way political campaigns have been traditionally run and the extraordinary changes that have occurred in the last decade. Johnson looks at the most sophisticated techniques of modern campaigning – micro-targeting, online fundraising, digital communication, new media – and the role of the political parties and outside interest groups, such as 527s organizations, to perform what amounts to an electoral CAT-scan at every level of campaigning. Selected Contents: 1. The Modern Campaign 2. Communicating with Voters: The New Media 3. Communicating with Voters: The Old Media 4. Fundraising 5. Independent Voices 6. Taking the Pulse of the Electorate 7. Voter Identification, Contact, and Mobilization 8. Campaigning in the Next Decade Routledge «Market: Politics / Current Affairs January 2011: 229x152: 160pp Pb: 978-0-415-80038-9: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-87896-5: £90.00/14
Conflict Resolution Theory and Practice Edited by Stefan Wolff, University of Birmingham, UK and Christalla Yakinthou, University of Western Australia, Australia Conflict Resolution: Theory & Practice is an ambitious and original textbook, which takes a multi-perspective approach to the study of conflict resolution in divided societies. It explains conflict resolution from the viewpoint of the political scientist, the constitutional architect, the activist, and the NGO and examines the philosophies underpinning constitutional design, the actors and processes involved, and the practicalities of the settlement process, combining conceptual and theoretical contributions with empirical case studies of Northern Ireland, Lebanon, Cyprus, Kosovo, Indonesia, Afghanistan, Iraq, Sudan and Rwanda. Selected Contents: 1. Introduction Section I. Theoretical Perspectives 2. Power-sharing/liberal consociationalism 3. Centripetalism 4. Power Dividing 5. Territorial solutions 6. A practitioner’s view Section II. Actors and processes 7. The Evolution of Diplomacy in Peace-making 8. Crafting solutions for divided societies – the UN 9. Crafting solutions for divided societies – the EU 10. Crafting solutions for divided societies – the AU 11. The role of activists – The Mano River Women’s Peace Network 12. The role of NGOs 13. The role of quiet diplomacy Section III. Case studies 14. Northern Ireland 15. Lebanon 16. Cyprus 17. Kosovo 18. Indonesia 19. Afghanistan 20. Iraq 21. Sudan 22. Rwanda 23. Conclusion Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations March 2011: 246x174: 336pp Hb: 978-0-415-56373-4: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56374-1: £25.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Contesting Global Order * Development, Global Governance And Globalization James H. Mittelman, American University, USA Few authors have sought to explain the links among development, global governance, and globalization, Contesting Global Order traces dominant values and patterns on a world level over the last half century. With a framing introduction written for the volume, this book brings together for the first time James H. Mittelman’s most influential works, offering cross-regional analysis, and including fieldwork in nine countries in Africa and Asia. Resisting being pigeonholed in any one school of thought, Mittelman forges a critical perspective throughout this collection, his reflections cutting against conventions in international studies and, more generally, global order. This volume will be of great interest to all scholars of global governance, international organisations and development. Routledge «Market: International Politics / Political Economy January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60095-8: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-60096-5: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83666-8: £85.00/14
Critical Theory in International Relations and Security Studies Interviews and Reflections Edited by Shannon Brincat, University of Queensland, Australia, Laura Lima and Joao Nunes, both at Aberystwyth University, UK Critical Theory in International Relations and Security Studies is the first book to present first hand interviews with some of the pioneering scholars of the disciplines. Through dialogical and reflective essays, it assesses the state of critical thinking in IR and security studies, and looks to the future of the discipline and theoretical developments.
Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60157-3: £80.00/08 Pb: 978-0-415-60158-0: £24.99/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Campaigning in the Twenty-First Century
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
politics 85
Designing Public Policies *
Humanitarianism Contested
Principles and Instruments
Michael Barnett, University of Minnesota, USA and Thomas G. Weiss, The City University of New York, USA
Michael Howlett, Simon Fraser University, Canada
This book provides a succinct but sophisticated understanding of humanitarianism, and insight into the on-going dilemmas and tensions that have accompanied it since its origins in the early nineteenth century. But what was latent and ignored in earlier periods has come to the fore in the post-Cold War era. Specifically, the book does the following:
Series: Routledge Textbooks in Policy Studies This textbook provides a concise and accessible introduction to the principles and elements of policy design in contemporary governance. Guiding students through the study of the instruments used by governments in carrying out their tasks, adapting to, and altering, their environments, this book: • discusses several current trends in instrument use often linked to factors such as globalization and the increasingly networked nature of modern society • considers the principles behind the selection and use of specific types of instruments in contemporary government • evaluates in detail the merits, demerits and rationales for the use of specific organization, regulatory, financial and informationbased tools and the trends visible in their use • addresses the issues of instrument mixes and their (re)design in a discussion of the future research agenda of policy design. Routledge «Market: Political Science / Public Policy November 2010: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-78132-9: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-78133-6: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83863-1: £85.00/14
FIFA (Fédération Internationale de Football Association) Alan Tomlinson, University of Brighton, UK
• it provides a brief survey of the history of humanitarianism • explains the evolution of humanitarianism • presents an overview of the contemporary humanitarian sector • analyses the ethical dilemmas confronted by humanitarian organization • examines how humanitarianism poses fundamental ethical questions regarding the kind of world we want to live in, what kind of world is possible, and how we might get there. Selected Contents: Introduction Part 1: Introducing the Debates 1. Humanitarianism: Definition and Identity 2. Dynamics Driving Humanitarianism: Destruction, Production, Salvation Part 2: Three Periods of Humanitarian Action 3. ‘Birth’ and Maturation, 1864–1945 4. The Traditional Enterprise Expands, 1945–1991 5. The Turbulent PostCold War Era Part 3: The Future 6. Strategic Humanitarianism 7. Humanitarianism and the Art of the (Im)Possible Routledge «Market: Politics / Human Rights March 2011: 216x138: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-49663-6: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-49664-3: £17.99/04
Idea of World Government James Yunker, Western Illinois University, USA Series: Global Institutions There is much discussion in contemporary international relations about global governance but where did this idea originate, what are its intellectual antecedents and does it have a realistic future? This book is a concise yet comprehensive account of the intellectual history of world government up to the present day.
Series: Global Institutions In this book, the history and underlying political dynamics characterising the growth of FIFA and its relationships with global-regional federations and international associations provide a foundation and focus for analysing this important organization.
çè
Routledge «Market: Sports Studies March 2011: 216x138: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-49830-2: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-49831-9: £17.99/04
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Selected Contents: 1. Introduction and Overview 2. Historical Antecedents 3. From Perpetual Peace to The Great War 4. From the Treaty of Versailles to the Nuclear Age 5. The Ephemeral Postwar World Government Boom 6. The End of the Cold War and the New World Order 7. Is There a Future for World Government? Routledge «Market: International Politics / International Organizations / Global Governance March 2011: 216x138: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-78162-6: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-78163-3: £18.99/04
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Selected Contents: 1. Introduction 2. Origins – History and Development of FIFA 3. Leaders – FIFA and the Men Who Led it 4. World Cups – FIFA’s Exclusive Product 5. How FIFA Works 6. FIFA Crises and the Critical Response 7. FIFA’s future – Emerging Issues and Future Directions
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
86 politics
In Search of Democracy *
International Migration *
Larry Diamond
Khalid Koser, Geneva Centre for Security Policy, Switzerland Series: Global Institutions
This important essay collection, including two new essays written for the volume, takes stock of democratic progress in the world and reflects upon the causes of democratic difficulty in the world. Diamond addresses some of the critical conditions for democratic success, analyzes democratic dilemmas and prospects in particular regions and countries, and then concludes by assessing the policy implications for promoting and assisting democratic development internationally.
International migration has always mattered, but today it matters more than ever before. Addressing the changing opportunities and challenges of international migration, and national and international responses, this volume: • discusses in detail topical issues including the impact on international migration of the global financial crisis; migrant smuggling and human trafficking; challenges of migrant integration; the links between migration and the demographic crisis; and ‘mixed flows’
Routledge «Market: Politics / Current Affairs January 2011: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-78127-5: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-78128-2: £24.99/04
• considers current efforts to improve the governance of international migration, at the national, international and institutional levels • adopts a global perspective, including substantial consideration of ‘South-South’ migration and the growing significance of Chinese migrations. Routledge «Market: Politics / Migration March 2011: 216x138: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-56155-6: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56156-3: £17.99/04
International History & International Relations
Interpretive Approaches to Research Design
Andrew Williams, University of St. Andrews, UK, Amelia Hadfield, University of Kent, UK and Simon Rofe, Kings College London, UK
Concepts and Processes
This textbook is designed to provide undergraduate students of international relations with valuable and relevant historical context. The book is organised thematically around the key issues in international relations such as war, peace, sovereignty, diplomacy, identity, revolution, political violence, empire and international organisations. Each chapter provides an overview of the main historical context, theories and literature in each area and applies this to the study of international relations.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
This book is a practical, short, simple, and authoritative examination of the concepts and issues in interpretive research design, looking across this approach’s methods of generating and analyzing data. Selected Contents: 1. What is Research Design and Why is It Important? 2. What is ‘Interpretive’ Research? 3. Designing for Interpretive Research 4. Sections of a Research Proposal and Their Relationship to a Research ‘Report’
Routledge «Market: Politics April 2011: 229x152: 144pp Hb: 978-0-415-87807-4: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87808-1: £17.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85490-7: £85.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Selected Contents: 1. Diplomatic, International and Global History 2. War 3. Peace 4. State and Sovereignty 5. Identity 6. Revolution 7. Political Violence 8. Empires 9. International Organisations and Global Governance Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations March 2011: 246x174: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-48178-6: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-48179-3: £22.99/04
Dvora Yanow, Vrije University, the Netherlands and Peregrine Schwartz-Shea, University of Utah, USA
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
politics 87
Making Sense of Media and Politics
Non-Governmental Organizations in World Politics *
Five Principles in Political Communication
The Construction of Global Governance
Gadi Wolfsfeld, Hebrew University of Jerusalem, Israel
Peter Willetts, City University, UK
Politics is above all a contest, and the news media is the central arena for viewing that competition. In Making Sense of Media and Politics, Gadi Wolfsfeld explores five concepts that provide a solid conceptual base for examining the interrelationship of media and politics. Selected Contents: Part I: Political Actors Compete over the News Media 1. Political Power and Media Power 2. Political Control and Control Over the News Part II: How The News Media Transform Politics into News 3. The Myth of Objectivity 4. The Rise of Infotainment Part III: The Effects of the News Media on Citizens 5. News Hits you Hardest when You’re not Paying Attention Routledge «Market: Politics March 2011: 229x152: 144pp Hb: 978-0-415-88522-5: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88523-2: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83987-4: £95.00/14
New Directions in the American Presidency
Series: Global Institutions Non-governmental organizations (NGOs) from Amnesty International and Oxfam to Greenpeace and Save the Children are now key players in global politics. This accessible and informative textbook provides a comprehensive overview of the significant role and increasing participation of NGOs in World Politics, and includes an evaluation of the enhanced communication offered by the creation of the Internet. This is the definitive guide to this crucial area within international politics and should be required reading for students, NGO activists and policymakers. Selected Contents: Introduction 2. NGOs, Social Movements and Civil Society 3. The Access of NGOs to Global Policy-Making 4. Understanding the Place of NGOs in Global Politics 5. NGO Influence upon Global Politics 6. Current Debates about the Role of NGOs in the UN System 7. NGOs and Global Governance Routledge «Market: Politics / Current Affairs December 2010: 216x138: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-38124-6: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-38125-3: £17.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83430-5: £80.00/14
Edited by Lori Cox Han, Chapman University, USA
Religious Institutions and Global Politics
Series: New Directions in American Politics
Katherine Marshall, The World Bank, Washington DC, USA
çè
Selected Contents: 1. Introduction: Studying the Presidency Lori Cox Han 2. The Presidency and the Constitution David Gray Adler 3. Presidential Campaigns and Elections Randall E. Adkins 4. The Public Presidency: Communications and Media Matthew Eshbaugh-Soha 5. The Presidency and Public Opinion Diane J. Heith 6. The Presidency and Congress Brandon Rottinghaus 7. The Presidency and the Courts Nancy Kassop 8. White House Staff Justin S. Vaughn and José D. Villalobos 9. The Presidency and the Executive Branch Matthew J. Dickinson 10. The Presidency and Domestic Policy David Shafie 11. The Presidency and Foreign Policy Meena Bose Routledge «Market: American Politics February 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-87801-2: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87802-9: £29.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85501-0: £95.00/14
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Series: Global Institutions This book will review the institutional context for contemporary religion, focusing on its transnational implications. The new forms that religious institutions are taking, their fit with human rights and democratic ideals, their changing nature in plural societies and are a highly relevant part of the global institutional picture, and this volume aims to provide an accessible and rich introduction to them. Selected Contents: 1. Religion: An Institutional Portrait 2. Global Religious Bodies 3. ‘Faith-inspired Organizations at work 4. The World of Global Interfaith 5. Religious ‘Movements’ 6. Emerging Issues and Future Directions Routledge «Market: Politics / Human Rights March 2011: 216x138: 144pp Hb: 978-0-415-78044-5: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-78045-2: £16.99/04
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
New Directions in the American Presidency takes a current look at the various issues facing the presidency and provides a ‘state of the art’ overview of current trends in the field of presidency research.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
88 politics
Routledge Handbook of International Law
Routledge Handbook of American Foreign Policy
Edited by David Armstrong, University of Exeter, UK
Edited by Steven W. Hook, Kent State University, USA and Christopher M. Jones, Northern Illinois University, USA
The Routledge Handbook of International Law provides a definitive global survey of the interaction of international politics and international law. Each chapter is written by a leading expert and provides a state of the art overview of the most significant areas within the field. A highly topical collection of specially commissioned papers from both established authorities and rising stars, the Routledge Handbook of International Law is an essential work of reference for scholars and practitioners of international Law. Selected Contents: Part 1: The Nature of International Law Part 2: The Evolution of International Law Part 3: Law and Power in International Society Part 4: Key Issues in International Law Routledge «Market: Politics / Law January 2011: 246x174: 504pp Pb: 978-0-415-61052-0: £32.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-88462-1: £125.00/14
The Handbook brings together leading experts in the field to examine current trends in the way scholars study the history and theories of American conduct in the world, analysis of state and non-state actors and their tools in conducting policy, and the dynamics of a variety of pressing transnational challenges facing the United States. Selected Contents: 1. Foreign Policy Analysis 2. Rise of American Power 3. Realist Theory 4. Liberal Theory 5. Critical Theory 6. Constructivist Theory 7. Institutional Analysis 8. Decision Making 9. President 10. National Security Council 11. State Department 12. Defense Department 13. Intelligence Community 14. Foreign Economic Bureaucracy 15. Congress 16. Courts 17. Public Opinion 18. News Media 19. Interest Groups 20. Multilateralism 21. Use of Military Force 22. Economic Sanctions 23. Development Aid 24. Weapons Proliferation 25. Counterterrorism 26. Global Trade 27. Human Rights 28. Environment and Energy 29. Global Balance of Power Routledge «Market: Politics April 2011: 254x178: 576pp Hb: 978-0-415-80088-4: £110.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-87863-7: £110.00/14
2nd Edition
Matthew J. Streb, Northern Illinois University, USA Series: Controversies in Electoral Democracy and Representation In this critical examination of the state of electoral democracy in the United States, Matthew Streb provides an analysis of the major debates that rage among scholars and reformers on subjects as diverse as the number of elections we hold, the use of nonpartisan elections, and the presidential primary process. Ultimately, Streb makes an argument for a less burdensome democracy; a democracy in which citizens can participate more easily. Selected Contents: 1. Creating a Model Electoral Democracy Part I. Rethinking the Costs of Voting 2. Factors that Influence Voter Turnout 3. The Offices We Elect 4. Direct Democracy Part II. Rethinking the Mechanics of Voting 5. Ballot Laws 6. Voting Machines Part III. Rethinking National Elections 7. The Redistricting Process 8. Presidential Primaries 9.The Electoral College 10. Campaign Finance 11. Moving Toward a Model Electoral Democracy Routledge «Market: Politics April 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-88201-9: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88202-6: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-84815-9: £95.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-96139-4
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Rethinking Foreign Policy Analysis States, Leaders, and the Microfoundations of Behavioral International Relations Edited by Stephen G. Walker, Arizona State University, USA, Akan Malici, Furman University, USA and Mark Schafer, Louisiana State University, USA Rethinking Foreign Policy Analysis addresses the agent-centered, micro-political study of decisions by leaders and the structureoriented macro political study of state interactions in an international system. Selected Contents: 1. Foreign Policy Analysis and Behavioral International Relations 2. Macropolitics and Foreign Policy Decisions 3. Micropolitics and Foreign Policy Decisions 4. Quantum Politics and Operational Code Analysis 5. The United States and Rogue Leaders 6. Deceptive Bargaining and Nuclear Ambitions 7. Small Group Dynamics 8. Alliances and Their Microfoundations 9. The Operational Codes of Fidel Castro and Kim Il Sung 10. Stability and Change in Belief Systems 11. Experiential Learning by U.S. Presidents 12. Cognitive Responses by U.S. Presidents to Foreign Policy Crises 13. Dueling with Dictators 14. Binary Role Theory 15. The Integration of Foreign Policy Analysis and International Relations Routledge «Market: Politics January 2011: 229x152: 352pp Hb: 978-0-415-88697-0: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88698-7: £30.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83486-2: £95.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Rethinking American Electoral Democracy
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
politics 89
Strategy in Information and Influence Campaigns How Policy Advocates, Social Movements, Insurgent Groups, Corporations, Governments and Others Get What They Want Jarol B. Manheim, George Washington University, USA Strategy in Information and Influence Campaigns sets out in comprehensive detail the underlying assumptions, unifying strategy, and panoply of tactics of the IIC, both from the perspective of the protagonist who initiates the action and from that of the target who must defend against it. Selected Contents: 1. Points of Origin 2. Information and Influence Campaigns 3. Strategy and Tactics in Campaign Communication I 4. Strategy and Tactics in Campaign Communication II 5. Networks and Netwaves 6. Strategy and Tactics in Network Activation 7. The Dimensionality of Targets 8. Deterring, Deflecting, Minimizing or Defeating Information and Influence Campaigns 9. Information, and Influence Routledge «Market: Politics January 2011: 229x152: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-88728-1: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88729-8: £28.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83328-5: £95.00/14
The Future of Global Currency * The Euro Versus the Dollar Benjamin J. Cohen, University of California, Santa Barbara, USA This book is a short account of the broad prospects for today’s top international currencies – the dollar, the Euro, and the yen – in the twenty-first century. Written by one of America’s most pre-eminent experts on the international political economy of the global monetary system, it traces the origins of the Euro-Dollar rivalry and assesses both their prospects in the current uncertain economic climate. The analysis explores how the future of the leading currencies may be influenced by the logic of market competition, the strategic preferences of national governments, and prospective technological developments as well as questioning whether monetary conflict could spill over into a broader geopolitical confrontation. Drawing together the key essays of Benjamin J. Cohen, this book will be of considerable interest to students and scholars of international finance and international political economy. Routledge «Market: Politics and Current Affairs / International Political Economy December 2010: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-78149-7: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-78150-3: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83380-3: £85.00/14
student reference
Terrorism: The Basics
The International Trade Centre
James Lutz and Brenda J. Lutz, both at Indiana University-Purdue, USA
Promoting an Export Culture
Series: The Basics An ideal starting point for anyone interested in one of the most discussed, written about and analysed aspects of modern life. This book dispels common misconceptions about the nature of terrorism and terrorists as the authors provide clear and jargon-free answers to the big questions:
Stephen Browne, The Future of the UN Development System (FUNDS) Project and Sam Laird, University of Nottingham, UK Series: Global Institutions In the era of rapid globalization, ITC is an important organization, and this work will seek to fill the gap in the existing literature by discussing the history, ongoing projects and future challenges of this dynamic organization. The status of ITC – half-in and half-out of the UN – could prove to be an interesting model for the future, and this work provides a comprehensive survey of the organization.
• What does terrorism involve? • Who can be classified as a terrorist? • Who are the supporters of terrorism? • Can there ever be an end to terrorist activity? Written with clarity and insight, this book is the a perfect introductory book on terrorism for students of all levels.
çè
Routledge «Market: Politics / Terrorism March 2011: 198x129: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-57333-7: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57334-4: £11.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83198-4: £55.00/14
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Selected Contents: 1. Introduction: The Importance of Trade in Development 2. Origins and History of ITC 3. Structure and mandate 4. Trade information as a public Good 5. ITC, The Private Sector and Development 6. Trade and Poverty Reduction 7. Trade and Environment 8. The Private Interest in Trade Negotiations 9. Facing the Future Routledge «Market: Politics / Economics / International Organizations March 2011: 234x156: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-58401-2: £65.00/08 Pb: 978-0-415-58402-9: £15.99/04
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
• What are terrorists trying to achieve?
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
90 politics
The Political Economy of Latin America
The Unilateralist Temptation in American Foreign Policy
Reflections on Neoliberalism and Development
David G. Skidmore II, Drake University, USA
Peter Kingstone, University of Connecticut, USA
Series: Foreign Policy Analysis The Unilateralist Temptation in American Foreign Policy traces U.S. unilateralism to the structural effects of the end of the Cold War, both domestically and abroad, to argue that the United States was more hegemonic than multilateralist – a rule-maker, not a rule-taker.
Neoliberalism has been at the center of enormous controversy since its first appearance in Latin America in the early 1970s. Even neoliberalism’s strongest supporters concede that it has not lived up to its promises and that growth, poverty, and inequality all have performed considerably worse than hoped. This brief text offers an unbiased reflection on the neoliberalism debate in Latin America and the institutional puzzle that underlies the region’s difficulties with democratization and development.
Selected Contents: 1. The Unilateralist Turn in U.S. Foreign Policy 2. The International and Domestic Sources of Unilateralism 3. Structure and Ideology in U.S. Foreign Policy: Clinton and Bush Compared 4. The United States and International Public Goods 5. Reconfiguring the Terms of U.S. Engagement with International Institutions 6. Barack Obama and the Unilateralist Temptation Routledge «Market: Politics February 2011: 229x152: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-88539-3: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88540-9: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83972-0: £95.00
Selected Contents: 1. Markets, States, and the Challenge of Development in Latin America 2. Import-Substitution Industrialization and the Great Transformation in Latin America 3. Neoliberalism and its Discontents 4. The Two Lefts and the Return of the State 5. Government, Markets and Institutions – Reflections on Development Routledge «Market: Politics / Latin America January 2011: 229x152: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-99826-0: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-99827-7: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-88260-3: £95.00/14
2nd Edition
The Politics of the New Germany Simon Green, University of Birmingham, UK, Dan Hough, University of Sussex, UK and Alister Miskimmon
The Politics of Inclusion and Exclusion Identity Politics in Twenty-First Century America Edited by David F. Ericson, George Mason University, USA Assessing the limits of pluralism, this book examines different types of political inclusion and exclusion and their distinctive dimensions and dynamics.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
• Grand Coalition • Lisbon treaty • Constitutional Court • Financial crisis and credit crunch • Reform of social policy • Afghanistan. Routledge «Market: Politics and European Politics March 2011: 246x174: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-60438-3: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-60439-0: £22.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-35365-6
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Selected Contents: 1. Introduction Part I: Politics of Inclusion 2. Minimal Political Inclusion of Minorities at Risk 3. Race, Nativity, and the Political Participation of Asian and Other Americans 4. The Home Styles of California Latino Representatives 5. Puerto Rican Politics in New York City During the 1960s 6. Inclusion, Exclusion, and Citizenship Part II: Politics of Exclusion 7. The Micro-Politics of Immigration 8. Transgendered Politics on a Global Stage 9. Politics and the Disabled Body 10. The Conservative Attack on Affirmative Action Routledge «Market: Politics January 2011: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-87619-3: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87620-9: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85793-9: £95.00/14
The Politics of the New Germany continues to provide the most comprehensive, authoritative and up-to-date textbook on contemporary German Politics. It covers the entire postwar era but has a particular focus on the post-reunification era. Written in a straightforward style by three experts, each of the chapters draws on a rich variety of real-world examples. In doing so, it highlights both the challenges and opportunities facing policy-makers in such areas as foreign affairs, economic policy, immigration, identity politics and institutional reforms. This 2nd edition has been revised and updated throughout and features new material on:
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
politics 91
The United States and Cuba
UN Human Rights Council *
Intimate Enemies
Bertrand G. Ramcharan, City University of New York, USA
Marifeli Pérez-Stable, Florida International University, USA and Inter-American Dialogue
Series: Global Institutions The Human Rights Council is already the subject of major public interest and controversy. This book aims to present a balanced view of the council, acknowledging where it has made positive contributions, point out its deficiencies, and identify options for improving the body’s future work. This guide will be essential reading for all those concerned with the future of international relations international organizations and human rights.
Series: Contemporary Inter-American Relations This book systematically covers the background of U.S.-Cuban relations and tensions after the Cold War into the twenty-first century. The author explores the future of this strained relationship under Obama’s presidency and in a post-Castro Cuba. Selected Contents: 1. The United States and Cuba Have Never Had Normal Relations 2. ‘Next Christmas in Havana’ 3. ‘Half Drunk and Throwing Bottles at Each Other’ 4. ‘We Need to De-Americanize the Problem of Cuba’ 5. ‘The Policy We’ve Had in Place for 50 Years Hasn’t Worked’ 6. The United States and Cuba: Comparative Reflections (Ana Covarrubias Velasco) Routledge «Market: Politics / Latin America February 2011: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-80450-9: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-80451-6: £25.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-87448-6: £90.00/14
Selected Contents: 1. The Mandate and Roles of the Council 2. The Institutional and Procedural Architecture of the Council 3. The Universal Periodic Review 4. The Legislative role of the Council 5. The Promotional and Educational Role of the Council 6. The Preventive Role of the Council 7. Fact-finding within the framework of the Council – its Special Procedures 8. The Human Rights Council and the Responsibility to Protect 9. The Advisory Committee 10. Human Rights NGOs in the Council Routledge «Market: International Organizations / Politics / Human Rights / International Law February 2011: 234x156: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-58398-5: £65.00/08 Pb: 978-0-415-58399-2: £15.99/04
4th Edition
Why People and Ideas Matter Thomas G. Weiss, The City University of New York, USA What is the current state of thinking about global governance? Can the United Nations be reformed and modernized? Is it legal, ethical or desirable for states to invade other states in the name of humanitarian intervention? Thomas G. Weiss has been contemplating these significant issues throughout the course of his illustrious career. This collection presents his most important contributions to debates (which he has often helped to frame and shape) on UN Reform, non-state actors and global governance, and humanitarian action in a turbulent world. A substantial new introduction brings these issues up-to-date and suggest fruitful new avenues for research. Thinking about Global Governance should be read by all graduate students in these areas and is an excellent resource for faculty and researchers.
çè
Routledge «Market: International Politics / Political Economy March 2011: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-78192-3: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-78193-0: £27.99/04
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Women’s Rights in the USA Policy Debates and Gender Roles Dorothy E. McBride, Florida Atlantic University, USA and Janine A. Parry, University of Arkansas, USA Women’s Rights in the USA examines the policy debates critical to women in politics. This fourth edition features updates on the most vital issues concerning women’s rights today: constitutional equality, reproduction, education, family, work, work & family, regulation and intimidation of sexuality, and economic status. Selected Contents: 1. Introduction 2. The U.S. Constitution 3. Political Resources 4. Reproduction 5. Education 6. Family 7. Work and Pay 8. Work and Family 9. Sexuality: Regulation 10. Sexuality: Intimidation 11. Economic Status Routledge «Market: Politics / Women’s Studies January 2011: 229x152: 432pp Pb: 978-0-415-80452-3: £26.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-87449-3: £26.99/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-94478-6
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Thinking about Global Governance
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
92 politics
Managing Children in Disasters Planning for Their Unique Needs Jane A. Bullock, George Haddow and Damon P. Coppola, all at Bullock and Haddow, LLC, Reston, Virginia, USA Written by seasoned FEMA professionals who developed a training course on managing children’s needs in disasters, this reference is a first-of-its-kind publication exploring the management of the care of children care during disasters. It takes a cross-disciplinary approach, addressing family structure, housing, schooling, family, mental health, and psycho-social issues. This book identifies the unique needs of children in disasters, examines the infrastructure that supports children in their daily lives, and explains how all involved parties can better prevent, prepare for, respond to, and recover from future disasters. Case studies clarifying concepts are included. CRC Press «Market: Business Management December 2010: 235x156: 374pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3766-5: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3767-2: £49.99/17
Principles of Emergency Management and Emergency Operations Centers (EOC) Michael J. Fagel, Aurora Safety, Illinois, USA The culmination of many years of experience, this book discusses the process and systems that should be considered in emergency planning and preparedness efforts. It provides critical insight helpful to those developing or revising emergency preparedness plans. The author details the needs for appropriate training and planning, both validated by a well-designed exercise program. He stresses the importance of consistency with the various national preparedness initiatives, includes definitions of terms, and examines language representative of the evolution of emergency planning. CRC Press «Market: December 2010: 235x156: 440pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3851-8: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3852-5: £49.99/17
Christianity and Party Politics *
Constructing Global Enemies
Keeping the Faith
Hegemony and Identity in International Discourses on Terrorism and Drug Prohibition
Martin Steven Series: Routledge Studies in Religion and Politics Christianity and Party Politics aims to discuss and evaluate the contemporary relationship between party politics and religion. The book focuses on the important role of the Church in both electoral politics and public policy formulation in the twenty first century, and argues that contrary to the established secularisation argument generally applied in Europe, religion continues to be a powerful influence, particularly within British politics. Providing a valuable and long overdue contribution to the field, this work will provide readers with a detailed knowledge of how the worlds of politics and religion interact.
Eva Herschinger, Universitaet der Bundeswehr Munich, Germany Series: New International Relations Examines efforts to counteract terrorism at the international level and drug prohibition policies. Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations November 2010: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-59685-5: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83638-5: £75.00/14
Constructing US Foreign Policy * The Curious Case of Cuba
Edited by Sonia Lucarelli, University of Bologna, Italy, Furio Cerutti, University of Florence, Italy and Vivien A. Schmidt Series: Routledge/GARNET series This book brings together a cluster of high profile scholars, from various disciplinary backgrounds to debate the ontological and epistemological aspects of research on identity and legitimacy formation in the EU. Routledge «Market: Politics / European Politics / Sociology December 2010: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-55100-7: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83464-0: £75.00/14
David Bernell, Oregon State University, USA
Cohesion Policy and Multi-level Governance in South East Europe Edited by Ian Bache, University of Sheffield, UK and George Andreou, Aristotle University of Thessaloniki, Greece This book considers the extent to which EU cohesion policy and related pre-accession instruments are contributing to the development of more compound polities in south east Europe and, specifically, promoting multi-level governance. This book was published as a special issue of Southeast European and Black Sea Studies.
Series: Routledge Studies in US Foreign Policy
Deleuze and World Politics
This book addresses the roots of the hostility that has characterized the United States’relationship with Cuba and has persisted for decades, even in the wake of the end of the Cold War. It answers the question of why America’s Cold War era policy toward Cuba has not substantially changed, despite a radically changed international environment. Cuba is indeed a ‘curious case,’ as the title suggests, and the book uses it to shed light on the contours and paradoxes of US policy during the Cold War and beyond.
Alter-Globalizations and Nomad Science
Routledge «Market: Foreign Policy / American History / Latin American Politics January 2011: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-78067-4: £75.00/08
Routledge «Market: European Studies / European Union Policy / Governance October 2010: 246x174: 160pp Hb: 978-0-415-59419-6: £80.00/08
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
Peter Lenco, Bielefeld University, Germany Series: Interventions Drawing on a wide variety of Deleuze’s writings, this work develops a thorough investigation of his ontology and metaphysics as they pertain to core questions of world politics such as power, identity, hierarchy, space, time, territory and the state. Deleuze’s work poses a major challenge to traditional understanding of global politics and this book will be of considerable interest to those with an interest in social and political theory, critical international relations and globalization studies. Routledge «Market: Politics / Political Theory / International Relations Theory January 2011: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-59008-2: £75.00/08
çè
Routledge «Market: Politics / Religion / Sociology December 2010: 234x156: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-55660-6: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83416-9: £75.00/14
order now!
Debating Political Identity and Legitimacy in the European Union *
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
politics 93 Democracy and Famine * Olivier Rubin, University of Copenhagen, Denmark
EU Foreign Policy and Post-Soviet Conflicts *
Fifty Years of EUTurkey Relations *
Series: Routledge Research in Comparative Politics
Stealth Intervention
A Sisyphean Story
Inspired by the work of Amartya Sen, whose influential hypothesis that democratic institutions together with a free press provide effective protection from famine, Democracy and Famine is a study combining qualitative and quantitative evidence, analysing the effect of democracy on famine prevention.
Nicu Popescu, European Council on Foreign Relations, UK
Edited by Armagan Emre Çakır
Series: Routledge Advances in European Politics This book examines EU intervention and nonintervention in conflict resolution, with a specific focus on the EU’s role in the post-soviet conflicts of Moldova, Abkhazia and South Ossetia in Georgia and Azerbaijan.
This book evaluates EU-Turkey relations in a historical perspective and focuses on the ‘delay’ in Turkey’s accession to the EU. It assesses the evolving strategies of Turkey and of the EU and addresses the political, economic, security, ethical and sociological dimensions.
Routledge «Market: European Politics / Foreign Policy / International Relations December 2010: 234x156: 160pp Hb: 978-0-415-58720-4: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83478-7: £75.00/14
Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations / European Studies / Middle East Studies December 2010: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-57963-6: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83642-2: £75.00/14
European Foreign Policy and the Challenges of Balkan Accession *
Global Ideologies and Urban Landscapes
Sovereignty Contested
Edited by Manfred B. Steger and Anne McNevin, both at RMIT University, Australia
Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations November 2010: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-59822-4: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83671-2: £75.00/14
Diversity in Europe * Dilemmas of Differential Treatment in Theory and Practice Edited by Gideon Calder, University of Newport, Wales and Emanuela Ceva, University of Pavia, Italy Series: Routledge/UACES Contemporary European Studies This book examines how European institutions address the plurality of religious faiths and ethical beliefs in a multicultural society, featuring case studies on Germany, Italy, Turkey, Spain, the Czech Republic and the UK and assesses the impact on political integration. Routledge «Market: Politics / Sociology / Ethics / Law December 2010: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-58082-3: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83711-5: £75.00/14
Gergana Noutcheva Series: Routledge/UACES Contemporary European Studies Analyses the impact of EU policy on integration in the Balkans. Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-59684-8: £75.00/08
European Security Governance in Transition Changing of the Guard
Ethnicity and Religion
Ursula Schroeder, Free University Berlin
Intersections and Comparisons
Series: Security and Governance
Edited by Joseph B. Ruane, University College Cork, Ireland and Jennifer Todd, University College Dublin, Ireland
Analyses the emergence of new forms of security governance in Europe in response to changing domestic and external challenges.
Series: Association for the Study of Nationalities
Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60159-7: £75.00/08
This book uses case studies from Ireland to France, Malaysia to Zimbabwe to evaluate the ways in which ordinary people construct their solidarities and identities in subtle and powerful ways using both ethnic and religious resources. This book was published as a special issue of Ethnopolitics . Routledge «Market: Ethnic Studies / Social Anthropology / Protest Movements November 2010: 246x174: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-60233-4: £80.00/08
@
Europeanization and Foreign Policy State Identity in Finland and Britain Juha Jokela, University of Helsinki, Finland Series: Routledge Advances in European Politics This book examines the relationship between the European Union (EU) and its member states by analysing how the process of integration in the field of foreign policy is shaping member states’ identities.
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
This book illuminates the spread of ideologies as both discursive and spatial phenomena in distinct contributions that ground their analysis in cities of the Global North and South. This book was published as a special issue of Globalizations. Routledge «Market: Urban Studies / Political Philosophy / Globalisation February 2011: 246x174: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-59863-7: £80.00/08
Globalization, Labor Export and Resistance A Study of Filipino Migrant Domestic Workers in Global Cities Ligaya Lindio-McGovern, Indiana University of Kokomo Series: Rethinking Globalizations
Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations March 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-60379-9: £75.00/08
çè
çè
for e-mail updates in your field
Series: Rethinking Globalizations
Examines international labour export of Filipino migrant workers and forms of resistance to globalization.
Routledge «Market: European Politics / International Relations / Foreign Policy December 2010: 234x156: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-57787-8: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83485-5: £75.00/14
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
Series: Routledge Advances in European Politics
International Environmental Agreements An Introduction Edited by Steinar Andresen, Elin Lerum Boasson and Geir Hønneland, all at The Fridjof Nansen Institute, Norway Series: Routledge Research in Environmental Politics Introduction to the working processes of the Agreements introduced to govern global environmental policy. Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations March 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-59825-5: £75.00/08
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
94 politics Islamization of Turkey under the AKP Rule *
Multilayered Migration Governance
Politics of Empathy
The Promise of Partnership
Ethics, Solidarity and Recognition
Edited by Birol Yesilada, Porland State University, USA and Barry Rubin, Interdisciplinary Center Herzliya, Israel
Edited by Rahel Kunz, University of Lucerne, Switzerland, Sandra Lavenex, University of Lucerne, Switzerland and Marion Panizzon, International Economic Law, University of Bern and World Trade Institute
Anthony M. Clohesy, University of Essex, UK
This book examines the decade in office of the Justice and Development Party (AKP) and its efforts to transform the Turkish republic toward a more Islamist-oriented system. This book was published as a special issue of the Turkish Studies. Routledge «Market: Politics / Middle East / Islam November 2010: 234x156: 160pp Hb: 978-0-415-56056-6: £80.00/08
Madness in International Relations *
Series: Routledge Advances in International Relations and Global Politics Examines the use of migration partnerships as a new tool in the political management of migration flows. Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations March 2011: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-59532-2: £75.00/08
Psychology, Security, and the Global Governance of Mental Health
National and European Foreign Policy
Alison Howell
Towards Europeanization
Series: Interventions
Edited by Reuben Wong, National University of Singapore and Christopher Hill, University of Cambridge
This book provides a novel approach to the study of security and global governance by demonstrating that psychological interventions are integral to global governmentality. Howell uses case studies to illustrate how therapeutic interventions are deployed in a range of global governance projects, and seeks to assess the effects of the problematization of the psyches of these populations. Routledge «Market: Politics / Development February 2011: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-57626-0: £75.00/08
Series: Routledge Advances in European Politics Examines how national foreign policies in the EU affect common EU positions in international politics. Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-61084-1: £75.00/08
Negotiation Theory and the EU The State of the Art
Migration, Nation States, and International Cooperation Edited by Randall Hansen, University of Toronto, Canada, Jobst Koehler, International Organisation for Migration, Switzerland and Jeannette Money, University of California, Davis, USA Series: Routledge Research in Transnationalism Against a background of past, limited examples of international cooperation, and ambitious hopes for extensive future efforts, this volume puts two related questions to the empirical test: under which conditions are states prepared to cooperate over international migration, and what form – bilateral, multilateral, formal, informal – will this coperation take?
Edited by Andreas Duer and Gemma Mateo, both at University of Salzburg, Austria and Daniel C. Thomas, University College Dublin, Ireland Series: Journal of European Public Policy Special Issues as Books This volume offers a thematic and forward-looking survey of cutting-edge research on EU negotiation dynamics, identifying findings to date and setting an empirical and methodological agenda for future research. This book was based on a special issue of Journal of European Public Policy.
The main argument of this book is that empathy is a necessary condition for a just, democratic and ethical politics. Empathy remains significant in a variety of fields but it remains largely unexamined within political theory. Routledge «Market: Politics / Political Theory / Political Philosophy March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-57009-1: £75.00/08
Power and Transnational Activism * Edited by Thomas Olesen, University of Aarhus, Denmark Series: Rethinking Globalizations Offering new and critical insights on global activism and power, it features case studies on China and Tibet, HIV/AIDS, climate change, child labour, the WTO, women and the UN, the global public sphere, world social forums and global civil society. Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations / Sociology / Globalization Studies November 2010: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-55369-8: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83665-1: £75.00/14
Race and US Foreign Policy The African-American Foreign Affairs Network Mark Ledwidge, University of Manchester, UK Series: Routledge Studies in US Foreign Policy The book provides cutting edge insight into the racial aspect of US foreign affairs. In addition to extending the parameters of US foreign policy literature to include race and ethnicity, the book documents case-specific analyses of the evolutionary development of the African American foreign affairs network (AAFAN). Routledge «Market: Politics / Foreign Policy March 2011: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-48211-0: £75.00/08
Routledge «Market: European Union Politics / Governance / Political Psychology November 2010: 234x156: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-59663-3: £80.00/08
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Politics April 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-88840-0: £75.00/08
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
politics 95 Regional Orders and Regional Powers
Social and Political Thought of Julius Evola *
Strategy in US Foreign Policy After the Cold War
Edited by Dirk Nabers and Nadine Godehardt, both at GIGA German Institute for Global and Area Studies
Paul Furlong
Nicholas Kitchen, London School of Economics, UK
Series: Extremism and Democracy
Series: Routledge Studies in US Foreign Policy
Julius Evola wrote over 36 books and over 1100 articles from 1924 until his death in 1974. His writing covered a vast range of subjects, from a distinctive and categorical ideological outlook and has been extremely influential on a significant number of extreme right thinkers, activists and organisations. This book is the first full length study in English to present his political thought to a wider audience, beyond that of his followers and sympathisers, and to bring into the open the study of a neglected strand of contemporary Western thought, that of traditionalism.
This book studies the debates surrounding the grand strategy of the United States following the Cold War. It assesses the strategic ideas that have been advanced to conceptualise American foreign policy, grouping these thematically under the headings of primacy, neo-isolationism and liberal multilateralism.
Routledge «Market: Political Theory / International Relations / Fascism January 2011: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-58968-0: £75.00/03
The Forum on China- Africa Cooperation (FOCAC) *
Series: Routledge/GARNET series A reconceptualization of the concept of ‘region’ and its function within power and order systems. Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60383-6: £75.00/08
Rewards for High Public Office in Europe and North America * Edited by B. Guy Peters, University of Pittsburgh, USA and Marleen Brans, Katholieke Universiteit Leuven, Belgium This book addresses an important element of public governance, and does so in a longitudinal and comparative manner. The approach enables us to make a number of interesting statements about the development of political systems and also about the differences among those systems. It provides an unique systematic investigation of both formal and informal rewards for working in high-level positions in the public sector, and seeks to determine the impacts of the choices of reward structures. Routledge «Market: Politics and Comparative Public Administration January 2011: 246x174: 400pp Hb: 978-0-415-78105-3: £75.00/03
Selected Writings of John A. Hobson 1932–1938 * The Struggle for the International Mind Edited by John M. Hobson and Colin Tyler Series: Routledge/Warwick Studies in Globalisation Previously unpublished writings of John A. Hobson. Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations December 2010: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-59823-1: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83443-5: £75.00/14
Somalia: Too Dangerous, Too Important to Ignore Edited by Brian J. Hesse, Northwest Missouri State University, USA Pirates, terrorists and humanitarian crises emanating from a failed state – Somalia is too dangerous and too important to ignore. The book was published as a special issue of the Journal of Contemporary African Studies. Routledge «Market: African Politics / International Relations / Terrorism February 2011: 246x174: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-59463-9: £80.00/08
Spatiality, Sovereignty and Carl Schmitt
The Forum on China-Africa Cooperation provides a concise introduction to an organisation that will be instrumental in the future of Africa’s relationship with the developed world, and will be of interest to students of African and Chinese politics, International Relations and International Organizations. Routledge «Market: Politics / Current Affairs / International Orgainizations December 2010: 216x138: 128pp Hb: 978-0-415-54860-1: £70.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83500-5: £70.00/14
The New Politics of European Civil Society *
Edited by Stephen Legg
Series: Routledge Studies on Democratising Europe
Series: Interventions
This multi-disciplinary book captures the evolving practices of European civil society that stretch across the local, national, European and global realm. It consolidates existing research and reviews its’ conceptual, normative and empirical-analytical foundations.
This work draws together both geographers and Schmitt experts who are attuned to the spatial dimensions of his work, in order to make a significant intervention in the fields of political geography, historical geography, critical geopolitics and critical international relations.
@
Series: Global Institutions
Geographies of the Nomos
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
for e-mail updates in your field
Ian Taylor, University of St. Andrews, UK
Edited by Ulrike Liebert, University of Bremen, Germany and Hans-Jörg Trenz, University of Oslo, Norway
Routledge «Market: Politics / Political Theory / International Relations Theory March 2011: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-60067-5: £75.00/08
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
Routledge «Market: Foreign Policy / American Politics / Strategic Studies March 2011: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-60750-6: £75.00/08
Routledge «Market: European Politics / Political Science / Sociology November 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-57845-5: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83668-2: £75.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
96 politics
The Electoral Consequences of Welfare State Retrenchment and Social Policy Performance in OECD Countries Nathalie Giger, University of Mannheim, Germany Series: Routledge/EUI Studies in the Political Economy of the Welfare State The Risk of Social Policy uses a comparative perspective to systematically analyse the effects of social policy reforms and welfare state retrenchment on voting choice. It re-examines twenty elections in OECD countries to show if and how social policy issues drive elections. Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations December 2010: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-59198-0: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83448-0: £75.00/14
EU varieties of capitalism and International Political Economy
Philippe Bourbeau, University of Ottawa
Huw Macartney, University of Manchester, UK
Series: Security and Governance
Series: Routledge/RIPE Studies in Global Political Economy
Provides an overview of the integration of migration into international security frameworks emphasizing policing and defence. Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations January 2011: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-59451-6: £75.00/08
Agonism, Restitution & Repair
Edited by Bjorn Erik Rasch, University of Oslo, Norway and George Tsebelis, University of Michigan, USA Series: Routledge/ECPR Studies in European Political Science With a strong comparative framework, this book examines fourteen countries with parliamentary or semi-presidential systems of government to provide a detailed investigation into the mechanisms by which governments determine the agendas of their parliaments.
Edited by Alexander Hirsch, University of California Santa Cruz, USA The founding of truth commissions, legal tribunals, and public confessionals in places like South Africa, Australia, Yugoslavia, and Chile have attempted to heal wounds and bring about reconciliation in societies divided by a history of violence and conflict. However this volume argues that such mechanisms of transitional justice either fall short or, worse, unwittingly perpetuate the very injustices they aim to suture. Featuring contributions from well-established scholars, and containing a wide variety of case studies including Sri Lanka, Grenada, Canada and Northern Ireland. Essential reading for all those with an interest in restorative justice, conflict resolution and peace studies. Routledge «Market: Politics / Political Theory / International Relations Theory March 2011: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-78173-2: £75.00/08
US Policy Towards Cuba *
This book provides comparative analyses of global and European banking communities, and economic research centres, in the UK, France, and Germany. It explains the current neoliberal order in global finance, and the realms of possibility for challenges to it. Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations December 2010: 234x156: 160pp Hb: 978-0-415-60150-4: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83634-7: £75.00/14
War, Identity and the Liberal State Everyday Experiences of the Geopolitical in the Armed Forces Victoria Basham Series: Interventions This book examines how the geopolitics of identity, war and liberalism are experienced and negotiated in the everyday lives of members of the armed forces, and how these experiences in turn, reinforce and sustain dominant and intersecting discourses of conflict, governance, gender, ethnicity and sexuality. The book draws on original and unique research with military personnel to take an intimate look at how soldiers negotiate, challenge, reinforce and resist the liberal state and its war machinery in their daily lives. Routledge «Market: Politics / Political Theory / International Relations Theory March 2011: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-58341-1: £75.00/08
Since the Cold War
Women in Executive Power
Jessica Gibbs, Aberystwyth University, UK
A Global Overview
Series: Routledge Studies in US Foreign Policy
Edited by Gretchen Bauer and Manon Tremblay, University of Ottawa
This is a comprehensive examination of US policy towards Cuba with a particular emphasis on the post-Cold War era. As well as providing a detailed account of US policy and actions towards Castro’s regime, the book also illustrates how this case study provides a revealing insight into wider debates about US foreign policy and international relations theory. Routledge «Market: American Politics / Foreign Policy / International Relations / Security Studies November 2010: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-43747-9: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-94612-1: £75.00/14
order now!
Variegated Neoliberalism *
A Study of Movement and Order
Theorising Post-Conflict Reconciliation
The Role of Governments in Legislative Agenda Setting *
Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations November 2010: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-48101-4: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83742-9: £75.00/14
The Securitization of Migration in the Post-Cold War Era *
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
Series: Routledge Research in Comparative Politics A comprehensive regional study of women in the political executive. Routledge «Market: Politics / International Relations March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60380-5: £75.00/08
çè
The Risk of Social Policy? *
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
Military & Strategic Studies
TOP TEN BESTSELLERS
1.
politics 97
6. Transforming Pakistan
3rd Edition
Ways Out of Instability
Masters of War
Hilary Synnott
Classical Strategic Thought
2009: 234x156: 186pp Pb: 978-0-415-56260-7: £9.99/04
Michael I. Handel
2.
2000: 234x156: 512pp Pb: 978-0-7146-8132-0: £27.99/04
7. German Unification 1989–90
2nd Edition
Documents on British Policy Overseas, Series III, Volume VII
Seapower
2009: 234x156: 592pp Hb: 978-0-415-55002-4: £90.00/08
Geoffrey Till
3.
A Guide for the Twenty-First Century 2009: 246x174: 432pp Pb: 978-0-415-48089-5: £27.99/04
8. Secret Intelligence
Understanding Counterinsurgency
A Reader Edited by Christopher Andrew, Richard J. Aldrich and Wesley K. Wark
Doctrine, Operations, and Challenges Edited by Thomas Rid and Thomas Keaney
2008: 246x174: 576pp Pb: 978-0-415-42024-2: £27.99/04
4.
2010: 246x174: 280pp Pb: 978-0-415-77765-0: £23.99/04
9. The Routledge Handbook of Security Studies
War, Peace and International Relations
Edited by Victor Mauer and Myriam Dunn Cavelty
An Introduction to Strategic History
2009: 246x174: 504pp Hb: 978-0-415-46361-4: £125.00/08
Colin S. Gray
5.
2007: 246x174: 320pp Pb: 978-0-415-38639-5: £24.99/04
10. A Reader
Handbook of Intelligence Studies
Edited by Thomas Mahnken and Joseph A. Maiolo
Edited by Loch K. Johnson
2008: 246x174: 464pp Pb: 978-0-415-77222-8: £26.99/04
2009: 246x174: 388pp Pb: 978-0-415-77783-4: £26.99/04
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Strategic Studies
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
98 military & strategic studies
Feminist Security Studies *
Political Economy of Statebuilding
A Narrative Approach Annick Wibben, University of San Francisco, USA
Power after Peace
Series: PRIO New Security Studies
Edited by Mats Berdal, King’s College London, UK and Dominik Zaum, University of Reading, UK
This book rethinks security theory from a feminist perspective, illustrating what feminist security concerns are, why they remain outside the purview of security studies, and what can be done to address them more successfully through the development of a comprehensive theoretical framework. It constitutes a major contribution to the fields of security studies and feminist IR.
Series: Routledge Studies in Intervention and Statebuilding This volume examines and evaluates the impact of international statebuilding interventions on the political economy of post-conflict countries over the past 20 years.
Selected Contents: Introduction 1. The Continuum of Violence and the Question of Survival 2. The Structure of Security Narratives and the Case of Human Security 3. Feminists Interventions and the Politics of Identity 4. Security as Narrative in the Age of Terror 5. The Future of Feminist Security Studies. Conclusion Routledge «Market: Security Studies / Feminist Theory / IR December 2010: 234x156: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-45727-9: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-45728-6: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83488-6: £85.00/14
Routledge «Market: Statebuilding / International Relations / War and Conflict Studies March 2011: 246x174: 368pp Hb: 978-0-415-60478-9: £80.00/03
Global Politics and the Responsibility to Protect *
Realism and World Politics * Edited by Ken Booth, Aberystwyth University This book contributes to the rethinking of realism through multiple analyses of the keys works of Kenneth Waltz, arguing that a sophisticated appreciation of realism is needed to truly understand world politics and International Relations.
From Words to Deeds Alex J. Bellamy, Griffith University, Australia Series: Global Politics and the Responsibility to Protect This book provides an in-depth introduction to, and analysis of, the issues relating to the implementation of the Responsibility to Protect (R2P) principle in international relations. The principal themes of this book are: • implementation challenges (especially the UN Secretary-General’s implementation agenda, the politics of implementation, and the relationship between R2P and international law) • key themes in implementation (focusing on the prevention of genocide and mass atrocities, strengthening the UN’s capacity to respond, the role of regional organizations and the place of women in the R2P agenda). The book will be of great interest to students of IR, foreign policy, security studies and politics. Routledge «Market: International Relations / Peace Studies / Security Studies December 2010: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-56735-0: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56736-7: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83716-0: £85.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
The book will be of great interest to students of IR, foreign policy, security studies and politics. Routledge «Market: IR / Security Studies / Foreign Policy December 2010: 234x156: 352pp Hb: 978-0-415-57057-2: £95.00/14 Pb: 978-0-415-57058-9: £26.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83396-4: £95.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
• the nature of the R2P principle
Bringing together a theoretically varied group of leading scholars from both sides of the Atlantic, this book is an outstanding appreciation of the work of realism’s most important theorist since the Second World War, and the persistent themes thrown up by his work over a half-century. The contributors do not engage with Waltz’s work as slavish disciples, but rather as positive critics, recognising its decisive significance in International Relations, while using the process of critical engagement to search for new or renewed understandings of unfolding global situations and new insights into long-standing problems of theory-building.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
military & strategic studies 99
The Liberal Peace
The Peace In Between
Selected Essays
Post-Conflict Violence and Peacebuilding
Michael W. Doyle, Columbia University, New York This volume comprises the key writings of Prof. Michael Doyle on the Liberal Peace, from the 1980s up to the present day. Selected Contents: 1. Kant, Liberal Legacies, and Foreign Affairs: Part I (1983) 2. Kant, Liberal Legacies, and Foreign Affairs: Part II (1983) 3. Liberalism and World Politics (1986) 4. Politics and Grand Strategy (1993) 5. The Voice of the People: Political Theorists on the International Implications of Democracy (1994) 6. One World, Many Peoples: International Justice in John Rawls’s The Law of Peoples (2006) 7. An International Liberal Community (1992) 8. A More Perfect Union? The Liberal Peace and the Challenge of Globalization (2000) 9. A Few Words on Mill, Walzer and Nonintervention (2009) 10. Conclusion: Liberal Peace revisited (2010) Routledge «Market: International Relations / Politics / Foreign Policy March 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-78174-9: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-78175-6: £22.99/04
Edited by Mats Berdal, King’s College London, UK and Astri Suhrke, Chr. Michelsen Institute, Norway Series: Conflict, Development and Peacebuilding This volume examines the causes and purposes of post-conflict violence in contemporary intra-state wars.
Routledge «Market: War and Conflict Studies / Peacebuilding / Politics March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-60932-6: £75.00/08
3rd Edition
Terrorism Versus Democracy *
The Responsibility to Protect *
The Liberal State Response
Norms, Laws and the Use of Force in International Politics
Paul Wilkinson, University of St Andrews, UK
Ramesh Thakur, University of Waterloo, Canada
Series: Cass Series on Political Violence
Series: Global Politics and the Responsibility to Protect
This acclaimed study examines both the new terror networks and those that have been around for decades. This new edition brings it up to date with the dramatic opening of the twenty first century, with new chapters on the 9/11 attacks, the growth of international terrorism, the Al-Qaeda network and the ‘War on Terror’.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Routledge «Market: International Law / Human Rights / War and Conflict Studies December 2010: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-78168-8: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-78169-5: £23.99/04
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Selected Contents: 1. Introduction to Revised 3rd Edition 2. Terrorism, Insurgency and Asymmetrical Conflict 3. The Emergence of Modern Terrorism 4. Origins and Key Characteristics of Al Qaeda 5. Politics, Diplomacy and Peace Processes: Pathways Out of Terrorism? 6. Law-Enforcement, Criminal Justice and the Liberal State 7. The Role of the Military in Combating Terrorism 8. Hostage-Taking, Sieges and Problems of Response 9. Aviation Security 10. The Media and Terrorism 11. International Cooperation Against Terrorism 12. The Future of Terrorism Routledge «Market: Terrorism / Security Studies and Politics January 2011: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-58800-3: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58799-0: £23.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83231-8: £85.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-38477-3
This volume is a collection of the key writings of Professor Ramesh Thakur on norms and laws regulating the international use of force. These essays represent the author’s writings on R2P, including reference to test cases as they arose, such as with Cyclone Nargis in Myanmar in 2008. Comprising essays by a key thinker and agent in the Responsibility to Protect debates, this book will be of much interest to students of international politics, human rights, international law, war and conflict studies, international security and IR in general.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
100 military & strategic studies
Theories of Violent Conflict
Why Did the US Invade Iraq?
An Introduction
Edited by Jane K. Cramer, University of Oregon, USA and A. Trevor Thrall, University of Michigan, Dearborn, USA
This textbook introduces students of violent conflict to a variety of prominent theoretical approaches, and to examine the ontological stances and epistemological traditions underlying these approaches. In reviewing theories of conflict, this book takes the centrality of the group as actor in contemporary conflict as a point of departure. The key role of the group in most conflicts is widely acknowledged: of the 118 conflicts that have taken place between 1989 and 2004, only 7 have been inter-state wars. We are left with three main questions from this departure point: 1. What makes a group? 2. Why and how does a group resort to violence? 3. Why and how do or don’t they stop? This book will be essential reading for students of war and conflict studies, peace studies, conflict analysis and conflict resolution, and ethnic conflict, as well as security studies and IR in general. Routledge «Market: War and Conflict Studies / IR / Security Studies March 2011: 246x174: 224pp Pb: 978-0-415-55534-0: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-86951-2: £22.99/14
War and Ideas * Selected Essays John Mueller, Ohio State University, USA This book is a collection of the key essays of Professor John Mueller on war and the role of ideas and opinions. Professor Mueller has maintained that war (and peace) are, in essence, merely ideas, and that war has waned as the notion that ‘peace’ is a decidedly good idea has gained currency. This book updates this argument, noting that as ideas have spread, war is losing out not only in the developed world, but now in the developing one, and that even civil war is in marked decline. It also assesses and critiques more recent theories arguing that this phenomenon is caused by the rising acceptance of democracy and/or capitalism. This book will be of much interest to students of international relations, security studies, foreign policy and international history. Routledge «Market: International Relations / Foreign Policy / Security Studies January 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-78176-3: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-78177-0: £23.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Series: Routledge Global Security Studies This volume presents the best scholarly thinking about why the U.S. invaded Iraq, a pivotal event in modern US foreign policy and international politics. The years since the announcement of the invasion of Iraq by George W. Bush in 2003 have revealed that the WMD threat was not the urgent threat the administration declared and that Saddam Hussein was not involved with Al Qaeda or 9/11. At least in part because of these revelations a majority of Americans (not to mention a majority of people globally) now believe that invading Iraq was a mistake and that the Bush administration misled the public to build support for war. So why did the U.S. invade Iraq? Taking a broad range of arguments – about the role of ideas, Israel, and oil, in partcular – the book highlights current areas of agreement and disagreement. The volume will be of much interest to students of the Iraq War, US foreign and security policy, strategic studies, Middle Eastern politics and IR/Security Studies in general. Routledge «Market: US Foreign Policy / Security Studies / Middle Eastern Politics March 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-78212-8: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-78213-5: £23.99/04
The Routledge Handbook of Energy Security Edited by Benjamin K. Sovacool, National University of Singapore, Singapore This Handbook focuses on energy security world-wide, examining its definition, dimensions, ways to measure and index it. The main objectives of the volume are to broaden existing discussions of energy security that center on access to fuels, focus not only on the supply side of energy but also the demand side, investigate energy security issues such as energy poverty, equity and access, and development and analyze ways to index and measure energy security progress at the national and international level. This handbook will be of much interest to students of energy policy, global security, economics/trade, environmental studies, and IR in general. Routledge «Market: Energy Policy / Global Security / International Relations December 2010: 246x174: 400pp Hb: 978-0-415-59117-1: £110.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83460-2: £110.00/14 Rising to £125.00/08 3 months after publication
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Jolle Demmers, Utrecht University, the Netherlands
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
military & strategic studies 101 Counter-Terrorism and State Political Violence
Grand Strategy and the Presidency *
Reconciliation after Terrorism
The ‘War on Terror’ as Terror
Foreign Policy, War and the American Role in the World
Edited by Alexander Spencer and Judith Renner, both at Ludwig-MaximiliansUniversity Munich
Edited by Scott Poynting, Manchester Metropolitan University and David Whyte, Liverpool University, UK
Strategy, Possibility or Absurdity?
C. Dale Walton Series: Strategy and History
Series: Routledge Critical Terrorism Studies This edited volume aims to deepen our understanding of state power through a series of case studies of political violence arising from state ‘counter-terrorism’ strategies. Routledge «Market: Critical Security / Terrorism Studies / Sociology March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60720-9: £75.00/08
This book examines the role of the Presidency in the formulation and conduct of grand strategy, and why this is important for the future of US national security. Routledge «Market: American History / Strategic Studies / Foreign Policy February 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-59832-3: £75.00/08
Humanitarian Intervention and the Responsibility to Protect *
Critical Perspectives on the Responsibility to Protect * Interrogating Theory and Practice Edited by Philip Cunliffe, University of Kent, UK Series: Routledge Studies in Intervention and Statebuilding This volume argues that the widely supported doctrine of the ‘Responsibility to Protect’ does not embody progressive values, and that it has the potential to undermine international order.
Series: Routledge Studies in Peace and Conflict Resolution This book brings together scholars from the hitherto disparate fields of terrorism and reconciliation studies to examine whether reconciliation is a possible strategy for dealing with and ending a terrorist conflict. Routledge «Market: Peace and Conflict Studies / Terrorism Studies / Politics March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-58858-4: £75.00/08
Security and Human Rights
Rethinking the Liberal Peace *
Cristina G. Badescu, University of Toronto, Canada
External Models and Local Alternatives
Series: Global Politics and the Responsibility to Protect
Edited by Shahrbanou Tadjbakhsh, Sciences Po Center for Peace and Human Security, France
This book is about the search to develop a more acceptable account of the principles and mechanisms associated with humanitarian intervention, which has become known as the ‘Responsibility to Protect’ (R2P).
Series: Cass Series on Peacekeeping This book presents a critical analysis of the liberal peace project and offers possible alternatives and models.
Routledge «Market: Human Rights / Critical Security / IR December 2010: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-58623-8: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83429-9: £75.00/14
Routledge «Market: International Relations / Security Studies / Human Rights November 2010: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-58627-6: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83454-1: £75.00/14
Routledge «Market: Peace and Conflict Studies / International Relations / Critical Security Studies February 2011: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-60055-2: £75.00/08
Gender and U.S. Foreign Policy
Law, Ethics and Security
Militarization, Resistance and the Discourse of Motherhood
Policy Challenges in the post-911 World
Russia and the Cult of State Security
Tina Managhan, Oxford Brookes University, UK
Edited by Aidan Hehir, Natasha Kuhrt and Andrew Mumford
Series: War, Politics and Experience
Series: Contemporary Security Studies
This book examines motherhood as a discursive practice in IR against the backdrop of US foreign policy formation.
This volume explores the nexus of the issues of international law and ethics in the context of the ‘War on Terror’, and the misalignment of contemporary security demands with existing law.
Routledge «Market: Gender Studies / Foreign Policy / Critical Security Studies March 2011: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-78195-4: £75.00/08
Routledge «Market: International Law / Security Studies / IR March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-60742-1: £75.00/08
The Chekist Tradition, From Lenin to Putin Julie Fedor Series: Studies in Intelligence This book explores the mythology woven around the Soviet secret police and the Russian cult of state security that has emerged from it. Routledge «Market: Russian History / Intelligence Studies / Politics March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-60933-3: £75.00/08
Seapower and the Asia-Pacific Naval Power and Expeditionary Wars
Adjusting to New Realities Edited by Geoffrey Till, Kings College London, UK and Patrick Bratton
Peripheral Campaigns and New Theatres of Naval Warfare
Series: Cass Series: Naval Policy and History
Edited by Bruce A. Elleman and S.C.M. Paine, both at US Naval War College, Newport
This volume examines the rise and fall of sea powers in the Asia-Pacific region.
Series: Cass Series: Naval Policy and History
Routledge «Market: Naval Power / Strategic Studies / Asian Politics March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-60934-0: £75.00/08
This book examines the nature and character of naval expeditionary warfare, in particular in peripheral campaigns, and the contribution of such campaigns to the achievement of strategic victory.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Naval and Military History / Strategic Studies December 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-54608-9: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83321-6: £75.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
102 military & strategic studies Statebuilding, Security-Sector Reform and the Liberal Peace
Terrorism, Identity, and Legitimacy *
The Political Economy of Peacemaking *
The Freedom of Security
The Four Waves Theory and Political Violence
Barry Ryan, University of Keele, UK
Edited by Jean Rosenfeld, UCLA, USA
Series: Routledge Studies in Intervention and Statebuilding
Series: Cass Series on Political Violence
Achim Wennmann, Graduate Institute of International and Development Studies, Switzerland
This book contextualises the rapid growth of Security Sector Reform (SSR) in state-building, and provides a critique of the liberal peace theories that lay behind it.
This edited collection is a critical examination of the significance of history, religion and ‘transcendent purpose’ on the successive waves of terror that have assaulted and shocked modern societies, and is inspired by David Rapoport’s research.
Routledge «Market: Security Studies / IR / Global Governance March 2011: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-55833-4: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-86774-7: £75.00/14
Routledge «Market: Terrorism Studies / Sociology / Conflict Studies November 2010: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-57857-8: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83432-9: £75.00/14
Terrorism and the Olympics *
Terrorist Rehabilitation and Counter-radicalisation *
Major Event Security and Lessons for the Future Edited by Anthony Richards, Peter Fussey and Andrew Silke, all at University of East London, UK Series: Cass Series on Political Violence Drawing on contributions from leading academics and practitioners in the field, this book provides an outline of the progress, problems and challenges of delivering a safe and secure Olympics in face of the growing terrorist threat to major public events. Routledge «Market: Terrorism Studies / Security Studies / Politics November 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-49939-2: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83522-7: £75.00/14
New Approaches to Counter-terrorism Edited by Lawrence Rubin, Rohan Gunaratna, IDSS, Singapore and Jolene Anne R. Jerard Series: Cass Series on Political Violence This book seeks to explore the new frontiers in counter-terrorism research, analyses and practice, focusing on the imperative to rehabilitate terrorists. Routledge «Market: International Relations / Security Studies / Diplomacy March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-58293-3: £75.00/08
Series: Conflict, Development and Peacebuilding This book focuses on the economic dimensions of peace processes, examining the opportunities and constraints associated with these issues. Routledge «Market: Peace and Conflict Studies / Development Studies / Political Economy December 2010: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-58626-9: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83517-3: £75.00/14
The Politics of Terrorism Expertise Knowledge, Power and the Media Edited by David Miller and Tom Mills Series: Routledge Critical Terrorism Studies This book provides an account of the history, geopolitics, activities and impact of the rise of the terror experts. Routledge «Market: Critical Terrorism Studies / Sociology / Politics January 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-60418-5: £75.00/08
Unipolarity and World Politics * A Theory and its Implications
The Official History of the British Civil Service * Reforming the Civil Service, Volume 1: The Fulton Years, 1966–81 Rodney Lowe, Cabinet Office, London Series: Government Official History Series This first volume of the Official History of the UK Civil Service covers its evolution from the seminal Northcote-Trevelyan Report of 1854 to the destruction of the ‘old order’ under Mrs Thatcher by 1981.
Birthe Hansen, University of Copenhagen, Denmark Series: Routledge Global Security Studies This new book offers a coherent model of a unipolar world order. Routledge «Market: Security Studies / IR / Foreign Policy January 2011: 234x156: 160pp Hb: 978-0-415-47820-5: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83230-1: £75.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: British Politics / Government January 2011: 234x156: 592pp Hb: 978-0-415-58864-5: £65.00/08
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
asian studies
TOP TEN BESTSELLERS
asian studies 103
1.
6. Chinese Politics
Women’s Movements in Asia
State, Society and the Market
Feminisms and Transnational Activism
Edited by Peter Gries and Stanley Rosen
Edited by Mina Roces and Louise Edwards
2010: 234x156: 304pp Pb: 978-0-415-56403-8: £24.99/04
2010: 234x156: 288pp Pb: 978-0-415-48703-0: £23.99/04
2.
7. Indian Political Thought
2nd Edition
The New Global Politics of the Asia Pacific
A Reader Edited by Aakash Singh and Silika Mohapatra 2010: 246x174: 328pp Pb: 978-0-415-56294-2: £25.99/04
Michael Connors, Remy Davison and Jörn Dosch 2011: 246x174: 288pp Pb: 978-0-415-46497-0: £22.99/04
3.
8. Routledge Handbook of South Asian Politics
Innovation in China
India, Pakistan, Bangladesh, Sri Lanka, and Nepal
Shang-Ling Jui
The Chinese Software Industry 2010: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-56456-4: £85.00/08
Edited by Paul R. Brass 2010: 246x174: 480pp Hb: 978-0-415-43429-4: £125.00/11
4.
9. The US-Japan Alliance
3rd Edition
Chinese Society
Balancing Soft and Hard Power in East Asia
Change, Conflict and Resistance
Edited by David Arase and Tsuneo Akaha
Edited by Elizabeth J. Perry and Mark Selden
2009: 234x156: 200pp Hb: 978-0-415-48713-9: £75.00/08
2010: 234x156: 344pp Pb: 978-0-415-56074-0: £25.99/04
5.
10. Gender and Sexuality in India
2nd Edition
South Asian Economic Development
Selling Sex in Chennai Salla Sariola 2009: 216x138: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-54915-8: £80.00/08
Moazzem Hossain, Rajat Kathuria and Iyanatul Islam
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
2009: 234x156: 288pp Pb: 978-0-415-45473-5: £25.99/04
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
104 asian studies
East Asian Transformation * On the Political Economy of Dynamism, Governance and Crisis Jeffrey Henderson, University of Bristol, UK This book brings together benchmark essays in the field of global political economy, covering the key politicaleconomic issues of East Asian development: the relation between the state and markets; the changing nature of economic governance and its relation to inequality; and the rise of China and its international consequences.
Routledge «Market: Asian Studies / Development Studies / Political Economy December 2010: 234x156: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-54791-8: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-54792-5: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83313-1: £90.00/14
Human Resource Management in China New Trends and Practices Fang Lee Cooke, RMIT University, Australia The approach to managing human resources has changed significantly in China over the last twenty-five years as its transformation from a state planned economy to a market-oriented economy continues. By adopting a broad notion of HRM, while remaining sympathetic to the strong emphasis on relationship management in the Chinese culture, Fang Lee Cooke builds on the foundations of traditional Chinese HRM practice and brings it right up to date, including analysis of currently under-explored issues such as diversity management, talent management, new pay schemes, and performance management. Routledge «Market: Chinese Business / Asian Business / Human Resource Management March 2011: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-55379-7: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-55380-3: £25.99/04
3rd Edition textbook
Government and Politics in Taiwan International Politics Dafydd Fell, SOAS, University of London, UK of the Asia Pacific Series: Routledge Research on Taiwan Series
Selected Contents: 1. Introduction 2. Authoritarian Rule 3. Transition to Democracy 4. Government and Constitutional Structure 5. Electoral Politics & Voting Behaviour 6. Party Politics 7. Competing National identities 8. Cross-Strait Relations 9. Foreign Policy Making 10. Political Economy 11. Local and Factional Politics 12. Social Welfare System 13. Social Movements 14. The Fall of the DPP and the New KMT Era 15. Challenges for Taiwan’s Democracy Routledge «Market: Asian Studies / Politics February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-57538-6: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57542-3: £22.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Michael Yahuda, University of London, UK Series: Politics in Asia The third edition of Michael Yahuda’s extremely successful textbook has been fully revised and updated, introducing students to the international politics of the Asia-Pacific region since 1945. As well as assessing the post-cold War uncertainties that challenged balance and power with the region, Yahuda also examines the first decade of the new millennium which includes no let up on the ‘war on terror’, new political administrations in all the key player-states and increased cooperative security between some nations, polarised by volatile relationships between others. Analyzing politics in terms of global, regional and local trends, this new edition includes an in-depth discussion of the Bush administration legacy and where the Obama administration’s vision takes their policy Routledge «Market: Asian Studies / International Relations and Politics January 2011: 234x156: 344pp Hb: 978-0-415-47479-5: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-47480-1: £20.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-20798-0
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Written by an experienced teacher and scholar this new textbook introduces the reader to the big questions that concern change and continuity in how politics operates and how Taiwan is governed. Thematic chapters covering all the key topics provide students with the essential background to the history and development of the political system, as well as an explanation of the key structures, processes and institutions that have shaped modern Taiwan. Government and Politics in Taiwan includes suggestions for further reading, study questions, discussion points and glossary lists of key terms and figures.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
asian studies 105
Taiwan’s Democracy Economic and Political Challenges Edited by Robert Ash, John W. Garver, Georgia Institute of Technology, USA and Penelope Prime, Mercer University, USA Series: Routledge Research on Taiwan Series This book analyses the political and economic challenges Taiwan has faced since since its democratic revolution began with the lifting of martial law in 1987. Taiwan’s Democracy will be of huge interest to students and scholars of Taiwan studies, Chinese politics and economics, international politics and economics, and development studies.
Routledge «Market: Taiwan Studies / Asian Economics / Asian Politics February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60457-4: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-60458-1: £25.99/04
Understanding India’s New Political Economy A Great Transformation? Edited by Sanjay Ruparelia and Sanjay Reddy, both at The New School for Social Research, John Harriss, Simon Fraser University, Canada and Stuart Corbridge, London School of Economics, UK This book addresses the three most important large-scale transformations that have reshaped India since 1989: the advent of liberal economic reform, the ascendance of Hindu cultural nationalism, and the empowerment of historically subordinate classes through popular democratic mobilizations. Filling a gap in the literature, it describes, explains and assesses the nexus between these central transformations in a rigorous and integrated manner.
Routledge «Market: South Asian Studies / IPE February 2011: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-59810-1: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59811-8: £24.99/04
The Routledge Atlas of South Asian Affairs Robert W. Bradnock, King’s College London, UK This Atlas highlights the global significance of South Asia in relation to economic, geopolitical and strategic interests. It provides a coherent descriptive and analytical account of the key elements of the complex societies that make up the region and its component countries.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: South Asian Studies / Geography / International Relations March 2011: 246x174: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-54512-9: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-54513-6: £23.99/04
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
106 asian studies Abandoned Japanese in Postwar Manchuria *
Buddhist Practice and Visual Culture The Visual Rhetoric of Borobudur
China’s One-Child Policy and Multiple Caregiving
The Lives of War Orphans and Wives in Two Countries
Julie Gifford, Miami University, Ohio, USA
Raising Little Suns
Series: Routledge Critical Studies in Buddhism
Esther Goh, National University of Singapore
Yeeshan Chan, Freelance Scholar
This is the first study to provide an overall interpretation of the Buddhist monument Borobudur in Indonesia. Including both the narrative reliefs and the Buddha images, the book opens up a wealth of information on Mahayana Buddhist religious ideas and practices that could have informed Borobudur and it convincingly interprets Borobudur within that context.
Series: Routledge Contemporary China Series
Series: Japan Anthropology Workshop Series This book relates the experiences of the zanryuhojin – the Japanese civilians, mostly women and children, who were abandoned in Manchuria after the end of the Second World War when Japan’s puppet state in Manchuria ended. It examines their eventual repatriation, alongside issues of war memory and war guilt, and the worldviews of the zanryu-hojin, alongside Japanese society and its anti-war social movements. Routledge «Market: Japanese History / Asian History November 2010: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-59181-2: £85.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83933-1: £85.00/14
Aesthetic Constructions of Korean Nationalism
Routledge «Market: Asian Religion / Buddhism / Southeast Asian Studies February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-78098-8: £85.00/08
Routledge «Market: Chinese Culture and Society / Asian Social Policy / Family Studies March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-60250-1: £75.00/08
Changing Power Relations in Northeast Asia
Chinese Economists on Economic Reform – Guo Shujing
Implications for Relations between Japan and South Korea
Guo Shujing
Edited by Marie Soderberg, Stockholm Economics School, Sweden
Spectacle, Politics and History
Series: European Institute of Japanese Studies East Asian Economics and Business Series
Hong Kal, York University, Canada Series: Asia’s Transformations Aesthetic Constructions of Korean Nationalism chooses expositions, museums and the urban built environment at particular moments in both colonial and postcolonial eras and analyses their discursive relations in the construction of Korean nationalism. By linking concepts of visual spectacle, space and governmentality, this book explores how visual spectacles and spaces made the nation imaginable to the public in both the past and the present; how they represented a new modality of seeing for the state and contributed to the shaping of collective identities in colonial and postcolonial Korea; and how their different modes were associated with the change in governmentality in Korea. In addressing these questions, the book interprets the politics behind the culture of displays and shows both the continuity and the transformation of spectacles as a governing technology in twentieth-century Korea. Routledge «Market: Korean Studies / Museum Studies / Heritage Studies March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60256-3: £75.00/08
The aim of this book is to analyse the JapanSouth Korean relationship from various angles such as politics, security, economics, culture and immigration issues and how the relationship is affected by the changing power relations in Northeast Asia. Understanding how Japan and Korea interact is central for anyone that wants to understand the politics of East Asia, with this in mind this volume will be of huge interest to students and scholars of Asian politics, as well as those interested in political science and peace and conflict resolution more generally. Routledge «Market: Asian Politics / Asian History / Peace Studies December 2010: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-58747-1: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83343-8
China’s Integrationist Language Policy Impact on Ethnic Harmony Edited by Gulbahar Beckett and Gerard Postiglione Series: Comparative Development and Policy in Asia
Buddhism in Australia * Traditions in Change Edited by Cristina Rocha, University of Western Sydney, Australia and Michelle Barker, Future Initiatives, Australia Series: Routledge Critical Studies in Buddhism The number of Buddhists in Australia has grown dramatically in recent years. In 2006, Buddhists accounted for 2.1 per cent of Australia’s population, almost doubling the 1996 figures, and making it the fastest growing religion in the country. This book analyses the arrival and localisation of Buddhism in Australia in the context of the globalisation of Buddhism.
This book examines the social phenomenon in contemporary urban China where grandparents from either or both paternal and maternal lineage, together with the biological parents, revolve themselves around raising the single child who is commonly referred to as ‘little sun.’
This book assesses the current state of indigenous and minority language policy in China. It considers especially language policy in the education system, including in higher education, and provides detailed case studies of how particular ethnic minorities are being affected by the integrationist approach. Routledge «Market: Chinese Studies / Asian Studies February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-59605-3: £85.00/08
Edited by The China Development Research Foundation Series: Routledge Studies on the Chinese Economy The China Development Research Foundation is one the leading economic think tanks in China, providing a base where many leading Chinese economists have developed the details of Chinese economic reform. This book is the first of a series which makes available to an English-speaking audience the work of the individual Chinese economists who were the architects of reform. Routledge «Market: China / Economics March 2011: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-58222-3: £95.00/03
Chinese Economists on Economic Reform – Xue Muqiao * Xue Muqiao, The China Development Research Foundation, China Edited by The China Development Research Foundation, China Series: Routledge Studies on the Chinese Economy This book is the first of a series which makes available to an English-speaking audience the work of the individual Chinese economists who were the architects of reform. The series provides an inside view of China’s economic reform, revealing the thinking of the reformers themselves, unlike many other books on China’s economic reform which are written by outside observers. Routledge «Market: China / Economics December 2010: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-59821-7: £85.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83724-5: £85.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Asian Religion / Buddhism / Religion in Practise November 2010: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-56818-0: £80.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-84032-0: £80.00/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
asian studies 107 China’s Southern Tang Dynasty, 937–975
Communalism and Globalization in South Asia and its Diaspora *
Contemporary Vietnam
Johannes L. Kurz, Universiti Brunei Darussalam
Edited by Deana Heath, Trinity College Dublin, Ireland and Chandana Mathur, National University of Ireland, Maynooth
Ian Jeffries, Swansea University, UK
Series: Intersections: Colonial and Postcolonial Histories Taking as its premise the belief that communalism is not a resurgence of tradition but is instead an inherently modern phenomenon, as well as a product of the fundamental agencies and ideas of modernity, and that globalization is neither a unique nor unprecedented process, this book addresses the question of whether globalization has amplified or muted processes of communalism.
This book provides full details of contemporary economic and political developments in Vietnam. Key topics covered include Vietnam’s success, in general, in maintaining high rates of growth in the face of inflation and the global financial crisis; continuing economic reforms; foreign trade and investment; battles against corruption; population growth; the Communist Party’s determined maintainance of power; and Vietnam’s response to public health problems such as AIDS, SARS and bird flu.
Routledge «Market: Asian History / South Asia / Postcolonialism December 2010: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-57364-1: £80.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83705-4: £80.00/14
Routledge «Market: South East Asian Studies / Asian Politics December 2010: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-60400-0: £85.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83437-4: £85.00/14
Conflict and Peacebuilding in Sri Lanka *
Decoding Boundaries in Contemporary Japan *
Caught in the Peace Trap?
The Koizumi Administration and Beyond
Edited by Jonathan Goodhand, University of London, UK, Jonathan Spencer, University of Edinburgh, UK and Benedikt Korf, University of Zurich – Irchel, Switzerland
Edited by Glenn D. Hook
Series: Asian States and Empires This book is the first in English to provide a comprehensive overview of the Southern Tang Dynasty (937–975). It shows that the Southern Tang was the key Chinese state of this period, preserving from the former great Tang dynasty (618–907) cultural values and artefacts which were to form the basis of the much better known Song dynasty (960–1279). Routledge «Market: Chinese History / Culture & Society March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-45496-4: £80.00/03
Chinese Migrants in Russia, Central Asia and Eastern Europe * Edited by Felix Chang and Sunnie Rucker-Chang Series: Routledge Contemporary Russia and Eastern Europe Series The countries of the former Soviet bloc – Russia, Eastern Europe and the countries of Central Asia – have a disproportionately high number of Chinese immigrants. This book provides a comprehensive overview of this migration to these countries, exploring how it has come about, discussing the motivation of the migrants and examining the significant contribution the migrants are making. Routledge «Market: Asian Studies / Migration / Politics March 2011: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-57874-5: £85.00/08
Citizens in the Making in Post-Soviet States Olena Nikolayenko Series: BASEES/Routledge Series on Russian and East European Studies This book, based on extensive original research, including new survey research amongst young people, examines young people’s political outlook in countries of the former Soviet Union, comparing and contrasting especially Russia, where authoritarianism has begun to reassert itself, and Ukraine, which experienced a democratic breakthrough in the aftermath of the Orange Revolution. Routledge «Market: Russian Studies January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-59604-6: £85.00/08
Series: Routledge Contemporary South Asia Series The period between 2001 and 2006 saw the rise and fall of an internationally supported effort to bring a protracted violent conflict in Sri Lanka to a peaceful resolution. A ceasefire agreement, signed in February 2002, was followed by six rounds of peace talks, but growing political violence, disagreements over core issues and a fragmentation of the constituencies of the key parties led to an eventual breakdown. This book brings together a unique range of perspectives on this problematic and ultimately unsuccessful peace process. Routledge «Market: South Asian Studies / Peace and Conflict Studies November 2010: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-46604-2: £80.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83824-2: £80.00/14
Constructing a Social Welfare System for All in China *
The purpose of this book is to illuminate the changing nature of contemporary Japan by decoding a range of political, economic and social boundaries, focising on the period following the inauguration of Prime Minister Koizumi Junichiro’s administration. A rapid turnover of prime ministers followed Koizumi but the transformation set in motion through his promotion of a more proactive role for Japan internationally, and the implementation of ‘structural reforms’ domestically, set the direction for future administrations. Routledge «Market: Japanese Politics / Asian Politics / Japanese Studies / International Relations December 2010: 234x156: 328pp Hb: 978-0-415-60044-6: £85.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83311-7: £85.00/14
Democratic Culture * Historical and Philosophical Essays Edited by Akeel Bilgrami Series: Critical Interventions in Theory and Praxis A collection of essays by distinguished scholars, this book delineates a substantial conception of democracy, the great promise as well as the pitfalls of a democratic mentality and culture. These essays go beyond the institutional and formal descriptions of democracy to its underlying cultural context – expressed both historically and analytically, descriptively and normatively.
This book sets out the general objectives, principles and framework of a proposed new social welfare system for China. It provides a comprehensive overview of China’s current welfare services, including retirement pensions, education, health, employment, housing and social security payments, and goes on to cost the proposed new social welfare system and assess the government’s capacity for implementing it.
@
Series: Sheffield Centre for Japanese Studies/ Routledge Series
Series: Routledge Studies on the Chinese Economy
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
for e-mail updates in your field
Series: Guides to Economic and Political Developments in Asia
China Development Research Foundation
Routledge «Market: Chinese Studies January 2011: 234x156: 416pp Hb: 978-0-415-58470-8: £95.00/08
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
A Guide to Economic and Political Developments
Routledge India November 2010: 216x138: 244pp Hb: 978-0-415-58991-8: £65.00/08
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
108 asian studies Designing History in East Asian Textbooks
Ecological Modernisation and Environmental Compliance *
Explaining Pakistan’s Foreign Policy
Edited by Gotelind Müller, University of Heidelberg, Germany
The Garments Industry in Bangladesh
Escaping India
Series: Routledge Studies in Education and Society in Asia
Shahpar Selim
Aparna Pande, Hudson Institute, USA
Based on a case study of the ready-made garments industry in Bangladesh, this book examines the complexities of introducing ethical trade practices in less developed economies as part of a supply chain in an international trade network.
Series: Routledge Contemporary South Asia Series
Routledge «Market: Asian Education / Asian History / Comparative Education March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-60252-5: £75.00/08
Development–induced Displacement, Rehabilitation and Resettlement in India
Routledge India November 2010: 216x138 Hb: 978-0-415-59819-4: £65.00/08
Economic Developments in Contemporary Russia Ian Jeffries, Swansea University, UK Series: Guides to Economic and Political Developments in Asia This book provides a comprehensive overview of economic developments in Russia since the late 1990s. Key subjects covered include economic transition, privatization and liberalization, changes in land ownership and agriculture, energy, foreign direct investment, economic stabilization, and economic performance. Routledge «Market: Russian Studies / International Economics / Economic Development December 2010: 234x156: 464pp Hb: 978-0-415-60344-7: £125.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83462-6: £125.00/14
Current Issues and Challenges
Ending Forced Labour in Myanmar
Edited by Sakarama Somayaji, and Smrithi Talwar, both at The Energy and Resources Institute (TERI), India
Engaging a Pariah Regime
Series: Routledge Contemporary South Asia Series This volume critically examines the impact of these new policy formulations, both at the level of analysis of the text of the guidelines, as well as the manner in which they have been applied across the country. Contributions by some of India’s most engaged administrators, academics, and activists in the field provide insightful interpretations, analyses and critique of land acquisition law and in-depth case studies of its application. Routledge «Market: Asian Studies / Development Studies February 2011: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-60080-4: £80.00/08
Richard Horsey Series: Routledge Contemporary Southeast Asia Series This book is an empirically rich, well-documented in-depth analysis of the interactions between an international organization and a member failing to comply with internationally agreed human rights standards. Horsey provides new insights into the internal decision-making processes of an international organization, the external pressures to which it is exposed, as well as the conduct, the logistics and the negotiation dynamics of fact finding missions. Routledge «Market: Asian Studies / Global Governance February 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-60077-4: £85.00/08
Digital Development in Korea Building an Information Society
Series: Routledge Advances in Korean Studies Digital Development in Korea analyses the communications revolution that over the past three decades has transformed South Korea from a developing nation with low teledensity to an advanced economy in the vanguard of the world’s information societies.
Food Culture in Colonial Asia A Taste of Empire Cecilia Leong-Salobir Series: Routledge Studies in the Modern History of Asia This book is a social history of colonial food practices in India, Malaysia and Singapore and of the contribution that Asian domestic servants made towards the development of this cuisine between 1858 and 1963. The author employs the media of domestic cookbooks, household management manuals, memoirs, diaries and travelogues to investigate the culinary practices in the colonial household, clubs, hill stations, hotels and restaurants. Routledge «Market: Asian Studies / History February 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-60632-5: £85.00/08
Gender, Emotions and Labour Markets – Asian and Western Perspectives * Ann Brooks, University of Adelaide, Australia and Theresa Devasahayam, Institute of Southeast Asian Studies, Singapore Series: Routledge Studies in Social and Political Thought
Routledge «Market: Asian Studies / Women’s Studies / Cultural Studies December 2010: 234x156: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-56389-5: £80.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83413-8: £80.00/14
Routledge «Market: Communication Studies / Information / Communication and Technology Studies / Korean Studies February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60646-2: £75.00/08
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Routledge «Market: Asian Studies January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-59900-9: £85.00/08
The concept of emotional labour has largely emerged from the analysis of organizations in the West. However, little has been written about the issue of what defines emotional labour and how it is configured in different cultural contexts. This book addresses this gap in the literature and considers how, and in what ways, emotional labour characterises formal and informal work environments in Southeast Asia.
Myung Oh, Konkuk University, South Korea and James Larson, Fulbright Commission, South Korea
order now!
Pakistan has over the decades become a hotbed for the terrorist ideology often referred to as Jihadism. Pandeinvestigates the underlying principles of Pakistan’s foreign policy from 1947 until the present day and explains the rise of Jihadism as an offshoot of Pakistan’s security concerns. In the eyes of Pakistan’s policy makers, Pakistan’s interests lay in ‘containing’ India, ‘seeking parity’ with India in military and political terms, ‘gaining’ allies against India and ‘escaping’ an Indian identity by disowning shared heritage. Pakistan’s policies towards India, Afghanistan, United States, China and the Muslim world reflect various aspects of this very construct.
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
This book analyses the efforts throughout East Asia to deploy education for purposes of political socialization, and in particular in order to shape notions of identity. Written by a group of international education experts chapters discuss the enduring focus on the role of curricula in inculcating homogenous visions of the national self, and indeed homogenized visions of significant ‘others’. The book also looks at the alternative approaches to textbook design, including the new trend of common textbook initiatives which operate with the aim of defusing the tensions that mutual representation have tended to fuel. It also breaks new ground in the alaysis of East Asia’s textbook wars by including contributions from scholars and curriculum developers involved in writing national and multi-national history textbooks.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
asian studies 109 Health and Religious Rituals in South Asia *
Insurgent Sepoys *
IT Development in Korea
Europe Views the Revolt of 1857
A Broadband Nirvana
Disease, Possession and Healing
Edited by Shaswati Mazumdar
Kwang-Suk Lee, SungKongHoe University, Korea
Edited by Fabrizio Ferrari, University of Chester, UK
This book documents representations of the Revolt of 1857 in India in non-English speaking Europe. It casts light on the impact of the Revolt elsewhere – its international dimension – asking the question of its probable impact on simultaneous articulations of nationalist identities in central, south and eastern Europe.
Series: Routledge Advances in Korean Studies
Series: Routledge South Asian Religion Series Drawing on original fieldwork, this book develops a fresh methodological approach to the study of indigenous understandings of disease as possession, and looks at healing rituals in different South Asian cultural contexts. Routledge «Market: Asian Religion / South Asia / History of Medicine December 2010: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-56145-7: £80.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83386-5: £80.00/14
Human Rights Discourse in North Korea *
Routledge India November 2010: 216x138 Hb: 978-0-415-59799-9: £65.00/08
Interrogating International Relations * India’s Strategic Practice and the Return of History Jayashree Vivekanandan
Post-Colonial, Marxist and Confucian Perspectives
Series: War and International Politics in South Asia
Jiyoung Song, University of Cambridge, UK Series: Routledge Advances in Korean Studies Jiyoung Song explains how North Korea has understood the concepts of human rights in its public documents since the independence in 1945 from Japan after 36 years’ colonial rule. Through active campaigns and international criticism, foreign governments and non-governmental organisations outside North Korea have been publishing numerous allegations on North Korean human rights violations. On the other hand, the efforts to engage with North Korea in order to improve the human rights situation through humanitarian assistance and to understand how North Koreans interpret human rights are often overshadowed by ‘naming and shaming’ and ‘push-until-it-collapses’ approaches. Routledge «Market: Korean Politics / Asian Politics / Human Rights December 2010: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-59394-6: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83496-1: £75.00/14
Institutional Diversity and Innovation Continuing and Emerging Patterns in Japan and China Cornelia Storz, Johann Wolfgang Goethe University, Germany and Sebastian Schäfer Series: Routledge Studies in the Growth Economies of Asia
The book interrogates the disciplinary biases that inform mainstream International Relations today. Examining the grand strategy of the Mughal empire under Akbar, it argues for a historicocultural notion of power and critiques IR’s tendency to usher in a selective ‘return of history’. Routledge India November 2010: 216x138 Hb: 978-0-415-59812-5: £65.00/08
This book investigates the contextual factors that led Korean society to broadband success and becoming the most wired nation by scrutinizing the historical contexts surrounding the Korean Information Infrastructure project, which aimed to establish a nationwide high-speed backbone network. It details the hidden mechanisms and real challeneges faced in bubuilind the national framework: the global constraints conditioning its telecom policies, the dense state – capital linkages, and the bureaucratic desire for social control. This book provides insights into how to formulate future telecom policies along much more democratically participatory lines while restraining the overwhelming power of the telecom oligopolies. It stands alone as the comprehensible study of the East Asian model of IT development, written specifically for examining Korea’s socio-historical mechanisms promoting speed and broadband mobility. Routledge «Market: Korean Studies / Information Technology March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-58746-4: £75.00/08
Japan’s Post-War
Islam and China’s Hong Kong Ethnic Identity, Muslim Networks and New Comprador Vision
Edited by Michael Lucken, Anne Bayard-Sakai and Emmanuel Lozerand, all at Institut National des Langues et Civilisations Orientales, France Translated by Arthur Stockwin
Wai Yip Ho
Series: Nissan Institute/Routledge Japanese Studies
Series: Routledge Contemporary China Series
Historical surveys of postwar Japan are usually established on the grounds that the era is already over, interpreting ‘postwar’ to be the years directly proceeding World War II. However, the contributors to this book take a unique approach to the concept of the postwar period and treat it as a network of historical time periods from the contemporary period, connecting these time capsules to the war to which they are inextricably linked. The book also takes a very interdisciplinary approach to examining post-war Japan and includes chapters centred around subjects as diverse as politics, poetry, philosophy, economics and art which serve to fill the blanks in the collective cultural memory that historical narratives leave behind. As such Japan’s Post-War will appeal to students and scholars of Japanese Studies and Modern Japanese History as well as historians studying the world after 1945.
Islam and China’s Hong Kong is a fresh and timely study examining how Muslims as a minority and their Islamic faith interweave with an East Asian global city as well as a city-state under the sovereignty of the People’s Republic China, post1997 Hong Kong. In the age of the ‘war on terror’, the wake of the transnational media networks, the global financial meltdown and the growing ethnic tension in China, this is the first book to investigate how ethnic and Chinese-speaking Muslims negotiate their identities and the increasing public attention to Islam in the postcolonial city reigned by the Chinese government. Routledge «Market: Islam / Chinese Culture / Ethnicity Studies March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-60725-4: £75.00/08
This book discusses the extent to which the diagnoses and reform recommendations of recent work on innovation theory and the related policy recommendations actually apply to Japan and China. It examines the present design and reasons underlying the Japanese and Chinese innovation systems, and based on those findings, emphasises the necessity for reform if the future competitiveness of these countries is to be secured.
Routledge «Market: Japanese History / Japanese Politics / Asian History March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60538-0: £75.00/08
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Asian Studies / Economics / Business Management January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-55455-8: £80.00/08
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
110 asian studies Learning to Labour in Post-Soviet Russia Vocational Youth in Transition Charles Walker, University of Southampton; University College London, UK Series: BASEES/Routledge Series on Russian and East European Studies This book explores the changing nature of growing-up working-class in post-Soviet Russia in a time of economic reform. Based on extensive research, it analyses the strategies of contemporary vocational education graduates and highlights their significance for wider processes of social change and social stratification in post-Soviet Russia. Routledge «Market: Russian Studies / Sociology / Business October 2010: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-47985-1: £80.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83787-0: £80.00/14
Leisure and Power in Urban China Unn Målfrid Rolandsen, University of Oslo, Norway
Media, Social Mobilisation and Mass Protests in Post-colonial Hong Kong *
Pakistan – the Political Economy of Growth, Stagnation and the State, 1991–2008
The Power of a Critical Event
Matthew McCartney, School of Oriental and African Studies, University of London, UK
Francis L.F. Lee and Joseph M. Chan, both at Chinese University of Hong Kong, Hong Kong Series: Media, Culture and Social Change in Asia Series This book discusses why the Hong Kong protest movement emerged at a specific time, how it developed from a single protest into a series collective actions, and how effective it has been in changing government policy. It argues that the news media has been crucial – more so than political parties or the movement’s organisers – in determining how the protests have developed, and it examines the possible connections between the 1 July protests in Hong Kong and the pro-democracy protests in China. Routledge «Market: Chinese Studies / Chinese Politics December 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-59606-0: £90.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83599-9: £85.00/14
Series: Routledge Contemporary China Series This book examines the kinds of leisure actitivites that urban Chinese engage in and the ways they talk about leisure, while at the same time analysing what the current party propaganda says about lesiure and the role of the local branches of the party state in the facilitation of leisure activities. Routledge «Market: Chinese Cultural Studies / Chinese Society / Leisure Studies February 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-60409-3: £75.00/08
Looking for Work in Post-Socialist China Feng Xu Series: Routledge Contemporary China Series This book examines China’s attempt to institutionalize, professionalize and humanize its approach to governance, drawing heavily on international norms and standards in employment regulation. It discusses the ways in which the government combines the new techniques with old campaign-style policy techniques, which not only makes the state’s power visible, but also allows it to claim credit for managing unemployment. Routledge «Market: Politics / Public Policy / Law January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-55968-3: £80.00/08
New Cultural Identitarian Political Movements in Developing Societies * The Bharatiya Janata Party Sebastian Schwecke, University of Göttingen, Germany Series: Routledge Advances in South Asian Studies Applying an intercultural and comparative theoretical approach across Asia and Africa, this book analyses the rise and moderation of political movements in developing societies which mobilise popular support with references to conceptions of cultural identity. The author includes not only the Hindu nationalist movement but also many Islamist political movements in a single category – New Cultural Identitarian Political Movements (NCIPM). Routledge «Market: Asian Politics / Comparative Politics / India December 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-59596-4: £85.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83390-2: £85.00/14
New Perspectives on the History and Historiography of Southeast Asia Continuing Explorations Edited by Michael Aung-Thwin, University of Hawaii at Manoa, USA and Kenneth R. Hall, Ball State University, USS This book presents new perspectives several important topics in Southeast Asian history and historiography. A unique ‘old-new’ treatment, covering the period from the ‘classical’ age to the twentieth-century, it reinterprets and revises several long-held conventional views in the field. All chapters share the approach to Southeast Asian history and historiography: namely, giving ‘agency’ to Southeast Asia in all research, analysis, writing, and interpretation.
Series: Routledge Studies in the Growth Economies of Asia This book provides a comprehensive reassessment of the development of the economy of Pakistan from independence to the present. It argues that the factors which bring about economic development in countries with high levels of deprivation are best understood by considering changing overall approaches where shifts in approaches do not always co-incide with changes in political regimes. Routledge «Market: South Asia Studies / International Politics / Asian Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-57747-2: £85.00/08
Political Developments in Contemporary Russia Ian Jeffries, Swansea University, UK Series: Guides to Economic and Political Developments in Asia This book provides a comprehensive overview of political developments in Russia since late 1999. It covers all aspects of politics including central government and elections, regional government and developments in the republics, including in Chechnya and other Caucasian republics, and human rights. Routledge «Market: Russian Studies / Russian Politics December 2010: 234x156: 608pp Hb: 978-0-415-60376-8: £125.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83446-6: £125.00/14
Political Theory and Community Building in Post-Soviet Russia * Edited by Oleg Kharkhordin, European University at St. Petersburg, Russia and Risto Alapuro, University of Helsinki, Finland Series: BASEES/Routledge Series on Russian and East European Studies This book revisits many aspects of current social science theories, such as actor-network theory and the French school of science and technology studies, to test how the theories apply in a specific situation: in this case the role of Soviet era infrastructure in the city of Cherepovets in Russia, home of Russia’s second biggest steel producer, Severstal. Routledge «Market: Russian Politics / Political Theory / Russian Studies December 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-59601-5: £90.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83524-1: £90.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Asian History / Southeast Asia January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-60083-5: £85.00/08
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
asian studies 111 Psychopharmaceuticals in India
Rural Tax Reform in China *
Stefan Ecks, University of Edinburgh, UK
Policy Processes and Institutional Change
Series: Routledge/Edinburgh South Asian Studies Series
Linda Chelan Li, City University of Hong Kong, Hong Kong
This book analyses two specific processes of globalization that have had an impact on the changing nature of doctor-patient encounters in India. One is the immense and successful growth of the global market in antidepressants over recent years, to the effect scholars speak of an ‘antidepressant era’. The other process is the rising Indian generics industry, which is to become the world largest manufacturer of generic medications by volume.
Series: Routledge Studies on China in Transition
Routledge «Market: International Health / Medical Anthropology / South Asia January 2011: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-59039-6: £80.00/08
Public Policymaking in Hong Kong Civic Engagement and State-Society Relations in a Semi-Democracy Eliza Lee, Joseph Chan, Elaine Chan, Peter Cheung, Wai Fung Lam and Wai Man Lam Series: Comparative Development and Policy in Asia This book discusses civic engagement and public policymaking in postcolonial Hong Kong. Utilizing case studies of citizens’ advisory committees involving four policy areas – urban planning, social welfare policy, environmental protection, and arts and culture policy – it examines the interaction between the state and civil society, and explores how far the state opens up its policy process for citizens’ participation. Routledge «Market: Asian Studies / Asian Politics / Public Policy March 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-57605-5: £80.00/08
This book charts the twists and turns in the change processes of a recent phase of an old practice in China: state extraction from the rural population. Using extensive interview data with local and central bureaucrats, Li’s findings highlight the role of parallel developments and agency in the change process, as well as the prevalence of contingency and uncertainty. It also elegantly blends the narrative of the rural tax and administrative reforms with theoretical discussions to deepen our understanding of policy process and institutional change in 21st century China. Routledge «Market: Chinese Studies March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-58751-8: £75.00/08
Brian Bennett
Utpal Vyas, Ritsumeikan Asia Pacific University, Japan Series: Routledge Contemporary Asia Series Soft power is overlooked in the field of international relations, dismissed as lacking relevance or robustness as a theoretical concept. This book expands upon the idea of ‘soft power’ in international relations and investigates how soft power actually functions by looking at three case studies in Japan-China relations. Routledge «Market: Asian Studies / Asian Politics / International Relations December 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-55170-0: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83579-1: £75.00/14
Security, Development and Nation-Building in Timor-Leste
The Role of Regional Cooperation
A Cross-sectoral Assessment
Series: Routledge Contemporary South Asia Series
Edited by Vandra Harris, Flinders University, Australia and Andrew John Goldsmith, University of Wollongong, Australia
The main focus of the book is to indicate how South Asia can take advantage of the rapid changes taking place in the structure of the global economy. It argues that the developing global economy will be much more complex than implied by what may be called the G2 model: that from a unipolar world the world is moving towards a bilpolar configuration with two countries – the US and China – at the center.
Series: Routledge Contemporary Southeast Asia Series This volume draws together the perspectives of practitioners, policy-makers and academics on the international efforts to rebuild the world’s newest nation. The contributors consider issues of peacebuilding, security and justice sector reform as well as human security in Timor-Leste, locating these in the broader context of building nation, stability and development.
Series: Routledge Contemporary Russia and Eastern Europe Series
Social Policy and Migration in China
This book examines the revival of Church Slavonic, relating it to a wide range of contemporary social and cultural developments in contemporary Russia, including debates about protecting Russia from western cults and culture, debates about recovering pre-revolutionary traditions and articulating Russian/Orthodox identities, and to factionalism and renewal within the Orthodox Church.
Series: Routledge Contemporary China Series
Routledge «Market: Russian Studies / Religion February 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-78063-6: £90.00/03
State, Sub-state and Non-state Relations
South Asia in the New World Order
Routledge «Market: Asian Studies / Development Studies March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-60124-5: £85.00/08
Religion and Language in Post-Soviet Russia
Soft Power in Japan-China Relations *
Lida Fan, Lakehead University, Canada This book explores the impacts of social policy on migration and makes recommendations for migration related policy making in China. Using social policy to mean the government’s regulations, stipulations and guidelines in dealing with migration issues directly and indirectly Lida Fan examines migration regulations and household registration, social welfare and insurance, employment, education, housing, medical care and industrial strategies, all of which heavily influenced migration in China both during the planned economic era and during the reform era. Routledge «Market: Chinese Studies / Chinese Culture and Society / Migration Studies March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-60782-7: £75.00/08
Shahid Javed Burki, previously Finance Minister of Pakistan and Vice President of the World Bank
Routledge «Market: Asian Politics / Asian Economics / South Asia February 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-58726-6: £80.00/08
Speaking of Epidemics in Chinese Medicine Disease and the Geographic Imagination in Late Imperial China Marta Hanson, Johns Hopkins University, USA Series: Needham Research Institute Series This book is the biography of a Chinese disease. Born in antiquity and reaching maturity during the epidemics that swept China during the seventeenth-century collapse of the Ming dynasty, the ancient notion of wenbing ‘Warm diseases’ continued to play a role even in the response of Traditional Chinese Medicine to the outbreak of SARS in 2002–3. By following wenbing from its birth to maturity and even life in modern times this book approaches the history of Chinese medicine from a new angle. It explores the possibility of replacing older narratives that stress progress and linear development with accounts that pay attention to geographic, intellectual, and cultural diversity. By doing so it integrates the history of Chinese medicine into broader historical studies in a way that has not so far been attempted, and addresses the concerns of a readership much wider than that of Chinese medicine specialists.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: History of Medicine / Chinese Medicine / Chinese History March 2011: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-60253-2: £75.00/08
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
112 asian studies Sufism and Saint Veneration in Contemporary Bangladesh
The Coal Industry in China’s Political Economy
The Heritage of Soviet Oriental Studies *
The Maijbhandaris of Chittagong
Tim Wright, University of Sheffield
Hans Harder, Heidelberg University, Germany
Series: Routledge Studies on the Chinese Economy
Series: Routledge Advances in South Asian Studies
This book examines key aspects of China’s coal industry which illustrate the political economy of China’s economic transformation. It shows how the coal industry was one of the pillars of the planned economy and how its transition to market-based operations has been particularly protracted and difficult, with particular difficulties in moving prices from the artificially low prices of the planned economy to market determined prices, and in determining financial performance where performance is affected significantly by external factors and artificially set prices.
Edited by Michael Kemper, University of Amsterdam, the Netherlands and Stephan Conermann, Bonn University, Germany
Routledge «Market: Asian Religion / South Asia / Islam January 2011: 234x156: 432pp Hb: 978-0-415-58170-7: £85.00/08
Taiwanese Business or Chinese Security Asset A Changing Pattern of Interaction between Taiwanese Businesses and Chinese Governments Chun-Yi Lee, University of Nottingham, UK Series: Routledge/Leiden Series in Modern East Asian Politics and History Combining government/business theory with empirical studies, this book is the first comprehensive work dealing with the impact of cross-Strait relations on Taiwanese business. Routledge «Market: Taiwan Studies / Chinese Politics / Political Economy March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-57593-5: £75.00/08
Taxation in ASEAN and China Edited by Nolan Sharkey, University of New South Wales, Australia Series: Routledge Studies in the Growth Economies of Asia This book gathers a cross-disciplinary group of imminent scholars who have focussed their research on Tax in ASEAN and China and traverses a wide range of regional issues and jurisdictions. Topics cover the role of DTAs in regional integration, the impact of social institutions on tax, corruption and its causes, economic development and taxation and the use of education in developing systems. Countries covered include China, Vietnam, Hong Kong, Singapore, the Philippines, Malaysia and Indonesia. Fundamentally this book sheds light on the question of whether different taxing institutions are needed in the region. Routledge «Market: Asian Economics / Asian Finance / Taxation March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60889-3: £75.00/08
order now!
Series: Routledge Contemporary Russia and Eastern Europe Series The Western field of oriental studies and orientalism – criticised by Edward Said among others for encouraging the orient to be viewed in a particular way – has a counterpart in Russia and the Soviet Union. This book examines this Russian/Soviet intellectual tradition of oriental scholarship covering Islamic history and Muslim literatures of the USSR republics of Central Asia and the Caucasus.
Routledge «Market: Chinese Studies / Development Studies / Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-49328-4: £85.00/08
Routledge «Market: Russian Studies / Russian History / Political Islam December 2010: 234x156: 336pp Hb: 978-0-415-59977-1: £85.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83275-2: £85.00/14
The Decline of Regionalism in Putin’s Russia
The Institutional Dynamics of China’s Great Transformation *
J. Paul Goode, University of Oklahoma, US
Edited by Xiaoming Huang, Victoria University of Wellington, New Zealand
Series: BASEES/Routledge Series on Russian and East European Studies This book reassesses the process whereby after 2000 Putin reversed the process by which in the 1990s power had shifted from Moscow to the regions. It focuses on the dynamics of regional boundaries: juridical boundaries, which defined a region’s territorial extent and thereby its resources; institutional boundaries that sustained regional differences; and cultural boundaries that defined the ethnic or technocratic principles on which a region could claim legitimate existence. Routledge «Market: Russian Studies / Russian Politcs / Regionalism Studies March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60807-7: £85.00/08
The Emergence of Daoism Creation of Tradition Gil Raz, Dartmouth College, USA Series: Routledge Studies in Taoism This book presents the history of early Daoism, tracing the development of the tradition between the first and the fifth centuries CE. It sheds new light on a complex and multifaceted phenomenon, the formation of Daoism as a new religion in early medieval China. Routledge «Market: Asian Religion / Taoism / Chinese Studies February 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-77849-7: £80.00/08
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
Series: China Policy Series This book examines the role of institutions in China’s recent large-scale economic, social and political transformation. Unlike existing literature, it offers perspectives from a range of disciplines to consider whether institutions form, evolve and change differently according to their historical or cultural environments and if their utilitarian functions can, and should be, observed, identified and measured in different ways. Routledge «Market: Asian Studies / Chinese Studies / Economics / Politics November 2010: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-58058-8: £85.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83687-3: £85.00/14
The Japanese Pharmaceutical Industry * Maki Umemura, Cardiff University, UK Series: Routledge Studies in the Growth Economies of Asia Charting the development of the industry from post-war devastation, through good recovery in the 1960s, and then up to the present, the book explores why Japan, despite being a world leader in many high technology industries, is only a minor player in the global pharmaceutical industry. Routledge «Market: Japanese Studies January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-58766-2: £85.00/08
çè
Focusing on the Maijbhandari movement in Chittagong, south-eastern Bangladesh, which claims the status of the only Sufi order originated in Bengal and which has gained immense popularity in recent years, this book provides a comprehensive picture of contemporary Bengali Islam in the South Asian context.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
asian studies 113 The Politics of Belonging in India Becoming Adivasi
The Spread of Tibetan Buddhism in China Charisma, Money, Enlightenment
Edited by Daniel J. Rycroft, University of East Anglia, UK and Sangeeta Dasgupta, Jawaharlal Nehru University, India Series: Routledge Contemporary South Asia Series This volume responds to the need for an interdisciplinary re-assessment of Tribal studies in postcolonial India. The volume engages in this process by defining a new field of Adivasi studies. As such it prompts a close review of the political and sociological categories of tribal peoples and Indigenous peoples. This process is driven by the relevance of the Indigenous movement worldwide to current research in India. Since the 1990s, and the formation of the International Decade of the World’s Indigenous Peoples, this movement has influenced Adivasi self-perception and self-representation. Routledge «Market: Asian Studies / Ethnic Studies February 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-60082-8: £80.00/08
Dan Smyer Yü, The Minzu University of China and the Council on International Educational Exchange, China Series: Routledge Critical Studies in Buddhism This book is concerned with contemporary Tibetan Buddhist revivals in Tibetan regions of China, interpreting the intricate entanglements of the Buddhist revivals with cultural identity, state ideology, and popular imagination of Tibetan Buddhist spirituality in contemporary China. Routledge «Market: Asian Religion / Buddhism / Chinese Religions January 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-57532-4: £75.00/08
The Theatre and the State in Singapore * Terence Chong, Institute of Southeast Asian Studies, Singapore Series: Routledge Contemporary Southeast Asia Series
The Politics of Religion in South and Southeast Asia Edited by Ishtiaq Ahmed, National University of Singapore Series: Routledge Contemporary Asia Series This book makes a contribution both to the theoretical and conceptual literature on the politics of religion as well as shed light on the implications and ramifications of the politics of religion on contemporary South Asian and Southeast Asian states. Routledge «Market: Asian Studies, February 2011: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-60227-3: £85.00/08
This book provides a comprehensive examination of the contemporary theatre field in Singapore. Based on extensive original research it provides a wealth of information on theatre in Singapore overall, not just theatre-state relations. Routledge «Market: Asian Studies / Asian Cultural Studies November 2010: 234x156: 210pp Hb: 978-0-415-58448-7: £80.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83728-3: £80.00/14
Time, History and the Religious Imaginary in South Asia
Trans-Colonial Modernities in Asia Edited by Michael Dodson, Indiana University, Bloomington, USA and Brian Hatcher, Illinois Wesleyan University, USA Series: Routledge Studies in the Modern History of Asia The generation of national cultures in colonized areas of Asia during the nineteenth and twentieth centuries has most often been traced to the cultural-textual production of emerging ‘middle-class’ elites. This book presents cuttingedge interpretations of the emergence of Asian nationalism, calling special attention to the realms of ‘national’ science, religion, and philosophy. Routledge «Market: Colonial History / Intellectual History / Asian Studies / Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-78062-9: £80.00/08
Xinjiang and China’s Rise in Central Asia * Michael Clarke, Griffith University, Australia Series: Routledge Contemporary China Series Traces the development of Xinjiang from the collapse of the Qing empire in the early twentieth century to the present, outlining the Chinese policy of integration, showing how the Chinese have pursued this through economic development and in-migration of Han Chinese, and demonstrating how the policy of integration is related to China’s concern for security and to its pursuit of increased power and influence in Central Asia. Routledge «Market: Chinese Studies February 2011: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-58456-2: £85.00/03
Anne Murphy, University of British Columbia, Canada Series: Routledge South Asian Religion Series This book addresses the contributing forces and comparative implications of the formation of religious and communitarian sensibilities as expressed through the imagination of the past, and suggest how these relate to each other within and across traditions in South Asia in the early modern period.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Asian Religion / South Asia March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-59597-1: £80.00/08
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
114 middle east studies
Gender and Violence in the Middle East *
Islamic Radicalism and Multicultural Politics *
Edited by Moha Ennaji and Fatima Sadiqi, both at Fès University, Morocco
The British Experience Tahir Abbas, University of London; Birkbeck College and University of Exeter, UK
Series: UCLA Center for Middle East Development (CMED) series This book examines the issue of gender and violence in the Middle East and North Africa. Drawing on case studies across the region, the authors examine the historical, cultural, religious, social, legal and political factors affecting the issue.
The emergence of an Islamic political radicalism in Britain has been one of the most dramatic developments in post-war society. Islamic Radicalism and Multicultural Politics explores the context behind this phenomenon, focusing on post-war immigration and integration, the complex relations that exist between Britain and Islam and the true extent of social and economic inequalities that affect Muslims.
Selected Contents: Part 1: Conceptualization and Theoretical Background Part 2: Armed Conflict and Gender Based Violence Part 3: Religious and Social Violence Against Women Part 4: Gender-Based Discrimination and Legal Reform Part 5: Language, Sexual Harassment and Media Routledge «Market: Political Science / Gender Studies / Middle Eastern Politics February 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-59410-3: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59411-0: £25.99/04
Routledge «Market: Political Science / Islamic Studies December 2010: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-57224-8: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57225-5: £23.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85004-6: £85.00/14
International Law and the Israeli-Palestinian Conflict
Libya *
Edited by Susan M. Akram, Michael Dumper, University of Exeter, UK, Michael Lynk, University of Western Ontario, Canada and Iain Scobbie, University of London Placing a rights-based approach to the Israeli-Palestinian conflict at the centre of discussions over its peaceful resolution, this book provides detailed consideration of international law and its application to political issues. Contributions from leading scholars in their respective fields give an in-depth analysis of key issues, ranging from security, through legal and political frameworks to refugees and Jerusalem.
Routledge «Market: Middle East Studies / Politics / Middle Eastern Politics December 2010: 234x156: 368pp Hb: 978-0-415-57322-1: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57323-8: £25.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83465-7: £85.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Ronald Bruce St John, Independent Scholar, USA Series: The Contemporary Middle East This book examines the socioeconomic and political development of Libya from earliest times to the present, concentrating in particular on the four decades of revolutionary rule which began in 1969. Focusing on the twin themes of continuity and change, Ronald Bruce St John emphasises the full extent to which the revolutionary government has distorted the depth and breadth of the post-1969 revolution by stressing policy change at the expense of policy continuity. Selected Contents: 1. Introduction 2. State Formation 3. Politics 4. Economics 5. International Relations 6. Conclusions Routledge «Market: Political Science / History / Middle East Studies February 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-77976-0: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-77977-7: £25.99/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
A Rights-Based Approach to Middle East Peace
Continuity and Change
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
middle east studies 115
The Israel-Palestine Conflict * Parallel Discourses Edited by Elizabeth Matthews, California State University, San Marcos, USA Series: UCLA Center for Middle East Development (CMED) series The Israel-Palestine conflict is frequently characterised by the violence between the two sides, beneath which lie a series of issues and disagreements. This book brings together Israeli and Palestinian viewpoints on key topics, providing an invaluable guide to the major issues that the peace process will be based around.
The Rise and Fall of Arab Jerusalem * Palestinian Politics and the City since 1967 Hillel Cohen, Hebrew University of Jerusalem, Israel Series: Routledge Studies on the Arab-Israeli Conflict This book examines the politics of Jerusalem since 1967 and the city’s decline as an Arab city. Covering issues such as the Old City, the barrier, planning regulations and efforts to remove Palestinians from it, the book provides a broad overview of the contemporary situation and political relations inside the Palestinian community, but also with the Israeli authorities.
Selected Contents: Part I: Issues 1. Refugees 2. Borders, Territory, and Settlements 3. Water Part II: Concepts 4. Democratization and the Domestic Political Environment 5. Human Rights 6. Peace Culture and Education
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Routledge December 2010: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-59853-8: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59854-5: £23.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83489-3: £85.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Politics / History January 2011: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-43478-2: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-43479-9: £23.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83939-3: £75.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
116 middle east studies Arabic Idioms A Corpus Based Study Ashraf Abdou, American University in Cairo, Egypt Series: Routledge Arabic Linguistics Series Idioms represent a fascinating linguistic phenomenon that has captured the attention of many linguists for decades. This book provides a corpus-based study of idioms in Modern Standard Arabic. Examining the data with regard to their semantic, discursive, lexical and grammatical properties, the author sheds light on their intricate nature, establishes the major patterns of their linguistic behaviour, and provides explanations for these patterns. Routledge «Market: Language and Linguistics / Arabic March 2011: 234x156: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-60340-9: £75.00/08
Memory and Conflict in Lebanon
A History of Arabic Sciences and Mathematics Volume 1
Series: Exeter Studies in Ethno Politics
Roshdi Rashed Series: Culture and Civilization in the Middle East This volume provides a unique primary source on the history and philosophy of mathematics and science from the mediaeval Arab world. It also includes extensive commentary from one of world’s foremost authorities on the subject. Routledge «Market: History / Mathematics / Middle East Studies July 2011: 234x156: 400pp Hb: 978-0-415-58217-9: £90.00/08
Gender in Contemporary Iran *
Being Human in Islam
Pushing the Boundaries
The Impact of the Evolutionary Worldview Damian Howard, Heythrop College, London Series: Culture and Civilization in the Middle East This examination of modern Islamic anthropology provides an account of the human being in various significant strands of Islamic religious thought since the later nineteenth century. Tracing the significance of Darwinist and other evolutionary theories in contemporary Islam, the author gives a thorough account of the variety of ways in which Islamic thought has been affected by, and responds to, the evolutionary anthropology encountered by Muslims through their interaction with occidental culture. Routledge «Market: Religion / Islam / Anthropology February 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-60368-3: £75.00/08
Edited by Roksana Bahramitash, University of Montreal, Canada and Eric Hooglund, Bates College, USA Series: Iranian Studies Iran has been a focus of international attention for much of the last decade. This book examines gender and the transformation of contemporary Iran, documenting the changes in women’s lives and challenging the idea that the revolution put back the clock for women to show how they have become agents of social change rather than victims. Routledge «Market: Political Science / Gender Studies / Middle Eastern Politics March 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-78101-5: £75.00/08
Iranian Music
Conflict and Peacemaking in Israel-Palestine * Theory and Application Sapir Handelman, Harvard University, USA Series: Routledge Studies in Middle Eastern Politics Presenting and evaluating interactive models of peacemaking and the phenomenon of intractable conflict, the book takes an in-depth look into specific models for peacemaking and applies them to the situation in Israel/Palestine. Routledge «Market: Political Science / Middle East January 2011: 216x138: 160pp Hb: 978-0-415-49215-7: £70.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83250-9: £70.00/14
Founding Figures and Commentators in Arabic Mathematics
A Century of Popular Entertainment from Motrebi to Losanjelesi Gay Breyley, Monash University, Australia and Sasan Fatemi, University of Tehran, Iran Series: Iranian Studies This book provides broad coverage of popular music in Iran in the twentieth century right up to the present day. It includes an examination of the role of popular music in Iranian society and culture as well as its ongoing development and genres. Routledge «Market: Music / Middle East Studies March 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-57512-6: £75.00/08
Islamic Revivalism in Syria The Rise and Fall of Ba’thist Secularism Line Khatib, McGill University, Canada
Remembering and Forgetting the Past Craig Larkin, University of Exeter, UK This book examines the legacy of Lebanon’s civil war and how the population has learnt to cope. The author explores the efforts of those who wish to forget and those who wish to remember, so as not to repeat past mistakes, shedding new light on trauma and the persistence of ethnic and religious hostility. Routledge «Market: Anthropology / History / Middle Eastern History March 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-58779-2: £75.00/08
Money in the Middle East and North Africa * Monetary Policy Frameworks and Strategies Edited by David Cobham, Heriot-Watt University, UK and Ghassan Dibeh, Lebanese American University in Byblos, Lebanon Series: Routledge Political Economy of the Middle East and North Africa Building on the editors’ earlier book, Monetary Policy and Central Banking in the Middle East and North Africa , this book emphasises monetary policy strategies and frameworks. It fills an important gap providing multi-country and single-country studies on monetary policy in post-civil war Lebanon, Egypt, Jordan, the Palestinian Territory and Turkey. Routledge «Market: Middle East Studies / Business Studies November 2010: 234x156: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-58768-6: £95.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83653-8: £95.00/14
Opposition and Legitimacy in the Ottoman Empire * Conspiracies and Political Cultures Florian Riedler, Independent scholar Series: SOAS/Routledge Studies on the Middle East In this account of the political culture of Ottoman rule in the late nineteenth century and the forces of opposition against it, the author examines a number of key political conspiracies and how these relate to the notion of legitimacy. In analysing the structure of these conspiracies, the motives and aims of the plotters, and their style of contestation, the author provides a detailed evaluation of Ottoman political culture of the period. Routledge «Market: History / Political History / Middle Eastern Studies December 2010: 216x138: 144pp Hb: 978-0-415-58044-1: £70.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83487-9: £70.00/14
Series: Routledge Studies in Political Islam This book describes Syria’s present day Islamic groups – particularly their social profile and ideology – as well as offering an explanation of their resurgence. It also examines the government’s shift from promoting secularism to muting secularism and co-opting Islamic sectors.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Political Science / Islamic Studies March 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-78203-6: £75.00/08
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
middle east studies 117 Palestinian Refugees * Identity, Space and Place in the Levant Edited by Are Knudsen, Chr. Michelsen Institute (CMI), Norway and Sari Hanafi, American University of Beirut, Lebanon Series: Routledge Studies on the Arab-Israeli Conflict More than four million Palestinian refugees live in protracted exile across the Middle East. Taking a regional approach to Palestinian refugee exile and alienation across the Levant, this book proposes a new understanding of the spatial and political dimensions of refugee camps across the Middle East. Routledge «Market: History / Middle Eastern History / Political Science November 2010: 234x156: 248pp Hb: 978-0-415-58046-5: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83925-6: £75.00/14
Political Liberalism in Muslim Societies Fevzi Bilgin, St Mary’s College, Maryland, USA Series: Islamic Studies Series Contrary to common expectations in the past, religious traditions have survived the process of modernization and reasserted themselves in public life. Today, religious traditions play an increasingly important public role in shaping and redefining social institutions and interactions. This book examines Rawls’s theory of political liberalism as it relates to Islamic societies where religion wields a significant social and political influence.
Surveillance and Control in Israel/Palestine *
The Moral Economy of the Madrasa *
Population, Territory and Power
Islam and Education Today
Edited by Elia Zureik and David Lyon, both at Queen’s University, Canada and Yasmeen Abu-Laban, University of Alberta, Canada
Edited by Keiko Sakurai, Waseda University, Japan and Fariba Adelkhah, Sciences Po-Ceri, France
Series: Routledge Studies in Middle Eastern Politics
Series: New Horizons in Islamic Studies
Surveillance is always a means to an end, whether that end is influence, management or entitlement. This book examines the several layers of surveillance that control the Palestinian population in Israel and the occupied territories, showing how they operate, how well they work, how they are augmented, and how in the end their chief purpose is population control.
This book provides an account of the role of Madrasas in contemporary Muslim societies across Asia, providing a nuanced understanding of their role in society within their local, national and global context.
Routledge «Market: Political Science / Sociology / Middle East Studies December 2010: 234x156: 400pp Hb: 978-0-415-58861-4: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-84596-7: £75.00/14
History and Identity in the Museum K. Hannah Holtschneider, University of Edinburgh, UK Series: Routledge Jewish Studies Series This book examines the issues surrounding the representation of Jews within the context of museum exhibitions and depictions of the Holocaust. Routledge «Market: History / Holocaust Studies / Museum Studies March 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-59714-2: £75.00/08
Qur’anic Hermeneutics
The Iran-Iraq War *
Al-Tabrisi and the Craft of Commentary
Antecedents and Conflict Escalation
Bruce Fudge, Ohio State University, USA
Jerome Donovan, Swinburne University, Australia
Series: Routledge Studies in the Qur’an
Series: Routledge Studies in Middle Eastern Politics
This is a study of one of the most important works of medieval commentary on the Qur’an which is still in use today, and an exploration of the nature of scriptural interpretation in Islam.
The conflict between Iran and Iraq was arguably the longest and one of the more costly conventional wars of the twentieth century. This book employs international relations theory to help explain one of the Middle East’s bloodiest conflicts. Using power transition and foreign policy reciprocity theory, the author develops new insights into the Iran-Iraq war.
Spiritual Purification in Islam * The Life and Works of al-Muhasibi Gavin Picken, University of Edinburgh, UK Series: Routledge Sufi Series
Unrecognized States in the International System Edited by Nina Caspersen, Lancaster University, UK and Gareth Stansfield, University of Exeter, UK
The Holocaust and Representations of Jews
Routledge «Market: Political Science / Religion / Sociology February 2011: 234x156: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-78182-4: £70.00/08
Routledge February 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-78200-5: £75.00/08
Routledge «Market: Political Science / Religion / Islamic Studies February 2011: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-58988-8: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-84078-8: £75.00/14
Series: Exeter Studies in Ethno Politics States that are not recognized in the international system are usually viewed as an anomaly. This book draws on both theory and case studies to better understand this phenomenon, demonstrating that their existence is less unusual than previously assumed Routledge «Market: Political Science / International Politics December 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-58210-0: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83451-0: £75.00/14
War and Peace in Jewish Tradition
Routledge «Market: Political Science / Middle East Studies / International Studies December 2010: 216x138: 160pp Hb: 978-0-415-57989-6: £70.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83935-5: £75.00/14
From the Ancient World to the Present Edited by Yigal Levin and Amnon Shapira, both at Ariel University Center, Israel Series: Routledge Jewish Studies Series This book shows the development of the concepts of war and peace throughout the history of Judaism from biblical to modern times. It includes historical, literary, philosophical and sociological approaches. Routledge «Market: Political Science / Religion / History / Middle Eastern History March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-58715-0: £85.00/08
Purification of the soul is a principle that is central to understanding Islamic spirituality. This book examines the work of the scholar Al-Muhasibi who lived and worked during the classical Islamic period under the Abbasids, providing a comprehensive overview of his work and its great significance in the development of Islamic spirituality.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Religion / History / Islamic Studies December 2010: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-54822-9: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83504-3: £75.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
118 law 3rd Edition
2nd Edition textbook
Commonwealth Caribbean Property Law *
Criminal Justice Research Methods Theory and Practice Gerald J. Bayens, Washburn University, Topeka, USA and Cliff Roberson, Kaplan University; and Washburn University, Topeka, Kansas, USA
Gilbert Kodilinye, University of the West Indies, Barbados ommonwealth Caribbean Property Law C sets out in a clear and concise manner the central principles of property and land law in the region in order to guide students through this often complex and confusing core subject area. The new edition has been fully updated and revised to include important new case law from the Caribbean jurisdictions. This textbook is essential reading for Caribbean LLB students as well as those on the CAPE law programme. The extensive coverage of landlord and tenant law from a Caribbean perspective, also makes this text a useful reference tool for practitioners.
Designed as a one semester introductory course in criminal justice research methods, this second edition offers important developments and updated examples in research methods and procedures. Written in an easily understood format, the book includes real-world scenarios to demonstrate research methods as well as practical and theoretical aspects for each method. Topics discussed include statistical concepts; scales, validity and reliability strategies; analytical and experimental research; interviewing; sampling; historical and archival data analyses; ethics in research; developing a research plan; program evaluation; and research and grant proposals.
Selected Contents: Creation of Leases Leasehold Covenants Assignment, Termination of Leases and Distress The Rent Restriction Acts Licences Co-ownership Condominium Restrictive Covenants Easements Mortgages Adverse Possession Sale of Land Routledge «Market: Commonwealth Law / Property Law December 2010: 234x156: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-57556-0: £75.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-84064-1: £75.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-1-8431-4644-5
CRC Press «Market: Forensics and Criminal Justice December 2010: 235x156: 292pp Pb: 978-1-4398-3696-5: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3697-2: £57.99/17
textbook
Advanced Concepts in Defensive Tactics
Criminal Law, Procedure, and Evidence
A Survival Guide for Law Enforcement
Walter P. Signorelli, John Jay College of Criminal Justice, New York, USA
Chuck Joyner, FBI, Houston, Texas, USA This ground breaking book is the first law enforcement defensive tactics publication that realistically addresses the limited training that law enforcement officers currently receive. This book concentrates on avoiding the initial attack, moving to safety, deploying a secondary weapon, and surviving the attack. Concepts are based upon extensive research, a landmark study by the International Association of Chiefs of Police, and street experience. The book stresses core concepts, proper body mechanics, and proven survival principles. Each chapter ends with drills to increase mental awareness, physical skills, and survivability tips.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
CRC Press «Market: Forensics and Criminal Justice January 2011: 235x156: 360pp Pb: 978-1-4398-5449-5: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5450-1: £82.00/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
CRC Press «Market: Law December 2010: 235x156: 280pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4500-4: £38.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4501-1: £38.99/17
In addition to delving into criminal law, procedure, and evidence, this volume considers how constitutional law shapes the legal process. Each chapter contains a problem that highlights one or more classic criminal justice issues that has the potential for compromising constitutional right, such as an automobile stop, a family dispute, or a police interrogation. These are presented from the point of view of citizens caught up in an investigation and from police attempting to enforce the law. After each problem, a series of questions are posed. The ultimate goal is to educate readers regarding liberty and security issues so that they may apply critical thinking when confronted with criminal justice issues involving constitutional principles.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
law 119 2nd Edition
2nd Edition
How the Law Works *
Managing and Coordinating Major Criminal Investigations
Gary Slapper, The Open University, UK How the Law Works is a refreshingly clear and reliable guide to today’s legal system. Offering interesting and comprehensive coverage, it makes sense of all the curious features of the law in day to day life and in current affairs. Selected Contents: 1. The Importance of Law 2. Judges 3. Lawyers 4. Cases and the Courts 5. Case Technique 6. Interpreting Acts of Parliament 7. Types of Law 8. The Jury 9. Language and Law 10. Miscellany
Routledge «Market: Law / English Law December 2010: 234x156: 280pp Pb: 978-0-415-60010-1: £14.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83336-0: £29.99/14
Robert F. Kilfeather, Sanford, Florida, USA Thoroughly updated with major revisions and expansion, this indispensible volume sets out a case management-based organizational system for working major criminal investigations. Drawing on the author’s extensive experience in the military, law enforcement, and legal arenas, it offers unique and expert insight and knowledge. Highlighting the management of complexities and the control of major investigations rather than the investigative aspects themselves, this practical reference adopts an instructional tone for law enforcement personnel to use in the field as a management, training, and development tool. CRC Press «Market: Law December 2010: 235x156: 280pp Pb: 978-1-4398-4922-4: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4923-1: £57.99/17
Drugs, Crime and Public Health
Labor Law
The Political Economy of Drug Policy
A Basic Guide to the National Labor Relations Act
Alex Stevens, University of Kent, UK
David E. Strecker, Strecker & Associates, Tulsa, Oklahoma, USA
Drugs, Crime and Public Health provides an accessible but critical discussion of recent policy on illicit drugs. Using a comparative approach – centred on the UK, but with insights and complementary data gathered from the USA and other countries – it argues that problematic drug use can only be understood in the social context in which it takes place.
Routledge «Market: Law / Criminology / Social Policy March 2011 Pb: 978-0-415-61067-4: £27.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-84416-8: £27.99/14
At times labor law can seem counterintuitive, but that does not mean it cannot or should not be understood. Whether you are a supervisor, a business owner, or an HR professional, it is essential that you understand the laws and rules governing how one treats employees and interacts with unions. This book deals with private sector labor law arising under the National Labor Relations Act. It provides a brief history of labor law in the United States before providing extensive information on the laws and regulations governing unions. It covers legal responses to unionization efforts, collective bargaining, strikes, arbitration, and what constitutes fair and unfair practices. This resource will educate you enough to let you manage with the confidence that comes from knowing the rights and obligations of employees, the company, and supervisors. It also serves as a valuable reference whenever quick advice is needed.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
CRC Press February 2011: 235x156: 216pp Hb: 978-1-4398-5594-2: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5595-9: £57.99/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
120 law 5th Edition
7th Edition
Q&A Civil Liberties & Human Rights 2011–2012
Q&A Company Law 2011–2012
Helen Fenwick, Durham University, UK and Kevin Kerrigan, Northumbria University Law School, UK
Mike Ottley, University of Greenwich, UK Series: Questions and Answers Each Q&A contains 50 questions on topics commonly found on exam papers, with answer plans and comprehensive suggested answers. The titles are written by lecturers who are also examiners, so the student gains an important insight into exactly what examiners are looking for.
Series: Questions and Answers Each Q&A contains 50 questions on topics commonly found on exam papers, with answer plans and comprehensive suggested answers. The titles are written by lecturers who are also examiners, so the student gains an important insight into exactly what examiners are looking for.
Selected Contents: Formation of Companies and Consequences of Incorporation. The Company and Insiders. The Company and Outsiders. The Directors. The Shareholders and their Rights. Share Capital. Loan Capital. Administering the Company
Selected Contents: Freedom of Expression. Official Secrecy and Freedom of Information. Freedom of Assembly and Association. Privacy. Police Powers and the Rights of Suspects. Prisoners’ Rights. Freedom of Movement. Freedom From Discrimination. The Human Rights Act 1998 and the European Convention on Human Rights Routledge «Market: Law / Human Rights Law and Civil Liberties January 2011: 220x152 : 400pp Pb: 978-0-415-48329-2: £12.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-43213-9
Routledge «Market: Law / Revision Guides and Company Law January 2011: 220x152 : 280pp Pb: 978-0-415-59908-5: £12.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-48331-5
6th Edition
7th Edition
Q&A Commercial Law 2011–2012 Q&A Constitutional & Jo Reddy Administrative Law 2011–2012 Series: Questions and Answers
Selected Contents: General Questions. Description and Quality. Passing of Property and Risk. Nemo Dat Quod Non Habet. Making and Cancelling a Credit Agreement. Default and Termination of Credit Agreements. Connected Lender Liability. General Principles of Agency. Relationship with Third Parties. FOB Contracts. CIF Contracts Routledge «Market: Law / Revision Guides and Commercial Law January 2011: 220x152: 272pp Pb: 978-0-415-59324-3: £12.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83286-8: £12.99/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-48041-3
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Helen Fenwick and Gavin Phillipson, Durham University, UK Series: Questions and Answers Each Q&A contains 50 questions on topics commonly found on exam papers, with answer plans and comprehensive suggested answers. The titles are written by lecturers who are also examiners, so the student gains an important insight into exactly what examiners are looking for.
Selected Contents: The Characteristics of the British Constitution. Parliamentary Sovereignty, the Human Rights Act and the European Union. The House of Commons. The House of Lords. Prerogative Powers. The Executive. Judicial Review. Ombudsmen. Protection for Human Rights. Freedom of Expression and Freedom of Information. The Individual and the State: Police Powers Routledge «Market: Law / Revision Guides and Constitutional and Administrative Law January 2011: 220x152: 440pp Pb: 978-0-415-59909-2: £12.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-48374-2
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Each Q&A contains 50 questions on topics commonly found on exam papers, with answer plans and comprehensive suggested answers. The titles are written by lecturers who are also examiners, so the student gains an important insight into exactly what examiners are looking for.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
law 121 9th Edition
7th Edition
Q&A Contract Law 2011–2012
Q&A Employment Law 2011–2012
Richard Stone, University of Lincoln, UK
Deborah Lockton, De Montfort University, UK
Series: Questions and Answers
Series: Questions and Answers
Each Q&A contains 50 questions on topics commonly found on exam papers, with answer plans and comprehensive suggested answers. The titles are written by lecturers who are also examiners, so the student gains an important insight into exactly what examiners are looking for.
Each Q&A contains 50 questions on topics commonly found on exam papers, with answer plans and comprehensive suggested answers. The titles are written by lecturers who are also examiners, so the student gains an important insight into exactly what examiners are looking for.
Selected Contents: Offer and Acceptance. Intention and Consideration. Privity. Capacity. Contents of the Contract. Exclusion Clauses. Mistake and Misrepresentation. Duress and Undue Influence. Illegality. Frustration. Performance and Breach. Remedies. Quasi-Contract and Restitution. Agency. Sale of Goods Routledge «Market: Law / Revision Guides and Contract Law January 2011: 220x152: 272pp Pb: 978-0-415-59325-0: £12.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-48167-0
Selected Contents: Institutions of Employment Law. Nature of the Relationship. Sources of Contractual Terms. Implied Duties. Discrimination. Equal Pay. Employment Protection. Termination at Common Law. Unfair Dismissal. Redundancy. Trade Unions and their Members. Trade Unions and industrial Action Routledge «Market: Law / Revision Guides and Employment Law January 2011: 220x152: 312pp Pb: 978-0-415-59321-2: £12.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83283-7: £12.99/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-48284-4
8th Edition
9th Edition
Q&A Criminal Law 2011–2012
Q&A English Legal System 2011–2012
Norman Baird, University of London External Laws Programme Series: Questions and Answers Each Q&A contains 50 questions on topics commonly found on exam papers, with answer plans and comprehensive suggested answers. The titles are written by lecturers who are also examiners, so the student gains an important insight into exactly what examiners are looking for.
Gary Slapper, The Open University, UK and David Kelly, Staffordshire University, UK Series: Questions and Answers Each Q&A contains 50 questions on topics commonly found on exam papers, with answer plans and comprehensive suggested answers. The titles are written by lecturers who are also examiners, so the student gains an important insight into exactly what examiners are looking for.
Selected Contents: General Principles of Criminal Law. Fatal and Non-Fatal Offences Against the Person. General Defences. Modes of Participation, Inchoate Offences and Various Liability. Offences Against Property
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Routledge «Market: Law and The English Legal System January 2011: 220x152: 272pp Pb: 978-0-415-59911-5: £12.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83192-2: £12.99/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-48032-1
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Law / Revision and Study Guides January 2011: 220x152: 272pp Pb: 978-0-415-59910-8: £12.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-48363-6
Selected Contents: Sources of Law and Legal Reform. The Courts and the Apellate Process. Judicial Reasoning. Judges and Juries. The Criminal Process. Civil Process and Legal Services. Alternative Dispute Resolution. The Rule of Law. Judicial Review and Human Rights
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
122 law 7th Edition
9th Edition
Q&A Equity & Trusts 2011–2012
Q&A Evidence 2011–2012
Mohamed Ramjohn, Thames Valley University, UK
Christopher Allen, Formerly at City University, UK
Series: Questions and Answers
Series: Questions and Answers
Each Q&A contains 50 questions on topics commonly found on exam papers, with answer plans and comprehensive suggested answers. The titles are written by lecturers who are also examiners, so the student gains an important insight into exactly what examiners are looking for.
Each Q&A contains 50 questions on topics commonly found on exam papers, with answer plans and comprehensive suggested answers. The titles are written by lecturers who are also examiners, so the student gains an important insight into exactly what examiners are looking for.
Selected Contents: The Creation of Trusts. Secret Trusts. The Three Certainties and the Beneficiary Principle. The Law of Charities. Resulting Trusts. Constructive Trusts 1: Not to Profit and Co-ownership. Constructive Trusts 2: The Liability of Strangers. The Law of Tracing. Breach of Trust. The Office of Trustee and its Powers and Duties Routledge «Market: Law / Equity and Trusts Law January 2011: 234x156: 264pp Pb: 978-0-415-59912-2: £12.99/04
Selected Contents: 1. Basic Concepts 2. Burden and Standard of Proof 3. Presumptions, Competence and Compellability 4. Hearsay I 5. Hearsay II 6. Hazardous Evidence 7. Confessions and Ill-Gotten Evidence 8. Character Evidence I 9. Character Evidence II 10. The Course of Testimony 11. Opinion Evidence 12. Privilege and Public Policy 13. Revision Routledge «Market: Law / Evidence January 2011: 220x152: 232pp Pb: 978-0-415-59830-9: £12.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83282-0: £12.99/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-48364-3
8th Edition
6th Edition
Q&A European Union Law 2011–2012
Q&A Family Law 2010–2011 Series: Questions and Answers Each Q&A contains 50 questions on topics commonly found on exam papers, with answer plans and comprehensive suggested answers. The titles are written by lecturers who are also examiners, so the student gains an important insight into exactly what examiners are looking for.
Series: Questions and Answers Each Q&A contains 50 questions on topics commonly found on exam papers, with answer plans and comprehensive suggested answers. The titles are written by lecturers who are also examiners, so the student gains an important insight into exactly what examiners are looking for. Selected Contents: Community Institutions. Sources of Law. EC Law and National Law. Judicial Remedies and Review (1): Direct Actions. Judicial Remedies and Review (2): Indirect Action – Preliminary References. The Free Movement of Goods. Competition Policy. The Free Movement of Workers. The Freedom of Establishment and the Freedom to Provide Services. Freedom from Discrimination. External Relations. The Internal Market and Beyond Routledge «Market: Law / European Union Law / Revision January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Pb: 978-0-415-59913-9: £12.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-48271-4
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Selected Contents: Nullity of Marriage. Divorce. Financial Provision Within Marriage. Financial Provision on Divorce. Property Disputes. Domestic Violence. Parental Responsibility and Disputes. Children on Divorce. Children and the Local Authority. Adoption. Overview Routledge «Market: Family Law and Revision January 2011: 234x156: 248pp Pb: 978-0-415-59914-6: £12.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-48365-0
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Michael Cuthbert, University of Northampton, UK
Rachael Stretch, Nottingham Trent University, UK
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
law 123 5th Edition
9th Edition
Q&A Jurisprudence 2011–2012
Q&A Torts 2011–2012
David Brooke, Leeds Metropolitan University, UK
Jason Lowther, University of Plymouth, UK
Series: Questions and Answers
Series: Questions and Answers
Each Q&A contains 50 questions on topics commonly found on exam papers, with answer plans and comprehensive suggested answers. The titles are written by lecturers who are also examiners, so the student gains an important insight into exactly what examiners are looking for. Selected Contents: General Aspects of Jurisprudence. Precursors of Modern Jurisprudence. Natural Law. Transcendental Idealism. Utilitarianism. Legal Positivism. Historical Jurisprudence. The Sociological Movement in Jurisprudence. Marxist Jurisprudence. Scandinavian Realism. American Realism. Contemporary American Jurisprudence. Rights. Law and Morality. Feminist Jurisprudence Routledge «Market: Law / Revision Guides / Jurisprudence January 2011: 220x152: 312pp Pb: 978-0-415-59915-3: £12.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83280-6: £12.99/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-48285-1
Each Q&A contains 50 questions on topics commonly found on exam papers, with answer plans and comprehensive suggested answers. The titles are written by lecturers who are also examiners, so the student gains an important insight into exactly what examiners are looking for. Selected Contents: Vicarious Liability. Negligence – Duty of Care Generally and Restricted Situations. Negligence – Breach, Causation and Remoteness of Damage. Breach of Statutory Duty. Employers’ Liability. Product Liability. Occupiers’ Liability. Nuisance. The Rule in Rylands v Fletcher and Fire. Animals. Defamation and Privacy. Trespass to the Person, to Land and to Goods. Economic Torts Routledge «Market: Law / Revision Guides / Tort law January 2011: 220x152: 288pp Pb: 978-0-415-59917-7: £12.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83220-2: £12.99/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-48372-8
7th Edition
Q&A Land Law 2011–2012
Q&A Medical Law 2011–2012
Series: Questions and Answers
Jonathan Herring, University of Oxford, UK
çè
Selected Contents: Introduction 1. Registered Land 2. Unregistered Land 3. Co-ownership 4. Successive Interests in Land 5. Leases 6. Licences and Proprietary Estoppel 7. Easements 8. Freehold Covenants 9. The Law of Mortgages 10. Miscellaneous Problems Routledge «Market: Law / Revision Guides and Land Law January 2011: 220x152: 264pp Pb: 978-0-415-59916-0: £12.99/04
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Series: Questions and Answers Each Routledge Q&A contains approximately fifty essay and problembased questions on topics commonly found on exam papers, complete with answer plans and fully worked model answers. The titles are written by lecturers who are also examiners, so you can recognise exactly what examiners are looking for in an answer. Selected Contents: 1. Medical Negligence 2. Rationing 3. Consent and Capacity 4. Confidentiality 5. Abortion and Pregnancy 6. Assisted Reproduction 7. Ownership of Bodies 8. End of Life 9. Mental Health 10. Medical Research 11. General Questions Routledge «Market: Law / Medical Law January 2011: 220x152: 320pp Pb: 978-0-415-57541-6: £12.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83225-7: £12.99/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Each Routledge Q&A contains approximately fifty essay and problembased questions on topics commonly found on exam papers, complete with answer plans and fully worked model answers. The titles are written by lecturers who are also examiners, so you can recognise exactly what examiners are looking for in an answer.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
124 law
Rethinking Rape Law * International and Comparative Perspectives Edited by Clare McGlynn, Durham University, UK and Vanessa E. Munro, University of Nottingham, UK Rethinking Rape Law: International and Comparative Perspectives provides a comprehensive and critical analysis of contemporary rape laws. Written by leading authors from across the world, this is the first authoritative text on rape law that crosses jurisdictions, examines its conceptual and theoretical foundations, and sets the law in its policy context. It is destined to become the primary source for scholarly work and debate on sexual offences laws.
Routledge «Market: Law / Criminology / Gender Studies January 2011: 234x156: 368pp Pb: 978-0-415-61066-7: £27.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85219-4: £85.00/14
textbook
The Rule of Reason in European Constitutionalism and Citizenship * Yuri Borgmann-Prebil, University of Sussex, UK Series: Discourses of Law Identifying crucial deficiencies in the legal theories of Hart and Dworkin, The Rule of Reason in European Constitutionalism and Citizenship draws on the work of Habermas and Alexy in order to elaborate a new juridical conception of citizenship. Taking Europe as its focus, the central substantive argument of the book is that a ‘rule of reason’ governs supranational constitutionalism. Offering an innovative theoretical analysis of EU law, this book will be of considerable interest to scholars of European law, European politics and legal theory. Selected Contents: Introduction. Chapter 1: Constitutional Conflict in the Light of Legal Theory, ‘Only in exchanges with others can I fix’. Chapter 2: A Rights Approach to the Free Movement Provisions: The Rule of Reason. Chapter 3: The Rule of Reason in European Citizenship. Chapter 4: A Juridical Conception of European Citizenship Routledge «Market: Law / Politics / European Studies March 2011: 234x156: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-56529-5: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56530-1: £21.99/04
The Study of Violent Crime Its Correlates and Concerns Scott Mire, University of Louisiana at Lafayette, USA and Cliff Roberson, Kaplan University; and Washburn University, Topeka, Kansas, USA Presenting a clear definition of violent crime, its correlates, and its impacts, this text covers historical trends, poverty and abuse, sociological theory, psychological theory, biological factors, and institutional influences. Written in an easily accessible format, the classic textbook layout provides over 150 photos, action boxes, case studies, tables and charts, references, and a glossary. Each chapter includes an outline, key concepts and issues, and review questions, and a companion website provides interactive learning, updates, study guides, and related references. An ancillary package for instructors is available with qualifying course adoption.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
CRC Press December 2010: 235x156: 236pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0747-7: £44.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0748-4: £49.99/17
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
law 125 Aboriginal Customary Law
Cosmopolitan Justice and its Discontents
A Source of Common Law Title to Land Ulla Secher, James Cook University, Australia Aboriginal Customary Law presents a comprehensive work addressing the potential legal consequences for Aboriginal rights to land, beyond recognition of native title, ensuing from acknowledgement of the Crown’s radical title. Routledge «Market: Law / Development Studies January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-44164-3: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-94073-0: £75.00/14
Anarchism and Sexuality Ethics, Relationships and Power Edited by Jamie Heckert and Richard Cleminson, University of Leeds, UK Series: Social Justice Anarchism and Sexuality: Dangerous Desires brings the rich traditions of anarchist thought and practice to contemporary questions about the politics of sexuality. Drawing contemporary inspiration from the rise of the global justice movement, and the corresponding wave of anarchist scholarship, this book is a timely intervention in contemporary discussions about putting ethics into practice. Anarchism and Sexuality engages current debates on gender equality, sexual violence, control of one’s own body and the interface of these dimensions with social mores, laws and other constraints, as it proposes a new engagement between the politics of anarchism and that of sexuality. Routledge «Market: Law / Sociology / Cultural Studies February 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-59989-4: £75.00/08
Bioethics Methods, Theories, Scopes Marcus Düwell, Utrecht University, the Netherlands Series: Biomedical Law & Ethics Library This book is a philosophically-oriented introduction to bioethics. It offers the reader an overview of key current debates in bioethics but the book also provides the reader with the methodological and theoretical tools for a more comprehensive understanding of bioethical debates and situates the areas of ethics into their philosophical context.
Edited by Cecilia Bailliet and Katja Franko Aas, both at University of Oslo, Norway Cosmopolitan Justice and its Discontents provides a multidisciplinary perspective on the legal and ethical implications of cosmopolitanism. Cosmopolitanism has had a direct impact on the evolution of international law. And cosmopolitan ideas about justice have expanded the scope and social dynamics of legal and institutional orders at the local, national, and international levels. But cosmopolitan justice evolves in and inhabits a world of unequal power relations. Organised around the three major themes of ‘Cosmopolitanism, Sovereignty and New Institutions’, ‘Human Rights, Difference and Exclusion’, and ‘Global Markets and Fairness’, Cosmopolitan Justice and its Discontents addresses the difficulties currently facing cosmopolitan justice. Routledge «Market: Law / Politics March 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-59343-4: £75.00/08
Cultural Expertise and Litigation Patterns, Conflicts, Narratives Edited by Livia Holden Cultural Expertise and Litigation addresses the issues surrounding the legal role of social scientists that provide evidence in cases related to minority groups and migration. In various circumstances, non-western laws and practices are regularly interpreted in western courts. Marriages, divorces, adoptions and other legal facts, whose legitimacy is uncontested locally, can be declared invalid: with consequences going beyond the geographic boundaries of the legal regimes of the west, in what now appears as the emergence of a specific kind of trans-cultural or transnational legal case. Focusing particularly on South Asian migrants in Europe and in North America, this book focuses on how, in such cases, social scientific experts – who do not per se belong to the formal setting of the law but are nevertheless bound to it – transform ‘culture’ into law. Routledge «Market: Law / Anthropology February 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-60156-6: £75.00/08
Child Pornography
Series: Nomikoi Critical Legal Thinkers
Law and Policy
Deleuze & Guattari: Emergent Law is an exposition and development of Deleuze & Guattari’s legal theory. Although there has been considerable interest in Deleuze & Guattari in critical legal studies, as well as considerable interest in legality in Deleuze & Guattari studies, this is the first book to focus exclusively on Deleuze & Guattari and law.
Jamie Murray, Liverpool John Moores University, UK
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
Routledge «Market: Law / Criminology December 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-55034-5: £75.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83588-3: £75.00/14
Forensic Interviewing and Personality Disorders Philip Erdberg, University of California, Corte Madera, California, USA, Craig N. Ackley, FBI Special Agent, Quantico, Kristen Beyer, National Center for the Analysis of Violent Crime, Quantico and Shannon M. Mack, Marymount University, Maryland, USA Experienced investigators know that taking an interviewee’s personality into account can lead to a more productive interview outcome. This volume provides a window into the personality types most commonly encountered in the legal system and demonstrates how to use this insight to plan and conduct effective interviews. The personality types include narcissistic, antisocial, psychopathic, borderline, inadequate/immature, paranoid, and schizotypal. The book is designed for law enforcement officers, attorneys, probation and parole officers, mental health workers, and anyone else who interviews witnesses, suspects, and offenders throughout the legal system. CRC Press «Market: Law December 2010: 229x152: 192pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8425-2: £44.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8427-6: £44.99/17
Bringing together an international range of academics, Gender, Law and Sexualities provides a comprehensive interrogation of the range of issues – both topical and controversial – raised by the gendered character of law and legal discourse. Routledge «Market: Law / Gender Studies March 2011: 234x156: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-57439-6: £85.00/03
Routledge «Market: Law / Philosophy / Social Theory March 2011: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-49601-8: £70.00/03
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Law / Social Policy March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-49987-3: £70.00/03
Escape Routes: Contemporary Perspectives on Life After Punishment addresses the reasons why people stop offending, and the processes by which they are rehabilitated or resettled back into the community. Engaging with, and building upon, renewed criminological interest in this area, it nevertheless broadens and enlivens the current debate.
Edited by Jackie Jones, University of the West of England, UK, Anna Grear, Bristol University, UK, Kim Stevenson, University of Plymouth, UK and Rachel Fenton, University of the West of England, UK
Deleuze & Guattari: Emergent Law *
Child Pornography: Law and Policy draws on interdisciplinary work in to order to critically address the law relating to child pornography.
Edited by Stephen Farrall, University of Keele, UK, Richard Sparks, University of Edinburgh, UK, Shadd Maruna, Queen’s University Belfast, UK and Mike Hough, Kings College London, UK
Gender, Law and Sexualities *
Routledge «Market: Law / Philosophy March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60991-3: £85.00/03
Alisdair A Gillespie, De Montfort University, UK
Escape Routes: Contemporary Perspectives on Life after Punishment *
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
126 law Globalisation and the Quest for Social and Environmental Justice *
Law and Power in Foreign Investment in Africa
Legal Architecture *
The Relevance of International Law in an Evolving World Order
Shades of Grey in the Shadow of the Law
Linda Mulcahy, University of London, UK
Lorenzo Cotula, International Institute for Environment and Development (IIED)
Legal Architecture addresses how the environment in which the trial takes place can be seen as a physical expression of our relationship with ideals of justice; as it approaches the history of courthouse design as a reflection of the troubled history of notions of due process.
The book is an exploration of the intricate nexus that emerges as a result of globalisation, linking together issues of international law, human rights, environmental law and international trade law. Bringing together experts in the field, the book focuses on the areas of social justice, environmental justice and globalisation. Routledge «Market: Law / Politics / Environmental Studies / Environmental Politics November 2010: 234x156: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-49910-1: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83692-7: £75.00/14
Human Rights in the Asia-Pacific Region
Series: Routledge Research in International Economic Law This book explores how the law protects the different and competing interests that are brought into contact by foreign investment projects in Africa. The book analyses the negotiating power between different holders of legally protected rights such as investors, local people affected by the investment, exploring whether any differences in legal protection tend to counter, or reinforce, asymmetries in negotiating power. Routledge «Market: Law / Development Studies March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60990-6: £75.00/08
Law and the Wearing of Religious Symbols
Towards Institution Building Edited by Hitoshi Nasu, Australian National University, Australia and Ben Saul Series: Routledge Research in Human Rights Law This edited collection makes a timely contribution to contemporary debates about strengthening the institutional protection of human rights in the Asia-Pacific region. The book critically examines the prospects for deepening and widening the institutionalization of human rights monitoring in the region, challenging the orthodox scepticism about whether Asia is ‘ready’ for stronger institutions. Routledge «Market: Law / Human Rights / Asian Studies March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60254-9: £75.00/08
European Bans on the Wearing of Religious Symbols in Education Erica Howard, Middlesex University, UK Schools and some universities in countries across Europe have banned the wearing of religious symbols and dress by teachers and/or pupils. This book looks at countries in Europe, analysing existing legislation and case law concerning the bans, and explores whether the way they are made at present is satisfactory. Routledge «Market: Law / Religion / Education / Human Rights March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60264-8: £75.00/03
Law, Complexity and Globalisation
Law and Ecology *
Julian Webb, University of Warwick, UK
New Environmental Foundations
Series: Law, Science and Society
Edited by Andreas Philippopoulos-Mihalopoulos, University of Westminster, UK
Recent work in complexity theory has shown how it can transcend the status inherent in classical functionalist thinking about the social order, by stressing the fluid, heterogeneous, unpredictable and increasingly global ordering of the social world.
Law and Ecology: New Environmental Legal Foundations contains a series of theoretical and applied perspectives on the connection between law and ecology, which together offer a radical and socially responsive foundation for environmental law. Routledge «Market: Law / Environmental Studies January 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-58713-6: £75.00/08
Routledge «Market: Law / Sociology / Social Theory January 2011: 234x156: 300pp Hb: 978-1-84472-033-0: £70.00/03
Law, Ethics and the Biopolitical * Amy Swiffen, Concordia University, Canada Law, Ethics and the Biopolitical explores the emerging consensus that legal authority is no longer related to national sovereignty but to the common good of a political community and the ‘moral’ attempt to nurture life. Routledge «Market: Law / Politics / Sociology December 2010: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-57844-8: £70.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83475-6: £70.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
Routledge «Market: Law / Architecture / Sociology December 2010: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-57539-3: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83624-8: £75.00/14
Legislative Drafting Edited by Aldo Zammit Borda, Commonwealth Secretariat, UK This book provides, for the first time, detailed commentary on legislative drafting with a specific focus on the Commonwealth. It constitutes a key reference for legislative drafters, parliamentary counsel and professionals involved in this area in the Commonwealth and beyond. This book was published as a special issue in Commonwealth Law Bulletin. Routledge «Market: Legislation / Civil Procedure / Legal Skills November 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-59781-4: £80.00/08
Limitation of Liability in International Maritime Conventions * The Relationship between Global Limitation Conventions and Particular Liability Regimes Norman A. Martínez Gutiérrez, IMO International Maritime Law Institute, Malta This book approaches limitation of liability for maritime claims from an international perspective looking at a number of key conventions and protocols including the LLMC Convention, the Athens Convention, the Nairobi Convention as well as conventions relating to the carriage of passengers and their luggage by sea, and those covering compensation for pollution damage. Routledge «Market: Law / Maritime Studies December 2010: 234x156: 432pp Hb: 978-0-415-60140-5: £85.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83403-9: £85.00/14
On the Right of Exclusion: Law, Ethics and Immigration Policy * Bas Schotel, University of Amsterdam, the Netherlands On the Right of Exclusion: Law, Ethics and Immigration Policy addresses the current immigration laws and practices of Western states, and argues that if states cannot substantially justify the exclusion of an alien, the latter should be admitted. Routledge «Market: Law / Politics March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-57537-9: £75.00/08
çè
Edited by Shawkat Alam, Natalie Klein and Juliette Overland, all at Macquarie University, Australia
Justice, Due Process and the Place of Law
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
law 127 Plea Bargaining in National and International Law
Sustainability in European Transport Policy *
A Comparative Study
Reading Modern Law: Critical Methodologies and Sovereign Formations
Regina Rauxloh, University of Surrey, UK
Essays in Honour of Peter Fitzpatrick
This book comparatively analyses plea bargain in different families of law. The book considers plea bargaining in England and Wales, Germany and the USA, and also looks at the absence of informal settlements in the former GDR. The book draws on these findings ask to what extent this practice should be developed in international criminal law.
Edited by Ruth Buchanan, York University, Canada, Stewart Motha, University of Kent, UK and Sundhya Pahuja, University of Melbourne, Australia
This book sets out a critical analysis of the body of law and policy initiatives that constitute the EU’s common transport policy. The development of the transport policy is charted through amending and founding Treaties as well as non-legislative documents using a model of sustainability as the basis for the analysis.
Routledge «Market: Law / Criminology / Social Policy March 2011: 234x156: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-59786-9: £75.00/08
Routledge «Market: Law / Legal Theory February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-56854-8: £75.00/08
Policing and Human Rights From Geneva to Johannesburg Julia Hornberger, University of Zurich, Switzerland Series: Law, Development and Globalization Policing and Human Rights analyses the implementation of human rights standards, tracing them from the nodal points of their production in Geneva, through the board rooms of national police management and training facilities, to the streets of downtown Johannesburg. Routledge «Market: Law / Criminology / Development Studies February 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-61068-1: £75.00/03
Beyond Restitution Anneke Smit, University of Windsor, Canada Protecting the Property Rights of Refugees and Internally Displaced Persons: Beyond Restitution pursues a rigorous examination of the various ways in which the protection of housing and property rights can contribute to durable solutions to displacement.
Routledge «Market: Law / Environmental Studies /Transport Policy November 2010: 234x156: 248pp Hb: 978-0-415-57831-8: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83823-5: £75.00/14
The European Court of Human Rights in the Post-Cold War Era * Universality in Transition
Reworking the Relationship between Asylum and Employment Penelope Mathew, Australian National University, Australia This book examines whether the right to work for refugees and asylum-seekers is protected by international human rights law. The book argues that both refugees and asylum-seekers have the right to work, and situates the law in the context of broader debates about sovereign control of immigration and the right to work. Routledge «Market: Law / Politics / Economics March 2011: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-58079-3: £75.00/08
Protecting the Property Rights of Refugees and Internally Displaced Persons *
Routledge «Market: Law / International Relations / Sociology March 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-57960-5: £75.00/08
Reading Modern Law addresses the identification and elaboration of a critical methodology for reading and writing about law in modernity. The essays in this volume – all direct or oblique engagements with the work of Peter Fitzpatrick – chart a mode of resisting the imperialism of social scientific method, as much as geo-political empire.
Matthew Humphreys, Kingston University, UK
State Accountability under International Law *
James A. Sweeney, University of Durham, UK Series: Routledge Research in Human Rights Law This book examines the case law of the European Court of Human Rights with particular reference to democratic transitions in Europe and the consequent enlargement of the European Convention system. The book analyses how the Court has responded to the difficult circumstances presented by the new Contracting Parties. Routledge «Market: Law / Human Rights / Central and Eastern European Studies January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-54433-7: £75.00/08
The External Impact of International Environmental Law and Principle Duncan French, University of Sheffield, UK
Holding States Accountable for a Breach of Jus Cogens Norms
Series: Routledge Research in International Environmental Law
Lisa Yarwood
Exploring how international environmental law affects a range of areas of international law including international trade and investment, development, human rights, security, and resource management, this books also looks at the ways in which other areas of law are providing a ‘feedback loop’ into the development of international environmental law.
Series: Routledge Research in International Law This book considers the extent to which States are held accountable for breaches of jus cogens norms under international law. The concept of State accountability is distinguished from the doctrine of State responsibility and refers to an ad hoc practice in international relations that seeks to ensure States do not escape with impunity when they violate norms that are considered fundamental to the interests of the international community as a whole.
Routledge «Market: Law / International Environmental Law March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-47245-6: £65.00/08
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Law / International Relations November 2010: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-57783-0: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83752-8: £75.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
128 law The Human Right to Water * Its Application in the Occupied Palestinian Territories
The Philosophy of Law meets the Philosophy of Technology Autonomic Computing and Transformations of Human Agency
Amanda Cahill-Ripley Series: Routledge Research in Human Rights Law This book examines the human right to water in international human rights law, including establishing its current legal status and substantive content as well as looking at the application of the human right to water in the Occupied Palestinian Territories under international humanitarian law pertaining to the occupation of territory. Routledge «Market: Law Human Rights / Politics / Environmental Studies January 2011: 234x156: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-57786-1: £75.00/08
The ICJ and the Development of International Law the Lasting Impact of the Corfu Channel Case Edited by Karine Bannelier and Théodore Christakis, both at University of Grenoble, France and Sarah Heathcote, Australian National University, Australia Series: Routledge Research in International Law In 1949 years ago, the International Court of Justice handed down its first judgment in the Corfu Channel Case. The contributors to this book consider the decision’s influence on various aspects of international law and its continuing relevance to many contemporary issues in international law. Routledge «Market: Law / International Relations March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60597-7: £75.00/03
The Integration of European Financial Markets The Regulation of Monetary Obligations Noah Vardi, University of Roma Tre, Italy
Edited by Mireille Hildebrandt and Antoinette Rouvroy, University of Namur, Belgium Autonomic Computing and Transformation of Human Agency interrogates the legal implications of the notion and experience of human agency implied by the emerging paradigm of autonomic computing, and the socio-technocal infrastructures it supports. Are autonomic – yet artificial – systems shrinking the distance between (acting) subjects and (acted upon) objects? How ‘distinctively human’ will agency be in a world of autonomic computing? Or, alternatively, does autonomic computing merely disclose that we were never, in this sense, ‘human’ anyway? A dialogue between philosophers of technology and philosophers of law, this book addresses these questions, as it takes up the unprecedented opportunity that autonomic computing and ambient intelligence offer for a reassessment of the most basic concepts of law. Routledge «Market: Law / Philosophy / Technology Studies January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-59323-6: £75.00/14
The Politics of Imagination Edited by Chiara Bottici, University of Florence, Italy and Benoît Challand, University of Bologna and Graduate Institute for International and Development Studies, Geneva The Politics of Imagination offers a multidisciplinary perspective on the contemporary relationship between politics and the imagination. Bringing together scholars from different disciplines and theoretical outlooks, The Politics of Imagination examines how the power of imagination reverberates in the various ambits of social and political life: in law, history, art, gender, economy, religion and the natural sciences. And it will be of considerable interest to those with contemporary interests in philosophy, political philosophy, political science, legal theory, gender studies, sociology, nationalism, identity studies, cultural studies, and media studies. Birkbeck Law Press «Market: Cultural Studies / Politics / Philosophy / Law March 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-60154-2: £75.00/08
The Right to Religious Freedom in International Law * Between Group Rights and Individual Rights Anat Scolnicov, University of Cambridge, UK
The Politics of Adjudication Aileen McHarg, University of Glasgow, UK The Politics of Adjudication addresses the pragmatics of legal decision making. This is a question of politics, according to which constitutional law is not, it is argued, the instantiation of timeless and universal principles of governance; but a discourse aimed at producing workable solutions, rather than right answers, to the problem of how to govern legitimately and effectively in particular contexts. Routledge-Cavendish «Market: Law / Politics January 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-47849-6: £70.00/03
Series: Routledge Research in Human Rights Law This book explores the right to religious freedom within international law. Analysing legal structures in a variety of both Western and Non-Western jurisdictions, the book sets out a topography of the different constitutional structures of religion within the state and their compliance with international human rights law. Routledge «Market: International Law / Religion / Human Rights October 2010: 234x156: 296pp Hb: 978-0-415-48114-4: £75.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-84263-8: £75.00/14
Vindicating Socio-Economic Rights
Series: UT Austin Studies in Foreign and Transnational Law
International Standards and Comparative Experiences
This book considers the discipline of monetary obligations within the context of financial markets. The book provides a comparative and transnational examination of the legal rules which form the basis of transactions on financial markets. Analysing the integration of the markets in this way highlights the role of globalisation as the key element favouring the circulation of rules, models, and especially the development of new regulatory sources.
Paul O’Connell, University of Leicester, UK Series: Routledge Research in Human Rights Law This book draws on the comparative experiences of a number of jurisdictions, including South Africa, India, Canada, and Ireland, in order to show how courts can play a substantial role in the vindication of socio-economic rights, while still respecting the doctrine of the separation of powers.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Law / Human Rights / Politics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60988-3: £75.00/08
Routledge «Market: Law / Finance / Economics December 2010: 216x138: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-60263-1: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83408-4: £75.00/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
criminology (Willan) 129 Willan Publishing 2009 marks an historic year in Criminology publishing, since the Willan list became part of the Routledge imprint. Routledge Criminology is now stronger, more rigorous and more diverse than ever, bringing you the very best in current criminological teaching, thinking and practise. The selection of books below represent both front list and key backlist titles. Each title will also be available in e-book format making them suitable for many applications, including Amazon Kindle.
A Certain Share of Low Cunning
A Restorative Justice Reader
David J. Cox, Keele University, UK
Edited by Gerry Johnstone, Hull University, UK
This book provides an account and analysis of the history of the Bow Street Runners, precursors of today’s police force, through a detailed analysis of a wide range of both qualitative and quantitative research data.
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology / History February 2010: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-1-84392-773-0: £45.00/08
This book brings together a selection of extracts from the most important and influential contributions to the restorative justice literature and its emergent philosophy, covering concepts, history, anthropology, theory and critical pespectives.
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology / Law May 2003: 246x174: 528pp Pb: 978-1-903240-81-6: £29.99/04
A New Response to Youth Crime
A Short History of Probation
Edited by David Smith, Edinburgh University, UK
George Mair and Lol Burke
çè
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology July 2010: 234x156 Hb: 978-1-84392-755-6: £68.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-754-9: £27.50/04
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
This book offers an account of the history and development of the probation service, providing an accessible, reliable and timely account of its origins and development from the second half of the 19th century up to its incorporation into NOMS.
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology / History December 2010: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-1-84392-250-6: £50.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-249-0: £18.99/04
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Antisocial and criminal behaviour involving children and young people have been a cause of heightened public concern in England and Wales for more than a quarter of a century. As an accompaniment to the Report of the Independent Commission on Youth Crime and Antisocial Behaviour (2010), this book takes a new look at the problem of youth offending and government, and exanines society’s response to this. The main focus rests on England and Wales, but the nature of responses in other parts of the world are also analysed for comparative purposes.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
130 criminology (Willan)
Age of Imprisonment
Computer Misuse
Elaine M. Crawley, The University of Salford, UK and Richard Sparks, University of Edinburgh, UK
Stefan Fafinski, Brunel University, UK This book is concerned with the nature of computer misuse and the legal and extra-legal responses to it, exploring what is meant by the term ‘computer misuse’, charting its emergence as a problem as well as its expansion.
This book addresses the issue of the rapidly growing number of elderly men entering prison, looking at the psychological and practical implications of serving a prison sentence late in life and offers an appraisal of current regimes and practices.
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology February 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-1-84392-263-6: £45.00/08
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology / Law April 2009: 234x156: 352pp Hb: 978-1-84392-380-0: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-379-4: £26.00/04
3rd Edition
2nd Edition
An Introduction to Criminological Theory
Comparative Criminal Justice Francis Pakes, Portsmouth University, UK This book offers an accessible introductory text on comparative criminal justice, examining the ways different countries and jurisdictions deal with the main stages and elements in the criminal justice process, from policing through to sentencing.
Roger Hopkins-Burke, Nottingham Trent University, UK This book provides a comprehensive and up-to-date introduction to criminological theory for students taking courses in criminology at both undergraduate and postgraduate level, focusing on recent developments in the theory of criminal behaviour.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology May 2009: 246x174: 416pp Hb: 978-1-84392-569-9: £68.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-407-4: £23.99/04
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology February 2010: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-1-84392-770-9: £58.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-769-3: £20.99/04
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
criminology (Willan) 131
Crime
Crime Prevention
Local and Global
Nick Tilley, UCL Jill Dando Institute of Crime Science
Edited by John Muncie, Deborah Talbot and Reece Walters, all at The Open University, UK
Series: Criminal Justice Series This book provides a concise and up-to-date account of crime prevention theory, practice and research in a form designed to be accessible and interesting to both students and practitioners.
Crime: Local and Global and its sister text Criminal Justice: Local and Global are two new teaching texts that aim to equip the reader with a critical understanding of the globally contested nature of ‘crime’ and ‘justice’.
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology February 2009: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-1-84392-395-4: £50.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-394-7: £17.99/04
Willan «Market: Criminology and Sociology August 2009: 246x174: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-515-6: £58.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-516-3: £22.99/04
Crime and Economics
Criminal Recidivism
An introduction
David P. Farrington and Georgia Zara, University of Turin, Italy This book aims to investigate criminal recidivism, the process involved in continuing offending and in delaying desistance from a criminal career, focusing on why, how and for how long an individual continues committing crimes.
Chris Fox and Kevin Albertson, both at Manchester Metropolitan University, UK Crime and Economics fills the gap for a comprehensive and accessible text locating the economics of crime within the study of crime and criminology. Written predominantly for students, it will also be valuable for managers and policy-makers.
çè
Willan «Market: Criminology and Sociology January 2011: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-1-84392-843-0: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-842-3: £21.99/04
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology December 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-1-84392-707-5: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-706-8: £22.99/04
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
132 criminology (Willan)
Dealing With Drugs
Evolution and Crime
Strategy, Policy and Practice
Jason Roach, Huddersfield University, UK and Ken Pease, UCL and University of Loughborough, UK
Richard Huggins, Oxford Brookes University, UK
This fascinating new book opens up new ways of looking at different aspects of crime and crime control, exploring the potential contribution that a more welcoming approach to the evolutionary perspective would make to criminology.
This book presents a comprehensive and detailed analysis of the strategic and policy responses to illicit drug use in the Britain since the mid-1980s and will be essential reading for both students and practitioners.
Willan «Market: Criminology and Sociology March 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-1-84392-392-3: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-391-6: £20.99/04
Willan «Market: Criminology and Sociology February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-834-8: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-833-1: £20.99/04
Electronically Monitored Punishment
Flashback Drugs and Dealing in the Golden Age of the London Rave Scene
International and Critical Perspectives Edited by Mike Nellis, Ralph Bas, Kristel Beyens and Dan Kaminski FlashBack_PPC_FNLv6.qxd
11/5/10
19:41
Jennifer (Jenni) Ward, Middlesex University, UK Series: Crime Ethnography
Page 1
Series editors: Dick Hobbs (LSE) and Geoffrey Pearson (Goldsmiths College)
Drugs and dealing in the Golden Age of the London rave scene Jennifer R. Ward
The stories it tells of different people and friendship groups illustrate the varied drug-selling roles and highlight the enterprise and entrepreneurship supporting their involvement. The book argues that rave club participants were economic actors who seized both the legal and illegal money-making opportunities presented through club culture and the widespread demand for drugs from within it. The camaraderie that underpinned rave club membership, alongside the busy nature of the London urban setting, contributed greatly to the expansion of drugselling activities - sometimes developing into thriving commercial-style operations. Told from the perspective of the author's own involvement in this night-time leisure culture, and embracing the disciplines of urban sociology and cultural criminology, this book contributes to our knowledge of recreational drugs markets and night-time leisure cultures. This book will appeal to students and academics with interests in these fields, as well as the many other people whose lives became a part of this vibrant leisure scene.
Jennifer R. Ward is Senior Lecturer in Criminology at Middlesex University
Drugs and dealing in the Golden Age of the London rave scene Jennifer R. Ward
This book is a detailed examination, told from the perspective of the author’s own involvement, of the rave club drugs market as it took place in nightclubs, dance parties, pubs, bars and among friendship networks in London in the mid to late 1990s.
Jennifer R. Ward
The author
Drugs and dealing in the Golden Age of the London rave scene
This book provides a fascinating account of the rave club drugs market that existed in nightclubs, dance parties, pubs and bars and among friendship networks in London, in the mid to late 1990s. It focuses on the organisational features of drugs purchasing and selling and differentiates anonymous drugs trading in public nightclub settings, from selling among extended networks of friends and others.
Flashback
CRIME ETHNOGRAPHY SERIES
CRIME ETHNOGRAPHY SERIES
Flashback
This book addresses the broader factors in the advance of electronic monitoring, Flashback developing a critical criminological perspective on electronic monitoring in selective countries around the world.
Academic and Professional Publisher of the Year 2008 International Achievement of the Year 2009
www.willanpublishing.co.uk
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Willan «Market: Criminology and Sociology May 2010: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-1-84392-791-4: £45.00/08
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Willan «Market: Criminology and Sociology March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-273-5: £40.00/08
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
Issues such as climate change, disposal of toxic waste and illegal fishing have generated increasing attention within criminological circles in recent years. This book brings together original cutting-edge work that deals with global environmental harm from a wide variety of geographical and critical perspectives. It includes writers from countries such as Australia, Canada, the United States, South Africa, Japan, China, The Netherlands, Italy and the United Kingdom. The topics covered in the book are global, regional and local in nature, although in each case there are clear transnational or global dimensions. The book explore topics that provide theoretical, methodological and substantive insights into the nature and dynamics of environmental harm, and the transference of this harm across regions, continents and globally. Specific topics include the criminal nature of global warming, an ethnographic study of pollution and consciousness of environmental harm, environmental destruction associated with huge industrial developments, chaos theory and environmental social justice, de-forestation as a global phenomenon, illegal trade in endangered species, and transference of toxicity. The book as a whole reinforces the importance of eco-global criminology as a dynamic paradigm for theory and action on environmental issues in the 21st century. It features contributions from different parts of the world, each with its own unique perspective on and analysis of specific types of environmental harm. Global warming and the many environmental harms identified in this book are the vital issues of our age. Accordingly, the criminological perspectives presented herein are important both in discerning the nature and complexities of these harms and, ultimately, in forging responses to them.
Global Environmental Harm
Criminological perspectives
The book brings together original cutting edge research to explore topics that provide theoretical, methodological and substantive insights into the nature of global environmental harm from a wide variety of geographical and critical perspectives.
Criminological perspectives
The editor
Edited by
Rob White is Professor of Criminology in the School of Sociology and Social Work at the University of Tasmania, Australia. He is the author of Crimes against Nature: environmental criminology and ecological justice (Willan, 2008) and editor of Environmental Crime: a reader (Willan, 2009).
Rob White
n S. Cahill, Jenny Yourstone Gisli H. Gudjonsson, Helinä m, Torun Lindholm, Svein Roos af Hjelmsäter, Stephen Stridbeck, Leif A. Strömwall,
Edited by Rob White, Tasmania University, Australia
Page 1
Edited by
P. A. Granhag
he University of Gothenburg. rently President-Elect of the
Nordic and international approaches
19:29
This book brings together the leading Global Environmental Harm authorities in the fieldCriminological of forensic perspectives White psychology in a NordicRob context, discussing the central issues and concerns of the subject and looking at both investigative psychology and psychology in court.
Edited by
of research in the Nordic e time concerned to situate tional context. The book is a ial reading for anybody with
Forensic Psychology in Context
1/3/10
Academic and Professional Publisher of the Year 2008 International Achievement of the Year 2009
Edited by P. A. Granhag
Edited by
Rob White
www.willanpublishing.co.uk
Willan «Market: Criminology and Sociology March 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-797-6: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-796-9: £24.99/04
Willan «Market: Criminology and Sociology June 2010: 234x156: 352pp Hb: 978-1-84392-828-7: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-827-0: £24.99/04
2nd Edition
Forensic Psychology
Handbook on Crime
Concepts, Debates and Practice
Edited by Fiona Brookman, University of Glamorgan, UK, Mike Maguire, Glamorgan University and Cardiff University, UK, Harriet Pierpoint and Trevor Bennett
Edited by Joanna R. Adler and Jacqueline M. Gray, both at Middlesex University, UK
This comprehensive edited volume contains analysis and explanation of the nature, extent, patterns and causes of over 40 different forms of crime, in each case drawing attention to key contemporary debates and social and criminal justice responses.
This updated, revised and significantly expanded edition develops the picture of diversity and depth of forensic psychology, considering ways in which the discipline has progressed and identifies challenges for its future sustainability and growth.
Willan «Market: Criminology and Sociology February 2010: 246x174: 984pp Hb: 978-1-84392-372-5: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-371-8: £39.50/04
Willan «Market: Criminology / Psychology July 2010: 234x156 Hb: 978-1-84392-930-7: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-414-2: £26.50/04
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
ngst them is to explore the n the light of both local and ections of the book then go chology and at the use of
Criminological perspectives
çè
land, Norway, Finland) have ly to the rapidly developing k brings together the leading ntral issues and concerns of y and psychology in court.
Nordic and International Approaches Global Environmental Harm
ersity of California, Irvine)
Global Environmental Harm
Global_Enviro_PBK6.qxd
Forensic Psychology in Context
hes
Forensic Psychology in Context Edited by Par Anders Granhag, Gothenburg University, Sweden Nordic and international approaches
in Context
criminology (Willan) 133
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
e’ forward as well as offering d policy in a more progressive
practitioners studying and religious, gender and sexual ogy; offending behaviour; sociocy; crime prevention and
ctim
ims and the State
Roberts
argely contextual in character, State and individual victim; ing the politics of victims' issues maining chapters explore the role tice, beginning with the on to analyse the treatment of udy of the use of victim impact xploring victim input into the
surrounding the complex and m in the criminal justice system. nts, practitioners and policy-
al 8 nt
Willan «Market: Criminology and Sociology April 2010: 234x156: 264pp Hb: 978-1-84392-780-8: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-779-2: £22.99/04
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology and Law March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-238-4: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-237-7: £22.99/04
Hearing the Victim
Intelligence and Intelligence Analysis
Adveresarial Justice, Crime Victims and the State Edited by Anthony Bottoms, University of Sheffield, UK and Julian Roberts, University of Oxford, UK
Patrick F. Walsh, Charles Sturt University, NSW, Australia This book tracks post 9/11 developments in national security and policing intelligence and their relevance to new emerging areas of intelligence practice such as: corrections, private industry and regulatory environments.
Series: Cambridge Criminal Justice Series
Hearing the Victim Adversarial justice, crime victims and the State
Hearing the Victim brings together leading authorities in the field to review the role of the victim in the criminal justice system in the context of recent legislative developments to ‘rebalance the criminal justice system in favour of the victim’.
Edited by
rofessor of Criminology, riminology, University of y at the University of Oxford.
Concepts, policy, future directions
Edited by
Adversarial justice, Anthony Bottoms crime victims and the State and Julian V. Roberts
ctims of crime – both in terms of in changes that have been ights and treatment. This announced to ‘rebalance the est book in the Cambridge ties in the field to review the context of these developments.
Hate Crime
This book provides a comprehensive account of the nature, causes and consequences of identity theft and a thorough analysis of the efficacy of a range of means of addressing the problem.
Hate Crime brings together contributions from leading experts to address key questions surrounding hate crimes and their associated harms, taking forward the ‘hate debate’ and offering practical suggestions for developing scholarship and policy.
Neil Chakraborti
Hearing the Victim
CE S E R I ES •
h of Cambridge
Emily Finch, University of Surrey, UK and Stefan Fafinski, Brunel University, UK
Edited by
istmann, Marian Duggan, David n, Hannah Mason-Bish, Jack k Walters, Kevin Wong.
Neil Chakraborti
e Department of Criminology, widely in the fields of ‘race’,
Concepts, Policy, Future Directions
Concepts, policy, future directions
erts in the field to address these controversial subject area. ally and internationally, the book nd in so doing enables readers to h research, theory and policy.
Identity Theft
Edited by
Anthony Bottoms
and Julian V. Roberts
Willan «Market: Criminology and Sociology March 2010: 234x156: 320pp Hb: 978-1-84392-272-8: £39.95/08
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Willan «Market: Criminology and Sociology February 2011: 234x156: 232pp Hb: 978-1-84392-738-9: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-739-6: £22.99/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
ns
ecent times as problems of ges for societies across the world. mes and their associated harms s, the problem is still widespread ing enough to protect vulnerable e offending behaviour of hate ng and responding to hate
Hate Crime Edited by Neil Chakraborti, University of Leicester, UK Hate Crime
e
134 criminology (Willan)
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
criminology (Willan) 135
International Police Cooperation
Key Readings in Criminology
Emerging Issues, Theory and Practice
Edited by Tim Newburn, London School of Economics, UK Key Readings in Criminology provides a comprehensive single-volume collection of readings in criminology, providing students with convenient access to a broad range of excerpts from original criminological texts and key articles.
Edited by Frederic Lemieux, The George Washington University, USA This book sets out to analyse the key emerging issues and theory and practice of international police cooperation. Contributors explore emerging initiatives and new challenges in several contexts at both national and international levels.
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology September 2009: 264x153: 960pp Hb: 978-1-84392-403-6: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-402-9: £34.99/04
Willan «Market: Criminology and Sociology January 2010: 234x156: 384pp Hb: 978-1-84392-761-7: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-760-0: £29.95/04
Just Authority?
Lost in Transition
Jonathan Jackson, Ben Bradford, University of Edinburgh, UK, Betsy Stanko and Katrin Hohl, London School of Economics, UK
Edited by Friedrich Lösel, Cambridge University, UK, Anthony Bottoms, University of Sheffield, UK and David P. Farrington
Just Authority? provides the most authoritative and comprehensive analysis thus far of the meaning, distribution and significance of trust in the police and the legitimacy of legal authorities.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
This book brings together leading experts to analyse both theoretical and policy issues relating to young adults and their treatment in the criminal justice system exploring different approaches to crime prevention and the treatment of offenders.
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology September 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-271-1: £39.95/08
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology December 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-848-5: £45.00/08
Series: Cambridge Criminal Justice Series
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
136 criminology (Willan)
Managing Clinical Risk
Night Clubbing
Edited by Lorraine Johnstone and Caroline Logan
Daniel Silverstone, University of Portsmouth, UK Series: Crime Ethnography
Violence and self-injury cause anxiety, misery and physical and psychological damage to service users, their carers, the practitioners who look after them, and in some cases, the public at large.
Drawing on the author’s experience of working in a London night club, this book provides an in depth ethnographic study of the night time economy, exploring the workings of a criminal door firm and considering the role of recreational drug use.
Willan «Market: Criminology / Psychology March 2011: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-1-84392-854-6: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-853-9: £29.99/04
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology February 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-1-84392-209-4: £45.00/08
Managing High Risk Sex Offenders in the Community 9/4/10
21:25
Edited by Wim Bernasco, Netherlands Institute for the Study of Criminality and Law Enforcement
Page 1
Edited by Karen Harrison Learning about crime from criminals
Edited by Wim
Bernasco
Foreword by Michael Tonry (University of Minnesota)
There are many things about crime that we can only learn from offenders. It is, however, not at all easy to find them and persuade them openly and truthfully to discuss their crimes. Most are difficult to reach, and many are unable or unwilling to provide the answers we need. Nevertheless, the offenders' perspective is vital to knowing and understanding crime: How did a person learn to commit an offence? How precisely was a specific crime enacted? What made the person commit the offence? Offenders on Offending provides a comprehensive overview of the challenges and possible solutions to the problems posed by offender-based research. The book focuses strongly on issues of methodology and what we can do to maximise the validity of what offenders tell us about their offending. It addresses the strengths and weaknesses of various methods used to elicit information on offending behaviour from offenders, and discusses strategies to obtain the collaboration of offenders and to maximise the validity and reliability of the data.
Leading authorities from around the world present their experiences and insights of work among various types of offender populations. Each contribution deals with some central issues:
This valuable new collection demonstrates that offender-based research is a thriving field where exciting developments are taking place. It will be essential reading for a wide audience, from experienced researchers to students who are starting to find there way in offender-based research. About the editor
Wim Bernasco, Fiona Brookman, Heith Copes, Ric Curtis, Henk Elffers, Matthias Gaderer, Frank van Gemert, Andy Hochstetler, Ben W. Hunter, Scott Jacques, Shane D. Johnson, Marie Rosenkrantz Lindegaard, Jody Miller, Carlo Morselli, Claire Nee, Veronika A. Polis˘enská, George F. Rengert, Neal Shover, Lucía Summers, Pierre Tremblay, Richard Wright, Sheldon X. Zhang, Birgit Zetinigg.
Academic and Professional Publisher of the Year 2008 International Achievement of the Year 2009
www.willanpublishing.co.uk
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology March 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-525-5: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-526-2: £26.00/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Edited by
The contributors
Wim Bernasco
Wim Bernasco is Senior Researcher at the Netherlands Institute for the Study of Crime and Law Enforcement (NSCR).
Learning about crime from criminals
• How can offenders be motivated to participate in research? • How can offenders be motivated to tell the truth on their offending? • How can the information that offenders provide be checked and validated? • What can we learn from offenders that cannot be accessed from other sources? • With the aim of obtaining valid and reliable information, how, where and under which conditions should we observe offenders and talk to them?
The book addresses the issue of assessing the reliability of information about crime from offenders, taking stock of the various methods used to elicit information on offending from offenders and collecting useful information on criminal behaviour.
Offenders on Offending
Offending This book explores the Offenders issues onsurrounding sex offenders, evaluating the measures in use or being considered, including drug treatment, MAPPA, the use of the Sex Offender Register, restorative justice techniques, and treatment programmes.
Offenders on Offending Learning about crime from criminals Edited by
Wim Bernasco
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology April 2010: 234x156: 328pp Hb: 978-1-84392-777-8: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-776-1: £25.00/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Offenders_On_PPCv6.qxd
Offenders on Offending
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
criminology (Willan) 137
Offenders or Citizens?
Police Interviewing
Edited by Philip Priestley and Maurice Vanstone
Stephen Moston, James Cook University, Australia
This book stimulates and furnishes a debate about the proper place of rehabilitation within a plural, morally defensible, and effective response to crime and will be essential reading for both students and practitioners within criminal justice.
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology May 2010: 246x174: 340pp Hb: 978-1-84392-530-9: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-529-3: £29.95/04
This book aims to describe and critically evaluate a wide range of police interviewing styles and tactics that might be used during the questioning of suspects in criminal investigations, in terms of their efficacy and acceptability.
Willan «Market: Criminology / Psychology November 2010: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-1-84392-521-7: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-522-4: £25.00/04
Offending Girls
Police Work
Gilly Sharpe, University of Sheffield, UK
Colin Rogers, Rhobert Lewis, Tim John and Tim Read, all at University of Glamorgan, UK
Offending Girls challenges simplistic representations of ‘bad’ girls in the twenty-first century and argues that the interventionist thrust which characterises the contemporary youth justice system has had a particularly pernicious impact on girls.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology December 2010: 246x174: 336pp Hb: 978-1-84392-532-3: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-531-6: £20.99/04
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-758-7: £40.00/08
This book provides a highly readable account of police work, providing a comprehensive, in depth and critical understanding of policing in today’s diverse society and written by current and former police practitioners at the University of Glamorgan.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
138 criminology (Willan)
Policing: An introduction
Psychological Criminology
Rob Mawby, University of Leicester, UK
Richard Wortley, Griffith University, Australia
Series: Criminal Justice Series
The book provides a comprehensive coverage of psychological theories of crime and criminality, emphasising the connections among approaches, and to show how, taken together, they provide a more complete picture of crime and criminality.
This book provides students of policing, criminology and criminal justice (as well as police practitioners) with a basic but comprehensive introduction to policing in the UK looking at organization, strategy and contemporary policing issues.
Willan «Market: Criminology / Psychology October 2010: 234x156: 264pp Hb: 978-1-84392-806-5: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-805-8: £20.99/04
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology December 2010: 234x156: 216pp Hb: 978-1-84392-349-7: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-348-0: £17.99/04
Prisoners’ Rights
Release from Prison
Susan Easton, Brunel University, UK
Edited by Nicola Padfield, University of Cambridge, UK, Dirk Van Zyl Smit and Frieder Dünkel, University of Greifswald, Germany
This book considers prisoners’ rights from socio-legal and philosophical perspectives, assessing the advantages and problems of Release from Prison a rights-based approach to imprisonment European policy and practice with a focus on citizenship,the treatment of women prisoners,and social exclusion. 10/2/10
20:02
Page 1
Release from prison is a matter of increasing interest throughout Europe. On the one hand, arguments about the need to reduce prison numbers, as well as findings that prisoners can be integrated into society more effectively if they are subject to a period of supervision in the community, have made early release policies attractive to governments and to academic commentators. On the other hand, there are concerns that early release may not be applied fairly to all prisoners.
Including contributions from leading subject specialists, this book aims to provide important comparative information on release from prison across Europe and explores some of the key themes and issues. Part of the focus is on Council of Europe Recommendations and on European Union measures but the main body of the book focuses on country perspectives, providing an invaluable survey of the differing situation in various European countries. The introductory and concluding chapters place the comparative material in a broader perspective. They explain how release policy is related to wider questions about justice and fairness in prison-related decision-making and the changing place of imprisonment in European society. The editors
Academic and Professional Publisher of the Year 2008 International Achievement of the Year 2009
www.willanpublishing.co.uk
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology November 2010: 234x156: 264pp Hb: 978-1-84392-809-6: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-808-9: £24.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Release from Prison European policy and practice
Edited by
Matjaz˘ Ambroz˘, Marie-Aude Beernaert, Kristel Beyens, Karin Bruckmüller, Leonidas K. Cheliotis, José Cid, Frieder Dünkel, Alessandra Gualazzi, Veronika Hofinger, Tapio Lappi-Seppälä, Chiara Mancuso, Martin Moerings, Thomas O'Malley, Nicola Padfield, Ioannis Papageorgiou, Ineke Pruin, Kim Reuflet, Sonja Snacken, John R. Spencer, Katja S˘ ugman Stubbs, Beatriz Tébar, Douglas Thomson, Dirk van Zyl Smit.
Nicola Padfield Dirk van Zyl Smit
The contributors
and Frieder Dünkel
Nicola Padfield is a Senior Lecturer at the Law Faculty, University of Cambridge; Dirk van Zyl Smit is Professor of Comparative and International Penal Law at the University of Nottingham; Frieder Dünkel is Professor of Criminology and Penal Law at the University of Greifswald in northeast Germany.
Release from Prison
Nicola Padfield, Dirk van Zyl Smit and Frieder Dünkel
European policy and practice
Edited by
This book addresses the current debates surrounding the release of prisoners, offering an invaluable survey of the situation in a number of European countries in a comparative perspective, and focusing on issues of fairness and justice.
Edited by
Nicola Padfield Dirk van Zyl Smit and Frieder Dünkel
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology February 2010: 234x156: 480pp Hb: 978-1-84392-741-9: £55.00/08
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Release_Prison_PPCv6.qxd
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
criminology (Willan) 139
Researching Crime and Justice
Secure Recovery
Louise Westmarland
Edited by Deborah Alred and Gerard Drennan Secure Recovery presents a cross-section of experiences in high, medium and low secure services and prison-based therapeutic communities in England and Scotland that have begun to implement a recovery-orientation to the rehabilitation of offenders with mental health needs. Taken together, the contributions set out a road map of guiding principles, practical and evidence-based strategies for promoting service user participation in their care and treatment.
This book provides a practical introduction to crime and justice research, as well as presenting key research philosophies and discussing the potential problems and pitfalls of a wide range of research methods. As such, it is essential reading for criminology students and other researchers of crime and justice.
Willan «Market: Criminology / Justice / Sociology October 2010: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-1-84392-317-6: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-316-9: £21.99/04
Willan «Market: Criminology / Forensic Psychology / Sociology December 2010: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-1-84392-837-9: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-836-2: £29.99/04
Restorative Justice in Practice
Sex, Crime and Morality
Joanna Shapland, University of Sheffied, UK, Gwen Robinson and Angela Sorsby
Sharon Hayes, Belinda Carpenter and Angela Dwyer Within modern democratic nations, there are a specific group of offences which bear the brunt of the label ‘crimes against morality’. These include offences related to prostitution and pornography, homosexuality, incest, and child sexual abuse. This book examines the historical, anthropological and moral reasons for such differentiations in contemporary western culture.
This book analyses the practicalities of setting up and running restorative justice schemes, the costs involved and the key professional and ethical issues involved such as victims’ and offenders’ needs and expectations, community and desistance.
çè
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Willan «Market: Criminology / Gender Studies / Sociology October 2010: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-1-84392-816-4: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-815-7: £21.99/04
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-846-1: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-845-4: £25.99/04
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
f reducing opportunities for crime. ng many different kinds of crime – al abuse and even terrorism – little cing organised crimes.
ernational group of researchers, uational prevention approach to a king, cigarette and drug smuggling, rofessionals and public officials, tion projects. By moving the focus e analysis of the crimes committed genda for policy and research.
kling organised crime problems as hat organised crime problems nforcement and other agencies
Situational Prevention of Organised Crimes
Ronald V. Clarke and Nick Tilley
Felson, James O. Finckenauer, d R. Kleemans, Lars Korsell, Gloria Johanna Skinnari, Melvin R.J. mpe, Anton W. Weenink.
state crime, and locates contemintegration. The Brutal Realities of two domestic varieties of state ems and prospects for confronting transnational justice practices and a
th the grave threats created by the ate Crime in the Global Age.
Technology, Crime and Justice
Edited by William J. Chambliss, Raymond Michalowski and Ronald C. Kramer
Mike McGuire, London Metropolitan University, UK
William J. Chambliss, Raymond Michalowski
al 8 nt
and Ronald C. Kramer
lliam J. Chambliss, Kimberly J. Cook, Ronald C. Kramer, Lauren N. Lang, Vincenzo Ruggiero, Elizabeth Stanley,
Willan «Market: Criminology / Gender Studies / Sociology November 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-206-3: £45.00/08
State Crime in the Global Age State Crime in the Global Age
Edited by
George Washington University and and the Society for the Study of ofessor of Criminology at Northern ociology and Director of the Criminal
Willan «Market: Criminology / Organised Crime / Sociology March 2010: 234x156: 216pp Hb: 978-1-84392-772-3: £35.00/08
State Crime in the Global Age
Michalowski
Drawing on a two-year ethnographic study undertaken in a Northern city in the UK, this book explores the political economy of drug dealing and crime amongst children and young people at the local level. It also provides illuminating description and analyses of the gendered nature of their drug taking practices and rituals.
Edited by
.uk
writings from leading scholars of f social harms flowing from the use nd by examining how globalization ovel theoretical understandings of strategies for confronting state mpire, the crimes of war, state judicial wrongdoing.
Series: Crime Ethnography
This collection of case studies, by a distinguished international group of researchers, documents the application of a situational prevention approach to a variety of organised crimes, including: sex trafficking, drug smuggling, corruption, and fraud. The book will be of interest to those tasked with tackling organised crime problems, as well as students of criminology and criminal justice.
Karen Bullock, Ronald V. Clarke and Nick Tilley
ssional r 2008 vement
e Global Age
Kate O’Brien
Series: Crime Science Series
Edited by Karen Bullock,
ciology at the University of Surrey; ol of Criminal Justice, Rutgers ent of Security and Crime Science
Edited by Karen Bullock, Ronald V. Clarke and Nick Tilley
Tac
Edited by
William J. Chambliss, Edited by Raymond Michalowski andKaren RonaldHarrison C. Kramer
Willan «Market: Criminology / Politics / Sociology March 2010: 234x156: 320pp Hb: 978-1-84392-704-4: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-703-7: £23.99/04
order now!
This book looks at the relation between technology and criminal justice, analysing a range of technologies to explore how far they provide new criminal opportunities and how it serves as a regulatory force, both in crime and social control.
This book brings together original writings from leading scholars in the field to explore the many ways that the use and abuse of state power results in grave social harms that outweigh, by far, the consequences of ordinary street crime. The topics covered include the crimes of empire, illegal war, the bombing of civilians, state sanctioned torture, state sacrifice of human lives, and judicial wrongdoing.
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-857-7: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-856-0: £25.00/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
rke and Nick Tilley
Situational Prevention of Organised Crimes
Situational Prevention of Organised Crimes
evention Crimes
140 criminology (Willan)
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
criminology (Willan) 141
The Dynamics of Desistance
Transitions to Better Lives
Deirdre Healy
Andrew Day, Sharon Casey, Tony Ward, Victoria University of Wellington, New Zealand, Kevin Howells and James Vess
Series: International Series on Desistance and Rehabilitation Transitions_PBKv6.qxd
6/4/10
22:07
Page 1
The last two decades have seen significant investment and support in the development and delivery of offender rehabilitation programmes across the western world. However, the value of offender rehabilitation is not universally recognised and it is now more important than ever that rehabilitation providers can demonstrate that their efforts are effective in reducing rates of offending or, at the very least, consistent with those practices that have been shown to be effective in other settings. The aim of this book is to describe, collate and summarise a body of recent research, both theoretical and empirical, that explores the issue of treatment readiness in offender programming, one of the most important recent developments in the theory and practice of offender rehabilitation. The book is divided into three sections: the first section reviews a model of treatment readiness and how it has been operationalised; the second section discusses how the construct has been applied to the treatment of different offender groups; and in the final section, some of the practice approaches that have been identified as holding promise in addressing low levels of offender readiness are discussed.
Transitions to Better Lives
Andrew Day, Sharon Casey, Tony Ward, Kevin Howells and James Vess
Offender readiness and rehabilitation
This book aims to shed light on the Lives Transitions to Better Offender readiness and rehabilitation reasons why offenders cease to commit crime. Drawing on a variety of methods, including in-depth interviews with repeat offenders and their probation officers, police records, and psychometric scores, the book explores and describes the shifts that occur in desisters’ minds and lives as they make the often turbulent transition to a crime-free life.
Transitions to Better Lives Offender readiness and rehabilitation
• Written by a group of leading researchers in the area;
• The only text that reviews all aspects of the offender readiness model; • Contains descriptions of practice in work with offenders;
About the authors
Andrew Day is Associate Professor at the School of Psychology, Deakin University, Australia; Sharon Casey is Senior Research Fellow at the School of Psychology, Deakin University, Australia; Tony Ward is Professor and Head of School at the School of Psychology, Victoria University of Wellington, New Zealand; Kevin Howells is Professor of Clinical and Forensic Psychology at the University of Nottingham; James Vess is Senior Lecturer in the School of Psychology, Deakin University, Australia.
Andrew Day, Sharon Casey, Tony Ward, Kevin Howells
This book will be essential reading for those who work or study in the criminal justice system and are interested, or involved, with the delivery of rehabilitation and reintegration programmes for offenders. This includes psychologists, social workers, probation and parole officers, managers and policy makers, and prison officers.
and James Vess
• Reviews current approaches to the measurement of treatment readiness.
Andrew Day, Sharon Casey, Tony Ward, Kevin Howells and James Vess
Academic and Professional Publisher of the Year 2008 International Achievement of the Year 2009
www.willanpublishing.co.uk
This book aims to describe, collate, and summarise a body of recent research – both theoretical and empirical – that explores the issue of treatment readiness in offender programming. Included within each section are contributions from a number of authors whose work has stimulated discussion and helped to inform practice in offender rehabilitation, making this an important resource for those who have an interest in the delivery of rehabilitation and reintegration programmes for offenders.
Willan «Market: Criminology / Crime Prevention / Sociology May 2010: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-1-84392-783-9: £40.00/08
Willan «Market: Criminology / Restorative Justice / Sociology April 2010: 234x156: 320pp Hb: 978-1-84392-719-8: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-718-1: £29.50/04
The Trouble With Truth
Transnational Environmental Crime
Kieran McEvoy, Queens University, Belfast This book explores the relationship the politics of truth recovery and its assumed links to reconciliation in the Northern Ireland Good Friday Agreement, looking at issues of transitional justice and the ownership and forms of truth recovery.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
This book provides a comprehensive introduction to eco-global criminology. By addressing global issues – including pollution, crimes against wildlife, and global warming – this book introduces topics such as the conceptualisation of environmental harm, and global dimensions of local environmental issues, to provide a thorough overview of concerns and discussions within the jurisdiction of environmental crime.
Willan «Market: Criminology / Environmental Crime / Climate Change March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-803-4: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-802-7: £25.00/04
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-236-0: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-235-3: £22.99/04
Rob White
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
142 criminology (Willan)
Victims
What Else Works?
Sandra Walklate, University of Liverpool, UK
What_Else_PBKv6.qxd
26/1/10
20:20
Edited by Jo Brayford, Francis Cowe and John Deering
Page 1
What Else Works?
Edited by
Jo Brayford, Francis Cowe, John Deering
This book has developed out of a growing awareness amongst practitioners that centralized notions of what works and ‘one size fits all’ approaches to work with offenders and other groups are inevitably limited in their scope and effectiveness. This reopens the door on ‘what works, with whom and in what circumstances?’ - the idea that successful intervention can come from a number of different approaches, linked to individual difference. The book argues that it may be unhelpful to continually think of probation service users as ‘offenders’ and socially excluded people as 'problems' to be managed and treated, and seeks to consider more creative alternatives to reduce both re-offending and social exclusion - for example in working separately with women, black and minority ethnic groups, local community-focussed projects, in education and nature and conservation programmes. Creative work with offenders has a long history, but this has been marginalised by centralist tendencies in probation practice and research for over a decade. However, increasingly, such top-down approaches are being seen to be ineffective and inflexible. This book offers an opportunity to both re-examine practices that have become obscured and to explore current examples and opportunities for such creative work with a range of service user groups. This book is aimed at probation, youth justice, criminal justice and social care staff, academics, students and policy makers, in line with the Editors’ vision of bringing together theory, policy and practice in an iterative, critically constructive relationship. It will appeal to students on criminal justice, criminology and social work courses, professionals operating in these fields as well as the wider audience of professionals and academics who may engage with these ‘service users’ from a range of policy and practice perspectives. It will also be of relevance to those involved in social inclusion and supported housing. The editors
Hindpal Singh Bhui, Jo Brayford, Martin C. Calder, Mark S. Carich, Peter A. Carich, Claudia Carter, Sally Cherry, Francis Cowe, John Deering, Liz Dixon, Mark Drakeford, Pauline Durrance, Lee Gregory, Duncan Holtom, Mike Maguire, Fergus McNeill, Frank Porporino, Aaron Pycroft, Peter Raynor, Jenny Roberts, Maurice Vanstone, Beth Weaver, Chris Wilson. Academic and Professional Publisher of the Year 2008 International Achievement of the Year 2009
Edited by
Contributors
Jo Brayford, Francis Cowe, John Deering
Jo Brayford is Senior Lecturer in Criminal and Community Justice at the University of Wales, Newport; Francis Cowe is Director of Academic Development and founder and head of the Newport Centre for Criminal and Community Justice, University of Wales, Newport; John Deering is Senior Lecturer in Criminology and Criminal Justice at the University of Wales, Newport.
What Else Works? Creative work with offenders
Creative work with offenders
This book offers a critical understanding of the nature, extent, and impact of criminal victimisation, tracing the experiences of the victim from their experience of crime, to their first contact with the criminal justice system and beyond. Creative work with offenders
What Else Works?
Series: Criminal Justice Series
Edited by
Jo Brayford Francis Cowe John Deering
www.willanpublishing.co.uk
This book taps into the growing awareness amongst practitioners that centralized notions of ‘one size fits all’ approaches to work with offenders in inevitably limited in its effectiveness, and instead seeks to consider more creative alternatives to reduce both re-offending and social exclusion. This book proves interesting reading for students on criminal justice, criminology, and social work courses, as well as professionals working in related fields.
Willan «Market: Criminology / Offender Rehabilitation / Sociology February 2010: 234x156: 304pp Hb: 978-1-84392-767-9: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-766-2: £22.99/04
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology February 2011: 234x156: 160pp Hb: 978-1-84392-831-7: £45.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-830-0: £17.99/04
Crime Prevention Policies in Comparative Perspective
Criminal Investigation
Criminal Psychology
An Introduction to Principles and Practice
Edited by Adam Crawford, University of Leeds, UK
Peter Stelfox
Francis Pakes, Portsmouth University, UK and Suzanne Pakes
Willan «Market: Criminology and Sociology June 2009: 234x156: 296pp Hb: 978-1-84392-413-5: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-412-8: £26.99/04
Willan March 2009: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-338-1: £50.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-337-4: £18.50/04
Edited by Deborah Drake, John Muncie, The Open University, UK and Louise Westmarland
Environmental Criminology and Ecological Justice Rob White, University of Tasmania, Australia Willan «Market: Criminology and Sociology June 2008: 234x156: 328pp Pb: 978-1-84392-361-9: £18.99/04
Willan October 2009: 246x174: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-513-2: £58.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-514-9: £22.99/04
Criminal Justice in Scotland
Criminal Behaviour in Context Space, Place and Desistance from Crime Nick Flynn, De Montfort University, UK Series: International Series on Desistance and Rehabilitation Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology August 2010: 234x156 Hb: 978-1-84392-811-9: £40.00/08
Criminology
Criminal Justice
Crimes Against Nature
Willan February 2009: 246x174: 184pp Hb: 978-1-84392-328-2: £50.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-364-0: £15.99/04
Edited by Hazel Croall, Glasgow Caledonian University, UK, Gerry Mooney, Open University, UK and Mary Munro, Cj Scotland, UK Willan September 2010: 234x156 Hb: 978-1-84392-786-0: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-785-3: £24.99/04
4th Edition
Criminal Law Tony Storey and Alan Lidbury
Edited by Tim Newburn, London School of Economics, UK Willan August 2007: 264x193: 1046pp Pb: 978-1-84392-284-1: £34.99/04
Criminology and Criminal Justice Peter Joyce Willan May 2009: 246x174: 224pp Hb: 978-1-84392-517-0: £50.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-336-7: £15.99/04
Dictionary of Policing Edited by Tim Newburn, London School of Economics, UK and Peter Neyroud Willan April 2008: 246x174: 384pp Pb: 978-1-84392-287-2: £24.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Willan September 2007: 234x156 Pb: 978-1-84392-696-2: £17.99/04
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
criminology (Willan) 143 Dirty Dancing
Handbook of Restorative Justice
Offender Supervision
An Ethnography of Lap Dancing
Edited by Gerry Johnstone, Hull University, UK and Daniel W. Van Ness
Edited by Fergus McNeill, Peter Raynor and Chris Trotter
Willan October 2006: 246x174: 672pp Pb: 978-1-84392-150-9: £34.99/04
Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology October 2010: 234x156 Hb: 978-1-84392-936-9: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-935-2: £29.95/04
Rachela Colosi Series: Crime Ethnography Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology July 2010: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-1-84392-817-1: £45.00/08
Doing Justice to Young People Youth Crime and Social Justice
How Offenders Transform Their Lives Edited by Bonita Veysey, Johnna Christian and Damian J. Martinez Willan July 2009: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-1-84392-509-5: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-508-8: £25.99/04
Roger Smith Willan «Market: Criminology / Sociology December 2010: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-1-84392-840-9: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-839-3: £24.99/04
Jerry H. Ratcliffe, Temple University, USA Willan February 2008: 246x174: 288pp Pb: 978-1-84392-339-8: £22.99/04
Edited by Rob White Willan August 2009: 234x156: 768pp Hb: 978-1-84392-511-8: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-512-5: £34.99/04
Edited by Tom Williamson, Becky Milne and Stephen P. Savage
Rachel Condry, University of Surrey, UK
Willan April 2009: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-1-84392-276-6: £45.00/08
Series: Crime Ethnography Willan January 2009: 234x156: 232pp Pb: 978-1-84392-501-9: £20.99/04
Policing and the Legacy of Lawrence Edited by Nathan Hall, John Grieve and Stephen P. Savage
Policing: Key Readings
Willan June 2009: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-518-7: £39.50/08
Edited by Tim Newburn, London School of Economics, UK Willan November 2004: 246x174: 848pp Pb: 978-1-84392-091-5: £34.99/04
Juvenile Justice Reform and Restorative Justice
Willan May 2007: 246x174: 728pp Hb: 978-1-84392-188-2: £89.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-187-5: £34.99/04
Gordon Bazemore, Florida Atlantic University, Fort Lauderdale, USA and Mara Schiff
Series: Criminal Justice Series
Edited by Jim Fraser and Robin Williams Willan July 2009: 246x174: 696pp Hb: 978-1-84392-312-1: £89.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-311-4: £34.99/04
2nd Edition
Making People Behave Elizabeth Burney
Handbook of Internet Crime Edited by Yvonne Jewkes, Leicester University, UK and Majid Yar Willan November 2009: 246x174: 664pp Hb: 978-1-84392-523-1: £89.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-524-8: £34.99/04
Edited by Mike Nash and Andy Williams, both at Portsmouth University, UK
Willan January 2011: 234x156: 160pp Hb: 978-1-84392-374-9: £50.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-373-2: £17.99/04
Protecting the Public?
Willan June 2009: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-698-6: £64.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-699-3: £21.99/04
Executive Discretion and the Release of Mentally Disordered Offenders Tessa Boyd-Caine
New Directions in Surveillance and Privacy
Handbook of Public Protection
Probation Rob Canton
Willan November 2004: 234x156: 400pp Pb: 978-1-84392-094-6: £26.99/04
Handbook of Forensic Science
Edited by Benjamin J. Goold and Daniel Neyland
Willan June 2010: 234x156: 216pp Hb: 978-1-84392-527-9: £39.50/08
Psychological Therapy in Prisons and other Settings
Willan April 2009: 240pp Hb: 978-1-84392-363-3: £37.50/08
Edited by Joel Harvey and Kirsty Smedley Foreword by Graham Towl, Durham University, UK
Willan September 2010: 246x174: 496pp Hb: 978-1-84392-851-5: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-850-8: £34.99/04
Willan September 2010: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-1-84392-800-3: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-799-0: £25.00/04
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Willan December 2010: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-1-84392-813-3: £40.00/08
Anna Eriksson
Edited by Tim Newburn, London School of Economics, UK, Tom Williamson and Alan Wright
for e-mail updates in your field
Legitimacy, Modernisation and Reform in the Criminal Justice Process
Willan February 2009: 234x156: 320pp Hb: 978-1-84392-506-4: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-505-7: £22.99/04
Justice in Transition
Handbook of Criminal Investigation
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
Willan June 2009: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-411-1: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-410-4: £22.99/04
Layla Skinns
International Developments in Investigative Interviewing
Families Shamed
Maurice Punch
Police Custody
Intelligence-led Policing
Environmental Crime
Police Corruption
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
144 criminology (Willan) Rape
Surviving and Moving On
Victims of Crime
Edited by Miranda Horvath and Jennifer Brown
Kim McGregor
Matthew Hall, University of Sheffield, UK
Willan September 2009: 234x156: 368pp Hb: 978-1-84392-519-4: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-520-0: £26.99/04
Willan January 2009: 464pp Pb: 978-1-84392-507-1: £21.99/04
Willan January 2009: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-1-84392-381-7: £39.50/08
2nd Edition
Working With Offenders
Repositioning Restorative Justice Edited by Lode Walgrave, K.U. University of Leuven, Belgium Willan September 2003: 234x156: 372pp Pb: 978-1-84392-016-8: £33.50/04
Edited by David Waddington, Fabien Jobard and Mike King Willan May 2009: 234x156: 320pp Hb: 978-1-84392-504-0: £48.50/08
Keith Soothill, Claire Fitzpatrick and Brian Francis
Sex Trafficking Marie Segrave, Sanja Milivojevic, Monash University, Australia and Sharon Pickering, University of Western Sydney, Australia
Series: Crime and Society Series Willan December 2010: 234x156 Hb: 978-1-84392-307-7: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-306-0: £22.99/04
Supermax
Willan June 2010: 246x174 Hb: 978-1-84392-928-4: £40.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-927-7: £19.99/04
Understanding Criminal Careers
Willan November 2010: 234x156: 176pp Hb: 978-1-84392-822-5: £45.00/08
Alan Doig
Transforming Behaviour Sally Cherry
Edited by Anna Costanza Baldry and Andreas Kapardis
A Guide to Concepts and Practices Rob White and Hannah Graham Willan September 2010: 234x156 Hb: 978-1-84392-794-5: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-793-8: £22.99/04
Workplace Violence
2nd Edition
Pro-social Modelling in Practice
Risk Assessment for Juvenile Violent Offending
State Crime
Edited by Alison Liebling, Cambridge University, UK, David Price and Guy Schefer Willan December 2010: 234x156 Hb: 978-1-84392-270-4: £50.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-269-8: £17.99/04
Rioting in the UK and France
Willan June 2009: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-528-6: £62.00/03
The Prison Officer
Willan May 2009: 246x174: 224pp Hb: 978-1-84392-503-3: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-502-6: £19.99/04
Understanding Youth Offending Stephen Case and Kevin Haines Willan June 2009: 234x156: 368pp Hb: 978-1-84392-342-8: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-341-1: £28.99/04
Edited by Vaughan Bowie, Bonnie S. Fisher, University of Cincinnati and Cary L. Cooper Willan October 2005: 234x156: 312pp Hb: 978-1-84392-134-9: £34.00/08
Youth in Crisis? ‘Gangs’, Territoriality and Violence Edited by Barry Goldson Routledge «Market: Juvenile Crime / Criminology / Sociology February 2011: 234x156: 248pp Hb: 978-1-84392-752-5: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-751-8: £22.99/04
Youth Justice Handbook Edited by Wayne Taylor, Rod Earle and Richard Hester Willan October 2009: 246x174: 288pp Hb: 978-1-84392-717-4: £58.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-716-7: £22.99/04
Victims and Policy-Making A Comparative Perspective Matthew Hall, University of Sheffield, UK Willan October 2010: 234x156 Hb: 978-1-84392-825-6: £62.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-824-9: £25.99/04
Sharon Shalev
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Willan September 2009: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-84392-409-8: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-408-1: £25.99/04
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
business & management 145
Applied Concept Mapping
Arts Leadership
Theory, Techniques, and Case Studies in the Business Applications of Novakian Concept Mapping
James Abruzzo, Rutgers University, USA
Edited by Brian Moon, Perigean Technologies, Fredericksburg, Virginia, USA, Robert R. Hoffman and Joseph Novak, both at Institute for Human and Machine Cognition, Pensacola, Florida, USA and Alberto Canas Providing case studies in business applications, this book describes the theory and methods underlying Novakian concept mapping. Developed by Joseph Novak as an educational strategy, concept mapping has been applied with increasing frequency to problems in the workplace. Novakian concept maps differ from other diagrams by their morphology, content, and semantics. The advent of Cmap Tools, a knowledge modeling software kit that enables computer-based creation and sharing of Novakian concept maps, has encouraged diverse applications. The text presents original work from the authors as well as contributors who have applied concept mapping in the industry.
Arts Leadership describes the singular importance and crucial effect that arts leaders have on the institutions they run. Selected Contents: Introduction: Why it is Important to Study Arts Leadership? Part I: Theory and History 1. History of Arts Leadership 2. What is Leadership? 3. The Model Arts Leader and His Effect on Creating and Sustaining Great Arts Institutions Part II: Types of Arts Leader 4. The Turn Around Leader 5. The Creator/ Entrepreneur 6. The Brand Builder/Sustainer 7. The Partner 8. The Adapter 9. Learning the Lessons from Arts Leaders 10. Post Script: Globalization and the ‘Third Generation’ Arts Leader Routledge «Market: Business & Management March 2011: 234x156: 312pp Hb: 978-0-415-77927-2: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-77928-9: £28.99/04
CRC Press «Market: Business Management December 2010: 229x152: 288pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2860-1: £38.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2861-8: £38.99/17
2nd Edition
2nd Edition
Andy & Me *
Basics of Process Mapping
Pascal Dennis, Lean Productivity Network In an era when auto companies are being propped up instead of profiting, many firms are revisiting this award winning fictionalized account and the very real lessons it teaches. The second edition of this entertaining parable, one of the most popular ever written on Lean, emphasizes practicality and a can do attitude in the face of all challenges, big and small. This edition adds study questions that highlight critical leadership lessons and includes corresponding notes that provide up-front guidance. The author is a Toyota veteran with two decades of professional experience as a consultant in Lean management and manufacturing.
çè
Productivity Press «Market: Business Management November 2010: 203x133: 216pp Pb: 978-1-4398-2538-9: £18.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5632-7298-1
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Robert Damelio The bestselling first edition of this influential resource has been incorporated into the curriculum at forward thinking universities, many in-house corporate continuous improvement approaches, including Six Sigma, and the United Nations’ headquarters in New York. Providing a complete and accessible introduction to process maps, this edition has been thoroughly updated to keep pace with recent developments. It explains how relationship maps, cross-functional process maps, and flowcharts can be used as a set to provide views of work at the organization, process, and job/performer levels. Productivity Press «Market: Business Management November 2010: 229x152: 192pp Pb: 978-1-56327-376-6: £9.99/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Crisis and Transformation on the Lean Journey
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
146 business & management
Building Brands in Asia
Commodity Risk Management
From the Inside Out
Theory and Application
Tim Andrews, University of Strathclyde, UK and Wilson Chew, StrategiCom, Singapore
Geoffrey Poitras
In a global business environment characterized by volatility and change, developing a unique brand personality is increasingly recognized as a key method to achieving the goal of customer loyalty. Focusing on the creation, development and management of brands in the world’s most dynamic and challenging business environment, Building Brands in Asia challenges the assumption that the continuing success of global brands in Asia is a given. The first part examines the challenge MNCs face in balancing brand consistency with local effectiveness. In the second part, attention shifts to Asian company brands, where branding has been relatively muted until now. Replete with anecdotes, interviews and case studies this book provides an insightful and detailed examination for those interested in today’s primary corporate preoccupation set in the world’s most exciting marketplace.
Chance and Intent Managing the Risks of Innovation and Entrepreneurship David L. Bodde and Caron H. St. John Corporate innovators, independent entrepreneurs, and investors find only incomplete advice in their quantitative assessments of new venture risk. In addition, they should employ a diverse set of tools and perspectives to manage the risks of entrepreneurship and innovation. This edited volume will interpret current research and best-practice to offer a more complete toolkit for managing them well.
Routledge «Market: Entrepreneurship March 2011: 254x178: 350pp Hb: 978-0-415-87760-2: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87761-9: £34.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Routledge «Market: Finance March 2011: 254x190: 350pp Hb: 978-0-415-87929-3: £66.67/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87930-9: £33.31/04
Dynamic Capacity Management for Healthcare Advanced Methods and Tools for Optimization Pierce Story, Jumbee, Inc. Wells, Maine Presenting new approaches, tools, and perspectives, this book facilitates the effective management of the complexities and ‘dynamism’ unique to health care operations. It introduces healthcare managers and professionals to state-ofthe-art concepts designed to improve both process- and dynamic systems-focused performance and develop appropriately dynamic process-level solutions to complex systems level issues. Employing common methodologies such as Lean, Sigma Six, and CQI, the ‘Dynamic Capacity Management’ approach addresses the analysis and improvement of hospital- and department-wide capacity, patient flow, resource allocation, and performance optimization. Productivity Press «Market: Healthcare November 2010: 235x156: 235pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1975-3: £38.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1976-0: £38.99/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Business & Management March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-54983-7: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-54984-4: £27.99/04
This book aims to cover the following general topics: development and assessment of theories for evaluating commodity risk; the role of derivative securities in managing commodity risk; and, an assessment of the actual management of commodity risk in specific situations. The primary contribution of the book is the explicit development of the often overlooked connection between risk management and speculation. The central theme is to demonstrate commodity risk management decisions require an in depth understanding of speculative strategies. To this end, this book aims to provide an unified treatment of important concepts and techniques that are useful in applying derivative securities in the management of risk arising in commodity markets.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
business & management 147
Entrepreneurship
Entrepreneurship Marketing *
An International Introduction
Principles and Practice of SME Marketing
Dafna Kariv, College of Management, Israel
Edited by Sonny Nwankwo and Tunji Gbadamosi, both at University of East London, UK
Entrepreneurship means different things to different people, but the entrepreneurial personality is a critical success factor to any new business.
Despite the number of small and medium-sized enterprises (SMEs) in the market, many fail. This can be explained to a significant degree by a lack of understanding of marketing in this sector.
This groundbreaking textbook differs from its competitors by emphasizing both the core processes and practices of entrepreneurship, as well as demonstrating the impact of complex, local environments in shaping processes of entrepreneurship. Selected Contents: Introduction Part I. The Resource Based Perspective in the Entrepreneurial Course Part II. The Process-Oriented Perspective in Entrepreneurship Part III. The Output-Oriented Perspective in the Entrepreneurial Realm Conclusion Routledge «Market: Business & Management January 2011: 246x174: 344pp Hb: 978-0-415-56119-8: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56120-4: £36.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83193-9: £95.00/14
This new textbook introduces the importance of marketing to entrepreneurial firms. Walking the student through the fundamentals of marketing within the SME context, Marketing and Entrepreneurship provides a more value-added learning experience than your standard marketing run-through. Providing a fresh approach for marketing students requiring a more real-world understanding of the impact of their discipline on entrepreneurial firms, the customer insight offered by this book will also benefit entrepreneurship students. Routledge «Market: Business & Management October 2010: 246x174: 448pp Hb: 978-0-415-57375-7: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57376-4: £36.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83864-8: £90.00/14
textbook
Effectual Entrepreneurship *
European Skills and Qualifications
Stuart Read, IMD, Switzerland, Saras Sarasvathy, Darden Graduate School of Business Administration, USA, Nick Dew, Naval Postgraduate School, USA, Robert Wiltbank, Atkinson Graduate School of Management, USA and Anne-Valérie Ohlsson, IMD, Switzerland
Towards a European Labour Market Linda Clarke, University of Westminster, UK and Christopher Winch, University of London, UK European Skills and Qualifications examines the continuing difficulty of recognising and establishing equivalence between qualifications and skills associated with particular national contexts. Focussing on the problems and possible solutions for the differences – conceptual and real – that exist, this book also discusses and analyses the official adoption of the European Qualification Framework and forthcoming changes, including an EU-wide credit accumulation and transfer system.
When you start a new venture – for-profit or not, individually or within existing organizations – you are not only trying to make a good living, you are engaged in expanding the horizon of valuable new economic opportunities. This book offers you expert principles to help you do that, from start to finish.
çè
Routledge «Market: Business & Management November 2010: 276x219: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-58643-6: £110.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58644-3: £39.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83690-3: £110.00/14
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Selected Contents: 1. Introduction 2. Cross National Recognition of Skills and Qualifications in Europe 3. Skills 4. Beruf 5. Competence 6. Savoir 7. Converging Occupations 8. Divergent Occupations in an EU Context 9. Zones of Mutual Trust 10. A Guide to European VET and Qualifications Routledge «Market: Business & Management February 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-55690-3: £100.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-55691-0: £29.99/04
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Selected Contents: Part I: I Want to be an Entrepreneur but… Part II: The Nuts and Bolts of Venturing: Effectuation in Action Part III: I am an Entrepreneur Now: How Far Can I Go?
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
148 business & management
Handbook of Medical Tourism Development
Healthcare Payment Systems * Fee Schedule Payment System Duane C. Abbey, Abbey & Abbey Consultants, Inc., Ames, Iowa, USA
Maria Todd, HealthPro Consoluting, Inc, Brooklyn, USA Written by leading experts in global network development, this book is a guide for hospitals and medical providers wishing to become global. It covers everything from developing a medical tourism network for medical services, diagnostics, wellness checkups, and spa retreats to assessing client satisfaction and patient follow-up. It considers important issues of confidentiality, documentation, safety, revenue implications, and contracting including working with health plans, case managers, professional facilitators, and multinational employers.
Following Healthcare Payment Systems: An Introduction, this second volume in a series by top medical payment expert Duane Abbey provides an overview and discussion of the various fee schedule payment systems used by healthcare providers and third party payers. Designed for hands-on use by providers and their fiscal agents, emphasis is placed on the basic elements of any fee schedule payment system along with the myriad variations that exist to garner payment for physician services, ambulance services, durable medical equipment, prosthetic and orthotics, laboratory services, physical and occupational therapy and associated services, and/or medical products. This volume offers special attention to the Medicare Physician Fee Schedule.
Productivity Press «Market: Medicine March 2011: 254x178: 325pp Pb: 978-1-4398-1314-0: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1315-7: £57.99/17
CRC Press «Market: Healthcare October 2010: 254x178: 144pp Pb: 978-1-4398-4023-8: £38.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4025-2: £38.99/17
2nd Edition
Implementing Lean Six Sigma throughout the Supply Chain *
Feedback Toolkit 16 Tools for Better Communication in the Workplace Rick Maurer, Maurer & Associates, Arlington, Virginia, USA Written by a noted leadership and change management authority, this toolkit provides managers with critical guidelines on effective feedback for high performance based on best practices and offers a six-step framework on the feedback process. It presents tools for giving and receiving feedback in a variety of situations, including one-on-one use and group use. This second edition addresses new developments that include key teachings on overcoming resistance to change, the role of performance appraisals using feedback as a mentoring tool, and modeling feedback on ‘after-action’ reports commonly used in military operations.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Elizabeth A. Cudney, Missouri University of Science and Technology, Rolla, USA and Rodney Kestle From start to finish, this book provides a comprehensive lean six sigma case study. The text follows a team as they implement a lean six sigma project and provides over illustrative 100 figures and tables. Unlike current published case studies, which give only an overview, this in-depth case study presents the data, which are also included in the accompanying CD, and comprehensively explains how the team drew their conclusions. The CD contains all of the data used throughout the case study, so that readers can make the same analyses. In addition, the authors demonstrate the clear linkages between all of the lean six sigma tools. Productivity Press «Market: Business Management October 2010: 254x178: 288pp Pb: 978-1-4398-2814-4: £38.99/04 eBook: 978-1-4398-2815-1: £38.99/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Productivity Press «Market: Business Management January 2011: 229x152: 80pp Pb: 978-1-4398-4093-1: £10.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5632-7056-7
The Comprehensive and Transparent Case Study
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
business & management 149
Implementing TWI Creating and Managing a Skills-Based Culture Patrick Graupp and Robert J. Wrona Featuring modernized implementation strategies employed in Lean initiatives today, this volume describes the experiences of a variety of companies using TWI, more than 60 years after Training Within Industry turned the U.S. into the industrial giant that won World War II. Based on their experience implementing TWI in companies across the world, Graupp and Wrona, highlight critical elements and point out key stumbling blocks to a successful TWI implementation. Designed as a hands-on manual, the book includes case studies as well as a variety of updated tools and templates. Productivity Press «Market: Business Management November 2010: 254x178: 498pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2596-9: £31.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2597-6: £31.99/17
Joan Wellman, Pat Hagan and Howard Jeffries, both at Seattle Children’s Hospital, Washington Blending case studies with practical theory, this book uniquely describes how the healthcare value proposition can be changed by reducing waste, variation, and complexity in healthcare. It reveals the leadership tenacity and culture change required to remove waste from healthcare processes and eliminate the root cause of soaring costs, poor quality and safety, and limited access. It provides practical, applicable advice alongside personal and organizational stories and case studies told by physician and administrative leaders, all students of the Toyota Production System.
çè
Productivity Press «Market: Healthcare December 2010: 235x156: 290pp Pb: 978-1-4398-2865-6: £38.99/04 eBook: 978-1-4398-2866-3: £38.99/17
@
Gary Santorella, Interactive Consulting, Providence, Rhode Island, USA Written by a veteran in the construction field, this reference is the first to address the direct application of Lean initiatives to that specific industry. It uniquely addresses people issues in terms of productivity and waste by applying behavioral psychology principles at a tactical level. The author expands the notion of ethics beyond the simple litmus test of right and wrong so team leaders can adopt proper professional and diplomatic attitudes and behaviors toward the implementation of Lean improvements. Stories and practical examples are included to better aid construction professionals in relating to and applying principles.
Lean for the Public Sector * The Pursuit of Perfection in Government Services Bert Teeuwen, WagenaarHoes Organization, the Netherlands Written specifically to address the application of Lean practices in government and the public sector, this highly original reference covers the basic philosophy of Lean before detailing specific methods to improve processes in the public sector. It addresses concerns unique to the public sector environment and considers the role of the citizen, not only as customer, but as a voter, taxpayer, and community participant. The approach provides a more reality-based view of value-added services and waste in the public sector. The text also includes many explanations of Lean principles and methods, examples, and international case studies for better comprehension. Productivity Press «Market: Business Management November 2010: 254x178: 218pp Pb: 978-1-4398-4022-1: £19.95/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4024-5: £19.95/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Driving Culture Change to Increase Value
for e-mail updates in your field
Building Responsible and Committed Project Teams
Productivity Press «Market: Business Management December 2010: 229x152: 264pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3508-1: £38.99/03 eBook: 978-1-4398-3510-4: £38.99/17
Leading the Lean Healthcare Journey
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
Lean Culture for the Construction Industry
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
150 business & management
Lean Office and Service Simplified Make Your Business The Definitive How-To Guide a Lean Business Drew Locher, Change Movement Associates, Mt. Laurel, New Jersey, USA
A single source, comprehensive reference, this unique book covers all of the relevant concepts pertaining to the coinciding realms of value stream mapping and ‘Lean office’. Providing extensive detail regarding the application of Lean thinking to office and services, this book describes value stream management, standard work, flow, and pull. It defines specific how-to methodologies in exhaustive depth, breaks down key Lean concepts into their elementary components and describes them in the context of office and services, provides implementation strategies on a function-byfunction or department-by-department basis, and includes detailed examples throughout. Productivity Press «Market: Business Management January 2011: 254x178: 136pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2031-5: £25.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2032-2: £25.99/17
How to Create Enduring Market Leadership Paul C. Husby, 3M Company, St. Paul, Minnesota, USA and Jerome Hamilton Written by business leaders for business leaders, this book is a how-to guide on transforming a business and building enduring market leadership. Based on the authors more than 60 years of experience, it provides the tools required to plan, align, and transform businesses, starting with the core business value proposition, and continuing through business planning, disciplined goal and resource alignment, and implementation management. It delineates a logical path to apply initial strategy to every detailed activity, engaging the entire organization to become more competitive day by day. Productivity Press «Market: Business Management March 2011: 229x152: 250pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2999-8: £31.99/03 eBook: 978-1-4398-3000-0: £31.99/17
2nd Edition
Leveraging Lean in Healthcare *
Managing IT Outsourcing *
Transforming Your Enterprise into a High Quality Patient Care Delivery System
Erik Beulen, Pieter Ribbers and Jan Roos, both at Tilburg University, the Netherlands This newly revised edition of Managing IT Outsourcing presents the latest theory, research and practice in this fast-changing field to explore how information outsourcing partnerships can be managed successfully.
Charlie Protzman, George Mayzell and Joyce Kerpchar
Productivity Press «Market: Healthcare November 2010: 279x216: 422pp Pb: 978-1-4398-1385-0: £47.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1386-7: £47.99/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Combining a range of case studies from outsourcing companies across the globe, this book offers examples of real-world industrial experience and expanded coverage of new issues to help the reader keep abreast of new developments in the field. Selected Contents: 1. Changing Business Models 2. The IT Outsourcing Phenomenon 3. Contracts 4. Offshore Outsourcing 5. Business Process Outsourcing 6. Structuring Responsibilities 7. Partnership Risk Management 8. Governance of IT Outsourcing 9. Governance Factors – The Recipient 10. Governance Factors – The Provider 11. Governance Factors – The Relationship 12. Looking Forward Routledge «Market: Business & Management December 2010: 234x156: 336pp Hb: 978-0-415-87322-2: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87323-9: £31.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83479-4: £85.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Expanding on the concepts and tools of lean hospitals and coupling these ideas with the principles of sigma six, this book presents a ‘how-to’ guide to true efficiency in hospitals. Beginning with an overview and description of lean tools, such as Toyota and Gilbreth and Taylor, it demonstrates lean implementation at every level of a hospital including the ED, OR, Radiology, and Cath Lab. The authors discuss traditional methods, typical problems, and a value stream map for each area and provide actionable blueprints, case studies, and lessons learned to facilitate the duplication of lean improvements.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
business & management 151
Manufacturing Intelligence The art of Making Factory Data Talk Michel Baudin, MMTI, Palo Alto, California, USA Written as an aid in obtaining information to solve factory problems, this text explains how to work with the information systems staff to retrieve factory data from the multiple and often incompatible legacy systems they typically reside in. The author examines the three sources of information: direct observation of the situation; interviews with knowledgeable managers, engineers, or operators; and existing data. By presenting solutions for acquiring information, ways to analyze the information, and systems of presentations, the book offers tricks to make the tangle of obsolete and inconsistent legacy systems produce timely answers. CRC Press «Market: Business Management June 2011: 229x152: 250pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2773-4: £38.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2774-1: £38.99/17
Robert Lomas, University of Bradford, UK The ability to write to a high standard is a key skill that is often overlooked in the business world. This short book from an international, best-selling author offers a practical guide to conceiving, researching and writing a business or management dissertation. Masters students across business and management will benefit enormously from reading this book, not just in adding serious value to their dissertations, but also helping to improve their writing skills throughout their business careers.
çè
Selected Contents: 1. Understanding Business Research 2. Where do you Start? 3. Has Somebody Answered my Question Before? 4. Different Questions Require Different Answers 5. How to Use Statistics 6. Planning your Research Project 7. Creating a Narrative Thread for your Dissertation 8. The Mechanics of Writing Routledge «Market: Business & Management / Research Methods November 2010: 216x138: 152pp Hb: 978-0-415-59678-7: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59679-4: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-09314-6: £90.00/14
@
Timothy D. Martin and Jeffrey T. Bell Understanding the thinking behind standardized work is essential to realizing its maximum benefits. This book is an all-inclusive guide to applying standardized work principles to virtually any situation or process. It includes an array of examples that demonstrate how the concepts can be applied in a variety of industries and business applications. In a step-by-step format, the book discusses the relationship of the work period of takt time – as expressed in the short-cycle, long-cycle, and non-cyclic applications – parallel work steps, takt boards, the three main worker interface levels in job designs, and their applications.
Progressive Kaizen The Key to Making Kaizen a Formidable Competitive Weapon John W. Davis Designed to teach the reader how to fully exploit Kaizen events, this book explains the four distinct types of Kaizen and that each has its own particular purpose. The book points out why and how Kaizen should be used as a prominent strategy in implementing Lean. This includes developing a structured plan for Kaizen and giving strong consideration to the insertion of a ‘Waste Reduction Activity Process’ (WRAP), which provides employee incentives for implemented improvements at an individual job level. It outlines how to conduct each type of Kaizen event, who to involve, and what the results should be. Productivity Press «Market: Business Management January 2011: 254x178: 112pp Pb: 978-1-4398-4608-7: £25.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4609-4: £25.99/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
How to Conceive, Research and Write a Good Business Dissertation
for e-mail updates in your field
Techniques for Manufacturing and Business Process Improvement
Productivity Press «Market: Business Management January 2011: 178x254: 176pp Pb: 978-1-4398-4080-1: £31.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4081-8: £31.99/17
Mastering Your Business Dissertation *
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
New Horizons in Standardized Work
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
152 business & management
Risk Management in Organizations An Integrated Case Study Approach Margaret Woods, Aston University, UK Measuring and managing risk is a difficult and often complicated task and the global financial crisis of the late noughties can be traced to a worldwide deficiency in risk management regimes. One of the problems in understanding how best to manage risk is a lack of detailed examples of real world practice. Risk Management in Organizations sets the world of risk management in the context of the broader corporate governance agenda, as well as explaining the core elements of a risk management system. With a detailed array of risk management cases, lecturers and managers will find this a uniquely well researched resource. Selected Contents: Preface: Risk Management and Corporate Governance 1. Introduction 2. How To Use This Book 3. Tesco 4. Royal Bank of Scotland 5. Hammerson plc 6. Department of Culture Media and Sport 7. Birmingham City Council 8. Discussion and Conclusion Routledge «Market: Business & Management / Accounting March 2011: 234x156: 312pp Hb: 978-0-415-59172-0: £100.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59173-7: £34.99/04
Safer Hospital Care Strategies for Continuous Innovation Dev Raheja An examination of the effectiveness of present hospital care methods, this book illustrates how to find simple, comprehensive solutions that produce high return on investment. It emphasizes innovative techniques, proven safety methods, models for risk managers, heuristics for leading change, reliability methods that deliver right care over time, dangers in medical devices for critical care, and techniques for giving care with speed and efficiency without compromising safety. Experts from the aviation industry, world-class organizations such as Toyota and General Electric, and innovative hospitals such as Johns Hopkins offer their insight. Productivity Press «Market: Healthcare December 2010: 235x156: 200pp Pb: 978-1-4398-2102-2: £38.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2103-9: £38.99/17
2nd Edition reader
Revealing the Corporation
Self-Balancing Processes
Perspectives on Identity, Image, Reputation, Corporate Branding and Corporate Level Marketing
True Lean Continuous Flow
Edited by John Balmer, Brunel Business School, UK and Stephen Greyser, Harvard Business School, USA
Since Henry Ford sent the first chassis down an assembly line, line balancing issues have proven hard to eradicate. Often time the achievement of TAKT is an illusion. Human factors, quality of parts, variation all must be considered every day. To maintain continuous flow requires not a single fix, but requires a paradigm shift in thinking that encourages continual self-correcting. Relying on a number of successful case studies of improvements initiated by the author, this book demonstrates ways to recognize weak links and continually solve them. It offers rules, tools (including simulation software), and guidelines to eliminate problems before they start or at the root.
Selected Contents: Part I: Revealing the Corporation: An Integrative Framework Part II: Identity: The Quintessence of an Organization Part III: Corporate Communications: A Dimension of Corporate Meaning Part IV: Corporate Image and Reputation: The Other Realities Part V: The Corporate Brand: An Organization’s Covenant Part VI: Case Study Section Routledge «Market: Business / Management and Marketing March 2011: 246x174: 352pp Hb: 978-0-415-77345-4: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-77346-1: £29.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-28420-2
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Productivity Press «Market: Business Management February 2011: 254x178: 200pp Pb: 978-1-4398-1965-4: £27.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1966-1: £27.99/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
This international and multidisciplinary collection is an eclectic anthology that affords a new way of comprehending organizations, without the need for limitations or narrow perspectives. It is essential reading for those interested in corporate meaning.
Gordon Ghirann
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
business & management 153
Social Media, Crisis Communication and Emergency Management
Staying Lean * Thriving, Not Just Surviving Peter Hines, Pauline Found, Gary Griffiths and Richard Harrison
Utilizing Web 2.0 Technologies
Originally designed as a self-published report, which was awarded the 2009 Shingo Prize, this book draws on the experience of a multi-national company that has successfully implemented Lean in its manufacturing and commercial areas. Based on a model of sustainable change, the text addresses the elements of successful lean management that are often difficult to emulate as well as the more visible features of process management and lean techniques.
Connie White, Jacksonville State University, Alabama Written to teach emergency personnel how to effectively utilize social media and Web 2.0 technologies in emergency planning, preparedness, and response, this book covers the do’s and don’ts of social media when dealing with emergency situations. It explains how government organizations, non-governmental organizations, volunteer, and private emergency agencies can utilize social media for a variety of purposes. Each chapter provides an example of a high profile individual, organization, or agency that utilizes the transformative power of social media. The book also includes exercises so readers can better understand the various uses of social media.
Productivity Press «Market: Business Management January 2011: 254x178: 278pp Pb: 978-1-4398-2617-1: £25.99/04 eBook: 978-1-4398-2618-8: £25.99/17
CRC Press April 2011: 235x156: 288pp Hb: 978-1-4398-5349-8: £44.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5350-4: £44.99/17
textbook
Strategic Management
Standard Work for Lean Healthcare
From Theory to Practice
J. Michael Rona Consulting Group LLC Series: Lean Tools for Healthcare Series Standard work is a major component of kaizen activities and effective Lean tools. Part of the Lean Tools for Healthcare Series, this user-friendly book contains innovative features designed to optimize this tool’s use. The text explains how standard work establishes the best way to do work and why it should be the basis for all continuous improvement activities. It describes work in terms of cycle time, work in process, takt time, and layout. Margin assists reveal key terms and points, how-to steps, and healthcare examples, making this a valuable resource for healthcare professionals starting their Lean journey.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Leadership, adaptability, value creation. These are the skills necessary for tomorrow’s managers. Allen Amason approaches the topic of strategic management with these traits in mind. Rather than simply teaching theory and research, he seeks to communicate to them the fundamental keys to how strategy works. This book is designed to help students think critically and understand fully how to strategically manage their future firms. In so doing, it will enable them to adapt and learn, even as their circumstances change; to apply sound logic and reasoning, even in new and unfamiliar settings. By conveying enduring and fundamental principles of economic and human behavior rather than simply reporting on the latest innovations, this book succeeds in preparing students to excel in the business environment over time, regardless of how it evolves. Routledge «Market: Management March 2011: 254x178: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-87172-3: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87169-3: £34.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-86583-5: £65.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Productivity Press March 2011: 254x178: 120pp Pb: 978-1-4398-3741-2: £18.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3742-9: £18.99/17
Allen Amason, University of Georgia, USA
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
154 business & management
The Exchange Resolution Technique Steven Dinkin, Barbara Filner and Lisa Maxwell Written to provide managers and supervisors with a process for addressing conflicts among their employees, this book adapts the National Conflict Resolution Center’s successful experience in resolving issues into a structured text. The book offers authorities a method of structuring conversations about conflicts and issues. Not only does it provide training through examples to become an effective mediator for disputes filled with emotionally charged personality issues, it provides a strategy for adapting the provided methods to fit the particular needs of every workplace. It also covers background issues that may lead to conflict, including culture and other diversities. Productivity Press «Market: Business Management March 2011: 254x178: 600pp Pb: 978-1-4398-5298-9: £25.99/04 eBook: 978-1-4398-5299-6: £25.99/17
Successful Business Consulting in a Changing World Ann Brooks, Texas State University, USA and Kathy Edwards, University of Texas, Austin, USA The primary focus of this book is to help future consultants build the inquiry and relational skills to increase their effectiveness in helping clients.
Routledge «Market: Management March 2011: 229x152: 300pp Hb: 978-0-415-80048-8: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-80049-5: £33.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
The A3 Workbook * Unlock Your Problem-Solving Mind Daniel D. Matthews Facilitating participation and responsibilty across an entire organization, this one-of-a-kind workbook takes readers step-by-step through the disciplined development of an A3 report, a single-sided piece of paper used by Lean industries to promote efficiency. The A3 provides all employees at all levels with a method to quickly identify a problem, analyze its root cause, select appropriate countermeasures, and communicate necessary actions to decision makers. The workbook includes worksheet templates that can be reproduced and used in future problem solving efforts. Productivity Press «Market: Business Management October 2010: 279x216: 184pp Pb: 978-1-4398-3489-3: £31.99/04 eBook: 978-1-4398-3490-9: £31.99/17
The Case Management Workbook Cherilyn G. Murer and Michael A. Murer, both at Murer Consutants, Inc., Joilet, USA and Lyndean L. Brick With a sinking economy, there are fewer people insured, forcing hospitals to be more prudent with their reimbursement. As a result, hospitals need to move patients more efficiently through their system. This book explores the application of continuum of care. It explains differences in venues, admission requirements, and intended length of stay. More importantly, it provides general knowledge regarding reimbursement structure and regulatory requirements, including a review of MDC and DRGs. The text concludes with a plan of action for designing an effective case management program. The authors also include exercises and exam questions for training team members in effective case management. Productivity Press February 2011: 254x178: 200pp Pb: 978-1-4398-2777-2: £38.99/04 eBook: 978-1-4398-2778-9: £38.99/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Strategies for Managing Conflict in the Workplace
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
business & management 155
The Definitive Guide to Emergency Department Operational Improvement Employing Lean Principles with Current ED Best Practices to Create the ‘No Wait’ Department Joseph T. Crane and Charles E. Noon Emergency Departments were never designed to serve as the walk-in clinics they have become; yet with so many having nowhere else to turn for needed care, they have become cauldrons of resentment in which neither the best needs of patient or hospital are served. Offering a solution to this fiscal and medical madness, this step-by-step guide shows how the application of lean principles can lead to more efficient, cost-effecitve, and patient friendly departments. It brings togethe leading experts who demonstrate the unique application of lean tools and concepts to hospital operations and looks at those hospitals who have put this innovative approach into action. Productivity Press «Market: Healthcare January 2011: 254x178: 352pp Pb: 978-1-4398-0840-5: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0841-2: £57.99/17
The Lean Accounting Handbook Gloria McVay, Winona State University, Minnesota, USA, Frances Kennedy, Clemson University, South Carolina, USA and Rosemary Fullerton, Utah State University, Logan, USA Despite the obvious need for transparency, a company’s lean results can continue to hide behind the mask of traditional accounting and dilute the benefits of a lean implementation. When your organization opts to go lean, its accountants must be empowered with lean tools in service of the lean mission. This step-by-step workbook demonstrates how to develop information and financial reports that serve the needs of lean-minded businesses. It includes checklists, guidelines, exercises, case studies, and company stories. It demonstrates alternative methods of reporting, offers special sections on healthcare and service industries, and includes a step-by-step guide for transitioning to lean accounting. Productivity Press «Market: Business Management March 2011: 279x216: 175pp Pb: 978-1-4200-8858-8: £28.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8859-5: £28.99/14
reader
How to Manage the Media in the Digital Age Jane Jordan-Meier, Jane Jordan & Associates, Green Valley, California, USA Examining communication between the media and the public during times of crisis, this book specifies the definition and stages of a crisis, the role of media, and media ethics during a crisis scenario. It discusses how to develop communication plans, what information to provide, and the role of social media in the present-day digital age. A wealth of case studies demonstrates how to choose the appropriate media outlet and language to convey an informative message and avoid potential ‘bad press’ due to mismanaging a situation.
çè
CRC Press «Market: Information Technology December 2010: 235x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-4398-5373-3: £38.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5374-0: £38.99/17
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
The Future of Global Business * A Reader Edited by Michael Czinkota, Georgetown University, USA and Ilkka Ronkainen A selection of readings from a distinguished group of international marketing researchers and educators are presented for your use in the classroom or your professional reading. In the fast paced world of global business, a key to success is staying current with the recent trends and current research in international marketing. Editors Michael R. Czinkota and Ilkka Ronkainen, both of Georgetown University, use their years of experience to choose a selection of readings noted for its currency, relevancy, and scholarly depth. Routledge «Market: Business & Corporate Strategy January 2011: 229x152: 982pp Hb: 978-0-415-80093-8: £85.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-87813-2: £85.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
The Four Stages of Highly Effective Crisis Management
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
156 business & management
The Toyota Kaizen Continuum
Toyota Kaizen Methods *
A Practical Guide to Implementing Lean
Six Steps to Improvement
Edited by John Stewart, Monomoy Capital Partners, Midway, Kentucky, USA
Isao Kato, TMI, Japan and Art Smalley, Art of Lean, Huntington Beach, California, USA
Written by an expert with 18 years of experience working for Toyota from an entry level operational position through the executive ranks of the company, this book provides a firsthand account of how to implement the Toyota Production System (TPS) throughout an organization. It answers the questions of how to get the process started and how to get senior management excited about the possibilities of an organization that embraces TPS. The author gives real knowledge and examples to equip readers with the ability to make immediate improvements in their area of responsibility in the organization.
This workbook is the first of its kind to document and outline the actual kaizen practices taught within the Toyota Motor Corporation to develop leadership skills and personal responsibility close to the manufacturing floor. By explaining in full context the six basic kaizen principles that govern Toyota, the authors enable readers to improve their own skills and those of their employees making full use of the kaizen approach. The text examines simple analytic methods for work elements, time, motion, production lead-time, machine losses, and standardized work.
Productivity Press «Market: Business Management February 2011: 254x178: 180pp Pb: 978-1-4398-4604-9: £25.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4605-6: £25.99/17
Productivity Press «Market: Business Management October 2010: 279x216: 151pp Pb: 978-1-4398-3853-2: £31.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3854-9: £31.99/17
2nd Edition
2nd Edition
The Measurement Nightmare
The Physician Employment Contract Handbook
Debra Smith, Constraints Management Group, Enumclaw, Washington, USA With supply chains extending further and further, the usefulness of applying the Theory of Constraints (TOC) is becoming more evident. Today’s major companies are using TOC to transition from push to pull manufacturing. This new edition demonstrates TOC’s growth in importance applied to what the author refers to as the four Vs: variability, volatility, visibility, and velocity. This edition adds new chapters detailing the conflicts that large manufacturers face and the areas that every manufacturer must address: materials and supply chain management, project and portfolio management, and production control. Case studies reveal how TOC practices are implemented in the real world. CRC Press «Market: Business Management February 2012: 235x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7620-2: £38.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7622-6: £38.99/14 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5744-4246-5
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
A Guide to Structuring Equitable Arrangments Maria Todd, HealthPro Consoluting, Inc, Brooklyn, USA This revised and updated edition provides an invaluable resource for physicians who are looking to sell their practice and for health systems who wish to become affiliated with a group practice or who are interested in contracting with physicians. The book provides sample physician employment contracts and explains how each contract works. Written by an expert in the field of physician contracting, the text discusses the various legal and compliance issues related to physician employment, such as anti-self referral and anti-kickback issues, and examines how to resolve disputes through arbitration or mediation. The author also outlines the pros and cons of various partnership arrangements. Productivity Press February 2011: 235x156: 240pp Pb: 978-1-4398-1316-4: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1317-1: £57.99/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
How the Theory of Constraints Can Resolve Conflicting Strategies, Policies, and Measures
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
business & management 157
The Practical Application of the Process Capability Study Evolving From Product Control to Process Control Douglas B. Relyea, Quality Principle Associates, Norwich, Connecticut, USA Using real-world examples in the context of the shop floor, this book addresses statistical process control through a non-mathematical, step-by-step explanation of the process capability study. It enables manufacturing personnel to understand how to recover a significant return on their investment from statistical process control. Machine operators and supervisors will better understand how they can communicate their process knowledge to management. Managers will then better understand the limitations of the process as it exists and will have a simple tool for managing process improvement. Productivity Press February 2011: 254x178: 104pp Pb: 978-1-4398-4778-7: £25.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4779-4: £25.99/17
Turbo Flow * Using Plan for Every (PFEP) to Turbo Charge Your Supply Chain Tim Conrad and Robyn Rooks, MPNL Solutions Inventory movement, the pacemaker of the assembly line along with inventory management, how and where parts are used within the factory, requires a detailed inventory plan. This plan is known to Lean operators as A Plan for Every Part (PFEP). It is all about determining the right part at the right time in the quantity needed. This book takes PFEP beyond the manufacturing cell to create a tool for managing the entire supply chain. Written by experts in supply chain integration, this text illustrates how to use PFEP to manage raw materials, WIP, and finished goods inventories. Productivity Press «Market: Business Management November 2010: 254x178: 136pp Pb: 978-1-4398-2067-4: £28.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2068-1: £28.99/17
Transforming Healthcare
Visual Controls *
Virginia Mason Medical Center’s Pursuit of the Perfect Patient Experience
Applying Visual Management to the Factory
Charles Kenney A chronicle of one of the most unusual series of events in the history of medicine, this book tells the story a group of men and women – clinicians, administrators, frontline workers, trustees, and leaders – blessed with vision, courage, and a relentless determination to improve. It is the story of a medical center transformed. Ultimately, it is the story of a new and possibly better way to take on the challenge we face in the United States today to provide superb medical care to our people while at the same time controlling costs.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Leaving little room for mistake, Chris Ortiz lays out what might be the most detailed approach to applying the Lean principles of 5S needed to convert a factory to a fully functional Visual Workplace. The book offers a clear discussion on management’s role in creating a Lean strategy that will implement the visual factory, while also molding the workplace culture needed to sustain it. A crucial section of the book is dedicated to discussing how to design and create visual shadow boards, an area where many efforts stumble. It also discusses right-sizing, Kanban, and ways to measure performance. Productivity Press «Market: Business Management December 2010: 235x156: 152pp Pb: 978-1-4398-2090-2: £25.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2092-6: £25.99/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Productivity Press «Market: Healthcare November 2010: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-1-56327-375-9: £25.99/17
Chris A. Ortiz and Murry Park, both at Kaizen Assembly, Inc., Bellingham
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
158 business & management
Business History
Compliance in Today’s Global Supply Chain *
Complexities and Comparisons Franco Amatori and Andrea Colli, both at University of Bocconi, Italy
Thomas A. Cook, American River International, Melville, New York, USA
This major new textbook on business history brings together the expertise of two internationally renowned authors to provide a thorough overview of the developments in business over the last two centuries. Business History is an exceptional resource for students on economic and business history courses, as well as for practitioners interested in broadening their understanding of business.
Your Customers’ Perception of Quality What it Means to Your Bottom Line and How to Control It Baboo Kureemun and Robert Fantina A detailed examination of a new concept in customer centricity, this book explores customer perception of quality and how to measure it. The author introduces a ground-breaking model for quantifying the impact that poor perception of quality has on the bottom line. It helps readers understand the importance of customer perception, how they may be misunderstanding this vital component, and how they can look at data collected from a variety of sources – surveys, customer conversations with sales representatives, etc. – and glean a clear understanding of their customers’ perception, and the insight necessary to improve it. Productivity Press «Market: Business Management January 2011: 229x152: 176pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4581-3: £31.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4582-0: £31.99/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
CRC Press «Market: Business Management October 2010: 235x156: 291pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8621-8: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8623-2: £49.99/14
Managing Spontaneous Community Volunteers in Disasters A Field Manual Lisa Orloff, World Cares Center, Bloomfield This comprehensive ‘how to’ guide provides readers with the understanding needed to prepare for disasters by effectively engaging, training, and utilizing spontaneous community volunteers. The text supplies volunteer managers with the skill-set needed to enable unaffiliated community volunteers to respond safely to hazards and facilitate an effective response. The author examines potential agency and community relevant roles for community volunteers and the need for flexible span of control as well as ‘just in time’ training. It offers step by step guidelines that address planning and strategies to bridge the gaps between communities and emergency managers. Auerbach Publications February 2011: 235x156: 296pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1833-6: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1834-3: £49.99/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Selected Contents: Part 1: Relevant Issues Part 2: The Company Between the Pre-Industrial Era and the First Industrial Revolution Part 3: The Birth and Consolidation of Big Business Part 4: State and Market in the Period Between the Two World Wars Part 5: From the Postwar Years to the Fall of the Wall: The Age of ‘Shrinking’ Space Part 6: The Globalization of Today Routledge «Market: Business & Management / History March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-42396-0: £105.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-42397-7: £31.99/04
Managing director of ARI and Department of Commerce appointee to the New York District Export Council, Thomas Cook is one of the most accomplished experts on international trade. In this comprehensive yet accessible resource, he provides a step-by-step blueprint for executing a corporate global trade program that is both compliant and cost-effective. The text identifies both traditional concerns and emerging complications, and then puts forward strategies to address them. In providing cost-effective solutions for building and securing a global supply chain, Cook emphasizes continuing education that will sensitize all levels of an enterprise to the importance of abiding by changing regulations.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
business & management 159
Revenue Assurance Expert Opinions for Communications Providers Eric Priezkalns, Revenue Protected Limited, UK A comnination of elements of audit and data analysis to find, correct, and prevent errors that damage financial performance, revenue assurance (RA) provides the operating systems supervisor with techniques to eliminate errors in both human and systems processes, thereby releasing value at relatively little cost. Drawing on the expertise and insights of the authors, this book instructs on the various techniques and discusses how to choose the most effective and efficient method for a specific business. With real world tips and case examples, it provides an extensive and multi-faceted guide to current and future RA practice. Auerbach Publications «Market: Business Management March 2011: 235x156: 456pp Hb: 978-1-4398-5150-0: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5151-7: £49.99/17
Business History and International Business Edited by Peter Buckley, University of Leeds, UK This book examines the interaction of International Business and Business History to produce a satisfying synthesis that covers many aspects of the globalisation of business entities. This book was published as a special issue of Business History. Routledge «Market: Business History / International Business / Microeconomics November 2010: 246x174: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-60060-6: £80.00/08
Business, Marketing, and Management Principles for IT and Engineering Dimitris N. Chorafas, Consultant for Major Corporations, France & Switzerland Presenting the theories, policies, and practices of business management, this book supplies mangers with the practical insight needed to effectively manage their organizations. The first section focuses on how to develop a strategy and how to manage an organization. The second part explains how to stay on track with these strategies and business plans. The last section discusses how to develop competitive products and pricing to stay ahead of the competition. Case studies throughout the text illustrate the right and wrong ways to implement the principles discussed.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Auerbach Publications «Market: Information Technology March 2011: 235x156: 320pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4806-7: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4807-4: £49.99/17
Challenges and Controversies in Management Research * Edited by Bill Lee, University of Sheffield, UK and Catherine Cassell, University of Manchester, UK Series: Routledge Advances in Management and Business Studies Management research has expanded considerably over recent decades. The impetus for such growth comes from a wide range of forces both inside and outside of the academic community stimulate and regulate its development, while the audience for which management research might be considered to be useful and the extent of that usefulness are highly contested. This book seeks to explore the forces that drive the development of management research, shape its current state and influence its future potential. Routledge «Market: Business & Management Studies January 2011: 229x152: 400pp Hb: 978-0-415-47217-3: £100.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83411-4: £100.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
160 business & management Creativity and Innovation in Business and Beyond
Energy Policy in the U.S.
Social Science Perspectives and Policy Implications
Laurance R. Geri, The Evergreen State College, Olympia, Washington, USA and David E. McNabb, Pacific Lutheran University, Tacoma, Washington, USA
Prasada Reddy, Lund University, Sweden
Series: Public Administration and Public Policy
In recent decades, the main concern regarding innovation relates to: multinational corporations relocating R&D to emerging economies’; and some companies from emerging economies entering global markets with innovative products and services, developed through their own R&D. These new developments have corporate strategic and policy implications for host and home countries, which are analyzed in this book.
Edited by Leon Mann, University of Melbourne, Australia and Janet Chan, University of New South Wales, Australia Series: Routledge Studies in Innovation, Organizations and Technology Creativity and Innovation in Business and Beyond illustrates the ways in which creativity spurs innovation – not only in the realms of business and management, but throughout the social sciences. With contributions from experts in fields as far-flung as policy, history, economics, law, psychology, and education, this volume explores the manifold avenues for creativity and innovation within and across a multitude of disciplines. Routledge «Market: Business and Management January 2011: 229x152: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-88010-7: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83306-3: £75.00/14
This comprehensive overview of energy production offers a sweeping analysis of energy policy in the United States since 1945. It describes how policies have led to a high production and consumption model that has provided generally stable supplies of relatively cheap energy. The authors examine the four interrelated institutions that make up the industry: energy Prime Movers, Industry Shapers, Energy Users, and Industry Regulators. They explore the alternative frameworks and policy instruments available to elected and appointed officials. The book also discusses problems and opportunities that could arise in the future. CRC Press «Market: Government and Education March 2011: 235x156: 376pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4189-1: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4190-7: £49.99/17
Cultural Competence for Public Managers Managing Diversity in Today’s World Espiridion Borrego, University of Texas Pan American, Edinburg, USA and Richard Greggory Johnson lll, University of Vermont, Burlington, USA Series: ASPA Series in Public Administration and Public Policy Providing public managers with the tools to manage diverse and multicultural employees, avoid cultural missteps, and create optimal performing organizations, this unique book is grounded in solid theoretical conceptual models, successful government and private sector practices, and international collaborations. Organized thematically, it defines the scope of cultural competence, highlights best practices, and describes variations in responsibility for administering cultural competence for executives, managers, supervisors, and employees. The authors give expert advice for building a culturally competent organization and troubleshooting cultural competence issues. CRC Press «Market: Government and Education March 2011: 235x156: 250pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2807-6: £38.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2808-3: £38.99/17
Politics, Challenges, and Prospects for Change
Gender Equity and Institutional Transformation Advancing Change in Higher Education Diane Bilimoria and Xiangfen Liang, both at Case Western Reserve University, USA Series: Routledge Studies in Management, Organizations and Society Gender Equity and Institutional Transformation offers a complete account of successful approaches to increase the participation and success of women in academia. Providing a comprehensive, stand-alone source of data on the specific organizational change initiatives undertaken at universities targeting the increased participation and advancement of women faculty in academic STEM, this volume documents the outcomes and effectiveness of these transformation efforts to advance the recruitment, advancement and leadership of women faculty. The authors include discipline-specific analyses of the initiatives, and propose an empirically-derived model of organizational change to serve as a template to academic and other organizations seeking transformation related to diversity, equity, and inclusion. Routledge «Market: Business and Management April 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-88562-1: £70.00/08
Global Innovation in Emerging Economies * Series: Routledge Studies in Innovation, Organizations and Technology
Routledge «Market: Business and Management January 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-87966-8: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83367-4: £75.00/14
Governance and Regulation in the Third Sector * International Perspectives Edited by Susan Phillips, Carleton University, Canada and Steven Rathgeb Smith, University of Washington, USA Series: Routledge Studies in the Management of Voluntary and Non-Profit Organizations This book brings together scholars and experienced practitioners from different countries to investigate the relationship between regulation and relational governance for the third sector in a comparative context. Routledge «Market: Business & Management Studies December 2010: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-77477-2: £80.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83507-4: £80.00/08
Green Business, Green Values, and Sustainability Edited by Christos Pitelis, University of Cambridge, UK and Jack Keenan, Grand Cru Consulting, Ltd., UK Series: Routledge Studies in Corporate Governance Bringing together leading academics, scientists and engineers, government leaders, and business executives to consider the central issues involved in the transformation toward sustainability, Green Business, Green Values offers a concise and definitive book on the green transformation of business in major sectors including government, finance, energy, and retail. Different solutions to sustainability are explored including ethical approaches, alternative environmental strategies, corporate responsibility, and carbon reductions.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Business and Management February 2011: 229x152: 185pp Hb: 978-0-415-88382-5: £70.00/08
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
business & management 161 Identity, Feeling and Sociality at Work
Internet Retail Operations
Affective Organizing
Elliot Rabinovich, Arizona State University, Tempe, USA and Timothy M. Laseter, University of Virginia, Charlottesville, USA
Integrating Theory and Practice for Managers
David Grant, University of Sydney, Australia, Rick Iedema, University of New South Wales, Australia, Carl Rhodes and Hermine Scheeres, both at University of Technology, Australia Series: Routledge Studies in Management, Organizations and Society The aim of this book is to examine the ways that contemporary organizing draws increasingly on the affective dimensions of worker sociality. The book explores the different ways that such kinds of affectivity have come to the fore in the contemporary ‘post-bureaucratic’ modes of work that necessitate high levels of social interdependence. Drawing on four detailed case studies the book examines the ways in which affectivity institutes an intensity of interaction in the workplace that involves workers in sociallynegotiated processes through which they not only revisit, (re)define and (re)produce their own tasks, but also their own identities and interpersonal relationships. Routledge «Market: Business & Management Studies April 2011: 229x152: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-45194-9: £75.00/08
Series: Supply Chain Integration Modeling, Optimization and Application The rise of the Internet as the first choice for retail shoppers presents new challenges for retailers and suppliers. This book details how information technology evolved to play such a role in retail supply chain networks, how this has impacted supply chain networks, and how this has changed service operations. The first part of the text addresses information technology in relation to service and retail industries. The second part covers how the new supply chain dynamics impacts traditional service and retail delivery, the costs involved, the impacts on customer service, and customer expectations. The third part presents case studies of how different retailers meet challenges. Taylor & Francis «Market: Business Management April 2011: 229x152: 288pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0091-1: £44.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0092-8: £44.99/17
Performative Imagery in Organizations
European Perspectives
Edited by Paolo Quattrone, Oxford University, UK, Nigel Thrift, University of Warwick, UK, Chris Mclean, University of Manchester, UK and Francois-Regis Puyou, Audencia, Nantes Management School, France
Edited by Victoria Krivogorsky, San Diego State University, USA
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
Series: Routledge Studies in Accounting The growing internationalization of markets, the relaxation of constraints on capital flows between countries, and the creation of different economic unions – the European Union in particular – initiated the flow of capital, goods, and services across national borders, growth and diffusion of shareholding, and increased merger activity among the world’s largest stock exchanges. These changes have stimulated an interest in understanding developments in accounting and corporate governance in a newly qualitative way. Law, Corporate Governance, and Accounting is instrumental in evaluating the corporate governance differences and first outcomes of this accounting convergence for robust policy prescriptions for future regimes.
Productivity Press March 2011: 254x178: 275pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1283-9: £38.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1284-6: £38.99/17
Series: ASPA Series in Public Administration and Public Policy An exploration of the ways in which people skills can be acquired and developed, this book discusses new career development tools, the role of professional commitment statements, psychological contracts, and how to work with difficult people. Each chapter elucidates the development of a specific skill and includes examples, sets benchmarks, and examines how the particular skill’s relationship to the other skills presented in the book. The author covers how to improve interpersonal relationships, communications, job performance, and dealing with people of different ages, gender, and backgrounds. CRC Press «Market: Government and Education June 2011: 235x156: 248pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9385-8: £31.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9386-5: £31.99/14
Routledge «Market: Accounting March 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-87186-0: £65.00/08
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Business and Management February 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-88064-0: £70.00/08
Providing chronic care patients with the ability to travel, medical tourism facilitators work with hospitals and physicians domestically and abroad to arrange referral networks for services, diagnostics, and follow-up care. They coordinate everything from travel arrangements to legal documentation. The first book of its kind, this work covers airport codes and layouts, immigration issues, immunizations and vaccinations, confidentiality / privacy issues, care in transit, and much more to provide a complete handbook for seasoned facilitators and those just entering the field. It also provides invaluable hard to find information for companions, paid or otherwise, who must take on this challenge.
Maria Berman
Imagining Business
Imagining Business addresses the question of how we visualise organizations and their activities as an important aspect of managerial work, focusing on practices and performances, organizing and ordering, and media and technologies. Moreover, it aims to provide a focal point for the growing collection of studies that explore how various business artefacts draw on the power of the visual to enable various forms of organizing and organizations in diverse contexts.
Maria Todd, HealthPro Consoluting, Inc, Brooklyn, USA
People Skills at Work
Law, Corporate Governance, and Accounting
Series: Routledge Studies in Management, Organizations and Society
Medical Tourism Facilitator’s Handbook
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
162 business & management Physician Integration Refocusing the Lens Maria Todd, HealthPro Consoluting, Inc, Brooklyn, USA An insightful look at physician integration in today’s healthcare market, this book draws on the author’s experience and expertise in the field to address those factors relevant to physician integration. He examines topics such as physician reimbursement not keeping pace, declining margins, physician shortages, physician hospital competition, rising practice investment requirements, the return to capitation as a payment mechanism, and changes in physician relationships with health systems. Outlining common characteristics of integrated groups and various organizational structures, the author discusses how to avoid mistakes and provides suggestions and ideas from successfully integrated practices. Productivity Press March 2011: 229x152: 225pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1308-9: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1309-6: £49.99/17
Voluntary Organizations and Public Service Delivery
Edited by Franco Amatori, University of Bocconi, Italy, Robert Millward, University of Manchester, UK and Pier Angelo Toninelli, University of Milan-Bicocca, Italy
Edited by Ian Cunningham, University of Strathclyde, UK and Philip James, Oxford Brookes University, UK
Series: Routledge International Studies in Business History Does state-owned enterprise once again have a future? The essays in this volume offer a contribution to this debate by providing a balanced assessment of two of the most relevant experiences of mixed economies, the UK and Italy. Routledge «Market: Business History March 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-87832-6: £70.00/08
Storytelling and the Future of Organizations * An Antenarrative Handbook
Pluralism in Management Organizational Theory, Management Education, and Ernst Cassirer Eirik Irgens, Nord-Trøndelag University College, Norway Series: Routledge Studies in Management, Organizations and Society In Pluralism in Management , author Eirik Irgens utilizes Ernst Cassirer’s pluralistic philosophy in order to investigate how different but connected forms of knowing, including art, myth, religion, science, and history may help us become better organizational scholars and management educators, forcing us to consider elements outside of a purely practical existence. Revitalizing Cassirer’s almost forgotten philosophy, the book illustrates the value of philosophical application to organizational study. Routledge «Market: Business and Management April 2011: 229x152: 152pp Hb: 978-0-415-88617-8: £70.00/08
Reappraising State-Owned Enterprise
Edited by David M. Boje, New Mexico State University, USA Series: Routledge Studies in Management, Organizations and Society Pioneering thinker in organizational communication David Boje here compiles a collection of new essays on the theme of ‘antenarrative,’ or non-linear narrative, as applied to organizations and business, bringing together different approaches and philosophical interpretations of the concept. Routledge «Market: Business & Management February 2011: 229x152: 360pp Hb: 978-0-415-87391-8: £95.00/08
Sustainability Management Handbook Shirley J. Hansen, Consultant, Gig Harbor, Washington, USA and James W. Brown, Consultant, Austin, Texas, USA A strong sustainability program requires leadership to draw on a solid knowledge base, manage resources wisely, identify sustainability opportunities, make difficult choices, and accept the challenge to lead, influence, and persuade colleagues. This book cuts through the hyperbole and offers practical steps for protecting the world around us. Rich in case studies, it addresses a range of critical stewardship issues. Developed out of a keen desire to protect the planet, the text helps management transform important information and critical leadership skills into socially responsible operations.
Series: Routledge Studies in the Management of Voluntary and Non-Profit Organizations Voluntary Organizations and Public Sector Delivery provides a systematic examination of how voluntary sector employment is being affected by the growing trend to the marketbased outsourcing of the delivery of public services. The volume draws together a team of expert contributors to explore how the process of outsourcing is impacting the internal and external labor markets of voluntary organizations, and the implications for the policy objectives underlying the externalization of the delivery of public services to them. Routledge «Market: Business & Management March 2011: 229x152: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-87473-1: £70.00/08
The Practice of Government Public Relations Edited by Mordecai Lee, University of Wisconsin, Milwaukee, USA, Grant Neeley and Kendra B. Stewart Series: ASPA Series in Public Administration and Public Policy The ability to communicate effectively has an increasing role in public administration. The book guides readers through the ins and outs of external communications. It highlights the importance of government public relations as a tool that can help all public sector agencies implement their missions and increase accountability. The author presents an up-to-date overview of best practices in the field of government public relations, as identified by leading researchers and practitioners. He provides an understanding of the uses of PR tools such as media relations; contributing to an informed public; listening to the citizenry; and crisis management to advance the goals of public agencies. CRC Press «Market: Government and Education April 2011: 235x156: 270pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3465-7: £38.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3466-4: £38.99/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Fairmont Press «Market: Business Management December 2010: 229x152: 300pp Hb: 978-1-4398-5195-1: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5196-8: £89.00/17
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
economics 163
Applied Statistics for Economists Margaret Lewis, College of St. Benedict/Saint John’s University, Minnesota, USA Hitherto, most economists have been forced to resort to business statistics or even general statistics texts in order to introduce quantitative methods to economists. This text moves beyond those and includes a wealth of examples and applications that are specifically relevant to economics. The focus is very much applied, with a wealth of real world examples and problem sets.
Routledge «Market: Economics / Business / Statistics / Mathematics March 2011: 246x174: 400pp Hb: 978-0-415-77798-8: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-55468-8: £33.99/04
Inequality, Development, and Growth Edited by Günseli Berik, University of Utah, Salt Lake City, USA, Yana van der Meulen Rodgers, Rutgers University, USA and Stephanie Seguino, University of Vermont, USA This volume presents a comprehensive analysis of the linkages between inequality, development, and growth from a feminist economics perspective offering a rich array of policy options for promoting gender equality. This book was published as a special issue of Feminist Economics.
Routledge «Market: Economic Theory / Economic Development / Women’s Studies November 2010: 234x156: 192pp Pb: 978-0-415-60994-4: £20.99/03
2nd Edition student reference
Economics: The Basics * Tony Cleaver, University of Durham, UK Series: The Basics Now in its second edition, Economics: The Basics provides an engaging and topical introduction to the key issues in contemporary economics. Fully updated to take into account the economic recession, changing patterns in world trade, housing and currency markets, this book covers:
Introduction to Estimating Economic Models Atsushi Maki, Tokyo International University, Japan Series: Routledge Advanced Texts in Economics and Finance The book is an essential reading in the application of econometric methods to empirical analysis concerning a range of economic issues. It bridges the gap between textbooks on economic theory and econometrics. It teaches methods of estimation in econometrics and the discipline of hypothesis testing well. Through data sets used for estimation derived from Monte Carlo method, students can understand the role of hypothesis testing applied to economic models easily.
• how economic systems function • the boom and bust cycle • the impact of emerging markets • how price, supply and demand interact • the role of the banking and finance industries • the impact of economics on the environment.
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics / Business / Management November 2010: 198x129: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-57108-1: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57109-8: £11.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-09294-1: £55.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-31412-1
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Routledge «Market: Economics December 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-58986-4: £110.00/08 Pb: 978-0-415-58987-1: £45.00/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83949-2: £110.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
With a glossary of terms, suggestions for further reading and new case studies covering subjects including the sub-prime mortgage crisis and changing gold prices, this comprehensive and accessible guide is essential reading for anyone who wants to understand how economics works.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
164 economics
Latin American Economic Development
Mathematics for Economics and Finance
W. Charles Sawyer, Texas Christian University, USA and Javier A. Reyes, University of Arkansas, USA
Michael Harrison and Patrick Waldron, both at Trinity College, Dublin
Latin American Economic Development provides the most up to date exploration of the economy and economics of Latin America, with a focus on why the continent can be considered to have underperformed, how the various Latin American economies function and the future prospects for the region.
Routledge «Market: Economics / Development Studies March 2011: 234x156: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-48613-2: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-49733-6: £36.99/04
The aim of this book is to bring students of economics and finance who have only an introductory background in mathematics up to a quite advanced level in the subject, thus preparing them for the core mathematical demands of econometrics, economic theory, quantitative finance and mathematical economics, which they are likely to encounter in their final-year courses and beyond. The level of the book will also be useful for those embarking on the first year of their graduate studies in Business, Economics or Finance. Routledge «Market: Economics / Finance / Mathematics March 2011: 246x174: 480pp Hb: 978-0-415-57303-0: £125.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57304-7: £44.99/04
Lectures on Political Economy *
Modern Political Economics *
Two Volumes
Making Sense of the Post-2008 World
Knut Wicksell First published in English in 1934 and 1935, this Routledge Revival is a reissue of Swedish economist Knut Wicksell’s hugely influential work two volume work on political economy, aimed at both the professional economist and the advanced student alike. Volume I concerns itself predominiantly with issues of theory, specifically the theory of value, the theory of production and distribution and the theory of capital accumulation, whilst Volume II deals with theories relating to money, currency and credit. Routledge «Market: Economics October 2010: 216x138: 578pp Pack: 978-0-415-60241-9: £150.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83333-9: £150.00/14
Yanis Varoufakis, University of Athens, Greece, Joseph Halevi, University of Sydney, Australia and Nicholas Theocarakis, University of Athens, Greece Once in a while the world astonishes itself. Anxious incredulity replaces intellectual torpor and a puzzled public strains its antennae in every possible direction, desperately seeking explanations for the causes and nature of what just hit it. 2008 was such a moment. Not only did the financial system collapse, and send the real economy into a tailspin, but it also revealed the great gulf separating economics from a very real capitalism. Modern Political Economics has a single aim: To help readers make sense of how 2008 came about and what the post2008 world has in store. This dynamic new book delves into every major economic theory and maps out meticulously the trajectory that global capitalism followed from post-war almost centrally planned stability, to designed disintegration in the 1970s, to an intentional magnification of unsustainable imbalances in the 1980s and, finally, to the most spectacular privatisation of money in the 1990s and beyond.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics / Politics March 2011: 234x156: 384pp Hb: 978-0-415-42875-0: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-42888-0: £33.99/04
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
economics 165
Problems of Economic Policy
Work and Wealth *
Keith Hartley, University of York, UK
A Human Valuation
Series: Routledge Revivals
J.A. Hobson First published in 1977, this is an applied economics text, in which the basic theory of any introductory economics couurse is applied to a whole range of UK macroand micro-economic policy issues. The book is designed specifically for first and second year university students, with the aim of demonstrating the relevance of theory to policy, how theory can be applied to policy problems and, in the process, to improve their understanding of the theory itself.
Series: Routledge Revivals First published in 1914 and reissued with a new introduction in 1992, Work and Wealth is a seminal vision of Hobson’s liberal utopian ideals, which desired to demonstrate how economic and social reform could transform existing society into one in which the majority of the population, as opposed to a small elite, could find fulfillment. Hobson attacked conventional economic wisdom which made a division between the cost of production and the utility derived from consumption. Far from being necesarily arduous, Hobson argued that work had the potential to bring about immense utility and enrichment. The qualitative, humanist work argues in favour of a new form of capitalism to minimise cost and maximise utility.
Routledge «Market: Economics December 2010: 216x138: 236pp Hb: 978-0-415-61071-1: £70.00/03
Routledge «Market: Economics October 2010: 216x138: 402pp Hb: 978-0-415-60243-3: £80.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83555-5: £80.00/14
The German Economy in the Twentieth Century CMYK
Crown Quarto 246x189+3mm
Macroeconomics TBC
Robert J. Rossana, Wayne State University, USA
The German Reich and the Federal Republic
Macroeconomics
Hans-Joachim Braun, Helmut-Schmidt Universität, Germany
RobeRt J.Rossana
Series: Routledge Revivals F irst published in 1990, this book traces the logic and the peculiarities of German economic development through the Weimar Republic, Third Reich and Federal Republic. Providing a comprehensive analysis of the period. The book also assesses controversial issues, such as the origins of the Great Depression, the primacy of politics or economics in the decision to invade Poland and the future risks to the Weltmeister economy of the Federal Republic oppressed by unemployment, the huge debts of some of its trading partners, and the possibility of worldwide protectionism.
Research in macroeconomics in the last thirty years has featured, almost exclusively on two characteristics: an emphasis on the microfoundations of macroeconomics and secondly, intertemporal economics, that is, the behavior of economic actors over time. Curiously, textbooks in intermediate macroeconomics have been very slow to adopt these traits. The aim of this book is to bring intermediate instruction in macroeconomics fully into line with the direction taken by the research community.
Routledge «Market: Economics / Finance / Business April 2011: 246x189: 600pp Hb: 978-0-415-77949-4: £125.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-77950-0: £44.99/04
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 216x138: 294pp Hb: 978-0-415-60959-3: £75.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83245-5: £75.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
166 economics An Economic History of Ireland Since Independence
Bubbles, Law and Financial Regulation
Crises and Cycles in Economic Dictionaries and Encyclopaedias
Andy Bielenberg and Raymond Ryan, both at University College Cork, Ireland
Erik F. Gerding, University of New Mexico, USA
Edited by Daniele Besomi, University of Lausanne, Switzerland
Series: Routledge Explorations in Economic History
This book aims to unpack the complex economic relationships between law, asset price bubbles and financial regulation looking at the financial fraud in the Enron era, the subprime crisis and previous financial crises throughout the world.
This book traces the evolution of the Irish economy since independence looking at how the state sought to shape, regulate and deregulate economic activity to deal with the challenges posed by the wider international environment. Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-56694-0: £90.00/08
Series: The Economics of Legal Relationships
Routledge «Market: Economics February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-77939-5: £90.00/08
Business Ethics and the Austrian Tradition in Economics
This book investigates from the perspective of the major economic dictionaries and encyclopaedias the notions of crises and cycles, featuring entries from Pascal Bridel, Cécile Dangel-Hagnauer, Ludovic Frobert, Harald Hagemann and Alain Raybaut. Routledge «Market: Economics February 2011: 234x156: 640pp Hb: 978-0-415-49903-3: £80.00/08
Hardy Bouillon, SMC University, Vienna
E.E. Slutsky as Economist and Mathematician
From Subjectivism to Social Evolution
Series: Routledge Frontiers of Political Economy
Crossing the Limits of Knowledge
Kiichiro Yagi, Kyoto University, Japan
Drawing on the works of Hayek, Popper and Menger, Bouillon develops a new definition of morally just economic action and subsequently uses it as yardstick to test relevant concepts and topics in business ethics.
Vincent Barnett, University of Birmingham
Series: Routledge Studies in the History of Economics Exploring the work of Austrian and German social scientists such as Carl Menger, Eugen v. BöhmBawerk and Friedrich Wieser, Yagi considers the place of subjective rationality or methodological individualism in the total view of social evolution. Routledge «Market: Economics February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-55404-6: £80.00/08
Autonomy and Formalism in Economics Methodological Tensions of the Marginalist Revolution Edited by Thomas Boylan, National University of Ireland, Galway and Paschal O’Gorman, National University of Ireland, Galway Series: Routledge INEM Advances in Economic Methodology Routledge March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-16188-6: £45.00/08
Bengal Industries and the British Industrial Revolution (1757–1857) Indrajit Ray, University of North Bengal, India Series: Routledge Explorations in Economic History Focusing primarily on cotton textiles, silk textiles, salt manufacturing, ship-building, and indigodye manufacturing, Ray examines how long the industrial revolution in Great Britain took to gain supremacy over Bengal industries. Routledge «Market: Economics January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-59477-6: £85.00/08
order now!
Routledge «Market: Economics February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60025-5: £85.00/08
Capital, Exploitation and Economic Crisis
Series: Routledge Studies in the History of Economics This is the first book in English assessing Slutsky’s contributions to economics and to their links with his influential work in pure mathematics and statistics, with new translations of some of Slutsky’s currently unknown works in economics. Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-54960-8: £80.00/08
John Weeks, University of London, UK
Economic Governance in the EU *
Series: Routledge Frontiers of Political Economy
Implementing Policies with the Financial and Coordination Modes
Marx anticipated crises in capitalism, arguing that it was derivative from the ‘fetishism of commodities’ inherent in the capitalist mode of production; this book substantiates the claim exploring Marx’s analysis of commodities to the recent crisis. Routledge «Market: Economics February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-61055-1: £75.00/08
Contributions to the History of Economic Thought Bertram Schefold, Johann-Wolfgang Goethe Universität, Frankfurt, Germany Series: Routledge Studies in the History of Economics This is the opus magnum of one of the worlds most renowned experts on the history of economic thought, delivering original insights about such well-known figures as Aristotle, Jevons or Wicksell, as well as forgotten or neglected figures and ideas. Routledge «Market: Economics / Intellectual History March 2011: 234x156: 560pp Hb: 978-0-415-43066-1: £85.00/08
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
Willem Molle, Erasmus School of Economics, the Netherlands Series: Routledge Studies in the European Economy This book sets out a systematisation of the theoretical and conceptual underpinnings of the financial and coordination methods used in EU Economic Governance, offering an empirical investigation into a range of European policy processes. Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-56544-8: £90.00/08
Economics and Diversity Carlo D’Ippoliti, University of Rome ‘La Sapienza’, Italy Series: Routledge Frontiers of Political Economy This book takes issue with the concept of ‘heterogeneity’ arguing that Economics should not disregard diversity and that this requires a broader, multidisciplinary approach to the explanation of individual and collective behaviour. Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60027-9: £85.00/08
çè
Austrian and German Economic Thought
Series: Routledge Studies in the History of Economics
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
economics 167 Fighting Market Failure Collected Essays in the Cambridge Tradition of Economics
Financial Liberalization and Economic Performance
Freight Transport and the Modern Economy
Brazil at the Crossroads
Michel Savy, University of Paris 12. and June Burnham, University of Middlesex, UK
Maria Cristina Marcuzzo, University of Rome, Italy
Luiz Fernando de Paula, State University of Rio de Janeiro, Brazil
Series: Routledge Studies in the History of Economics
Series: Routledge Studies in the Modern World Economy
The book brings together Marcuzzo’s major contribution to the Cambridge tradition of economics, focusing on Keynes, Kahn, J. Robinson and Sraffa, who shared in the physical space and lifestyle of Cambridge to an exceptional degree. Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-58310-7: £85.00/08
Energy, Bio Fuels and Development * Comparing Brazil and the United States Edited by Edmund Amann, University of Manchester, UK, Werner Baer, University Of Illinois, Urbana, USA and Don Coes, University of New Mexico, USA Series: Routledge Studies in Development Economics This collection examines the important and topical issue of the economic, social and environmental implications of concerted attempts to diversify energy sources away from fossil fuels. The book expertly examines this issue by focussing on the contrasting experiences of two major economies; one developed, and the other a rapidly expanding, emerging market. Energy, Bio Fuels and Development evaluates the experience of Brazil, with elements of that of the US highlighted for the purpose of comparison. A key area of concern surrounds the causes and consequences of the contrasting routes to biofuel production represented by sugar cane (in Brazil) and corn (in the US). The book also places the recent biofuels drive in perspective by discussing the broader energy policy context. The book shows the complexity and interdependence of the issues involved in moving a society reliant on non-renewable energy sources to one based on alternative sources of energy. Routledge «Market: Economics December 2010: 234x156: 336pp Hb: 978-0-415-56720-6: £85.00/08
Since the beginning of the 1990s, Brazil has followed a pattern of economic development inspired by Washington Consensus. This framework includes a set of liberalising and market friendly policies such as privatisation, trade liberalization, stimulus to foreign direct investment, tax reform, and social security reforms. This book assesses the determinants and impacts of financial liberalisation in Brazil considering its two dimensions: the opening up of the balance of payments capital account, and the penetration by foreign bank of the domestic banking sector. The author combines theoretical and empirical analyses. Some make use of mathematical models and/or statistical techniques; however, they are only used when they are strictly necessary to the analysis. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-46009-5: £80.00/08
Freedom and Happiness in Economic Thought and Philosophy From Clash to Reconciliation Edited by Ragip Ege, University of Strasbourg, France and Herrade Igersheim, Aix-Marseille University, France Series: Routledge Frontiers of Political Economy This book brings together modern European research from leading scholars looking at the fundamental debates and issues surrounding the economics and philosophy of happiness, looking at the work of Hume, Smith, Mill and Jevons. Routledge «Market: Economics February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-57948-3: £85.00/08
Series: Routledge Studies in the Modern World Economy This book presents the transport of freight as a system, mixing information and theory, so as to show how it itself functions and its strong influence on a wide economic and social environment. Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-57750-2: £85.00/08
General Equilibrium Analysis A Century after Walras Edited by Pascal Bridel, University of Lausanne, Switzerland Series: Routledge Studies in the History of Economics This book brings contributions from the likes of Kenneth Arrow, Alan Kirman, Richard Posner, Amartya Sen and Robert Solow to share their thoughts and reflections on the theoretical heritage of Léon Walras and general equilibrium theory. Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-59464-6: £85.00/08
Global Politico-Economic Crises * The pragmatic approach Keiichiro Komatsu, Komatsu Research & Advisory, UK Series: Routledge Studies in the Modern World Economy This book examines the threats to the world economy arising in the wake of the tragedy of 11th September 2001 and the preceding Asian financial crisis of 1997. Routledge «Market: Economics February 2011: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-47766-6: £70.00/08
From Bioeconomics to Degrowth Georgescu-Roegen’s ‘New Economics’ in Eight Essays Nicolas Georgescu-Roegen
Global Population Ageing and Migration in Europe *
Edited by Mauro Bonaiuti, University of Bologna, Italy
Bo Malmberg, Stockholm University, Sweden, Kristof Tamas, David Bloom, Harvard University, Rainer Munz and David Canning
A Minskian Analysis
Series: Routledge Studies in Ecological Economics
Series: Routledge Studies in the European Economy
Eric Tymoigne, Lewis and Clark College, USA and L. Randall Wray, University of Missouri, Kansas City, USA
Nicolae Georgescu-Roegen (1906–1994) is considered today as perhaps the chief founder of the transdisciplinary field today known as Ecological Economics, but that he defined himself as Bioeconomics. In his later years GeorgescuRoegen intended to write a book of this title that would systematize what he considered to be the most significant results of his work. This project intends to resume this project, publishing a collection of the most relevant Georgescu-Roegen essays on Bioeconomics, including previously unpublished papers.
This book focuses on the extent European external policies should be reconsidered in the light of current demographic challenges, focusing on current demographic trends, an analysis of demographic transitions and European migration policies.
Financial Structure and Income Distribution
Series: Routledge Critical Studies in Finance and Stability The book studies the trends that led to the worst financial crisis since the Great Depression, as well as the unfolding of the crisis, showing that Minsky’s approach can be used to draw some policy implications to improve financial stability.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
Routledge «Market: Environment / Economics February 2011: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-58700-6: £85.00/08
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-59193-5: £85.00/08
Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-55123-6: £80.00/08
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
168 economics Globalization, Outsourcing and Labour Development in ASEAN
Intellectual Property Rights in Contemporary Capitalism *
Multilateralism and Regionalism in Global Economic Governance
Shandre Thangavelu, National University of Singapore and Aekapol Chongvilaivan, Institute of Southeast Asian Studies, Singapore
Edited by Birgitte Andersen, University of London, UK
Trade, Investment and Finance
Series: Routledge Studies in the Modern World Economy
Series: Routledge Studies in the Modern World Economy
Edited by Junji Nakagawa, University of Tokyo, Japan Series: Routledge Studies in the Modern World Economy
This new book fills an important gap in the literature looking at the impact outsourcing has on labour markets, its subtle effects on regional economies and policy implications in ASEAN countries with empirical evidence.
This book is a timely contribution to an important debate on the increased, changed or new scope of Intellectual Property Rights in the light of Contemporary Capitalism and focusing on evidence from sector studies as well as inter-disciplinary theory-perspectives.
Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-56745-9: £90.00/08
Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-48346-9: £80.00/08
Happiness, Ethics and Economics
Keynes and Modern Economics
Johannes Hirata, University of Applied Sciences Osnabrück, Germany
Series: Routledge Studies in the History of Economics
Series: Routledge International Studies in Money and Banking
Leading economists including Ed Nell and Heinz Kurz have joined forces in this volume with internationally respected Japanese scholars to produce a strong collection of contributions to the debate on Keynes’ monumental legacy.
The book assembles chapters by researchers in philosophy, history, political science, sociology and economics who have not only produced significant innovations in the theory of money, but also have an interest in interdisciplinary cooperation.
Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-46977-7: £80.00/08
Routledge «Market: Economics January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-59525-4: £85.00/08
Labour-Intensive Industrialization in Global History *
Political Economy and Liberalism in France The Economic Contributions of Frédéric Bastiat
Series: Routledge Frontiers of Political Economy
Edited by Gareth Austin, London School of Economics, UK and Kaoru Sugihara, Kyoto University, Japan
Eric A Schutz argues that social power is a fundamental part of the story of rising economic inequality in these times and offers a theoretically focused discussion on the role of social power in comprehending economic inequality.
This volume presents a discussion on the significance of labour-intensive industrialization by leading economic historians and seeks to foster a new academic dialogue on global economic history.
This book provides a comprehensive analysis of the work of Frédéric Bastiat’s (1801–1850), the influence on his thought by Smith, Ricardo and Malthus and his impact on economics and liberalism in the mid-nineteenth century.
Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-55480-0: £80.00/08
Routledge «Market: Economics February 2011: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-45552-7: £75.00/08
Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-58055-7: £85.00/08
Innovative Fiscal Policy and Economic Development in Transition Economies
Market Liberalism, Growth, and Economic Development in Latin America
Public Expenditures for Agricultural and Rural Development in Africa
Aleksandr V Gevorkyan, Capco, USA
Edited by Gerardo Angeles Castro, Instituto Politecnico Nacional, Mexico, Ignacio Perrotini-Hernández, Ciudad Universitatia and Humberto Ríos-Bolivar
Edited by Tewodaj Mogues and Samuel E. Benin, both at International Food Policy Research Institute, USA
This book provides a stringent interpretation of the evidence on the relationship between economic conditions and life satisfaction and shows that it can be understood with the help of a handful of psychological and economic effects. Routledge «Market: Economics February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-58404-3: £85.00/08
Inequality and Power An Essay on the Economics of Class Edited by Eric A. Schutz, Rollins College, USA
Series: Routledge Studies in the Modern World Economy This book explores the problems of fiscal policy as an instrument of economic and social development in the modern environment, primarily focusing on the transition economies of Eastern Europe, Caucasus, and Central Asia. Evaluating the transformational experience in these countries, this work meets a need for a critical analysis in the aftermath of the 1990s market liberalization reforms, of current trends and to outline the roadmap for future development. Routledge «Market: Economics February 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-59807-1: £85.00/08
order now!
Series: Routledge Explorations in Economic History
Series: Routledge Studies in Development Economics
New Approaches to Monetary Economics and Theory Interdisciplinary Perspectives Edited by Heiner Ganßmann, Free University, Berlin
Robert Leroux, University of Ottawa, Canada Series: Routledge Studies in the History of Economics
Series: Routledge Studies in Development Economics
Using a combination of theoretical approaches, this book looks at economic liberalization in Latin America and new developments in this region, in terms of the impact these policies had on growth, poverty and inequality.
The book brings together recent analysis of public spending for agricultural growth and rural development in Africa, providing insights on the contributions of different types of public expenditures for poverty, growth and welfare outcomes.
Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-57374-0: £90.00/08
Routledge «Market: Economics January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60367-6: £85.00/08
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Series: Routledge Frontiers of Political Economy
Edited by Ryuzo Kuroki, University of Rikkyo, Japan
Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-59569-8: £95.00/08
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
economics 169 Seeking Sustainability *
The Constitution of Liberty
On the Prospect of an Ecological Liberalism
F.A. Hayek
The Evolving Structure of the East Asian Economic System since 1700
G.J. Paton, University of Sydney, Australia
Edited by Ronald Hamowy
A Comparative Analysis
Series: New Political Economy
Series: The Collected Works of F.A. Hayek
This book is born of the need for a critique of current approaches to environmental policy and governance and the search for alternative sustainability frameworks.
Originally published in 1960, The Constitution of Liberty delineates and defends the principles of a free society and traces the origin, rise, and decline of the rule of law. Casting a skeptical eye on the growth of the welfare state, Hayek examines the challenges to freedom posed by an ever expanding government as well as its corrosive effect on the creation, preservation, and utilization of knowledge. In distinction to those who confidently call for the state to play a greater role in society, Hayek puts forward a nuanced argument for prudence. Guided by this quality, he elegantly demonstrates that a free market system in a democratic polity – under the rule of law and with strong constitutional protections of individual rights – represents the best chance for the continuing existence of liberty. Striking a balance between skepticism and hope, Hayek’s profound insights remain strikingly vital half a century on.
Edited by A.J.H. Latham, University of Wales, Swansea, UK and Heita Kawakatsu
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-56610-0: £90.00/08
Social Banks and the Future of Sustainable Finance Olaf Weber and Sven Remer, both at Institute for Social Banking, Germany Series: Routledge International Studies in Money and Banking The book describes and explains the history, the current state and the development of social and sustainable banking, covering a range of topics featuring case studies of different social banks worldwide. Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-58329-9: £85.00/08
Essays in Honour of Bertram Schefold
South-South Globalization
Edited by Volker Caspari, Darmstadt Technical University, Germany
Challenges and Opportunities for Development
Series: Routledge Studies in the History of Economics
Edited by Syed Mansoob Murshed, Institute of Social Studies, the Netherlands, Pedro Goulart and Leandro Serino, both at Institute of Social Studies, the Hague
This book consists of contributions by distinguished economists from Europe, the US and Japan, covering a range of topics chosen according to Bertram Schefold’s main fields of research, from Wicksell to Sraffa to Marx.
This volume will bring together contributions from key researchers to address the unified theme of South-South economic cooperation and interaction in a recession affected globalized and interdependent world. Routledge «Market: Economics February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-59217-8: £85.00/08
Routledge «Market: Economics February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-59683-1: £85.00/08
Series: Routledge Studies in Global Competition
Series: Routledge Studies in Crime and Economics With thorough analysis of original empirical date, Verhage provides a rich and illustrative insight in the world of compliance officers and the sometimes paradoxical anti-money laundering system that they have to work within.
The Foundations of Institutional Economics K. William Kapp Edited by Sebastian Berger, Roanoke College, Virginia, USA and Rolf Steppacher Kapp was one of the leading 20 th century institutionalists and this volume presents his analysis of the foundations of institutional economics. Unpublished since his death, this volume comes complete with a thorough editorial introduction. Routledge «Market: Economics February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-58655-9: £85.00/08
The Global Economic Crisis New Perspectives on the Critique of Economic Theory and Policy
Series: Routledge Frontiers of Political Economy
The Evolving Firm in the Evolving Context * Päivi Oinas, Helsinki School of Economics, Finland
Antoinette Verhage, University of Gent, Belgium
Routledge «Market: Economics February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60032-3: £85.00/08
Edited by Emiliano Brancaccio, University of Sannio, Italy and Giuseppe Fontana, University of Leeds, UK
Coordinating Competences
The Anti Money Laundering Complex and the Compliance Industry
Bringing together leading scholars from both the east and west, this book offers fascinating insights into the cotton trade, the rice, wheat and shipping industries and the development of trade and finance in East Asia.
Series: Routledge Frontiers of Political Economy
Routledge March 2011 Hb: 978-0-415-03530-9: £80.00/11
The Evolution of Economic Theory
Series: Routledge Studies in Development Economics
Series: Routledge Explorations in Economic History
This volume offers a broad social scientific view of ‘the firm’ and will prove to be an outstanding contribution to evolutionary political economy, economic geography and business economics as whole. Routledge «Market: Business and Industrial Economics December 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-33966-7: £70.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-44943-1: £70.00/14
This book constitutes a collection of new work proposing reinterpretations of the primary schools of heterodox economics, stringent critiques of the mainstream readings of the recession and alternative economic policies to those hitherto adopted. Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-58661-0: £85.00/08
The Ideas of Ronald H. Coase Market Failure and Planning by Contract for Sustainable Development Lawrence W.C. Lai, University of Hong Kong, Republic of China Series: Routledge Studies in the History of Economics
Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-60076-7: £85.00/08
This book shows how Ronald H. Coase’s theories can be used to establish a practical pro-planning agenda without compromising the freedom of contract or private property rights as pillars of a market economy in the context of sustainable development.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-55906-5: £90.00/08
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
170 economics The Impact of China on Global Commodity Prices
The Planet in 2050 *
The Global Reshaping of the Resource Sector
Edited by Jill Jäger, Independent scholar and Sarah Cornell, University of Bristol, UK
Matthew Smith, University of Sydney, Australia
Series: Routledge Studies in Ecological Economics
The purpose of this book is to provide a comprehensive account and reconsideration of the contribution to political economy of Thomas Tooke (1774–1858) throwing new light on monetary analysis within the framework of classical economics.
Masuma Farooki and Raphael Kaplinsky, Open University, UK Series: Routledge Studies in the Modern World Economy This book looks at the impact of China on global prices and though this on other low income economies, considering both the possibility of a sustained rise in commodity prices as well as the growing financialisation of global commodity markets. Routledge «Market: Economics February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-59789-0: £85.00/08
The Incredible Complexity of the Social Sciences Donald Saari, University of California, Irvine Series: The Graz Schumpeter Lectures Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-78038-4: £70.00/08
Edited by Joonmo Cho, Sungkyunkwan University, Korea, Richard B. Freeman, Harvard University, USA, Jaeho Keum, Korea Labor Institute, Korea and Sunwoong Kim, University of Wisconsin, Milwaukee, USA Series: Routledge Studies in the Modern World Economy This new book looks at the issues that have faced the Korean labour market since the financial crisis, tracing the rise in inequality between workers and the effect of expansion in higher education, increased longevity and the low fertility. Routledge «Market: Economics February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-59209-3: £85.00/08
The Political Economy of Capital Definitions and Transformations Howard Engelskirchen Series: Routledge Frontiers of Political Economy In this new analysis of Marxian Political Economy, Howard Gelsenkirchen focuses in on the social theory underpinning much of Marx’s writing and as such provides a new perspective on his defining work – Das Kapital. Routledge «Market: Economics February 2011: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-77691-2: £80.00/08
The Rule of Law * The Justice Sector and Economic Development Edited by Maria Dakolias, The World Bank, Washington DC, USA and Sandra E. Oxner
The Political Economy of Bureaucracy *
Thomas Tooke and the Monetary Thought of Classical Economics Series: Routledge Studies in the History of Economics
Routledge «Market: Economics February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-58393-0: £85.00/08
Utility Theory * German Contributions John Chipman, University of Minnesota Series: Routledge Studies in the History of Economics In this ground breaking book, John Chipman introduces new translations of important writings from German economists such as Rau, Hildebrand, Roscher and Knies showing that the modern theory of marginal utility originated with them. Routledge «Market: Economics March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-78113-8: £85.00/08
Value Chains, Social Inclusion and Economic Development Contrasting Theories and Realities Edited by Bert Helmsing, the Hague Institute of Social Studies, the Netherlands and Sietze Vellema, Wageningen University, the Netherlands Series: Routledge Studies in Development Economics There is growing recognition that governance of value chains plays a crucial role in issues of inclusion and endogenous economic growth and this book focuses on the links between international firm strategies and local development processes. Routledge «Market: Economics February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-59163-8: £85.00/08
Series: The Economics of Legal Relationships
Series: Routledge Frontiers of Political Economy Richardson offers a careful analysis of US federal agencies examining the interaction between executive and legislative branches of government, combining Austrian economics, Public Choice and Evolutionary methodology in his approach.
Today we recognize that to promote investment and jobs, laws and legal institutions must provide an environment conducive to economic activity. To reduce poverty requires a rule of law where the entire legal sector functions effectively, transparently, and with due process. Maria Dakolias demonstrates how reforms related to the justice sector continue to contribute to economic development. Routledge «Market: Economics December 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-77253-2: £80.00/08
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Steven O. Richardson, Center for Program Planning and Results, Department of Labor, USA
order now!
This book is a contextualised collation of ideas articulated by the 50 participants of the Planet 2050 workshop held in Lund in October 2008, as part of The Planet in 2050, an interdisciplinary Fast Track Initiative of the International GeosphereBiosphere Programme. Participants were selected from academia and the sustainability practice community to give a wide-ranging, multi-cultural, trans-disciplinary set of perspectives. This collection explores four broad sectoral themes: energy and technologies; development, economies and culture; environment; and land use change. By doing so, this book emphasises the importance of a social dialogue on our collective future, and our responsibility to the Earth. It makes strong statements about what needs to happen to the global economy for a sustainable future and documents a new kind of scholarly discussion, engaging people from diverse knowledge communities in a spirit of exploration and reflexivity. Routledge «Market: Environment / Economics / Politics November 2010: 216x138: 128pp Hb: 978-0-415-59000-6: £75.00/08
The Korean Labour Market after the 1997 Economic Crisis
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-58856-0: £75.00/08
The Lund Discourse of the Future
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
geography & gis 171
An Introduction to Visual Research Methods in Tourism Edited by Tijana Rakic, Napier University, UK and Donna Chambers, University of Surrey, UK
Children, Youth and the City Kathrin Horschelmann, University of Durham, UK and Lorraine van Blerk, Brunel University Series: Routledge Critical Introductions to Urbanism and the City Painting a vivid picture of children and youths in the city, the authors analyze theoretical arguments and international case studies to explore how they make sense of city life, and how they appropriate it through their social actions.
Series: Contemporary Geographies of Leisure, Tourism and Mobility This is the first book to present, discuss and promote the use of a range of visual methods, including still and moving images within the context of tourism research. The book discusses questions surrounding philosophical approaches, (inter)disciplinary location, range and choice of methods, implementation and data analysis techniques to provide an essential guide to using visual methods in tourism research. The discussions surrounding these key issues are supplemented with international case studies from existing research to show how these methods are used in practice. In addition to this practical tip boxes are included to help avoid some of the pitfalls associated with visual research. Routledge «Market: Tourism Research Methods February 2011: 234x156: 252pp Hb: 978-0-415-57004-6: £90.00/08 Pb: 978-0-415-57005-3: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85586-7: £90.00/14
elected Contents: 1. Introduction S 2. Theorising and Researching Children and Youth in the City 3. The Causes of Effects of Social Inequalities on Children and Youth in the City 4. Growing up in the City – How Children and Youth Experience Urban Space 5. Globalisation and Urban Youth Culture 6. Participation and Active Citizenship in the City 7. Conclusion Routledge «Market: Geography March 2011: 234x156: 236pp Hb: 978-0-415-37693-8: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-37692-1: £20.99/04
5th edition reader
Carbon Management in Tourism Mitigating the Impacts on Climate Change Stefan Gossling, Lund University, Sweden
City Reader Edited by Richard T. LeGates and Frederic Stout Series: Routledge Urban Reader Series The fifth edition of the highly successful The City Reader juxtaposes the best classic and contemporary writings on the city, containing fifty-seven selections including seventeen new selections. The fifth edition has been extensively updated and expanded to reflect the latest thinking in each of the disciplinary areas included and in topical areas such as sustainable urban development, climate change, globalization, and the impact of technology on cities. The plate sections have been extensively revised and expanded and a new plate section on global cities has been added.
Series: Routledge International Series in Tourism, Business and Management Tourism is one of the world’s largest industries, which both contributes to, and will be notably affected by, climate change. Given the emerging global legal frameworks, the growing costs of carbon and environmentally orientated customers, carbon management will be a future necessity. Carbon Management in Tourism is the first book devoted to these issues and showcases a wide range of measures that help to achieve a lower carbon tourism future. This book combines theory and practice of climate change mitigation in global tourism, addressing various levels of scale, and provides thorough scientific discussion of the causes of emissions growth, reducing emissions and carbon management practices. International case studies demonstrate how tourism businesses or destinations have successfully reduced emissions of greenhouse gasses, considering economic and socio-cultural issues are integrated throughout.
Routledge «Market: Urban Studies / Planning January 2011: 246x189: 672pp Hb: 978-0-415-55664-4: £100.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-55665-1: £31.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-86926-0: £100.00/14
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Tourism December 2010: 246x174: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-56632-2: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56633-9: £29.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-86152-3: £95.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
172 geography & gis
Environment and Economy *
Envisioning Landscapes, Making Worlds
Molly Scott Cato, University of Wales Institute, UK Series: Routledge Introductions to Environment
Geography and the Humanities
Environment and Economy begins by introducing readers to the pioneers of this field, such as Fritz Schumacher and Paul Ehrlich, who first drew attention to the disastrous consequences for our environment of our ever-expanding economy. The second part of the book describes the main academic responses to the need to resolve the tension between economy and environment: environmental economics, ecological economics, green economics, and anti-capitalist economics. Part III is structured around key themes including an introduction to economic instruments such as taxes and regulation; pollution and resource depletion; growth; globalisation vs. localisation; and climate change. Each key issues is approached from a range of different perspectives, and working policies are presented in detail.
Edited by Stephen Daniels, University of Nottingham, UK, Dydia DeLyser, Louisiana State University, USA, J. Nicholas Entrikin, UCLA, USA and Doug Richardson, Association of American Geographers, USA Envisioning Landscapes, Making Worlds examines the depth and complexity of human meaning invested in maps, attached to landscapes, and embedded in the spaces and places of modern life. The clashing and blending of cultures caused by globalization and the new technologies that profoundly alter human environmental experience suggest new geographical narratives and representations that are explored here by a multidisciplinary group of authors. With contributions from leadng scholars, this text is essential reading for scholars and students seeking to understand the new synergies and interconnectedness of geography and the humanities.
Routledge «Market: Environmental Studies / Economics January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-47740-6: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-47741-3: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83415-2: £75.00/14
Routledge «Market: Geography January 2011: 234x156: 352pp Hb: 978-0-415-58977-2: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58978-9: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83928-7: £85.00/14
Environment and Food
Event Policy
Colin Sage, University College Cork, Eire
From Theory to Strategy
Series: Routledge Introductions to Environment
David Mcgillvray, Malcolm Foley and Gayle McPherson
Routledge March 2011: 234x156: 252pp Hb: 978-0-415-36311-2: £70.00/08 Pb: 978-0-415-36312-9: £20.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-01346-5: £70.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Events Policy: From Theory to Strategy locates the phenomena of events within a theoretical and strategic framework and in doing so demonstrates the links between the development of events in policymaking and the theoretical exploration of the role of events as policy. Building on a strong coherent framework the book explores the conceptual terrain in which events and festivities are located, evaluates the range of theoretical perspectives pertinent to the study of events policy, appraises the socioeconomic and socio-cultural implications of event-led policies internationally and draws together the main theoretical and event policy issues for the future. The text utilises a range of international cases to help demonstrate the relationships between theory and strategy. Routledge «Market: Tourism / Events and Leisure February 2011: 234x156: 324pp Hb: 978-0-415-54832-8: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-54833-5: £29.99/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
This timely book provides a thorough introduction to the inter-relationship of food and the environment. Although human societies control a large proportion of earth’s resources for the purpose of food production, we remain subject to the effective functioning of global ecosystem services. The importance of these services are highlighted to explain why we should be concerned about the depletion of freshwater resources, soil fertility decline and loss of biological diversity. This book also discusses challenges, such as climate change and the prospect of significantly higher energy prices, which are likely to have significant implications for the long-term functioning of global supply chains and raise profound questions regarding the nutritional security of the world’s population. Environment and Food is a highly original, inter-disciplinary and accessible text. It is richly illustrated with figures and makes extensive use of boxes to highlight relevant examples.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
geography & gis 173
GeoHumanities
Handbook of Urban Ecology *
Art, History and Text at the Edge of Place
Edited by Ian Douglas, University of Manchester, UK, David Goode, University College London, UK, Mike Houck, Portland State University, USA and Rusong Wang, Chinese Academy of Sciences, China
Edited by Michael Dear, Jim Ketchum, Sarah Luria and Douglas Richardson GeoHumanities explores the creative zone at the edge of the humanities’ rapidly expanding engagement with geography, and the multi-methodological inquiries that analyze the meanings of place, and then reconstruct those meanings to provoke new knowledge as well as the possibility of altered political practices. It is no coincidence that the geohumanities are forcefully emerging at a time of immense intellectual and social change. The book’s contributors address urgent contemporary imperatives, such as the link between creativity and place; altered practices of spatial literacy; the increasing complexity of visual representation in art, culture, and science; and the ubiquitous presence of geospatial technologies in the Information Age. Routledge «Market: Geography February 2011: 234x156: 384pp Hb: 978-0-415-58979-6: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58980-2: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83927-0: £80.00/14
This Handbook contains original contributions from leading academics and practitioners from across the world to provide an in-depth coverage of the main elements of practical urban ecology. The sixty five chapters provide practitioners and students with the wealth of interdisciplinary information needed to manage the biota and green landscapes in urban areas. In six parts it deals with the philosophies, concepts and history of urban ecology; followed by consideration of the biophysical character of the urban environment and the diverse habitats found within it. It then examines human relationships with urban nature, the health, economic and environmental benefits of urban ecology before discussing the methods used in urban ecology and ways of putting the science into practice. Routledge «Market: Environmental Science / Geography / Planning / Urban Studies December 2010: 246x174: 744pp Hb: 978-0-415-49813-5: £150.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83926-3: £150.00/14
3rd Edition textbook
2nd Edition textbook
Fundamentals of Geomorphology
Geographies of Globalization Warwick Murray, Victoria University of Wellington, New Zealand
çè
Routledge «Market: Geomorphology / Geography and Environmental Sciences February 2011: 246x189: 528pp Hb: 978-0-415-56774-9: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56775-6: £32.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-86008-3: £90.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-39084-2
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Series: Routledge Contemporary Human Geography Series Geographies of Globalization offers a lively exploration of the geographical impacts of globalization and the distinctive contribution of human geography to studies and debates in this field. Fully up-to-date and engaging, this work critically appraises the concept and processes of globalization from a geographical perspective, debates the historical evolution of globalized society and illustrates how the core principles of human geography – such as space and scale – lead to a better understanding of the phenomenon. This book analyses the interconnected economic, political and cultural geographies of globalization and discusses the challenges for the environment and the Third World created by globalizing processes. Boxed sections highlight key concepts and innovative work by geographers. The book is also illustrated with a wide range of figures, photographs, and maps. Routledge «Market: Geography / Sociology / Development Studies February 2011: 234x156: 416pp Hb: 978-0-415-56761-9: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56762-6: £25.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-86019-9: £95.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-31800-6
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
This extensively revised and updated edition presents an engaging and comprehensive introduction, exploring the world’s landforms from a broad systems perspective. It reflects on the latest developments in the field and includes new chapters on geomorphic materials and processes, hillslopes and changing landscapes. Fundamentals of Geomorphology begins with a consideration of the nature of geomorphology and the geomorphic system, geomorphic materials and processes, and the quest of process and historical geomorphologists. It then moves on to discuss: structure, process and form and history. Providing a stimulating and innovative perspective on the key topics and debates within the field of geomorphology and written in an accessible and lively manner, it includes guides to further reading, chapter summaries and an extensive glossary of key terms.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
174 geography & gis
Responsible Tourism
Tourism and Social Marketing
Harold Goodwin
Michael Hall, Cantebury University, UK
Series: Routledge Research in Responsible Tourism
Series: Routledge International Series in Tourism, Business and Management
This book contains discussion built on strong theoretical framework to explore how Responsible Tourism is implemented and what impacts it has had on tackling economic, social and environmental issues. The book integrates both theory and original case studies from varying geographical developing & developed regions to show practical insights into how Responsible Tourism has been implemented and draws together conclusions about the efficacy of Responsible Tourism and sets a future research agenda. Written by leading authority in Responsible Tourism, this book is essential reading for students, academic and practitioners interested in Tourism Impacts and Sustainable Tourism Development. Routledge «Market: Tourism February 2011: 234x156: 225pp Hb: 978-0-415-57002-2: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57003-9: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85585-0: £80.00/14
2nd Edition textbook
This is the first book to comprehensively detail the relevance of social marketing principles and practice to tourism, destination management and marketing. It provides significant insights into how the behaviours of visitors and businesses may be changed so as to develop more sustainable forms of tourism and improve the quality of life of destination communities. It further provides a powerful impetus to the development of tourism related forms of sustainable consumption and promotion of ethical tourism and marketing and innovative perspective on the sustainable tourism debate and practice. The book considers a variety of social marketing sub fields relevant to tourism including, health, non-profit, political, environment and sustainable marketing and draws on social marketing practices from a range of disciplines. International cases studies to help tourism students engage with the broader debates in social marketing and show theory in practice. Routledge «Market: Tourism and Marketing February 2011: 246x174: 285pp Hb: 978-0-415-57665-9: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57666-6: £25.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85425-9: £90.00/14
Tourism Supply Chain Management
Katie Willis, University of London, UK
Haiyan Song, Hong Kong Polytechnic University, Hong Kong
Series: Routledge Perspectives on Development
Series: Advances in Tourism
Global economic crisis and the implications of global environmental change have led academics and policy-makers to consider how ‘development’ in all parts of the world should be achieved. Theories and Practices of Development provides a clear and user-friendly introduction to the complex debates around how development has been understood and achieved. The second edition has been fully updated and expanded to reflect global political and economic shifts, as well as new approaches to development. The rise of China and India is given particular attention, as is the global economic crisis and its implications for development theories and practice. There are new sections on faith-based development, disability and sexuality, as well as greater engagement with development theories as they are put into practice in the Global North.
This significant and timely volume is the first to apply supply chain management theories and practices in the context of Tourism. By doing so the book offers insight into the relationships between tourism enterprises, how co–ordination across organisations can be effectively achieved and how business performance can be improved. It offers comprehensive & systematic coverage of all the key issues and principles associated with Tourism Supply Chain Management including distribution and marketing activities as well as the suppliers and stakeholders involved in the provision and consumption of tourism products. The book combines essential theory and comparative international examples based on primary research to show challenges and opportunities of effective Touirsm Supply Chain Management.
Routledge «Market: Development Studies and Human Geography February 2011: 234x156: 276pp Hb: 978-0-415-59070-9: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59071-6: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-84418-2: £75.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-30053-7
Routledge «Market: Tourism / Business and Management / Operations Management March 2011: 234x156: 270pp Hb: 978-0-415-58155-4: £90.00/08 Pb: 978-0-415-58156-1: £26.99/03
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Theories and Practices of Development
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
geography & gis 175 Children’s and Families’ Holiday Experience *
Design Economies and the Changing World Economy *
Political Economy and Tourism
Neil Carr, University of Otago, New Zealand
Innovation, Production and Competitiveness
Series: Contemporary Geographies of Leisure, Tourism and Mobility
John R. Bryson, University of Birmingham, UK and Grete Rusten, University of Bergen, Norway
Edited by Jan Mosedale, University of Sunderland, UK
Children’s and Families’ Holiday Experience is the first volume to consider the active social role of children as well as parents in shaping the nature of the family holiday experience. It provides significant insights into the holiday desires, expectations, and experiences of children and the families’ tourism behaviour, that offers the potential for the tourism industry to plan, develop, and market products that provide a higher quality service to these populations. This book traces the modern history of the demand for and provision of holidays for children and families and examines the roles society and the tourism industry play in influencing children and family desires and how the tourism caters to these needs. This thorough investigation will be of interest to students, researchers and academics in the areas of Tourism, Geography and Cultural studies as well as Tourism Industry.
Series: Routledge Studies in Human Geography
Routledge «Market: Tourism / Travel January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-54543-3: £80.00/03
Manufacturing and service companies based in high cost locations are increasingly finding it difficult to compete on price with producers located in countries like India and China. This book developes a comprehensive account of the operation of design economies and designintensive firms and countries and firms whose competitive advantage is founded upon design rather than price. Design economies are explored through an analysis of corporate strategies, the relationship between consumer behaviour and design, and design-centred regional and national policies. This book identifies and analyses imitators of design economies with companies and nations, such as China and India, copying design-based policies and strategies. Design has only recently been identified as a key competitive advantage and this book is the first to provide a comprehensive account of the role of design in both corporate and national competitiveness. Routledge «Market: Geography / Economics / Planning December 2010: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-46175-7: £85.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83929-4: £85.00/14
Cities and Low Carbon Transitions * Edited by Harriet A. Bulkeley, Durham University, UK, Vanesa Castan-broto, University of Durham, UK, Mike Hodson, University of Salford, UK and Simon Marvin, University of Salford, UK Series: Routledge Studies in Human Geography Cities and Low Carbon Transitions presents a ground-breaking analysis of the role of cities in low carbon socio-technical transitions. Insights from the fields of urban studies and technological transitions are combined to examine how, why, and with what implications cities bring about low carbon transitions. The book outlines the key concepts underpinning theories of socio-technical transition and assesses its potential strengths and limits for understanding the social and technological responses to climate change that are emerging in cities. It draws on a diverse range of examples including world cities, ordinary cities and transition towns, from North America, Europe, South Africa and China, to provide evidence that expectations, aspirations and plans to undertake purposive socio-technical transitions are emerging in different urban contexts. Routledge «Market: Urban Studies / Environmental Studies / Geography December 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-58697-9: £85.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83924-9: £85.00/14
A Critical Perspective
Series: Contemporary Geographies of Leisure, Tourism and Mobility This is the first volume to bring together different theoretical perspectives and discourse in political economy related to tourism. In doing so it provide insights and alternative critical perspectives from political economy theory to expand discussions of tourism development and policy in the future. The volume is organised into three sequencial Parts linked by politics and economy. Part 1 presents different approaches to political economy such as Marxism, class, gender, regulation, power. Part 2 analyses the production, consumption nad regulation of tourism in the context of political economy appraches considered in Part 1, and Part 3 examines the political economy at various geographies of scales and focuses on the outcomes and processes of the political act of planning and managing tourism production. Routledge «Market: Tourism December 2010: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-54802-1: £80.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83587-6: £80.00/14
The Globalization of Advertising * Agencies, Cities and Spaces of Creativity
Feminist Advocacy and Gender Equity in the Anglophone Caribbean *
James R. Faulconbridge, University of Lancaster, UK, Peter J. Taylor, Corrine Nativel and Jonathan V. Beaverstock
Envisioning a Politics of Coalition
The role of advertising in everyday life and as a major employer in post-industrial economies is in many ways bound up with processes of contemporary globalization. At the centre of the advertising industry are the global advertising agencies which have an important role in developing global brands reliant upon advertising for their worldwide diffusion and in also developing national brands. This book unpacks the contemporary structure and spatial organization of global advertising agencies and reveals how global agencies operate as transnationally integrated organizations. It focuses on how the role of New York, Detroit and Los Angeles in advertising work has changed radically over recent years experiencing both growth and decline in employment as a result of their position in global networks of advertising work, networks that operate in the context of the rise of new and emerging centres of advertising in Asia and South America.
Michelle V. Rowley, University of Maryland, USA Series: Routledge International Studies of Women and Place This book explores the extent to which gendermainstreaming (GM) has effectively advanced a more gender-just reality for women in the Anglophone Caribbean. Routledge «Market: Geography January 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-87854-8: £70.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83288-2: £70.00/14
Improving Water Policy and Governance Edited by Cecilia Tortajada, Instituto Aragonés del Agua, Spain and Asit K Biswas, Third World Centre for Water Management, Mexico This book analyses case studies of good water governance from different parts of the world and the enabling environments that made it possible. This book was published as a special issue of the International Jounral of Water Resources Development.
Series: Routledge Studies in Human Geography
Routledge «Market: International Business / Economic Geography / Urban Studies December 2010: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-56716-9: £85.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-86089-2: £85.00/14
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Development Studies / Human Geography / Environmental Studies November 2010: 246x174: 196pp Hb: 978-0-415-60628-8: £80.00/08
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
176 geography & gis The Government of Chronic Poverty
Tourism and India *
Tourism and National Identities
A Critical Introduction
An International Perspective
From the Politics of Exclusion to the Politics of Citizenship?
Kevin Hannam, University of Sunderland and Anya Diekmann, Université Libre de Bruxelles, Belgium
Edited by Elspeth Frew, La Trobe University, Australia and Leanne White
Edited by Sam Hickey, University of Manchester, UK The book assesses whether a progressive politics of poverty reduction can be forged within the current post-neoliberal moment of development It was published as a special issue of the Journal of Development Studies. Routledge «Market: Development Studies / Poverty / Citizenship March 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-59850-7: £80.00/08
Tourism and Agriculture New Geographies of Consumption, Production and Rural Restructuring Edited by Rebecca Maria Torres and Janet Momsen, University of California, USA Series: Contemporary Geographies of Leisure, Tourism and Mobility Routledge «Market: Tourism January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-58429-6: £80.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83440-4: £80.00/14
Series: Contemporary Geographies of Leisure, Tourism and Mobility Tourism and India is the first book to specifically focus on and fully analyze the issues facing contemporary India both as a destination and a potential source of tourists. The book analyses previous research and applies critical theory to key aspects of tourism in this region and supports this with a wide range of examples to illustrate the key conceptual points. As such the book examines aspects of tourism in India including tourism governance, cultural tourism, heritage tourism, nature-based tourism from the supply side and international tourism, domestic tourism, outbound tourism and the Indian Diaspora from the demand side. This timely book includes original research to offer insights into India’s future development in terms of tourism. It will be of interest to students, researchers and academics in the areas of Tourism, Geography and related disciplines. Routledge «Market: Tourism November 2010: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-55729-0: £75.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-86878-2: £80.00/14
Series: Contemporary Geographies of Leisure, Tourism and Mobility Routledge February 2011: 234x156: 301pp Hb: 978-0-415-57277-4: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-85596-6: £75.00/14
Tourist Shopping Villages * Forms and Functions Laurie Murphy, Pierre Benckendorff, Gianna Moscardo and Philip L. Pearce, all at James Cook University, Australia Series: Routledge Advances in Tourism This landmark volume – based on a two year research program from a team of authors – examines the forms and functions of approximately 50 tourist shopping villages in Australia, New Zealand, the United Kingdom, Ireland, Canada and the United States. Routledge «Market: Geography January 2011: 229x152: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-96527-9: £70.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83482-4: £70.00/14
anthropology student reference
Fifty Key Anthropologists *
Pilgrimage Tourism of Diaspora Africans to Ghana
Edited by Robert J. Gordon, University of Vermont, USA, Harriet Lyons, University of Waterloo, Canada and Andrew Lyons, Wilfrid Laurier University, Canada
Series: Routledge Studies on African and Black Diaspora
Edited by Ann Reed, University of North Dakota, USA
Series: Routledge Key Guides Fifty Key Anthropologists surveys the life and work of some of the most influential figures in anthropology. The entries, written by an international range of expert contributors, represent the diversity of thought within the subject, incorporating both classic theorists and more recent anthropological thinkers. Names discussed include: Clifford Geertz; Bronislaw Malinowski; Zora Neale Hurston; Sherry B. Ortner; Claude Lévi-Strauss; Rodney Needham; Mary Douglas; Marcel Mauss.
This ethnography critically analyzes the travel of diaspora Africans to Ghana by considering its cultural and political economic meanings for hosts, guests, and intermediaries. Reed highlights how tensions inherent in promoting heritage travel alternatively as tourism or as pilgrimage have profound implications for economic development and reclaiming an African identity. Routledge «Market: Anthropology April 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-88502-7: £75.00/08
This accessible A-Z guide contains helpful cross-referencing, a timeline of key dates and schools of thought, and suggestions for further reading. It will be of interest to students of anthropology and related subjects wanting a succinct overview of the ideas and impact of key anthropologists who have helped to shape the discipline.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Anthropology November 2010: 216x138: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-46104-7: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-46105-4: £15.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83879-2: £65.00/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
sociology 177
A Companion to Life Course Studies
Coffee Culture
the Social and Historical Context of the British Birth Cohort Studies Edited by Michael E.J. Wadsworth, University College London Medical School, UK and John Bynner, University of London, UK
Local and Global Dimensions of the World’s Most Controversial Beverage Catherine M. Tucker Series: Routledge Series for Creative Teaching and Learning in Anthropology ’The Anthropology of Stuff’ is part of a new Series dedicated to innovative, unconventional ways to connect undergraduate students and their lived concerns about our social world to the power of social science ideas and evidence. Our goal with the project is to help spark social science imaginations and in doing so, new avenues for meaningful thought and action. Each ‘Stuff’ title is a short (100 page) ‘mini text’ illuminating for students the network of people and activities that create their material world.
Series: Routledge Advances in Sociology Course research contributes uniquely to policy, showing the effects of interaction of individual development and the socio-economic context. This book shows how policy innovation influenced development, ageing and well-being, differently in each generation, over half a century, and how those differences offer new opportunities for life course research.
A Minyan of Women Family Dynamics, Jewish Identity and Psychotherapy Practice Edited by Beverly A. Greene, St. John’s University, USA and Dorith Brodbar, Borough of Manhattan Community College, USA This book examines the role of family dynamics in the shaping of Jewish identity and the role of that identity in the practice of psychotherapy. This book was published as a special issue of Women and Therapy.
çè
Routledge «Market: Psychotherapy / Jewish Studies / Gender Studies January 2011: 246x174: 352pp Hb: 978-0-415-60882-4: £80.00/08 Pb: 978-0-415-61065-0: £24.50/04
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Routledge February 2011: 229x152: 128pp Hb: 978-0-415-80024-2: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-80025-9: £13.99/04
Confronting Climate Change Constance Lever-Tracy, Flinders University, Australia Series: Short Cuts In this highly accessible introduction to the predicted global impacts of climate change, Constance Lever-Tracy provides an authoritative guide to one of the most controversial issues facing the future of our planet. Discussing how the social and natural sciences must work together more effectively in confronting climate change, Lever-Tracy provides a sober, critical assessment of the politics of global warming and climate change.
Routledge «Market: Environmental Sociology / Climate Change / Social Policy March 2011: 198x129: 152pp Hb: 978-0-415-57622-2: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57623-9: £15.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83008-6: £60.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Routledge «Market: Social Interaction / Social Change February 2011: 234x156 Hb: 978-0-415-49540-0: £80.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-87858-3: £80.00/08
From the coffee producers and pickers who tend the plantations in tropical nations, to the middlemen and processors, to the consumers who drink coffee without ever having to think about how the drink reached their hands, here is a commodity that ties the world together. This is a great little book that helps students apply anthropological concepts and theories to their everyday lives, learn how historical events and processes have shaped the modern world and the contexts of their lives, and how consumption decisions carry ramifications for our health, the environment, the reproduction of social inequality, and the possibility of supporting equity, sustainability and social justice.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
178 sociology
Confronting Global Gender Justice *
Corrections Foundations for the Future Jeanne B. Stinchcomb, Florida Atlantic University, USA
Women’s Lives, Human Rights
Series: Criminology and Justice Studies
Edited by Debra Bergoffen, Paula Ruth Gilbert, Tamara Harvey and Connie L. McNeely, all at George Mason University
The Fourth Edition is available for online and hybrid courses and is also customizable in inexpensive paperback forms with other materials instructors may wish to assign their students.
Confronting Global Gender Justice: Women’s Lives, Human Rights examines the most complex and demanding challenges facing theorists, activists, artists, and educators engaged in establishing women’s rights as human rights and fighting to make these rights realities in women’s lives. Issues addressed include: trafficking, AIDS, immigration, war-time violence, and legal battles.
The text and its companion website has been designed for use in online and hybrid courses as well as in conventional ‘bricks and mortar’ classes. The text is also customizable in inexpensive paperback format, instructors may select only those chapters which they wish to assign. Routledge March 2011: 254x203: 576pp Pb: 978-0-415-87333-8: £65.00/04
Routledge «Market: Gender Studies / Women’s Studies / Human Rights November 2010: 234x156: 352pp Hb: 978-0-415-78078-0: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-78079-7: £25.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83859-4: £85.00/14
2nd Edition textbook
3rd Edition textbook
Contemporary Social Work Practice
Corrections A Critical Approach Michael Welch This book confronts mass imprisonment in the United States, a nation boasting the highest incarceration rate in the world. By attending closely to historical and theoretical development, the book identifies and examines the key social forces shaping penal practice in the US – politics, economics, morality, and technology.
Series: New Directions in Social Work Sufficiently concise to be teachable in a one-semester practice course, yet available with a treasure trove of related materials for use in a two or three-course practice sequence, this text helps translate the guiding theoretical perspectives of social justice, human rights, and critical social construction into purposeful social work practice. Three unique cases, specially written for this Series, provide a ‘learning by doing’ framework unavailable from any other social work publisher. Companion readings and many other resources enable this text to be the centerpiece for three semesters of practice teaching. Go to www.routledgesw.com to learn more. Routledge February 2011: 235x187: 356pp Hb: 978-0-415-87457-1: £125.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87336-9: £65.00/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Routledge «Market: Penology / Criminology / Law December 2010: 246x174: 584pp Hb: 978-0-415-78208-1: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-78209-8: £27.99/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Marla Berg-Weger, Saint Louis University, USA, Julie Birkenmaier and Martha P. Dewees
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
sociology 179
Crime and Criminal Justice
Feelings
Ian Marsh, Liverpool Hope University, UK
Stephen Frosh, University of London
This book provides students with a comprehensive and engaging introduction to the study of criminology by taking an interdisciplinary approach to explaining criminal behaviour and criminal justice. It is divided into two parts, which address the two essential bases that form the discipline of criminology. Part One describes, discusses and evaluates a range of theoretical approaches that have offered explanations for crime. Part Two offers an accessible but detailed review of the major philosophical aims and sociological theories of punishment, and examines the main areas of the contemporary criminal justice system.
Series: Short Cuts
Routledge «Market: Criminology / Theory of Crime / Criminal Justice June 2011: 246 x 174: 384pp Hb: 978-0-415-58151-6: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58152-3: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83378-0: £90.00/14
Everyone talks abut their feelings, but what exactly are they? What are the distinguishing features of feelings, and how do they differ from emotions and affects? How do our feelings influence the kinds of people we are, and the sorts of communities and societies in which we live? In this wonderful short book, acclaimed author Stephen Frosh interrogates the terrain of feelings and asks how this ‘hidden’ dimension of the self helps shape our worlds. The book provides an accessible and thought-provoking introduction to the major debates around feelings in the modern world. Feelings is a handy and engaging resource for undergraduate and postgraduate students, academics, and anyone with an interest in gaining a better understanding of this fundamental aspect of life. Routledge «Market: March 2011: 160pp Hb: 978-0-415-57483-9: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57484-6: £16.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85491-4: £60.00/14
2nd Edition
Durkheim, Bernard and Epistemology *
Effective Practice in Youth Justice Martin Stephenson, Sally Brown and Henri Giller Providing a comprehensive and up-to-date review of research and the implications for practice, the second edition of Effective Practice in Youth Justice proves to be an essential resource for professionals working within the youth justice system, those training to work in youth justice, and students taking courses in youth justice or related subjects.
Paul Q. Hirst
çè
Selected Contents: Part 1: Claude Bernard 1. Claude Bernard’s Epistemology 2. Bernard’s Physiology Part 2: Emile Durkheim’s Rules of Sociological Method 3. Durkheim’s Epistemology 4. Pathology and Morphology 5. Individualism and Holism: Purpose, Functionalism and Social Facts 6. Individualism and Holism: Vitalism and the Social Milieu 7. Conclusion: The Rules of Sociological Method and Durkheim’s Sociology Routledge «Market: Sociology October 2010: 216x138: 222pp Hb: 978-0-415-56349-9: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83816-7: £70.00/14
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Routledge «Market: Youth Justice / Criminal Practice / Criminology December 2010: 246x174: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-61075-9: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-61077-3: £20.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83194-6: £55.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
This title, first published in 1975, contains two complimentary studies by Paul Q. Hirst: the first based on Claude Bernard’s theory of scientific knowledge, and the second concerning Emile Durkheim’s attempt to provide a philosophical foundation for a scientific sociology in The Rules of Sociological Method. The author’s primary concern is to answer the question: is Durkheim’s theory of knowledge logically consistent and philosophically viable? His principal conclusion is that the epistemology developed in `the Rules is an impossible one and that its inherent contradictions are proof that sociology as it is commonly understood can never be a scientific discipline.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
180 sociology
Geographies of Children, Youth and Families
Handbook of Human Rights Edited by Thomas Cushman, Wellesley College, USA The Handbook maps out the field of human rights for the humanities and social sciences. It provides a solid foundation for the reader who wants to learn the basic parameters of the field, but also to promote new thinking and frameworks for the future study of human rights in the 21 st century.
An International Perspective Edited by Louise Holt This edited collection brings together international experts of geographies of children, youth and families. The book provides an overview of current conceptual and theoretical debates, drawing upon cutting-edge research from across the globe. The volume is an invaluable course text for undergraduate and postgraduate students of geography, the social sciences and education.
Routledge «Market: Human Geography / Children / Youth Studies / Sociology December 2010: 234x156: 296pp Hb: 978-0-415-56383-3: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56384-0: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-86330-5: £75.00/14
Routledge «Market: Human Rights / Sociology / Politcs December 2010: 246x174: 584pp Hb: 978-0-415-48023-9: £110.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-88703-5: £110.00/14
2nd Edition
2nd Edition
Hopeful Girls, Troubled Boys
Illicit Drugs
Race and Gender Inequality in Urban Education
Misuse and Control
Nancy Lopez
Adrian Barton
An exciting revision of a classic book. Hopeful Girls, Troubled Boys focuses on the life histories of the largest immigrant group in New York City – the youth from the Dominican Republic, the West Indies, and Haiti – to explain why girls of colour are succeeding at higher rates than their male counterparts. Nancy Lopez brings to life the attitudes, feelings, and expectations of these teens, and shows that girls maintain optimistic outlooks on their lives, while boys are ambivalent about the promises of education. This fascinating account explains how and why our schools and cities are failing boys of color.
The second edition of Illicit Drugs: Use and Control provides a completely up-dated and re-written volume that includes three new chapters which look at illicit drug use: class, gender and race; the geopolitics of illicit drug production and distribution and; Britain in a global context. These have been included to alert the reader to the increasingly global nature of the drug trade and the uneven manner in which drug use takes place and is portrayed by the media. The format and layout of the book has changed and it is now more ‘user-friendly’ seeing the inclusion of text boxes, questions for reflection and suggested further reading lists at the end of each chapter. The new edition still offers the same broad-brush approach and is written in the same accessible style but endeavours to bring to the reader the latest developments in the use and control of illicit drugs.
Routledge February 2011: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-87422-9: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87423-6: £28.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Criminology / Drugs / Social Policy February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-49233-1: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-49237-9: £23.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-87991-7: £80.00/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
sociology 181
Lycra
McCounterfeiting Inc.
Kaori O’connor
Yi-Chieh Jessica Lin
Series: Routledge Series for Creative Teaching and Learning in Anthropology
Series: Routledge Series for Creative Teaching and Learning in Anthropology
Lycra describes the development of a specific fabric, but in the process provides students with rare insights into U.S. corporate history, the changing image of women in America, and how a seemingly doomed product came to occupy a position never imagined by its inventors and contained in the wardrobe of virtually every American. And it will generate lively discussion of the story of the relationship between technology, science and society over the past half a century.
Routledge February 2011: 229x152: 128pp Hb: 978-0-415-80436-3: £80.00/03
In our world, the process whereby intangible and highly valued intellectual property rights become tangible commodities through lesser-valued manual labor is highly politicized, so are the issues of ‘authenticity’ and ‘morality’. How China has treated the IPR ‘problem’ could have serious implications on China’s domestic cultural industries, including questions of profitability, viability and cultural diversity. As a result, the recent emergence of ‘bandit’ or ‘pirate’ subculture in China represents a new sphere of extralegality in economic development; Chinese citizens have created a shared sense of cultural intimacy though piracy. This book updates readers with the latest development of the national economy in China. Routledge March 2011: 229x152: 128pp Hb: 978-0-415-88302-3: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88303-0: £18.99/04
2nd Edition textbook
Edited by Steven Seidman, State University of New York, Albany, USA, Nancy Fischer, Augsburg College, Minnesota, USA and Chet Meeks, Northern Illinois University, USA Breaking new ground, both substantively and stylistically, Introducing the New Sexuality Studies, 2nd Edition offers students and academics an engaging, thought-provoking introduction and overview of the social study of sexualities. Its central premise is to explore the social construction of sexuality, the role of social differences such as race or nationality in creating sexual variation, and the ways sex is entangled in relations of power and inequality. Through this approach the field of sexuality is considered in multicultural, global, and comparative terms, and from a truly social perspective. The second edition of this definitive textbook consists of over seventy-five short, original essays on the key topics and themes in sexuality studies. It also includes interviews with fourteen leading scholars in the field, which convey some of the most innovative work currently being undertaken. Each contribution is original, presenting the latest thinking and research in clear and accessible terms, using engaging examples to illustrate key points.
çè
Routledge «Market: Gender and Sexuality Studies February 2011: 246x174: 512pp Hb: 978-0-415-78125-1: £125.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-78126-8: £32.99/04
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Niklas Luhmann Christian Borch Series: Key Sociologists Niklas Luhmann offers an accessible introduction to one of the most important sociologists of our time. It presents the key concepts within Luhmann’s multifaceted theory of modern society, and compares them with the work of other key social theorists such as Jürgen Habermas, Michel Foucault, and Zygmunt Bauman. The book pays particular attention to introducing and discussing Luhmann’s original sociological systems theory. It presents a thorough investigation into the different phases of his oeuvre, through which both the shifting emphases as well as the continuities in his thinking are shown. The primary focus of this text is Luhmann’s theory of modern society as being differentiated into a plethora of ‘function systems’ – such as politics, law, and economy – which operate according to their own distinct logics and which cannot interfere with one another. For Luhmann, this functional differentiation works as a bulwark against totalitarian rule, and as such is a key foundation of modern democracy. Furthermore, the book critically examines the implications of this functional differentiation for inclusion and exclusion dynamics, as well as for the understanding of power and politics. Routledge «Market: Social Theory / Philosophy / Law December 2010: 198x129: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-49093-1: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-49094-8: £25.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-88052-4: £70.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Introducing the New Sexuality Studies
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
182 sociology
Philosophy and the Idea of Freedom *
Routledge International Handbook of Contemporary Social and Political Theory
Roy Bhaskar Series: Classical Texts in Critical Realism In Philosophy and the Idea of Freedom Roy Bhaskar sets out to develop a critique of the work of Richard Rorty, who must be one of the most influential authors of recent decades. In a brilliant tour de force, Bhaskar shows how Rorty falls victim to the very epistemological problematic Rorty himself describes. ‘ Philosophy and the Idea of Freedom is full of fascinating, important ideas and insights, and is immensely timely. It will have a deeply beneficial effect, and will surely be very widely read and discussed.’ – Professor Terry Eagleton, University of Oxford Routledge «Market: Philosophy / Sociology November 2010: 234x156: 224pp Pb: 978-0-415-57964-3: £25.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85109-8: £80.00/14
Edited by Gerard Delanty, University of Sussex, UK and Stephen P. Turner, University of South Florida, USA The handbook will address a range of issues that have emerged out of recent social and political theory. It will focus on key themes as opposed to schools of thought or major theorists. Each chapter is an emerging, cutting edge topic that is of interest both to social theory and to political theory. Most topics will have a clear and substantive focus on social or political problems.
Routledge «Market: Political Theory / Cont. Social Theory / Cultural Theory March 2011: 246x174 Hb: 978-0-415-54825-0: £110.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-87557-5: £110.00/14
student reference
2nd Edition textbook
Research Methods: The Basics *
Social Policy for Effective Practice
Nicholas Walliman, Oxford Brookes University, UK
A Strengths Approach
Series: The Basics
Rosemary Chapin, University of Kansas, USA
• structuring and planning a research project • the ethical issues involved in research • different types of data and data quality • analysing and organising data to draw sound conclusions • writing up and displaying data in effective ways. Complete with a glossary of key terms and guides to further reading, this book is an essential text for anyone coming to research for the first time, and is widely relevant across the social sciences and humanities. Routledge «Market: Social Science / Humanities / Research Methods November 2010: 198x129: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-48991-1: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-48994-2: £11.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83607-1: £55.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Series: New Directions in Social Work For use as a text in foundations generalist social policy courses, either at the baccalaureate or Master’s Level, this book examines the process of defining need, analyzing social policy, and developing new policy. A clear philosophical base and a common theoretical framework underlie the discussion of each component of the policy process. Four themes are interwoven throughout the book: the importance of thinking critically about social policy, the benefits of using the strengths perspective in policy analysis and development, the critical role social policy plays in all areas of practice, and the absolute responsibility of every social worker to engage in policy practice. At www.routledgesw.com/policy, you will find a wealth of resources to help you create a dynamic, experiential introduction to social work for your students. Routledge January 2011: 235x187: 400pp Hb: 978-0-415-87335-2: £125.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83484-8: £125.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Research Methods: The Basics is an accessible, user-friendly introduction to the different aspects of research theory, methods and practice. Structured in two parts, the first covering the nature of knowledge and the reasons for research, and the second the specific methods used to carry out effective research, this book covers:
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
sociology 183
Stargazing
The Culture of Management
Celebrity, Fame and Social Interaction
Stefano Harney From filo faxes to palm pilots; from cell phones to laptops; from spreadsheets to online banking, many of us try to make the most of our day, to not waste any time, to maximize our efficiency. These are the hallmarks of time, financial, and information management. More and more we find ourselves managing our time, health, finances, careers and families. We are all managers now.
Kerry O. Ferris and Scott Harris Series: Contemporary Sociological Perspectives Stargazing highlights the interactional dynamics of celebrity and fame in contemporary society, including the thoughts and feelings of stars on the red carpet, the thrills and risks of encountering a famous person at a convention or on the streets, and the excitement generated even by the obvious fakery of celebrity impersonators. Using compelling, real-life examples involving popular celebrities, Ferris and Harris examine how the experience and meanings of celebrity are shaped by social norms, interactional negotiations, and interpretive storytelling. Routledge April 2011: 229x152: 225pp Hb: 978-0-415-88427-3: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88428-0: £21.99/04
In The Culture of Management, Stefano Harney investigates how the principles of management now shape our lives, both individually and collectively. Ironically, as we embrace the tools of management in our personal lives, as workers we are often leery of the promises of Management. In examining the work world, Harney finds that the age-old clash between Management and Worker is alive and well. But, instead of vilifying Management, Harney asks: What new opportunities can the New Management offer us? Chapters include coverage on such issues as popular management literature; management in a global context, the new labor movement versus the new management. The Culture of Management shows us that, for better or worse, we are all in the business with ourselves. Routledge «Market: Sociology / Cultural Studies and Business March 2008: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-93069-7: £70.00/04 Pb: 978-0-415-93070-3: £16.99/04
textbook
Social Statistics The Basics and Beyond Thomas J. Linneman, The College of William and Mary, Virginia, USA Series: Contemporary Sociological Perspectives With just the right level of detail, and a graphically innovative approach, this book carefully guides students through the statistical techniques they will encounter in the real world. The basics, plus multiple regression, interaction effects, logistic regression, non-linear effects, all covered in a non-intimidating way for your students. The book uses three datasets throughout: General Social Survey, American National Election Studies, World Values Survey, and includes SPSS demonstrations at the end of each chapter. Most of your students will likely take only one stats course and use only one stats book in their college careers. This one innovatively equips them for their worlds ahead, regardless of the career paths they follow.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
A Practical Guide to Women’s and Gender Studies Michele T. Berger and Cheryl Radeloff Series: Contemporary Sociological Perspectives Transform Yourself, Transform the World is a user friendly guide of practical guidance and inspiration for supporting a student’s interest in a Women’s Studies degree. It focuses on three of the major barriers students face when exploring Women’s Studies. The first is a lack of awareness that Women’s Studies constitutes an academic field. The second barrier is the negative response a student often faces when announcing to the world that he or she is interested in Women’s Studies. The third barrier regards the perceived lack of employment and career options of graduating with a Women’s Studies degree. This book will support students to think critically about what they know, how to demonstrate what they know, and how to prepare for life both personally and professionally after the degree. Routledge March 2011: 229x152: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-87327-7: £95.00/03
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge January 2011: 235x187: 464pp Hb: 978-0-415-80501-8: £110.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-84167-9: £110.00/14
Transform Yourself, Transform the World
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
184 sociology
Unequal Educations
Youth in Crisis?
Dismantling the Achievement Gaps
‘Gangs’, Territoriality and Violence
Nancy Lopez
Edited by Barry Goldson
There are roughly 45 million Latina(o) people living in the United States today and immigration scholars agree that the population of undocumented immigrants in the U.S. is around 12 million today, many of whom are of Hispanic origin. Immigration scholars also agree that a major unanswered question for the future of U.S. society is how well the children of these population groups will ‘make it’ in the educational system and therefore begin to move up the socio-economic ladder. Will their ‘achievement’ in the educational system parallel the experience and success of other immigrant groups of generations past? Or will many of these children experience much higher drop-out rates and if so, with what consequences? And are there policy options to prevent this from happening? Those are the very important issues this book will explore. Routledge March 2011: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-87506-6: £95.00/03
Few issues attract greater concern and censure thatn those that surround youth ‘gangs’. Comprising a series of essays from leading national and international researchers, this book subjects such claims to rigorous critical scrutiny. It provides a challenging and authoritative account of complex questions pertaining to urban youth identities, crime and social order.
Routledge «Market: Juvenile Crime / Criminology / Sociology January 2011: 234x156: 248pp Hb: 978-1-84392-752-5: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-1-84392-751-8: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83200-4: £55.00/14
Urban Tourism and Urban Change Visual Research Methods Cities in a Global Economy in the Social Sciences Costas Spirou, National-Louis University USA Urban Tourism and Urban Change: Cities in a Global Economy provides both a sociological / cultural analysis of change that has taken place in many of the world’s cities. This focused treatment of urban tourism examines the implications of these changes for urban management and planning sense, for success and failure in metropolitan change. Uniquely suited for teaching purposes, Costas Spirou integrates numerous case studies of cities to illuminate the significant impact and promise of tourism on urban image and economic development. Routledge January 2011: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-80162-1: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-80163-8: £26.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83580-7: £85.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Awakening Visions
Stephen Spencer, Sheffield Hallam University, UK This is a practical guide for students, researchers and teachers in the social sciences who wish to explore and actively use visual research. Demonstrating the use of visual ethnography, video and photography, ‘researcher found’ imagery and representations in popular culture, this book offers an integrated approach to doing visual research.
Routledge «Market: Visuality / Research Methods / Culture Studies November 2010: 234x156: 280pp Hb: 978-0-415-48382-7: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-48385-8: £23.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-88386-0: £80.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Series: The Metropolis and Modern Life
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
sociology 185
Visual Sociology An Introduction Douglas Harper Selected Contents: 1. Visual Sociology as Embodied Observation: Part of all Sociology that includes Observation 2. Visual Sociology as the Analysis of Symbolic Properties of the Visual Universe (semiotics) 3. Visual Sociology as an Approach to Data: Empirical, Narrative, Phenomenological and Reflexive 4. Visual Sociology as an Aspect of Photo Documentary 5. Visual Sociology and new Forms of Digital Visualization
Routledge «Market: Visuality / Visual Anthropology / Visual Sociology / Research Methods June 2011: 234x156 Hb: 978-0-415-77895-4: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-77896-1: £25.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-87267-3: £80.00/14
Alternatives to Privatization in the Global South Edited by David McDonald, Queen’s University, Canada and Greg Ruiters, Rhodes University, South Africa Series: Routledge Studies in Development and Society From community-led water management schemes in Latin America to national health insurance programs in Africa, this volume assesses different alternative models to privatization and the typologies used for classifying them, providing groundbreaking insights into the scope and scale of alternative service delivery mechanisms and offering the first reliable source of comparative data that go beyond the indices used by international development agencies. Routledge «Market: Development Studies March 2011: 229x152: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-88668-0: £75.00/08
Automobility in Transition? A Socio-Technical Analysis of Sustainable Transport Edited by Frank Geels, University of Sussex, UK, René Kemp, Maastricht University, the Netherlands, Geoff Dudley and Glenn Lyons, both at University of West of England Series: Routledge Studies in Sustainability Transitions Private cars have become the dominant mode of passenger road transport in developed countries. This book examines the past evolution towards car-based forms of transport: problems associated with it, the success of past and current efforts to deal with problems of pollution, congestion, safety and degradation of public spaces and amenities, and also new developments, visions and strategies. Routledge «Market: Sociology March 2011: 229x152: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-88505-8: £30.00/08
Contradictions of Archaeological Theory Engaging Critical Realism and Archaeological Theory Sandra Wallace Series: Critical Realism: Interventions Routledge March 2011: 234x156: 300pp Hb: 978-0-415-59127-0: £80.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-84347-5: £80.00/14
Critical Realism and Creativity Lee Martin Series: Ontological Explorations Routledge «Market: Philosophy / Sociology March 2011: 234x156: 264pp Hb: 978-0-415-57410-5: £90.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-85516-4: £90.00/14
Dynamic Embodiment for Social Theory On the Move Brenda Farnell Series: Ontological Explorations
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-78109-1: £80.00/08
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
186 sociology Eurocentrism
Leadership and Place
Politics of Knowledge
A Critical Realist and Marxian Critique of Civil Society
Edited by Chris Collinge, John Gibney and Chris Mabey, all at The Birmingham Business School, UK
Edited by Patrick Baert, University of Cambridge, UK and Fernando Domínguez Rubio
Nick Hostettler
Series: Regions and Cities
Series: Ontological Explorations
This book makes an important contribution to the discussion of the contemporary leadership challenges in the context of sustainable place shaping. This collection first appeared as a special issue of Policy Studies and is now published by kind permission in the Regional Studies Association book series, Regions and Cities.
Routledge February 2011 Hb: 978-0-415-56510-3: £80.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-86190-5: £80.00/08
Experts
This volume explores how the relation between knowledge and the political is developing in the rapidly evolving context of ‘knowledge societies’. By analysing how the traditional boundaries and categories of the political are being redefined in the age of communication technologies and information economies, this monograph provides a novel perspective on current debates about ‘knowledge societies’.
Series: Key Ideas
Routledge «Market: Social Policy / Urban Development / Housing November 2010: 246x174: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-55014-7: £80.00/08
Routledge «Market: Social Theory / Knowledge / Consumption February 2011: 198x129: 112pp Hb: 978-0-415-60803-9:: £65.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-82964-6: £65.00/14
Routledge «Market: Political Sociology January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-49710-7: £80.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-87774-6: £80.00/14
Music, Difference and the Residue of Race
Psychoanalysis in Social Research
The Knowledge and Power of Expertise Nico Stehr and Reiner Grundmann
Foundations of Critical Media and Information Studies Christian Fuchs, University of Salzburg, Austria Series: Routledge Advances in Sociology Routledge «Market: Media Studies / Information Society / Social Theory February 2011: 234x156: 252pp Hb: 978-0-415-58881-2: £75.00/03
Food in a Sustainable World Edited by Gert Spaargaren, Wageningen University, the Netherlands, A.M. Loeber, University of Amsterdam, the Netherlands and Peter Oosterveer, Wageningen University, the Netherlands
Jo Haynes, University of Bristol, UK Series: Routledge Research in Race and Ethnicity Race and music seem fatally entwined in a way that involves both creative ethnic hybridity and ongoing problems of racism. This book presents a sociological analysis of this enduring relationship and asks: how are ideas of race critical to the understanding of music genres and preferences? What does the ‘love of difference’ via music contribute to contemporary perspectives of racism? Routledge «Market: Sociology May 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-87921-7: £70.00/08
Overcoming Objectification * A Carnal Ethics
Series: Routledge Studies in Sustainability Transitions
Ann J. Cahill, Elon University, USA
This edited volume presents and reflects upon empirical evidence of ‘sustainability’-induced and -related transition in food practices. The material collected in the various chapters contributes to our understanding of the ways in which ideas and preferences, sociotechnological developments and changes in the governance of food interact and become visible in practices of consumption, retail and production.
Series: Routledge Research in Gender and Society
Routledge «Market: Sociology May 2011: 229x152: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-88084-8: £30.00/08
Objectification is a foundational concept in feminist theory, used to analyze such disparate social phenomena as sex work, representation of women’s bodies, and sexual harassment. In this work, Cahill argues that the notion should be abandoned by feminist theorists due to its reliance on outdated philosophical assumptions, such as the centrality of autonomy and rationality to both subjectivity and ethics. Instead, she suggests working towards an ethics of sexuality based upon the recognition of difference. Routledge «Market: Sociology January 2011: 229x152: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-88288-0: £70.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83584-5: £70.00/14
G.H. Mead A Reader Filipe Carreira da Silva, University of Lisbon Series: Routledge Classics in Sociology
Shifting Theories and Reframing Concepts Claudia Lapping, University of London, UK Routledge «Market: Research Methods / Sociology February 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-47925-7: £80.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-88282-5: £80.00/14
Religion and Social Problems * Edited by Titus Hjelm, University College London, UK Series: Routledge Advances in Sociology Although students and scholars of social problems have often acknowledged the role of religion, no thorough examinations of the relation between the two have emerged. This book fills this gap by providing a definitive work on the impact of religion on social problems, religion as a solution to social problems, and religion as a social problem in itself. Routledge «Market: Sociology December 2010: 229x152: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-80056-3: £70.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83510-4: £70.00/14
Rio de Janeiro Urban Life through the Eyes of the City Edited by Beatriz Jaguaribe, Federal University of Rio de Janeiro Series: CRESC Jaguaribe’s book offers exciting and creative perspectives on the urban imaginaries and experiences of Rio de Janeiro. It illuminates how Rio de Janeiro’s popular culture, artistic productions, social violence, and urban layout make it one of the foremost cityscapes in the world. Routledge «Market: Cultural Studies / Sociology March 2011: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-56931-6: £80.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-85951-3: £80.00/14
This book introduces social scientists to the ideas of George Herbert Mead (1863–1931), one of the most original yet neglected thinkers of early twentieth-century social thought. Based on Mead’s published and unpublished writings, this collection is the first edition of his writings that critically assesses aspects central to his system of thought.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Sociology / Social Psychology / Science December 2010: 234x156: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-55625-5: £85.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-86955-0: £85.00/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
sociology 187 Stillness in a Mobile World
The Politics of Bioethics
Urban Youth in China
Edited by David Bissell, The Australian National University and Gillian Fuller, University of New South Wales, Australia
Alan Petersen, Monash University, Australia
Modernity, the Internet and the Self
Series: Routledge Studies in Science, Technology and Society
Fengshu Liu, University of Oslo, Norway
Series: International Library of Sociology
This book investigates the socio-political implications of bioethics discourse and practices in relation to a range of controversial developments. It will be of interest to policymakers, clinicians, scholars, and others who are looking for new ways of making sense and evaluating recent developments in the field of bioethics.
This collection intervenes in debates around mobility, life, animation and thought by foregrounding the radically ambiguous concept of ‘stillness’ as a crucial site for critical interrogation. Stillness provides both a challenge and an invitation to consider how the dynamics of passivity, suspension and stasis are integral to our understanding of life on the move. Routledge «Market: Sociology / Philosophy / Communication November 2010: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-57262-0: £80.00/05 eBook: 978-0-203-85589-8: £80.00/14
Routledge «Market: Sociology March 2011: 229x152: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-99006-6: £65.00/08
The Politics of Women’s Integration Voices from the Margins
Series: Routledge Research in Information Technology and Society As both youth and the Internet hold the potential to inflict far-reaching economic, social, cultural, and political changes, this book fulfills a need for a systematical investigation of the lives of Chinese youth and the growth of the Internet against the backdrop of rapid and profound social transformation in China. Routledge «Market: Sociology February 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-87486-1: £70.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83304-9: £70.00/14
Studies of the Holocaust
Leah Bassel
Lessons in Survivorship
Series: Routledge Advances in Sociology
Young People, Social Capital and Ethnic Identity
Edited by Roberta R Greene, University of Texas at Austin, USA
Does accommodating Islam violate women’s rights? This book demonstrates that debates over the headscarf in France and religious arbitration in Canada ignore the realities of the women at the heart of these controversies. Addressing this vital question requires enabling the active participation of these women in democratic life.
This edited collection explores the cultural and social contexts in which young people operate, and their use of social capital in developing identity and belonging. This book was published as a special issue of the Race and Ethnic Studies.
This book examines a number of theoretical frameworks that explore survival strategies before, during, and after the Holocaust. Powerful quotes taken from survivors’ interviews reveal hope, determination, and resilience. This book was previously published as a special issue of Journal of Human Behaviour and the Social Environment. Routledge «Market: Jewish Studies / Race & Ethnic Studies / Human Rights November 2010: 246x174: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-57172-2: £80.00/08
Routledge «Market: Women’s Studies / Religion / Politics March 2011: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-60360-7: £75.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83459-6: £75.00/14
Edited by Tracey Reynolds, London South Bank University, UK
Routledge «Market: Culture / Youth Studies / Ethnic Studies November 2010: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-55211-0: £80.00/08
The West Indian Diaspora Suzanne Model, University of Massachusetts, USA
The Challenges of Being a Rural Gay Man
Series: Routledge Studies of Diasporic Peoples
Coping With Stigma Deborah Bray Preston and Anthony R. D’Augelli, both at Penn State University, USA Series: Routledge Advances in Sociology Gay men often face struggles in the conservative world of rural life, due to the pervasive social stigmas associated with homosexuality and the lack of anonymity in a small-town setting. This book presents the results of in-depth interviews and surveys with rural gay men, providing unique and hitherto unknown perspectives on their experiences coping with intolerance.
Suzanne Model examines the adaptation of West Indians in five host societies: the United States, Great Britain, Canada, France and the Netherlands. The economic, political, and demographic disparities within these countries raise the question: how do conditions at their destination affect West Indian well-being? Routledge «Market: Sociology April 2011: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-87121-1: £70.00/08
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Sociology May 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-88069-5: £70.00/08
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
188 sports science, leisure studies & culture
HRM in the Sport and Leisure Industry *
Routledge Handbook of Sports Development *
Jeff Abrams, Leeds Metropolitan University, UK, Sue Minten and Chris Wolsey
Edited by Barrie Houlihan and Mick Green, both at Loughborough University, UK
By its very service nature, leisure and sport are staff intensive sectors, making effective Human Resource management and development central to understanding the business, and to business success. HRM in the Leisure and Sport Industry provides a comprehensive course textbook and reference for students of HRM, business, sports and leisure management. Selected Contents: 1. The Evolution of HRM 2. Organisational Structure and the Determinants of Organisational Culture 3. Foundations of Individual and Group Performance 4. Personal Skills for Managers 5. Recruitment and Selection 6. Training and Development 7. Mentorship & Coaching 8. Evaluating and Rewarding Employees 9. Leadership and Human Resource Strategy 10. Organisational Development and Change 11. The Learning Organisation Routledge «Market: HRM / Sport & Leisure Management March 2011: 246x174: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-42178-2: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-42179-9: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-88553-6: £75.00/14
Sports development has become a prominent concern within both the academic study of sport and within the organisation and administration of sport. This book presents important new studies of sports development around the world, illustrating the breadth of practice within and between countries, and examines the most important issues facing practitioners within sports development today. The Routledge Handbook of Sports Development is the first book to comprehensively map the wide-ranging territory of sports development as an activity and as a policy field, and to offer a definitive survey of current academic knowledge and professional practice. Routledge «Market: Sport Studies / Sports Management / Sport Development December 2010: 246x174: 648pp Hb: 978-0-415-47996-7: £125.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-88558-1: £125.00/14
Single Case Research Methods in Sport and Exercise
Managing Sport Business An Introduction Edited by Linda Trenberth, Birkbeck University, UK and David Hassan, Ulster University, UK
Jamie Barker and Paul McCarthy, Marc Jones, both at Staffordshire University, UK and Aidan Moran, University College, Dublin
Series: Foundations of Sport Management
This is the first book to fully explain single case research in the context of sport and exercise. Starting with first principles, the book offers a comprehensive introduction to the single case research process, from study design to data analysis and presentation. Including case studies and examples from across the sport and exercise sciences, the book provides practical guidance for students and researchers and demonstrates the advantages and common pitfalls of single case research for anybody working in applied or behavioural science.
Contemporary sport is both a sophisticated and complex international business and a mass participatory practice run largely by volunteers and community organisations. This authoritative and comprehensive introduction to the theory and practice of sports management helps managers to understand the modern commercial environment that shapes sport at all levels and gives clear and sensible guidance on best practice in sports management, from elite sport to the local level.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Routledge «Market: Sport Science / Research Methods March 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-56511-0: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56512-7: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-86188-2: £85.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Sport Management February 2011: 246x174: 328pp Hb: 978-0-415-57028-2: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57029-9: £29.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85841-7: £85.00/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
sports science, leisure studies & culture 189
Sport and Politics
Strategic Sports Development
Alan Bairner, Loughborough University, UK
Edited by Rosemary Leach, Sheffield Hallam University, UK, Stephen Robson, Leeds Metropolitan University, UK, Kirstie Simpson, Warrington Collegiate Institute, UK and Lee Tucker, Leeds Metropolitan University, UK
Series: Frontiers of Sport This book begins with three main propositions – that politicians use sport, that sport reflects political conditions and that sport itself contributes to political culture for good or for ill. Against this background Sport and Politics explores the key points of interaction between the two. With fascinating case studies woven throughout, this book is the perfect introduction to an important contemporary topic for all students of sport, politics and society.
Routledge «Market: Sport / Politics March 2011: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-57026-8: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57027-5: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85843-1: £75.00/14
Strategic Sports Development is designed to help students develop the practical skills needed to contribute to development strategy in a vocational context, and give practitioners the confidence and knowhow to improve the strategic development of their sports organisation.
Routledge «Market: Sports Development / Sport & Leisure Management / Business and Corporate strategy March 2011: 246x174: 352pp Hb: 978-0-415-54400-9: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-54401-6: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-87627-5: £95.00/14
2nd Edition textbook
Sport and the Transformation of Modern Europe States, Media and Markets 1950–2010
Sport, Culture and Society An Introduction Grant Jarvie, Stirling University, UK This exciting, comprehensive and accessible textbook introduces the study of sport, culture and society. International in scope, the book explores the key social theories that shape our understanding of sport as a social phenomenon and critically examines many of the assumptions that underpin that understanding. Placing sport at the very heart of the analysis, and including vibrant sporting examples throughout, the book introduces the student to every core topic and emerging area in the study of sport and society.
Edited by Alan Tomlinson, University of Brighton, UK, Christopher Young, University of Cambridge, UK and Richard Holt, De Montfort University, Leicester, UK Series: CRESC
çè
Routledge «Market: History of Sport / European History March 2011: 234x156: 232pp Hb: 978-0-415-59222-2: £75.00/08
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Routledge «Market: Sport Studies / Sociology March 2011: 246x174: 480pp Pb: 978-0-415-48393-3: £29.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-88380-8: £29.99/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-30647-8
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
In the modern era sport has been an important agent, and symptom, of the political, cultural and commercial pressures for convergence and globalisation. In this fascinating, interdisciplinary study, leading international scholars explore the making of modern sport in Europe, illuminating sport and its cultural and economic impacts in the context of the supra-state formations and global markets that have re-shaped national and trans-national cultures in the later twentieth century.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
190 sports science, leisure studies & culture
The Coaching Process * A Practical Guide to Becoming an Effective Sports Coach Lynn Kidman, University of Worcester, UK and Stephanie J. Hanrahan, The University of Queensland, Australia The Coaching Process develops an ‘athlete-centred approach’ to sports coaching, by which athletes take ownership of their learning, in turn strengthening their abilities to retain key skills and to make effective decisions during competition. Useful pedagogical features in each chapter, such as real life case studies, activities, self-reflection questions, and summaries of current research and best practice, encourage reflective practice and help student coaches to develop and extend their coaching techniques and philosophies. Routledge «Market: Sports Coaching December 2010: 234x156: 280pp Hb: 978-0-415-57053-4: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57054-1: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-85742-7: £85.00/14
The Sociology of Sports Coaching * Edited by Robyn L. Jones, University of Wales Institute, UK, Paul Potrac, University of Hull, UK, Chris Cushion, Loughborough University, UK and Lars Tore Ronglan, Norwegian School of Sport Science, Norway The Sociology of Sports Coaching establishes an alternative conceptual framework from which to explore sports coaching, introducing the student to the work of key social theorists such as Foucault, Marx and Bourdieu, and highlighting the key themes that link the study of sociology and sports coaching, such as power, structure and agency, and theories of knowledge and learning. This is the first book to describe a critical sociological perspective on sports coaching and as such it represents an important step forward in the professionalisation of the discipline. Routledge «Market: Sports Coaching / Sport Studies / Sociology December 2010: 234x156: 248pp Hb: 978-0-415-56084-9: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56085-6: £25.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-86554-5: £95.00/14
The Ethics of Sports Coaching
The Sports Management Toolkit
Edited by Alun R. Hardman and Carwyn Jones, both at University of Wales Institute, Cardiff, UK
Paul Emery, La Trobe University, Melbourne, Australia The Sports Management Toolkit is a practical guide to the most important management tools and techniques available to those working in the sport and leisure industries. Each chapter includes a detailed, step-by-step description of the key tools and techniques and their application; a ‘real world’ case study to demonstrate the technique in action, plus an extensive guide to further resources and a series of self-test questions.
Series: Ethics and Sport
Routledge «Market: Sport Studies / Sports Coaching / Ethics December 2010: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-55774-0: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-55775-7: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-86844-7: £90.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Routledge «Market: Sport Management / Business and Management March 2011: 246x174: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-49158-7: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-49159-4: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-88027-2: £85.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Despite the increasing sophistication of our understanding of the player-sportcoach relationship, the dominant perspective of the sports coach is still an instrumental one, focused almost exclusively on performance, achievement and competitive success. In this groundbreaking new book, leading sport scholars challenge that view, arguing that the coaching process is an inherently moral one with an inescapably ethical dimension, involving intense relationships between players and coaches. The Ethics of Sports Coaching critically examines this moral aspect, develops a powerful idea of what sports coaching ought to be, and argues strongly that coaches must be aware of the ethical implications of their acts.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
sports science, leisure studies & culture 191 Critical Readings in Bodybuilding
Race, Ethnicity and Football
Women, Sport, Society
Edited by Adam Locks, University of Chichester, UK and Niall Richardson, University of Sussex, UK
Persisting Debates and Emergent Issues
Further Reflections, Reaffirming Mary Wollstonecraft
Series: Routledge Research in Sport, Culture and Society This is the first collection to address the contemporary practice of bodybuilding, especially the way in which the activity has become increasingly more extreme, and to consider much neglected debates of gender, eroticism, and sexuality related to the activity. Routledge «Market: Sports Studies April 2011: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-87852-4: £70.00/08
Edited by Daniel Burdsey, University of Brighton, UK Series: Routledge Research in Sport, Culture and Society Elucidating the linkages between race, ethnicity, gender and masculinity in football, this volume addresses topics such as the experience of Muslim players, recruitment of African players, devolution and national identities, minority ethnic clubs, ‘mixed-race’ players, sectarianism, and foreign club ownership. Routledge «Market: Sociology March 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-88205-7: £70.00/08
Inclusion and Exclusion Through Youth Sport
The Cultural Politics of Post 9/11 American Sport
Edited by Symeon Dagkas, University of Birmingham, UK and Kathleen Armour Series: Routledge Studies in Physical Education and Youth Sport Focusing on youth sport as a touchstone sector of sport in society, this book examines the theoretical and empirical bases of arguments for sport’s role in the social inclusion agenda, offering international perspectives on an issue that underpins many of the bold claims and presumptions being made for the power of sport. It represents the most up-to-date and authoritative presentation of core knowledge related to inclusion and exclusion in youth sport and as such, will be invaluable reading for any student, researcher, policy maker or practitioner working in sports development, sports coaching, sport studies or physical education.
Edited by Roberta J. Park, University of California, Berkeley, USA and Patricia Vertinsky, University of British Columbia, Canada Series: Sport in the Global Society – Historical perspectives This book seeks to broaden our understandings about the backgrounds, motivations and achievements of dedicated women who have historically contributed to physical education, dance and sport in ways that go far beyond being teachers, athletes and coaches. It was published as a special issue of the International Journal of the History of Sport. Routledge «Market: History of Sport / Women’s Studies / Social History January 2011: 246x174: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-59738-8: £80.00/08
Michael L. Silk, University of Bath, UK Series: Routledge Research in Sport, Culture and Society This book uncovers how political, economic and military trajectories in the post 9/11 era have been normalized, reduced to the affective realm of popular culture, and nurtured and expressed in, and through, commercial media sporting spectacles. Routledge «Market: Sports May 2011: 229x152: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-87341-3: £70.00/08
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Sport Studies / Physical Education April 2011: 234x156: 302pp Hb: 978-0-415-57803-5: £85.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-85239-2: £85.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
192 psychology Taylor & Francis is the official distributor for Guilford Press books in the UK, Europe and Israel. Customers from the USA, Canada and the rest of the world should purchase Guilford Press titles (indicated below) via www.guilford.com
3rd Edition
2nd Edition textbook
Adolescent Rationality and Development
Assessment, Measurement, and Prediction for Personnel Decisions
Cognition, Morality, and Identity
Robert M. Guion, Bowling Green State University, USA This revision of Bob Guion’s bestselling book on Assessment, Measurement and Prediction for Personnel Decisions will be of interest to every graduate student and practitioner in the fields of Industrial, Organizational and Work psychology and Human Resource Management. Written by a well-known leader in this field, this book will help give the reader a good understanding of the assessment process for personnel decisions and help those in charge of hiring and training decisions in the workplace.
David Moshman, University of Nebraska – Lincoln, USA F requently cited in scholarly work, this book focuses on developmental changes and processes in adolescence rather than on the problems of daily life. Noted for its exceptionally strong coverage of cognitive, moral, and social development, this brief, inexpensive book is appreciated by anyone interested in adolescent development. The new edition features expanded coverage of thinking and reasoning and four new chapters: metacognition and epistemic cognition; moral principles; the relation of personal and social identity; and current controversies concerning the rationality, maturity, and brains of adolescents.
Close Relationships Pamela Regan, California State University, Los Angeles, USA Introducing the concepts, methodologies, theories, and empirical findings of interpersonal relationships drawn from psychology,communication, sociology, philosophy, and religion, this engaging book will appeal to anyone interested in learning more about romantic relationships as well as relationships with friends and family. Numerous examples demonstrate how the material is relevant to the readers. Active learning is encouraged throughout including measurement instruments that readers can take and score themselves. The book reviews relationship experiences from all age groups, for all relationship types, and from a variety of cultures and the latest research on ‘cyber-flirting,’ sex differences in jealousy, the neurochemistry of love, and bullying. Routledge Academic «Market: Relationships February 2011: 246x174: 408pp Hb: 978-0-415-87743-5: £64.95/01 Pb: 978-0-415-87799-2: £39.95/01 eBook: 978-0-203-83474-9: £64.95/01
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Cluttering A Handbook of Research, Intervention and Education Edited by David Ward, University of Reading, UK and Kathleen Scaler Scott, Misericordia University, USA Very few people are aware of the significant negative impact that cluttering – a communication disorder which affects a person’s ability to speak in a clear, concise and fluent manner. Although different from stuttering, it is often related to this more well-known disorder. This book treats cluttering as a serious communication disorder in its own right, providing an in-depth examination of the critical factors surrounding its assessment, treatment and research. Using evidencebased data as well as information regarding the assessment and treatment of cluttering within the field of speech-language pathology, the volume includes the latest research findings and work from leading cluttering experts, worldwide. Clinicians, faculty members, researchers, students in the field of speech pathology, and those who clutter, alike, will find this book an essential and unique source of information on cluttering. Psychology Press «Market: Language Disorders January 2011: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-1-84872-029-9: £44.95/01
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Psychology Press «Market: Adolescent Psychology February 2011: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-1-84872-860-8: £44.95/01 Pb: 978-1-84872-861-5: £17.50/01 eBook: 978-0-203-83511-1: £39.95/01 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8058-4830-4
Psychology Press «Market: April 2011: 246x174: 752pp Hb: 978-0-8058-6023-8: £70.00/01 eBook: 978-0-203-83676-7: £59.95/01 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8058-1577-1
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
psychology 193
Cognitive Development and Working Memory
Handbook of Ethics in Quantitative Methodology
A Dialogue between Neo-Piagetian Theories and Cognitive Approaches
Edited by Abigail T. Panter, University of North Carolina – Chapel Hill, USA and Sonya K. Sterba, Vanderbilt University, USA
Edited by Pierre Barrouillet, Université de Genève, Switzerland and Vinciane Gaillard, Université Libre de Bruxelles, Belgium ‘This book brings together a selected group of leading researchers, to discuss a currently hot topic. The authors represent different theoretical approaches and research groups, and each chapter contributes in its unique way, using theoretical modelling, experimental and individual-difference studies, to a debate that has become highly relevant in the scientific community. The book is excellent.’ – Sergio Morra, University of Genoa, Italy This book presents a unique attempt to address issues of working memory by establishing a dialogue between neo-Piagetian theorists and researchers specialized in typical and atypical working memory development. Psychology Press «Market: Cognitive Psychology November 2010: 234x156: 296pp Hb: 978-1-84872-036-7: £39.95/01 eBook: 978-0-203-84583-7: £39.95/14
Series: Multivariate Applications Series This Handbook is the first to provide a practical, interdisciplinary review of ethical issues as they relate to quantitative methodology including how to present evidence for reliability and validity, what comprises an adequate tested population, and what constitutes scientific knowledge for eliminating biases. The book emphasizes the human cost of quantitative decision making to help researchers understand the implications of their choices. The chapter order parallels the chronology of the research process: determining the research design; data analysis; and communicating findings. Each chapter: explores the ethics of the topic; identifies methodological issues; reviews strategies for handling such issues and their ethical implications; provides a case example; and outlines plausible approaches to the issue including best-practice solutions.This Handbook appeals to researchers and practitioners in psychology, health, education, sociology, political science, and business. Routledge Academic «Market: Research Methods February 2011: 234x156: 568pp Hb: 978-1-84872-854-7: £59.95/01 Pb: 978-1-84872-855-4: £29.95/01 eBook: 978-0-203-84002-3: £59.95/01
Deception * A Young Person’s Life Skill? Rachel Taylor, University of Glamorgan, UK and Lynsey Gozna, University of Lincoln, UK Series: Studies in Adolescent Development This book considers the role of deception in adolescence, and explores the factors underpinning adolescents’ choice to deceive, whether these deceptions will be successful, and the ways in which such lies could be detected. The book builds on the recent influential developmental challenge model, exploring how it can provide a useful explanatory framework for the development of the skill of deception in adolescence. Interpersonal and forensic settings for deceptive behaviour are referred to, and it discusses how adolescents’ deceptions could be detected and presents strategies to maximize the effectiveness of interpersonal interactions with suspected deceivers. This book is ideal for parents, researchers and practitioners working with children and young people. The observations, interviews and focus groups provide a unique insight into the factors influencing young people’s communication choices.
Handbook of Police Psychology Edited by Jack Kitaeff, Clinical Psychologist, USA Series: Applied Psychology Series This new handbook of approximately 30 chapters is intended to be a professional reference that will include a literature review and extensive reference list. The handbook can serve as a textbook for graduates interested in police psychology. Other markets that will find this book interesting include: criminal justice, public service, clinical psychology, and organizational psychology. Division 18 of APA (Society for Police and Criminal psychology) will be the most interested. Routledge Academic «Market: Police Psychology March 2011: 246x174: 632pp Hb: 978-0-415-87766-4: £64.95/01 eBook: 978-0-203-83617-0: £64.95/01
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Psychology Press «Market: Adolescent Development December 2010: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-1-84169-876-2: £39.95/01 eBook: 978-0-203-83370-4: £39.95/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
194 psychology
Handbook of Health Psychology and Behavioral Medicine *
Illegal Leisure Revisited Changing Patterns of Alcohol and Drug Use in Adolescents and Young Adults
Edited by Jerry M. Suls, University of Iowa, USA Karina W. Davidson, Columbia University, USA and Robert M. Kaplan, University of California, Los Angeles, USA ’Suls, Davidson, and Kaplan are leaders in the fields of health psychology and behavioral medicine ... This is a ‘must-have’ reference for graduate students and researchers in health psychology, behavioral medicine, and related disciplines, such as medical sociology and nursing science.’ – Kenneth A. Wallston, Vanderbilt University, USA Providing a state-of-the-science overview of theory, research, and practice at the interface of psychology and health, this comprehensive volume brings together leading experts from multiple disciplines. The book explores how health and health behaviors are shaped by a wide range of psychological processes and socialenvironmental factors. It describes exemplary applications in the prevention and clinical management of today’s most pressing health risks and diseases, including coronary heart disease, diabetes, cancer, chronic pain, obesity, sleep disturbances, and smoking. Guilford Press «Market: Psychology October 2010: 246x174: 592pp Hb: 978-1-60623-895-0: £57.00/01
2nd Edition
Judith Aldridge, University of Manchester, UK, Fiona Measham, Lanacaster University, UK, Howard Parker and Lisa Williams, both at University of Manchester, UK Series: Adolescence and Society Series This book updates the progress into adulthood of 14-year-olds that were tracked for the first edition, using qualitative interviews and self-report surveys. It presents to the reader the ways in which these young people have moved into the world of work, long-term relationships and parenthood. The book is ideal reading for researchers and undergraduate students from a variety of fields. Professionals working in criminal justice, health promotion, drugs education, harm reduction and treatment will find this book an invaluable resource. Selected Contents: 1. History Lessons: Drug Use Trends Amongst Young Britons 1980–2010 2. The North-West Longitudinal Study 3. Alcohol ‘Our Favourite Drug’ 4. Pattern: An Overview of Drug Offers, Trying, Use and Drugs Experiences Across Adolescence 5. Pathways: Drug Abstainers, Former Triers, Current Users and Those in Transition 6. Journeys: Becoming Users of Drugs 7. Towards the Normalisation of Recreational Drug Use Routledge «Market: Adolescent Development February 2011: 216x138: 280pp Hb: 978-0-415-49552-3: £45.00/01 Pb: 978-0-415-49553-0: £21.95/01
Handbook of Neurodevelopmental and Genetic Disorders in Children Language and Edited by Sam Goldstein, Learning and Behavior Center, Salt Bilingual Cognition * ’An excellent introduction to the science and practice underlying the assessment, diagnosis, and treatment of children with complex neurodevelopmental conditions ... This updated second edition will become a ‘go-to guide’ for pediatric and clinical child neuropsychologists.’ – Scott J. Hunter, University of Chicago, USA Recognized as the definitive reference in the field, this book addresses a broad range of biologically based disorders that affect children’s learning and development. Leading authorities review the genetics of each disorder; its course and outcome; associated developmental, cognitive, and psychosocial challenges; and what clinicians and educators need to know about effective approaches to assessment and intervention. Coverage encompasses numerous lower-incidence neurodevelopmental disabilities as well as more frequently diagnosed learning and behavior problems with a genetic component. Guilford Press «Market: Psychology / Child and Adolescent Mental Health January 2011: 246x174: 588pp Hb: 978-1-60623-990-2: £57.00/01 Prev. Ed: 978-1-57230-448-2
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Edited by Vivian Cook, University of Newcastle, UK and Benedetta Bassetti, Northumbria University, UK Leading figures from various disciplines provide a state-of-the-art overview of the relationship between language and cognition, with a focus on bilinguals. Selected Contents: How Does Language Affect Thought? View from Anthropology. View from Cognitive Linguistics. Interactive Influences. Tools for Thinking. L2 User. Perspective from Semantics. Advances in Bilingualism. Bilingual Worlds. Color & Bilingual Cognition. Spatial Language & SLA. Perception of Motion. Expressing Voluntary Motion in a L2. Sensitivity to Temporal Phase. Grammatical & Conceptual Gender of Animals. Space & Gesture. Interpreting & Recounting Accidental Events in Spanish and English. Theory of Mind & Bilingual Cognition. Bilingualism & the Impact of Emotion. Emotions in Bilingual Life Narratives. Linguistic Relativity & Language Teaching. Translation. Culture & Cognition. Advertising to the Buy-Lingual Consumer Psychology Press «Market: Psycholinguistics December 2010: 234x156: 594pp Hb: 978-1-84872-924-7: £45.00/01 eBook: 978-0-203-83685-9: £45.00/01
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Lake City, USA and Cecil R. Reynolds, in Private Practice, USA
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
psychology 195
Multi-Team Systems
Nadia Revisited
An Organization Form for Dynamic and Complex Environments
A Longitudinal Study of Savant Syndrome
Edited by Stephen J. Zaccaro and Michelle Marks, both at George Mason University, USA and Leslie De Church, University of Central Florida, USA
This book re-examines the case of Nadia, a child aged six who had been drawing with phenomenal skill and visual realism from the age of three, despite having autism and severe learning difficulties. Nadia’s abilities are contextualised amongst recent studies of the drawing development of normal/average children, and the anomaly which Nadia represents is examined. The book analyses how these research findings can be used to discuss broad theories of developmental psychology, and the possible links between prodigious talents and underlying neurological dysfunction.
This book examines an emerging organizational form called multi-team systems (MTS). This type of aggregation is being increasingly adopted by organizations and agencies that need to respond to complex strategic problems. The book will also explore how such systems emerge and develop, as well as the methods for studying MTSs. Because the notion of MTSs cuts across multiple domains, we expect that this book will interest scholars in industrial/organizational psychology, organizational science, management and organizational theory, human factors, sociology, organization communications, and public administration. Psychology Press April 2011: 234x156: 400pp Hb: 978-1-84872-869-1: £45.95/01
Lorna Selfe, Clinical Practice, UK
Selected Contents: 1. Nadia: Then and Now 2. The Drawings 3. Nadia and Normal Representational Drawing Ability 4. Nadia and Autism 5. Theories of the Savant Syndrome 6. Where Does Nadia Fit In? 7. Unanswered Questions Psychology Press «Market: Developmental Psychology February 2011: 234x156: 264pp Hb: 978-1-84872-038-1: £29.95/01
2nd Edition
Handbook of Self-Regulation *
Neuroscience of Decision Making
Research, Theory, and Applications
Edited by Oshin Vartanian and David R. Mandel, both at Defence Research and Development, Canada
’Vohs and Baumeister have assembled an impressive range of contributors ... It is difficult to imagine how someone could be a researcher in the field of self-regulation, or a serious student of the topic, without owning a copy of this book.’ – David C. Funder, University of California, Riverside, USA This authoritative Handbook reviews the breadth of current knowledge on the conscious and nonconscious processes by which people regulate their thoughts, emotions, attention, behavior, and impulses. Individual differences in self-regulatory capacities are explored, as are developmental pathways. The volume examines how self-regulation shapes, and is shaped by, social relationships. Failures of self-regulation are also addressed, in chapters on addictions, overeating, compulsive spending, and attention-deficit/ hyperactivity disorder.
çè
Guilford Press «Market: Psychology December 2010: 246x174: 594pp Hb: 978-1-60623-948-3: £54.00/01 Pb: 978-1-59385-475-1: £24.00/01 Prev. Ed: 978-1-57230-991-3
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Series: Contemporary Topics in Cognitive Neuroscience This volume capitalizes on recent advances in the neurosciences to address key issues in behavioral decision theory, with implications for psychology, economics, and law. Leading researchers provide a broad overview of how decision processes may be grounded within a brain model. Selected Contents: 2-alternative Forcedchoice Decision Making (DM). Why Does it Take Time to Make a Decision? Emotions in DM. Neuroscience of Financial DM. Uncertainty and Neuromodulation. DM under Risk and Uncertainty. Reward-related Processing in the Human Striatum. Neural Mechanisms of Reward and Punishment Learning in the Brain. Reward and Punishment Processing in the Brain. Neural Foundations of Strategic Behavior. Neural Bases of Social DM. Social and Biological Influences on Trust and Cooperation. Making Judgments at Face Value. Goal-directed and Spontaneous Forms of Thought. ‘Well, What Do You Want to Do?’ Cognitive Neuroscience View of Plan DM. Decision Junctures in the Creative Process Psychology Press «Market: Cognitive Neuroscience March 2011: 234x156: 352pp Hb: 978-1-84169-489-4: £39.95/01 eBook: 978-0-203-83592-0: £39.95/01
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Edited by Kathleen D. Vohs, University of Minnesota, USA and Roy F. Baumeister, Florida State University, USA
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
196 psychology
Rethinking the Knowledge Controversy in Organization Studies
Social Understanding and Social Lives From Toddlerhood through to the Transition to School Claire Hughes, University of Cambridge, UK
A Generative Uncertainty Perspective
Series: Essays in Developmental Psychology
Walter Nord and Ann Connell, both at University of South Florida, USA Series: Series in Organization and Management Recently the field of organization studies has been plagued by intense, disruptive controversy about what counts as knowledge. This book, written by the major researchers and voices in the field of organization studies , attempts to respond to this controversy by offering the topic of ‘generative uncertainty’ as the primary vehicle for rethinking about this issue. The authors prefer admitting uncertainty to making unwarranted assumptions. The ideas about questioning the possibility of knowledge that is certain goes back to before the time of Socrates. This unique, historical look at the study of organization studies will be of interest to all students and scholars of this field. Routledge Academic «Market: April 2011: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-87512-7: £44.95/01 eBook: 978-0-203-83339-1: £44.95/01
Based on rich observational data from her extended longitudinal study, this book examines the varied nature of children’s awareness of others’ thoughts from both social and cognitive perspectives, and investigates the real-life significance of individual differences in theory of mind. It analyses the differences in children’s ability to self-regulate, their general language skills and the quantity and quality of family conversations, to explain why some children show a much more advanced social understanding than others. It also examines the quality of children’s interactions with friends, their ability to resolve conflict without resorting to antisocial or disruptive behavior, and diverse aspects of school adjustment. Selected Contents: Part 1: Cognitive Perspectives on Social Understanding Part 2: Social Influences on Children’s Understanding of Mind Part 3: Social Understanding and Social Outcomes Psychology Press «Market: Developmental Psychology February 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-1-84169-735-2: £29.95/01
4th Edition
IBM SPSS for Intermediate Statistics Statistical Approaches to Use and Interpretation Measurement Invariance Nancy L. Leech, University of Colorado at Denver, USA, George A. Morgan and Karen C. Barrett, both at Colorado State University, USA
Roger Millsap, Arizona State University, USA
Routledge Academic «Market: Statistics April 2011: 276x219: 300pp Pb: 978-0-415-88047-3: £19.95/01 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8058-6267-6
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Routledge Academic «Market: Measurement April 2011: 234x156: 352pp Hb: 978-1-84872-818-9: £50.00/01 Pb: 978-1-84872-819-6: £24.99/01
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Readers learn to analyze and interpret research data using SPSS 19 with this book. It reviews how to choose the statistic based on the design; interpret output; and write about the results. All of the key SPSS windows needed to perform the analyses are provided along with outputs with call-out boxes to highlight key points, interpretation questions, and extra problems for review. It reviews how to assess the accuracy and reliability of data and an overview of basic statistics. Chapters on multilevel linear modeling, MANOVA, assessing reliability of data, and factor analysis are provided. Realistic data sets used in the book and SPSS syntax and output are available on the web. Appreciated by researchers in psychology, education, social, and health sciences, the new edition features more on assumptions and effect size measures and multilevel modeling.
This book reviews the statistical procedures used to detect measurement bias. Measurement bias is examined from a general latent variable perspective so as to accommodate different forms of testing in a variety of contexts including cognitive or clinical variables, attitudes, personality dimensions, or emotional states. Measurement models that underlie psychometric practice are described, including their strengths and limitations. Practical strategies and examples for dealing with bias detection are provided throughout. Emphasis is placed on latent variable models, with introductions to classical test theory, factor analysis, and item response theory, and the controversies associated with each. Measurement invariance and bias in the context of multiple populations is defined. Researchers in psychology and education faced with considering bias in measurement will value this book.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
psychology 197
Theories of Team Cognition Cross-Disciplinary Perspectives Edited by Eduardo Salas, University of Central Florida, Stephen M. Fiore, University of Central Florida, Orlando, USA and Michael Letsky Series: Applied Psychology Series Teamwork, by definition, is achieved when members interact independently and work together toward shared and valued goals. Expert teamwork involves the adaptation of collaboration strategies through coordination, cooperation, and communication as well a collective understanding of the task. Cognitive psychology has substantially influenced the study of teams. Now much crossdisciplinary attention has focused on determining how cognitive processes contribute to effective team performance. This book will gather a group of well known contributors/scientists in the field of shared cognition, team cognition and the emerging field of macrocognition. Routledge Academic «Market: Team Performance & Cognition February 2011: 234x156: 340pp Hb: 978-0-415-87413-7: £50.00/01
4th Edition textbook
The Nature of Adolescence *
Therapeutic Processes for Communication Disorders * A Guide for Clinicians and Students Edited by Robert J. Fourie, University College Cork, Ireland Authors in the fields of communication disorders analyse the psychological, social and linguistic processes and interactions underpinning clinical practice, from both the client and clinician perspectives.The chapters demonstrate how it is possible to analyze and understand client-clinician discourse using qualitative research, and describe various challenges to establishing relationships such as cultural, gender and age differences. The authors go on to describe self-care processes, the therapeutic use of the self, and various psychological factors that could be important for developing therapeutic relationships. While this book is geared toward the needs of practicing and training speech, language and hearing clinicians, other professional such as teachers of the deaf, psychotherapists, nurses, and occupational therapists will find the ideas relevant, interesting and easily translatable for use in their own clinical practice. Psychology Press «Market: Clinical Psychology November 2010: 234x156: 280pp Hb: 978-1-84872-041-1: £34.95/01 eBook: 978-0-203-83970-6: £34.95/14
John Coleman, Oxford University, UK Series: Adolescence and Society Series ’This book is unique in bringing together perspectives on adolescence from psychology, psychoanalysis, anthropology, neuroscience and criminology. It is essential reading for all those who wish to understand young people.’ – John Pitts, University of Bedfordshire, UK The new edition of this successful textbook provides an up-to-date introduction to all of the key features of adolescent development. This is essential reading for students of human development, as well as for professional postgraduate courses, including teachers, social workers, health workers, counsellors, and youth workers.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Selected Contents: 1. Introduction 2. Physical Development 3. Thinking and Reasoning 4. The Self and Identity 5. The Family 6. Health 7. Sexual Development 8. Adolescence and Education 9. Friends and the Peer Group 10. Anti-Social Behaviour 11. Risk, Resilience and Coping in Adolescence Routledge «Market: Adolescent Development December 2010: 246x174: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-56419-9: £52.50/01 Pb: 978-0-415-56420-5: £18.50/01 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-19898-1
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
mental health
TOP TEN BESTSELLERS
198 psychology
1.
6. ADD-Friendly Ways to Organize Your Life
Why Love Matters How Affection Shapes a Baby’s Brain Sue Gerhardt
Strategies that Work from a Professional Organizer and a Renowned ADD Clinician
2004: 198x129: 256pp Pb: 978-1-58391-817-3: £9.99/06
Judith Kolberg and Kathleen Nadeau 2002: 254x178: 280pp Pb: 978-1-58391-358-1: £13.50/01
2.
7. Counselling for Toads
Discovering Your Couple Sexual Style
A Psychological Adventure Robert de Board
Sharing Desire, Pleasure, and Satisfaction
1997: 198x129: 160pp Pb: 978-0-415-17429-9: £12.50/06
3.
Barry W. McCarthy and Emily McCarthy 2009: 229x152: 152pp Pb: 978-0-415-99469-9: £9.99/04
8. Skills-based Learning for Caring for a Loved One with an Eating Disorder
Rekindling Desire A Step-by-Step Program to Help Low-Sex and No-Sex Marriages Barry McCarthy and Emily McCarthy
The New Maudsley Method
2003: 210x140: 224pp Pb: 978-0-415-93551-7: £12.50/01
Janet Treasure, Gráinne Smith and Anna Crane 2007: 234x156: 248pp Pb: 978-0-415-43158-3: £13.50/06
4.
9. Depression
How to Overcome Premature Ejaculation
The Way Out of Your Prison
Helen Singer Kaplan
Dorothy Rowe
1989: : 128pp Pb: 978-0-87630-542-3: £13.50/01
3rd Edition
2003: 197X130: 344pp Pb: 978-1-58391-286-7: £9.99/04
10. Getting Better Bit(e) by Bit(e)
Child Parent Relationship Therapy (CPRT)
A Survival Kit for Sufferers of Bulimia Nervosa and Binge Eating Disorders
A 10-Session Filial Therapy Model
Ulrike Schmidt and Janet Treasure
Garry L. Landreth and Sue C. Bratton
1993: 233x169: 160pp Pb: 978-0-86377-322-8: £13.50/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
2005: 229x152: 512pp Hb: 978-0-415-95110-4: £26.95/01
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
5.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
clinical psychology & psychiatry 199
Ageing and Older Adult Mental Health Issues and Implications for Practice Edited by Patrick Ryan and Barry J. Coughlan, both at the University of Limerick, Ireland
Desistance from Sex Offending * Alternatives to Throwing Away the Keys D. Richard Laws, Pacific Design Research, Canada and Tony Ward, Victoria Univesrity of Wellington, New Zealand ’This book is an essential resource for clinicians, researchers, and policymakers ... Students would benefit from the excellent integration of research and theory into clinical practice, and would find the fresh perspective on rehabilitation to be eye opening.’ – Elizabeth L. Jeglic, John Jay College of Criminal Justice, USA
’The authors are to be congratulated for editing a highly accessible book on ageing and mental health.’ – Alan Carr, University College Dublin, Ireland This book examines the issues and implications that mental health professionals face when dealing with ageing and older adults. It focuses on the biological, psychological and cultural influences that impact on the work of mental health practitioners. Selected Contents: Ryan, O’Rourke, Ward, Aherne, Historical and Current Perspectives. O’Connell Kehoe, Coughlan Assessment of Mental Health Issues. Dempsey, Coughlan Treatment of Mental Health Issues. O’Reilly, Lavin, Coughlan Ageing and Dementia. O’Donoghue, Ryan Depression and Ageing. Smith, Elder Abuse. Ryan, O’Sullivan, Smyth Older Adults: Key to the Success of Younger Generations Routledge «Market: Clinical Psychology and Psychiatry December 2010: 234x156: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-58289-6: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58290-2: £21.99/04
CBT for Psychosis *
This book offers a fresh perspective on treating a population that is often demonized by policymakers, the public, and even clinicians. The authors argue that most sex offenders are ‘people like us,’ with the potential to lead meaningful, law-abiding lives – if given a chance and appropriate support. They present an empirically and theoretically grounded rehabilitation approach, the Good Lives Model, which can be integrated with the assessment and intervention approaches that clinicians already use. Guilford Press «Market: Clinical Psychology and Psychiatry November 2010: 229x152: 306pp Hb: 978-1-60623-935-3: £30.50/01
3rd Edition
A Symptom-Based Approach Edited by Roger Hagen, Norwegian University of Science and Technology, Norway, Douglas Turkington, Newcastle University, UK, Torkil Berge, Vinderen Community Mental Health Centre, Norway and Rolf W. Gråwe, Drug and Alcohol Treatment, Norway
Handbook of Pain Assessment Dennis C. Turk, University of Washington, USA and Ronald Melzack, McGill University, Canada ’There is simply no other text or resource that so thoroughly defines the current status of pain assessment ... This well-written, easy-to-read volume from some of the most eminent specialists in the field should be required reading for all health professionals who come into contact with people in pain.’ – Margaret Caudill-Slosberg, Dartmouth Medical School, USA
Series: The International Society for the Psychological Treatments of the Schizophrenias and Other Psychoses
This book brings together international experts from different aspects of this fast developing field and will be of great interest to all mental health professionals working with people suffering from psychotic symptoms.
çè
Selected Contents: Part I: Cognitive Models of Psychosis and Their Assessment Part II: Treating Psychotic Symptoms Using CBT Part III: CBT and Co-morbid Problems Part IV: CBT and Bipolar Disorders Routledge «Market: Clinical Psychology and Psychiatry / Cognitive Behaviour Therapy December 2010: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-54946-2: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-54947-9: £19.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83267-7: £60.00/14
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
This definitive clinical reference comprehensively reviews the most advanced methods for assessing the person in pain. The field’s leading authorities present essential information and tools for evaluating psychosocial, behavioral, situational, and medical factors in patients’ subjective experience, functional impairment, and response to treatment. Best-practice recommendations are provided for assessing the most prevalent pain syndromes and for working with children, the elderly, and people with communication difficulties. Guilford Press «Market: Clinical Psychology and Psychiatry December 2010: 254x178: 542pp Hb: 978-1-60623-976-6: £51.00/01 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5723-0488-8
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
This book offers a new approach to understanding and treating psychotic symptoms using cognitive behavioural therapy (CBT). Stressing the important connection between mental illness and mental health, topics of discussion include: the assessment and formulation of psychotic symptoms; how to treat psychotic symptoms using CBT; CBT for specific and co morbid conditions; and CBT of bipolar disorders.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
200 clinical psychology & psychiatry
Scientific Foundations of Clinical Assessment
The Promise of Integrated Healthcare
Stephen N. Haynes, University of Hawaii, USA, Gregory Taylor Smith, University of Kentucky, USA and John D. Hunsley, University of Ottawa, Canada
Edited by Nicholas A. Cummings and William T. O’Donohue, both at the University of Nevada, Reno, USA The Promise of Integrated Healthcare is a necessary book, edited and contributed to by a great variety of authors from academia, government, and industry. The book takes a bold look at what reforms are needed in healthcare and provides reforms and specific recommendations. Some of the serious concerns about the healthcare system that Cummings, DeLeon, O’Donohue, and contributors address include access problems, safety problems, costs problems, the uninsured, and problems with efficacy. When students, practitioners, researchers, and policy makers finish reading this book they will have not just a greater idea of what problems still exist in healthcare, but, more importantly, a clearer idea of how to tackle them and provide much-needed reform.
Series: Foundations of Clinical Science and Practice Scientific Foundations of Clinical Assessment is a user-friendly overview of the most important science-based principles and concepts of clinical assessment. It provides readers with a science-based framework for interpreting assessment research and making good assessment decisions, such as selecting the best instruments and measures, and interpreting the obtained assessment data. Written in a direct and highly readable fashion, this text is one every professional and graduate student needs. Routledge «Market: Clinical Psychology and Psychiatry April 2011: 229x152: 225pp Hb: 978-0-415-87650-6: £52.00/08 Pb: 978-0-415-87651-3: £15.50/04
Routledge «Market: Clinical Psychology and Psychiatry May 2011: 229x152: 384pp Hb: 978-0-415-87643-8: £24.95/08
2nd Edition
The Aging Intellect * Douglas Powell, Harvard Medical School, Massachusetts, USA The Aging Intellect is written for the large number of professionals, including social workers, nurses, retirement home administrators, doctors, psychologists, pastors and others, who oversee the well being of elderly women and men. It provides elder care workers with an array of suggestions (beyond exercising and eating right) that can improve, maintain or maximize the quality of their client’s mental abilities for as long as possible. The Aging Intellect serves its purpose by addressing four major issues associated with agerelated cognitive decline, each of which has a solid research footing and is within the reach of most seniors. Routledge «Market: Clinical Psychology and Psychiatry / Gerontology May 2011: 229x152: 216pp Hb: 978-0-415-99685-3: £19.50/08 eBook: 978-0-203-88250-4: £19.50/01
Understanding Research in Clinical and Counseling Psychology Edited by Jay C. Thomas and Michel Hersen, both at Pacific University, Oregon, USA Understanding Research in Clinical and Counseling Psychology, Second Edition is designed and written for graduate students aspiring to careers in practice and presents research as an indispensable tool for practice. Contributing authors are experts in both psychological research and practice, and fulfill their goal of helping build the basic skills of how to utilize research findings and to communicate with researchers what new knowledge is most needed. The book is divided into four parts that organizes topics logically for students around introductory basics, research strategies, planning, doing, and interpreting research, and special issues. Overall, the coverage gives students all the relevant information they need and reflects research in the real world.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Clinical Psychology and Psychiatry April 2011: 229x152: 528pp Pb: 978-0-415-99221-3: £38.95/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83170-0: £77.90/01 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8058-3671-4
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
psychotherapy & counselling 201
A Clinician’s Guide to Effective Dropping the Baby and Career Counseling for Individuals Other Scary Thoughts Breaking the Cycle of Unwanted Thoughts in Motherhood with Psychiatric Disabilities Michael Walsh has created a practical and user-friendly guide for mental health professionals who perform career counseling work with patients who have psychiatric disabilities. This guide discusses how to handle career counseling in a recovery-friendly way, emphasizing the importance of vocational counseling with this group. Topics covered include the unique challenges one faces when working with this group, how acquiring and maintaining employment aids in the recovery process, and helpful suggestions for strengthening client motivation. Each chapter includes a list of additional resources and discussion questions, as well as numerous case studies, that will no doubt be of great help to the practitioner. Walsh’s light and engaging writing style and focus on practical information make this handbook both easily accessible and a valuable resource for the clinician. Routledge «Market: Psychotherapy and Counseling March 2011: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-99704-1: £53.00/08 Pb: 978-0-415-99705-8: £17.00/04 eBook: 978-0-203-88426-3: £53.00/01
2nd Edition
Attachment, Trauma and Multiplicity * Working with Dissociative Identity Disorder Edited by Valerie Sinason, Clinic for Dissociative Studies, UK This revised edition investigates the subject of Dissociative Identity Disorder. With new chapters on police work and attachment theory it has been fully updated to include new research.With contributions from psychotherapists, psychiatrists, psychoanalysts and service users this book covers the background history and a description of the condition along with the issues of diagnoses and treatment. It looks at: the phenomenon of DID; the conflicting models of the human mind that have been found to try and understand DID; and the political conflict over the subject.
çè
Selected Contents: Part I: Mapping the Territory: Childhood Aetiology, Abuse, Attachment Theory Research, Dissociation, Dissociative Identity Disorder Part II: Attachment Focus: Mainly Theory Part III: Attachment Focus – Mainly Practice Part IV: Other frames of reference: Linguistic, Diagnostic, Forensic and Historic Issues Routledge «Market: Psychotherapy and Counselling December 2010: 234x156: 248pp Hb: 978-0-415-49179-2: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-49181-5: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83114-4: £60.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-19555-3 www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Karen Kleiman, The Postpartum Stress Center, USA and Amy Wenzel, University of Pennsylvania, USA
Dropping the Baby and Other Scary Thoughts: Breaking the Cycle of Unwanted Thoughts in Motherhood addresses the nature of the intrusive, negative, and anxious thoughts pregnant and postpartum women can experience. It provides answers to the women who seek information, clarification, and validation and is a useful resource for healthcare professionals who work with them. It is a resource for consumers and clinicians who must confront these negative cognitions by outlining what these thoughts are, why they are there, and what can be done about them. The compassionate tone of the book will be a voice that is familiar to many women in the postpartum community. This book is written by two clinicians who have established themselves as leading experts and authors in this specialized field. Routledge «Market: Anxiety / Parenting January 2011: 229x152: 264pp Hb: 978-0-415-87700-8: £13.99/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83561-6: £13.99/01
2nd Edition
Making Cognitive-Behavioral Therapy Work * Clinical Process for New Practitioners Deborah Roth Ledley, in Private Practice, Philadelphia, USA, Brian P. Marx, Boston University, USA and Richard G. Heimberg, Temple University, USA ’I wish this kind of clinical resource had been available when I was a doctoral student learning CBT! ... A wonderful resource for the psychotherapist in training or for the experienced practitioner new to CBT methods. Most highly recommended as a classroom or practicum textbook.’ – Bruce A. Thyer, Florida State University, USA Used around the world by novice clinicians as well as experienced therapists new to cognitive-behavioral therapy (CBT), this bestselling book has been widely adopted as a text in clinical training programs. The authors provide a vivid picture of what it is actually like to do CBT and offer practical guidance for becoming a more skilled and confident clinician. Vignettes and examples illustrate the entire process of therapy, from intake and assessment to case conceptualization, treatment planning, intervention, and termination. Guilford Press «Market: Psychotherapy and Counselling October 2010: 229x152: 289pp Hb: 978-1-60623-912-4: £27.00/01 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5938-5142-2
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Michael J. Walsh, University of South Carolina, USA
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
202 psychotherapy & counselling 2nd Edition
2nd Edition
Favorite Counseling and Therapy Techniques *
Favorite Counseling and Therapy Homework Assignments *
Edited by Howard Rosenthal, St. Louis Community College at Florissant Valley, USA
Edited by Howard Rosenthal, St. Louis Community College at Florissant Valley, USA
In the new edition of this highly popular book, Howard Rosenthal once again brings together a group of prominent therapists who share their insightful, pioneering, and favorite therapeutic techniques. These therapists include such well-known figures as Albert Ellis, Arnold Lazarus, William Glasser, Raymond Corsini, and Allen E. Ivey. All of the entries in the previous edition are once again included, some unaltered and others updated, while several new chapters have been added to reflect the newest advancements in the counseling field. For practitioners wondering what methods to use when working with clients and what they can prescribe for them between sessions, or for those who simply are interested in gaining insight into the thoughts and minds of such eminent therapists, the more than 50 entries in this text are sure to be both highly useful and exciting reads.
This companion to Favorite Counseling and Therapy Techniques contains more than fifty handouts and homework assignments used by some of the finest and most renowned therapists in the world, such as Albert Ellis, William Glasser, Richard B. Bolles, Alan E. Ivey, Marianne Schneider Corey, Gerald Corey, Maxie C. Maultsby, Jr., and Peter R. Breggin. Several new entries have been added to reflect the newest advancements in the counseling field. This is sure to be a highly useful and insightful read for any practitioner wishing to learn new techniques to benefit their practice and patients.
Routledge «Market: Psychotherapy and Counseling February 2011: 229x152: 360pp Pb: 978-0-415-87104-4: £21.95/04 eBook: 978-0-203-86977-2: £21.95/01 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5603-2667-0
2nd Edition
Foundations of Ethical Practice, Research, and Teaching in Psychology and Counseling
Mindfulness and the Therapeutic Relationship
Karen Strohm Kitchener, University of Denver, USA and Sharon K. Anderson, Colorado State University, USA
Edited by Steven F. Hick, Carleton University, Canada and Thomas Bien, in Private Practice, Albuquerque, USA
In Foundations of Ethical Practice, Research, and Teaching in Psychology and Counseling, Kitchener and Anderson lay a conceptual foundation for thinking well about ethical problems. Whereas the first edition focused mainly on ethical reasoning and decision-making, this new edition draws more explicitly on all components of James Rest’s model of moral/ethical behavior, including sensitivity, decision-making, motivation, and the ego strength to follow through on the decision. The book addresses five key principles of ethical decision making and includes updated sections on research, teaching and supervision, and practice. It discusses the relationship of the ethical principles and the model of ethical decision-making to professional ethical codes, while offering discussion questions, case scenarios, and activities to help the reader focus on ethical character and virtue.
Grounded in research, chapters demonstrate how therapists’ own mindfulness practice can help them to listen more attentively and be more fully present. Leading proponents of different treatment approaches – including behavioral, psychodynamic, and family systems perspectives – illustrate a variety of ways that mindfulness principles can complement standard techniques and improve outcomes by strengthening the connection between therapist and client. Guilford Press «Market: Psychotherapy and Counselling / Cognitive Behaviour Therapy September 2010: 229x152: 240pp Pb: 978-1-60918-019-5: £16.95/01
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Routledge «Market: Psychotherapy and Counseling / Clinical Psychology February 2011: 254x178: 416pp Hb: 978-0-415-96541-5: £31.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-89383-8: £31.00/01 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8058-2309-7
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
’Leading scholars from diverse orientations address mindfulness and the therapeutic relationship with regard to issues of definition, measurement, treatment, and training. The result is a significant contribution to the literature – one that will be greatly appreciated by clinical practitioners, researchers, graduate students, and instructors.’ – J. Christopher Muran, Albert Einstein College of Medicine, USA
order now!
Routledge «Market: Psychotherapy and Counseling February 2011: 229x152: 392pp Pb: 978-0-415-87105-1: £21.95/04 eBook: 978-0-203-86976-5: £21.95/01 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5839-1065-8
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
psychotherapy & counselling 203
Mindfulness- and Acceptance-Based Behavioral Therapies in Practice *
The Mindful Way Through Anxiety Break Free from Chronic Worry and Reclaim Your Life Susan M. Orsillo, Suffolk University, Boston, USA and Lizabeth Roemer, University of Massachusetts, Boston, USA
Lizabeth Roemer, University of Massachusetts, Boston, USA and Susan M. Orsillo, Suffolk University, Boston, USA
’By far the most sophisticated and engaging guide I have seen on mindfulness and anxiety. This book is a gem ... It is an excellent resource for anyone who seeks a path to freedom from anxiety and stress.’ – Christopher K. Germer, Author of The Mindful Path to Self-Compassion
Series: Guides to Individualized Evidence-Based Treatment ’This is the shape of things to come – a book that should be read by every clinician and clinical trainee who wants to stay abreast of advances in psychological treatments.’ – David H. Barlow, Boston University and Center for Anxiety and Related Disorders, USA Accessible and practical, this book provides a unified framework for integrating acceptance and mindfulness into cognitive-behavioral practice. The authors interweave elements of acceptance and commitment therapy, mindfulnessbased cognitive therapy, mindfulness-based relapse prevention, and dialectical behavior therapy. They demonstrate how to conduct an assessment, develop a case formulation, and derive a flexible treatment plan for each patient. Vivid case examples and transcripts illustrate the entire process of therapy, showing how treatment can be tailored for different presenting problems and concerns. More than two dozen reproducible handouts and forms are included. Guilford Press «Market: Psychotherapy and Counselling January 2011: 254x178: 244pp Pb: 978-1-60623-999-5: £16.95/01
3rd Edition textbook
Psychoeducational Groups Process and Practice
Anxiety constrains the lives of millions, leaving sufferers exhausted, stressed, and overwhelmed. And the things most people do to try to feel better – avoiding feared situations, pushing worry out of mind – only make the problem worse. Leading psychologists Susan M. Orsillo and Lizabeth Roemer provide a powerful new alternative: they help readers fundamentally change their relationship to anxiety. With clarity and compassion, the authors describe how to gain awareness of anxious feelings without letting them escalate; reap the benefits for emotional and physical well-being; and open life to inspiring new possibilities. Guilford Press «Market: Psychotherapy and Counselling / Self-Help February 2011: 229x152: 308pp Hb: 978-1-60623-982-7: £27.00/01 Pb: 978-1-60623-464-8: £10.99/01
2nd Edition
The Bipolar Disorder Survival Guide What You and Your Family Need to Know David J. Miklowitz, Oxford University, UK ’A practical, straightforward book that will be a great help to those who have bipolar illness, as well as their families. I could not recommend this book more highly.’ – Kay R. Jamison, Author of An Unquiet Mind
Nina W. Brown, Old Dominion University, USA
çè
Routledge «Market: Psychotherapy and Counseling February 2011: 254x178: 280pp Pb: 978-0-415-88239-2: £24.95/01 eBook: 978-0-203-84778-7: £49.95/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-94602-5
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
A bipolar diagnosis can be overwhelming to sufferers and their family members. They need trustworthy information and support for finding the right treatment and coping with the illness’s devastating ups and downs. Over 200,000 readers have already found exactly that in this indispensable guide from a leading expert. Explaining the disorder’s causes, diagnosis, and best current treatments, David J. Miklowitz shows how to plan for and reduce recurrences of mood symptoms, make needed lifestyle changes to stay well, and strengthen relationships strained by the illness. Readers love the user-friendly tone, true-to-life stories, checklists, worksheets, and practical problem-solving advice. Guilford Press «Market: Psychotherapy and Counselling / Self-Help January 2011: 254x178: 354pp Hb: 978-1-60623-983-4: £30.50/01 Pb: 978-1-60623-542-3: £12.99/01 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5723-0712-4
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
This third edition of Psychoeducational Groups remains the only comprehensive, user-friendly guide to planning, implementing, facilitating, and evaluating psychoeducational groups. It presents all the necessary information to prepare leaders of a psychoeducational group through group design and practice. Included are step-bystep guidelines on how to initiate group sessions, construct group objectives, engage group members, monitor progress, and establish evaluation and follow-up guidelines. Emphasis is placed on the personal growth and development of the group leader, with careful consideration given to increasing awareness of personal issues and the potential impact that a leader can have on the group. New to this edition are chapters on cultural and diversity factors; risk management and ethics; groups for relating and communication; and groups in educational, agency, and workplace settings.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
204 psychotherapy & counselling
Tackling Depression at Work *
The Therapeutic Alliance *
A Practical Guide for Employees and Managers
An Evidence-Based Guide to Practice
Kerrie Eyers, Black Dog Institute, Australia and Gordon Parker, University of New South Wales and Black Dog Institute, Australia
Edited by J. Christopher Muran, Adelphi University, New York, USA and Jacques P. Barber, University of Pennsylvania, USA
Figures suggest that more than 10 percent of people in the workforce struggle with depression. Both employees and their managers are looking for the same outcome: recovery and return to best functioning. This book explains the key issues that arise and offers proven strategies employees and managers can take. With insightful advice from workers who’ve learned to manage their disorder on the job, this book offers invaluable support for any worker with depression. It is also an invaluable resource for line managers and human resource managers. Selected Contents: Sizing Things Up: The Prevalence of Workplace Disability. Reading the Game: Well-pitched Intervention and Support. When Someone’s ‘Off Their Game’: Signals that Indicate a Problem. Early Intervention Scores Goals: Managerial Strategies. Carrying an Injury Into the Game: To Disclose or Not to Disclose Routledge «Market: Psychotherapy and Counselling / Self Help December 2010: 198x129: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-60171-9: £44.95/03 Pb: 978-0-415-60172-6: £9.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83108-3: £44.95/14
The Resilient Practitioner * Burnout Prevention and Self-Care Strategies for Counselors, Therapists, Teachers, and Health Professionals Thomas Skovholt, University of Minnesota, USA and Michelle Trotter-Mathison, Boynton Health Center, USA Series: Counseling and Psychotherapy: Investigating Practice from Scientific, Historical, and Cultural Perspectives
This state-of-the-art book presents researchbased practice guidelines that clinicians of any orientation can use to optimize the therapeutic alliance. Leading proponents of the major psychotherapeutic approaches explain just what a good alliance is, how to create it, and how to recognize and repair alliance ruptures. Applications in individual, group, couple, and family therapy are explored; case examples vividly illustrate the concepts and techniques. Guilford Press «Market: Psychotherapy and Counselling October 2010: 229x152: 368pp Hb: 978-1-60623-873-8: £27.00/01
Acceptance and Commitment Therapy Distinctive Features Paul E. Flaxman, City University, UK, J.T. Blackledge, Morehead State University, Kentucky, USA and Frank W. Bond, University of London, UK Series: CBT Distinctive Features ACT focuses on accepting and dealing with uncomfortable thoughts and feelings. Divided into two sections; theory and practice, this book summarises the key features of ACT in 30 concise points and explains how this technique differs from traditional cognitive behaviour therapy. This book provides an excellent guide to ACT. Its straightforward format will appeal to those who are new to the field and provide a handy reference tool for experienced clinicians.
This informative and inspirational volume creates a map for new mental health practitioners – one that provides a positive trinity of validity, clarity, and hope for novices, their teachers, and their supervisors. Selected Contents: Opening Up Your Life to the Excitement of the Helping Professions. The Novice Advantage. The Curse of Ambiguity and Other Ills and What to Do about Them. Who am I Becoming? Novice Critical Incidents. Developing Habits of Culturally Competent Practice. Issues, Concerns and Tips for the Novice Practitioner. Clash of Cultures. The Holding World of Supervisors, Mentors and Peers. Accelerating Development Along the Novice to Expert Path. The Cycle of Caring. Developing Practitioner Resiliency. The Enormous Meaning of the Work Routledge «Market: Psychotherapy and Counseling February 2011: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-98938-1: £56.00/08 Pb: 978-0-415-98939-8: £22.00/04 eBook: 978-0-203-89332-6
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Selected Contents: Part I: The Distinctive Theoretical Features of ACT. Developments within CBT. Relational Frame Theory. Mindfulness and Behaviour Change. ACT and CBT: Assumptive Differences. Part II: The Distinctive Practical Features of ACT. ACT-based Case Conceptualization. Promoting Active Acceptance. Cultivating Mindfulness to Promote Contact with the Present Moment. Clarifying Values. ACT in Groups and Non-clinical Contexts Routledge «Market: Psychotherapy and Counseling November 2010: 186x123: 184pp Hb: 978-0-415-45065-2: £50.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-45066-9: £9.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83468-8: £50.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
2nd Edition
’Drawing together leading contributors to psychotherapy research, training, and practice, Muran and Barber provide an unparalleled opportunity to develop a critically balanced, researchinformed understanding of key factors ... I have no doubt that this book will become an ‘instant classic’ in the field of psychotherapy, one that will continue to shape alliance research and practice in the years to come.’ – Lynne E. Angus, York University, Canada
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
Couples & Family Therapy 205 2nd Edition
Handbook of Clinical Issues in Couple Therapy Edited by Joseph L Wetchler, Purdue University, USA Handbook of Clinical Issues in Couple Therapy is a comprehensive overview of emerging issues that impact couple therapy, all in a single volume. While other guides concentrate more on the approaches themselves, this invaluable source provides the latest research and perspectives every clinician needs when dealing with challenging issues often found in practice. This carefully referenced book is divided into five important areas and discusses in detail several of the most crucial aspects of each major issue. Issues explored include intimate partner violence, posttraumatic stress disorder and its effect on couple relationships, divorce therapy, remarriage and cohabitation issues, cultural issues and couple therapist training. Handbook of Clinical Issues in Couple Therapy is valuable, insightful reading for couple therapists, family therapists, counselors, psychologists, social workers, pastoral counselors, educators, and graduate students.
Restoration Therapy Understanding and Guiding Healing in Marriage and Family Therapy Terry D. Hargrave, Fuller Theological Seminary and Amarillo Family Institute, USA Restoration Therapy introduces the reader to the essential elements of its namesake and from there guides clinicians to a systemic understanding of how certain forces lead to destructive cycles in relationships which perpetuate more and more dysfunction among members. Restoration Therapy will revolutionize the effectiveness of family of origin therapy. Clients and therapists both will understand issues more clearly, experience the impacts that emotion can have on insight, and practice the process so more loving and trustworthy relationships can take hold in the intergenerational family. Routledge «Market: Couples and Family Therapy May 2011: 229x152: 214pp Hb: 978-0-415-87625-4: £52.99/08 Pb: 978-0-415-87626-1: £19.50/04
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Couples and Family Therapy April 2011: 229x152: 368pp Hb: 978-0-415-80475-2: £43.95/08 Pb: 978-0-415-80476-9: £21.95/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83259-2: £43.95/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-7890-3657-5
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
206 psychoanalysis
Between Winnicott and Lacan
Toward Mutual Recognition
A Clinical Engagement
Relational Psychoanalysis and the Christian Narrative
Edited by Lewis A. Kirshner, Boston Psychoanalytic Institute, USA
Marie T. Hoffman, Brookhaven Center for Counseling and Development, Pennsylvania, USA
D.W. Winnicott and Jacques Lacan are arguably two of the most important psychoanalytic theoreticians since Freud, and, somewhat ironically, seemingly two of the most incompatible. But the possibility of a psychoanalytic treatment that can move and develop between the two need not be an illusion. In Between Winnicott and Lacan, Lewis Kirshner and his colleagues attempt to demonstrate how the intellectual contributions of these two figures – such as Winnicott’s self and Lacan’s subject – complement productively despite their apparent contrast. Throughout the book, their major concepts are clarified and differentiated, but always with an eye toward points of intersection and a more effective psychoanalytic practice. Furthermore, these contributors address the Winnicott-Lacan relationship itself and the evolution of their respective theories. The book is peppered with detailed clinical examples of how integrations of their ideas have been utilized with patients directly. Routledge «Market: Psychoanalysis March 2011: 229x152: 160pp Hb: 978-0-415-88373-3: £50.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-88374-0: £18.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-84336-9: £50.00/14
Series: Relational Perspectives Book Series In Toward Mutual Recognition, Marie Hoffman, coming from a Christian perspective, suggests that the current relational turn in psychoanalysis has been influenced by numerous theorists – analysts and philosophers alike – who were themselves shaped by an embedded Christian narrative. As a result, the redemptive concepts of incarnation, crucifixion, and resurrection – central to the tenets of Christianity – can be traced to relational theories, emerging analogously in the transformative process of mutual recognition in the concepts of identification, surrender, and gratitude, a trilogy which she develops as forming the ‘path of recognition.’ Each movement on this path of recognition is given thought-provoking, in-depth attention, utilizing the theoretical perspectives of Benjamin, Hegel, and Ricouer. Routledge «Market: Psychoanalysis January 2011: 229x152: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-99913-7: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-99914-4: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-88127-9: £55.00/14
new in paperback
Awakening the Dreamer
Masculine Shame
Clinical Journeys
From Succubus to the Eternal Feminine
Philip M. Bromberg, New York University, USA
Mary Y. Ayers, in Private Practice, USA
Routledge «Market: Psychoanalysis December 2010: 229x152: 233pp Pb: 978-0-415-88808-0: £24.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
This book explores the idea that the image of the succubus, a demonic female creature said to emasculate men and murder mothers and infants, has been created out of the masculine projection of shame and looks at how the transformation of this image can be traced through Western history, mythology, and Judeo-Christian literature. It places the image of the succubus at the very heart of psychoanalytic thought and as such will be of great interest to all those in the fields of analytical psychotherapy and psychoanalysis. Selected Contents: Part I: The Birth of Civilization and the Evolution of the Succubus Part II: The Image of the Succubus in the Writings of Freud and Jung Part III: From the Succubus as Child Killing Mother to the Restoration of the Eternal Feminine Routledge «Market: Psychoanalysis December 2010: 234x156: 216pp Hb: 978-0-415-39038-5: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-39039-2: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-08613-1: £55.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Philip Bromberg continues his illuminating explorations into dissociation and clinical process. Among our most gifted clinical writers, he is unique in his ability to record peripheral variations in relatedness – those subtle, split-second changes that capture the powerful workings of dissociation and chart the changing self-states that analyst and patient bring to the moment. Laced with his characteristic honesty, humor, and thoughtfulness, these essays elegantly attest to the mind’s reliance on dissociation, in both normal and pathological variants, in the ongoing effort to maintain self-organization. Like Standing in the Spaces before it, Awakening the Dreamer is destined to become a permanent part of the literature on therapeutic process and change.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
psychoanalysis 207
Intersubjective Processes and the Unconscious An Integration of Freudian, Kleinian and Bionian Perspectives Lawrence J. Brown, in Private Practice, USA
Reading Winnicott Edited by Lesley Caldwell, University College London, UK and Angela Joyce, Anna Freud Centre, UK Series: New Library of Psychoanalysis Teaching Series This book offers a selection of papers by the psychoanalyst and paediatrician Donald Winnicott. Taken together, these papers offer a summary of Winnicott’s work over a forty year period and provide an exploration and in-depth discussion of the mental health and well being of mothers, babies, children and families.
Series: The New Library of Psychoanalysis This book looks at how the minds of the therapist and the patient interact with each other in a profound and unconscious way: a concept first described by Freud. Topics of discussion include: • the unconscious dimensions of intersubjective processes • an historical overview of Freudian, Kleinian and Bionian contributions • the central importance of dreaming in intersubjective processes • the clinical implications. This book will be invaluable to all psychoanalysts interested in the topic of intersubjectivity as well as those who want to learn more about the interactional dimensions of Freud, Klein and Bion. Selected Contents: Klein, Bion and Intersubjectivity. An Integrated Model. Intersubjectivity and the Internalized Oedipal Couple. The Evolution of Thinking. Dreaming and Historicization in the Treatment of Traumatized Patients. The Triadic Intersubjective Matrix in Supervision Routledge «Market: Psychoanalysis February 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-60699-8: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-60700-1: £22.99/04
Selected Contents: The Observation of Infants in a Set Situation. Primitive Emotional Development. Hate in The Countertransference. The Theory of the Parent-infant Relationship. The Development of the Capacity for Concern. Communicating and Not Communicating Leading to a Study of Certain Opposites. Fear of Breakdown. A Clinical Study of the Effect of a Failure of the Average. Playing: A Theoretical Statement. The Use of an Object and Relating Through Identifications. Creativity and Its Origins Routledge «Market: Psychoanalysis December 2010: 246x174: 312pp Hb: 978-0-415-41594-1: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-41595-8: £21.95/04
Object Relations in Depression *
Sexual Revolutions *
A Return To Theory
Psychoanalysis, History and the Father
Trevor Lubbe, in Private Practice, South Africa
Edited by Gottfried Heuer, in Private Practice, London, UK This is a major interdisciplinary enquiry into the history, nature and plausibility of the idea of a ‘sexual revolution’, drawing also on the related fields of history, law, criminology, literature, sociology and philosophy. Offering an international range of contributors, areas of discussion include:
This book examines the role of British Object Relations Theory in order to explore our understanding and treatment of depression. It challenges current conceptualizations of depression whilst simultaneously discussing the complex nature of depression, its long lasting and chronic implications and the susceptibility to relapse many may face.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
• a contemporary perspective on sexual revolutions • the broad influence of Otto Gross • the father/son conflict • a Jungian perspective on history. Selected Contents: Part I: History. Lu, Jung and History. Part II: Fathers and Sons. Gilman, Kafka, Sex and the Jews. Dienes, Gross vs. Gross. Part III: Psychoanalysis, Literature and Sociology. Totton, Wilhelm Reich’s Theory of Sexuality. Michaels, Otto Gross’ Influence on German-language Writers. Part IV: Sexual Revolutions. Orbach, Kahr, Sexual Liberation: Where Have We Got to? Samuels, Carnal Critiques Routledge «Market: Psychoanalysis / Analytical Psychology December 2010: 234x156: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-57043-5: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57044-2: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83471-8: £60.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Selected Contents: Depression Today. Freud’s Theory of Depression. Karl Abraham’s Theory of Depression. Melanie Klein’s Theory of Depression. When the Body Gets Depressed: Henri Rey. Winnicott on Depression. A Note on Fairbairn’s Concept of ‘Futility’. Analytic Sub-types of Depression. A Theoretical Contribution to the Problem of Relapse. The Correlation Between Dream Work and the Work of Mourning. Case Study: A Type of Identication Found in Depression – Related Loss. The Depressed Child. Freud’s Depression. Klein’s Depression. Bion’s Depression Routledge «Market: Psychoanalysis December 2010: 234x156: 168pp Hb: 978-0-415-57676-5: £50.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57677-2: £19.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83217-2: £50.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
208 psychoanalysis
From Classical to Contemporary Psychoanalysis A Critique and Integration Morris N. Eagle, Adelphi University, New York, USA Series: Psychological Issues The landscape of psychoanalysis has changed, at times dramatically, in the hundred or so years since Freud first began to think and write about it. Freudian theory and concepts have risen, fallen, and evolved in the hands and minds of analysts the world over, leaving us with a theoretically pluralistic (yet threateningly multifarious) diffusion of psychoanalytic viewpoints. To help make sense of it all, Morris Eagle sets out to critically reevaluate fundamental psychoanalytic concepts of theory and practice. He reintroduces notions of the mind, object relations, psychopathology, and treatment from first Freudian and then contemporary psychoanalytic perspectives. However, there is an underlying emphasis on identification and integration of converging themes, reemphasized and expanded in a final chapter. Clinical vignettes and relevant empirical research are used throughout, thus basic concepts are reexamined in the light of more contemporary developments. Routledge «Market: Psychoanalysis March 2011: 229x152: 312pp Hb: 978-0-415-87161-7: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-87162-4: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-86855-3: £60.00/14
Memory, Myth, and Seduction Unconscious Fantasy and the Interpretive Process Jean-Georges Schimek Edited by Deborah L. Browning, New York University, USA Series: Psychological Issues A practicing psychoanalyst and Freud scholar, Jean-Georges Schimek sought to clarify Freud’s concepts and theories and disentangle complexities borne of inconsistencies in his assumptions and expositions. This collection of published and unpublished papers, skillfully arranged and edited by Deborah Browning, reveals the development and evolution of Schimek’s thinking on unconscious fantasy and the interpretive process, derived from a close reading of Freud as well as contemporary psychoanalysis. Divided thematically, the first section concerns fantasy, interpretation, and the coconstruction of meaning in the therapeutic setting. A scholarly history and reappraisal of Freud’s seduction theory comprises the second section, and the third, more theoretical section provides a foundation for understanding many current discussions of unconscious fantasy, dreaming, memory, consciousness, affect, self-reflection, mentalization, and implicit relational knowing. Routledge «Market: Psychoanalysis February 2011: 229x152: 248pp Hb: 978-0-415-87393-2: £24.99/08 eBook: 978-0-203-86414-2: £24.99/14
The New Dictionary of Kleinian Thought Edited by Elisabeth Bott Spillius, British Psychoanalytical Society, UK, Jane E. Milton, The Melanie Klein Trust, UK, Penelope Garvey, in Private Practice, UK, Cyril Coure, in Private Practice, UK and Deborah Steiner, Tavistock Clinic, UK T his book offers a comprehensive and accessible exposition of Kleinian ideas, bringing together both Kleinian and post-Kleinian concepts. The main entries focus on the basic Kleinian concepts including, projective identification, child analysis and the superego, whilst the general entries deal with important subsidiary concepts and the main post-Kleinian writers such as Hannah Segal, Wilfred Bion and Herbert Rosenfeld. As such this book will be an essential reference work for clinicians, psychologists, students and anyone with an interest in Kleinian thought.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Selected Contents: Preface. Acknowledgements. Main Entries. General Entries. Bibliography Routledge «Market: Psychoanalysis March 2011: 234x156: 544pp Hb: 978-0-415-59258-1: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59259-8: £24.95/04
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
jung/analytical psychology 209
Jung, Film, Neo-Realism and Italian National Identity Donatella Spinelli Coleman, De Montfort University, UK Italian neo-realism has inspired film audiences and fascinated critics and film scholars for decades. This book offers an original analysis of the movement and its defining films from the perspective of the cultural unconscious. Combining a Jungian analytical approach with traditional theorisations of film and national identity, this book re-interprets the familiar images of well-known masterpieces and introduces some less renowned yet equally significant films.
çè
Selected Contents: Part I: Primo Tempo. The Uninvited Guest: Film, Psychoanalysis and the Jungian Absence. Archetype and Complex. Jung, Film and Nation. Part II: Intervallo. Italian Neo-Realism and the Unmitigated Darkness of Historical Truth. Part III: Secondo Tempo. 1942–1945: War and Archetypes. 1942–1943: Leaving the Father’s House. 1949–1952: Redeemers, Tricksters and the Wisdom of the Unconscious Routledge «Market: Jung and Analytical Psychology / Film Studies February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-55513-5: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-55514-2: £19.99/04
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
House: The Wounded Healer on Television * Jungian and Post-Jungian Reflections Edited by Luke Hockley, University of Bedfordshire, UK and Leslie Gardner, Manchester Metropolitan University, UK This book employs a Jungian perspective to examine the psychological construction of the series, House MD, and its namesake, Dr Gregory House. Divided into three parts; Diagnosing House, Consulting House and Dissecting House, topics of discussion include: • themes, motifs and tropes throughout the series • narrative, character and visual structure. • the combination of performative effects, text and images of the doctor and his team Selected Contents: Hockley, Doctoring Individuation. Izod, The Physician’s Melancholia. Hauke, Playing House. Waddell, House’s Caduceus Crutch. Huskinson, Anatomy of a Genius. Cotter, Limping the Way to Wholeness. Rowland, House not Ho(l)mes. Gardner, Gestures of Excess. Beebe, Not as a Stranger. Miller, I Feel Like a Failure: In-house Feminism Routledge «Market: Jung and Analytical Psychology / Film Studies December 2010: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-47912-7: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-47913-4: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-84033-7: £60.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Filming the Nation *
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
210 child & adolescent mental health
Advanced Play Therapy
Child-Centered Play Therapy *
The Complete Picture
Risë VanFleet, Family Enhancement and Play Therapy Center, Pennsylvania, USA, Andrea E. Sywulak and Cynthia Caparosa Sniscak, both in Private Practice, Pennsylvania, USA
Dee Ray, University of North Texas, USA This text presents students and practitioners of play therapy with a resource that addresses topics beyond the training level. It provides advanced knowledge on the three main areas of play, child development, and play therapy and integrates them to help the play therapist gain a holistic understanding of how play therapy works. The author also presents original operational functions for play therapy tasks that she has developed and refined during her years of experience to provide play therapists with step-bystep methods to use in their own practices. Special topics covered include aggression in and out of the playroom, group play therapy, play therapy in schools and community settings, and research in play therapy. An accompanying CD includes a Child-Centered Play Therapy Treatment Manual and materials for use in supervision, self-reporting, and other tools the advanced play therapy student would find of use. Routledge «Market: Child and Adolescent Mental Health / Creative Arts Therapies March 2011: 229x152: 352pp Hb: 978-0-415-88604-8: £27.95/01 eBook: 978-0-203-83726-9: £27.95/01
Highly practical, instructive, and authoritative, this book vividly describes how to conduct child-centered play therapy. The authors are master clinicians who explain core therapeutic principles and techniques, using rich case material to illustrate treatment of a wide range of difficulties. The focus is on nondirective interventions that allow children to freely express their feelings and take the lead in solving their own problems. Guilford Press «Market: Child and Adolescent Mental Health / Creative Arts Therapies October 2010: 229x152: 238pp Hb: 978-1-60623-902-5: £24.00/01
Engaging Boys in Treatment
Academic Skills Problems * Direct Assessment and Intervention Edward S. Shapiro, Lehigh University, Pennsylvania, USA Series: Guilford School Practitioner This bestselling text provides a comprehensive framework for the direct assessment of academic skills. Presented is a readily applicable, four-step approach for working with students experiencing a range of difficulties with reading, spelling, written language, or maths. School-based practitioners are guided sequentially through assessment of the instructional environment, assessment of instructional placement, instructional modification, and progress monitoring. Extensively rewritten to reflect current findings and best practices, this edition includes information on useful Internet resources, updated sample forms and charts, and all-new case illustrations. Guilford Press «Market: Child and Adolescent Mental Health December 2010: 229x152: 448pp Hb: 978-1-60623-960-5: £37.00/01 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5723-0977-7
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Creative Approaches to Formulating, Initiating, and Sustaining the Therapy Process Edited by Craig Haen, Adolescent Services for Kids in Crisis, Greenwich, USA Series: The Routledge Series on Counseling and Psychotherapy with Boys and Men This edited book is the first of its kind to focus on creative approaches to the treatment of boys, providing a valuable resource for both students and professionals seeking new and effective strategies for reaching their young male clients. Chapters discuss the theory behind and implementation of various creative approaches to therapy with boys, such as play therapy, including sports, movement, and gross-motor activity; animal-assisted therapy; the use of computers and digital animation; the use of superheroes in role play, metaphor, and play therapy; and art therapy. Attention is also given to methods for working with five special populations: angry and aggressive boys; young boys with ADHD; boys with sexual behavior difficulties; gender variant and sexual minority boys; and African American boys with non-resident or absent fathers. Routledge «Market: Child and Adolescent Mental Health April 2011: 229x152: 352pp Hb: 978-0-415-87405-2: £56.00/08 Pb: 978-0-415-87406-9: £21.95/04 eBook: 978-0-203-86357-2: £56.00/01
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
4th Edition
order now!
’Finally, a book that teaches and illustrates the essential ‘how-to’ details of child-centered play therapy (CCPT)! ... This book is a ‘must’ for teaching CCPT and should be on the shelves of all therapists interested in using play to help children heal.’ – Heidi Gerard Kaduson, The Play Therapy Training Institute, Inc., New Jersey, USA
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
child & adolescent mental health 211
Research-Based Strategies That Work
Kathleen Lynne Lane, Vanderbilt University, USA Holly Mariah Menzies, California State University, USA, Allison L. Bruhn and Mary Crnobori, both at Vanderbilt University, USA Series: What Works for Special-Needs Learners This book provides tested, easy-toimplement strategies for preventing problem behavior in the classroom and responding effectively when it does occur. Chapters describe specific steps that K-12 teachers and other school-based professionals can take to develop effective classroom rules and routines; plan suitably challenging instruction; and promote student engagement and motivation. Presenting a continuum of strategies from prevention to more intensive behavior supports, the book offers clear-cut instructions for implementing behavioral contracts, self-monitoring, and functional assessmentbased interventions. Special features include more than a dozen reproducible checklists, self-assessment tools, and planning forms; the large-size format facilitates photocopying. Guilford Press «Market: Child and Adolescent Mental Health / School Psychology November 2010: : 253pp Pb: 978-1-60623-951-3: £24.00/01
2nd Edition
Response to Intervention * Principles and Strategies for Effective Practice Rachel Brown-Chidsey and Mark W. Steege, both at the University of Southern Maine, USA Series: Practical Intervention in the Schools ’... This accessible book is a ‘must’ for professional development with school psychologists and school- and district-based leadership teams. The inclusion of systems-level guidance in the second edition addresses an essential aspect of implementation.’ – Jennifer Knutson, Anchorage School District, Alaska, USA This bestselling work provides practitioners with a complete guide to implementing response to intervention (RTI) in schools. The authors are leading experts who explain the main components of RTI – high-quality instruction, frequent assessment, and databased decision making – and show how to use it to foster positive academic and behavioral outcomes for all students. Implementation procedures are described in step-by-step detail. In a large-size format with lay-flat binding to facilitate photocopying, the book includes reproducible planning and implementation worksheets.
çè
Guilford Press «Market: Child and Adolescent Mental Health / School Psychology October 2010: : 208pp Pb: 978-1-60623-923-0: £24.00/01 Prev. Ed: 978-1-59389-215-3
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Serving the Gifted Evidence-Based Clinical and Psycho-Educational Practice Steven I. Pfeiffer, Florida State University, USA Series: School-Based Practice in Action Designed specifically for school psychologists and school counselors, this volume is intended to serve as a practical and easy-to-use resource for working with gifted students, their teachers, and their parents and families. It provides timely, practical, evidence-based techniques and guidelines to help these practitioners better help an underserved group. The book will be written in a user-friendly style that will make this a quick, simple, and easy reference. Topics to be covered include identification and assessment of gifted students; important information for understanding the needs of the gifted; counseling and psychotherapy strategies; career counseling for gifted and talented students, methods for working with the families of the gifted; and legally-correct and ethically-smart counseling techniques. An accompanying CD will contain valuable resources such as counseling forms, monitoring tools, and parent handouts. Routledge «Market: Child and Adolescent Mental Health / School Psychology March 2011: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-99749-2: £53.00/08 Pb: 978-0-415-99750-8: £22.00/04 eBook: 978-0-203-88358-7: £53.00/01
2nd Edition
Sandtray Therapy A Practical Manual Linda Homeyer, Texas State University, USA and Daniel Sweeney, George Fox University, USA This manual is intended for play therapists, counselors, and other mental health practitioners seeking to incorporate sandtray work into their clinical repertoire. Chapters cover the history and rationale for sandtray therapy, the materials needed for successful sessions, and how to conduct and process a therapy session. New to this edition is a discussion of the incorporation of verbal techniques, group sandtray therapy, working with couples and families, assessment in sandtray, and a review of the relevant research support. Case vignettes, sample dialogues, and photos showing examples of different sandtray layouts, figures, and tools are also provided. Routledge «Market: Child and Adolescent Mental Health / Creative Arts Therapies January 2011: 279x216: 192pp Pb: 978-0-415-88334-4: £16.95/01 eBook: 978-0-203-84489-2: £33.95/01
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Managing Challenging Behaviors in Schools *
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
212 child & adolescent mental health
Treating Depressed and Suicidal Adolescents *
Comprehensive Children’s Mental Health Services in Schools and Communities
A Clinician’s Guide David A. Brent, Kimberly D. Poling and Tina R. Goldstein, all at the Western Psychiatric Institute and Clinic, University of Pittsburgh Medical Center, USA
Rick Jay Short, Middle Tenessee University, USA and Robyn S. Hess, University of Northern Colorado, USA
’Brent and his colleagues have produced a superbly written book that provides state-of-the-art information about evidence-based assessment and treatment of adolescent depression and suicidality. The book is infused with clinical wisdom that will fully prepare the reader for treating these challenging conditions. This exceptional book is a ‘must read.’ – Matthew K. Nock, Harvard University, USA Grounded in decades of research and the clinical care of thousands of depressed and suicidal teens, this highly accessible book will enhance the skills of any therapist who works with this challenging population. The authors describe the nuts and bolts of assessing clients and crafting individualized treatment plans that combine cognitive and behavioral techniques, emotion regulation interventions, family involvement, and antidepressant medication.
2nd Edition
Child Anxiety Disorders A Guide to Research and Treatment Deborah C. Beidel, University of Central Florida, USA and Candice A. Alfano, George Washington University, USA Childhood anxiety disorders represent one of the most common psychological disorders found among the general population. They can be serious, distressful, and functionally impairing, so much so that there has been an explosion of interest in their treatment, primarily from pharmacological and cognitivebehavioral perspectives. Addressing these perspectives is the second edition of Child Anxiety Disorders, by Drs. Beidel and Alfano. They pay close attention to new pharmacological and psychological interventions as well as multi-center trials that compare single and combined treatment modalities. Additionally, they include new case studies, sections on stability of childhood fears and the longitudinal course of anxiety disorders, and a new chapter on sleep and anxiety disorders. Routledge «Market: Child and Adolescent Mental Health February 2011: 229x152: 464pp Hb: 978-0-415-87373-4: £27.95/08 eBook: 978-0-203-86425-8: £27.75/01 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-94797-8
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
In this text, the authors propose a public health model for comprehensive children’s mental health services that encompasses, rather than replaces, the traditional model in school psychology. The background and theoretical perspective for this public health model is discussed as an important way to solve problems and accomplish goals in schools, after which the authors outline and develop a clear, practical procedure for implementing and evaluating programs based on public health ideas. This text will also address new roles for school psychologists that focus on prevention and promotion. An accompanying CD will contain sample activities, forms, handouts, and other materials. Selected Contents: I. Overview and Introduction. II. Basic Principles. III. Guidelines for Service. IV. Some Examples: Evidence-Based Comprehensive Mental Health Programs. V. Concluding Comments. VI. Practitioner Resources Routledge «Market: Child and Adolescent Mental Health / School Psychology March 2011: 229x152: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-80448-6: £53.00/08 Pb: 978-0-415-80449-3: £19.95/04 eBook: 978-0-203-87453-0: £53.00/01
4th Edition
Hypnosis and Hypnotherapy with Children Daniel P. Kohen, Univeristy of Minnesota, USA and Karen Olness, Case Western Reserve University, USA Updated and revised in response to developments in the field, this fourth edition of Hypnosis and Hypnotherapy with Children describes the research and clinical historical underpinnings of hypnosis and hypnotherapy with children and adolescents, and presents an up-to-date compendium of the pertinent world literature regarding this topic. The authors focus on the wide variety and scope of applications for hypnotherapy; including an integrated description of both clinical and evidence-based research as it relates to understanding approaches to various clinical situations, case studies of practical aspects, and how-to elements of teaching hypnotherapeutic skills to clients. Routledge «Market: Child and Adolescent Mental Health / Hypnosis May 2011: 229x152: 544pp Hb: 978-0-415-87627-8: £33.50/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83013-0: £33.50/01
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Guilford Press «Market: Child and Adolescent Mental Health December 2010: 229x152: 264pp Hb: 978-1-60623-957-5: £24.00/01
Series: School-Based Practice in Action
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
creative arts therapies 213
Navigating Art Therapy * A Therapist’s Companion Edited by Chris Wood, Art Therapy Northern Programme, UK Art therapy is used in an increasing range of settings and is influenced by a range of disciplines, including psychotherapy, social psychiatry, social work and education. Navigating Art Therapy is an essential companion for both seasoned art therapists and those new to the field as it offers a comprehensive guide to key terms and concepts. With contributions from art therapists around the world, entries cover: • forms of interpretation • processes of adaptation • history of art therapy • the inspiration provided by artworks and popular culture. This book is an ideal source of reference as the concise, crossreferenced entries enable easy navigation through ideas and terms integral to the discipline. As such, it is invaluable for anyone working in the art therapy field.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
The Art Of Art Therapy What Every Art Therapist Needs to Know Judith A. Rubin, University of Pittsburgh, USA First published in 1984, The Art of Art Therapy was written primarily to help art therapists first define and then refine a way of thinking about their work. This new edition contains thoroughly revised material that reflects the significant expansion of the field of art therapy in the period since the book was first written. Specifically, this second edition invites the reader to consider closely the main elements of the discipline embodied in its name: the Art Part and the Therapy Part. Chapters dealing with each of these topics comprise the first two sections of the book. The third section, The Interface, contains chapters dealing with putting the two together in an integrated way, i.e. Doing Art Therapy (step by step) and doing it Artistically. Included with this edition is a DVD containing chapter-related video content. Selected Contents: Part I: The Art Part. Part II: The Therapy Part. Part III: The Interface. Part IV: Applications. Part V: Related Service Routledge «Market: Creative Arts Therapies February 2011: 254x178: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-96094-6: £27.99/08 eBook: 978-0-203-89384-5: £27.99/01 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8763-0371- 9
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Creative Arts Therapies December 2010: 234x156: 336pp Hb: 978-0-415-22318-8: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-22319-5: £24.99/04
2nd Edition
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
nursing
TOP TEN BESTSELLERS
214 nursing
1.
6. 3rd Edition
2nd Edition
From Birth to Five Years
Managing in Health and Social Care
Children’s Developmental Progress Mary D. Sheridan, Ajay Sharma and Helen Cockerill
Vivien Martin, Julie Charlesworth, and Euan Henderson
2007: 246x174: 112pp Pb: 978-0-415-42365-6: £10.99/04
2.
2010: 246x174: 384pp Pb: 978-0-415-49389-5: £24.99/04
7. Evidence-based Care for Normal Labour and Birth
Working with Substance Misusers
A Guide for Midwives
A Guide to Theory and Practice
Denis Walsh
Edited by Trudi Petersen and Andrew McBride
2007: 246x174: 200pp Pb: 978-0-415-41891-1: £22.99/04
2002: 246x174: 392pp Pb: 978-0-415-23568-6: £25.99/04
3.
8. Becoming a Midwife
World Religions for Healthcare Professionals
Edited by Rosemary Mander and Valerie Fleming 2009: 216x138: 248pp Pb: 978-0-415-46438-3: £19.99/04
4.
Edited by Siroj Sorajjakool, Mark Carr and Julius Nam 2009: 235x156: 192pp Pb: 978-0-7890-3813-5: £20.99/04
9. Managing Long-term Conditions and Chronic Illness in Primary Care
2nd Edition
Neonatal Intensive Care Nursing Edited by Glenys Boxwell 2010: 246x174: 542pp Pb: 978-0-415-47756-7: £29.99/04
A Guide to Good Practice Judith Carrier 2009: 246x174: 224pp Pb: 978-0-415-45088-1: £21.99/04
5.
10. 2nd Edition
2nd Edition
Depression in New Mothers
Intensive Care Nursing
Causes, Consequences, and Treatment Alternatives
A Framework for Practice
Kathleen A. Kendall-Tackett
2006: 246x174: 608pp Pb: 978-0-415-37323-4: £30.99/04
2009: 246x174: 224pp Pb: 978-0-415-77839-8: £22.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Philip Woodrow and Jane Roe
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
nursing 215
Child-Centred Pharmacology
Home Birth *
An Introduction for Nurses and Allied Health Professionals
The Politics of Difficult Choices
Barbara Novak, City University, UK
Mary Nolan, University of Worcester, UK
This book focuses on the aspects of pharmacology that are crucial for truly child-centred prescribing practice and discusses the best choice of therapeutic interventions available when caring for children. Selected Contents: 1. Perspectives in Child-Centred Pharmacology 2. Pharmacogenetic Considerations in Determining the Best Therapeutic Interventions 3. Pharmacotherapeutics in Children with Respiratory Problems 4. Pharmacotherapeutics in Children with Infection 5. Pharmacotherapeutics of Antipyretics and Anti-Inflammatory Drugs 6. Pharmacotherapeutics in Children with Endocrine and Metabolic Problems 7. Safe Prescribing for Children Requiring Surgery 8. Health Promoting Pharmacotherapeutics 9. Adverse Responses to Drugs 10. Child-Centred Formulae and their Use in Practice 11. Medication Error 12. Medicine Management and Administration 13. Clinical Trials 14. Holistic Child Assessment Routledge «Market: Nursing / Health Studies March 2011: 246x174: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-54899-1: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-54900-4: £24.99/04
Evidence-based Care for Breastfeeding Mothers A Guide for Midwives Maria Pollard, University of the West of Scotland, UK
This is a book for midwives and health professionals but it is one which starts from women’s stories and their points of view. Pointers to best practice are presented alongside the narratives, making this a practical read for those concerned with making home birth an option for women. Selected Contents: Introduction 1. Policy – Does it Mean What it Says? 2. Choosing Home Birth Against Medical Advice 3. Fear and Risk 4. Choice, Bullying and Coercion 5. Communication and Language 6. Avoidance, Subversion and Confrontation 7. Stress in Pregnancy and Birth 8. Men’s Experience of Home Birth Against Medical Advice 9. Free Birth: The End of the Choice Continuum 10. Advocacy, Empathy and Autonomy 11. The Dialectic between Possibilities and Limits Routledge «Market: Midwifery / Childbirth November 2010: 234x156: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-55754-2: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-55755-9: £20.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83667-5: £70.00/14
Supporting Women to Give Birth at Home A Practical Guide for Midwives Edited by Mary Steen, University of Chester, UK This practical text discusses the challenges and issues that midwives encounter when preparing for and attending a home birth.
Based on the UNICEF UK Baby Friendly best practice standards, this text addresses all 18 outcomes to ensure that students are equipped with the essential knowledge and skills to effectively promote and support breastfeeding mothers.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Routledge «Market: Midwifery February 2011: 246x174: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-56029-0: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56030-6: £20.99/04
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Selected Contents: Introduction 1. Breastfeeding and Public Health 2. Anatomy and Physiology of Lactation 3. Essential Skills for Practice 4. Good Practice to Promote, Initiate and Support Breastfeeding 5. Management of Common Problems 6. Supporting Mothers with Special Needs 7. Babies with Special Needs 8. Alternative Methods of Infant Feeding when Breastfeeding is not Possible 9. Introducing Solid Foods 10. Ongoing Support for Breastfeeding Mothers Routledge «Market: Midwifery January 2011: 246x174: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-49906-4: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-49907-1: £19.99/04
Selected Contents: Part 1. Introduction to Birth 1. Birth Settings, Women’s Choices and Implications for Midwifery Practice Part 2. Preparation for Home Birth 2. The Option of Home Birth 3. Evidence and Guidelines to Support Home Birth 4. Supporting Home Birth Part 3. Attending Home Birth 5. Caring for Women During a Home Birth 6. Home Birth Pain Management Options 7. Case Studies 8. Conclusions and Implications for Midwifery Practice
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
216 nursing 2nd Edition textbook
2nd Edition
Evidence-based Care for Normal Labour and Birth
The Biological Basis of Mental Health Nursing
Skills and Best Practice for Midwives
William T. Blows, City University, UK Written by an experienced nurse lecturer who also trained as a mental health nurse, this book explores the underlying biology associated with the pathology of mental health disorders and the related nervous system. Fully revised for this second edition, the text includes three new chapters on brain development, pharmacology and the biology of learning, developmental and behavioural disorders.
Denis Walsh, University of Central Lancashire, UK
Routledge «Market: Midwifery March 2011: 246x174: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-57731-1: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57732-8: £24.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-41891-1
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Selected Contents: 1. Introduction to the Brain 2. Brain Development 3. Neural Communication 4. Neurotransmitters and Receptors 5. Hormones and Behaviour 6. Genetic Disorders affecting Mental Health 7. Pharmacology 8. Drug Abuse 9. Anxiety, Fear and Emotions 10. Schizophrenia 11. Depression 12. Epilepsy 13. Subcortical Degenerative Diseases of the Brain 14. The Ageing Brain and Dementia 15. Learning, Behavioural and Developmental Disorders Routledge «Market: Nursing / Mental Health December 2010: 246x174: 392pp Hb: 978-0-415-57097-8: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57098-5: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83388-9: £85.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-24854-9
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
This is a helpful and practical guide that explores the latest research and evidence, drawing out what is known about the effectiveness of care in normal labour and birth. It highlights where the evidence is compelling and discusses its application where women question its relevance to them, and where the practitioner’s expertise leads them to challenge it. Written by an experienced practising midwife, the book is structured in an accessible way so that so that each chapter gives background and context for the particular clinical topic, and provides a discussion of the research to date. This essential text contains up-to-date and relevant information to help all student and practising midwives keep abreast of the evidence surrounding normal birth and ensure their practice takes full advantage of it.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
medical sociology & health studies 217
Evidence-based Parenting
Generational Intelligence
Kirsten Asmussen
Age, Identity and the Future of Gerontology This evidence-based book provides a comprehensive description of what parenting support works and how, with clear examples of how this knowledge can inform frontline work with parents.
Selected Contents: 1. The Need for Evidence-Based Parenting Support 2. Understanding the Evidence Base 3. Evidence-Based Theories of Child Development 4. Evidence-Based Therapies Used in Parenting Work 5. The Role of the Practitioner in Providing Evidence-Based Parenting Support 6. Planning and Evaluating Evidence-Based Parenting Support 7. Evidence-Based Parenting Support at the Community Level 8. Moving Forward Routledge «Market: Health / Early Years February 2011: 246x174: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-60992-0: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-60993-7: £21.99/04
Simon Biggs, King’s College London, UK and Ariela Lowenstein, Haifa University, Israel This book examines intergenerational relations, presenting the innovative notion of ‘Generational Intelligence’. It develops a pathway for reflecting on generational issues and increasing awareness about one’s position in the life course, that of other generations, and the influence of familial, social and historical factors in the situations one encounters. Selected Contents: Part 1. Generational Issues Part 2. Generational Intelligence (GI) Part 3. Practical Problems Part 4. Future Directions Routledge «Market: Health / Social Work February 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-54654-6: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-54655-3: £21.99/04
3rd Edition textbook
From Birth to Six Years Mary D. Sheridan, Justine Howard and Dawn Alderson, both at Swansea University, UK Based on the pioneering work of Mary D. Sheridan, Play in Early Childhood is a classic introductory text to play and development – key topics for all who work with young children. Thoroughly updated for a contemporary audience, it explains how children’s play develops and how they develop as they play. Selected Contents: Introduction 1. Theorising about Play 2. Observing the Development of Children’s Play 3. Variation in Children’s Play 4. Providing for Play
çè
Routledge «Market: Nursing / Early Years / Psychology December 2010: 246x174: 104pp Hb: 978-0-415-57789-2: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57790-8: £14.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83260-8: £70.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-18693-3
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Practice-based Evidence for Healthcare * Clinical Mindlines John Gabbay and Andrée le May, both at University of Southampton, UK The evidence-based practice movement hasn’t been entirely successful. It rests on an idealised model of how clinicians ought to use evidence without understanding why they so often don’t. This book appraises the EBP movement and introduces a concept – ‘mindlines’ – which illustrates how clinicians actually do develop and use clinical knowledge. Selected Contents: 1. Introduction: Evidence in Practice 2. From Formal Knowledge to Guided Complexity 3. Clinical Thinking and Knowledge in Practice 4. Growing Mindlines: Laying the Foundations 5. Growing Mindlines: Cultivating Contextual Adroitness 6. The Place of Storytelling in Knowledge Sharing 7. A Community of Clinical Practice? 8. Co-Constructing Collective Mindlines 9. Co-Constructing Clinical Reality 10. Conclusions and Implications Routledge «Market: Nursing / Medicine November 2010: 234x156: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-48668-2: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-48669-9: £23.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83997-3: £75.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Play in Early Childhood
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
218 medical sociology & health studies
Racial Disparity in Mental Health Services
Routledge Handbook of Global Public Health *
Why Race Still Matters
Edited by Richard Parker, Columbia University, USA and Marni Sommer
Edited by Larry E. Davis, University of Pittsburgh, USA
The Routledge Handbook of Global Public Health addresses emerging issues and conceptualizations in global health, expanding upon the critical priorities in this rapidly evolving field. It provides an authoritative overview for students, practitioners, researchers, and policy makers concerned with public health around the globe.
This book comprehensively examines disparities in mental health provision across a wide spectrum of areas, including racial identity, education and socioeconomic conditions. This book was published as a special issue of Social Work in Public Health.
Selected Contents: Part 1. The Transition from International Health to Global Health Part 2. Structural Inequalities and Global Public Health Part 3. Ecological Transformation and Environmental Health in the Global System Part 4. Population and Reproductive Health Part 5. Conflict, Violence and Emergencies in Global Public Health Part 6. Global Public Health Policy and Practice Part 7. Global Public Health and Development Part 8. Global Mental Health Part 9. Global Access to Essential Medicines Part 10. Health Systems, Health Capacity, and the Politics of Global Public Health Routledge «Market: Public Health December 2010: 246x174: 504pp Hb: 978-0-415-77848-0: £110.00/13 eBook: 978-0-203-83272-1: £125.00/14
Routledge «Market: Social Policy / Cross-Cultural Psychiatry / Mental Health Nursing May 2011: 246x174: 304pp Hb: 978-0-7890-3820-3: £80.00/08 Pb: 978-0-7890-3821-0: £27.00/01
Alcohol, Tobacco and Obesity
Population Mental Health *
Women, Children, and Addiction
Morality, Mortality and the New Public Health
Evidence, Policy, and Public Health Practice
Edited by Kirsten Bell and Amy Salmon, both at University of British Columbia, Canada and Darlene McNaughton, James Cook University, Australia
Neal Cohen, Hunter College, CUNY, USA and Sandro Galea, University of Michigan, USA
Edited by Loretta P. Finnegan, Thomas Jefferson University, USA and Stephen R. Kandall, Albert Einstein College of Medicine, USA
Series: Routledge Studies in Public Health
This cutting edge collection of essays explores recent developments in alcohol, tobacco and obesity in comparative, international and interdisciplinary perspective.
This book examines the evidence-base for incorporating mental health into the public health agenda by linking the research on populationbased mental health with public health policy and practice, and sets out an innovative model for integrated care.
Routledge
Routledge
«Market: Public Health / Sociology March 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-59017-4: £75.00/08
«Market: Public Health / Social Work January 2011: 234x156: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-77921-0: £75.00/03
Series: Routledge Studies in Public Health
This book provides comprehensive and up-to-date information, ranging from a historical perspective to current theories and practices related to affected women and their children. This book was published as a special issue in the Journal of Addictive Diseases. Routledge «Market: Drug Addiction / Women’s Studies / HIV November 2010: 276x219: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-60103-0: £80.00/08
Recovery from Addiction in Communal Living Settings The Oxford House Model Edited by Leonard A. Jason and Joseph R. Ferrari, both at DePaul University, USA This book raises treatment providers’ awareness of the social environments where clients live after residential treatment or while attending outpatient programs. This book was published as a special issue in the Journal of Groups in Addiction and Recovery. Routledge
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
«Market: Drug Addiction / Managed Care / Evidence-based Mental Health February 2011: 246x174: 160pp Hb: 978-0-415-61010-0: £80.00/08
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
alternative medicine 219 2nd Edition
Herbal Medicines
Herbal and Traditional Medicine
Development and Validation of Plant-derived Medicines for Human Health
Biomolecular and Clinical Aspects
Edited by Giacinto Bagetta, University of Calabria, Italy, Marco Cosentino, University of Insubria, Italy, Marie Tiziana Corasaniti, University Magna Graecia of Catanzaro, Italy and Shinobu Sakurada, Tohoku Pharmaceutical University, Japan
Edited by Iris F.F. Benzie, The Hong Kong Polytechnic University, China Series: Oxidative Stress and Disease Responding to the increased popularity of herbal medicines and other forms of complementary or alternative medicine in countries around the world, this reference reviews and evaluates various safety, toxicity, and qualitycontrol issues related to the use of traditional and herbal products for health maintenance and disease prevention and treatment. With over 3,550 current references, the book highlights the role of herbal medicine in national health care while providing case studies of widely used herbal remedies and their effects on human health and wellness. It alse explores the need for the design and performance of methodologically sound clinical trials for the plethora of herbal medicines. CRC Press
Series: Clinical Pharmacognosy While discussion concerning the validity of the plant approach to nutrition and disease treatment continues, the explosion of natural product use has generated concern regarding their effectiveness and possible danger. Using a rational, sequential approach, this book explores the development of efficacious medicinal herbal products. Expert contributors from the fields of natural products research and drug discovery bring awareness to the many problems facing the development of such products, such as quality control, pharmacokinetic and pharmacodynamic issues. The text addresses botanical, phytochemical, PD-PK, as well as analytical and clinical issues. CRC Press
«Market: Medicine March 2011: 254x178: 512pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0713-2: £121.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0716-3: £121.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8247-5208-8
«Market: General Chemistry March 2011: 235x156: 300pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3768-9: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3769-6: £89.00/17
social work & social policy 2nd Edition
Cognitive-Behavioural Therapy * Research and Practice in Health and Social Care Brian Sheldon, Formerly Centre for Evidence-Based Social Services, Peninsula Medical School, UK Cognitive-Behavioural Therapy is written in a lively and accessible style and is designed to give readers a thorough grounding in cognitive-behavioural methods and their application. It is essential reading for students and professionals in social work, nursing and psychotherapy.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Selected Contents: 1. Origins and Development of Cognitive-Behavioural Therapy 2. Research on the Effectiveness of Cognitive-Behavioural Therapy 3. Philosophical Implications 4. Learning Theory and Research 5. Emotional Reactions 6. Assessment, Monitoring and Evaluation 7. Stimulus-Control Techniques 8. Response-Control Techniques 9. Ethical Considerations Routledge «Market: Nursing / Social Work / Psychology December 2010: 246x174: 344pp Hb: 978-0-415-56436-6: £85.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56435-9: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83371-1: £85.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-09374-3
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
220 social work & social policy
Building Relationships and Communicating with Young Children * A Practical Guide for Social Workers Karen Winter, Queen’s University Belfast, UK This book provides a timely, invaluable resource and practical guide for social work students specialising in family and child care and for practitioners who have young children on their caseloads. Packed with real life examples of in-depth interviews conducted with young children known to social services, it outlines what can be done to improve practice in this challenging and demanding area. Selected Contents: Introduction 1. Setting the Scene 2. The Importance and Value of Relationships 3. Barriers to Building Relationships 4. A Child Rights-Based Approach 5. Communicating with Young Children: Stages and Skills 6. Communicating with Young Children: Methods 7. Case Studies 8. Summary and Ways Forward Routledge «Market: Social Work / Early Years December 2010: 246x174: 184pp Hb: 978-0-415-56267-6: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56268-3: £19.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83672-9: £70.00/14
Social Work with Children and Families * Developing Advanced Practice Penelope Welbourne, University of Plymouth, UK Series: Post-qualifying Social Work There is an increasing emphasis on post-qualifying training for social workers, especially in the complex and demanding area of working with children and families. This essential textbook is especially designed for practitioners studying at this level. Selected Contents: 1. Introduction 2. Social Work Values and Ethics 3. Accountability and Post-Qualifying Professional Development 4. Direct Work with Children and Young People 5. Promoting Security and Stability for Children and Young People 6. Working with Reluctant Service Users 7. Assessment of Parenting 8. Working Across Boundaries 9. Empowering Practice 10. Going to Court 11. Children and Young People Going Home 12. Supporting Others in their Professional Development 13. Conclusion Routledge «Market: Social Work February 2011: 246x174: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-56379-6: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56380-2: £19.99/04
reader
Pam Green Lister, Glasgow School of Social Work, UK Series: Student Social Work
Social Work * A Reader Edited by Viviene E. Cree, University of Edinburgh, UK Series: Student Social Work This inspiring Reader brings together some of the most significant ideas which have informed social work practice over the last 40 years. Exploring these fundamental ideas, the book includes commentaries that allow the reader to understand the texts on their own terms as well as to be aware of their relations to each other and to the wider social work context.
All social work students study theory and undertake practice placements. Integrating the two – so that each informs the other – is both essential and notoriously tricky. This accessible book demystifies the process and offers helpful evidence-based strategies for doing it successfully. Selected Contents: Introduction 1. What is Theory? 2. Existing Knowledge and Learning Styles 3. Theoretical Explanations: How and Where to Look 4. Exploring Key Theoretical Concepts: Social Science Literature 5. Anti-Oppressive Theorising: Anti Oppressive Practice 6. Exploring Key Theoretical Concepts: Social Work Methodology 7. Critically Analysing Theory – Developing Conceptual Frameworks 8. Critical Incident Analysis – Assisting the Analysis of Theory in Practice 9. Applying Theory to Practice in Social Work Education Assignments 10. Conclusion Routledge «Market: Social Work February 2011: 246x174: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-48112-0: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-48113-7: £19.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Selected Contents: Part 1: The Profession of Social Work Part 2: Knowledge and Values for Social Work Part 3: Skills and Practice in Social Work Routledge «Market: Social Work November 2010: 246x174: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-49972-9: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-49973-6: £22.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-84089-4: £75.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Integrating Social Work Theory and Practice
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
medicine 221
Vision Rehabilitation
Performance Based Medicine
Multidisciplinary Care of the Patient Following Brain Injury
Creating the High Performance Network to Optimize Managed Care Relationships
Edited by Penelope S. Suter and Lisa H. Harvey, in Private Practice, Fort Bragg, California, USA Providing all of the necessary information required to provide post-acute vision rehabilitative care following brain injury, this multidisciplinary book bridges the gap between theory and practice and presents clinical information and scientific literature supporting the diagnostic and therapeutic strategies applied. It covers all areas of vision care, including the structure and function of the eye, organization of visual perception in the brain, and rehabilitation concepts applied to the visual system. It offers cutting-edge research, prescribing lenses and prisms and therapy techniques that will enable even the experienced clinician to provide enhanced care to the brain injury patient. CRC Press «Market: Clinical Medicine December 2010: 235x156: 608pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3655-2: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3656-9: £57.99/17
William J. DeMarco, DeMarco & Associates, Rockford, Illinois, USA Highlighting quality-driven issues, the power behind pay for performance, and value-based benefit designs, this book provides the knowledge to establish performance based structures, such as quality measurement, incentive payment structure, and incentive size within an existing organization. Focusing on how to implement new designs and how to create strategies to measure performance and improve efficiency, it discusses how to create value and optimize payment and market share. It also describes the trade-off of systems and IT investments by providers and payers to gain incremental quality improvement. Productivity Press March 2011: 229x152: 300pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1288-4: £44.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1289-1: £44.99/17
2nd Edition
Concussive Brain Trauma * Neurobehavioral Impairment & Maladaption Rolland S. Parker, New York University School of Medicine, USA Continuing the tradition of the bestselling first edition, this second edition provides comprehensive coverage of neurobehavioral disorders in children and adults following impact and acceleration accidents. Completely revised and updated, the book includes comprehensive coverage of consciousness including normal, acute, and persistent alterations. Drawing on his training, education, and experience in human physiology, neuroanatomy, and endocrinology, the author not only gives readers a solid foundation for understanding, diagnosing, and treating concussive brain trauma, but also gives them tools to increase standards of care. CRC Press
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
«Market: Rehabilitation / Disability December 2010: 254x178: 976pp Hb: 978-0-8493-8039-6: £99.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-0798-5: £99.00/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
222 biological sciences 4th Edition
4th Edition
BIOS Instant Notes in Biochemistry BIOS Instant Notes in Microbiology David Hames and Nigel Hooper, both at University of Leeds, UK Series: Instant Notes BIOS Instant Notes in Biochemistry, 4th edition, continues the tradition of previous editions in being an effective learning resource for students. As before, it clearly and concisely presents only essential topics but has also been updated to incorporate major advances particularly in protein structure and function and PCR-related technology. There will be a new section on studying proteins and terminology will also be updated throughout. Selected Contents: A. Cells B. Amino acids and proteins C. Studying proteins D. Enzymes E. Membranes and cell signalling F. DNA structure and replication G. Transcription and RNA processing H. Protein synthesis I. Recombinant DNA technology J. Carbohydrate metabolism K. Lipid metabolism L. Respiration and energy M. Nitrogen metabolism Taylor & Francis «Market: Biochemistry / Molecular Biology March 2011: 246x174: 420pp Pb: 978-0-415-60845-9: £20.00/17
3rd Edition
Simon Baker, Oxford Brookes University, UK, Jane Nicklin, University of London, UK and Caroline Griffiths, Oxford Brookes University, UK Series: Instant Notes BIOS Instant Notes in Microbiology, 4th edition, has been streamlined to concentrate on features that are unique to the microbial world, including viruses, making it a more effective resource for students. Information on pathogenesis will be placed within other sections rather than as a separate section. While retaining the Instant Notes philosophy of only covering core material, the text has been updated throughout and will include metagenomics, next generation sequencing, and more on industrial microbiology. Selected Contents: A. The Microbial World B. Systematics C. Prokaryotes D. Microbial Growth E. Microbial Metabolism F. DNA and RNA G. Industrial Microbiology H. Bacterial Infections I. Overview of Eukaryotic Microbes J. Fungi and Related Phyla K. Protista and Chlorophyta L. Viruses Taylor & Francis «Market: Biology / Microbiology / Molecular Biology / Cell Biology March 2011: 246x174: 350pp Pb: 978-0-415-60770-4: £20.00/17
3rd Edition
BIOS Instant Notes in Immunology BIOS Instant Notes in Neuroscience Alan Longstaff, Science Writer and Neuroscience Lecturer, UK Series: Instant Notes BIOS Instant Notes in Neuroscience, 3rd edition, has been reorganized and some detail removed from both text and figures in order to make it a more effective resource for students. While concentrating on core themes, areas where there have been significant advances, especially learning, memory, and cognition, have been thoroughly updated. There will be a separate section on methods allowing students to separate results from methodology.
Series: Instant Notes BIOS Instant Notes in Immunology, 3rd edition, reflects major advances in the field. The infection process is discussed with relation to the progression from the innate to adaptive immune response, and the topic innate immunity has been expanded. Coverage of gender and aging in immunology, regulation of the immune response, immunotherapy, and the relationship between the nervous and endocrine systems has been updated. Selected Contents: A. Overview of the Immune System B. Cells and Molecules of the Innate Immune System C. The Adaptive Immune System D. Antibodies E. The Antibody Response F. The T Cell Response – Cell-Mediated Immunity G. Regulation of the Immune Response H. Immunity to Infection I. Vaccination J. Immunodeficiency – When the Immune System Fails K. Hypersensitivity – When the Immune System Overreacts L. Autoimmunity and Autoimmune Diseases M. Transplantation N. Gender and the Immune System O. Aging and the Immune System (Immunosenescence) P. Immunotherapy Taylor & Francis «Market: Immunology March 2011: 246x174: 340pp Pb: 978-0-415-60753-7: £20.00/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Selected Contents: A. Organization of the nervous system B. Neuron excitation C. Synapses D. Neurotransmitters E. Neural Coding F. Somatosensory systems G. Eye and Vision H. Hearing I. Chemical senses (Smell and taste) J. Motor function: Spinal cord and brainstem K. Motor Function: cortex, cerebellum and basal ganglia L. Neuroendocrine, autonomic and vital functions M. Brain states and goal-directed behaviours N. Learning and memory O. Cognition P. Neuroscience methods Taylor & Francis «Market: Biology / Neuroscience / Medical Sciences March 2011: 246x174: 400pp Pb: 978-0-415-60769-8: £20.00/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Peter Lydyard, Royal Free and University College Medical School, UK, Alex Whelan, Trinity College Dublin, UK and Michael Fanger, Dartmouth Medical School, USA
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
biological sciences 223 3rd Edition
textbook
Animal Behavior Desk Reference
Fields, Forces, and Flows in Biological Systems *
A Dictionary of Animal Behavior, Ecology, and Evolution Edward M. Barrows, Georgetown University, Washington, D.C., USA Completely revised and updated, Animal Behavior Desk Reference, Third Edition: A Dictionary of Animal Behavior, Ecology, and Evolution provides definitions for terms in animal behavior, evolution, ecology, genetics, biogeography, systematics, psychology, and statistics. Formatted like a standard dictionary, this reference presents definitions in a quick- and easy-to-use style. It discusses how definitions impact the way people communicate and serves as an access point to the primary literature through extensive referencing This book is a valuable resource for teachers, students, writers, or anyone active in science. CRC Press «Market: Biological Sciences January 2011: 279x216: 792pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3651-4: £99.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-2005-7
Alan J. Grodzinsky, MIT, USA
Fields, Forces, and Flows in Biological Systems
ALAN J. GRODZINSKY
Fields, Forces, and Flows in Biological Systems describes the fundamental driving forces for mass transport, electric current, and fluid flow as they apply to the biology and biophysics of molecules, cells, tissues, and organs. Basic mathematical and engineering tools are presented in the context of biology and physiology. This textbook is written for advanced undergraduate and graduate students in biological and biomedical engineering and will be a valuable resource for interdisciplinary researchers.
Garland Science «Market: Biophysics January 2011: 279x216: 500pp Hb: 978-0-8153-4212-0: £49.00/17
2nd Edition
3rd Edition
Encyclopedia of Animal Science (Online Version)
Handbook of Plant and Crop Stress
Edited by Duane E. Ullrey, Michigan State University, East Lansing, USA, Charlotte Kirk Baer, USDA, Washington, D.C., USA and Wilson G. Pond, Cornell University, Ithaca, New York, USA
Edited by Mohammad Pessarakli, University of Arizona, Tucson, USA
çè
CRC Press «Market: Agriculture November 2010: 279x216: 952pp Online: 978-0-415-80286-4: £309.00/17
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Series: Books in Soils, Plants, and the Environment Detailing interrelated topics, this work addresses issues and concerns related to plant and crop stress. This edition includes information on pH stress, temperature stress, water-deficit conditions, carotenoids and stress, light stress, pollution stress, agrichemical stress, oxidative damage to proteins, UV-B induced stress, and abiotic stress tolerance.
CRC Press «Market: Agriculture November 2010: 254x178: 1270pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1396-6: £127.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1399-7: £127.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8247-1948-7
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Containing case studies that complement material presented in the text, the vast range of this definitive encyclopedia encompasses animal physiology, animal growth and development, animal behavior, animal reproduction and breeding, alternative approaches to animal maintenance, meat science and muscle biology, farmed animal welfare and bioethics, and food safety. With contributions from top researchers in their discipline, the book addresses new research and advances in this burgeoning field and provides quick and reader-friendly descriptions of technologies critical to professionals in animal and food science, food production and processing, livestock management, and nutrition.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
224 biological sciences
Plant Tissue Culture, Development, and Biotechnology * Edited by Robert N. Trigiano, University of Tennessee, Knoxville, USA and Dennis J. Gray, University of Florida, Apopka, Florida, USA Addressing several specialized areas generically termed biotechnology, Plant Tissue Culture, Development and Biotechnology uses a broad range of species that are studied via laboratory exercises. Based on the editors’ previous textbooks this book provides detailed perspectives and hands-on training in this rather diverse field. It concentrates on plant development and its application in biotechnology, while maintaining as broad of a base as possible. Supporting laboratory exercises are provided. CRC Press «Market: Biological Sciences November 2010: 254x178: 600pp Pb: 978-1-4200-8326-2: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8327-9: £63.99/17
The Laboratory Zebrafish * Claudia Harper, Amgen Inc., Cambridge, Massachusetts, USA and Christian Lawrence, Children’s Hospital Boston, Massachusetts, USA Series: Laboratory Animal Pocket Reference Providing a quick reference source for basic information and common procedures, this guide is designed for a range of experience levels. It covers all aspects pertaining to the use of these organisms including humane care and management, husbandry, compliance, technical procedures, veterinary care, housing, and water quality management.
CRC Press December 2010: 235x156: 256pp Pb: 978-1-4398-0743-9: £38.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0744-6: £38.99/17
3rd Edition
Progress and Challenges Edited by Michael Pillay, Vaal University of Technology, South Africa and Abdou Tenkouano, AVRDC – World Vegetable Center, Tanzania Bananas are one of the most important agricultural crops, however they have been largely neglected with only a few breeding programs. Aiming to provide practical understanding of banana breeding, this book presents a detailed account of the methodologies used in conventional and molecular breeding of bananas. Chapters cover the origin, history, and distribution of bananas. Also featured in their own dedicated chapters are genetics, reproductive biology, conventional breeding methods, seed production, disease management, pest management, propagation, biotechnology, hybrid distribution, quality improvement, processing, and value addition. It also details future prospects for the continued, successful cultivation of bananas. CRC Press «Market: Agriculture January 2011: 254x178 Hb: 978-1-4398-0017-1: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0018-8: £89.00/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Growth and Mineral Nutrition of Field Crops Nand Kumar Fageria, EMBRAPA, San Antonio de Goias, Brazil, Virupax C. Baligar, USDA/ARS SPCL, Beltsville, USA and Charles Allan Jones, Texas A&M University, Dallas, USA Series: Books in Soils, Plants, and the Environment This new edition of a bestseller examines plant nutrition’s role as one of the most important limiting factors that must be overcome to optimize food production. Extensively revised and updated, the new edition provides comprehensive coverage of on topics such as genetic, physiological, and agronomic bases of crop growth. It covers soil-plant-climatic relationships that govern the growth and mineral nutrition of crops in temperate and tropical regions. The book contains two new chapters covering remediation of heavy metal contaminated soils and cover crops as well as several new figures, references, and tables. CRC Press «Market: Agriculture October 2010: 254x178: 592pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1695-0: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1696-7: £95.00/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Banana Breeding
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
biological sciences 225 African Natural Plant Products
Transgenic Horticultural Crops
TRP Channels
From Forests and Fields to the Marketplace
Challenges and Opportunities
Edited by James Simon and Rodolfo Juliani, both at Rutgers University, New Brunswick, New Jersey, USA and Lyle Craker, University of Massachusetts, Amherst, USA
Beiquan Mou, USDA-ARS, Salinas, California, USA and Ralph Scorza, USDA, ARS, AFRS, Kearneysville, West Virginia, USA
Edited by Michael XI Zhu, The Ohio State University, Columbus, USA
This book is a review of the latest discoveries made through the collection, cultivation, production, processing, marketing, and commercialization of African botanicals, herbs, spices, and plants. It provides case studies on several new plants used as supplements and nutraceuticals. The text provides a background in the botany and ecology of the indigenous plants in Africa and examines products such as plant-based butters and edible oils used in foods, cosmetics, and lubricants. Gums and resins are discussed, as well as aromatic plants as sources of essential oils. The book also covers the principles necessary for sustainable cultivation and other commercialization issues. CRC Press «Market: Biological Sciences March 2011: 254x178: 448pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2176-3: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2178-7: £89.00/17
An Ecosystem Approach
Edited by Keshun Liu, USDA-ARS, Aberdeen, Idaho, USA and Kurt. A. Rosentrater, United States Department of Agriculture, Brookings, South Dakota, USA Written to address the growth of distillers dried grains with soluble (DDGS) as a major feed ingredient in North America and abroad, this reference provides a complete overview of its traditional use and future employment. It provides information on the U.S. fuel ethanol industry and presents traditional and additional uses of DDGS, including feed for cattle, swine, poultry, fish, and other animals. The book includes information on the physical and chemical aspects of DDGS, and explains its composition and nutritional properties. The authors discuss new uses for DDGS such as its potential as a biofiller in plastic.
Richard F. Dame, Coastal Carolina University, Conway, South Carolina, USA Series: Marine Science Considering the ecology of bivalves from an ecosystem view, this book explores the potential use of bivalves as indicators and monitors of ecosystem health and describes experiments from the perspective of computer simulations, mesocosm studies, and field manipulation experiments. The second edition discusses major new developments, including phase shifts in many coastal and estuarine ecosystems dominated by suspension-feeding bivalves, the invasion or introduction of alien bivalve species, the rapid growth of environmental restoration focused on bivalves, and the examination of past geological time with regard to global climate change and its impact on bivalve dominated systems.
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
CRC Press «Market: Biological Sciences April 2011: 235x156: 320pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3909-6: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3912-6: £63.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-8045-7
AOCS Publishing «Market: Agriculture May 2011: 254x178: 350pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1725-4: £85.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1726-1: £85.00/17
çè
CRC Press «Market: Biological Sciences March 2011: 235x156: 480pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1860-2: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1861-9: £95.00/17
Ecology of Marine Bivalves
Production, Properties, and Utilization
for e-mail updates in your field
Taylor & Francis «Market: Agriculture April 2011: 254x178: 424pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9378-0: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9379-7: £95.00/17
Transient Receptor Potential (TRP) channels have gained a lot of popularity in recent years due to their involvement in a wide variety of cellular functions in many different systems. The purpose of this book is to provide detailed methods for the study of TRP channels. It includes expression and functional studies of TRP channels in heterologous systems as well as structural and functional studies of TRP channels. The author also explores various methods for detailed analysis of biophysical properties of TRP channels. In addition, the text covers high-throughput screening assays for TRP channels and offers novel and effective approaches to study endogenous TRP channel function in native systems.
2nd Edition
Distillers Grains
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
Although there are many books available that cover with plant biotechnology and transgenic plants, few, if any on horticultural crops. This book fills that void. Internationally acclaimed experts from diverse disciplines assess the current status of transgenic horticultural crops, examine the challenges for the creation and commercialization of horticultural biotechnology, cover the impacts of intellectual property rights, and identify opportunities, strategies, and priorities for future progress in this important field. The book focuses on transgenic horticultural crops throughout the United States, Europe, and China.
Series: Methods in Signal Transduction Series
World Soil Resources and Food Security Edited by Rattan Lal, The Ohio State University, Columbus, USA and B.A. Stewart, West Texas A&M University, Canyon, USA Series: Advances in Soil Science This book provides current information regarding the world’s soil resources available for food production; management and input requirements needed to achieve increased production on soils available for production; and ways to maintain or improve soil resources to gain optimal production. Chapters cover global food demand, soil degradation, fertilizer needs, nutrient budgeting and plant nutrition, disease suppressive soils, soil and climate change, soil fertility management, ecological efficiency, sustainable production systems, soil resilience, and soils and human health. The contributing authors offer innovative soil and water management options. The editors have included photographs, anatomical art, and equations to aid in comprehension. CRC Press «Market: Agriculture May 2011: 235x156: 472pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4450-2: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4451-9: £82.00/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
226 biotechnology 2nd Edition textbook
2nd Edition
Biomechanics of the Upper Extremities
Biomedical Transducers and Instruments
Mechanics, Modeling, and Musculoskeletal Injuries
Tatsuo Tagawa, Waseda University, Tokorozawa, Japan, Toshiyo Tamura, Chiba University, Japan and P. Ake Oberg, Linkoping University Hospital, Sweden
Andris Freivalds, Pennsylvania State University, University Park, USA Over the past two decades, the growth in computer-related jobs has led to considerable increase in the number of work-related musculoskeletal disorders in the upper limbs. Now in its second edition, this comprehensive text is now expanded to include recent findings regarding job stressors and a variety of ergonomic solutions. It provides up-todate research on the biomechanics of the upper limbs and the mechanics of neuromuscular systems. It covers risk factors for various disorders and tools used to identify their causes. Qualified instructors can access a supporting website offering materials such as PowerPoint slides and sample exams and an instructor’s manual with complete solutions. CRC Press «Market: Biomedical Engineering February 2011: 254x178: 640pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9119-9: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9120-5: £76.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-7484-0926-6
2nd Edition textbook
Written for graduate-level engineering and kinesiology students but also beneficial to researchers, industrial ergonomists, industrial hygienists, and medical professionals, this book is an engineering-oriented reference on upper-extremity musculoskeletal disorders. It begins with an introduction to the human musculoskeletal system, neuromuscular physiology, and the motor control system and is followed by the mechanics and models of the components of the neuromuscular system. The book then goes on to present instruments and tools to identify the work-related musculoskeletal disorders (WRMSDs) in the industrial workplace. Final chapters provide specific applications to hand tools and computer workstations, the culprits for most upper limb ailments. CRC Press «Market: Biomedical Engineering March 2011: 254x178: 464pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9078-9: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9079-6: £89.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-7671-9
Biomedical Engineering Principles BioMEMS Integrating engineering, medicine, biology, and physics, this book clearly defines basic principles in image processing and biomechanics, modeling physiological processes, and bioelectric signal analysis to build a solid understanding of devices and designs for improved functioning of the human body. It includes cutting-edge discussions of tissue engineering, cardiovascular components, bone regrowth, and nerve regeneration. Other topics include technologies at the forefront of cardiac care, such as total artificial hearts, left ventricular assist devices, and stents, as well as issues related to minimally invasive and robotic surgery, next-generation imaging devices, and nanodevices. CRC Press «Market: Biomedical Engineering March 2011: 229x152: 850pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1232-7: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1233-4: £63.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8247-9616-7
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Science and Engineering Perspectives Muthukumaran Packirisamy and Simona Badilescu, Concordia University, Canada Written to cover often overlooked areas in the field of bioMEMS, this volume bridges topics related to biomolecules and complex biological entities with those directly related to the design, fabrication, and characterization of the devices. Unlike other references, this text aids with the fundamental physiochemical understanding of biological processes relevant to the performance of various biosensing devices. Accessible to seniors and graduate students enrolled in engineering programs, the book includes problems in each chapter as well as case studies to provide real-life examples. CRC Press «Market: Biomedical Engineering February 2011: 254x178: 376pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1699-8: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1700-1: £42.99/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Edited by Vikki Hazelwood and Antonio Valdevit, both at Stevens Institute of Technology, Hoboken, USA and Alfred Ascione, Alcatel-Lucent Technologies, USA
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
biotechnology 227
Biomimetics
Biotechnology Operations
Nature Based Innovation
Principles and Practices
Yoseph Bar-Cohen, JPL/Caltech, Pasadena, California, USA
Michael J. Roy, University of Wisconsin-Madison, Madison, USA
Based on the concept that nature offers numerous sources of inspiration for inventions related to mechanisms, materials, processes, and algorithms, this book covers the topic of biomimetics and the inspired innovation. The many recognized world-wide leaders that contribute to the text describe the efforts of turning science fiction ideas into engineering reality. This book is a follow-up to the author’s 2005 publication and addresses many topics that were not covered in the original text. It reviews possibilities, the state of the art, and the challenges toward inspiring new experts to join the field. Extensive references at the end of each chapter are provided to enhance additional study.
Based on the author’s five years of teaching this book introduces key biotechnology developments covering the critical elements of such as project management, regulatory affairs, quality assurance, biomanufacturing, quality control, nonclinical safety testing, and clinical evaluation. The author discusses these subjects in relation to development planning, process and pathways, management of integrated projects and the business and economic aspects of development. It describes the functional areas that must be successfully integrated to bring a biotechnology product to market.
CRC Press «Market: Biomedical Engineering April 2011: 254x178: 500pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3476-3: £99.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3477-0: £99.00/17
CRC Press «Market: Biotechnology April 2011: 229x152: 450pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3027-7: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3028-4: £63.99/17
3rd Edition
Bionanotechnology II Global Prospects Edited by David E. Reisner, The Nano Group, Inc., Farmington, Connecticut, USA A blend of information from the Biomedical Engineering Handbook and new material, this book draws on the experience of experts from countries such as Iran, Cuba, South Africa, UK, Canada, China, India, and Russia. It reflects the increasing emphasis and importance of nanomedicine and biotechnology with the inclusion of topics such as Biomimicry, Stem Cells, Optical Togs, Nanocoating for Medical Implantable Devices, Food Industry, Cosmetics, Cardiac Diagnosis, Batteries, Drug Delivery, Photonics, DNA Building Blocks, Protein Devices, Quantum Dots, Bioanalysis, Optics, Nanomedicine, Personalized Medicine and the Business of Emerging Bionanotech Companies.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Essential Principles and Practices Edited by Jann Hau, University of Copenhagen & Rigshhospitalet, Denmark and Steven Schapiro, The University of Texas, Bastrop, USA Now in its third edition, this comprehensive handbook explores the myriad issues surrounding the use of animals in scientific laboratories. Topics in Volume I include the history of animal research, ethical concerns, regulation and legislation, facilities and equipment, genetics, health monitoring, nutrient requirements and feeding schedules, statistical analysis, surgical and nonsurgical techniques, and anesthesia. The book also explores alternatives to lab animal use with a discussion of the refinement, reduction, and replacement of animal uses in the life sciences. The book boasts an array of international contributors. CRC Press «Market: Life Sciences December 2010: 254x178: 624pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8455-9: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8456-6: £95.00/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
CRC Press «Market: Biomedical Engineering January 2011: 254x178: 350pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0463-6: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0464-3: £63.99/17
Handbook of Laboratory Animal Science, Volume I
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
228 biotechnology textbook
textbook
Healthcare Biotechnology
Introduction to Complexity and Complex Systems
A Practical Guide Dimitris Dogramatzis, Dogramatzis Pharmacy, Athens, Greece A first of its kind to focus on the management of health-care related biotechnology, this text is a resourceful practical guide that assists all healthcarerelated biotech professionals in their day-to-day activities. The book contains chapters on bioeconomy, biolicensing, biofinance, biopartnering, biodrug research, biomarketing planning, biopromotion, product life cycle management, and biobusiness models, among others. Written by a wellestablished professional and registered pharmacist, this reference is appropriate for graduate students and industry professionals. It contains over 350 tables and figures and end-of-section problems accompany each chapter. There are also extensive references following each chapter to enhance further study. CRC Press «Market: Biotechnology December 2010: 235x156: 768pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4746-6: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4747-3: £63.99/17
Laboratory Mouse and Laboratory Rat Procedural Techniques *
Robert B. Northrop, University of Connecticut, Storrs, USA Written for students and professionals in the fields of biomedical engineering, systems biology, biophysics, and physiology, this unique reference covers complexity issues within living systems. Topics explored include human responses to coping with complex systems, the Law of Unintended Consequences, the relation of complexity to evolution, the complexity inherent in invertebrate immune systems, and the complexity inherent in economic systems. A comprehensive glossary is included to help readers with acronyms and terms relating to complex, nonlinear biological systems. Also included are dynamic models and homework questions to further aid in understanding. CRC Press «Market: Biomedical Engineering December 2010: 229x152: 568pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3901-0: £44.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3902-7: £44.99/17
Laboratory Mouse Procedural Techniques
Manuals and DVDs John J. Bogdanske, Scott Hubbard-Van Stelle, Margaret Rankin-Riley and Beth M. Schiffman, all at University of Wisconsin, Madison, USA
November 2010: 235x156: 98pp Pb: 978-1-4398-5042-8: £38.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5043-5: £38.99/17
Laboratory Rat Procedural Techniques
CRC Press «Market: Life Sciences November 2010: 235x156: 192pp Pb: 978-1-4398-5050-3: £68.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5091-6: £68.99/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
November 2010: 235x156: 82pp Pb: 978-1-4398-5044-2: £38.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5045-9: £38.99/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
This combination of manuals and DVDs provides much-needed training on the proper handling of mice and rats used in biomedical research. The DVDs include narrated video clips that demonstrate and describe each procedural technique. The manuals contain handouts with color illustrations and descriptive text for each technique, including the purpose and application of the procedure, recommended skills, and necessary supplies. The pair can be used as a training resource and refresher for lab animal veterinarians, veterinary technicians, animal care staff, trainers, and research investigators and staff.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
biotechnology 229
Mechanobiology Handbook Edited by Jiro Nagatomi, Clemson University, South Carolina, USA At appropriate levels, mechanical stimuli are necessary for growth and maintenance of healthy tissues and organs. Mechanobiology examines effects of mechanical force stimuli on cellular biological functions. The past two decades have seen a dramatic increase in the level of research in mechaniobiology. Collecting the cutting-edge research findings from a diverse range of scientists, this volume, which presents basic materials in mechanics and cell biology, is a reference for those new to the field and also is designed to stimulate new ways of thinking in current mechanobiology researchers. CRC Press «Market: Biomedical Engineering March 2011: 254x178: 512pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9121-2: £109.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9122-9: £109.00/17
Nanotechnology For the Life Sciences Fundamentals and Applications Arlen D. Meyers, University of Colorado, Denver, USA, Gabor L. Hornyak, NanoThread, Inc., Golden, Colorado, USA, Anil K. Rao, Metropolitan State College of Denver, Colorado, USA and Raechelle A. D’sa, Belfast, UK Although touted as the next industrial revolution, the interdisciplinary nature of nanotechnology can pose a challenge to students. Exploring nanotechnology through a life sciences filter, this book focuses on the applications of nanoscience and the engineering aspects of medical and biotechnological nanodevices. Divided into introductory, intermediate, and advanced section, each chapter offers a succinct introduction, a detailed discussion of the topic at hand with illustrative examples, numerous figures and necessary equations, and a concise summary. Problem sets include exercises of varying difficulty and numerical problems that are analytical to thought provoking. CRC Press «Market: Medicine March 2011: 235x156: 450pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1122-1: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1123-8: £89.00/17
3rd Edition
Loeb and Quimby’s Clinical Chemistry of Laboratory Animals David M. Kurtz, Experimental Pathology Laboratories, Inc., North Carolina, USA, Judith S. Prescott, GlaxoSmithKline, Research Triangle Park, USA and Gregory S. Travlos, National Institute of Environmental Health Services, Research Triangle Park, USA Edited in partnership with the American College of Laboratory Medicine (ACLAM), Loeb and Quimby’s Clinical Chemistry of Laboratory Animals, Third Edition is the most comprehensive reference available on in vivo animal studies as a critical part of biomedical research. It covers relevant laboratory animal species, specific organ systems (hepatic, renal, etc.), and important classes of analytes (hormones, lipids, carbohydrates, etc.). The book also addresses additional organs not included in earlier editions such as cardiovascular/ pulmonary; gastrointestinal and pancreas; and skeletal. The book concludes with a discussion of the development of novel biomarkers and use of statistical analyses.
Stem Cell Engineering Handbook Edited by Xuejun Wen, Clemson University, Charleston, South Carolina, USA Stem cell engineering allows scientists to manipulate stem cells artificially for the purpose of studying and controlling their survival, potency, proliferation, migration, specific differentiation, plasticity, immunocompatibility, fate in vivo, and other properties. This new research area holds great promise for researchers using stem cells for testing the safety and effects of new drugs, for the treatment of disease, and for the regeneration of injured tissues. This volumes brings researchers from engineering, chemistry, physics, and biology to discuss basic and advanced topics in this burgeoning field. CRC Press «Market: Biotechnology April 2011: 254x178: 1000pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9005-5: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9007-9: £95.00/17
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
CRC Press «Market: Life Sciences December 2011: 254x178: 1024pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9113-7: £114.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9114-4: £114.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5603-2717-2
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
230 biotechnology
Usability Testing of Medical Devices Edited by Michael E. Wiklund, Jonathan Kendler and Allison S. Yale, all at Wiklund Research Design, Concord, USA Informative, practical, and engaging, this handbook covers how to conduct usability tests of medical devices. Recognizing that the intended readers, including marketers, engineers, and regulatory affairs specialists, are busy and disinclined to read lengthy textbooks, this book has been carefully designed to be concise and visual, allowing readers to read it all in one sitting or jump from one section to another as needed. The book provides a general understanding of usability testing and reviews key concepts. It highlights the challenges of validating that protects against dangerous errors that could lead to patient injury and death. CRC Press «Market: Biomedical Engineering December 2010: 235x156: 360pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1183-2: £44.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1184-9: £44.99/17
Pediatric Rehabilitation Engineering
Quality Control Training Manual
From Disability to Possibility
Comprehensive Training Guide for API, Finished Pharmaceutical and Biotechnologies Laboratories
Edited by Tom Chau, Bloorview Kids Rehab, Toronto, USA and Jillian Fairley, Toronto, Ontario, Canada Series: CRC Press Series in Rehabilitation Science in Practice
Syed Imtiaz Haider and Erfan Asif Syed, both at Julphar Gulf Pharm Industries, United Arab Emirates
Written by international experts, this book provides an up-to-date synopsis of advances in pediatric rehabilitation engineering research. Offering a single comprehensive resource on the latest research findings, each chapter presents a different area of technology or the developments of particular clinical relevance to pediatric rehabilitation. The material within each chapter also includes a conceptual description of the technology or underlying scientific principles, followed by a synthesis of relevant literature, recent research advances, selected clinical case studies (where applicable), and perspectives for future directions.
A valuable tool for chemists and analysts working in Quality Control laboratories, this book provides technical solutions that fulfill training requirements and build skilled manpower. The text is written for practitioners in quality control laboratories, product development laboratories, and stability laboratories in pharmaceutical and bio-pharmaceutical manufacturing, along with students in pharmaceutical and biotechnology development. It includes chapters on various elements commonly used in quality control labs, with questions at the end to ensure understanding. It also includes training manuals, training log and a CD-ROM on various laboratory aspects.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
CRC Press «Market: Biotechnology January 2011: 229x152: 408pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4994-1: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5016-9: £89.00/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
CRC Press «Market: Biomedical Engineering December 2010: 235x156: 360pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0842-9: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0851-1: £89.00/17
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
biotechnology 231 Stem Cells and Neovascularization in Tissue Engineering
The Physiology of Bioelectricity in Development, Tissue Regeneration and Cancer
Edited by Hyunjoon Kong, University of Illinois Urbana-Champaign, Illinois, USA, Andrew Putnam, University of California, California, USA and Lawrence B. Schook, University of Illinois, Urbana, USA
Series: Biological Effects of Electromagnetics
Series: Biotechnology and Bioprocessing Tissue engineering is considered a promising new tool to improve the repair and restoration of tissue function and to rebuild new tissues. Stem cells are being extensively studied for use in tissue engineering because of their ability to develop into a variety of tissues. This volume addresses various scientific and engineering principles and technologies that support and stimulate the regenerative capabilities of stem cells. It provides results of successful and unsuccessful preclinical and clinical trials and provides guidelines for the future use of stem cells in tissue engineering and regenerative medicine. CRC Press «Market: Biotechnology March 2011: 229x152: 500pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0323-3: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0324-0: £95.00/17
Revealing the role of biological electric fields in pathophysiologies such as cancer, this book describes the importance of biological electric fields in regulating physiology at the cellular level and influencing tissue repair and regeneration. The text explains how biological electric fields are generated and how to measure them; how cells can sense these local electrical guidance cures; how bioelectricity plays a role in development, regeneration, wound repair, and cancer; and how we can harness our current understanding to promote tissue regeneration and wound repair as well as to attempt to reduce occurrences of cancer. CRC Press «Market: Biomedical Engineering January 2011: 229x152: 400pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3723-8: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3724-5: £76.99/17
pharmaceutical sciences
Yu Shyr and Lynne D. Berry, both at Vanderbilt University, Nashville, Tennessee, USA Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Biostatistics Series In the past, pharmaceutical companies have quickly jumped to Phase III without completion and full analysis of Phase II, which consequently led to failure. In the future, more emphasis needs to be placed on quality designed, conducted, and analyzed Phase II clinical trials. Focusing on Phase II clinical trials conducted in a sequential manner, this handbook presents modern techniques of clinical trial design, describes many Phase II designs, and discusses the software used for sample size and power analysis. It also provides sample size tables for those without the appropriate software to calculate sample size and power and includes numerous real-world examples of trial designs in use.
çè
CRC Press «Market: Statistics February 2012: 235x156: 352pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2162-6: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2163-3: £48.99/17
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Pharmacy Fits Practical Tactics for Integrating Medication Related Computer Systems, Teams and Processes Faron Moore, Coweta, Oklahoma, USA After exploring how many of the challenges and frustrations for healthcare IT projects can be traced to confusing data related to medication processes, this text offers valuable insight into how these challenges might be addressed, both in pharmacy informatics and in the broader health IT arena. This book is easy and enjoyable to read, practical, and insightful into the source of challenges in an attempt to both aid and popularize pharmacy informatics. The book brings a fresh perspective on how healthcare IT project problems are faced and solved. A glossary and worksheets are provided to boost comprehension. Productivity Press March 2011: 254x178: 200pp Pb: 978-1-4398-4148-8: £44.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4150-1: £44.99/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Handbook of Phase II Clinical Trial Design
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
232 pharmaceutical sciences 3rd Edition
Drug Delivery Systems Vasant V. Ranade, Academic Pharmaceuticals Inc, Lake Bluff, USA and John B. Cannon, Targeted Drug Solutions, Grayslake, USA Series: Pharmacology and Toxicology: Basic and Clinical Aspects The third edition of this popular book contains the latest research and development on drug delivery systems. It also contains a new chapter on nanoscience and technology for drug delivery along with cutting-edge business intelligence and strategies throughout the text. Like previous editions, it continues to provide readers with a multitude of possible drug delivery systems that can be used to improve therapeutics as well as information on the technology involved and the regulatory approaches that make them useful. The authors introduce complex drug delivery technology in an easy-to-understand format with numerous practical examples. CRC Press «Market: Pharmacology and Toxicology April 2011: 235x156: 464pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0618-0: £127.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0619-7: £127.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-1433-9
Edited by S. Narasimha Murthy, University of Mississippi, University, USA Presenting the first comprehensive reference on this important new area of research, this book provides an overview of the fundamentals of dermatokinetics: the study of drug uptake into skin layers. It offers a detailed discussion of dermatokinetics that is applicable to any route of administration and to different pharmaceutical drug delivery systems. The author includes a general overview of the theoretical as well as the practical aspects of dermatokinetics and addresses the impact of drug delivery system design on the dermatokinetics of drugs. Chapters cover such topics as dermatopharmacology, cutaneous microdialysis, and dermatokinetics of gene therapeutics. CRC Press «Market: General Chemistry March 2011: 235x156: 264pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0477-3: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0478-0: £82.00/17
order now!
Trans-ungual Drug Delivery
Triggered Drug Delivery
Edited by S. Narasimha Murthy, University of Mississippi, University, USA
Physical Methods and Applications
Presenting crucial information on the state-ofthe-science in trans-ungual drug delivery, this comprehensive overview provides a useful tool to assist in the development of products to treat and solve nail diseases. A growing area of pharmaceutical research, the search for efficient delivery techniques that can cross the nail barrier has yielded several effective strategies. Discussing existing techniques, ongoing research, new approaches, and basic concepts in trans-ungual drug delivery, this book summarizes the current knowledge and represents a jumping-off point for creating novel techniques of drug delivery across the nail. CRC Press «Market: General Chemistry March 2011: 235x156: 200pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1129-0: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1131-3: £82.00/17
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
Colin P. McCoy and Gavin P. Andrews, both at Queen’s University Belfast, UK Offering a comprehensive approach organized by types of systems, this book outlines the design, development, and application of the rapidlydeveloping field of triggered drug delivery systems. Drawing from the latest research, it examine the emerging area of smart implantable drug delivery platforms. Among the systems discussed, it covers light, thermal, chemical, magnetic, ultrasound, electrical, and pressure triggered systems. The text demonstrates the context of the triggers with current examples of applications. This text is a unique and invaluable guide for pharmaceutical scientists and biomedical engineers needing to keep abreast of the latest technological advances. CRC Press «Market: General Chemistry January 2012: 235x156: 296pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9969-0: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9970-6: £82.00/17
çè
Dermatokinetics of Therapeutic Agents
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
neuroscience 233
Neurobiology of Sensation and Reward Jay A. Gottfried, Northwestern University, Chicago, Illinois, USA Series: Frontiers in Neuroscience A comprehensive systems overview of sensory and reward processing in the brain, this book explores what reward processing can teach us about the senses and what sensory processing can teach us about reward. In examining the neurobiological interface between sensation and reward, the book reveals how the instrinsic properties of sensory systems effectively define and constrain the ambitions of reward-related processing in human and non-human brains. With contributions from leading investigators in the fields of sensation and reward, the text injects the ‘sensory’ back into the study of reward processing, and the ‘rewarding’ back into the study of sensory processing. CRC Press «Market: Medicine March 2011: 254x178: 520pp Hb: 978-1-4200-6726-2: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-6729-3: £95.00/17
forensic science
Creating Cultural Monsters
CSI for the First Responder
Serial Murder in America
A Concise Guide
Julie B. Wiest, University of Tennesee, Knoxville, USA
Jan LeMay
A unique and comprehensive explanation of serial murder, this book draws on the years of experience and dedicated research of Dr. Julie Wiest. The book examines connections between American culture and the incidence of serial murder and draws clear and well supported conclusions. Dr. Wiest presents six empirically-supported arguments that have the potential to revolutionize how serial murder is understood, studied, investigated, and brought to light, including a sociological context as to why most serial murderers are white males. This text is suitable as a reference as well as a textbook for serial murder, serial violence, and criminal profiling courses.
Covering all aspects of crime scene investigation, this book provides guidelines and procedures for initial assessment and securing the scene; searching for and identifying evidence; evidence documentation through notes, photography, video, sketches, and diagrams; and evidence collection and preservation. It explains the investigative value of different types of evidence, includes advice on testifying in court, and provides numerous case studies to show ideal situations, common mistakes, and how to avoid them. Written for law enforcement, this volume is easy to understand and self-contained. The text is also available on CD-ROM for download to a vehicle computer.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
CRC Press «Market: Forensics and Criminal Justice December 2010: 235x156: 168pp Pb: 978-1-4398-1922-7: £38.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1923-4: £38.99/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
CRC Press «Market: Forensics and Criminal Justice May 2011: 235x156: 250pp Hb: 978-1-4398-5154-8: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5155-5: £49.99/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
234 forensic science
Forensic Anthropology
Forensic Science in Healthcare
2000 to 2010
Caring for Patients, Preserving the Evidence
Edited by Sue Black and Eilidh Ferguson, both at University of Dundee, UK
Connie Darnell, Jemez Springs, New Mexico, USA This book contains basic forensic information necessary for healthcare professionals to assess and manage victims of trauma and criminal behavior. Chapters cover information on types of wounds and how to describe them; various types of evidence which may be encountered in the healthcare setting; and general principles of evidence collection. Common evidentiary items such as clothing, foreign objects, trace evidence, biological evidence, and bite marks are discussed and collection procedures are identified. A glossary of terms is included and a downloadable CD-ROM with information and printable templates such as human body diagrams supplements the text.
Written for students and professionals, this text summarizes the international literature on 12 topics related to forensic anthropology within the last decade. Topics include age determination in juveniles and adults, sex determination, stature, ancestral origin, skeletal trauma, trends in pathology, taphonomy, comparative osteology, dental ID, soft tissue ID, and facial ID of the dead. It presents current trends in the field and future research. This volume provides a supplemental text for any physical anthropology or archaeology class. Taylor & Francis «Market: Forensics and Criminal Justice February 2011: 235x156: 384pp Pb: 978-1-4398-4588-2: £25.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4589-9: £25.99/17
CRC Press «Market: Forensics and Criminal Justice December 2010: 235x156: 360pp Pb: 978-1-4398-4490-8: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4491-5: £57.99/17
3rd Edition textbook
3rd Edition
Financial Investigation and Forensic Accounting
Firearms, the Law, and Forensic Ballistics
George A. Manning, formerly Consultant-Enrolled IRS Agent, Campbellton, Florida, USA
Tom Warlow, Cambrideshire, UK Firearms Consultative Committee, UK
Presenting a complete examination of the current methods and legal considerations involved in the detection and prosecution of economic crimes, this book examines different types of offenses with a financial element. It explores offshore activities and the means criminals use to hide their ill-gotten gains and provides a thorough review of evidentiary rules as well as the protocol involved in search warrants. It examines two modalities used to prove financial crime and presents an example scenario based on real-life incidents. Additional topics include organized crime and money laundering, consumer and business fraud and the different schemes that befall the unwary, computer crimes, and issues surrounding banking and finance.
Series: International Forensic Science and Investigation
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
CRC Press «Market: Forensics and Criminal Justice May 2011: 235x156: 480pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1827-5: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1828-2: £63.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-31601-9
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
CRC Press «Market: Forensics and Criminal Justice November 2010: 254x178: 784pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2566-2: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2567-9: £79.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-2223-5
Firearms, the Law, and Forensic Ballistics, Third Edition describes what happens when a weapon is fired in terms of internal, external, and terminal, or wound, ballistics and the consequences of these happenings for the forensic scientist both at the scene of the shooting incident and in the laboratory. With new and updated information, this second edition explains the role of the forensic scientist, including attending the scene of the crime and post-mortem examination, setting up databases, the recovery of deleted markings and serial numbers, instrumental and analytical techniques used in the laboratory, and the presentation of evidence in court.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
forensic science 235
Healthcare Crime Investigating Abuse, Fraud, and Homicide by Caregivers Kelly M. Pyrek, Glendale, Arizona, USA Through in-depth personal interviews with a notable list of forensic experts, this book covers the motivation, opportunity, and investigation of equivocal deaths in healthcare settings. It describes the red flags indicating illicit behavior of medical professionals; considers contributing factors such as personnel shortages and lack of oversight; catalogs methods of injury, assault, and murder along with descriptions of forensic evidence for each; and provides insight on other healthcare-related crimes including assisted suicide and narcotics theft. Practical advice from forensic/legal healthcare experts covers the intervention, prevention, and prosecution of perpetrators through case studies and scientific evidence. CRC Press «Market: Forensics and Criminal Justice January 2011: 235x156: 336pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2033-9: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2034-6: £49.99/17
Practical Crime Scene Investigations for Hot Zones Jacqueline T. Fish, Charleston Southern University, Charleston, South Carolina, USA, Robert N. Stout, Lynchburg, Virginia, USA and Edward Wallace, Staten Island, New York, USA Series: Practical Aspects of Criminal & Forensic Investigations A comprehensive reference, this book contains guidelines and best practices for working in the hazardous environment of a high consequence event. It contains validated methodologies and introduces the latest technologies for crime scene processing, enhancing the personal and procedural safety of crime scene investigators. Pulling together recognized protocols and expertise, the book is a single source of reliable and court-defensible best practices that enhances the safety of the CSls responsible for processing the scene of the next high consequence event. Taylor & Francis December 2010: 235x156: 356pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2052-0: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2053-7: £63.99/17
2nd Edition
Investigation and Prevention of Officer-Involved Deaths *
Practical Bomb Scene Investigation
Cyril H. Wecht, Cyril H. Wecht Institute of Forensic Science & Law, Pittsburg, Pennsylvania, USA, Henry C. Lee, Connecticut State Police Forensic Science Lab, Meriden, USA, D.P. van Blaricom, formerly Chief of Police, Bellevue, Washington, USA and Mel Tucker, Raleigh, North Carolina, USA
James T. Thurman, Eastern Kentucky University, Richmond, USA
çè
CRC Press «Market: Forensics and Criminal Justice November 2010: 235x156: 184pp Hb: 978-1-4200-6374-5: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-6375-2: £52.81/17
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Practical Bomb Scene Investigation presents methods and procedures used to locate and collect evidence at the site of an explosion. It addresses safety issues such as military ordnance identification procedures and indicators of biological, chemical, and radiological material use. Full-color photographs document bomb scenes, explosives, military ordinance, and bomb components. Case studies illustrate an organized, methodical approach to investigation. Enhanced with diagrams, examples, and tables, the book examines explosives residue collection procedures, methods of equipment decontamination, chain of custody and scene administration forms, and characteristics of explosive products. Taylor & Francis «Market: Forensics and Criminal Justice February 2011: 254x178: 464pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1959-3: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1960-9: £63.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-4198-4
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
An in-depth examination of all the facets of investigating police-related deaths, this book includes coverage of death scene investigation for reconstruction. It discusses collection of physical evidence, interviews, medical examination of the decedent, psychological factors involving both parties, and litigation of alleged police misconduct. The authors create composite scenarios from their collective case studies, providing precise examples that are factual and to the point. The scenarios covered include: suicide by cop shooting, restraint asphyxia in-custody death, fatal accident resulting from vehicular pursuit, police shootings, and preventing deaths of mentally ill and drug intoxicated individuals.
Series: Practical Aspects of Criminal & Forensic Investigations
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
236 forensic science
Practical Forensic Digital Imaging *
Mechanics of Impression Evidence David Pierce, Sarnia Police Service, Ontario, Canada P resenting the hard science increasingly required by courts to back up expert opinion in cases that hinge on impression evidence comparison, this book applies the methods of physics, chemistry, and engineering to analysis and interpretation of fingerprints, footwear and tire tread impressions, ballistic evidence, and bloodstains. Using easily accessible language, it shows the scientific method behind each of these discrete disciplines. It then combines and cross-references the knowledge within each to ultimately present a more generalist approach and thus a more informed judgment.
Applications and Techniques Patrick Jones, Purdue University, West Lafayette, Indiana, USA Series: Practical Aspects of Criminal & Forensic Investigations Practical Forensic Digital Imaging: Applications and Techniques provides the most up-to-date information on digital imaging in the forensic sciences. Written at a basic level, this book begins with an introduction to technical aspects of digital photo imaging, hardware, and storage of media, light, and filters; information on 35mm cameras is presented for comparison. Organized by scene and by crime, various techniques for photographing specific kinds of evidence, such as impression evidence, blood, and documents, are detailed. The text also covers photographic evidence in the context of law and testimony and contains exercises, case studies, and the latest FBI recommendations on digital imaging.
Auerbach Publications February 2011: 235x156: 250pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1370-6: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1372-0: £49.99/17
CRC Press «Market: Forensics and Criminal Justice January 2011: 254x178: 440pp Hb: 978-1-4200-6012-6: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-6013-3: £63.99/17
2nd Edition
Bitemark Evidence
Scientific Protocols for Forensic Examination of Clothing
A Color Atlas and Text Edited by Robert B.J. Dorion, Laboratoire de Sciences Judiciaires et de Médecine Légale, Canada
Jane Moira Taupin, Greensboro, Australia and Chesterene Cwiklik, Cwiklik and Associates, Seattle, Washington, USA
Series: International Forensic Science and Investigation
The first of its kind, this text describes and discusses the forensic examination of clothing in criminal cases. It examines the ramifications of DNA profiling and its effect on the screening approach to clothing examination. Coverage includes protocols, procedures, and philosophy; preliminary assessment; examination; testing and sampling; quality assurance and control; and the significance of results. Author, Jane Moira Taupin has testified as a forensic expert more than 130 times. Chesterene Cwiklik is a founder of the Pacific Coast Forensic Science Institute. Their expertise makes this a valuable resource for all those who examine clothing items and interpret subsequent findings. CRC Press «Market: Forensics and Criminal Justice November 2010: 254x178: 248pp Hb: 978-1-4200-6821-4: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-6823-8: £82.00/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
The first stand-alone textbook on the subject, this reference compiles the expertise and recommendations of a team of 21 eminent specialists from the disciplines of forensic odontology, DNA analysis, pathology, and jurisprudence to illustrate the many facets of bitemark recognition, diagnosis, handling, excision, lifting, transillumination, storage, preservation, transportation, analysis, and comparison. With more than 543 black and white photographs and 32 full-color pages, the book illustrates animal and human bitemarks on the living, the deceased, and on objects, incorporating sections on the history of bitemark evidence, salivary DNA, genotypic comparison of oral bacteria, and more. CRC Press February 2011: 279x216: 552pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1862-6: £127.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1863-3: £127.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8247-5414-3
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Series: Protocols in Forensic Science
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
forensic science 237
Practical Methods for Legal Investigations
Quality Assurance in the Pathology Laboratory
Concepts and Protocols in Civil and Criminal Cases
Forensic, Technical, and Ethical Aspects
Dean A. Beers, CLI, Forensic Investigators of Colorado, LLC, La Porte, USA
Edited by Maciej J. Bogusz, Consulting Toxicologist, Germany
Written as a step-by-step handbook on methodically finding and reporting evidence in every aspect of the investigative process, this text is both a training guide and textbook. The processes described are meant to assist both novices and skilled investigators in all professions, including investigative journalists. It examines the protocols and principles that cover the finer details of legal investigation and presents a model of five simple investigative steps. This text documents the complete investigation process, from the beginning steps of gathering facts to how to presenting the attorney with a complete picture of the case based upon the facts. CRC Press «Market: Forensics and Criminal Justice January 2011: 254x178: 320pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4484-7: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4485-4: £57.99/17
Written to improve laboratory work, this volume also examines logistic and legal tools related to quality issues. Authored by researchers long involved with theoretical and practical laboratory activity, the first part concerns selected aspects of quality assurance of quantifiable methods, applied in laboratory medicine and toxicology. In the second part, quality aspects of emerging disciplines – personalized therapy and virtopsy – are discussed. The next chapters present regulatory and logistic instrumentation. A final section considers the quality of professional education at the graduate and postgraduate level in pathology and laboratory medicine. CRC Press «Market: Forensics and Criminal Justice February 2011: 235x156: 384pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0234-2: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0235-9: £63.99/14
Cyber Criminology
Disaster Victim Identification
Exploring Internet Crimes and Criminal Behavior
Experience and Practice
Edited by K. Jaishankar, Manonmaniam Sundaranar University, India
L. Hackman and X. Mallet, both at University of Dundee, UK
Cybercrime is a newly emerging discipline that analyzes the changing nature and scope of victimization through the use of the internet. This newly updated volume explores the interface of computer science, internet science, and criminology. It includes a foreword by David S. Wall, the leading cybercrime scholar in the UK. The text covers such topics as cyberbullying, terrorist use of the internet, gambling, fraud, money laundering, cyberstalking, online sex solicitation, music and IP pirating, and human rights issues. The book serves as a leading reference and also provides an initial textbook presentation of the research available in this area.
Series: Global Perspectives on Disaster Victim Identification
CRC Press «Market: Forensics and Criminal Justice February 2011: 235x156: 424pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2949-3: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2950-9: £49.99/17
CRC Press «Market: Forensics and Criminal Justice June 2011: 235x156: 480pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9412-1: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9413-8: £82.00/17
Based on a selection of key historical incidents, this book provides a candid discussion of potential areas for improvement in preparedness and future deployment capabilities, written by the actual investigators. The book explores how mistakes of the future are more likely to be avoided if history’s lessons are available and future deployments may be more efficient and effectively executed as a result. Each chapter provide a summary of the case examined, details of the disaster, and a review of important aspects in terms of legislative, moral, practical, other considerations.
Effective Crime Reduction Strategies International Perspectives Edited by James F. Albrecht, St. John’s University, New York, USA and Dilip K. Das, International Police Executive Symposium, New York and Coppin State University, Baltimore, Maryland, USA Police worldwide are finding it increasingly difficult to prevent crime and maintain public safety and a sense of security while dealing with decreasing budgets and personnel. The exchange of effective crime fighting principles and proven best practices is crucial to helping them succeed. Drawn from the proceedings at the 2005 IPES meeting in the Czech Republic on effective crime prevention, this book addresses the impact of terrorism and transnational crime on law enforcement in the U.S. and Europe, the effects of democratic reforms on policing, and the positive influence of the unionization of police forces. It also reviews counterterrorism, border control, transnational criminality, measurement of police effectiveness, and the investigation of juvenile crimes.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
CRC Press «Market: Forensics and Criminal Justice December 2010: 235x156: 660pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7838-1: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7840-4: £82.00/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
238 food science textbook
3rd Edition
Food Process Engineering Operations
New Food Product Development
Series: Contemporary Food Engineering Current textbooks on food process engineering cover mainly the traditional unit operations of fluid flow and heat transfer, with less attention paid to mass transfer and important mechanical processing operations. This textbook provides needed balance with coverage of traditional unit operations, using updated engineering properties and data and simplified computer aided techniques. It discusses mechanical processing and novel food processes such as membrane separations and introduces elements of food packaging operations, hygiene aspects, food process design, and economics. It examines the effects of each process on the quality, safety, and physical structure of food products. CRC Press «Market: Food Science and Technology February 2011: 235x156: 656pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8353-8: £53.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8354-5: £53.99/17
2nd Edition
Handbook of Food Process Modeling and Statistical Quality Control Mustafa Ozilgen, Yeditepe University, Turkey Presenting mathematical prerequisites in summary tables, this book explains fundamental techniques of mathematical modeling processes essential to the food industry. The author focuses on providing an in-depth understanding of modeling techniques, rather than the finer mathematical points. Topics covered include modeling of transport phenomena, kinetic processes, and food engineering operations. The book also discusses statistical process analysis and quality control. It includes examples from almost every conceivable food process, most of which are based on real data given in the many references. Each example is followed by a clear, step- by-step worked solution. CRC Press «Market: Food Science and Technology February 2011: 254x178: 552pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1486-4: £121.00/17 Pb: 978-1-4398-1938-8: £115.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5620-8: £121.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-9-0569-9142-5
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Gordon W. Fuller, Guelph, Ontario, Canada This new edition of a bestselling text in food product development provides a comprehensive overview of the new food product development process. With refreshing new chapter titles and current real-world examples, the book describes the stages of development, beginning with sources of ideas, development, final screening, and introduction into the marketplace. The author outlines ways a company can organize for new product development and utilize available resources. Fuller focuses on the roles, functions, and interactions of the members of the food product development team as well as other company departments and outside resources in the food product development process. CRC Press «Market: Food Science and Technology January 2011: 235x156: 496pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1864-0: £59.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1865-7: £59.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-1673-9
Pocket Dictionary of Food Safety * Jeffrey T. Solate, Canadian Food Safety Institute A handy, illustrated dictionary, this reference is an ideal source of quick answers. A collection of terms and definitions, it covers related areas such as food microbiology, food chemistry, food quality assurance, food borne incidents, food regulations, standards, to name just a few. Pocket-sized for easy portability, this dictionary also classifies and organizes food safety terms from various sources in alphabetical listing. Readers will find it a perfect companion to other technical and industry materials. It draws from the areas pertinent to food science including biological and medical sciences, infectious diseases, community medicine, and public health. CRC Press November 2010: : 154pp Pb: 978-1-4398-4203-4: £27.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4205-8: £27.99/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
George D. Saravacos and Zacharias B. Maroulis, both at National Technical University of Athens, Greece
From Concept to Marketplace
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
food science 239
Probiotic Foods in Health and Disease Edited by G.B. Nair and Yoshifumi Takeda, Enfield, New Hampshire, USA A blend of fundamental and applied research, this volume looks at how probiotics can enhance human health. The book covers all aspects of intestinal microflora and while the focus remains on the recent findings in the field of gut health, this book also looks at the possible role of probiotics beyond the gut such as in oral health care, allergic disorders and women’s health. The book also reviews pertinent legislation across the globe with special emphasis on Japan, which pioneered the establishment of a regulatory framework for functional foods. Science Publishers «Market: Food Science and Technology November 2010: : 150pp Pb: 978-1-57808-698-6: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5220-0: £57.99/17
Environmental Effects on Seafood Availability, Safety, and Quality * Edited by Elzbieta G. Daczkowska-Kozon, Agrigultural University in Szczecin, Poland and Bonnie Sun-Pan, National Taiwan Ocean University, Taiwan Series: Chemical & Functional Properties of Food Components Addressing various aspects of seafood quality, this 12th volume in the Chemical & Functional Properties of Food Components series focuses on the effects of natural and anthropogenic environmental conditions on the availability of marine organisms harvested for food purposes. Particular emphasis is placed on how physical, chemical, and biological characteristics of the marine environment impact technological suitability, sensory quality, nutritional value, health-promoting activity, and safety aspects of raw seafood materials. The authors explain how to enhance the desirable sensory quality and health effects of various marine food products. The text also explores the health risks and benefits of consuming seafood. CRC Press «Market: Food Science and Technology December 2010: 235x156: 395pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0327-1: £108.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0328-8: £108.00/17
Biosensors in Food Processing, Safety, and Quality Control Edited by Mehmet Mutlu, Hacettepe University, Turkey Series: Contemporary Food Engineering This book details the latest developments in sensing technology and its application in food industry. It explores the opportunities created by the chemical and biosensensing technology and improvements performed in recent years for better food quality, better food safety, better food processing and control, and better input for food industry. The chapters in this book have been divided into three sections: basic principles of chemical and biosensing technology, biosensors for food processing and control, and biosensors for food safety.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Analysis Instrumentation and Methods Edited by Leo M.L. Nollet, University College Ghent, Belgium and Arjon van Hengel, European Commission Joint Research Centre, Belgium Covering all of the major recognized food allergens in the US and EU, this comprehensive work begins with an introduction to the problem and prevalence of food allergens. It discusses health issues and the presence of allergens in various food products, examines methodologies for analysis and detection, and details specific methods for each food type. Maintaining a consistent structure and format throughout, each chapter describes the properties of the allergen, and demonstrates the appropriate sample extraction and clean-up, separation and analysis, and detection and quantification techniques. CRC Press «Market: Food Science and Technology December 2010: 235x156: 228pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1503-8: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1505-2: £95.00/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
CRC Press «Market: Food Science and Technology December 2010: 235x156: 392pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1985-2: £99.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1986-9: £99.00/17
Food Allergens
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
240 food science
Nutrition, Epigenetic Mechanisms, and Human Disease Edited by Nilanjana Maulik, University of Connecticut, Farmington, USA and Gautam Maulik, Harvard Medical School, Boston, USA Extensive research on nutrigenomics has unveiled numerous epigenetic mechanisms that are influenced by our dietary signature. This book illustrates how nutrition can influence epigenetic inheritance and the mechanisms that underlie modification of the metabolic imprint of an individual. The text discusses the basics of nutrigenomics and epigenetic regulation, types of nutrition influencing genetic imprinting, and the role of nutrition in modulating an individual’s predisposition to disease. It also covers epigenetic variation, genomic imprinting, maternal nutrition, neonatal nutrition, as well as epigenetics and nutrition relating to cancer, heart disease, and obesity. CRC Press «Market: Nutrition
December 2010: 235x156: 413pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0479-7: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0482-7: £89.00/17
A Guide to Obesity and the Metabolic Syndrome
Agricultural and Biological Engineering Education
Arthritis
Origins and Treatment
Global Perspectives and Current Practice
George A. Bray, Louisiana State University, Baton Rouge, USA
Edited by Umezuruike Linus Opara, Stellenbosch University, South Africa
Examining the dramatic and growing epidemic of obesity, this book presents the history and origins of the problem, its etiology, and the various components necessary to develop effective intervention and treatment strategies. The first section covers the history of obesity, defines and evaluates the clinical presentation of the pathology, discusses its prevalence in the population, and explains common analytical measurements. Chapters include genetics and genetic factors, modern consequences of obesity, and quality of life issues. The second section introduces prevention strategies in children and adults, such as dietary and lifestyle changes, medication, and surgical interventions.
Series: Contemporary Food Engineering
Edited by Debasis Bagchi, University of Houston College of Pharmacy, Texas, USA, Hiroyoshi Moriyama, Showa Pharmaceutical University, Japan and Siba P. Raychaudhuri, University of California, Davis, USA and VA Medical Center Sacarmento, USA
order now!
CRC Press «Market: Food Science and Technology May 2011: 235x156: 576pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0771-2: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0772-9: £82.00/17
Written as an overall analysis of available arthritis treatments, this book covers pathophysiology, traditional medicine, alternative therapies, and lifestyle changes. The book focuses on treatment regiments, including synthetic drugs, their safety and toxicity; natural and herbal products; healthy foods; and non pharmacologic interventions such as acupuncture and psychosocial management. It covers preventative strategies for rheumatoid arthritis and osteoarthritis as well. The association of arthritis in obesity, hypertension, and cardiovascular disease is highlighted. Extensive research on natural products is also included within the text, as is information on synthetic drugs such as COX-2 inhibitors. Tables, figures, and charts are used throughout. CRC Press «Market: Nutrition March 2011: 235x156: 392pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1686-8: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1687-5: £89.00/17
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
CRC Press «Market: Nutrition February 2011: 254x178: 352pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1457-4: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1458-1: £57.99/17
Providing a comprehensive review of existing approaches to agricultural engineering (AE) education and curriculum reform, this book highlights different models of AE education, including historical development, curriculum design, course contents, industrial training, and graduate attributes. Chapters describe design projects, internships, and capstones; present specific pedagogies and instructional tools for program delivery and evaluation; and discuss emerging issues.
Pathophysiology, Prevention, and Therapeutics
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
food science 241 Diet and Nutrition in Palliative Care
Fruit and Cereal Bioactives *
Handbook of Nutraceuticals
Edited by Victor R. Preedy, King’s College, UK
Sources, Chemistry, and Applications
With contributions from international experts, this pioneering work defines palliative care and endof-life care while also covering methods of pain control and sedation. It presents general concerns and information on critical care factors such as hydration, dysphagia, artificial nutrition, home nutritional support, and other specific aspects for hospice patients. It provides extensive coverage on nutritional guidelines and diet therapy, along with research on nutrition for patients with incurable types of cancer, dementia, and HIV/AIDS, as well as those in a vegetative state. Discussion of proper diet related to palliative care, including surgery and wound healing, is also included.
Edited by Ozlem Tokusoglu, Celal Bayer University, Turkey and Clifford A Hall III, North Dakota State University, Fargo, USA
Volume II: Scale-Up, Processing and Automation
CRC Press «Market: Nutrition March 2011: 235x156: 480pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1932-6: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1933-3: £89.00/17
Diet, Nutrients, and Bone Health Edited by John J.B. Anderson, University of North Carolina, Chapel Hill, USA, Sanford C. Garner, SRA International, Durham, USA and Philip J. Klemmer, University of North Carolina, Chapel Hill, USA Presenting recent advancements in research findings and the resulting new schools of thought on the physiology of human bone, this comprehensive reference examines information on dietary pattern and specific nutrients in bone health. Written by experts in the areas of nutrition, bone function, and medicine, chapters include research on a variety of bone-related topics including effects of vitamins, nutrients, and antioxidants; dietary requirements; physical exercise; bone hormones; lifestyle and effects through the life cycle; race and ethnicity; and prevention of bone diseases including osteopenia and osteoporosis. CRC Press «Market: Nutrition April 2011: 235x156: 320pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1955-5: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1956-2: £82.00/17
Presenting up-to-date data in an easy-to-use format, this comprehensive overview of the chemistry of bioactive components of fruits and cereals addresses the role of these compounds in determining taste, flavor, and color, as well as recent claims of anticarginogenic, antimutagenic, and antioxidant capabilities. It provides detailed information on both beneficial bioactives such as phenolics, flavonoids, tocols, carotenoids, phytosterols, and avenanthramides and toxicant compounds including mycotoxins; aflatoxins, ocratoxin A, patulin, citrinin, cyclopiazonic acid, fumonisin, and zearalenon. A valuable resource for current knowledge and further research, it offers critical reviews, recent research, case studies, and references.
Focusing on the scale up, processing, and automation of nutraceutical production under cGMP production regulations, this volume introduces processing techniques including homogenization, particle size reduction, emulsification, and cell disruption as well as high shear fluid processing with high precision, uniformity, and predictability. It addresses factors that enhance nutritional value, color, taste, and texture and presents computer simulation and modeling techniques used in scaling and processing. It discusses the aspects and applications of a wide range of processing techniques such as continuous vs. batch processing, pelletization, extrusion, extraction, and purification and addresses current challenges and future trends.
CRC Press «Market: Food Science and Technology December 2010: 254x178: 456pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0665-4: £108.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0667-8: £108.00/17
CRC Press «Market: Food Science and Technology March 2011: 235x156: 456pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2368-2: £108.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2370-5: £108.00/17
2nd Edition
2nd Edition
Edible Coatings and Films to Improve Food Quality
Frying of Food
Edited by Elizabeth A. Baldwin, Robert Hagenmaier and Jinhe Bai, all at USDA, ARS, CSPL, Winter Haven, Florida, USA The second edition of Edible Coatings and Films to Improve Food Quality presents the latest research in coating materials, permeability properties, and measurement techniques. Updated chapters provide new information on the main materials used as film formers in coatings, including proteins, lipids, resins, and polysaccharides. The text covers the permeability properties of coatings and techniques to measure permeability. Additional chapters discuss the use and function of additives as well as experimental and commercial coatings for various types of foods. A new chapter focuses on regulatory aspects. With expanded application areas, this book also discusses special types of coatings for encapsulation and pharmaceuticals.
for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
CRC Press «Market: Food Science and Technology March 2011: 235x156: 408pp Hb: 978-1-4200-5962-5: £121.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-5966-3: £121.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5667-6113-0
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
Yashwant Vishnupant Pathak, Sullivan University, Louisville, Kentucky, USA
Oxidation, Nutrient and Non-Nutrient Antioxidants, Biologically Active Compounds and High Temperatures Edited by Dimitrios Boskou, Aristotle University of Thessaloniki, Greece and Ibrahim Elmadfa, University of Vienna, Austria This important resource concentrates mainly on two factors that influence the deterioration of a fat at elevated temperatures: the nature of the heated fat and the presence of oxidation retardants, especially those naturally occurring in oils or obtained from natural sources. Discussions include important biologically active ingredients present in oils and fats and minor constituents, which appear to affect the performance of a heated oil and/or may also be categorized as functional. Frying of Food also discusses olar phenolic compounds which have an impact on the stability of oils at high temperatures. CRC Press «Market: Food Science and Technology December 2010: 235x156: 334pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0682-1: £99.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5667-6786-6
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
242 food science Introduction to Food Process Engineering *
Marine Polysaccharides
Ohmic Heating in Food Processing
Food Applications
Albert Ibarz, University of Lleida, Spain and Gustavo V. Barbosa-Canovas, Washington State University, Pullman, USA
Vazhiyil Venugopal, Indian Institute of Technology, Mumbai
Edited by Michele Marcotte, Agriculture & Agri-Food Canada, Canada, Hosahalli S. Ramaswamy, McGill University, Canada, Sudhir Sastry, The Ohio State University, Columbus, USA, Khalid Abdelrahim, Campbell Soup Company, Camden, New Jersey, USA and Peter J. Fryer, University of Birmingham, UK
Series: Food Preservation Technology A basic introduction to the principles of food process engineering, this textbook covers the physical properties of food, traditional fluid mechanics, and heat transfer via conduction, convection, and radiation. It examines transport phenomena, momentum, energy and mass balances, as well as macroscopic balances. It reviews the basic principles of physics, provides references and exercise problems. CRC Press «Market: Food Science and Technology April 2011: 235x156: 528pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0918-1: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0919-8: £57.99/17
Management-Based Quality Systems in the Food Industry Debby Newslow, D.L. Newslow and Associates, Inc., Orlando, USA The value of an effective well-defined, implemented, and maintained management system is priceless. Based on the requirements of ISO 900 I, ISO 22000, and PAS 220, this text provides a collection of participation-based tools that can be applied to the development, implementation, and maintenance of a management-based system in the food industry. The book clearly explains how to choose the right system for an organization, what the requirements are, how to identify gaps in the system, and ways to integrate these resources into individual operations. The author also compares ISO and HACCP programs as well as includes case studies from professionals. CRC Press «Market: Food Science and Technology February 2011: 235x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2679-9: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2680-5: £89.00/17
Consolidating the most recent information on polysaccharides and the efficient use of seafood wastes, this book discusses applications of marine polysaccharides in food product development and other areas. Chapters include isolation and characterization of chitin and its derivatives in seafood wastes, production of carrageenan, algin, agar, and fucoidan from seaweed, and the associated properties of these compounds. It discusses the potential functional roles of these polysaccharides in development of various food products, both of animal (including muscle and dairy) and vegetable origin, and their possible role as edible films and carriers of nutrients. CRC Press «Market: Food Science and Technology January 2011: 235x156: 360pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1526-7: £108.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1527-4: £108.00/14
2nd Edition
Methods of Analysis of Food Components and Additives Edited by Semih Otles, Ege University, Turkey Series: Chemical & Functional Properties of Food Components Methods of Analysis for Food Components and Additives is a concise presentation of the state of the art in the analysis of food components. The author brings together an international team of experts to summarize key findings on novel methods of analysis of food components, additives, and contaminants, including the identification, speciation, and determination of components in raw materials and food products. They discuss all major classes of food components and contaminants along with components of current interest to the nutraceutical and functional foods industries. CRC Press «Market: Food Science and Technology May 2011: 235x156: 512pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1552-6: £108.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1553-3: £108.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-1647-0
2nd Edition
Melatonin in the Promotion of Health Edited by Ronald Ross Watson, University of Arizona, Tucson, USA This new edition presents information on how melatonin is synthesized and produced in the body as well as how this hormone affects several diseases. The book heavily focuses on prevention as well as treatment of various human disease states including behavior disorders, mental disorders, breast cancer, bone health, and gastrointestinal diseases. It covers the role of melatonin in the prevention of oxidative stress, mutagenesis, sun damage, ocular health, gut motility, and detoxification. It also presents mechanisms of melatonin action in humans including cell modulation, signaling mechanisms, protective effects, and melatonin receptors as well as its role as an antioxidant.
Series: Electro-Technologies for Food Processing Series This book covers all aspects of ohmic heating, its science and engineering, chemistry and physics, biochemistry and nutrition, quality and safety, development and technology, both basic and applied. It provides a general overview of ohmic processing, such as the basic concepts of electricity, the efforts of electricity on foods, the effects of electricity on microorganisms and enzymes, and a comparison of ohmic heating and other heating methods. In addition to providing the basic theory, principles and applications of ohmic heating technology, the book will provide examples of applications these technologies for different classes of food products. CRC Press «Market: Food Science and Technology May 2011: 235x156: 500pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7108-5: £114.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7109-2: £114.00/17
2nd Edition
Unit Operations in Food Engineering Albert Ibarz, University of Lleida, Spain and Gustavo V. Barbosa-Canovas, Washington State University, Pullman, USA Series: Food Preservation Technology In order to successfully produce food products with maximum quality, each stage of processing must be well-designed. Unit Operations in Food Engineering systematically presents the basic information necessary to design food processes and the equipment needed to carry them out. It covers the most common food engineering unit operations in detail, including guidance for carrying out specific design calculations. Initial chapters present transport phenomena basics for momentum, mass, and energy transfer in different unit operations. Later chapters present detailed unit operation descriptions based on fluid transport and heat and mass transfer. Every chapter concludes with a series of solved problems. CRC Press «Market: Food Science and Technology April 2011: 235x156: 528pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0944-0: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0945-7: £57.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5667-6929-7
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
CRC Press «Market: Nutrition May 2011: 235x156: 350pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3979-9: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3980-5: £82.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-8564-3
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
architecture
TOP TEN BESTSELLERS
Architecture 243
1.
6. Form & Fabric in Landscape Architecture
3rd Edition
Analysing Architecture Simon Unwin
A Visual Introduction
2009: 276x219: 296pp Pb: 978-0-415-48928-7: £24.99/04
2.
Catherine Dee 2001: 229x218 Pb: 978-0-415-24638-5: £27.99/04
7. Theatre Buildings
2nd Edition
Renewable Energy Resources
A Design Guide
John Twidell and Tony Weir
Association of British Theatre Technicians
2005: 234x156: 624pp Pb: 978-0-419-25330-3: £37.99/17
Edited by Judith Strong
3.
2010: 276x219: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-54894-6: £39.99/03
8. Housing Design Handbook
Rethinking Architecture
A Guide to Good Practice
A Reader in Cultural Theory
David Levitt
Neil Leach
2009: 276x219: 288pp Pb: 978-0-415-49150-1: £34.99/17
1997: 246x174: 432pp Pb: 978-0-415-12826-1: £31.99/17
4.
9. Best Tall Buildings 2009
Smartcities and Eco-Warriors
Edited by Antony Wood
C.J. Lim and Ed Liu
2009: 254x203: 168pp Hb: 978-0-415-77974-6: £29.99/17
2010: 276x219: 256pp Pb: 978-0-415-57124-1: £29.99/04
5.
10. Twenty Buildings Every Architect Should Understand
Heidegger for Architects Adam Sharr 2007: 216x138: 144pp Pb: 978-0-415-41517-0: £15.99/04
Simon Unwin
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
2010: 276x219: 240pp Pb: 978-0-415-55252-3: £16.99/04
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
244 Architecture
Architecture, Crisis and Resuscitation
Daylighting Architecture and Lighting Design Peter Tregenza, University of Sheffield, UK and Michael Wilson, University of Westminster, UK
The Reproduction of Post-Fordism in Late-Twentieth-Century Architecture Tahl Kaminer, Delft School of Design, the Netherlands Studying the relation of architecture to society, this book explains the manner in which the discipline of architecture adjusted itself in order to satisfy new pressures by society. It offers an understanding of contemporary conditions and phenomena, from the ubiquity of landmark buildings to the celebrity status of architects. It concerns the period spanning from 1966 to the first years of the current century – a period which saw radical change in economy, politics, and culture and a period in which architecture radically transformed, substituting the alleged dreariness of modernism with spectacle. Selected Contents: Foreword Hilde Heynen Introduction Part 1: Crisis and Withdrawal Part 2: Autonomy and the Resuscitation of the Discipline Part 3: The Real Epilogue: From the Ideal to the Simulacra and Back Routledge «Market: Architectural History January 2011: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-57823-3: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57824-0: £29.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83184-7: £95.00/14
Benjamin for Architects * Brian Elliott, University of Oregon, USA Series: Thinkers for Architects
Selected Contents: 1. Criteria 2. What Light Does 3. Daylight Climate 4. Daylight and the Form of Buildings 5. Energy and Control 6. Standards, Design Guidance, Development Control 7. Daylight Factors 8. Daylight Illuminance 9. Collecting Daylight 10. Daylight Coefficients and Numerical Models 11. Notes, References Worksheets Algorithms, Equations Routledge «Market: Architecture / Building / Planning February 2011: 276x219: 304pp Pb: 978-0-419-25700-4: £39.99/04
Derrida for Architects Richard Coyne, University of Edinburgh, UK Series: Thinkers for Architects
Selected Contents: Introduction 1. Metropolitanism and Method 2. Radicalism and Revolution 3. Modernism and Memory 4. Utopianism and Utility 5. Participation and Politics 6. Benjamin’s Memorial Routledge «Market: Architecture / Philosophy / Architectural History and Theory December 2010: 216x138: 144pp Hb: 978-0-415-55814-3: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-55815-0: £15.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83387-2: £65.00/14
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Looking afresh at Jacques Derrida’s thinking in relation to architecture, this book simplifies his ideas in a clear, concise way. Derrida‘s treatment of key philosophical texts has been labelled as ‘deconstruction,’ a term that resonates with architecture. Although his main focus is language, his thinking has been applied by architectural theorists widely. As well as a review of Derrida’s interaction with architecture, this book is also a careful consideration of the implications of his thinking, particularly on the way architecture is practiced. An ideal introduction for architects and architecture students. Selected Contents: 1. Introduction 2. The Senses 3. Metaphor 4. Economics 5. Institutions 6. Derrida on Architecture Routledge «Market: Architecture / Philosophy / Architectural History and Theory March 2011: 216x138: 128pp Hb: 978-0-415-59178-2: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59179-9: £15.99/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Walter Benjamin has become a decisive reference point for a whole range of critical disciplines, as he constructed a unique and provocative synthesis of aesthetics, politics and philosophy. Examining Benjamin’s contributions to cultural criticism in relation to the works of Max Ernst, Adolf Loos, Le Corbusier and Sigfried Giedion, this book also situates Benjamin’s work within more recent developments in architecture and urbanism. This is a concise, coherent account of the relevance of Walter Benjamin’s writings to architects, locating Benjamin’s critical work within the context of contemporary architecture and urbanism.
order now!
This authoritative and multi-disciplinary book sets out a new approach to daylight design based on daylight’s essential variability and centrality of people to lighting design. The book is well-structured with worksheets giving step by step examples of calculations and design procedures for use in practice and a collection of algorithms and equations for reference. Highly illustrated, it provides a new set of useful tools for the practitioner and researcher. This is an invaluable resource for architects, building engineers, interior designers and town planners.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
Architecture 245
Eleven Exercises in the Art of Architectural Drawing
Short Stories: London in Two-and-a-Half Dimensions
Slow-Food for the Architect’s Imagination
CJ Lim and Ed Liu, both at Bartlett School of Planning, UCL, UK
Marco Frascari, Carleton University, Canada
Combining place and fiction in an imaginative interpretation of 12 sites in the city of London, CJ Lim and Ed Liu take familiar places, institutions and landmarks in the British capital and render them fantastic. The book is an intersection of paper assemblages with short stories. The stories have been exhibited at the Royal Academy of Arts and Victoria and Albert Museum but are collected for the first time in this single volume, laid out as they were designed to be seen as one phantasmogoric city vision. Beautifully illustrated, this collection designs a vision of London immoral, anarchic and unscientific and at the same time glorious, ravishing and a pleasure to behold.
This book deals with the critical nature and crucial role of architectural drawings. Organized around eleven exercises, the book does not emphasise speed, nor incorporates many timesaving tricks typical of drawing books, but rather proposes a slow, meditative process for construing drawings and for drawing constructing thoughts. Selected Contents: Preface 1. Architectural Iconoclasm 2. The Cosmopoiesis of Architectural Drawings 3. Festina Lente 4. Drawings as Loci for Thought 5. The Pregnancy of Drawings 6. Nullo die sine linea 7. Architectural Consciousness 8. Architectural Brouillons: Work Intended to be Recopied 9. Cosmopoiesis and Elegant Drawings 10. Traces and Architecture 11. Tools for Architectural Thinking 12. Disegnare Designare 13. The Light of Drawing Imagination 14. Cosmopoiesis and World-Making Postface Routledge «Market: Architecture and Architectural Theory March 2011: 246x189: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-77925-8: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-77926-5: £29.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83585-2: £95.00/14
Selected Contents: 1. Introduction 2. Prologue 3. SW11 4. SE10 5. SE1: Living in the City 6. EC 1: Nocturnal Tower 7. E1 to W4 8. EC4 9. W1. The Baker’s Garden 10. W2 11. NW1: the Bunny Club 12. Any Public Square in London Routledge «Market: Architecture / Design February 2011: 186x123: 192pp Pb: 978-0-415-57358-0: £19.99/04
Prospects for an Ethics of Architecture
Spatial Agency: Other Ways of Doing Architecture
William Taylor and Michael Levine, both at University of Western Australia, Australia
Tatjana Schneider, University of Sheffield, UK, Jeremy Till, University of Westminster, UK and Nishat Awan, University of Sheffield, UK
çè
Selected Contents: 1. Ethics, Architecture and Philosophy 2. Architecture, Ethics and Aesthetics 3. Architecture and Culture 4. Experiencing Architetcure 5. Writing on ‘The Wall’ 6. Building Community Routledge «Market: Architecture / Architectural Theory February 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-58971-0: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58972-7: £29.99/04
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
This book offers the first comprehensive overview of alternative approaches to architectural practice. At a time when many commentators are noting that alternative and richer approaches to architectural practice are required if the profession is to flourish, this book provides multiple examples from across the globe of how this has been achieved and how it might be achieved in the future. Particularly pertinent in the current economic climate, this book offers the reader new approaches to architectural practice in a changing world, it makes essential reading for any architect, aspiring or practising. Selected Contents: Part 1. Overview of Spatial Agency Part 2. Encyclopaedia of Spatial Agency Routledge «Market: Architecture March 2011: 276x219: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-57192-0: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57193-7: £24.99/04
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Bringing together the reflections of an architectural theorist and a philosopher, this book encourages philosophers and architects, scholars and designers alike, to reconsider what they do as well as what they can do in the face of challenging times. It does so by exploring the notion that architecture and design can (and possibly should), in their own right, make for a distinctive form of ethical investigation. The built environment contributes to the inculcation of all sorts of values (good and bad). Thus, this book aims to change the way people commonly think about ethics, not only in relation to the built environment, but to themselves, their ways of thinking and modes of behaviour.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
246 Architecture
Sustainability and the Design of Transport Interchanges
Towards Creative Learning Spaces * Re-thinking the Architecture of Post-Compulsory Education Jos Boys, British Higher School of Art and Design, Russia
Brian Edwards, Royal Danish Academy of Fine Arts, Denmark The interchange is a new form of transport building which integrates into a single whole various modes of public transport, putting the passenger first (rather than the infrastructure). This idea of ‘interchange’ is increasingly relevant as town planners, engineers and architects address the question of sustainable development with its emphasis on energy efficiency, social cohesion, access for the elderly, and urban regeneration. Exploring the phenomenon of the transport interchange with particular focus upon the need to achieve sustainable development through better design and management of transport infrastructure, this book presents design principles for transport interchanges and offers analysis of best practice in the UK and abroad. Selected Contents: Part 1: Concepts, Ideas and Evolution Part 2: Design Strategies Part 3: Examples from Recent Practice Part 4: Conclusions Routledge «Market: Architectural Design / Structural Design January 2011: 276x219: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-46449-9: £44.99/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83965-2: £45.00/14
Looking at relationships between learning and the spaces in which it takes place, this book considers post-compulsory education and what matters about the design of its spaces. Starting from contemporary educational and architectural theories, the book offers conceptual frameworks and methods that can map the social and spatial practices of university education. Selected Contents: 1. Why Re-think Learning Spaces Part 1: Reviewing our Frames 2. Architectural Perspective 3. Educationalist Perspective 4. Estates Planning Perspective Part 2: Mapping the Terrain 5. Getting Beneath the Surface 6. Searching for the Student Experience 7. Shaping Learning Part 3: Shifting the Boundaries 8. Learning as a Transitional Space 9. Hybrid Spaces and the Impact of New Technologies 10. Creative Learning Spaces Routledge «Market: Architecture / Education November 2010: 234x156: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-57062-6: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57064-0: £29.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83589-0: £95.00/14
reader
The EcoEdge
The Religious Imagination in Modern and Contemporary Architecture
Urgent Design Challenges in Building Sustainable Cities Esther Charlesworth, RMIT University, Melbourne and Rob Adams, Director of Design and Urban Environment, City of Melbourne Presenting diverse case studies of contemporary sustainable urban practice from Europe, Africa, India, South America, the USA and Australia, this book offers the reader a fantastic wealth of practical material from a range of internationally renowned authors. Divided into three parts, each part is introduced by a thematic overview essay by an internationally respected design scholar, on sustainability and their field of practice. These essays offer insights on principles and comparisons illustrated by each case study chapter that follows. Highly illustrated, thematically focused and with a superb global coverage, this book presents a multi-voiced and yet highly cohesive reference for anyone interested in green issues in urban design and architecture.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Edited by Renata Hejduk, Arizona State University, USA and Jim Williamson, Cornell University, USA This anthology is the first survey that collects, substantiates, and demonstrates the importance of the religious imagination within Western modern and contemporary architecture. The essays written for the anthology take a critical look at the relationship between religion and architecture in the twentieth century, also giving a brief look at the pre-history of the modern movement and its relationship to religion and architecture. These are grounded by and help to explicate the reprinted essays from names as Michael Benedikt, Peter Carl, John Hejduk, and Sanford Kwinter. This is an important introduction to the religious imagination in architectural thought, and to the interdisciplinary discourse that examines how different disciplines express abstract concepts such as faith, spirit, God and knowledge. It makes essential reading for any architect, aspiring or practising, delving deeper into the meaning of architectural practice. Routledge «Market: Architecture / Religion March 2011: 254x190: 432pp Hb: 978-0-415-78080-3: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-78081-0: £29.99/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Selected Contents: Part 1: Urban Design and a Sustainable City Part 2: Infrastructure and a Sustainable City Part 3: Architecture and Sustainable City Routledge «Market: Architecture / Urban Design March 2011: 246x189: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-57247-7: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57248-4: £29.99/04
A Reader
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
Architecture 247
The Art of Structures Aurelio Muttoni, Structural Concrete Laboratory, EPFL, Switzerland This book looks at the complete panorama of supporting structures and their function by describing how loads are sustained and transmitted to the ground. With a minimum of mathematics, it guides the reader through analysis of some of the world’s most famous designs and structures from a civil-engineering perspective. Taking an intuitive approach, the basics of equilibrium analysis are explained by visualizing the internal forces of specific structures with the aid of simple graphical tools. Selected Contents: Foreword. Introduction 1. Forces and Equilibrium, Internal Forces, Resistance and Stiffness 2. Cables 3. Networks of Cables, Tents and Membranes 4. Arcs 5. Archways, Domes and Shells 6. The Arch-Cable 7. Trusses 8. Trusses in Space 9. Beams 10. Frames 11. Wall Beams 12. Ribbed Slabs 13. Beam Grids 14. Slabs 15. Stability of Elements Under Compression Routledge «Market: Architecture / Civil Engineering / Construction November 2010: Special: 280pp Pb: 978-0-415-61029-2: £34.99/04
Vernacular Architecture of West Africa Jean-Paul Bourdier and Trinh T. Minh-ha, both at University of California at Berkeley, USA The living environments of hundreds of African ethnic groups offer a variety of ideas and construction practices which contradict the over-played image of primitive huts that have come to represent rural Africa. Each house or group of houses is conceived not only to shelter the family but also to facilitate communication with ancestors and the divinities and to be in tune with nature. This cultural dimension and its application using different architectural practices are fantastically illustrated in this work, with examples taken from the habitats of different ethnic groups of south and west Africa. Designs, plans, axonometrics, and photography make the beauty and complexity of this architecture abundantly clear, showing that it is as much a real life work of art as it is a place to live. Selected Contents: Part 1: Habitat and Living Environment Part 2: Architectural Practice Routledge «Market: Architecture March 2011: Special: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-58543-9: £49.99/04
2nd Edition
The Structural Basis of Architecture Bjorn N. Sandaker and Arne P. Eggen, both at Oslo School of Architecture, Norway and Mark R. Cruvellier, Cornell University, New York, USA One of the most important subjects in the education of an architect is building structures. This textbook is by authors teaching and working in both architecture and structural engineering fields. Approached in a qualitative, discursive manner, the subject is illustrated by many photographs of architectural projects and structural behaviour diagrams. Examples are drawn from both historical and contemporary projects. This new edition, perfect as a course text, includes plenty of worked-out examples and problems.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Selected Contents: 1. Structuring Space 2. Statics 3. Loads in an Architectural Context 4. Materials 5. The Tension Rod 6. The Beam and the Slab 7. The Column and the Wall 8. The Truss and the Space Frame 9. The Frame and Lateral Stability 10. The Cable and the Membrane 11. The Arch and the Vault 12. The Dome and the Shell Routledge «Market: Architecture February 2011: 8.5x11: 368pp Hb: 978-0-415-41545-3: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-41547-7: £24.99/04
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
248 planning
Methods and Techniques for Performing Tasks with Efficiency
European Gardens History, Philosophy and Design Tom Turner, Greenwich University, UK arden design and usage has been a G feature of human civilisation as far back as Neolithic times, when the first gardens began to be used for residential, horticultural and sacred tasks. Tom Turner follows the entire history of the European garden from its prehistoric roots right up to the present day in this beautifully illustrated and insightful book featuring the author’s own plans and maps. An ideal companion to Asian Gardens.
Anastassios Perdicoulis, UTAD and FEUP, Portugal and Oxford Institute for Sustainable Development, Oxford Brookes, UK Series: Natural and Built Environment This textbook for planning students and practitioners explains how to develop the necessary technical competences to perform practical tasks efficiently; how to make and assessing the quality of development proposals. Tasso Perdicoulis presents suitable techniques for a wide range of planning tasks, illustrates the application of those techniques with best practice examples and shows how to guard against potential pitfalls. Selected Contents: 1. Introduction 2. Starting Point 3. Desired End Point 4. Action Proposal 5. Test-Flight, or Ex-Ante Assessment 6. Proof of Performance, or Ex-Post Assessment 7. Epilogue: Facing the Future Routledge «Market: Planning March 2011: 234x156: 200pp Hb: 978-0-415-59454-7: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59456-1: £29.99/04
City Design Modernist, Traditional, Green and Systems Perspectives Jonathan Barnett, University of Pennsylvania, USA Jonathan Barnett is an experienced urban designer and professor who describes in this book the four most widely accepted approaches to city design: Modernist, Traditional, Green and Systems. Drawing on their history, theory, practice, pros and cons, Barnett provides an accessible text on city design ideal for planners, landscape architects, urban designers and those interested in how to improve cities. Selected Contents: Introduction: Three City Design Challenges 1. Modernist City Design 2. Traditional City Design and the Modern City 3. Green City Design and Climate Change 4. Systems City Design Conclusion: The Fifth Way Routledge «Market: Urban Design / Architecture / Planning January 2011: 246x189: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-77540-3: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-77541-0: £31.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Selected Contents: Preface 1. Design Philosophy 2. Garden Origins 10,000–1,000 BCE 3. Egyptian Gardens 2,000 BCE–1000 BCE 4. Classical Gardens 1400 BCE–500 AD 5. Medieval Gardens 600 AD–1500 AD 6. Renaissance Gardens 1350–1650 7. Baroque Gardens 1600–1750 8. Neoclassical and Romantic Gardens 1700–1810 9. Eclectic Gardens 1800–1900 10. Abstract and Post-Abstract Gardens 1900–2000 Notes. Picture Credits. Index Routledge «Market: Gardening / Garden History March 2011: Special: 512pp Hb: 978-0-415-49684-1: £35.00/08
Insurgencies: Essays in Planning Theory John Friedmann, UCLA, USA Series: RTPI Library This collection of Friedmann’s most influential essays tells a coherent, compelling story about how the evolution of thinking about planning over several decades has shaped its practice. An ideal text for study of planning theory, each chapter is introduced by a brief essay to establish its context and importance, and is followed by a series of study questions and suggested readings to help in classroom discussion. Selected Contents: Foreword Patsy Healey Introduction 1. The Transactive Style of Planning 2. The Epistemology of Social Practice 3. Preface to The Good Society 4. The Mediations of Radical Planning 5. Rethinking Poverty: The Dis/Empowerment Model 6. The Rise of Civil Society 7. Planning Theory Revisited 8. The Good City: In Defense of Utopian Thinking 9. The Many Cultures of Planning 10. The Uses of Planning Theory. Epilogue: Citizen Planners in an Era of Limits Routledge «Market: Planning / Urban Studies January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-78151-0: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-78152-7: £19.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83211-0: £95.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Building Competences for Spatial Planners
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
Planning 249
Patrick Geddes and Town Planning A Critical View Noah Hysler-Rubin, The Hebrew University of Jerusalem and Bezalel Academy of Art and Design, Isreal
The Good City Reflections and Imaginations Allan B. Jacobs, Professor Emeritus, University of California, Berkeley, USA Jacobs is one of the world’s best know planners and urban design practitioners, with a long and distinguished career based initially in US cities, and then throughout the world. Featuring a wonderfully engaging, humorous tone and Jacobs’ own ink drawings, The Good City transfers lessons on city design, building and urban change to all those willing to help cities become the magnificent, beautiful places they should be – and encourages all inhabitants to learn to appreciate and explore their own cities.
Cultural geographer and town planner Noah Hysler-Rubin takes a critical view on the life and work of one of the world’s most famous town planners – Patrick Geddes. Including a long overdue model of his urban theory, this book acts as a useful tool to evaluate modern town planning as an academic and practical discipline. Selected Contents: Part 1: The Planning Historiography of Patrick Geddes Part 2: Geddes and Geography Part 3: Planning in the Colonies Part 4: Postcolonial Scrutiny Conclusion: The Historiography of Town Planning, a Postcolonial Reading Routledge «Market: Planning / Urban Design January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-57866-0: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57867-7: £24.99/04
Selected Contents: Part 1: Experiencing Cities Part 2: Learning From Calcutta Part 3: Learning in Italy Part 4: City People – Fragments Part 5: Breaking and Making Community Part 6: World Class Cities Part 7: City Certainties Part 8: San Francisco Part 9: The Good City Routledge «Market: Planning / Urban Studies April 2011: 178x254: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-59350-2: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59353-3: £19.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83596-8: £95.00/14
Sunburnt Cities
Urban Coding and Planning *
The Great Recession, Depopulation and Urban Planning in the American Sunbelt
Edited by Stephen Marshall, University College London, UK Series: Planning, History and Environment Urban codes have a profound influence on urban form, affecting the design and placement of buildings, public spaces and street layouts. By examining historical and ongoing traditions of coding from around the world this book provides lessons for today’s theory and practice of place-making.
Justin B Hollander, Tufts University, USA
çè
Selected Contents: 1. Introduction 2. Perspectives on Growth and Decline 3. When People Leave – The Ruins of Urban Neighborhoods 4. Lessons From a Declining City: Flint, Michigan after 40 Years of Population Loss 5. A New Model for Neighborhood Change in Shrinking Cities 6. Unfamiliar Patterns in the Sun – What Postal Workers Already Know 7. Facing Change in the Central Valley: A Declining Fresno 8. Endless Growth in the Desert? The Fall of Phoenix 9. Abandonment Outside the Magic Kingdom: What Went Wrong in Orlando 10. Conclusion Routledge «Market: Planning January 2011: 246x174: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-59211-6: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59212-3: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83438-1: £95.00/14
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Selected Contents: 1. Introduction 2. Chronicle of Urban Codes in Pre-Industrial London’s Streets and Squares 3. Controlling Urban Code of Enlightenment Scotland 4. Learning from Laws of the Indies 5. Paradigms for Design: Vastu Vidya Codes of India 6. Prescribing Ideal City 7. Machizukuri and Urban Codes in Historical and Contemporary Kyoto 8. Coding in French Planning System 9. Adelaide’s Urban Design 10. Coding as ‘Bottom-Up’ Planning 11. How Codes Shaped Development in United States, and Why They Should be Changed Routledge «Market: Planning January 2011: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-44126-1: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-44127-8: £29.99/04
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
The decline in sun-belt cities of America has followed on from the decline of those in the rust-belt. Hollander addresses the reasons and statistics behind these shrinking cities with a positive outlook, arguing that growth for growth’s sake is not beneficial for communities, suggesting instead that urban development could be achieved through shrinkage. Case studies include Phoenix, Fresno and Flint.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
250 Planning
Women and Housing *
The Making of Hong Kong *
An International Analysis
From Vertical to Volumetric
Edited by Patricia Kennett, University of Bristol, UK and Kam-Wah Chan, The Hong Kong Polytechnic University, Hong Kong
Barrie Shelton, University of Sydney, Australia, Justyna Karakiewicz and Thomas Kvan, both at University of Melbourne, Australia
Series: Housing and Society
Series: Planning, History and Environment Series
This collection explores the housing circumstances of women in developed and emerging societies in Europe, USA and East Asia, at a time of substantial economic and social change. Its focus is on the interface between housing and gender and how this socially constructed relationship manifests and transforms over time and space.
Dialogues in Urban and Regional Planning * Volume 4 Edited by Thomas L. Harper, University of Calgary, Canada, Michael Hibbard, University of Oregon, USA, Heloise Costa, Federal University of Minas Gerais, Brazil and Anthony Yeh, University of Hong Kong, Hong Kong
Routledge «Market: Planning History / Geography / Urban Studies November 2010: 246x174: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-48701-6: £65.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-83560-9: £65.00/14
Implementing Sustainability * The New Zealand Experience Caroline Miller, Massey University, New Zealand Series: RTPI Library New Zealand’s Resource Management Act was hailed as a radical new approach to planning; the first to attempt to put environmental concerns ahead of social and economic issues. This book examines the lessons that can be learned from this groundbreaking legislation. It offers a practitioner’s insight into the RMA, those strategies and techniques that have proved successful, and spells out the lessons that can be applied to planning systems of other countries.
Series: Dialogues in Urban and Regional Planning This 4th volume of some of the best, award-winning urban and regional planning writing from around the world’s planning schools promotes discussion and a basis for further research. The international authors address a broad spectrum of planning issues including safety in urban spaces, rebuilding postKatrina and planning and governance in urban Zimbabwe. Published in association with the Global Planning Education Association Network (GPEAN), and the member planning schools associations, who have selected these papers based on regional competitions. Routledge «Market: Planning December 2010: 234x156: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-59334-2: £90.00/08 eBook: 978-0-203-84202-7: £90.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Selected Contents: 1. Introduction 2. Implementing Sustainablity by Legislation 3. Integrated Management and Regional Planning – Water, Air and Land 4. Urban Planning and the Built Environment 5. Energy and Infrastructure 6. Tangata Whenua and the Resource Management Act 7. The Profession, the Politicians and the Public 8. Conclusions – The Lessons from New Zealand Routledge «Market: Planning December 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-49550-9: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-49551-6: £29.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83514-2: £95.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Housing / Gender Studies December 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-54895-3: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-54897-7: £34.99/04
This book investigates what the history of Hong Kong’s urban development has to teach other cities as they face environmental challenges, social and demographic change and the need for new models of dense urbanism. The authors describe how the high-rise intensity of Hong Kong came about; how the forest of towers are in fact vertical culs de sac; and how the city might become truly ‘volumetric’ with mixed activities through multiple levels and 3D movement networks incorporating ‘town cubes’ rather than town squares.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
Civil engineering 251
Fundamentals of Civil Engineering An Introduction to the ASCE Body of Knowledge Richard H. McCuen, University of Maryland, MD, USA, Edna Z. Ezzell, Fulton, USA and Melanie K. Wong, University of Maryland, USA Written for undergraduate civil engineering students as an introduction to the general education outcomes of the ASCE’s Body of Knowledge (BOK), this book explains what individuals are expected to know and be able to do by the time they enter professional practice. This text covers key topics such as sustainability, physical geography, scientific method, engineering history, public policy, and ethics. Also discussed are contemporary issues such as impacts of terrorism, conflicts over water supply, recycling, and green building. Chapters include case studies, examples, sidebars, and 10 to 25 discussion questions to aid in reader comprehension. CRC Press «Market: Civil Engineering January 2011: 235x156: 240pp Pb: 978-1-4398-5148-7: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5149-4: £49.99/17
eWork and eBusiness in Architecture, Engineering and Construction Proceedings of the European Conference on Product and Process Modelling 2010, Cork, Republic of Ireland, 14–16 September 2010 Edited by Karsten Menzel, University College Cork, Ireland and Raimar Scherer, Technical University Dresden, Germany eWork and eBusiness in Architecture, Engineering and Construction 2010 provides strategic knowledge on the achievements and trends in research, development, standardisation and industrial implementation of product and process information technology. The book contains contributions from leading experts, is divided into three main themes (Complex Engineering Systems; Processes and Construction Management; EnergyEfficiency), and is of interest to academics and professionals working in Architecture, Engineering and Construction. CRC Press «Market: Civil Engineering September 2010: 246x174: 436pp Hb: 978-0-415-60507-6: £129.00/17 eBook: 978-0-203-83377-3: £129.00/17
textbook
Soil Mechanics Fundamentals Isao Ishibashi, Old Dominion University, USA and Hemanta Hazarika, Kyushu University, Japan Comprehensive and introductory, this textbook covers all basic fundamental concepts of soil mechanics. It delineates how soil behaves, why it behaves that way, and the engineering significance of such behavior. The text clearly explains the various behaviors of soils based on mathematics, physics, and chemistry in simple but comprehensive ways. The authors include essential engineering equations to emphasize the importance of fundamentals, and 180 problems and solutions to aid with application. An instructor’s guide, solutions manual, and PowerPoint presentation are available upon qualifying course adoption.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
CRC Press «Market: Civil Engineering December 2010: 235x156: 480pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4644-5: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4645-2: £49.99/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
252 civil engineering Fiber and Fabric Reinforced Cement Composites
Stone Matrix Asphalt *
Structural Damping
Theory and Practice
Applications in Seismic Response Modification
Manufacturing, Analysis, and Design
Krzysztof Blazejowski, Transportation Engineering Consultant, Poland
Zach Liang, George C. Lee, Gary F. Dargush and Jianwei Song, University at Buffalo, Amherst, New York, USA
Barzin Mobasher, Arizona State University, Tempe, USA This book presents new opportunities for developing innovative and cost-effective methods and products in cement and concrete composites manufacturing. It requires the user to rethink and reevaluate the traditional design and manufacture of reinforced concrete structures. Engineers can achieve efficient structural systems with innovative lightweight materials designed using fundamental aspects of composite material mechanics. CRC Press «Market: Civil Engineering March 2011: 235x156: 450pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0660-9: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0661-6: £82.00/17
A comprehensive introduction, this book presents the history, materials, requirements, properties, and applications of Stone Matrix Asphalt (SMA). Detailing the requirements and materials for the mix, including asphalt cement, aggregates, and stabilizers, the author discusses design processes and implementation, alternative design methods, and best practices and production processes both in the U.S. and abroad. It covers issues specific to the mix, such as permanent deformation and fatigue resistance, as well as special applications of SMA, including bridge deck surfacing, airfields, and runways. Written in an easy-to-read style, it draws on the author’s notable expertise and provides over 400 references. CRC Press October 2010: 235x156: 350pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1971-5: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1972-2: £82.00/17
Infrastructure Health in Civil Engineering * Mohammed M. Ettouney, Weidlinger Associates Inc., New York, New York, USA and Sreenivas Alampalli, NYSDOT, Albany, New York, USA Understanding engineering structural health is vital for making informative decisions in maintaining and renewing infrastructure to meet increasing demands. Structural Health in Civil Engineering integrates the decision making concept into the field of structural health. This book examines the process of addressing and maintaining structural health, including measurements, structural identification, and damage identification and discusses the theoretical and practical issues involved for each aspect. Emphasizing state-of-the-art practice as well as future directions, this text also features numerous practical case studies and covers the latest techniques in sensing and sensor utilization. CRC Press «Market: Civil Engineering December 2010: 279x216: 1320pp Hb: 978-0-8493-2040-8: £108.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-0375-8: £108.00/17
Intelligent Transportation Systems Planning, Operations, and Evaluation
Strong Earthquake Ground Motion * Theory and Applications Mustafa Erdik and Eser Durukal, both at Bogaziçi University, Turkey
Series: Advances in Earthquake Engineering This book describes important principles for dealing with the damping of structures to aid in the analysis and design of supplemental damping to mitigate seismic effects. It reviews basic issues of structural damping, including the maximum energy dissipation principle; the damping adaptivity of devices that can work with a large dynamic range of earthquake load; and the structural cross effect that needs to be minimized in design practice. The text also examines limitations and the problem of damping and stiffness nonlinearity that may not be approximated with sufficient accuracy using the simplified present-day approaches. CRC Press «Market: Civil Engineering March 2011: 235x156: 488pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1582-3: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1583-0: £82.00/17
Understanding Structural Engineering From Theory to Practice
Specifically focused on earthquake-resistant design, this book addresses essential issues and engineering applications of strong ground seismology. Its application-oriented style includes detailed coverage of source, physics, wave propagation, recording, characteristics, synthetic stimulation, and all approaches of ground motion simulations. It also provides a clear link between seismology, geophysics, and engineering, which has far-reaching applications in earthquakeresistant design code and performance-based design requirements. Written with a didactic approach, this text offers a concise resource of information that fills the gap between earthquake engineering and seismology.
Wai-Fah Chen, University of Hawaii at Manoa, Honolulu, USA and Salah El-Din E. El-Metwally, El-Mansoura University, Egypt
CRC Press «Market: Civil Engineering March 2011: 235x156: 608pp Hb: 978-0-8493-2271-6: £99.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-0399-4: £99.00/17
CRC Press «Market: Civil Engineering February 2011: 235x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2710-9: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2711-6: £63.99/17
Asad J. Khattak, University of North Carolina, Chapel Hill, USA and Haitham Al-Deek
From science to engineering and from theory to practice, it illustrates different breakthroughs, traced back to their origin and placed into prospective. First, the text presents the fundamental laws of mechanics, the theory of elasticity, and the development of the generalized stress-generalized strain concept. Next, it details the era of plasticity. The finite element method comes as an offspring of the generalized stress generalized strain concept. Finally, the authors explore the era of computer simulation to offer a glimpse into the future.
Combining communications and transportation technologies to improve the flow of goods and people, Intelligent Transportation Systems: Planning, Operations, and Evaluation provides comprehensive coverage of the fundamental principles, methods, tools, and technology applications in the field of intelligent transportation systems. This book addresses the impact of information and communications technology on transportation. It also analyzes research literature, discussing issues of measurement, research design, data reliability, and validity. Presented in a research-oriented style, this text is a one-stop reference for civil engineers, traffic engineers, and automotive engineers.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
CRC Press «Market: Civil Engineering March 2011: 235x156: 330pp Hb: 978-0-8493-3120-6: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-0473-1: £63.99/17
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
building 253
Energy Efficiency in New and Existing Buildings
Fire Safety and Security in Retail Premises
Comparative costs and CO2 savings (FB 26)
A Practical Guide for Owners, Managers and Responsible Persons (BR 508)
Fiona MacKenzie
A practical guide to assessing the risk of fire and enhancing the security of retail premises. It identifies the important issues, and encourages an approach in which good fire safety and security practice become familiar and normal to employees.
This BRE Trust report considers the relative impact on UK CO2 savings targets of constructing new zero-carbon buildings compared to improving the energy efficiency of the existing stock, using existing data.
BRE Press «Market: Fire November 2010: 297x210: 104pp Pb: 978-1-84806-145-3: £25.00/14
BRE Press «Market: Energy Use August 2010: 297x210: 32pp Pb: 978-1-84806-137-8: £30.00/14
Automatic Fire Detection and Alarm Systems An Introductory Guide to Components and Systems R. Dudley Automatic Fire Detection and Alarm Systems are effective and reliable means of detecting fires and signalling an alarm to occupants. This guide introduces these systems, explains how they are developed and managed, and the regulatory requirements.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Vina Kukadia Practical guidance on developing effective ventilation strategies for reducing ingress of external pollution into buildings, while maintaining adequate ventilation. It takes account of air pollutant sources (near and far) and assesses their impact.
BRE Press «Market: Building Design October 2010: 297x210: 48pp Pb: 978-1-84806-147-7: £40.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
BRE Press «Market: Fire October 2010: 297x210: 24pp Pb: 978-1-84806-146-0: £22.50/14
Ventilation for Healthy Buildings: Reducing the Impact of Urban Air Pollution
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
254 building
Building Performance Simulation Introduction to for Design and Operation Building Procurement Edited by Jan L. M. Hensen, Technical University of Eindhoven, the Netherlands and Roberto Lamberts, Federal University of Santa Catarina, Brazil
Brian Greenhalgh, Quantity Surveying Consultant, UK and Graham Squires I ntroduction to Building Procurement familiarises the reader with the principles and methods of the procurement of buildings, starting at the most basic level. Starting with introductory chapters that explain the structure of the construction industry, the nature of clients, and the historical development of the procurement methods in use today, the book goes on to address core procurement tasks. It is the ideal introductory textbook for professionals and undergraduates studying quantity surveying, construction project management and construction commercial management.
This book provides a unique and comprehensive overview of building performance simulation for the complete building life-cycle from conception to demolition. It is primarily intended for advanced students in building services engineering, and in architectural, environmental or mechanical engineering; and will be useful for building and systems designers and operators.
Spon Press «Market: Building Simulation & Engineering January 2011: 246x174: 512pp Hb: 978-0-415-47414-6: £65.00/17 eBook: 978-0-203-89161-2: £65.00/14
Spon Press «Market: Construction Management & Building January 2011: 246x174: 276pp Hb: 978-0-415-48215-8: £95.00/17 Pb: 978-0-415-48216-5: £24.99/17 eBook: 978-0-203-88506-2: £95.00/14
Harvesting and Managing Knowledge in Construction
Life Cycle Assessment in the Built Environment
From Theoretical Foundations to Business Applications
Robert Crawford, University of Melbourne Starting from first principles and establishing a basic framework for life cycle assessment, this book looks at a number of case studies to establish a practical methodology. Comprehensively introducing and demonstrating the uses of life cycle assessment for built environment projects, this book will show you how to assess your clients’ projects, to compare designs across their whole lives and to do so as accurately as possible.
Yacine Rezgui and John Miles, both at Cardiff University, UK
Spon Press «Market: Construction Management February 2011: 234x156: 232pp Hb: 978-0-415-54595-2: £95.00/17 Pb: 978-0-415-54596-9: £29.99/17 eBook: 978-0-203-87609-1: £95.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Selected Contents: 1. Global Warming and Climate Change 2. Minimizing the Environmental Impact of the Built Environment 3. What is Life Cycle Assessment? 4. Life Cycle Thinking in the Built Environment 5. Building Case Studies 6. Reducing Environmental Impacts of the Built Environment. Appendices Spon Press «Market: Construction Economics / Construction Management March 2011: 234x156: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-55795-5: £80.00/17 eBook: 978-0-203-86817-1: £80.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
A holistic approach to knowledge management is taken in this textbook to incorporate all of the relevant themes, tackling technological, socio-cultural and organisational issues, with the creation of value as a focus throughout. Information is drawn from a broad range of sources to explain core theories, and provide guidance on practical application. These are further illustrated with case studies from companies such as Taylor Woodrow, Davis Langdon, and the French building research establishment CSTB.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
building 255
Organization Management in Construction Edited by Paul Chinowsky, University of Colorado, Boulder, USA and Anthony Songer, Boise State University, USA
Whole Life Costing A New Approach Peter Caplehorn, Scott Brownrigg, UK Whole life costing has been a subject waiting to come of age for many years. What was previously of mainly academic interest is now becoming a key business tool in the procurement and construction of significant projects. This books sets out the practical issues involved in the selection of materials, their performance, and the issues that need to be taken into account. The emphasis, unlike in other publications, is not to formularise or to package the issues but to leave the reader with a clear understanding and a sensible practical way of arriving at conclusions in the future.
This book provides a comprehensive overview of the key issues that organization leaders must understand and address. It provides concise summaries by leading international authorities of the ten key strategic management issues, shows how they have emerged, and outlines their potential impact on the construction organization.
Selected Contents: 1. Introduction 2. Relevance to Today 3. The Building Process 4. Building Elements 5. The Future References Spon Press «Market: Construction February 2011: 246x174: 356pp Hb: 978-0-415-43422-5: £95.00/17 Pb: 978-0-415-43423-2: £34.99/17 eBook: 978-0-203-88896-4: £95.00/14
Spon Press «Market: Construction Management January 2011: 246x174: 208pp Hb: 978-0-415-57257-6: £95.00/17 Pb: 978-0-415-57261-3: £29.99/17 eBook: 978-0-203-85610-9: £90.00/14
Traditional Construction for a Sustainable Future Carole Ryan, Bournemouth University, UK As the construction industry faces up to its environmental responsibilities, this book explores its rich and ancient tradition to provide tried and trusted solutions to modern day construction problems. Over 250 original photos, and over 50 bespoke diagrams illustrate the features, techniques, and characteristics of traditional construction that could make such a valuable contribution to the industry today.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Selected Contents: 1. The Natural Way of Life, the Birth of the Traditional House and its Demise 2. Traditional Building Materials, Their Sustainability, and the Contrast with Modern Materials 3. Traditional Sustainable Building ConstructionAncient and Modern 4. Thermal Performance and the Breathing Wall 5. Climate, Site and Thermal Performance 6. The Role of the Building Regulations in Traditional Building Construction 7. The Pathology of Traditional Buildings Spon Press «Market: Green Building and Conservation January 2011: 246x174: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-46756-8: £100.00/17 Pb: 978-0-415-46757-5: £29.99/17 eBook: 978-0-203-89550-4: £100.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
256 Environmental engineering
Surface Modeling
textbook
Geostatistics
High Accuracy and High Speed Methods
Mohammed A. Kalkhan, Colorado State University, Fort Collins, USA Geospatial information modeling and mapping has become an important tool for the investigation and management of natural resources at the landscape scale. Geostatistics reviews the types and applications of geospatial information data, such as remote sensing, GIS and GPS, as well as their integration into landscape scale geospatial statistical models and maps. Readers will learn the requirements and limitations of each geospatial tool. With statistical data analysis methods, the text includes laboratory exercises using ArcInfo, ArcGIS, ArcView, and other popular software for geospatial modeling. It also features case studies with examples, homework problems, and a solutions manual. CRC Press «Market: Environmental Engineering March 2011: 235x156: 250pp Hb: 978-1-4200-6976-1: £33.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-6977-8: £33.99/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Tian-Xiang Yue, Institute of Geographical Sciences and Natural Resourses Research, China Series: Applied Ecology and Environmental Management Based on newly developed methods, this handbook bridges the gap between the mathematical-oriented theory of surface modeling and the user-oriented application where the user is actually able to retrieve information on the method itself. It provides readers with methods for surface modelling on high accuracy and high speed and their application examples using MATLAB and C++. The accompanying CD ROM supplies programs and tools (in MATLAB and C++) that allows users to easily conduct the HASM modeling themselves. CRC Press «Market: Environmental Engineering December 2010: 235x156: 728pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1758-2: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1759-9: £82.00/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Spatial Information Modeling and Mapping for Natural Resources, Ecological and Environmental Applicationss
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
Environmental engineering 257 Advanced Waste Treatment in the Food Processing Industry
Biomass Energy
Edited by Lawrence K. Wang, Zorex Corporation, Newtonville, New York, USA, Yung-Tse Hung, Cleveland State University, Ohio, USA and Nazih K. Shammas, Pittsfield, Massachusetts, USA
Edited by Robert Foster, MSC WERC, Las Cruces, New Mexico, USA, James Witcher, Witcher & Associates, Las Cruces, New Mexico, USA, Vaughn C. Nelson, West Texas A&M University, Canyon, Texas, USA, Majid Ghassemi, New Mexico Tech, Albuquerque, New Mexico, USA, Luz Elena Mimbela and Abbas Ghassemi, both at New Mexico State University, Las Cruces, USA
Series: Advances in Industrial and Hazardous Wastes Treatment Advanced Waste Treatment in the Food Processing Industry provides environmental engineers with in-depth coverage across a range of topics. Examining current conditions and future trends, the text discusses pollution sources, waste characteristics, control technologies, management strategies, facility innovations, process alternatives, costs, and effluent standards. Much of the information is supported with case histories. It delineates methodologies, technologies, and considers regional and global effects of important pollution control practices. Most importantly, it provides a focus on new developments in innovative and alternative technologies, design criteria, managerial decision methodology, and environmental conservation approaches that are specific to the food industries CRC Press «Market: Environmental Engineering March 2011: 254x178: 400pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7227-3: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7229-7: £57.99/17
Renewable Energy and the Environment
Series: Energy and the Environment Focusing on geothermal energy systems, this book covers background, theory, power generation technologies, applications, strengths and weaknesses, and useful practical technical techniques for implementing wind energy projects. It stresses the link between energy acquisition and consumption and the environment, examines sustainability issues, discusses processing of various biomass fuels, and compares biomass energy to other renewable and sustainable energies. With copious examples, examples, real world case studies, practical implementation steps, and lessons learned, the book demonstrates how to implement successful and efficient biomass projects. CRC Press «Market: Environmental Engineering March 2011: 254x178: 408pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7564-9: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7565-6: £76.99/17
Atmospheric Remote Sounding Roy Gordan Grainger, Oxford University, UK
Chemicals, Environment, Health
The global nature of atmospheric change makes satellite remote sensing a key tool in the investigation of these processes. Reflecting its importance, this book provides a comprehensive resource on remote sensing of the Earth’s atmosphere. It begins with a review of the properties and behavior of the Earth’s atmosphere, then discusses retrieval theory, including applications, and remote sounding. Each chapter contains problems as exercises to test reader comprehension. By providing a single volume that combines radiative transfer and retrieval theory with examples of most instrument types, this book should become a vade mecum for atmospheric scientists.
A Global Management Perspective
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
This book reviews and analyzes the global multilateral efforts established to address the danger of chemicals on the world stage. It refers to a number of environmental issues, statutes, and organizations in the context of chemicals and their related risks to humans and the environment. The text offers specialists and those in related fields with an up-to-date reference that consolidates currently scattered information related to international chemicals management.
Edited by H. Magdi Selim, Louisiana State University, Baton Rouge, Louisiana, USA Written by international experts, this book supplies coherent presentations of recent developments along with a clear understanding of heavy metal dynamics and bioavailability in the soil root zone. It provides a multidisciplinary approach with emphasis on geohydrology, plant and soil science, and environmental chemistry. Evaluating the current state of the art in this field, the text explores innovative experimental and theoretical modeling approaches. Numerous figures, tables and equations are included within the text to further enhance knowledge of the subject. CRC Press «Market: Environmental Engineering March 2011: 229x152: 300pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2622-5: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2623-2: £82.00/17
Fundamentals and Applications in Aerosol Spectroscopy Edited by Ruth Signorell, University of British Columbia, Vancouver, BC, Canada and Jonathan P. Reid, University of Bristol, UK Understanding of aerosol spectroscopy in terms of microscopic/molecular properties is growing rapidly, along with understanding of crucial implications regarding atmospheric chemistry and physics, air pollution control, and health issues. Differences between fundamentally oriented research groups and groups working in applied aerosol spectroscopy have caused unnecessary challenges. Bringing together contributions from both sides of that issue, this unique book covers the spectroscopy of a variety of aerosols, ranging from cold aerosol particles in planetary atmospheres to organic and bio-aerosols important to Earth’s atmosphere. It surveys different state-of-the-art experimental techniques. CRC Press «Market: Environmental Chemistry and Toxicology December 2010: 254x178: 536pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8561-7: £99.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8562-4: £99.00/17
CRC Press «Market: Environmental Chemistry and Toxicology March 2011: 235x156: 500pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8469-6: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8470-2: £82.00/17
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
CRC Press «Market: Environmental Engineering March 2011: 235x156: 500pp Hb: 978-0-8493-7250-6: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-0685-8: £89.00/17
Edited by Philip Wexler, National Library of Medicine, Bethesda, Maryland, USA, Jan van der Kolk, Eco Conseil, the Netherlands, Asish Mohapatra, Health Canada- Contaminated Sites Division, Canada and Ravi Agarwal, Toxics Link, India
Dynamics and Bioavailability of Heavy Metals in the Rootzone
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
258 Environmental engineering Hydroelectric Energy
Megatrends for Energy Efficiency and Renewable Energy
Spatial Data Infrastructures
Renewable Energy and the Environment Bikash Pandey, South Asia Clean Energy Group, USA and Ajoy Karki, Pulchowk, Nepal
Michael Frank Hordeski, Atascadero, California, USA
Yola Georgiadou, Joep Crompvoets and Zorica Nedovic-Budic
Series: Energy and the Environment
The use of energy is being shaped by environmental issues including the fear of global warming. This has resulted in the development of renewable energy sources and more efficient building technology. Examining trends in energy efficiency, this book explores energy technologies and fuels, their prospects in a world with greenhouse gas restrictions. It looks at the technical and economic tradeoffs of traditional renewables such as wind and solar, as well as large scale PV and concentrated thermal power. It also considers biomass technologies. For each of these technologies, it discusses planning, siting, installation, operation and maintenance, health and safety, power conditioning, and efficiency innovations.
With contributions from international experts, this book presents cutting edge Spatial Data Infrastructure (SDI) research on information technology, systems, and infrastructures that is theoretically-based and empirically supported. It examines the complexities involved in the establishments of SDIs in the Northern and Southern hemispheres and use of SDIs in a variety of cultural, societal, and institutional contexts. The focus is on urban and regional levels where socio-economic and environmental sustainability is realized.
Providing essential theory and useful practical techniques for implementing hydroelectric projects, this book outlines the resources, power generation technologies, applications, and strengths and weaknesses for hydroelectric technologies. Emphasizing the links between energy and the environment, it serves as a useful background resource and facilitates decisionmaking regarding which renewable energy technology works best for different types of applications and regions. Including examples, real world case studies, and lessons learned, each chapter contains exercise questions, references, and ample photographs and technical drawings from actual micro hydropower plants. CRC Press «Market: Environmental Engineering March 2011: 254x178: 384pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1167-2: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1168-9: £82.00/17
Reversibility of Chronic Degenerative Disease and Hypersensitivity, Volume 2
Industrial Composting Environmental Engineering and Facilities Management
Clinical Manifestations of Chemical Sensitivity
Eliot Epstein, Epstein Environmental Consultants, Boca Raton, USA Packed with figures, photographs, and tables, this book covers the technical and environmental engineering aspects of large-scale industrial composting. It covers facilities design, planning, operational issues, environmental impacts, public relations, and community concerns, as well as the utilization and economics of marketing compost. It also provides operators and managers a full understanding of the management of odors, such as neutralizers and additives, bioaerosols, and other facilities issues. Chapters on facility siting, planning, permitting, site management, and community involvement round out the coverage. CRC Press «Market: Environmental Engineering February 2011: 235x156: 440pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4531-8: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4532-5: £89.00/17
Fairmont Press «Market: Environmental Engineering November 2010: 229x152 Hb: 978-1-4398-5354-2: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5355-9: £82.00/17
William J. Rea, Environmental Health Center, Dallas, Texas, USA and Kalpana Patel, Allergy and Environmental Health Center WNY, Buffalo, New York Encyclopedic in scope, this three volume work, a nascent classic in the field of environmental medicine, draws deeply on the clinical histories of thousands of profoundly ill patients to describe the physiology and chemical sensitivity of chronic degenerative diseases, their different manifestations, how to diagnose them, and how to reverse the dysfunction. The first volume introduces the basics of homeostasis for the body, the manner in which pollutants might enter, and the possibility for reversal. The second describes clinical syndromes within each of the body’s systems. The final volume presents laboratory data and treatment options. CRC Press «Market: Environmental Chemistry and Toxicology March 2011: 254x178: 442pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1343-0: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1344-7: £89.00/17
North and South
CRC Press «Market: Environmental Engineering February 2011: 229x152: 200pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2802-1: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2803-8: £63.99/17
Tolerance to Environmental Contaminants Edited by Claude Amiard-Triquet, Universite de Nantes, SMAB, Nantes Cedex, France, Philip S. Rainbow, The Natural History Museum, UK and Michele Romeo, University of Nice-Sophia Antipolis, France Series: Environmental and Ecological Risk Assessment An up-to-date compilation of the views international experts, this book covers the tolerance of living organisms to toxic contaminants. It examines the degree of generalization of tolerance different levels of biological organization and discusses mechanisms of defense involved in the acquisition of tolerance to different classes of environmental contaminants, taking into account the limits above which such mechanisms are overwhelmed. It also examines the ecological consequences and specific aspects of tolerance, especially those that impact the environment and society. CRC Press «Market: Environmental Chemistry and Toxicology December 2010: 235x156: 392pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1770-4: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1771-1: £82.00/17
Warfare Decontamination Seshadri S. Ramkumar and George P. Cobb, both at Texas Tech University, Lubbock, USA
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
CRC Press «Market: Environmental Engineering March 2011: 279x216: 300pp Hb: 978-0-8247-2661-4: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-1475-4: £89.00/17
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
ergonomics & human factors 259
Handbook of Driving Simulation for Engineering, Medicine, and Psychology Edited by Donald L. Fisher, University of Massachusetts, Amhurst, USA, Matthew Rizzo, University of Iowa, Iowa City, USA, Jeffrey Caird, University of Calgary, Canada and John D. Lee, University of Iowa, Iowa City, USA A how-to-do-it resource for researchers and professionals, this book brings together discussions of technical issues in driving simulation with broad areas in which driving simulation is now playing a role. Covering basic and advanced topics, the book provides a comprehensive review of the topics related to driving simulation. It examines hardware and software selection, visual database and scenario development, independent subject variables and dependent vehicle, environmental, and psychological variables, statistical and biostatistical analysis, different types of drivers, existing and future key-in vehicle devises, and validation of research. CRC Press «Market: Ergonomics and Human Factors February 2011: 279x216: 768pp Hb: 978-1-4200-6100-0: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-6101-7: £82.00/17
Ergonomic Trends from the East Proceedings of Ergonomic Trends from the East, Japan, 12–14 November 2008 Edited by Masaharu Kumashiro, University of Occupational and Environmental Health, Japan This book consists of 56 contributions carefully selected from those presented at the meeting ‘Ergonomic Trends from the East’, held in Japan in November 2008. The experts established a roadmap outlining how ergonomics activities in East Asia should progress, as well as the ideal form of a practical standard for qualifications in the East Asian conglomeration. The book will be useful for research on East Asian ergonomics in the future. Selected Contents: The East Asian Ergonomics Roadmap. Safety Ergonomics. Qualification Systems. Cognitive Ergonomics. Ergonomics in Occupational Health. Social and Organizational Ergonomics. Ergonomics Modeling and Usability Evaluation. Ergonomics in Manufacturing CRC Press «Market: Ergonomics August 2010: 246x174: 368pp Hb: 978-0-415-88178-4: £99.00/17 eBook: 978-0-203-83334-6: £99.00/17
Ergonomics for All: Celebrating PPCOE’s 20 years of excellence
Practical Speech User Interface Design
Selected Papers of the Pan-Pacific Conference on Ergonomics, 7–10 November 2010, Kaohsiung, Taiwan
Although speech is the most natural form of communication, using speech to communicate with machines is anything but natural. Drawing from psychology, human-computer interaction, linguistics, and communication theory, this book provides a comprehensive yet concise survey of practical speech user interface design. The text contains research and practice-based guidance for the development of usable speech user interfaces, such as the interactive voice response applications designed to provide phone-based call routing and self-service. The author, a leading human factors engineer, covers both high- and low-level decisions and also includes VoiceXML code examples.
Edited by Dyi-Yih Michael Lin, I-Shou University, Taiwan and Hsieh-Ching Chen, Chaoyang University of Technology, Taiwan This book present the papers presented at the 20 th anniversary meeting of the Pan-Pacific Conference on Ergonomics organized by the Ergonomics Society of Taiwan. PPCOE 2010 is an international forum aimed to bring together scholars and practitioners around the world to exchange and disseminate the latest developments in ergonomics, and the interplay of these advances between the pan-pacific region and the rest of the world.
James R. Lewis, IBM Software Group, Delray Beach, Florida, USA Series: Human Factors and Ergonomics
CRC Press «Market: Ergonomics and Human Factors December 2010: 235x156: 312pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1584-7: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1585-4: £57.99/17
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Selected Contents: Aging. Anthropometry. Aviation Ergonomics. Biomechanics. Cognitive Ergonomics. Collaborative/Team Work. Digital Aspects. E-Business. Health Care. Manufacturing. Human-Computer Interaction. Industrial Design. Macro Ergonomics. Occupational Ergonomics. Safety And Warning. Universal Design. Usability. Vehicle/Transportation Systems. Virtual Environments CRC Press «Market: Ergonomics October 2010: 246x174: 646pp Hb: 978-0-415-58608-5: £121.00/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
260 environmental science
Handbook of Ecological Models in Ecosystem and Environmental Management
Peatland Biogeochemistry and Watershed Hydrology at the Marcell Experimental Forest
Edited by Sven Erik Jorgensen, Copenhagen University, Denmark
Edited by Randall Kolka and Stephen Sebestyen, both at USDA Forest Services, Grand Rapids, Minnesota, USA, Elon S. Verry, Ellen River Partners, Grand Rapids, Minnesota, USA and Kenneth Brooks, University of Minnesota, St. Paul, USA
Written to help researchers and environmental managers tackle environmental problems, this book presents models as reference points for specific plans of action. The first part of the book focuses on the ecosystem, while the second focuses on the different types of environmental problems. Initial chapters present available models for every ecosystem in the world and are followed by models of relevant environmental problems. The author explains which models to use in particular situations. With discussions on lakes, estuaries, and rivers, the book covers environmental problems including oxygen depletion, species diversity, and ground water pollution. The book contains many tables and figures throughout.
2nd Edition
Environmental Contaminants in Biota Interpreting Tissue Concentrations Edited by W. Nelson Beyer, USGS Patuxent Wildlife Research Center, Beltsville, Maryland, USA and James Meador, NOAA-NMFS, Seattle, Washington, USA This updated and expanded edition of a bestseller presents information on interpreting tissue concentrations of contaminants in wildlife. Supplying authoritative advice based on current scientific research, this edition provides a greater emphasis on aquatic organisms and includes new chapters. Each chapter includes a review of literature on a specific chemical, followed by a summary that provides research guidance. The book supplies direction on how to interpret conflicting or insufficient data. Chapters include a comprehensive history of interpreting contaminants in fish and wildlife, the use if tissue residues in ecological risk assessment, and coverage of all bioaccumulative contaminants and their affects on birds, fish, and mammals. CRC Press «Market: Ecology February 2011: 254x178: 904pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8405-4: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8406-1: £82.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5667-0071-9
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
CRC Press «Market: Forestry February 2011: 235x156: 600pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1424-6: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1425-3: £89.00/17
textbook
Global Environment Policy Concepts, Principles, and Practice Charles H. Eccleston, Derwood, Maryland, USA and Federic March, Thinkwell Associates. Albuquerque, New Mexico, USA Establishing a foundation in environmental policy, this book addresses some of the most significant environmental challenges facing our generation. It examines policy implications and the current scientific accounts of global environmental threats. Complete with learning objectives, examples, problems, and comprehensive case studies, the text discusses topics of interest to a domestic and international audience. It also presents a professional assessment of major global issues using current data and analysis from international policy organizations and think tanks. CRC Press «Market: Environmental Science and Technology December 2010: 235x156: 456pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4766-4: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4767-1: £63.99/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
CRC Press «Market: Ecology February 2011: 235x156: 500pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1812-1: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1813-8: £76.99/17
A synthesis of 50 years of research on hydrology and biogeochemistry of peatland watersheds at the Marcell Experimental Forest, this book covers the history of the project, what has been learned, and where the research should go in the future. The book examines the establishment of the MEF, the history behind the research, the value of long-term monitoring, the paleo-history of the MEF landscape, effects of forest management on water and chemical fluxes, the physical and chemical properties of upland and peatland soils, and the cycling of mercury. Figures, photographs, and tables depict concepts and findings within the book.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
environmental science 261 Cumulative Effects in Wildlife Management
Global Contamination Trends of Persistent Organic Chemicals
Handbook of Indoor Air Contaminants
Impact Mitigation
Edited by Bommanna G. Loganathan, Murray State University, Kentucky, USA and Paul Kwan-Sing Lam, City University of Hong Kong, China
Dean T. Tompkins and Marty S. Kanarek, both at University of Wisconsin, Madison, USA and Eugene C. Cole, Brigham Young University, Provo, Utah, USA
Composed by a diverse group of experts, this reference covers the history, present status, and projected future trends of environmental contamination from highly toxic synthetic chemical pollutants. The text informs practitioners on the effects of man-made chemical pollutants in a comprehensive manner not seen in existing textbooks and references. The book is ideal for professionals and students alike, providing timely coverage on the rising concern about environmental issues, including organic chemicals. Supplementary figures and equations are included for enhanced comprehension of the subject.
A comprehensive, one-stop source of data, this book summarizes important chemical, biological, and toxicological information on indoor air contaminants in a technically sound, up-to-date, and useful manner. Arranged alphabetically, the book provides the chemical and physical properties, concentration measurements, lifetimes and fate, reactivity, and health effects of the contaminants covered. It includes the molecular weight, source, and toxicity profile along with information on pertinent measurement instruments and remediation approaches. Molecular diagrams and photomicrographs of affected tissue further illustrate the data and concepts discussed in the book.
Edited by Paul R. Krausman, University of Montana, Missoula, USA and Lisa K. Harris, Harris Environmental Group and the University of Arizona, Tucson, USA Discussing the array of issues associated with the cumulative effects of projects and developments on surrounding habitat this book outlines methods to address these impacts in wildlife management. Chapters cover definitions and approaches, NEPA (National Environmental Policy Act), quantifying effects both spatially and temporally, monitoring and regulation at home and abroad, economic considerations, and the impact of shortfalls. Each chapter includes illustrative examples including anthropogenic impacts on freshwater fish and cumulative effects on sage-grouse, barrenground caribou, and bighorn sheep. CRC Press «Market: Ecology March 2011: 229x152: 312pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0916-7: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0917-4: £63.99/17
Mechanisms, Conservation, and Management Edited by Jerrold L. Belant, Mississippi State University, USA and Erik Alan Beever, USGS Alaska Science Center, Anchorage, USA Using real-world examples from diverse taxa and ecosystems, this book presents research on rapid shifts in temperature and precipitation and explains how these shifts alter the biotic landscape now and in the future. It highlights the general trends expected in wildlife and ecological responses, and the exceptions and contingencies that may mediate those responses. Topics include biotic response to rapid climate change, biological and ecological relationships to climate change, monitoring ecological effects of climate change, conservation and management efforts, and ecological responses to climate change describing past trends and future needs. CRC Press «Market: Ecology March 2011: 235x156: 336pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8720-8: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8722-2: £76.99/17
2nd Edition
Water-Rock Interaction XIII describes novel advances in research related to interactive processes between the hydrosphere and the lithosphere. Innovative studies, theoretical approaches and lab experiments are applied to reconstruct and combine pieces of the complex hydrological puzzle, and to confront society´s impact on the environment. The contributions are of interest to professionals and students in Earth sciences (geochemistry, hydrochemistry, hydrology, geology, mineralogy, volcanology, environmental sciences), and to decision-makers and engineers involved in the management of energy and natural resources.
A Comprehensive Guide to NEPA EAs and International Environmental Impact Assessment
CRC Press «Market: Earth Sciences October 2010: 246x174: 1008pp Hb: 978-0-415-60426-0: £199.00/17 eBook: 978-0-203-83404-6: £199.00/17
Indoor Air Quality The Latest Sampling and Analytical Methods
A Guide to Best Professional Practices Charles H. Eccleston, Derwood, Maryland, USA This book provides an in depth, yet understandable description of the ecological, socioeconomic, and other parts of the natural environment that may be affected by various activities. While written for professionals in government, consulting, and the private sector, this text also forms an introductory lesson in Environmental Impact Assessment. The author supplies a theoretical introduction to the subject as well as practical guidance. The book includes problems at the end of each chapter.
@
Managing and Preparing Environmental Assessments Charles Eccleston, Carrollton, Texas, USA For the first time, readers are provided with a comprehensive and authoritative source on how to effectively prepare an environmental assessment (EA). This book is suitable for a diverse audience, ranging from the general public to decisionmakers and seasoned practitioners. The information has been carefully synthesized and organized, providing a wealth of information for the professional and layperson alike. It supplies current research from nationally recognized experts from the government and private sectors, and contains tables, figures, graphics, flow charts, and checklists. CRC Press «Market: Environmental Science and Technology January 2012: 235x156: 200pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0882-5: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0890-0: £49.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5667-0559-2
Kathleen Hess-Kosa, OMEGA Southwest Environmental Consulting, Canyon Lake, Texas, USA The updated edition of this reader-friendly guide covers basic concepts and details various approaches to the identification and assessment of indoor air contaminants that contribute to building-related illness in commercial buildings, institutions, and residences. Included are newly added topics focusing on less common concerns in indoor air quality such as psychological and building comfort factors and approaches to assessing air movement within buildings. Expanded appendices and three new chapters provide readers with 30 percent new material, including the most recent approaches to indoor air quality. CRC Press «Market: Environmental Science and Technology January 2011: 235x156: 432pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2665-2: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2666-9: £111.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5667-0539-4
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
CRC Press «Market: Environmental Science and Technology November 2010: 235x156: 280pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2873-1: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2874-8: £76.99/17
çè
Edited by Peter Birkle, Gerencia de Geotermia, Cuernavaca, México and Ignacio Salvador Torres Alvarado, Centro de Investigación en Energía, UNAM, Temixco, México
2nd Edition
Environmental Impact Assessment
for e-mail updates in your field
CRC Press «Market: Environmental Science and Technology February 2012: 279x216: 500pp Hb: 978-1-56670-613-1: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-0-203-49002-0: £89.00/14
Water-Rock Interaction XIII
Ecological Consequences of Climate Change
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
CRC Press «Market: General Chemistry May 2011: 254x178: 608pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3830-3: £99.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3831-0: £99.00/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
262 gis & remote sensing Volume 3
Volume 2
GIS Applications in Agriculture
GIS Applications in Agriculture
Invasive Species
Nutrient Management for Energy Efficiency
Edited by Sharon A. Clay, South Dakota State University, Brookings, USA
Edited by David Clay, South Dakota State University, Brookings, USA and John F. Shanahan, University of Nebraska, Lincoln, USA
Series: GIS Applications in Agriculture
Series: GIS Applications in Agriculture
This volume focuses on GIS applications in the fight against invasive species, including weeds, insects, disease, and microbes. It offers practical applications for mapping and managing invasives and presents research on GIS applications in monitoring, tracking, modeling, forecasting, managing, and assessing for economic and environmental impacts. The book covers a variety of agricultural settings, including annual and perennial cropland, pastures, rangeland, conservation reserve, and riparian areas such as conservation buffers. It includes an interactive CD-ROM that allows readers to work through example GIS applications and analyze their own data.
Written to provide information for assessing the impact of different nutrient management scenarios on energy efficiency, this reference offers powerful techniques to help farmers produce a greater abundance of crops more efficiently at lower costs. Sections cover manure management, water and nutrient management in relation to energy efficiency and ethanol production, matching crops, landscape positions, nutrient management, and nitrogen and energy efficiency. The book includes research on a broad range of GIS techniques useful over a range of spatial and temporal scales. An interactive CD-ROM is provided to help readers work through examples and data.
CRC Press «Market: Agriculture February 2011: 235x156: 488pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7880-0: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7881-7: £82.00/17
CRC Press «Market: Agriculture February 2011: 235x156: 592pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9270-7: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9271-4: £89.00/17
Advances in Environmental Remote Sensing Sensors, Algorithms, and Applications
GIS Programming
Edited by Qihao Weng, Indiana State University, Terre Haute, USA
Concepts and Applications
Featuring contributors from 17 countries, this book systematically presents recent advances in environmental remote sensing. First, the text provides the latest developments in remote sensing data and sensor systems, paying special attention to LIDAR, high spatial-resolution sensing, hyperspectral sensing, and data fusion of various sensors. Next the authors examine cutting-edge algorithms and techniques for the detection, interpretation, characterization, and modeling of Earth surface features. The final section explores applications of current data, sensors, algorithms, and techniques to the remote sensing of land, vegetation, water, and air.
Conventional GIS does not provide all the functions needed for geospatial processing. As a result, GIS customization and programming are becoming increasingly important. Focusing on automation and customization, this book describes concepts of computer programming in general and of GIS programming in particular. Python and Visual Basic for Application illustrate the geospatial techniques discussed in the text. Various applications further demonstrate concepts and methods. An included CD-ROM provides a wide range of hands-on exercises as well as sample data for programming. This complete reference is designed to bring professionals up to date in this rapidly evolving field. CRC Press «Market: Environmental Engineering July 2011: 229x152: 250pp Hb: 978-0-8493-8527-8: £60.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-0813-5: £60.99/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
CRC Press «Market: Environmental Engineering February 2011: 254x178: 536pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9175-5: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9181-6: £95.00/17
Remote Sensing of Land Use and Land Cover Principles and Applications Chandra P. Giri, Science Applications International Corp, South Dakota, USA Series: Remote Sensing Applications Series This book discusses the fundamentals of land use/land cover characterization and mapping using remote sensing technology. It covers basic concepts, provides an overview and history, enumerates today’s status and development, and determines the relationship between land cover and land use. It also considers the classification systems used with remotely sensed data, as well as state-of-the-art methods and techniques in data acquisition, pre-processing, classification, and accuracy assessment needed for land use/land cover characterization and mapping. Synthesizing decades of research conducted by leading scientists in the field, the text presents a new perspective on the subject. CRC Press «Market: Environmental Engineering October 2011: 235x156: 250pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7074-3: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7075-0: £82.00/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Edited by Zhi-Jun Liu, University of North Carolina at Greensboro, USA, David Percy, Portland State University, Oregon, USA and Larry V. Stanislawski, USGS, Rolla, Missouri, USA
Series: Remote Sensing Applications Series
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
electrical, chemical & mechanical engineering 263 2nd Edition textbook
2nd Edition textbook
Advanced Thermodynamics Engineering
Digital Signal Processing with Examples in MATLAB
Kalyan Annamalai, Texas A&M University, College Station, USA, Ishwar K. Puri, Virginia Polytechnic Institute & State University, Blacksburg, USA and Milind A. Jog, University of Cincinnati, Ohio, USA
Samuel D. Stearns, Sandia National Laboratories, Albuquerque, New Mexico, USA and Don R. Hush, Los Alamos National Laboratory, New Mexico, USA
Series: Computational Mechanics and Applied Analysis
This book explains the fundamentals of digital signal processing and describes how to apply DSP to the design of signal processing systems. Using the book’s accompanying software, readers can implement basic signal processing operations, including spectral analysis and modeling. This second edition features new sections on simulation of continuous systems, the Chirp-z transform, linear and logarithmic sampling and resampling, the discrete sine transform, spread-spectrum techniques, digital differentiation, and integration. It also includes more information on the power density spectrum, implementation of the FFT, and the equation error method in adaptive signal processing.
Designed for readers needing to grasp the engineering physics of thermodynamic concepts and apply their knowledge to the field, this volume features physical explanations along with mathematical equations so that the principles can be applied to real-world problems. Employing almost 300 illustrations to enhance clarity, the book first presents the phenomenological approach to a problem and then delves into the details. Using a self-teaching format, the authors eschew esoteric material in favor of concrete examples and applications. The book includes several tables containing thermodynamic properties and other useful information, and additional material is available for download. CRC Press «Market: Mechanical Engineering December 2010: 254x178: 992pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0572-5: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0571-8: £82.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-2553-3
Series: Electrical Engineering & Applied Signal Processing Series
CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering February 2011: 235x156: 400pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3782-5: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3783-2: £63.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-1091-1
2nd Edition textbook
Edited by Kenneth W. Ragland, University of Wisconsin, Madison, USA and Kenneth M. Bryden, Iowa State University, Ames, USA Introducing fundamental concepts of combustion with an emphasis on their use in design, this new edition provides detailed coverage of major combustion technologies and fuels. Placing a stronger emphasis on pedagogic features, the authors keep the focus on engineering issues as they relate to combustion. The book contains numerous tables featuring practical data and formulas worked examples and problems. Mathematical methods are presented with qualitative descriptions of the methods used. Engineering applications are detailed throughout, showing the range of combustion engineering and identifying the latest trends in combustion and fuels.
çè
CRC Press «Market: Mechanical Engineering March 2011: 235x156: 544pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9250-9: £69.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9251-6: £69.99/17
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Control and Mechatronics Edited by Bodgan Wilamowski and J. David Irwin, both at Auburn University, Alabama, USA The successful construction of industrial systems requires an understanding of the various aspects of control theory. This area of engineering, like that of power electronics, is also seldom covered in depth in engineering curricula at the undergraduate level. The goal of this volume from The Industrial Electronics Handbook, Second Edition is to present many of the concepts of control in a manner that facilitates its understanding by practicing engineers or students who would like to learn about the applied aspects of control systems. CRC Press «Market: Electronics February 2011: 254x178: 736pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0287-8: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0288-5: £63.99/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Combustion Engineering
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
264 electrical, chemical & mechanical engineering 3rd Edition 3-volume set
2nd Edition
Fundamentals of Microfabrication and Nanotechnology *
Fuel Cell Technology Handbook Gregor Hoogers, Trier University of Applied Sciences, Germany Series: Handbook Series for Mechanical Engineering The second edition of this popular bestseller updates every chapter to present a complete and current exploration of the technical and commercial aspects of the rapidly maturing fuel cell technology that is at the heart of our energy future. Fully accessible to the non-expert, the book discusses recent fuel cell applications in the automotive industry, as well as advancements in stationary power generation and portable power devices. New chapters cover fuel production and the development of a long-term strategy for creating a hydrogen fuel infrastructure for vehicles. The book also provides commercial information on suppliers. Each chapter concludes with a list of questions and problems for self-study.
Marc J. Madou, University of California, Irvine, USA Updated and revised, this perennial bestseller continues to provide the most complete MEMS and NEMS reference currently available. Discussing a variety of approaches, it offers background and comprehensive coverage on materials, processes, and manufacturing options. Now in its third edition, Fundamentals of Microfabrication includes recent developments in design packages, DNA and protein array, and fluidics. It also includes a section on nanotechnology applications and a chapter on nanomachining. This seminal reference also serves as a cogent instructional text, providing both classroom and self-learners with worked-out example problems and questions with answers.
CRC Press «Market: Mechanical Engineering February 2011: 254x178: 500pp Hb: 978-1-4200-6989-1: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-6990-7: £76.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-0877-2
Selected Contents: Lithography. Pattern Transfer with Dry Etching Techniques. Patterns Transfer with Additive Techniques. Wet Bulk Micromachining. Surface Micromaching. LIGA and Micromolding. Top-Down Manufacturing Methods Compared-Substrate Choice. The Emergence of Bottom-Up Manufacturing Methods: Nano-chemistry. Modeling, Packaging Brains and Power. Scaling and Actuators. Miniaturization Applications CRC Press «Market: Mechanical Engineering January 2011: 279x216: 2640pp Hb: 978-0-8493-3180-0: £159.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-0479-3: £159.00/17
Industrial Communication Systems Edited by Bodgan Wilamowski and J. David Irwin, both at Auburn University, Alabama, USA
Fundamentals of Industrial Electronics Edited by Bodgan Wilamowski and J. David Irwin, both at Auburn University, Alabama, USA Fundamentals of Industrial Electronics is the first volume in The Industrial Electronics Handbook, Second Edition. It focuses on the fundamental areas which form the basis for the field of industrial electronics. Because of the breadth of this field, the knowledge required spans a wide spectrum of technology that includes analog and digital circuits, electronics, electromagnetics, machines, and signal processing. The four other volumes in the Handbook are also available individually: Industrial Communication Systems, Intelligent Systems, Power Electronics and Motor Drives,and Control and Mechatronics. Additionally, all of the volumes are available as a set.
The successful operation of any production process is dependent upon a well designed and reliable communication system. Modern communication systems that are employed within a factory use a variety of means for sending and receiving information. With time, these systems have become more and more complicated. This volume in The Industrial Electronics Handbook, Second Edition spans the full gamut of topics which are needed for engineers working with industrial communication systems. A detailed description of the numerous topics covered in this volume is outlined in the Preambles that are provided for the various sections, and readers are directed there for the detailed topics contained within. The four other volumes in the Handbook are available individually: Fundamentals of Industrial Electronics, Intelligent Systems, Power Electronics and Motor Drives, and Control and Mechatronics. Additionally, all of the volumes are available as a set. CRC Press «Market: Electronics February 2011: 254x178: 832pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0281-6: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0282-3: £63.99/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
CRC Press «Market: Electronics February 2011: 254x178: 744pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0279-3: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0280-9: £63.99/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
electrical, chemical & mechanical engineering 265 2nd Edition
2nd Edition textbook
Fundamentals of Natural Gas Processing
Nanotechnology
Arthur J. Kidnay, Colorado School of Mines, Golden, USA, William R. Parrish, Retired, ConocoPhillips, Brigantine, New Jersey, USA and Daniel G. McCartney, Black & Veatch, Shawnee Mission, Kansas, USA Updated to cover new advances, this book introduces the natural gas industry to readers new to the field or those providing a narrow service who would benefit from an understanding of the overall process. The initial chapters give a brief overview of basic concepts applicable throughout the chemical processing industry. The second part addresses natural gas processing following the gas stream from purchase at the wellhead to its entrance at the market place. Wherever possible, advantages, limitations, and ranges of applicability of various processes are discussed so that their integration into the overall gas plant can be fully appreciated. CRC Press «Market: Chemical Engineering January 2011: 254x178: 566pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8519-8: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8521-1: £82.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-3406-1
Technology has now progressed to the point that intelligent systems are replacing humans in the decision making processes as well as aiding in the solution of very complex problems. In many cases intelligent systems are already outperforming human activities. Artificial neural networks are not only capable of learning how to classify patterns, such images or sequence of events, but they can also effectively model complex nonlinear systems. Their ability to classify sequences of events is probably more popular in industrial applications where there is an inherent need to model nonlinear system behavior. Fuzzy systems have similar applications. Their main advantage is their simplicity and ease of implementation. Various aspects of neural networks and fuzzy systems are covered in this volume from The Industrial Electronics Handbook, Second Edition. System optimization is also examined and several new techniques are discussed, including evolutionary methods and swarm and ant colony optimizations. The last section is devoted to several applications involving methods of computational intelligence.
çè
CRC Press «Market: Electronics February 2011: 254x178: 568pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0283-0: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0284-7: £63.99/14
@
Series: Mechanical Engineering Series With substantial revisions, additional material, and extensive updates, this second edition of one of the primary works on the subject of nanotechnology incorporates user input and the perceived need to deliver a significant contribution to the current body of knowledge. New to this edition is an expanded glossary of over 300 terms enabling the text to be used as an effective nanotech dictionary. Each chapter includes updates and additional references while retaining the successful format of the original. Revisions and amendments extend to the solutions manual and other ancillary materials, making this text the gold standard in nanotechnology.
Nuclear Hydrogen Production Handbook Edited by Xing L. Yan and Ryutaro Hino, both at Japan Atomic Energy Agency, Ibaraki-ken Series: Green Chemistry and Chemical Engineering A comprehensive review of the current state and future prospects of nuclear hydrogen production, this volume offers substantial scholarly analyses, industrial data, and extensive references. It discusses research sponsored by Japan, the US DOE, Korea, China, France, and the EU. Coverage includes all major nuclear reactors and associated hydrogen processes; hydrogen production methods and nuclear hydrogen production systems; applications such as high-temperature electrolysis of steam, heat and corrosion resistant construction materials; development of ceramic process heat exchangers; operation management and safety; and thermochemical iodine-sulfur processes. CRC Press «Market: Chemical Engineering March 2011: 254x178: 768pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1083-5: £146.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1084-2: £146.00/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Edited by Bodgan Wilamowski and J. David Irwin, both at Auburn University, Alabama, USA
for e-mail updates in your field
Ben Rogers, Reno, Nevada, USA, Sumita Pennathur, University of California, Santa Barbara, USA and Jesse Adams, Nevada Nano, Inc., Reno, USA
CRC Press «Market: Mechanical Engineering February 2011: 254x178: 300pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4920-0: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4921-7: £63.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-8207-9
Intelligent Systems
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
Understanding Small Systems
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
266 electrical, chemical & mechanical engineering textbook
2nd Edition textbook
Principles of Sustainable Energy
Simulation of Dynamic Systems with MATLAB and Simulink
Series: Mechanical Engineering Series The field of renewable energy has grown beyond the use of solar power as an alternative energy source. Offering an interdisciplinary approach, this book presents a comprehensive overview of the many renewable energy courses currently available, which cover biomass and biofuels, solar thermal conversion, hydrogen cells, and wind energy conversion. Each chapter concludes with problem sets to reinforce concepts and applications. Examples and exercises throughout cover latitudes in northern and southern hemispheres and use the most current worldwide solar radiation data. CRC Press «Market: December 2010: 235x156: 880pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1407-9: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1404-8: £76.99/17
Power Electronics and Motor Drives Edited by Bodgan Wilamowski and J. David Irwin, both at Auburn University, Alabama, USA Universities throughout the world typically provide an excellent education in the various aspects of electronics, however their focus is normally on traditional low power electronics. In contrast, in the industrial environment, there is a need for high power electronics that is used to control electromechanical systems in addition to the low power electronics typically employed for analog and digital systems. To address this need, Section 1 of this volume in The Industrial Electronics Handbook, Second Edition, is focused on special high power semiconductor devices. Section 2 not only describes the various types of electrical motors and their principles of operation, but their limitations as well. Since electrical power can be delivered in either ac or dc, there is a need for high efficiency devices that perform the necessary conversion between these different types of power. These aspects are covered in the Section 3. Section 4 on Motor Drives is dedicated to a presentation of very specialized electronic circuits for the efficient control of electric motors. CRC Press «Market: Electronics February 2011: 254x178: 1024pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0285-4: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0286-1: £63.99/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Harold Klee and Randal Allen, University of Central Florida, Orlando, USA Employing the widely adopted MATLAB® and Simulink® software packages, this book offers the scientific and engineering communities integrated coverage of continuous simulation and the essential prerequisites in one resource. It also provides a complete introduction to the Real-Time Workshop. The text takes readers through the process of converting a mathematical model of a continuous or discrete system into a simulation model and source code implementation, which can be explored to better understand the dynamic behavior of the system. The second edition addresses common nonlinearities, expands coverage of the Kalman filter, and features extensive treatment of numerical parameters. CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering February 2011: 254x178: 784pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3673-6: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3674-3: £89.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-1-4200-4418-8
Semiconductors Integrated Circuit Design for Manufacturability Artur Balasinki, Cypress Semiconductor, San Deigo, California, USA Series: Devices, Circuits, and Systems The direction of integrated circuit design (ICD) continues to gradually evolve. Focusing on economic rather than technical aspects, this book explains the concept of ICD for manufacturability and its major steps: product definition, design, layout, and manufacturing. Exploring the return-on-investment for ICD for manufacturing, the text presents realistic test cases of product challenges, examines possible solutions, and then demonstrates how to choose and implement the right strategy. The author carefully considers the technical and economic tradeoffs of ICD for manufacturing based on mature methodologies. He also addresses manufacturing techniques for physical, electrical, and logical design. CRC Press «Market: Electronics May 2011: 235x156: 300pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1714-8: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1715-5: £82.00/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Frank Kreith, University of Colorado at Boulder, USA. and Jan F. Kreider, Kreider & Associates, Boulder, Colorado, USA
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
electrical, chemical & mechanical engineering 267 2nd Edition 3-volume set
2nd Edition
The Control Handbook
The Industrial Electronics Handbook – Five Volume Slip Case Set
Edited by William S. Levine, University of Maryland, College Park, USA Series: Electrical Engineering Handbook This second edition of an award-winning, bestselling handbook reflects not only the field’s advances but also its expansion. With approximately 25 new chapters and 35 revised chapters, the book provides enhanced coverage of networked and embedded control systems and new topics such as hybrid controls, biological controls, and network controls. Widely recognized as the defining book for the field of control systems, the first edition’s enormous and unique scope, coupled with its excellent organization by a first-class advisory panel quickly made it a standard reference. Completely revised and updated, the second edition is poised to continue the legacy. CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering December 2010: 254x178: 2096pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7366-9: £121.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7367-6: £121.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-8570-4
The Image Processing Handbook John C. Russ, North Carolina State University, Raleigh, USA This guide clearly explains the acquisition and use of digital images in a wide variety of scientific fields. This sixth edition features new sections on selecting a camera with resolution appropriate for use on light microscopes, on the ability of current cameras to capture raw images with high dynamic range, and on imaging in more than two dimensions. It discusses Dmax for x-ray images and combining images with different exposure settings to further extend the dynamic range. This edition also includes a new chapter on shape measurements, a review of new developments in image file searching, and a wide range of new examples and diagrams.
@
From traditional topics that form the core of industrial electronics to new concepts and technologies, The Industrial Electronics Handbook, in a single volume, brings together all of the topics important in electronics, system and process control, factory communications, measurement and instrumentation, circuits and devices, hardware, software, and factory automation. Expertly written, critically reviewed, and masterfully compiled, this bestselling handbook is an indispensable reference for engineers working with applications of electronic and electrical systems, apparatus, circuits and devices, process control, and industry equipment.
Through-the-Wall Radar Imaging Edited by Moeness G. Amin, Villanova University, Pennsylvania, USA As the first book on through wall radar imaging, this text examines an emerging and important area of research and technology, appealing to both engineers and scientists. It offers theory, analyses, and experimentations and covers key research and development efforts in signal processing, array processing, EM modeling, antenna design, SAR, Doppler signature estimation, polar difference imaging, and more. This book provides research findings, including real solutions to real problems. It also shows the impact of various types of walls on image resolution and quality and explores the various approaches to removing these effects. CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering December 2010: 235x156: 602pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1476-5: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1477-2: £95.00/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering November 2010: 254x178: 972pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4045-0: £108.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4063-4: £108.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-7254-4
for e-mail updates in your field
Series: Electrical Engineering Handbook
CRC Press «Market: Electronics February 2011: 254x178: 2000pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0289-2: £178.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0290-8: £178.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-8343-4
6th Edition
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
Edited by Bodgan Wilamowski and J. David Irwin, both at Auburn University, Alabama, USA
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
268 electrical, chemical & mechanical engineering
Heat Pipe Design and Technology Advances in Fluid A Practical Approach Catalytic Cracking Bahman Zohuri, Galaxy Advanced Engineering, Hillsborough, California, USA
This book provides a practical study of modern heat pipe engineering. After a review of heat and mass transfer theory relevant to heat pipe performance, the text first develops mathematical models for calculating heat-transfer limitations of high-temperature heat pipes and heat-transfer limitations and temperature gradient of low temperature heat pipes. It then compares the results with available experimental data. In addition, the author discusses heat pipe technology pertinent to the design and application of selfcontrolled, variable conductance heat pipes for spacecraft thermal control. The book also includes a computer program for designing and predicting heat pipe system performance. CRC Press «Market: Mechanical Engineering March 2011: 235x156: 584pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4523-3: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4524-0: £76.99/17
Testing, Characterization, and Environmental Regulations Edited by Mario L. Occelli, Atlanta, Georgia, USA Series: Chemical Industries Modern spectroscopic techniques are essential to the understanding of catalyst performance and feedstock properties. This volume examines the use of adsorption microcalorimetry to measure acidity, acid site density, and strength of the strongest acid sites in heterogenous catalysts. The book discusses the use of H-NMR to characterize the properties of an FCCU feedstock, pilot plant testing of catalysts and non traditional feedstocks, maximizing and improving LCO (heating oil) production and quality, and the improvement of FCCU operations. The final chapters review consent decree negotiation as well as FCC emissions (SOx, NOx, CO, PM) reduction technologies. CRC Press «Market: Chemical Engineering November 2010: 235x156: 488pp Hb: 978-1-4200-6254-0: £127.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-6255-7: £127.00/17
4th Edition
textbook
Transformer and Inductor Design Handbook
Mechanical Design
This is the fourth edition of a classic text on transformers and inducers. Ideal as a design manual, it begins by providing the basic fundamentals of magnetics, followed by an explanation of the design using the Kg or Ap approach. It also covers topics such as laminations, tape cores, powder cores and ferrites, and iron alloys. The author offers practical coverage on designing transformers, with step-by-step directions and several comparison tables and graphics. Two chapters were fully revised from the third edition, and five chapters were added. The book includes more than 400 illustrations, 125 tables, and 25 design examples. CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering January 2011: 254x178: 648pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3687-3: £121.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3688-0: £121.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8247-5393-1
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
With a focus on the Italian School of machine design as founded by R. Giovannozzi of Turin Polytechnic, this book provides a complete picture of the necessary components of design, along with the necessary instruments for implementation. It also explains the method of the compact modeling analysis of the mechanical problem. The book provides details from simple fundamentals to explanation of the design of traditional mechanical components. Topics covered include the methodological statement of engineering, properties of engineering materials, and the design of mechanical components and systems. Case studies are included for the different themes. CRC Press «Market: Mechanical Engineering March 2011: 254x178: 648pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1169-6: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1170-2: £63.99/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Colonel Wm. T. McLyman, K.G. Magnetics Inc., Idyllwild, California, USA
Antonino Risitano, University of Catania, Italy
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
electrical, chemical & mechanical engineering 269
Mobile Web 2.0
Testing Complex and Embedded Systems
Developing and Delivering Services to Mobile Devices Edited by Syed A. Ahson, Microsoft Corporation, Bellevue, Washington, USA and Mohammad Ilyas, Florida Atlantic University, Boca Raton, USA From basic concepts to research, this handbook covers all aspects of Mobile Web 2.0. The text identifies the main challenges and proposes a platform architecture that addresses some of these challenges, discusses different platforms for developing mobile services, and examines the effect of context on mobile usability. In addition to exploring mobile social software as an ICT and different platforms for developing mobile services, the book also illustrates a conceptual framework that provides modeling facilities for context-aware, multi-channel web applications and demonstrates how high-level modeling constructs can drive the application development process through automatic code generation. Auerbach Publications «Market: Electrical Engineering December 2010: 235x156: 626pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0082-9: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0083-6: £76.99/17
Kim H. Pries, Stonebridge Electronics North America, El Paso, USA and Jon M. Quigley, Lexington, North Carolina, USA Using combinatorial approaches, this book aims to motivate testers and testing organizations to perform meaningful testing. The text details planning activities prior to testing, how to scope the work, and how to achieve a successful conclusion. Rather than presenting the entire continuum of testing for a particular product or design attribute, this volume focuses on boundary conditions. The authors provide various techniques that can be used to streamline testing and help identify problems before they occur, including turbocharge testing methods from Six Sigma. Coverage includes testing, simulation, and emulation. CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering December 2010: 235x156: 312pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2140-4: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2141-1: £57.99/17
2nd Edition textbook
Modeling, Control Design and Simulation Sabiha Wadoo, New York Institute of Technology, Old Westbury, USA and Pushkin Kachroo, University of Nevada, Las Vegas, USA Highlighting the unique and difficult design and control problems related to autonomous underwater vehicles (AUVs), this book explains the impact of nonlinear dynamics, uncertain models, and unforeseeable environmental interferences and disturbances on AUV control. It emphasizes the importance of vehicle adherence to a precise trajectory whether that trajectory is preprogrammed, derived by a knowledgebased system in response to the environment, or specified by a human supervisor. Contributions consider motion planning, nonlinear controllability, and nonlinear feedback controller design systems, and they emphasize high-level planning and reliance on dynamic control to guarantee stability and consistent performance.
çè
CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering November 2010: 235x156: 165pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1831-2: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1832-9: £89.00/17
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Bio-inspired Computing and Networking Yang Xiao, The University of Alabama, Tuscaloosa, USA In seeking new methods to cope with greater communication demands, researchers are finding inspiration in examples presented by nature. Considering a range of sources from insect to primate communication, leading researchers present state-of-the-art approaches and novel technologies for developing bio-inspired models. They cover mathematical models and present experimental studies of bio-inspired computing and communications. They explore bio-inspired topology control and reconfiguration methods, as well as bio-inspired localization, synchronization, and mobility approaches. They also delve into such forward-thinking concepts as the evolution and self-healing of network architectures. CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering February 2011: 235x156: 368pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8032-2: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8033-9: £76.99/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Autonomous Underwater Vehicles
Computational Methods for Electromagnetic and Optical Systems John Jarem, University of Alabama, Huntsville, USA and Partha P. Banerjee, University of Dayton, Ohio, USA Series: Optical Science and Engineering This text introduces and examines a variety of spectral computational techniques – including k-space theory, Floquet theory and beam propagation – that are used to analyze electromagnetic and optical problems. The book also presents a solution to Maxwell’s equations from a set of first order coupled partial differential equations. CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering February 2011: 279x216: 488pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0422-3: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0423-0: £76.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8247-7916-0
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
270 electrical, chemical & mechanical engineering Configurational Forces
Discrete-Event Modeling and Simulation
Thermomechanics, Physics, Mathematics, and Numerics
Theory and Applications
Gerard A. Maugin, Universite Pierre et Marie Curie, France Series: Modern Mechanics and Mathematics Presenting the general framework of configurational forces, this book offers an approach to material forces that can be used to predict the propagation of defects in materials ranging from dislocations and cracks in metals to domain walls in ferromagnets and many industrial components. It discusses a wide range of varied applications, including elasticity, plasticity, fracture, physics, and even biomechanics. Providing numerous problems and examples, the author addresses such topics as field theory, canonical thermomechanics of complex continua, generalized continua, Eshelby stress, systems with mass exchange, electromagnetic materials, and numerical applications. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Mechanical Engineering November 2010: 235x156: 544pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4612-4: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4613-1: £76.99/17
Connectivity for Seamless Mobility Edited by Syed A. Ahson, Microsoft Corporation, Bellevue, Washington, USA and Mohammad Ilyas, Florida Atlantic University, Boca Raton, USA Series: Internet and Communications
With its obvious advantages, discrete event simulation has the potential to become a unifying framework for handling differential equations models, difference equation models, and state machines. Toward that end, this book brings together world-class scientists: both practical researchers who are involved with discrete event simulations as the means to their desired end, and theoretical researchers who are particularly interested in advancing the state of the means. Between them, they bring together formerly scattered approaches to hone in on a framework matured over more than four decades, one responsible for the most effective and, likely to become, the most accepted modelbased design approaches. CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering December 2010: 235x156: 536pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7233-4: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7234-1: £82.00/17
Enabling Technologies for Seamless Mobility
Series: Internet and Communications
DC Power Supplies Power Management and Surge Protection for Power Electronic Systems Nihal Kularatna, The University of Waikato, New Zealand Modern electronic systems, particularly portable consumer electronic systems and processor based systems, are power hungry, compact, and featurepacked. This book presents the most essential summaries of the theory behind DC-DC converter topologies of both linear and switching types. The text discusses power supply characteristics and design specifications based on new developments in power management techniques and modern semiconductors entering into the portable electronics market. The author also addresses off-the-line power supplies, digital control of power supply, power supply protection, transient protection, and patent-pending supercapacitor based techniques.
Auerbach Publications «Market: Electrical Engineering September 2011: 235x156: 384pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9202-8: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9203-5: £49.99/17
Finance and Accounting for Energy Engineers S. Bobby Rauf, Lilburn, Georgia, USA Understanding finance and accounting principles is important in interfacing and conducting business with accountants, financial analysts, and members of upper management. In a relatively simple and easy-to-understand manner, this book familiarizes professionals with decision-making skills founded on financial calculations and quantitative analysis. It covers finance and accounting ratios and other metrics; income statements, balance sheets, cash flow, and working capital concepts; inventory concepts; life cycle, period, direct, and indirect costs; and energy performance contracting. Each chapter concludes with a list of questions or problems and answers are at the back of the book.
Byoungho Lee and Hwi Kim, both at Seoul National University, Korea Most available books on computational electrodynamics are focused on FDTD, FEM, or other specific techniques developed in microwave engineering. Co-authored by a well-known expert in the field, this book is a complete guide to the principles and detailed mathematics of the upto-date Fourier modal method of optical analysis. It takes readers through the implementation of MATLAB® codes for practical modeling of wellknown and promising nanophotonic structures. The authors also address the limitations of the Fourier modal method. CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering February 2011: 235x156: 350pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8838-0: £99.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8839-7: £99.00/17
2nd Edition
Handbook of Hydraulic Fluid Technology George E. Totten Edited by George E. Totten, Portland State University, Oregon, USA and Victor J. De Negri, FAPEU, Brazil The Handbook of Hydraulic Fluid Technology provides an ideal resource for designing hydraulic systems and selecting hydraulic fluids used in engineering applications. Featuring new illustrations, data tables, and practical examples, this second edition is updated with essential information on the latest hydraulic fluids and testing methods. The detailed text facilitates unparalleled understanding of the total hydraulic system, including important hardware, fluid properties, and hydraulic lubricants. Written by worldwide experts, the book also offers a rigorous overview of hydraulic fluid technology and evaluates the ecological benefits of water as an important alternative technology. CRC Press «Market: Mechanical Engineering March 2011: 254x178: 1040pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8526-6: £121.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8527-3: £121.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8247-6022-9
Fairmont Press «Market: Electrical Engineering December 2010: 229x152 Hb: 978-1-4398-5193-7: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5194-4: £82.00/17
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
order now!
Series: Computational Analysis, Synthesis, and Design of Dynamic Systems
Edited by Syed A. Ahson, Microsoft Corporation, Bellevue, Washington, USA and Mohammad Ilyas, Florida Atlantic University, Boca Raton, USA
Auerbach Publications «Market: Electrical Engineering September 2011: 235x156: 320pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9206-6: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9208-0: £49.99/17
CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering March 2011: 235x156: 300pp Hb: 978-04-1580-247-5: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-04-1580-248-2: £82.00/17
Edited by Gabriel A. Wainer, Carleton University, Canada and Pieter J. Mosterman, The MathWorks, Inc. Natick, Massachusetts, USA
Fourier Modal Method and Its Applications in Computational Nanophotonics
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
electrical, chemical & mechanical engineering 271 Heat Exchangers for Refrigeration Applications *
Image and Video Processing in the Compressed Domain
Large Energy Storage Systems Handbook
Zahid H. Ayub, Isotherm, Inc., Arlington, Virginia, USA
Jayanta Mukhopadhyay, Indian Institute of Technology, Kharagpur
Refrigeration systems are a vital part of our daily lives and are needed for food preservation, indoor air quality, comfort control, gas liquefaction, food and beverage production, and electronic cooling. However, power plants that generate energy for refrigeration systems are a major source of global warming. In view of this, refrigeration equipment engineers must design more efficient systems to address environmental impacts, efficiency regulations, and operating costs. Heat Exchangers for Refrigeration Applications provides a comprehensive look at refrigeration system design and features practical examples and problems in each chapter that address real-world issues and lead to viable solutions.
This book presents the fundamentals and properties of various image transforms used in image and video compression and discusses their applications in designing various image and video processing algorithms in the compressed domain. Emphasizing DCT-based compression algorithms and DWT-based JPEG2000, the text explores different image and video compression techniques. It then describes key properties of various transform spaces, with a focus on block DCT space and DWT. The author also covers several types of image and video processing operations along with techniques related to the analysis of video and images in the compressed domain.
Edited by Frank S. Barnes, University of Colorado, Boulder, USA and Jonah G. Levine, Nederland, Colorado, USA
CRC Press «Market: Mechanical Engineering March 2011: 235x156: 400pp Hb: 978-1-4200-4737-0: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-4738-7: £76.99/17
Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Computer Science / Computer Engineering / Computing March 2011: 235x156: 250pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2935-6: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2936-3: £49.99/17
Heat Pump Drying *
Induction Motor Drives
Experimentation, Theory, Design, and Practice
Principles, Control, and Implementation
Odilio Alves-Filho, Norwegian University of Science & Technology, Trondheim and German Efremov, Moscow State Open University, Russia
Chandan Chakraborty and Suman Maiti, both at Indian Institute of Technology, Kharagpur
çè
CRC Press «Market: Mechanical Engineering February 2012: 235x156: 472pp Hb: 978-0-8493-4632-3: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-0603-2: £95.00/17
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
With an emphasis on real-life experimentation, this book introduces the principles of operation and the implementation of controllers for induction motor drives through both simulation and experimental results. The book deals with some common and important topics associated with induction motor drives, and it introduces basic types of controllers by implementing them in actual experimentation. The goal of the text is to help users test a controller for induction motor drives using a Simulink® model (provided on the book’s accompanying CD-ROM), then quickly develop a prototype and validate the simulation results through experimentation with the prototype. The accompanying CD-ROM also includes MATLAB® models. CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering March 2011: 235x156: 475pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1835-0: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1836-7: £95.00/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Although heat pump technology has been around for several decades, its advantages and limitations are largely unknown. This volume covers drying fundamentals, theory, and experiments, linking these essential elements to heat pump dryer (HPD) design and industrial practices. Integrating various fields, it describes experiments, governing laws, and analyzed results from examples and solved problems. It presents recent research and dimensioning of HPD based on operating conditions required for enhanced product quality, low energy use, and low environmental impact. It also presents new approaches, such as environmentally friendly working fluids, intermittent drying, and cold extrusion.
Series: Power Electronics and Applications Series
Series: Mechanical Engineering Series Reviewing several ways in which energy can be stored so that it may be deployable by utilities, this handbook covers major topics, including pumped hydroelectric systems, compressed air, and batteries. By considering the perspective of developers, planners, and legislators as well as engineers tasked with assessing and developing real energy storage systems, readers will find the information they need to make economic and practical decisions concerning renewable energy. Chapters on modeling for integration of wind and solar energy into the grid, hydrogen generation and storage, and thermal energy storage are covered. CRC Press «Market: Mechanical Engineering February 2011: 235x156: 280pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8600-3: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8601-0: £89.00/17
textbook
Intelligent Instrumentation Principles and Applications Manabendra Bhuyan, Tezpur Central University, India A reflection of the evolution of topics now covered in instrumentation or sensor engineering courses, this book employs principles-based explanations to delineate the technology. Using commercial devices and technology to support the theory, the author provides solid answers to the questions: What makes a sensor intelligent? What are the various ways to classify them? How can a classical instrumentation system be provided with the intelligent features? and What are the recent technologies of II/SS? The book includes illustrations, photographs, numerical problems and case studies wherever needed to explain the theory. CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering November 2010: 235x156: 550pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8953-0: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8954-7: £49.99/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
272 electrical, chemical & mechanical engineering
Edited by Douglas Rickman, NASA, Huntsville, Alabama, USA and Christian Schrader, NASA – Oak Ridge Associated Universities, Huntsville, Alabama, USA Written in language that non-geologists can easily understand, this book provides basic information about the lunar regolith and simulants. It explains how simulants are produced, what sources exist, and what processes are used for their production. It emphasizes the cost structure of simulants and the limitations of existing models. Chapters cover terrestrial sources of simulant components and processing technologies for production of simulants. The text supplies figures, photographs, charts, a glossary, and extensive references for further study. CRC Press «Market: Mechanical Engineering March 2011: 229x152: 300pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4874-6: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4875-3: £89.00/17
Membrane Technologies and Applications Edited by Kaustubha Mohanty, Indian Institute of Technology, India and Mihir K. Purkait, IIt Guwahati, India Compiling recent advances in membrane separations technology, this book introduces cost-effective solutions for separation problems in a wide range of industries. It discusses membrane use in oil, petrochemicals, and fossil fuels; natural gas exploration; bioseparation; water purification and wastewater treatment; and chemical manufacturing. It describes the role of membrane technologies in resource recovery, pollution prevention, and energy production, as well as in environmental monitoring and quality control. A concise resource for emerging technologies, the book provides the tools to implement effective production processes, improve environmental protection and public health, and explore new opportunities for sustainable growth. CRC Press «Market: Chemical Engineering March 2011: 229x152: 296pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0526-8: £99.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0527-5: £99.00/17
Nonlinear H-Infinity Control, Hamiltonian Systems and Hamilton-Jacobi Equations M.D.S. Aliyu, Ecole Polytechnique, Canada Based on a decade of research, this reference manual is a comprehensive mathematical treatment of nonlinear robust control, particularly nonlinear H-infinity control. To be used as a textbook and reference, it covers topics ranging from singular nonlinear H-infinity control, nonlinear H-infinity filtering, mixed H2/H-infinity nonlinear control and filtering, and nonlinear H-infinityalmost-disturbance-decoupling. Continuous-time and discrete-time systems are discussed as well. One chapter focuses on algorithms for the solution of the Hamiltonian – Jacobi equations. The authors employ examples, figures, and simulations to ensure comprehension. They include more than 2,000 equations throughout the book.
Micromechanical Analysis and Multi-Scale Modeling Using the Voronoi Cell Finite Element Method Somnath Ghosh, Ohio State University, Columbus, USA Series: Applied & Computational Mechanics Concerned with heterogeneous materials, functionally graded materials, and alloy systems, this book addresses the key problem of multi-scale deformation and failure of heterogeneous materials. It emphasizes a special micromechanical analysis tool, the Voronoi Cell Finite Element Method (VCFEM), developed by the author and others for the modeling of heterogeneous microstructures acquired from real micrographs. Considerable success has been achieved in modeling thermoelastic-plastic problems and microstructural damage with VCFEM. This book provides a unique perspective for creating an integrated system that links quantitative microstructural characterization with detailed multi-scale analysis of deformation for heterogeneous materials. CRC Press «Market: Mechanical Engineering April 2011: 235x156: 608pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9437-4: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9438-1: £95.00/17
Operating Systems and Development Platforms for Seamless Mobility Edited by Syed A. Ahson, Microsoft Corporation, Bellevue, Washington, USA and Mohammad Ilyas, Florida Atlantic University, Boca Raton, USA Series: Internet and Communications Small yet powerful portable computers, combined with the exponential growth of the Internet, have made it possible to access information at nearly any location at almost any time. From basic concepts to research-level material, this book provides a single resource on the present state of the field, then explores the benefits and challenges. The text includes technical information about all aspects of mobile computing. With a panel of experts offering the latest insight, this volume focuses specifically on operating systems and development platforms for seamless mobility. Auerbach Publications «Market: Electrical Engineering August 2011: 235x156: 320pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9200-4: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9201-1: £49.99/17
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Moriaki Wakaki, Tokai University, Japan, Keiei Kudo, formerly at University of Tsukuba, Japan and Takehisa Shibuya, Tokai University, Japan Series: Optical Science and Engineering This book brings together and couples results from electromagnetic, mechanics, thermodynamics, solid state physics, chemistry, optics, and materials science to provide a coherent picture. It discusses the underlying physical basis of each property, including constituents, bonding, and structural order. The book also discusses units and unit conversions, provides simple models for estimating properties or extrapolating data, and supplies examples of how to fit data using these models. Two chapters are completely devoted to practical problems in optical systems. CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering March 2011: 229x152: 300pp Hb: 978-0-8247-2759-8: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-1548-5: £89.00/17
Optical Techniques for Solid-State Materials Characterization Edited by Rohit P. Prasankumar and Antoinette J. Taylor, both at Center for Integraed Nanotechnologies, Los Alamos, New Mexico, USA With an overview of the electronic, optical, magnetic and structural properties of semiconductors and metals, this book provides a detailed look at basic and advanced optical techniques used to characterize complex solid-state materials. The text begins with an introduction to light-matter interactions and nanoscale properties of semiconductors, metals, and other materials. Next, it examines linear optical spectroscopy, including photoluminescence, followed by a discussion of time-resolved optical spectroscopy. Several chapters focus on spatially-resolved optical spectroscopy. A final section looks at recent developments, emphasizing techniques that integrate temporal and spatial resolutions. CRC Press February 2011: 235x156: 450pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1537-3: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1437-6
3rd Edition textbook
Power-Switching Converters Simon Ang, University of Arkansas, Fayetteville, USA and Alejandro Oliva, Universidad Nacional del Sur, Argentina The third edition of this volume addresses new subjects, including LED drivers, and DC-DC converters both for solar panels and for fuel cells. The book covers converter power management, phase-shift PWM, and low-noise and bidirectional DC-DC converters, featuring a non-linear discrete model of the DC-DC converter itself. The text discusses new simulation tools such as PSIM, LTSPICE, and POWERESIM, and provides additional and updated information on digital control of DCDC converters, switched capacitor converters, and power factor controllers. CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering November 2010: 235x156: 651pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1533-5: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1534-2: £76.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8247-2245-6
CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering March 2011: 235x156: 500pp Hb: 978-1-4398-5483-9: £146.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5485-3: £146.00/17
order now!
Optical Materials and Applications
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Lunar Regolith Simulant
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
electrical, chemical & mechanical engineering 273 Seamless Mobility Enabling the Convergence of Mobile Computing and Communications (4 Volume Set) Edited by Syed A. Ahson, Microsoft Corporation, Bellevue, Washington, USA, Mohammad Ilyas and Imad Mahgoub, both at Florida Atlantic University, Boca Raton, USA Series: Internet and Communications A complete review and overview of the field, this handbook explores benefits, challenges, and the latest thinking about the major topics of this emerging discipline. In 40 chapters written by industry experts, it provides technical information about all aspects of mobile computing, from basic concepts to research-level material, with learned analysis of future directions. This fourvolume set captures the present state of the field and provides an invaluable source of reference material. It covers the entire spectrum of mobile computing: operating systems and development platforms, technologies, user interfaces and applications, and connectivity. Auerbach Publications «Market: Electrical Engineering October 2011: 235x156: 1200pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9213-4: £127.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9214-1: £127.00/17
Tensor Product Model Transformation in Polytopic Model-Based Control
Transportable Off-Grid Power Solutions Based on Alternative Energy Sources
Peter Baranyi, Institute of the Hungarian Academy of Sciences, Budapest, Yeung Yam, Chinese University of Hong Kong, Shatkin and Peter Varlaki, Institute of the Hungarian Academy of Sciences, Budapest
Design, Installation and Maintenance
Authoritative and highly focused, this reference describes a novel method in multi-objective control system design. It uses examples drawn from aerospace engineering and a free MATLAB toolbox for easy implementation. The book unites two well-known areas of multi-objective control system design – quasi Linear Parameter Varying (LPV) models and the Linear Matrix Inequality (LMI) method. It introduces a methodology to automatically generate from any given quasi LPV model a set of invariant, canonical and convex poly topic representations that are readily executable for LMI based system control design. CRC Press April 2011: 235x156: 250pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1816-9: £82.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1817-6: £82.99/17
Siew-Chong Tan, Yuk-Ming Lai and Chi-Kong Tse, all at The Hong Kong Polytechnic University, Kowloon This reference provides a complete understanding of sliding mode control principles, its application to power converters, and the practical realization of such controllers. Bridging the gap between power electronics and control theory, it presents a detailed description of the various theories, operating principles, and information that are relevant to the state of the art and the current development of sliding mode controllers and their applications to power converters. The book also reviews traditional and modern implementation techniques of sliding mode control for power converters, covering pulse-width modulation as well as conventional hysteresis modulation. CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering March 2011: 235x156: 350pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3025-3: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3026-0: £89.00/17
Comparing energy solutions, applications, and requirements, this text explores possible explanations and answers for the two billion people worldwide currently without electricity. It explores the potential solution of off-grid power use and provides a discussion of the typology, different technologies available, and cost assumptions associated with it. Experts from around the world explore the off-grid application to solar energy, fuel cells, generators, wind, and biomass fuel. From this dialogue, project managers can grasp the pros and cons associated with each source as well as the dimensions needed to design an off-grid power solution from scratch.
The Control Handbook
2nd Edition
Control System Fundamentals
The Control Systems Handbook
Edited by William S. Levine, University of Maryland, College Park, USA
Techniques and Implementation
Series: Informa Telecoms & Media
CRC Press April 2011: 235x156: 300pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7779-7: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7780-3: £63.99/17
2nd Edition
Sliding Mode Control of Switching Power Converters
Edited by Martin Riedi, Off-Grid Systems, Winterthur, Switzerland and Christ Andri Hassler, Bonat, Switzerland
Series: Electrical Engineering Handbook CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering December 2010: 254x178: 664pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7362-1: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7363-8: £57.99/17
Edited by William S. Levine, University of Maryland, College Park, USA Series: Electrical Engineering Handbook
2nd Edition
The Control Handbook Control System Applications Edited by William S. Levine, University of Maryland, College Park, USA Series: Electrical Engineering Handbook CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering December 2010: 254x178: 768pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7360-7: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7361-4: £57.99/17
Control System Advanced Methods
A revision of the widely respected, award winning, bestselling first edition, this book has been completely updated to reflect the numerous advances in the field. Divided into three volumes, the second edition emphasizes the progress made during the past ten years and highlights topics that have increased in importance. While the fundamentals have remained largely unchanged, the advanced methods and applications sections have been extensively revised and expanded. The set contains new material on digital control, enhanced coverage of networked and embedded control systems, hybrid controls, biological controls, and network controls. CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering December 2010: 254x178: 760pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7364-5: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7365-2: £57.99/17
User Interfaces and Applications for Seamless Mobility Edited by Syed A. Ahson, Microsoft Corporation, Bellevue, Washington, USA, and Mohammad Ilyas, Florida Atlantic University, Boca Raton, USA Series: Internet and Communications
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Auerbach Publications «Market: Electrical Engineering September 2011: 235x156: 448pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9204-2: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9205-9: £49.99/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
274 industrial engineering & management
Concise Guide to Workplace Safety and Health
Handbook of Healthcare Delivery Systems
What You Need to Know, When You Need It
Edited by Yuehwern Yih, Purdue University, West Lafayette, Indiana, USA
Gary Chambers, Studio City, California, USA Going beyond compliance, this book addresses 34 major occupational safety and health topics. Organized for quick access to regulatory requirements or online resources, the text addresses required documentation, training elements, record-keeping, and more, including quality online links for background and training information and those that lead to sample programs.This is a valuable reference for business owners, HR managers, safety supervisors. lawyers, and students as well as OSHA-concerned personnel who are seeeking to be safe as well as compliant. CRC Press «Market: Environmental and Occupational Health and Safety December 2010: 235x156: 412pp Pb: 978-1-4398-0732-3: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0733-0: £49.99/17
Series: Industrial and Systems Engineering Series A resource covering the delivery of all healthcare services, this handbook provides the collective source to promote and facilitate integrated system solutions for healthcare. Written from a systems engineering perspective, it provides theoretical foundations, methodologies, and case studies in each main sector of healthcare delivery system for designing, assessing, optimizing, and managing each healthcare outcome. It covers the state-of-the-art in modern technologies and offers a comprehensive description of the healthcare delivery system from the macro level (e.g. hospitals) to the micro level (e.g. operating room). CRC Press «Market: Manufacturing and Industrial Engineering December 2010: 254x178: 792pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0333-2: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0362-2: £82.00/17
2nd Edition
2nd Edition
Handbook for Critical Cleaning
Microorganisms in Home and Indoor Work Environments
Updated, re-organized, and rewritten, this two-volume handbook covers cleaning processes, applications, management, safety, and environmental concerns. The editors rigorously examine technical issues, cleaning agent options and systems, chemical and equipment integration, contamination control, cleanliness standards, analytical testing, process selection, implementation and maintenance, specific applications areas, and regulatory issues. International contributors give the text a global viewpoint. Color illustrations, video clips, and animation for download are online and provide enhanced understanding. The handbook is available for purchase individually or as a two-volume set. CRC Press «Market: Manufacturing and Industrial Engineering January 2011: 254x178: 1152pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2826-7: £114.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-1655-5
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Diversity, Health Impacts, Investigation and Control Edited by Brian Flannigan, Napier University, UK, Robert A. Samson, CBS Fungal Biodiversity Centre, the Netherlands and David J. Miller, Carleton University, Canada A complete review of airborne microorganisms and the indoor environments in which they can be found, this second edition of a bestseller covers heterotrophic bacteria and fungi, viruses, pollen, and mites. The authors provide a comprehensive review of microorganisms in outdoor and indoor as well as air, their growth, control, and remediation. The book highlights the effects of prolonged exposure on the health of occupants of buildings. Extensively revised and expanded, this second edition includes three additional chapters and reflects advances made in the decade since its initial publication. CRC Press «Market: Environmental and Occupational Health and Safety March 2011: 279x216: 560pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9334-6: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9335-3: £95.00/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Edited by Barbara Kanegsberg and Ed Kanegsberg, both at BFK Solutions, Pacific Palisades, California, USA
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
industrial engineering & management 275
Manufacturing Techniques for Microfabrication and Nanotechnology *
Systems Life Cycle Costing
Marc J. Madou, University of California, Irvine, USA
Series: Complex Systems Engineering and Management
Authored by Marc Madeau, leading expert in MEMS and manufacturing at the nano scale, this textbook focuses on industrial lithography and pattern transfer. It includes extensive references, a comprehensive glossary, worked out problems, and end of chapter problems. PowerPoint slides and solutions are available for qualifying instructors.
CRC Press «Market: Manufacturing and Industrial Engineering December 2010: 279x216: 976pp Hb: 978-1-4200-5519-1: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-5521-4: £63.99/17
Economic Analysis, Estimation, and Management John Vail Farr, Stevens Institute of Technology, Hoboken, New Jersey, USA An analysis of today’s business environment and the integration of software, people, and interfaces, this book explores the roles of engineers, information technologists, and product development professionals. It provides methods, processes, and tools (MPTs) for life cycle costing while focusing on technology-centric examples. The author includes unpublished material on the costing of commercial off the shelf systems and presents the MPTs for a product development perspective. The text also covers applications that use Excel spreadsheets for better comprehension. CRC Press February 2011: 235x156: 376pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2891-5: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2892-2: £63.99/17
3rd Edition textbook
Product Design for Manufacture and Assembly
Transportation Systems Reliability and Safety
Geoffrey Boothroyd, Boothroyd Dewhurst Inc., Wakefield, Rhode Island, USA, Peter Dewhurst and Winston A. Knight, both at University of Rhode Island, Kingston, USA
B.S. Dhillon, University of Ottawa, Canada y integrating coverage of transportation B reliability and safety topics and concepts into a single volume, this book eliminates the need to consult a number of different resources to obtain important information. It begins with mathematical concepts and safety basics considered useful to understanding the contents of subsequent chapters. The author then covers the significance of human error in rail and transportation systems and provides material on methods used to perform reliability and safety analyses. He offers problems to test reader comprehension and examples with solutions.
Series: Manufacturing Engineering and Materials Processing
çè
CRC Press «Market: Manufacturing and Industrial Engineering December 2010: 254x178: 712pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8927-1: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8928-8: £82.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8247-0584-8
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
CRC Press «Market: Manufacturing and Industrial Engineering January 2011: 235x156: 248pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4640-7: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4641-4: £63.99/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Now in its third edition, this volume features new problem sets and student assignments, making this respected reference work now even more suitable for use in product design and design for manufacture courses. Chapters have been updated from previous editions with more recent case studies of the application of design for manufacture and assembly (DFMA) techniques, important industry changes, and emphasis on current trends such as design for power injection molding and surface mount devices. Each chapter also includes updated cost information on materials, labor, and machine operations.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
276 industrial engineering & management Air and Missile Defense Systems Engineering
RFID and Auto-ID in Planning and Logistics
Statistical Process Control for Real-World Applications
Warren Boord, Washington, D.C., USA and John B. Hoffman, Technology Service Corporation, Silver Spring, Maryland, USA
A Practical Guide for Military UID Applications
William A. Levinson, Levinson Productivity Systems, Wilkes-Barre, Pennsylvania, USA
As new missile shield programs are put into place, the need increases for information on the latest systems design techniques and component technologies. This book explains how to properly assess war-fighting capability by examining detect, control, and engage processes in the context of the combat system. The authors present a systems engineering approach that can be applied to new systems under consideration and to existing operational system designs. Using this approach, performance tradeoffs can be made between the sensor (radar) and weapon (missile) that support the development, testing, and fielding of a balanced system. The text also addresses battlespace performance assessment. CRC Press «Market: Information Technology March 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0670-8: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0671-5: £82.00/17
Erick C. Jones, University of Nebraska, Lincoln, USA and Christopher A. Chung, Seabrook, Texas, USA Now that RFID technology has come of age and there are numerous choices to consider the challenge has become how to select the right one for the job. A practical reference on the workings of RFID and Auto-ID technologies such as satellite tags and barcodes and their integration into logistics initiatives, this book covers background, history, and current applications. It delineates a decision model for choosing RFID and other Auto-ID technologies. It covers integrating and developing RFID and AutoID applications, traditional planning and logistics, military UID requirements, and future research. CRC Press «Market: Manufacturing and Industrial Engineering March 2011: 254x178: 432pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9427-5: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9428-2: £95.00/17
CRC Press «Market: Manufacturing and Industrial Engineering November 2010: 235x156: 280pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2000-1: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2001-8: £49.99/17
textbook
Edited by Barbara Kanegsberg and Ed Kanegsberg, both at BFK Solutions, Pacific Palisades, California, USA Updated, re-organized, and rewritten, this second edition of a bestseller covers cleaning processes, applications, management, safety, and environmental concerns. Color illustrations, video clips, and animations that enhance the book’s accessibility are available online. The handbook is available for purchase individually or as a two-volume set. CRC Press «Market: Manufacturing and Industrial Engineering February 2011: 254x178: 608pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2829-8: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2830-4: £63.99/17
Critical Cleaning Processes
Safety Professional’s Reference and Study Guide
Thermal Computations for Electronics
W. David Yates, Bodine Services of the Midwest, Decatur, Illinois, USA
Conductive, Radiative, and Convective Air Cooling
Written as a reference and study guide for candidates preparing to take the Board of Certified Safety Professional’s exam, this book provides technical information needed for the test. It covers topics such as math review, ventilation, noise, gases and particulates, radiation, toxicology, industrial hygiene, biological hazards, thermal stressors, statistics, fire protection and prevention, accident investigation, mechanics, hydrostatics and hydraulics, electrical safety, engineering economy and worker’s compensation. The book provides step-by-step instructions on how to solve the equations and formulas on the exam and gives examples on how and when to use them.
Gordon Ellison, Portland State University, Oregon, USA
CRC Press «Market: Environmental and Occupational Health and Safety December 2010: 235x156: 580pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3485-5: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3486-2: £63.99/17
Edited by Barbara Kanegsberg and Ed Kanegsberg, both at BFK Solutions, Pacific Palisades, California, USA
CRC Press «Market: Manufacturing and Industrial Engineering November 2010: 254x178: 414pp Hb: 978-1-4398-5017-6: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5076-3: £76.99/17
CRC Press «Market: Manufacturing and Industrial Engineering February 2011: 254x178: 544pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2827-4: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2828-1: £63.99/17
( +44 (0)1235 400524
This book covers mathematical calculation, prediction, and application methods for conductive, radiative, and convective heat transfer in electronic equipment. It provides complete mathematical derivations, supplements formulae with design plots, and offers exercise solutions and lecture aids. These include landscapeviewable PDF files and downloadable Mathcad worksheet files for text application. The author covers topics such as methods for multi-surface radiation exchange, conductive heat transfer in electronics, and finite element theory with a variational calculus method explained for heat conduction. Offering mathematical descriptions of large thermal network problem formulation, he discusses theory of comprehensive thermal spreading resistance (with design curves and applications), and includes steady-state and time-dependent problems.
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Critical Cleaning Process Applications, Management, Safety, and Environmental Concerns
order now!
Picking up where the textbooks usually leave off, this book equips readers to deal with non-normal applications scientifically and to explain the methodology to suppliers and customers. It shows how to handle uncooperative real-world processes that do not follow textbook assumptions. The text explains how to set realistic control limits and calculate meaningful process capability indices for non-normal applications. Higlighting the pitfalls of assuming normality for all processes, the book addresses multivariate systems, nested variation sources, as well as lognormal, gamma, and Weibull distributions.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
mathematics & statistics 277 textbook
2nd Edition
A Mathematical Look at Politics
Algebraic Number Theory
E. Arthur Robinson, Jr. and Daniel Ullman, both at George Washington University, Washington, USA
Richard A. Mollin, University of Calgary, Canada
With record voter turnouts for the 2008 presidential election, interest in the U.S. electoral system and voting,especially among college students, has never been higher. This textbook is based on a popular mathematics and politics course that the authors have taught at George Washington University for the past six years. It explores the mathematics of politics, showing how mathematical reasoning is connected to the pressing issues of contemporary politics and in the liberal arts. Focusing on voting, apportionment, conflict, and the Electoral College, each part of the text examines a type of decision problem and a possible way to solve it.
The second edition of this popular book features coverage of L-functions and function fields to provide a more modern view of the field. This edition also introduces class groups for both binary and quadratic forms, making it much easier to prove the finiteness of the class number of both groups via an isomorphism. In addition, the text provides new results on the relationship between quadratic residue symbols and fundamental units of real quadratic fields in conjunction with prime representation. Along with reorganizing and shortening chapters for an easier presentation of material, the author includes updated problem sets and additional examples.
CRC Press «Market: Math December 2010: 235x156: 479pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1983-8: £30.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1984-5: £30.99/17
Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Math January 2011: 254x178: 420pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4598-1: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4599-8: £57.99/17
A Student’s Guide to the Study, Practice, and Tools of Modern Mathematics
An Introduction to Forecasting Time Series Using Stata
Series: Discrete Mathematics and Its Applications
Robert Yaffee, New York University, New York, USA An Introduction to Forecasting Time Series Using Stata explores forecasting times series with Stata 10. It presents theory, modeling, programming, and interpretation of the major time series models, along with interesting applications to business and risk analysis in finance. The book shows how to apply these techniques to real-life social science, economic, business, financial, and medical data, with many examples on the reporting and interpreting of the results.
Donald Bindner and Martin Erickson, both at Truman State University, Kirksville, Missouri, USA Series: Discrete Mathematics and Its Applications Ideal for students and newcomers to the field, this guidebook provides a comprehensive reference to key topics in modern mathematics. With an introduction to MATLAB®, Mathematica®, Maple™, Maxima, LaTeX, and R, the text explains how to study mathematics, how to write proofs, how to conduct mathematical research, and how to give presentations on mathematics. In addition, the authors detail how to get started with various programming languages, including Beamer, Octave, HTML, PostScript, and open source software. They also discuss how Geometer’s sketchpad is a useful tool for drawing illustrations.
Stata Press «Market: Statistics January 2011: 279x216 Pb: 978-1-59718-015-3: £53.99/17
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Math November 2010: 254x178: 272pp Pb: 978-1-4398-4606-3: £25.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4607-0: £25.99/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
278 mathematics & statistics 3rd Edition
2nd Edition textbook
An Introduction to Stata for Health Researchers
An Introduction to Stochastic Processes with Applications to Biology
This book continues to systematically cover data management, simple description and analysis, and more advanced analyses that are most often used in health research, such as regression models, survival analysis, measurement, and diagnosis. It also describes many graph types as well as how to modify the appearance of a graph. This third edition presents some of the new features in Stata 11, including the new, flexible syntax for factor variables. It also incorporates Stata 11 in the updated chapters on regression and survival analysis. Robust data sets can be downloaded from the book’s website. Stata Press «Market: Statistics October 2010: 235x187: 340pp Pb: 978-1-59718-077-1: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5516-4: £49.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5971-8044-3
Bijective Combinatorics Nicholas Loehr, Virginia Polytechnic University and State University, Blacksburg, USA Series: Discrete Mathematics and Its Applications Emphasizing bijective methods, this introductory text details the tools needed to solve problems in enumerative combinatorics. These tools can be used to analyze many structures including words, permutations, functions, graphs, trees, and more. Later chapters delve into algebraic aspects, including treatments of formal power series, symmetric groups and polynomials, determinants, and the combinatorial calculus of tableaux. The text requires only a familiarity with basic logic, set theory, and proof techniques. Nearly 1000 exercises, from routine verifications to unsolved problems, are included, many with solutions or hints. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Math February 2011: 254x178: 608pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4884-5: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4886-9: £63.99/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Linda J.S. Allen, Texas Tech University, Lubbock, USA The second edition of a bestseller, this textbook delineates stochastic processes, emphasizing applications in biology. It includes MATLAB throughout the book to help with the solutions of various problems. The book is organized according to the three types of stochastic processes: discrete time Markov chains, continuous time Markov chains and continuous time and state Markov processes. It contains a new chapter on the biological applications of stochastic differential equations and new sections on alternative methods for derivation of a stochastic differential equation, data and parameter estimation, Monte Carlo simulation, and more. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Math December 2010: 235x156: 490pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1882-4: £39.99/17
Biostatistics: A Computing Approach * Stewart Anderson, University of Pittsburgh, Pennsylvania, USA Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Texts in Statistical Science Focusing on visualization and computational approaches with an emphasis on the importance of simulation, Biostatistics introduces modern and classical biostatistical methods and compares their respective usefulness. The book covers essential topics in biostatistical science, including simple linear regression, multivariate regression, repeated measure, nonparametric analysis, survival analysis, sample size, and power calculations. Assuming only basic knowledge of probability and statistics, the text offers numerous practical applications and detailed worked examples taken from the medical area, all computed using R and SAS, along with exercises with solutions. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Statistics March 2011: 235x156: 416pp Pb: 978-1-58488-834-5: £39.99/17 eBook: 978-1-58488-835-2: £39.99/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Svend Juul and Morten Frydenberg, both at Aarhus University, Denmark
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
mathematics & statistics 279 textbook
textbook
College Geometry
Computational Methods in Finance
A Unified Approach David Kay, formerly at University of North Carolina, Ashville, USA Series: Textbooks in Mathematics This text presents a unified treatment of the three classical geometries: Euclidean, hyperbolic, and spherical (elliptic). This unique approach of combining all three geometries simultaneously using twelve concise axioms has never appeared in book form before at this level. The text introduces each axiom, including its reasons for use and implications, and then explains it in detail. In addition to numerous figures, examples, and exercises, the book includes Geometer’s Sketchpad to help students build and investigate math models, objects, figures, and graphs. The author provides programs for students to use on a supporting website and a solutions manual is available for qualifying instructors. CRC Press «Market: Math March 2011: 235x156: 512pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1911-1: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1912-8: £57.99/17
Ali Hirsa, Natixis Caspian Capital Management, LLC, New York, New York, USA Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Financial Mathematics Series This text addresses a variety of numerical methods for pricing derivative contracts, including Fourier techniques, finite differences, numerical simulation, and Monte Carlo simulation methods – one of the first books to cover all of these techniques. After presenting the basics of pricing techniques, it covers key concepts of calibration and parameter estimation. Written by a popular professor at Columbia University and NYU’s Courant Institute, the book is suitable for any graduate course on computational finance in financial engineering and financial mathematics programs as well as for practitioners interested in computational methods in finance. CRC Press «Market: Finance and Investing February 2011: 235x156: 306pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2957-8: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2958-5: £49.99/17
textbook
Clinical Trial Data Analysis using R
Discrete Structures with Contemporary Applications
Ding-Geng Chen and Karl E. Peace, both at Georgia Southern University, Statesboro, USA
Alexander Stanoyevitch, California State University – Dominguez Hills, Carson, USA
Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Biostatistics Series
This self-contained text on discrete mathematics covers contemporary applications, including simulation, probabilistic algorithms, and public-key cryptography. Other topics discussed include logic and sets, relations and functions, number systems, counting techniques, generating functions, algorithms, and basic simulations. The author includes exercises throughout the sections and at the end of each chapter to illustrate key concepts. He also provides solutions to the problems to ensure further understanding. Numerous supplementary topics are introduced in the appendices and exercise passages to allow for student projects.
ith examples based on the authors’ 30 W years of real-world experience in many areas of clinical drug development, this book provides a thorough presentation of clinical trial methodology. It presents detailed step-by-step illustrations on the implementation of the open-source software R. Case studies demonstrate how to select the appropriate clinical trial data. The authors introduce the corresponding biostatistical analysis methods, followed by the step-by-step data analysis using R. They also offer the R program for download, along with other essential data, on their website.
çè
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Math December 2010: 254x178: 933pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1768-1: £44.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1769-8: £44.99/17
CRC Press «Market: Statistics December 2010: 235x156: 392pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4020-7: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4021-4: £57.99/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
280 mathematics & statistics
Dose Finding by the Continual Reassessment Method
Exercises and Solutions in Biostatistical Theory *
Ying Kuen Cheung
Lawrence L. Kupper, University of North Carolina, Chapel Hill, USA, Sean M. O’Brien, Duke Clinical Research Institute, Durham, North Carolina, US and Brian H. Neelon, University of North Carolina, Chapel Hill, USA
Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Biostatistics Series This book presents the continual reassessment method (CRM) as a tool for dose-finding studies. With a focus on the implementation and practice of the CRM and its variations, it explains how the CRM may be calibrated and extended to suit common clinical settings. The book includes examples of real clinical trials data to illustrate the calibration techniques and shows how R can be used to carry out the techniques. It reviews the literature, related methodology, and theoretical properties of the CRM. It also explores alternatives for situations where the CRM fails. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Statistics March 2011: 235x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9151-9: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9152-6: £49.99/17
Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Texts in Statistical Science A self-contained resource, this book includes an unusual collection of problems and solutions that illustrate theoretical concepts essential to an understanding of the underlying principles of the field of biostatistics. Each chapter begins with a review of basic tools and concepts that aid in the solution of the problems encountered in that chapter. The material illustrated extends from the basic elements of probability to advanced multiparameter maximum likelihood-based methods for estimation and hypothesis testing. The book includes highly practical problems based on real-life applications taken predominantly from the health sciences. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Statistics November 2010: 235x156: 428pp Pb: 978-1-58488-722-5: £24.99/17 eBook: 978-1-58488-723-2: £24.99/17
2nd Edition
textbook
Exploratory Data Analysis with MATLAB
Fundamental Concepts for Clinical Trial Statisticians
Wendy L. Martinez, The Department of Defense, Fredericksburg, Virginia, USA, Angel Martinez, Fredericksburg, Virginia, USA and Jeffrey Solka, Dahlgren, Virginia, USA
Scott Evans, Harvard School of Public Health, Boston, Massachusetts, USA and Naitee Ting, Boehringer-Ingelheim, Ledyard, Connecticut, USA
Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Computer Science & Data Analysis
Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Biostatistics Series
The first book to use MATLAB® to illustrate computational aspects of EDA, Exploratory Data Analysis with MATLAB presents the methods of EDA from a computational perspective. The authors extensively use MATLAB code and algorithm descriptions to provide state-of-the-art techniques for finding patterns and structure in data. Addressing theory, they also incorporate many annotated references to direct readers to the more theoretical aspects of the methods. The book presents an approach using only the basic functions from MATLAB and the MATLAB Statistics Toolbox in order to be more accessible and enduring. It also contains pseudo-code to enable users of other software packages to implement the algorithms.
With complete coverage of issues in all phases of clinical trials, including design, data monitoring, analyses, interpretation, and reporting, this book provides an overview of fundamental concepts important to statisticians working with clinical trials. It examines issues related to product development and regulation, and then discusses the attributes that statisticians can acquire to maximize their contribution to the research. The co-authors draw on their experience in industry and academia to provide balanced, practical guidance on how statisticians can apply their knowledge to address real world clinical trial issues.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
CRC Press «Market: Statistics December 2010: 235x156: 512pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1220-4: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1221-1: £57.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5848-8366-1
Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Statistics March 2011: 235x156: 350pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9087-1: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9089-5: £49.99/17
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
mathematics & statistics 281
Handbook of Markov Chain Monte Carlo
Handbook of Spatial Point Pattern Analysis in Ecology
Methods and Applications
Thorsten Wiegand, Umweltforschungszentrum, Germany and Kirk A. Moloney, Iowa State University, Ames, USA
Edited by Steve Brooks, University of Cambridge, UK, Andrew Gelman, Columbia University, New York, USA, Galin Jones, University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, Minnesota, USA and Xiao-Li Meng, Harvard University, Cambridge, Massachusetts, USA Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Handbooks of Modern Statistical Methods Handbook of Markov Chain Monte Carlo brings together the major advances that have occurred in recent years while incorporating enough introductory material for new users of MCMC. Along with thorough coverage of the theoretical foundations and algorithmic and computational methodology, this comprehensive handbook includes substantial realistic case studies from a variety of disciplines. These case studies demonstrate the application of MCMC methods and serve as a series of templates for the construction, implementation, and choice of MCMC methodology. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Statistics February 2011: 235x156: 800pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7941-8: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7942-5: £63.99/17
Gary Chartrand, Western Michigan University, Kalamazoo, USA, Linda Lesniak, Drew University, Madison, New Jersey, USA and Ping Zhang, Western Michigan University, Kalamazoo, USA ritten for advanced undergraduate and W beginning graduate students, the fifth edition of this best-selling book provides a wide range of new examples along with historical discussions of mathematicians, problems, and conjectures. It features new and expanded coverage of such topics as toughness, graph minors, perfect graphs, list colorings, nowhere zero flows, list edge colorings, the road coloring problem, and the rainbow number of a graph. Additional applications, exercises, and examples illustrate the concepts and theorems. A solutions manual is available for qualifying instructors.
Edited by Henri Cohen, Universite Bordeaux I, France, Gerhard Frey, Universitat Duisburg-Essen, Germany, Roberto Avanzi, Ruhr University, Germany, Christophe Doche, Macquarie University, Australia, Tanja Lange, Technical University of Denmark, Lyngby, Kim Nguyen, Bundesdruckerei GmbH, Germany and Frederik Vercauteren, Katholieke Universiteit Leuven, Belgium Series: Discrete Mathematics and Its Applications This handbook provides a complete reference on elliptic and hyperelliptic curve cryptography. Addressing every aspect of the field, the book contains all of the background necessary to understand the theory and security of cryptosystems as well as the algorithms that can be used to implement them. This second edition features the latest developments on pairing-based cryptography, new ideas on index-calculus attacks, improved algorithms for genus-2 arithmetic, and a number of other new additions. It also includes many new applications and provides better explanations on some of the more mathematical presentations. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Math February 2011: 254x178: 1024pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4000-9: £70.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4001-6: £70.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5848-8518-4
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Math November 2010: 235x156: 592pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2627-0: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2629-4: £66.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5848-8390-6
@
Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Statistics February 2011: 235x156: 450pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8254-8: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8255-5: £49.99/17
Handbook of Elliptic and Hyperelliptic Curve Cryptography
Graphs & Digraphs
for e-mail updates in your field
A guidebook to spatial point-pattern analysis for ecologists, this book provides a comprehensive presentation of the theory behind point-pattern analysis targeted at the non-expert. It contains case studies, worked examples, focus boxes, a bibliography, and a glossary. The book uses Programita for the analysis of all examples and includes detailed step-bystep instructions of how to perform the analyses within the workbook. An executable copy of Programita and all example data sets is available with the workbook. This book meets the growing need for a resource focusing on the applications of point patterns analysis to ecological problems.
2nd Edition
5th Edition textbook
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Applied Environmental Statistics
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
282 mathematics & statistics
R Insights
Spline Smoothing
A Developer’s Guide to R
Methods and Applications
Simon Urbanek, Madison, New Jersey, USA
Yuedong Wang, University of California, Santa Barbara, California, USA
Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Computer Science & Data Analysis Aimed at users who want to take their understanding of R software and its capabilities to the next level, R Insights: A Developer’s Guide to R provides comprehensive coverage of R programming, including R graphics devices, debugging code, and importing code from C++ and Fortran. The book includes numerous examples and guides readers through the steps needed to build their own R packages. It outlines various methods for embedding R in other languages as well as for building GUIs. Written in an accessible style and requiring only minimal programming knowledge, the book is appropriate for those researchers, students, and practitioners who wish to use R for more sophisticated problems.
Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Monographs on Statistics & Applied Probability
Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Statistics February 2011: 235x156: 320pp Hb: 978-1-58488-679-2: £44.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-1175-3: £44.99/17
Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Statistics February 2011: 229x152: 415pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7755-1: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7756-8: £57.99/17
This book covers basic nonparametric spline models, such as polynomial spline, periodic spline, thin-plate spline, L- spline, partial spline, and smoothing spline ANOVA for both Gaussian data and data from exponential families. It also presents smoothing spline models with unequal variance and correlated random errors as well as advanced models, including semiparametric linear and nonlinear mixed-effects models and nonparametric and semiparametric nonlinear regression models. In addition, the author describes vector spline models for multivariate observations and functional linear models.
textbook
Martin Walter, University of Colorado, Boulder, USA S uitable for a general studies course on mathematics, this textbook examines the mathematics of the environment. It presents the mathematics by building patterns in numbers, arithmetic, and algebra and by using axioms as building blocks. A truly interdisciplinary study of mathematics, the text explores examples in population models, DNA computing, epidemics, financial mathematics, and more. It encourages students to use Excel spreadsheets to solve many of the open-ended problems. Along with numerous references, the book contains an appendix of solutions. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Math January 2011: 235x156: 672pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3472-5: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3473-2: £57.99/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Statistical Thinking in Epidemiology Yu-Kang Tu and Mark S. Gilthorpe, both at University of Leeds, UK Addressing issues that have plagued researchers throughout the last decade, this book provides new insights into the many existing problems in statistical modeling and offers several alternative strategies to approach these problems. Emphasizing the importance of statistical thinking behind all analyses, the authors use specific examples in epidemiology to illustrate different model specifications that can imply different sets of causal relationships between variables. Each model is interpreted with regard to the context of implicit or explicit causal relationships. The authors also use vector geometry where applicable to provide an intuitive understanding of important statistical concepts. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Statistics March 2011: 235x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9991-1: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9992-8: £57.99/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Mathematics for the Environment
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
mathematics & statistics 283
Green’s Functions and Partial Differential Equations Theory, Applications and Computation Prem K. Kythe, University of New Orleans, Louisiana, USA Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Applied Mathematics & Nonlinear Science This book provides complete coverage of Green’s functions, which have become an important topic of interest in recent years. Along with Mathematica® and MATLAB® code, it supplies the necessary background material and presents a large number of examples and exercises from different areas of mathematics, applied science, and engineering. The book includes boundary value problems involving ordinary differential equations, partial differential equations, and stochastic differential equations. The author describes various methods for solving these problems, including classical methods, Bernoulli’s separation method, integral transform, conformal mapping, and wavelet transform. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Math February 2011: 235x156: 384pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4008-5: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4009-2: £76.99/17
Mathematical Inequalities A Perspective Pietro Cerone and Silvestru Sever Dragomir, both at Victoria University, Australia This book provides an overview of the expanding field of mathematical inequalities and their applications. Instead of focusing on narrow treatments of various mathematical inequalities, the authors present a number of classical and recent results across the field, covering integral inequalities, discrete inequalities, and inequalities in abstract spaces. They also make new connections and investigate intimate relationships between inequalities. Written in an accessible manner, the text offers simple proofs for young researchers yet incorporates sufficient detail to appeal to experts and graduate students in real and functional analysis. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Math December 2010: 235x156: 401pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4896-8: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4897-5: £76.99/17
Introduction to Statistical Limit Theory * Alan M. Polansky, Northern Illinois University, Dekalb, USA Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Texts in Statistical Science Those moving on to advanced statistics typically lack the mathematical foundation that allows them to make full use of statistical limit theory. This accessible resource reviews approximation theory and limit theory for sequences of functions and basic notions of functional analysis. It provides detailed arguments that show how underlying mathematical and statistical theory work together. Among its unique qualities, the text covers expansion theory, which is becoming increasingly important in modern applications. It also discusses bootstrap, kernel smoothing, and Markov chain Monte Carlo and includes a wide array of examples and problems from the fundamental to very advanced.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Statistics January 2011: 235x156: 640pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7660-8: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7661-5: £57.99/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
284 mathematics & statistics Applications of Lie Groups to Difference Equations *
Controversial Issues in Clinical Trials
Discrete Variational Derivative Method
Vladimir Dorodnitsyn, Keldysh Institute of Applied Mathematics, Russia
Shein-Chung Chow, Duke University School of Medicine, Durham, North Carolina, USA
A Structure-Preserving Numerical Method for Partial Differential Equations
Series: Differential and Integral Equations and Their Applications
Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Biostatistics Series
Daisuke Furihata, Osaka University, Japan and Takayasu Matsuo, University of Tokyo, Japan
This book presents a survey of methods and results in a new application area of Lie groups to difference equations and difference meshes (lattices). It focuses on the formulation and mathematical substantiation of exact symmetry preservation in difference models, such as difference equations and meshes. Methods are illustrated with numerous examples and applications in heat and mass transfer, hydrodynamics, physics, and mechanics. To highlight the numerical aspect of the book, the author provides a short survey of methods and theory of finite difference schemes and meshes. He also explains other approaches to quality features of difference schemes, such as variational and moving frames methods. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Math December 2010: 254x178: 344pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8309-5: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8310-1: £57.99/17
Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Statistics March 2011: 235x156: 400pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4961-3: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4962-0: £63.99/17
2nd Edition textbook
Computability Theory S. Barry Cooper, University of Leeds, UK
2nd Edition
Series: Chapman Hall/CRC Mathematics Series
An Introduction to Ecological Economics * Robert Costanza, University of Vermont, Burlington, USA, John H Cumberland and Herman Daly, both at University of Maryland, College Park, USA, Robert Goodland, World Bank, Washington, DC, USA and Richard B Norgaard, University of California at Berkeley, USA An Introduction to Ecological Economics, Second Edition is the definitive introduction to the field of ecological economics, which is concerned with extending and integrating the study and management of ecological as well as economic needs, sustaining both ‘nature’s household’ and ‘humankind’s household.’ It provides a unified understanding of natural and human-dominated ecosystems and reintegrates market economics within the limits posed by the biophysical world. Written by five of the leading figures in the field, this new edition adds a series of boxes to expand and update information in the current text and addresses such critical topics as the historical development of economics and ecology and motivation for incorporating humans into ecosystems. CRC Press «Market: Math April 2011: 229x152: 300pp Hb: 978-1-56670-684-1: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-1267-5: £57.99/17
Covering a number of controversial issues that are commonly encountered when conducting clinical trials, this book serves as a useful desk reference and an assessment of the current state of the art. It discusses the appropriateness of traditional statistical hypotheses (which primarily focus on efficacy) for clinical evaluation of both efficacy and safety, instability of classical sample size calculation based on information from a small pilot study, and integrity of randomization and blinding. The author illustrates the issues using real-world examples and up-to-date data. He also provides recommendations of possible resolutions of these issues.
Designed for advanced undergraduate or beginning graduate students, this book provides a complete introduction to computability theory. This second edition includes new material on hyperarithmetical and Borel sets as well as more material on computability of structures, Pi-0-1 classes, and computability in science. It features an expanded treatment of complexity of computations and updated future directions in computability. In addition, the section on randomness is now a separate chapter. The author also discusses advanced topics in greater depth, including Post’s problem, forcing and category, applications of determinacy, and the computability of theories. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Math March 2011: 235x156: 506pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3843-3: £34.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3844-0: £34.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5848-8237-4
Element of Differential Topology Anant R. Shastri, Indian Institute of Technology, Bombay Assuming prior knowledge of real analysis, multivariable calculus, and point set topology, this book presents the central notions in differential topology, including tangent space and tubular neighborhoods. After briefly reviewing the calculus of several variables, the author covers manifolds in Euclidean space, abstract smooth manifolds, intersection theory, Morse functions, Whitney’s easy embedding theorem, normal bundles and tubular neighborhoods, orientation, vector fields, isotopies, differential forms, Stokes theorem, and much more. The text contains illustrative diagrams, exercises with solutions, and a comprehensive bibliography.
Series: Chapman and Hall/CRC Numerical Analysis and Scientific Computation Series Many important problems in engineering and science are modeled by nonlinear partial differential equations (PDEs). A new trend in PDEs, called structure-preserving numerical methods, has recently developed. This book is devoted to one such technique, called the discrete variational derivative method. First, the text introduces the key factors and the basic ideas of this method, followed by target problems solvable by the method. The second section describes the rigorous mathematics in detail along with relevant applications, which are illustrated by worked examples. It concludes with a comprehensive of listing of essential references on structurepreserving algorithms for advanced readers. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Math December 2010: 235x156: 392pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9445-9: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9446-6: £63.99/17
Exploratory Multivariate Analysis by Example Using R Francois Husson, Sebastien Le and Jerome Pages, all at Laboratoire de Mathematiques Appliques, Rennes, France Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Computer Science & Data Analysis An introduction to exploratory techniques for multivariate data analysis, this book covers the key methodology, including principal components analysis, correspondence analysis, mixed models and multiple factor analysis. The authors take a practical approach, with examples leading the discussion of the methods and many graphics to emphasize visualization. They present the concepts in the most intuitive way possible, keeping mathematical content to a minimum or relegating it to the appendices. The book includes examples that use real data from a range of scientific disciplines and implemented using an R package developed by the authors. CRC Press «Market: Statistics November 2010: 235x156: 240pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3580-7: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3581-4: £49.99/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
CRC Press «Market: Math March 2011: 235x156: 360pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3160-1: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3163-2: £57.99/17
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
mathematics & statistics 285 Extreme Value Methods with Applications to Finance
Gaussian Process Regression Analysis for Functional Data
Introduction to Functional Equations
Serguei Y. Novak, Middlesex University Business School, London, UK
Jian Qing Shi, University of Newcastle upon Tyne, UK and Taeryon Choi, Korea University, Korea
Focusing on optical imaging problems, applications, and theory, this book describes progress in optical tomography. The text consists of several self-contained chapters with references written by pioneers and experts in the theoretical aspects of optical tomography and nonlinear imaging in general. The first chapter introduces the theoretical problem of optical tomography as it is relevant to applications in biomedical imaging. Each subsequent chapter addresses a particular technique that has been applied to tackle the problem of instability in optical tomography. The last three chapters summarize the state of the art and address the future of the field.
A Gaussian process is a type of stochastic process that is particularly useful for Bayesian inference of complex problems. This book presents an overview of Gaussian process regression, all of the necessary theory, and real-world applications from the fields of medicine and engineering. It covers the required background in regression and examines key aspects of the modeling process, including model selection as well as more advanced topics, such as mixture models and kernel-based methods. For implementing the methods discussed in the text, the authors provide Ad Hoc software for download on their website.
Prasanna K. Sahoo, University of Louisville, Kentucky, USA and Palaniappan Kannappan, University of Waterloo, Canada
CRC Press «Market: Statistics March 2011: 235x156: 260pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3574-6: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3575-3: £63.99/17
Fourier Series in Several Variables with Applications to Partial Differential Equations Victor Shapiro, University of California, Riverside, USA Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Applied Mathematics & Nonlinear Science Presenting Fourier series from the aspect of several variables, this book covers connections between Fourier analysis and partial differential equations. It discusses newly emerging topics, such as the fundamental results on Calderon–Zygmund kernels in multi-dimensions and their relation to Fourier series and integrals, along with Fourier integrals and their applications to uniqueness for two-dimensional trigonometric series. The author explores important applications for the first time through reactiondiffusion equations and Navier–Stokes equations. The text also covers spherical harmonics and includes problems to aid with application.
Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Statistics March 2011: 235x156: 224pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3773-3: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3774-0: £63.99/17
Introduction to Closure Systems Robert E. Jamison, Clemson University, South Carolina, USA Series: Discrete Mathematics and Its Applications The notion of closure pervades mathematics, especially in the fields of topology and projective geometry. Demonstrating this pervasiveness in the field, this graduate-level book provides a complete introduction to closure systems. With an emphasis on finite spaces and algebraic closures, the text covers graph theory, ordered sets, lattices, projective geometry, and formal logic as they apply to the study of closures. Each chapter presents a vignette to illustrate the topic covered. The author also includes numerous exercises as well as concrete examples to support the material discussed. CRC Press «Market: Math March 2011: 235x156: 352pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1991-3: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1992-0: £57.99/17
Handbook of Empirical Economics and Finance
Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Math February 2011: 235x156: 352pp Hb: 978-1-4398-5427-3: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5428-0: £63.99/17
Edited by Aman Ullah, University of California, Riverside, USA and David E. A. Giles, University of Victoria, Canada Series: Statistics: A Series of Textbooks and Monographs
Functional equations form a modern branch of mathematics. This book provides an elementary yet comprehensive introduction to the field of functional equations and stabilities. Concentrating on functional equations that are real or complex, the authors present many fundamental techniques for solving these functional equations. Topics covered in the text include Cauchy equations, additive functions, functional equations for distance measures, and Pexider’s functional equations. Each chapter points to various developments in abstract domains, such as semigroups, groups, or Banach spaces, and includes exercises for both self-study and classroom use. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Math February 2011: 235x156: 426pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4111-2: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4116-7: £63.99/17
2nd Edition
Measures of Interobserver Agreement and Reliability Mohamed M. Shoukri, King Faisal Specialist Hospital & Research Center, Saudi Arabia Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Biostatistics Series Measuring interobserver agreement is a method used to evaluate inconsistencies in findings from different evaluators who collect basically the same information. Emphasizing applications over theory, this book provides a comprehensive survey of this method and provides readers with standards and directions on how to run sound clinical and other types of studies. The author clearly explains how to reduce measurement error and presents numerous practical examples of the interobserver agreement approach. To help with problem solving, the treatment includes SAS code, both within the book and on the CRC website. An extensive review of the literature provides access to the latest developments in the field. CRC Press December 2010: 235x156: 288pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1080-4: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1081-1: £63.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5848-8321-0
This handbook provides an up-to-date reference source of cutting-edge developments in applied econometrics and the modeling of special types of economic and financial data. Leading researchers in the field contribute state-ofthe-art, previously unpublished chapters that address these developments. The book covers major themes in the areas of microeconometrics, macroeconometrics, financial econometrics, panel and spatial data, time-series analysis, semiparametric and nonparametric methods, and treatment effects. It also discusses computation with reference to Bayesian methods as well as information-theoretic approaches to inference.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Statistics December 2010: 235x156: 522pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7035-4: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7036-1: £95.00/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
286 mathematics & statistics Multiparameter Eigenvalue Problems
No-Arbitrage Pricing * Analytical and Numerical Methods
Randomized Clinical Trials of Nonpharmacologic Treatments
Sturm-Liouville Theory
Svetlana Boyarchenko and Sergey Levendorskiy, both at University of Texas, Austin, Texas, USA
Edited by Isabelle Boutron and Philippe Ravaud, both at INSERM U738, France and David Moher, University of Ottawa, Canada
Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Financial Mathematics Series
Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Biostatistics Series
With special attention to the Sturm–Liouville theory, this book discusses the full multiparameter theory as applied to second-order linear equations. It considers the spectral theory of these multiparameter problems in detail for both the regular and singular cases. The text covers eignencurves, the essential spectrum, eigenfunctions, oscillation theorems, the distribution of eigencurves, the limit point, limit circle theory, and more. This text is the culmination of more than two decades of research by F.V. Atkinson, one of the masters in the field, and his successors, who continued his work after he passed away in 2002. CRC Press «Market: Math November 2010: 235x156: 320pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1622-6: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1623-3: £63.99/17
Multivariate Generalized Linear Mixed Models Using R Damon M. Berridge and Robert Crouchley, both at Lancaster University, UK To provide researchers with the ability to analyze large and complex data sets using robust models, this book presents a unified framework for a broad class of models that can be applied using a dedicated R package (Sabre). The first five chapters cover the analysis of multilevel models using univariate generalized linear mixed models (GLMMs). The next few chapters extend to multivariate GLMMs and the last chapters address more specialized topics, such as parallel computing for large-scale analyses. Each chapter includes many real-world examples implemented using Sabre as well as exercises and suggestions for further reading. Appendices cover selected background topics and computing aspects. CRC Press January 2011: 235x156: 320pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1326-3: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1327-0: £57.99/17
No-Arbitrage Pricing: Analytical and Numerical Methods demonstrates the importance of an analytical viewpoint for the theoretical analysis of pricing and hedging of options and other contingent claims. The authors illustrate that the majority of processes used in finance and mathematical finance are sufficiently regular; therefore, many efficient analytical tools are applicable. They also provide guidance for the development of efficient numerical methods and show how to apply these tools to several situations that are important in financial engineering and mathematical finance. Topics covered include the Black–Scholes equation and the eigenfunction expansion method. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Math February 2011: 235x156: 356pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7898-5: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7899-2: £49.99/17
Optimal Experimental Design with R * Dieter Rasch, University of Natural Resources and Applied Life Sciences, Austria, Jurgen Pilz, University of Klagenfurt, Austria, L.R. Verdooren, Danone Research Centre for Specialized Nutrition, Wageningen, the Netherlands, and Albrecht Gebhardt, University of Klagenfurt, Austria Optimal Experimental Design with R introduces experimenters to the philosophy of experimentation and the need for good design and data collection for experiments. It gives experimenters and statisticians guidance on how to construct optimum experimental designs and calculate the sample size needed using R programs. The book contains many detailed realworld examples that show how the R programs should be used. The authors discuss variations of the regression model, including linear and nonlinear regression models. They also provide a final chapter of theoretical details for interested mathematical statisticians. Chapman and Hall/CRC February 2011: 235x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1697-4: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1698-1: £63.99/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
Nonpharmacological treatments include a wide variety of treatments such as surgery, technical procedures, implantable devices, nonimplantable devices, rehabilitation, psychoteherapy, and behavioral interventions. This book focuses on the methods of assessing nonpharmacological treatments, highlighting specific issues and discussing all possible design of trials. It provides practical examples to underline the issues and solutions in assessing nonpharmacological treatment in trials. Arguably the first book to exclusively explore this topic, it discusses various categories of treatments from surgical procedures to psychotherapy. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Statistics March 2011: 235x156: 300pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8801-4: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8802-1: £63.99/17
Randomized Response and Indirect Questioning Techniques in Surveys Arijit Chaudhuri, Indian Statistical Institute, Calcutta Series: Statistics: A Series of Textbooks and Monographs A long-standing problem in survey research is that respondents are often reluctant to give truthful answers to sensitive questions. The randomized response technique (RRT) addresses this problem by guaranteeing respondents’ anonymity and minimizing their discomfort. The key to this is that respondents determines which question they answer using some probability device, such as a coin flip or a roll of the dice. In this book, one of the world’s leading experts on the subject summarizes the current state of the theory and practice of RRT. He examines how to extend the theory to situations employing unequal probability sampling. Chapman and Hall/CRC December 2010: 235x156: 184pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3657-6: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3658-3: £76.99/17
çè
F.V. Atkinson and Angelo B. Mingarelli, Carleton University, Canada
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
mathematics & statistics 287 RC4 Stream Cipher and Its Variants Goutam Paul, Jadavpur University, India and Subhamoy Maitra, Indian Statistical Institute, Kolkata Series: Discrete Mathematics and Its Applications This book is the first comprehensive volume on RC4, the most popular and widely deployed state-of-the-art software stream cipher algorithm. After the basic fundamentals of cryptography, the text provides substantial coverage of stream ciphers in general. Other topics covered include key scheduling, key recovery, WEP attacks, and keystream generation. The book also explores both LFSR and non-LFSR-based hardware stream ciphers as well as software stream ciphers. The techniques and analysis presented can be applied to many RC4-like stream ciphers that are based on arrays and modular addition. The authors provide end-of-chapter exercises along with a number of illustrative tables and figures. CRC Press February 2011: 235x156: 300pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3135-9: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3137-3: £57.99/17
2nd Edition
Statistics of Medical Imaging *
Robust Nonparametric Statistical Methods
Tianhu Lei, University of Pennsylvania & Children’s Hospital, Philadelphia, USA
Thomas P. Hettmansperger, Pennsylvania State University, University Park, USA and Joseph W. McKean, Western Michigan University, Kalamazoo, USA Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Monographs on Statistics & Applied Probability Often referred to as distribution-free methods, nonparametric methods do not rely on assumptions that the data are drawn from a given probability distribution. With an emphasis on Wilcoxon rank methods that enable a unified approach to data analysis, this book presents a unique overview of robust nonparametric statistical methods. Drawing on examples from various disciplines, the relevant R code for these examples, as well as numerous exercises for selfstudy, the text covers location models, regression models, designed experiments, and multivariate methods. This edition features a new chapter on cluster correlated data. CRC Press January 2011: 254x178: 552pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0908-2: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0909-9: £63.99/17
Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Interdisciplinary Statistics More work is being done in the statistical aspects of medical imaging, and this book fills the gap to provide a unified framework of study by presenting a complete look at medical imaging and statistics – from the statistical aspects of imaging technology to the statistical analysis of images. It provides technicians and students with the statistical principles that underlay medical imaging, as required reference material for researchers involved in the design of new technology. Illustrations are included throughout as are many real examples, and algorithms. The text also includes exercises developed out of the author’s many years experience with studying the statistics of medical imaging. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Statistics March 2011: 235x156: 416pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8842-7: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8843-4: £63.99/17
2nd Edition
Separable Galois theory of Commutative Rings Andy R. Magid, Central Oklahoma Math Production, Inc., Norman, USA Series: Pure and Applied Mathematics
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
CRC Press «Market: Math May 2012: 279x216: 300pp Hb: 978-0-8247-9006-6: £108.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-1464-8: £108.00/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
Computer science & computer engineering
TOP TEN BESTSELLERS
288 mathematics & statistics
1.
6. R Graphics
2nd Edition
Computer Science Handbook
Paul Murrell 2005: 235x156: 328pp Hb: 978-1-58488-486-6: £55.99/17
2.
Edited by Allen B. Tucker 2004: 254x178: 2752pp Hb: 978-1-58488-360-9: £99.00/17
7. Introduction to Modern Cryptography
2nd Edition
Intelligent Systems for Engineers and Scientists
Principles and Protocols
Adrian A. Hopgood
Jonathan Katz and Yehuda Lindell
2000: 235x156: 488pp Hb: 978-0-8493-0456-9: £90.00/17
2007: 235x156: 552pp Hb: 978-1-58488-551-1: £40.99/17
3.
8. Data Analysis Tools for DNA Microarrays
Statistical Analysis of Gene Expression Microarray Data
Sorin Draghici
Edited by Terry Speed
2003: 235x156: 552pp Hb: 978-1-58488-315-9: £61.99/17
2003: 235x156: 240pp Hb: 978-1-58488-327-2: £59.99/17
4.
9. 3rd Edition
2nd Edition
Cryptography
Coding Theory and Cryptography
Theory and Practice Douglas R. Stinson
The Essentials
2005: 235x156: 616pp Hb: 978-1-58488-508-5: £44.99/17
D.C. Hankerson, Gary Hoffman, D.A. Leonard, Charles C. Lindner, K.T. Phelps, C.A. Rodger and J.R. Wall 2000: 229x152: 368pp Hb: 978-0-8247-0465-0: £61.99/17
10. Digital Color Imaging Handbook
3rd Edition
Graphics and GUIs with MATLAB
Edited by Gaurav Sharma 2002: 235x156: 816pp Hb: 978-0-8493-0900-7: £117.00/17
O. Thomas Holland and Patrick Marchand 2002: 254x178: 536pp Pb: 978-1-58488-320-3: £39.99/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
5.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
computer science & computer engineering 289
Automated Physical Database Design and Tuning
Computational Systems Biology of Cancer
Nicolas Bruno, Microsoft, Redmond, Washington, USA
Emmanuel Barillot, Laurence Calzone, Philippe Hupe, Jean-Philippe Vert and Andrei Zinovyev, all at Institut Curie, France
Series: Database Systems and Applications Relational database systems have significantly evolved since their inception over 30 years ago. New applications are now more complex than ever and tuning a production system for performance has become a critical yet time-consuming activity. This book shows how to use automated systems for time-efficient database tuning. The authors present a detailed overview of the fundamental research that makes it possible to automatically recommend changes to the physical design of database systems. They provide a comprehensive overview of the automated tuning tools that can be used to systematically explore the space of alternatives and to guide database administrators. CRC Press «Market: Computer Science / Computer Engineering / Computing February 2011: 229x152: 168pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1567-0: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1568-7: £49.99/17
Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Mathematical & Computational Biology Concentrating on the most challenging problems for the molecular biology of cancer, this book provides a systematic overview of the current state of the art in computational systems biology. It presents concepts, algorithmic methods, bioinformatics tools, and biological applications, along with accompanying tables and illustrations. The authors introduce theoretical elements and demonstrate them using practical approaches with real data. Each chapter begins with an overview of a biological or clinical question of importance in cancer research or treatment followed by a description of the current state of the art of the field and a list of available resources. CRC Press «Market: Computer Science / Computer Engineering / Computing March 2011: 235x156: 356pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3144-1: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3145-8: £49.99/17
textbook
An Open Source Approach Allen Tucker, Bowdoin College, Hilton Head, South Carolina, USA, Ralph Morelli, Trinity College, West Hartford, Connecticut, USA and Chamindra de Silva, Colombo, Sri Lanka Series: Software Engineering Focusing on projects that real-world clients value, this text outlines the principles and practice of software development. It presents agile techniques, modern collaboration tools, continuous client involvement, and teamwork as central themes. Relying on recent experiences teaching software development, the authors provide a framework that can be replicated for a one-semester course at many institutions. This innovative text uses hands-on projects to teach students how to develop real-world software in a team, emphasizing how effective collaboration results in quality software. Teachers receive a complete package of software development course materials, including required documents.
çè
CRC Press «Market: Information Technology February 2011: 235x156: 400pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1290-7: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1291-4: £49.99/17
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Green Computing Large-Scale Energy Efficiency Edited by Wu-chun Feng, Virginia Polytechnic Institute and State University, Blacksburg, USA Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Computational Science Driven by the newly placed importance and growing search for ways to make computing greener and more efficient, this reference is the first research-level book devoted to green computing and large-scale energy efficiency. With contributions from leading experts in the field, the book presents current research and developments in hardware, systems software, run-time systems, programming languages, data center management, and applications. It also covers the emerging green movement in computing, including the Green Grid and the Green 500 list, as well as important programs in grassroots organizations and government agencies. CRC Press «Market: Computer Science / Computer Engineering / Computing March 2011: 235x156: 300pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1987-6: £54.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1988-3: £54.99/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Client-Driven Software Development
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
290 computer science & computer engineering
Robot Development Using Microsoft Robotics Developer Studio Shih-Chung Kang, Wei-Tze Chang, Kai-Yuan Gu and Hung-Lin Chi, all at National Taiwan University, Taipei The Microsoft® Robotics Developer Studio (MSRDS) provides a flexible platform for creating robotic systems, making it accessible for those who are new to robotics. Designed for readers with only basic programming skills, this book provides an introductory reference on robot development and programming using MSRDS. After a brief introduction to the MSRDS system, the authors demonstrate how to use MSRDS to develop software for operating robots and verify programs without connecting to physical equipment. They also discuss the hardware modules contained in the LEGO Mindstorms Educational Toolkit and provide examples for implementing an intelligent robot. Chapman and Hall/CRC November 2010: 254x178: 432pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2165-7: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2166-4: £49.99/17
Scientific Computing with Multicore and Accelerators Edited by Jakub Kurzak, University of Tennessee, Knoxville, USA, David A. Bader, Georgia Institute of Technology, Atlanta, USA and Jack Dongarra, University of Tennessee, Knoxville, USA Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Computational Science The current trend in microprocessor architecture is toward powerful multicore designs in which a node contains several full-featured processing cores, private and shared caches, and memory. The IBM Cell Broadband Engine (B.E.) and Graphics Processing Units (GPUs) are two accelerators that are used for a variety of computations, including signal processing and quantum chemistry. This is the first reference on the use of Cell B.E. and GPUs as accelerators for numerical kernels, algorithms, and computational science and engineering applications. With contributions from leading experts, the book covers a broad range of topics on the increased role of these accelerators in scientific computing. CRC Press December 2010: 235x156: 488pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2536-5: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2537-2: £57.99/17
2nd Edition
textbook
Official (ISC)2 Guide to the SSCP CBK
Real-Time Graphics for Game Development
Edited by Harold F. Tipton, HFT Associates, Villa Park, California, USA
JungHyun Han, Korea University, Seoul and Jubok Kim, Nexon Corporation, South Korea
Series: (ISC)2 Press
This full-color text on real-time graphics in video game development balances theory and application. The presentation of topics allows readers to quickly understand the key aspects of real-time graphics. The authors, who are leaders in this field, cover such concepts as rendering, texturing, post-processing, and animation. To maintain the emphasis on practicality, each chapter includes boxed Math Notes that enable readers to access mathematical or theoretical content without interrupting the flow of the main text. The book contains over 300 clear and detailed figures along with homework problems. A solutions manual is also available upon qualified course adoption.
Auerbach Publications «Market: Computer Science / Computer Engineering / Computing December 2010: 235x156: 544pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0483-4: £44.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0484-1: £44.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-2774-2
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Computer Science / Computer Engineering / Computing February 2011: 235x156: 500pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2737-6: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2738-3: £49.99/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
SSCP Certification is the key to unlocking the upper ranks of security implementation at the world’s most prestigious organizations. For anyone who is serious about becoming a leading tactician at the front lines, the (ISC)²® Systems Security Certified Practitioner (SSCP®) Certification is an absolute necessity-demanded by cutting-edge companies worldwide, today more than ever before. Nowhere else are the seven domains of the CBK embodied more adeptly than in the second edition of the Official (ISC)²® Guide to the SSCP® CBK®. In a milestone effort by (ISC)², five of the of the world’s leading tacticians with hands-on experience in IT security acknowledge the importance of the security implementation process.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
computer science & computer engineering 291
Security & Policy Driven Self-Management Computing
The Garbage Collection Handbook
Lei Liu, Sun Microsystems, Menlo Park, California, USA
The Art of Automatic Memory Management
An overview of security applications for self-managed systems, this book provides researchers and developers with usable code and artifacts for security and policy driven self-managed systems in the areas of storage, data management, and network computing. With a wealth of practical, applicable information, it identifies potential research directions and technologies that will drive innovation; offers an overall assessment of selfmanaged systems that highlight progress and best practices; describes research topics, gaps, and challenges facing next-generation systems; and discusses the latest R&D work, industrial trends, technology, and technical studies of security and policy issues.
Richard Jones, University of Kent, UK, Antony Hosking, Purdue University, West Lafayette, Indiana, USA and Eliot Moss, University of Massachusetts, Amherst, USA
CRC Press December 2010: 235x156: 336pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2579-2: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2580-8: £49.99/17
Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Applied Algorithms and Data Structures series Published in 1996, Richard Jones’s Garbage Collection was a milestone book in the field. Since the field has changed considerably, there is a need for an updated look at where garbage collection and memory management research stands today. While following the successful format of the previous book, this volume explores new challenges, such as concurrency and parallelism. It provides comprehensive, accessible coverage of important algorithms and places these algorithms within a common framework using consistent terminology. This approach facilitates comparisons between various designs. The book also examines the research literature and effective practical techniques and includes numerous case studies. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Computer Science / Computer Engineering / Computing March 2011: 254x178: 400pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8279-1: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8280-7: £49.99/17
Human-Computer Etiquette * Cultural Expectations and the Design Implications They Place on Computers and Technology Caroline C. Hayes, University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, USA and Christopher A. Miller, Smart Information Flow Technologies, Minneapolis, Minnesota, USA Written by experts from various fields, this edited collection explores a wide range of issues pertaining to how computers evoke human social expectations. The book illustrates how socially acceptable conventions can strongly impact the effectiveness of human-computer interactions and how to consider such norms in the design of human-computer interfaces. Providing a complete introduction to the design of social responses to computers, the text emphasizes the value of social norms in the development of usable and enjoyable technology. It also describes the role of socially correct behavior in technology adoption and how to design human-computer interfaces for a competitive global market.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Auerbach Publications «Market: Computer Science / Computer Engineering / Computing December 2010: 235x156: 336pp Hb: 978-1-4200-6945-7: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-6946-4: £49.99/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
292 computer science & computer engineering
Modelling the Knowledge Discovery Creation Process Edited by Yashiteru Nakamori, Japan Advanced Institute of Science and Technology, Japan Providing an overview of this emerging interdisciplinary topic, this book brings together experienced researchers in decision science, artificial intelligence, systems engineering, behavioral science, and management science. The introductory chapter on knowledge technology and science addresses the roles and features of the field and emphasizes the multidisciplinary aspect of it. Contributors discuss knowledge discovery and management, knowledge synthesis, knowledge justification, and knowledge construction. The book provides knowledge engineering tools and a framework for integrating knowledge creation, discovery, and management. CRC Press «Market: Computer Science / Computer Engineering / Computing February 2011: 235x156: 250pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3836-5: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3837-2: £82.00/17
Data Analysis and Knowledge Discovery * Nikola K. Kasabov, Auckland University of Technology, New Zealand, Brendon J. Woodford, University of Otago, New Zealand and Michael J. Watts, Lincoln University, New Zealand This book begins by addressing the fundamental differences between data, information, and knowledge. It then considers how data can be effectively characterized in light of its diverse forms and origins before looking at the various aspects of data acquisition and storage. The authors then discusses several topics related to information theory, including measurement, probability, and entropy, and consider how data is analyzed and transformed into information. Finally, they look to computational modeling for both problem solving and knowledge discovery, employing methods derived from statistics and computer science and discussing selection, use, and particular applications of these methods. CRC Press «Market: Computer Science / Computer Engineering / Computing March 2011: 235x156: 400pp Hb: 978-0-8493-3814-4: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-0548-6: £63.99/17
order now!
Designing Network On-Chip Architectures in the Nanoscale Era
Fundamentals of Multicore Software Development
Edited by Jose Flich, Universidad Politecnica de Valencia, Spain and Davide Bertozzi, University of Ferrara, Italy
Edited by Victor Pankratius, University of Karlsruhe, Germany, Ali-Reza Adl-Tabatabai, Intel Corporation, Santa Clara, California, USA and Walter Tichy, University of Karlsruhe, Germany
Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Computational Science Paving the way for the use of network on-chip architectures in 2015 platforms, this book presents the industrial requirements for such long-term platforms as well as the main research findings for technology-aware architecture design. It covers homogeneous design techniques and guidelines, including the solutions that are most appealing to the industry and best suited to meet the requirements of on-chip integration. Each chapter addresses a specific key architecture design, including fault tolerant design, topology selection, dynamic voltage and frequency scaling, synchronization, network on-chip resources exposed to the architecture, routing algorithms, and collective communication.
Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Computational Science With the emergence of multicore computers, the challenge of parallelizing performance-critical applications has gained increasing importance. Compared to sequential applications, the availability of tools and methods for cost-effective and reliable parallel applications remains limited. This volume examines the current state of multicore software development. Written by leading international experts who present a software development point of view, the book addresses a wide range of pertinent issues in multicore systems architecture, operating systems, as well as languages and compilers for multicore systems.
Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Information Technology January 2011: 235x156: 501pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3710-8: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3711-5: £63.99/17
CRC Press «Market: Computer Science / Computer Engineering / Computing March 2011: 235x156: 400pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1273-0: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1274-7: £57.99/17
Dimensional Music Emotion Recognition for Content Retrieval
High Performance Computing
Yi-Hsuan Yang and Homer H. Chen, National Taiwan University, Taipei Series: Multimedia Computing, Communication and Intelligence With over 300 references, this book explains the essential aspects of automatic music emotion recognition (MER), including background, key techniques, and applications. It reviews existing work in the field and establishes a computational framework that generalizes emotion recognition from categorical domain to real-valued 2D space. Furthermore, it describes how to take the subjective nature of emotion perception into account in the development of automatic MER systems. This book can be used as a reference and guide to developing an automatic music emotion recognition system. CRC Press «Market: Computer Science / Computer Engineering / Computing February 2011: 235x156: 208pp Hb: 978-1-4398-5046-6: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5047-3: £57.99/17
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
Programming and Applications John Levesque, Cray, Inc., Knoxville, Tennessee, USA and Gene Wagenbreth, University of Southern California, Los Angeles, USA Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Computational Science Newer computer architectures rely on multicore, multi-chip designs to achieve the highest performance; programmers, therefore, need to utilize multi-threading and parallel programming techniques in their applications to achieve high performance on these new designs. This book provides application developers with a detailed understanding of how to effectively program for these new high performance architectures. The authors give a broad overview of the current state of hardware and software advances to support high performance applications. They focus on the more common and successful strategies for multi-threading and parallel programming using examples from actual codes. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Computer Science / Computer Engineering / Computing December 2010: 235x156: 224pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7705-6: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7706-3: £57.99/17
çè
Knowledge Science
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
computer science & computer engineering 293 Mining Software Specifications
Particle Swarm Optimisation
Methodologies and Applications
Classical and Quantum Perspectives
Edited by David Lo, Singapore Management University, Khoo Siau Cheng, National University Singapore, Jiawei Han, University of Illinois at Urbana, USA and Chao Liu, Microsoft Corporation, Redmond, Washington, USA
Jun Sun, Choi-Hong Lai, University of Greenwich, UK and Xiao-Jun Wu, Jiangnan University, China
Series: Chapman & Hall/CRC Data Mining and Knowledge Discovery Series Data mining and machine learning techniques have been used to learn baseline models of software behavior. Mined models help in understanding existing systems and reducing the cost incurred during software maintenance. Presenting a comprehensive overview of the emerging field of software specification mining, this book provides the latest tools to help researchers test, verify, and reengineer the systems that they are building or maintaining. It addresses the intersection between three research domains: software engineering, programming languages, and data mining. The book unifies existing research in mining software specification and examines the challenges and future trends in the field. CRC Press March 2011: 235x156: 300pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0626-5: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0627-2: £57.99/17
Series: Chapman and Hall/CRC Numerical Analysis and Scientific Computation Series This volume provides a detailed description of the state-of-the-art of Particle Swarm Optimization, PSO, and Quantum-behaved particle swarm optimization QPSO algorithms. The authors present the motivation, principle, and theoretical analysis of the algorithm. They discuss advanced topics such as behavior of individual particles, global convergence, time complexity, and rate of convergence. The book also presents examples and applications to show the applicability of QPSO algorithms, which vary in difficulty. It includes the source code of the algorithm. CRC Press «Market: Computer Science / Computer Engineering / Computing March 2011: 235x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3576-0: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3577-7: £57.99/17
information technology
Cyber Security Essentials Edited by Rick Howard, Verisign iDefense Security Intelligence Services, Dulles, Virginia, USA A collection of intelligence and security articles, this book covers common security terms and vulnerabilities, such as Stack Based Buffer Overflows, Malware_Naming, Fast-Flux, SQL Injection, and Format_ String_ Vulnerability. It clearly and concisely explains more than 75 common security vulnerabilities in short, wellillustrated, easy-to-read and comprehend descriptions. The author provides actionable advice on how to mitigate each vulnerability that enables a proactive response to threats and attacks.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Sumeet Dua and Xian Du, both at Louisiana Tech University, Ruston, USA Introducing basic concepts of machine learning and data mining methodologies for cyber security, this book provides a unified reference for specific machine learning solutions and cybersecurity problems. The authors focus on how to apply machine learning methodologies in cybersecurity, categorizing methods for detecting, scanning, profiling, intrusions, and anomalies. The text presents challenges and solutions in machine learning along with cybersecurity fundamentals. It also describes advanced problems in cybersecurity in the machine learning domain and examines privacy-preserving data mining methods as a proactive security solution. Auerbach Publications «Market: Forensics and Criminal Justice January 2011: 235x156: 240pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3942-3: £54.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3943-0: £54.99/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Auerbach Publications «Market: Information Technology December 2010: 235x156: 336pp Pb: 978-1-4398-5123-4: £44.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5126-5: £44.99/17
Data Mining and Machine Learning in Cybersecurity
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
294 information technology
Encyclopedia of Information Assurance – 4 Volume Set (Print Version)
Internet Searches for Vetting, Investigations, and Open-Source Intelligence
Edited by Rebecca Herold, LLC, Van Meter, Iowa, USA and Marcus K. Rogers, Purdue University, West Lafayette, Indiana, USA
Edward J. Appel, iNameCheck LLC, Bethany Beach, Delaware, USA
Information Assurance (IA) professionals are charged with protecting the confidentiality, integrity, availability, and delivery of an entity’s data. The Encyclopedia of Information Assurance is a comprehensive collection of articles and references that cover the wide range of subjects found within the field. Timely and reliable, this four-volume set presents new methods, techniques, and strategies through entries and illustrations that address every meaningful topic in information assurance, including risk management, privacy, legal and regulatory compliance, auditing, and digital forensics. Auerbach Publications «Market: Information Technology December 2010: 279x216: 2000pp Hb: 978-1-4200-6620-3: £765.00/17
Virtual activities made possible by high-bandwidth internet connectivity have changed societal behavior. As a result, employers, investigators, and intelligence analysts must adopt better strategies for internet searching in order to protect information assets. Addressing legal, policy, privacy, and management issues, this book provides a procedural framework for effective internet searching in investigations and intelligence. The text describes the proper use of internet vetting, investigations, and open-source intelligence and offers solutions to common stumbling blocks that prevent the adoption of appropriate defenses against those who misuse information systems. CRC Press «Market: Information Technology December 2010: 235x156: 264pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2751-2: £44.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2752-9: £44.99/17
10th Edition
Green IT Strategies and Applications
Information Security Management Handbook, 2011 CD-ROM Edition
Bhuvan Unhelkar, Consultant, New South Wales, Australia Series: Advanced & Emerging Communications Technologies Based on extensive research, literature review, experimentation, and the author’s practical experience, this book demonstrates what environmental intelligence is, how it can be used towards a greener environment, and how IT should be targeted to help achieve this end. It demonstrates how environmentally responsible business strategies can be implemented in an organization through specific phases of diagnosis, planning, enactment and review. The socio-political challenges of environmentally responsible businesses are also discussed together with strategies to ameliorate them. Figures, tables, case studies, and a PowerPoint presentation are included. CRC Press «Market: Information Technology March 2011: 235x156: 320pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3780-1: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3781-8: £49.99/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Harold F. Tipton, HFT Associates, Villa Park, California, USA and Micki Krause Nozaki, Pacific Life Insurance Company, Newport Beach, California, USA Containing the complete contents of Volumes 1, 2,3, and this year’s Volume 4, the Information Security Management Handbook, 2010 CD-ROM Edition is an authoritative resource that is linked, searchable by keyword, and organized under the CBK® domains. In addition to the complete contents of the 6,000 page set, the CD-ROM includes an extra volume’s worth of information – including chapters from other security and networking books that have never appeared in the print editions. Auerbach Publications «Market: Information Technology March 2011 CD-ROM: 978-1-4398-5320-7: £127.00/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Using Environmental Intelligence
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
information technology 295
ITIL
Program Management Complexity
Assessment, Planning, and Management
A Competency Model
Donna M. Manley, University of Pennsylvania, Philadelphia, USA
Ginger Levin, Project Management Consultant, Lighthouse Point, Florida, USA and J. LeRoy Ward, ESI International, Arlington, Virginia, USA
This book explains the preliminary due diligence, planning, and execution required to effectively institute ITIL as a way of business life. It presents the benefits of using this framework and details how to prepare an organization for the opportunities and challenges that this commitment brings. Including sample timelines, the author discusses how to successfully identify processes currently in place, understand the role each process plays in the organization, and determine if a process is really necessary. The text concludes with methods to sustain progress through organizational and personal performance activities. CRC Press February 2011: 235x156: 200pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2724-6: £41.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2725-3: £41.99/17
Series: ESI International Project Management Series Written by two of the first people to obtain the Program Management Professional (PgMP) certification from the Project Management Institute, this book explores various competency models for program management. The book delineates a competency model that follows the framework of PMI’s model for project managers but is applied to program managers with performance and personal competencies. After an overview of the model, the text presents three separate questionnaires designed for organizations, existing program managers, and aspiring program managers, respectively, to assess their own development plans. Auerbach Publications March 2011: 235x156: 136pp Hb: 978-1-4398-5111-1: £44.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5112-8: £44.99/17
Official (ISC)2® Guide to the ISSMP® CBK®
Adaptive Security Management Architecture *
Edited by Harold F. Tipton, HFT Associates, Villa Park, California, USA
James S. Tiller, BT INS, Raleigh, North Carolina, USA
The Official (ISC) 2® Guide to the ISSMP® CBK® provides an overview of management topics related to information security. This iteration provides for a more expanded enterprise model of security and management, one that delves into project management, risk management, and continuity planning. Preparing the professional for certification as well as for job readiness, this resource promotes an understanding of what are now ISSEP domains. These include Enterprise Security Management Practices, Enterprise-Wide System Development Security, Law, Investigations, Forensics and Ethics, Overseeing Compliance of Operations Security, and Business Continuity and Disaster Recovery Planning.
çè
Auerbach Publications «Market: Information Technology February 2011: 235x156: 472pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9443-5: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9444-2: £49.99/17
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
To take the next step in information security, Adaptive Security Management Architecture provides a comprehensive approach to managing people, process, and technology through the sound application of metrics. This book demonstrates how to develop a balanced strategy for meeting security challenges and enhancing the business in addressing threats and compliance. Describing how the different facets of a secure IT system are related, it integrates IT security with business, using managerial measures of performance such as balanced scorecards and applying business risk analysis. The text also focuses on customer satisfaction to stress the importance of IT as a part of business rather than as a separate entity. Auerbach Publications «Market: Information Technology November 2010: 235x156: 478pp Hb: 978-0-8493-7052-6: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-1337-5: £49.99/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Series: (ISC)2 Press
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
296 information technology
Software Engineering Reviews and Audits
2nd Edition
The Security Risk Assessment Handbook
Boyd L. Summers, the Boeing Company, Seattle, Washington, USA
Douglas Landoll, Lantego, LLC, Austin, Texas, USA The Security Risk Assessment Handbook: A Complete Guide for Performing Security Risk Assessments provides detailed insight into precisely how to conduct an information security risk assessment from a practical point of view. Designed for security professionals who want a more in-depth understanding of the risk assessment process, this volume contains real-world advice that promotes professional development and experience. It also enables security consumers to better negotiate the scope and rigor of a security assessment, effectively interface with a security assessment team, deliver insightful comments on a draft report, and have a greater understanding of final report recommendations. CRC Press «Market: Information Technology December 2010: 235x156: 400pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2148-0: £48.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-2998-2
Designed to answer questions regarding the setup and performance of specific software engineering reviews and audits, this book explains how to conduct reviews and audits properly and in compliance with mandatory software requirements. It provides best methods for conducting reviews and audits for aerospace companies, defense contractors, and software organizations. Authored by an industry professional with more than 20 years of experience, the text offers insight on conducting functional and physical configuration audits. It includes a glossary of acronyms and abbreviations for ease of comprehension. Auerbach Publications January 2011: 235x156: 192pp Hb: 978-1-4398-5145-6: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5146-3: £49.99/17
Applied Semantic Web Technologies
Architectural Design Patterns in C#
Edited by Vijayan Sugumaran, Oakland University, Rochester, Michigan, USA and Jon Atle Gulla, NTNU, Norway
With a focus on designing applications, this book presents a step-by-step architectural approach to learning and mastering design patterns using C#. The author provides guidance for the architecture and design of reusable, scalable, and robust enterprise applications. The text discusses a number of common architectural models and patterns and explains how to choose the best ones for particular scenarios. Real-life code examples and UML diagrams illustrate the patterns and how they work.
Joydip Kanjilal, Kolkata, India
Due to their rapid development, many practitioners are confused about the state of semantic technologies, which are considered to be at different levels of maturity. With an emphasis on the adoption and diffusion of semantic technologies for real-world applications, this book covers the most mature parts of the Semantic Web and practical applications in information and knowledge management. It presents a combination of theory and industry cases that discuss the technical and practical issues related to semantic technologies in intelligent information management. Topics addressed include ontology engineering and semantic retrieval.
Auerbach Publications «Market: Information Technology March 2011: 235x156: 350pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1656-1: £44.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1658-5: £44.99/17
Auerbach Publications «Market: Information Technology February 2011: 235x156: 400pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0156-7: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0157-4: £57.99/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
Data Mining in Biomedical Imaging, Signaling, and Systems Edited by Sumeet Dua, Louisiana Tech University, Ruston, USA and Rajendra Acharya U, Ngee Ann Polytechnic, Singapore Approaching the techniques and challenges of image mining from a multidisciplinary perspective, this book presents data mining techniques, methodologies, algorithms, and strategies to analyze biomedical signals and images. Written by experts, the text addresses data mining paradigms for the development of biomedical systems. It also includes special coverage of knowledge discovery in mammograms and emphasizes both the diagnostic and therapeutic fields of eye imaging. Auerbach Publications «Market: Information Technology January 2011: 235x156: 384pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3938-6: £66.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3939-3: £66.99/17
çè
A Complete Guide for Performing Security Risk Assessments
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
information technology 297 Data Storage Management, Implementation, and Strategies Hubbert Smith, Samsung Semiconductor, Inc., Sandy, Utah, USA This work provides a storage industry insider’s insight on how to properly scope, plan, evaluate, and implement storage technologies to maximize performance, capacity, reliability, and power savings. It covers all types of storage technology, including SAN, capacity-optimized drives, and solidstate drives. Written for IT managers, data center managers, and CIOs, the book offers strategies for minimizing risk and cost when implementing storage technology, including how to reduce air conditioning costs and overall power consumption. It also analyzes cloud technology and its effects on an organization’s storage strategies. Auerbach Publications «Market: Information Technology February 2011: 235x156: 304pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3487-9: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3488-6: £49.99/17
Service Delivery Platforms Developing and Deploying Converged Multimedia Services Edited by Syed A. Ahson, Microsoft Corporation, Bellevue, Washington, USA and Mohammad Ilyas, Florida Atlantic University, Boca Raton, USA In the telecommunications industry, it is becoming increasingly important for operators to quickly provide a service delivery platform. This book discusses the fundamental requirements of service delivery platforms, evaluating their basic functions and feasibility. Starting with content and media in modern networks, the text presents the entire user experience, including requirements for the user terminal, supporting systems, broadcasting, and networks. Expert contributors explore the evolving role of service delivery platforms, explaining various applications and delivery mechanisms, providing an overview of enabling technologies, and addressing a wide range of security issues. Auerbach Publications February 2011: 235x156: 416pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0089-8: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0090-4: £76.99/17
FISMA Compliance Principles and Best Practices Patrick D. Howard, Nuclear Regulatory Commission, Rockville, Maryland, USA Few organizations have not felt the impact of government regulation in the area of information systems security. In light of new legislation such as the Federal Information Security Management Act (FISMA), there is an increased need to measure the ability of government organizations and companies subject to these standards to protect information. This book provides practical guidelines for addressing FISMA compliance. It offers workable solutions for establishing and operating a security compliance program, including how to gain management support, design and staff a compliance capability, build organizational relationships, and integrate compliance into the system development life cycle. Auerbach Publications «Market: Information Technology March 2011: 235x156: 288pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7829-9: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7830-5: £49.99/17
Implementing and Developing Cloud Computing Applications David E.Y. Sarna, Hendon, Stamford Hill & Co., Inc., Teaneck, New Jersey, USA Major enterprises and small start-ups are beginning to embrace cloud computing for the scalability and reliability that cloud vendors can provide. This book demonstrates how to implement robust and highly scalable cloud computing applications. Filled with comparative charts and decision trees to help navigate the many implementation alternatives, the author describes the major available commercial offerings and guides readers in choosing the best combination of platform, tools, and services for a small, growing start-up or an established enterprise. Aimed at software developers and their managers, the text details cloud development environments, lifecycles, and project management. Auerbach Publications «Market: Information Technology February 2011: 235x156: 304pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3082-6: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3083-3: £49.99/17
Handbook of Mobile Systems Applications and Services
Strategic Text Analytics
Edited by Anup Kumar, University of Louisville, Kentucky, USA and Bin Xie, University of Cincinnati, Ohio, USA
Peter Mancini, Nashville, Tennessee, USA
An investigation of the evolution of mobile services technologies, this book provides a complete understanding of these technologies, from theoretic concept to implementation protocols, and from fundamentals to real applications. It contains chapters written by internationally recognized researchers who discuss concepts, theory, algorithms, implementations, and new applications. Topics covered include building blocks for mobile services architecture, middleware for mobile services, and applications, standards and performance evaluation of mobile services. It provides a comprehensive reference for students, instructors, researchers, engineers, and other professionals, building their understanding of mobile service computing. Auerbach Publications «Market: Information Technology March 2011: 235x156: 600pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0152-9: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0153-6: £76.99/17
Planning, Implementation, and Management In past decades, the ability of a system to index thousands of documents and conduct key word searches was deemed sufficient. Today, systems must be able to quickly scale to tens of millions of documents and search keywords as well as the meaning of those keywords. This book explains the theories behind fundamental informational retrieval technologies. It examines available technologies and solutions and discusses how to evaluate, apply, and implement these technologies. The author, a leading IT analyst addresses semantics, concept mining, concept searching, and information extraction. Auerbach Publications December 2010: 235x156: 304pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4167-9: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4172-3: £57.99/17
Web-Based Outsourcing * Edited by Vivek Sharma, K.S. Rajasekaran, Infosys Technologies, Ltd., Bangalore, India, and Varum Sharma, Faridabad, India Series: Infosys Press Project execution is often outsourced to external organizations possessing specialized expertise in planning, allocating resources, and completing projects in an integrated manner faster than the project owner. Written by a team of authors from the world’s largest software outsourcer, this book explains how to buy and sell outsourcing services, find the right outsourcing partner, effectively execute projects, and benefit from past project experience. It discusses how to leverage the web to manage and deploy geographically dispersed people, resources, and competencies. It includes two web-based business models and covers outsourced project management.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Auerbach Publications «Market: Information Technology February 2011: 235x156: 336pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1055-2: £38.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1056-9: £38.99/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
298 geotechnology, mining and petroleum engineering
Geologically Active
Rock Stress and Earthquakes
Proceedings of the 11th IAEG Congress. Auckland, New Zealand, 5–10 September 2010
Edited by Furen Xie, Institute of Crustal Dynamics, China Earthquake Administration, Beijing, P.R. China Rock Stress and Earthquakes covers measuring techniques, interpretation methods, and the application of in-situ stress in engineering practice and geophysics. It aims to build new connections between traditional and geophysical methods, which will both benefit earthquake prediction based on the concept of the crustal stresses. The book is much of interest to academics and engineers in rock mechanics, geophysics, geology, and seismology.
Edited by A.L. Williams, Beca Infrastructure Ltd, New Zealand, G.M. Pinches, Aurecon New Zealand Ltd, New Zealand, C.Y. Chin, URS New Zealand Ltd, New Zealand, T.J. McMorran, Golder Associates (NZ) Limited, New Zealand and C.I. Massey, Institute of Geological and Nuclear Science, New Zealand Containing over 500 papers from 44 countries worldwide, presented at the 11th Congress of the IAEG, this keynote and invited paper volume including a CD-ROM presents the state-of-the-art on practice in engineering geology. This combined resource provides must-have information for engineering and geological academics and consultants, government organizations, and power and mining companies.
CRC Press «Market: Rock Mechanics July 2010: 246x174: 892pp Hb: 978-0-415-60165-8: £149.00/17 eBook: 978-0-203-83610-1: £149.00/17
CRC Press «Market: Engineering Geology August 2010: 246x174: 352pp Pack: 978-0-415-60034-7: £349.00/17 e-Book: 978-0-203-83825-9: £349.00/17
2 Volume Set
Uttam Ray Chaudhuri, University of Calcutta, India Series: Chemical Industries A complete delineation of the basics of crude oil, petrochemicals, refineries, and hydrocarbon processing plants, this book begins with coverage of crude exploration and production and concludes with start-up and shut-down. Each chapter contains exercises and questions at the end and solved problems are provided throughout the book. The book includes topics such as products from crude oil and their testing, refinery operations, lubricants and petrochemical manufacture, plastic and rubber processing, offsites, utilities, chemicals, plant and equipment calculations, instrumentation and control, and management. CRC Press «Market: Chemical Engineering December 2010: 235x156: 408pp Hb: 978-1-4398-5160-9: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5161-6: £89.00/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Unsaturated Soils Edited by Eduardo E. Alonso, Technical University of Catalonia (UPC) Barcelona, Spain and Antonio Gens, Technical University of Catalonia (UPC), Barcelona, Spain This book reports significant advances in the areas of unsaturated soil behaviour, testing techniques, constitutive and numerical modelling and applications. The areas of application include soilatmosphere interaction, foundations, slopes, embankments, pavements, geoenviromental problems and emerging topics. The contributions are a comprehensive record of the state-of-the art in unsaturated soil mechanics and a sound basis for further progress in the future, and will serve as an essential reference for academics, researchers and practitioners interested in unsaturated soils. CRC Press «Market: Soil Mechanics August 2010: 246x174: 1532pp Pack: 978-0-415-60428-4: £299.00/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Fundamentals of Petroleum and Petrochemical Engineering
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
geotechnology, mining and petroleum engineering 299
Rock Engineering Design John A. Hudson, Imperial College, London, UK and Xia-Ting Feng, Institute of Rock and Soil Mechanics, Chinese Academy of Sciences
Rotary Drilling and Blasting in Large Surface Mines Balchandra V. Gokhale A reference guide comprehensively covering rotary blasthole drilling and surface blasting. Presents drilling and surface blasting, rock, rock mass, machinery, tools and accesories, compressors and air flushing, computing, and practice. Comprises classic and new concepts, methodologies and techniques, all supported by multiple illustrations and a wealth of data. Intended for professionals, technicians and advanced students in mining, geological, and mechanical engineering working on mine design and construction.
Given the recent advances in site investigation techniques, computing, access to information and monitoring, plus the current emphasis on safety, accountability and sustainability, this book introduces an up-to-date methodology for the design of all types of rock engineering projects, whether surface or underground. Guidance is provided on the modelling to support design; also included is a procedure for technical auditing the modelling and design together with the related protocol sheets. For consulting engineers, contractors, researchers, and students. Selected Contents: 1. Introduction to Rock Engineering Modelling and Design 2. Ways Ahead 3. Flowcharts 4. Information Required 5. Technical Auditing 6. Case: Rock Slope 7. Case: Underground Cavern 8. Protocol Sheets 9. Example Protocol Sheets Use. App-A: ISRM Suggested Methods. App-B: Chinese BQ Rock Mass Classification System. CD-ROM with Protocol Sheets CRC Press «Market: Civil Engineering & Mining / Rock Mechanics / Geophysics February 2011: 246x174: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-60356-0: £76.99/17
New Techniques and Technologies in Mining School of Underground Mining 2010 Edited by Volodymyr Bondarenko, National Mining University of Ukraine, Dnipropetrovs’k, Ukraine, Irina Kovalevska, National Mining University, Dnipropetrovs’k, Ukraine and Roman Dychkovskiy, National Mining University, Dnipropetrovs’k, Ukraine A selection of papers resulting from the International Mining School 2010, held in Yalta is presented in this book. Papers authored by outstanding and experienced authors in the field of mining are compiled providing an interesting overview of the state of the art in the area of underground mining. CRC Press «Market: Mining August 2010: 246x174: 300pp Hb: 978-0-415-59864-4: £82.00/17
CRC Press «Market: Mining & Blasting December 2010: 246x174: 450pp Hb: 978-0-415-87878-4: £99.00/17 eBook: 978-0-203-84139-6: £99.00/17
Mine Safety and Efficient Exploitation Facing Challenges of the 21st Century
Elements of Industrial Hazards
International Mining Forum 2010
Ratan Raj Tatiya, Sultan Qaboos University, Oman, United Arab Emirates
Edited by Liu Zegong, Jerzy Kicki, Polish Academy of Sciences, Cracow, Poland, Hua Xinzhu, Yuan Shujie, Anhui University of Science and Technology, Anhui, P.R. China, Dai Guanglong and Eugeniusz J. Sobczyk, Polish Academy of Sciences, Cracow, Poland The International Mining Forum is a meeting of scientist and professionals for exchanging new ideas and experiences, evaluating previously implemented solutions, and discussing fresh ideas that might change the mining industry’s image. The International Mining Forum 2010 will provide experts all over the world with an opportunity and platform to exchange information and ideas. Purpose of the forum is to promote research and development of mine safety, efficient exploitation theory and provide theoretical and technical support for mine safety improvement.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
CRC Press «Market: Mining October 2010: 246x174: 300pp Hb: 978-0-415-59896-5: £63.99/17
Health, Safety, Environment and Loss Prevention
An introductory course on Health, Safety and Environment as applicable to all manufacturing and exploration engineering industries. Its first part deals with fundamentals, ecology and environmental engineering and covers air and water pollution sources, magnitude, measuring techniques and remedial measures to minimize them. The second part deals with industrial hazards, health and safety. Includes standards, strategies, risk assessment and accident analysis. The last part treats elements of HSE management, a critical activity for virtually any engineering business. For a broad audience active in the engineering, ranging from the plant supervisor to HSE consultants to operators in the field. CRC Press «Market: Engineering Safety November 2010: 246x174: 418pp Hb: 978-0-415-88645-1: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-0-203-83612-5: £89.00/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
300 physics, chemistry & materials science 3rd Edition
textbook
Corrosion Mechanisms in Theory and Practice
Essentials of Physical Chemistry Donald Shillady, Virginia Commonwealth University, Richmond, USA
Edited by Philippe Marcus, Ecole Nationale Superieure, France Series: Corrosion Technology Building on previous editions described as ‘a useful contribution to the current literature on corrosion science, engineering, and technology’ by Corrosion Review, this third installment offers real-world applications and problem-solving techniques to reduce the occurrence of pits, cracks, and deterioration in industrial, automotive, marine, and electronic structures. It also details the electrochemical and chemical properties, adsorption mechanisms, environmental parameters, and microstructural factors that influence corrosion formation. Including contributions from authors around the world, this reorganized third edition covers the most recent advances in the field, adding three new chapters on Fundamentals of Corrosion from a Surface Science and Electrochemical Basis, High-Temperature Oxidation, and Atomistic Modeling of Corrosion.
Particularly well-suited for premedical and forensic science students, as well as others not pursuing a traditional chemistry curriculum, this book presents a standalone approach to teaching physical chemistry in a one-semester course, a current trend in undergraduate education. This new undergraduate textbook succeeds in inspiring a thorough understanding rather than merely exposing students to what they all too often perceive as a painful and confusing experience. The author includes real-world applications, worked examples, end-of-chapter problems, key solutions, thermodynamic data, and much more to assist in the teaching and learning of physical chemistry. CRC Press «Market: General Chemistry March 2011: 254x178: 216pp Pb: 978-1-4398-4097-9: £27.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4098-6: £27.99/17
CRC Press «Market: Material Science April 2011: 254x178: 850pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9462-6: £108.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9463-3: £108.00/17
Commonly Asked Questions in Thermodynamics
Fundamentals of Attosecond Optics
Marc J. Assael, Aristotle University, Thessaloniki, Greece, William A. Wakeham, University of Southampton, UK, Anthony R.H. Goodwin, Schlumberger Technology Corporation, Sugar Land, Texas, USA, Stefan Will, Fachgebiet Technische Thermodynamik, Germany and Michael Stamatoudis, Aristotle University, Greece
Zenghu Chang, University of Central Florida, Orlando, USA
Every scientist and engineer encounters problems that may be solved at least in part using the principles of thermodynamics. The importance of thermodynamics is often so fundamental to life that we should all have a fairly detailed understanding of this core field. This clearly written, easy-to-follow guide allows even nonscientists considering use of alternative fuel sources to achieve a solid grounding in thermodynamics. The authors cover topics spanning from energy sources to the environment to climate change. A broad audience of general readers, students, industry professionals, and academic researchers will appreciate the answers found in this book.
A discussion of fundamental concepts, basic techniques, and the state-of-the-art applications, this book’s coverage builds from basic underlying theory to more complex ideas related to attosecond optics. It shows how the generation of attosecond optical pulses requires knowledge of femtosecond laser technologies but is also quite distinct from femtosecond laser technologies. The authors elaborate on this point using semi-classical models and quantum mechanics theories. They explain generation of attosecond pulse train and gating methods for extracting single isolated pulses, and present illustrative examples of attosecond applications. CRC Press «Market: Physics February 2011: 254x178: 560pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8937-0: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8938-7: £57.99/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
CRC Press «Market: Physics February 2011: 235x156: 280pp Pb: 978-1-4200-8695-9: £25.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8696-6: £25.99/17
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
physics, chemistry & materials science 301 2nd Edition
2nd Edition
Fundamentals of FourierTransform Infrared Spectroscopy
Handbook of Surface and Nanometrology
Brian C. Smith, Spectros Associates, Shrewsbury, Massachusetts, USA Upon its initial publication, the first edition of this text quickly became a bestselling industry standard. Completey revised and updated, the second edition teaches the basics of FTIR spectroscopy to those new to the field and is an outstanding reference for experienced users. Highly accessible, the book explains difficult theoretical concepts using a multitude of diagrams and a minimum of complex mathematics. It covers spectral data manipulation, and provides step-by-step handling instructions and a discussion of the 15 pitfalls of quantitative analysis. A comprehensive glossary offers quick and easy definition of key FTIR terms. CRC Press «Market: Analytical Chemistry December 2010: 235x156: 288pp Hb: 978-1-4200-6929-7: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-6930-3: £95.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-2461-1
David J. Whitehouse, University of Warwick, UK David Whitehouse, known as the father of digital metrology, helped pioneer the use of nanotechnology in surface science and surface metrology, and he continues to move the field forward. In this heavily revised and expanded edition, he addresses the many paradigm shifts occurring in the field. He explains the incorporation of physics to develop optimum solutions for manufacture and performance, and provides mechanical engineers with accessible explanations of essential concepts along with the higher mathematics that is now required of those working in the field. Emphasis is placed on systems wherever possible and the connection between nano surface geometry characterization and instrumentation. CRC Press «Market: Physics December 2010: 279x216: 1015pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8201-2: £191.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8202-9: £153.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-7503-0583-9
textbook
Fundamentals of Nonlinear Optics Nanobiomaterials Handbook Peter E. Powers, University of Dayton, Ohio, USA Thsi introductory volume begins with the wave equation in its simplest form. The author enhances comprehension by progressively removing simplifying assumptions. He guides readers to a clear understanding of core aspects of three wave interactions, including second harmonic generation, sum and difference frequency generation, and the electrooptic effect. The concepts of phase matching, bandwidths, and gain unfold naturally from these formalisms and extend to higher order processes such as four-wave mixing, Raman, Brillouin, and two-photon processes. The author also highlights recent developments and key applications throughout the text.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
A comprehensive overview and broad introduction to nanobiomaterials, this handbook defines the field and discusses its scope, current status, and future prospects. It then provides an in-depth survey of nanobiomaterials and provides a comprehensive overview of the various synthesis and processing techniques important for developing bionanomaterials. It also includes a detailed overview of the interaction between bionanomaterials and biological systems as well as the biocompatibility issues associated with bionanomaterials. Extensive references are included at the end of each chapter to enhance additional study. CRC Press «Market: Material Science April 2011: 254x178: 1000pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9466-4: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9467-1: £95.00/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
CRC Press «Market: Physics March 2011: 254x178: 300pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9351-3: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9352-0: £49.99/17
Edited by Balaji Sitharaman, State University of New York at Stoneybrook, USA
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
302 physics, chemistry & materials science 2nd Edition textbook
3rd Edition
Plasma Physics and Engineering
Polarized Light
Alexander Fridman, University of Illinois at Chicago, USA
Dennis H. Goldstein, Polaris Sensor Technologies, Inc., Niceville, Florida, USA
CRC Press «Market: Physics December 2010: 235x156: 744pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1228-0: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1229-7: £82.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-1-5603-2848-3
Nanofabrication Handbook Edited by Stefano Cabrini, Lawrence Berkeley National Laboratory, Berkeley, California, USA and Satoshi Kawata, Osaka University, Japan A comprehensive resource for this rapidly emerging discipline, this book includes detailed discussions of the underlying theoretical basis, the resolution, patterns, and substrates used along with applications. It builds upon current understanding of microfabrication, moving into the nano dimension and demonstrating how work at this level calls for a different process. Most notably, the book provides guidance on particular lithographic techniques that better fit specific research needs. It includes coverage of how to approach key problems in the decision-making process related to materials, methods, surface considerations, and more. CRC Press «Market: Physics March 2011: 254x178: 600pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9052-9: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9053-6: £82.00/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
An in-depth exploration of polarized light, this book covers production and uses, facilitating self-study without requiring prior knowledge of Maxwell’s equations. This third edition includes more than 2500 figures and equations along with chapters on polarization elements, anisotropic materials, Stokes polarimetry, Mueller matrix polarimetry, and the mathematics of the Mueller matrix. It features two new chapters, one on polarized light in nature and one on birefringence. It also presents a completely revised review of the history of polarized light and contains a new appendix on conventions used in polarized light. CRC Press «Market: Physics December 2010: 254x178: 624pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3040-6: £121.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3041-3: £159.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8247-4053-5
Nanoscience Education, Workforce Training, and K-12 Resources * Judith Light Feather, The Nanotechnology Group, Inc., Nacogdoches, Texas, USA and Miquel F. Aznar, Santa Cruz, California, USA Designed for nano-aware individuals in both the public and private sectors, this first-of-its-kind volume provides a concise, readable resource on nanoscience education and workforce development in the field. Defining nanotechnology and evaluating the field’s global and national landscapes, this book provides a historical perspective on the complexity of K-12 education communities and presents successful changes within them. Aimed at helping K-12 students acquire the skills to understand and evaluate emerging technologies, this book offers plans of action and links to sustainable development tools. It is designed to enhance awareness, review the facts, and fabricate a platform from which to launch a plan. CRC Press «Market: Physics December 2010: 235x156: 343pp Pb: 978-1-4200-5394-4: £31.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-5397-5: £31.99/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Plasma engineering is a rapidly expanding area of science and technology with increasing numbers of engineers using plasma processes over a wide range of applications. An essential tool for understanding this dynamic field, Plasma Physics and Engineering provides a clear, fundamental introduction to virtually all aspects of modern plasma science and technology, including plasma chemistry and engineering, combustion, chemical physics, lasers, electronics, methods of material treatment, fuel conversion, and environmental control. The book contains an extensive database on plasma kinetics and thermodynamics, many helpful numerical formulas for practical calculations, and an array of problems and concept questions.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
physics, chemistry & materials science 303 textbook
textbook
Quantitative Understanding of Biosystems
Understanding Nanomaterials
An Introduction to Biophysics
Malkiat S. Johal, Pomona College, Claremont, California, USA and Robert J. Rawle, Stanford University, California, USA This textbook provides a coherent overview of the fundamental principles underlying nanomaterials fabrication, as well as a discussion of the characterization and application of these materials. The author takes an interdisciplinary approach, highlighting the theory and tools contributed by chemistry, biology, physics, medicine, and engineering. Real world examples related to energy, the environment, and medicine are included throughout the text that underscore the technological applications.
Thomas M. Nordlund, University of Alabama at Birmingham, USA An intermediate level treatment from a quantitative perspective, this text covers the biophysics of macromolecules and subcellular structure interactions with light. The author emphasizes mathematical and computational approaches to the study of the properties and physical behavior of biomolecules and nonstructures. He provides detailed coverage of key principles of statistical mechanics and quantum effects that are important for biological function, as well as light interactions with supramolecular structures. The book incorporates learning tools such as problem sets, exercises, review material, and learning objectives and includes discussions of topics that are often neglected, such as structural hierarchy. CRC Press «Market: Physics December 2010: 279x216: 864pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8972-1: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8973-8: £49.99/17
CRC Press «Market: Physics February 2011: 254x178: 400pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7310-2: £38.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7311-9: £38.99/17
2nd Edition textbook
The Physics of Medical Imaging Edited by S. Webb, Institute of Cancer Research and Royal Marsden NHS Trust, UK Series: Series in Medical Physics and Biomedical Engineering This updated text explains the physical principles governing medical imaging. It places different techniques in context with each other to provide a historical perspective and insight on future developments. It also illustrates techniques through examples of clinical imaging applications. The book covers the use of x-rays in diagnostic radiology and computed tomography in radiotherapy planning. It also discusses the tools and techniques of radioisotope, ultrasound, magnetic resonance, infrared, and optical imaging, along with the mathematics involved in image formation and processing, and image interpretation as well as computational requirements of imaging systems.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Particle, Fields and Quantum Electrodynamics Oleg Boyarkin, Belarus State Pedagogical University, Minsk Carefully constructed and written at a level accessible to graduate students, this book provides thorough and detailed coverage of forces, supersummetry, supergravity, particles, fields, and quantum electrodynamics. The author has based the book on advanced graduate courses and includes all the necessary particle physics, including mathematical techniques and derivation to allow students to start serious research. The complete and self contained design of the work makes it an excellent resource or handbook for those working in the area. It includes an examination of the first successfully operating quantum field theory, quantum electrodynamics. Taylor & Francis «Market: Physics November 2010: 254x178: 640pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0414-8: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0418-6: £63.99/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Taylor & Francis «Market: Physics March 2011: 235x156: 600pp Pb: 978-0-7503-0573-0: £44.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-1241-5: £120.00/17
Advanced Particle Physics Volume 1 *
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
304 physics, chemistry & materials science
Advanced Particle Physics Volume 2
Dynamical Tunneling Theory and Experiment Edited by Srihari Keshavamurthy, Indian Institute of Technology Kanpur, India and Peter Schlagheck, Universite de Liege, Belgium
The Standard Model and Beyond Oleg Boyarkin, Belarus State Pedagogical University, Minsk Accessible to graduate students, this second volume deals with the standard model of particle physics and quantum chromodynamics. It also covers topics beyond the standard model, including the hierarchy problem, dark matter and energy, and the strong CP problem, and discusses the topic of neutrino physics. The book features a mathematical presentation in which all intermediate steps are derived and contains extensive references to provide a comprehensive understanding of the development of particle physics. It also includes many worked examples, problems, and exercises.
Tunneling, a quantum mechanical phenomenon, has been the focus of research for nearly a century. Because of growing experimental sophistication and the probing of systems with sizes between single molecules and bulk materials, the need to understand the subtle influences of dynamical tunneling is becoming more critical. This text includes contributions from both the molecular and atomic physics communities to provide a comprehensive review of both theoretical and experimental advances in the field. From kicked atoms to Bose-Einstein condensates in optical lattices, this book discusses a wide range of systems and topics, including resonance and chaos-assisted tunneling.
Taylor & Francis «Market: Physics January 2011: 254x178: 608pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0416-2: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0417-9: £63.99/14
CRC Press «Market: Physics February 2011: 235x156: 424pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1665-3: £109.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1666-0: £109.00/17
Advances in Chromatography, Volume 49
Equilibrium Molecular Structures From Spectroscopy to Quantum Chemistry Edited by Jean Demaison, University of Lille, France, James E. Boggs, University of Texas at Austin, USA and Attila G. Csaszar, Eotvos University, Budapest, Hungary
Edited by Eli Grushka, The Hebrew University of Jerusalem, Israel and Nelu Grinberg, Boehringer-Ingelheim Pharmaceuticals, Inc., Ridgefield, Connecticut, USA
Following a new paradigm, this textbook takes advantage of the insight of world experts who have contributed chapters and relies upon its editors to seamlessly integrate the information into a unified presentation. It covers experimental and computational techniques and compares different methods. The book describes their interplay and the advantages of their combined use. More than merely a review of the modern literature, it is a true textbook that can be used by advanced students.
Series: Advances in Chromatography For more than four decades, scientists and researchers have relied on this series for the most up-to-date information on chromatographic methods and applications. This volume again compiles the work of expert contributors in order to present timely and cutting-edge reviews on a variety of related topics. Each author’s clear presentation of topics and vivid illustrations make the material accessible to those at all levels of experience. This edition covers method harmonization, strategies for rapid HPLC development, multidimensional ion chromatography, quantitative in silico analysis, mechanistic aspects of chiral discrimination on protein phases, novel materials for chromatographic analysis, and advances in CE-MS based glycoanalysis.
CRC Press «Market: Physics December 2010: 235x156: 312pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1132-0: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1135-1: £82.00/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
CRC Press «Market: Analytical Chemistry January 2011: 235x156: 488pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4091-7: £146.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4092-4: £146.00/17
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
physics, chemistry & materials science 305
From MEMS to Bio-MEMS and Bio-NEMS *
Micro Reaction Technology in Organic Synthesis
Manufacturing Techniques and Applications
Paul Watts and Charlotte Wiles, both at The University of Hull, UK
Marc J. Madou, University of California, Irvine, USA
A valuable resource for the modern
This text details manufacturing techniques applicable to bio-nanotechnology. After reviewing MEMS techniques, materials, and modeling, the author covers nanofabrication, genetically engineered proteins, artificial cells, nanochemistry, and self-assembly. He also discusses scaling laws in MEMS and NEMS, actuators, fluidics, and power and brains in miniature devices. He concludes with coverage of various MEMS and NEMS applications.
synthetic chemist, this broadly applicable book addresses the multidisciplinary field of micro reaction technology from novel research technique to a synthetic approach capable of changing the way chemists perform reactions. Concise and informative, it discusses the theory of process-intensification and continuous flow purifications, describes the advantages of miniaturization of organic reactions, and offers expert insight into micro reaction technology and the opportunity to increase the efficiency of organic reactions on a broad scale.
CRC Press «Market: Material Science December 2010: 279x216: 952pp Hb: 978-1-4200-5516-0: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-5518-4: £63.99/17
CRC Press «Market: General Chemistry March 2011: 235x156: 576pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2471-9: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2472-6: £89.00/17
Handbook of Analysis of Oligonucleotides and Related Products
Nanoporous Materials
A first-of-its-kind handbook, this text covers all the analytical techniques and methods commonly employed with oligonucleotides. With contributions from experts in the field, this handbook presents comprehensive coverage for analytical chemists, biochemists, biotechnologists, molecular biologists, and geneticists on the latest analytical technologies currently available. Topics covered include purity determination by HPLC, molecular weight determination, determination of hygroscopicity, analysis of bioburden, and analyses of ionic species by ion chromatography. A chapter on PAT and coverage of bioanalytical techniques is also included, and illustrations of analytical techniques and outputs are presented to aid with comprehension.
çè
CRC Press «Market: Analytical Chemistry February 2011: 254x178: 520pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1993-7: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1994-4: £89.00/17
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Edited by Nick Kanellopoulos, Demokritos National Centre for Scientific Research, Greece The past thirty years has seen a dramatic rise in the field of porous materials due to the development of an increasing number of novel materials. This book provides researchers of different disciplines with a clear and concise presentation of the current state of the art, recent advances and expected developments, as well as simulation techniques and their applications to optimize processes involving sorbents, membranes and catalysts. The chapters address experimental techniques, modeling techniques, processes, and case studies. CRC Press «Market: Material Science January 2011: 235x156: 584pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1104-7: £108.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1105-4: £108.00/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Edited by Jose V. Bonilla, Girindus America, Cincinnati, Ohio, USA and G. Susan Srivatsa, ElixinPharma, Encinitas, California, USA
Advanced Techniques for Characterization, Modeling, and Processing
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
306 physics, chemistry & materials science
Nuclear Medicine Physics
Small-Scale Laboratory Synthesis of Chemical Reagents
Edited by Joao Jose De Lima, IBILI Biophysics Institute, Portugal Series: Series in Medical Physics and Biomedical Engineering Edited by a renown international expert in the field, Nuclear Medicine Imaging Physics presents a full description on nuclear medicine imaging physics and methodology, serving as a useful reference of the basic physics and various applications in medicine and imaging systems. Written at a level accessible for a wide audience, including graduate students, this book provides advanced knowledge of relevant physical aspects behind modern nuclear imaging techniques, from radioisotope production to data acquisition and processing. Special emphasis is placed on the physics of biological functions from the perspective of their study with radioisotopes and the biological effects of radiation.
Leonid Lerner, Defence Science & Technology Organization, Australia T he in-lab preparation of some chemical reagents provides a number of advantages over purchasing commercially-prepared samples. This volume contains a detailed description of methods for the rapid and reliable synthesis of many useful reagants that are otherwise difficult to obtain. It provides spectroscopic analyses of products, presents the thermodynamic/ kinetic data of reactions, and offers a thorough analysis of the purity of the final products. Enhanced by useful diagrams and photographs, this text is a valuable reference for researchers in small or remote laboratories.
Taylor & Francis «Market: Physics November 2010: 235x156: 592pp Hb: 978-1-58488-795-9: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-58488-796-6: £95.00/17
CRC Press «Market: General Chemistry February 2011: 235x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1312-6: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1313-3: £89.00/17
Semiconductor Device-Based Sensors for Gas, Chemical, and Biomedical Applications
Solid-State Physics, Fluidics, and Analytical Techniques in Micro- and Nanotechnology *
This book provides a basic understanding of new developments on semiconductorbased sensors. Written for senior undergraduate and graduate students majoring in solid-state physics, electrical engineering, and materials science and engineering, this material is also relevant to researchers in the field of sensors for gas, chemical, bio, and medical applications. It presents original theory and experimental research, featuring numerous experts in the field who review progress in semiconductor and nano-material-based sensors and discuss the latest research regarding their applications. Fields addressed include: Si-MOS based sensors, nano-material based sensors, GaN-bsed sensor arrays for nano- and pico-fluidic systems, and InN based sensors. CRC Press «Market: Material Science February 2011: 254x178: 392pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1387-4: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1388-1: £95.00/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Marc J. Madou, University of California, Irvine, USA Providing a clear theoretical understanding of MEMS and NEMS, Solid-State Physics, Fluidics, and Analytical Techniques in Micro- and Nanotechnology covers all aspects of solid state physics behind nanotechnology and science. After exploring the rise of Si, MEMS, and NEMS in a historical context, the text discusses crystallography, quantum mechanics, the band theory of solids, and the silicon single crystal. It concludes with coverage of photonics, the quantum hall effect, and superconductivity. The text offers end-ofchapter problems, worked examples throughout, extensive references, and PowerPoint slides for download, along with a solutions manual for qualifying instructors. CRC Press «Market: Material Science December 2010: 279x216: 1008pp Hb: 978-1-4200-5511-5: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-5515-3: £63.99/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Edited by Fan Ren and Stephen J. Pearton, both at University of Florida, USA
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
physics, chemistry & materials science 307
Support Vector Machines and Their Application in Chemistry and Biotechnology
Thin-Film Organic Photonics
Yizeng Liang, Hunan University, China and Qing-Song Xu, Central South University, China
Artificial materials with atomic/molecularlevel tailored structures are the final goal of material scientists. Such structures enable electron-wave function control, which will improve material performance and generate new photonic/electronic phenomena. This book describes how photonic/electronic properties of thin films can be improved by precise control of atomic and molecular arrangements, and demonstrates the prospect of artificial materials with tailored structures. It describes related topics including a self-organized lightwave network, and a heterogeneous integration process. It also looks at applications in computers, optical switching systems, solar energy conversion systems, and bio/medical-photonics.
Support vector machines (SVMs), a promising machine learning method, is a powerful tool for chemical data analysis and for modeling complex physicochemical and biological systems. It is of growing interest to chemists and has been applied to problems in such areas as food quality control, chemical reaction monitoring, metabolite analysis, QSAR/QSPR, and toxicity. This book presents the theory of SVMs in a way that is easy to understand regardless of mathematical background. It includes simple examples of chemical and OMICS data to demonstrate the performance of SVMs and compares SVMs to other traditional classification/regression methods. CRC Press «Market: General Chemistry January 2011: 235x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2127-5: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2128-2: £76.99/17
Molecular Layer Deposition and Applications Tetsuzo Yoshimura, Tokyo University of Technology, Japan Series: Optics and Photonics
CRC Press «Market: General Chemistry January 2011: 235x156: 504pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1973-9: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1974-6: £89.00/17
Adaptive Radiation Therapy
Advanced Particle Physics
Edited by X. Allen Li, Medical College of Wisconsin, Milwaukee, USA
Oleg Boyarkin, Belarus State Pedagogical University, Minsk
Series: Imaging in Medical Diagnosis and Therapy
Providing a complete overview of modern particle physics, this work is composed of two volumes. Following a section on necessary mathematical techniques, the first volume covers forces, supersymmetry, supergravity, particles, fields, and quantum electrodynamics. The second volume explores the standard model of particle physics and quantum chromodynamics. Also discussed is what is referred to as Beyond the Standard Model, which includes the hierarchy problem, dark matter and energy, the strong CP problem, and the topic of neutrino physics. The complete and self-contained nature of the work makes it an excellent resource or handbook for those working in the area.
çè
CRC Press «Market: Physics January 2011: 279x216: 408pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1634-9: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1635-6: £95.00/17
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Taylor & Francis «Market: Physics April 2011: 254x178: 1248pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0412-4: £108.00/17
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
Edited by Vikas Mittal, BASF SE, Polymer Research, Ludwigshafen, Germany Written and edited by pioneers in the field, this text elucidates recent advances in polyolefin nanocomposites, which have recently been shown to be commercially viable as nanocomposites across a number of fields, including biomedical science, aerospace, and automotive engineering. It focuses on theoretical models to help readers understand the organic-inorganic interfaces in polyolefins and also provides a detailed description of the recently developed models for property prediction of these nanocomposites. It concentrates on developments with not only the aluminosilicate fillers, but also with other equally important fillers like layer double hydroxides and nanotubes. CRC Press «Market: Material Science December 2010: 254x178: 456pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1454-3: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1456-7: £95.00/17
çè
Adaptive Radiation Therapy (ART) has the ability to achieve highly individualized radiation treatment of cancer patients through customized planning and delivery. This comprehensive book covers treatment planning aspects, including uses of patient-specific spatial morphological and biological information for target definition; methods to optimize plans based on the patientspecific information; and techniques to assess treatment response for feedback. It discusses technologies for treatment delivery across various modalities and presents clinical examples that demonstrate modern applications of ART. Worldclass experts discuss state-of-the-art radiation therapy for brain tumors, head and neck cancer, sarcomas, and breast cancer.
Advances in Polyolefin Nanocomposites
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
308 physics, chemistry & materials science Applications of Field-Programmable Gate Arrays in Scientific Research
Artificial Neural Networks in Biological and Environmental Analysis
Hartmut F.-W. Sadrozinski, University of California, Santa Cruz, USA and Jinyuan Wu, Fermi National Accelerator Laboratory, Batavia, Illinois, USA
Grady Hanrahan, California Lutheran University, Los Angeles, USA
Emphasizing concepts and practical examples, this book presents an introduction to applications of field-programmable gate arrays (FPGAs) in various fields of research. It covers the principle of FPGAs and their functionality. The book explores how FPGAs work and how they are programmed to specific areas of applications in physics. Many figures and hands-on examples are included to show why FPGAs are so popular. The book also contains several chapters on special topics contributed by experts in the field. In addition, the accompanying CD-ROM (included upon qualification) provides detailed schematics, photographs, and screen shots not in the text. Taylor & Francis «Market: Physics December 2010: 235x156: 184pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4133-4: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4134-1: £82.00/17
CRC Press «Market: Analytical Chemistry January 2011: 235x156: 200pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1258-7: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1259-4: £57.99/17
Edited by Stuart Farquharson, Real-Time Analyzers, Inc, Middletown, Connecticut, USA With comprehensive coverage, Applications of Surface-Enhanced Raman Spectroscopy provides practitioners of SERS with a resource of current applications described by experts in each area to guide applications of this technology. The book covers both the traditional applications in chemical and biochemical research as well as commercial applications in the areas of environmental science, forensics, and pharmaceuticals and biotechnology. It emphasizes the hot-topic areas of homeland security and medical applications. Offering groundwork for future application development, this text is essential for analytical chemists involved in trace chemical analysis and those companies selling SERS products.
Peng-Cheng Ma, Leibniy Institute of Polymer Research, Dresden, Germany and Jang-Kyo Kim, Hong Kong University of Science and Technology, China Reinforcement for polymer matrix composites may not grab headlines, but it is one of the most important applications of carbon nanotubes (CNTs). This book highlights those areas where fabrication has proven difficult due to CNT entanglement and poor interfacial interactions among the CNTs and polymers. The text outlines how to specifically functionalize CNTs and control their surface functionalities to enhance the interfacial interactions with polymer matrix. CRC Press «Market: Material Science February 2011: 235x156: 224pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2621-8: £114.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2624-9: £114.00/17
Chemistry of Discotic Liquid Crystals From Monomers to Polymers
Boron Science
Applications of Surface-Enhanced Raman Spectroscopy *
CRC Press «Market: Analytical Chemistry March 2011: 254x178: 320pp Hb: 978-0-8493-3998-1: £127.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-0576-9: £127.00/17
Drawing on the experience and knowledge of a practicing professional, this book provides a comprehensive introduction and practical guide to the development, optimization, and application of artificial neural networks (ANNs) in modern environmental and biological analysis. Based on our knowledge of the functioning human brain, ANNs serve as a modern paradigm for computing. Presenting basic principles of ANNs together with simulated biological and environmental data sets and real applications in the field, this volume helps scientists comprehend the power of the ANN model to explain physical concepts and demonstrate complex natural processes.
Carbon Nanotubes for Polymer Reinforcement
New Technologies and Applications Edited by Narayan S. Hosmane CRC Press «Market: General Chemistry March 2011: 235x156: 440pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2662-1: £99.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2663-8: £99.00/17
Broadband Optical Modulators Science, Technology, and Applications Edited by Antao Chen, Triquint Semiconductor, Breinigsville, Pennsylvania, USA and Edmond Murphy, West Hartford, Connecticut, USA This book provides a comprehensive overview of the state of the art in optical modulator science and technology. It covers fundamental topics such as the electro-optic effect in nonlinear optic crystals and semiconductors. It addresses the optical and electro-optic properties of relevant materials, including traditional single crystalline lithium niobate, silicon, and III-V compound semiconductors, as well as emerging materials such as electrooptic polymers and organic nonlinear optic crystals. For each type of modulator, the author discusses the factors important to modulator performance, typical modulator design, and fabrication.
Sandeep Kumar, Raman Research Institute, India Series: Liquid Crystals Book Series Compiling the scattered literature into a single work, this book describes the basic design principles, synthesis, and mesomorphic properties of discotic liquid crystals. Of fundamental importance as models for the study of energy and charge migration in self-organized systems, discotic liquid crystals find functional application as one-dimensional conductors, photoconductors, light emitting diodes, photovoltaic solar cells, field-effect transistors, and gas sensors. This book highlights the scientific concepts behind the hierarchical self-assembly of these discshaped molecules alongside their commercial production and experimental and applied use in nanotechnology and other emerging fields. CRC Press «Market: General Chemistry December 2010: 254x178: 527pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1143-6: £121.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1145-0: £121.00/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
CRC Press «Market: Electrical Engineering April 2011: 235x156: 350pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2506-8: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2507-5: £82.00/17
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
physics, chemistry & materials science 309 Computational Quantum Mechanics for Nuclear Physics
Electroanalytical Chemistry
Energetic Materials
A Series of Advances: Volume 24
David J. Dean, Oak Ridge National Laboratory, Tennessee, USA and Mortin Hjorth-Jensen, University of Oslo, Norway
Edited by Allen J. Bard, University of Texas, Austin, USA and Cynthia Zoski, New Mexico State University, Las Cruces, USA
Thermophysical Properties, Predictions, and Experimental Measurements
This book presents various many-body techniques used to describe nuclei from the basic interactions among nucleons. It provides a brief description of modern nuclear forces and their application in finite nuclei. It also includes an overview of several many-body techniques used in the field, including quantum Monte Carlo, configuration interaction, and coupled cluster methods. The book covers the key algorithms necessary to build out and/ or use computer codes for simple problems. It also focuses on important high-performance computing aspects, modern computing languages, parallelization methods and libraries, and basic quantum many-body training.
Series: Electroanalytical Chemistry: A Series of Advances
Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Physics February 2011: 235x156: 300pp Hb: 978-1-4200-6609-8: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-6617-3: £63.99/17
CRC Handbook of Phase Equilibria and Thermodynamic Data of Copolymer Solutions Christian Wohlfarth, Martin-Luther University, Germany Packed with newly published references, this book provides 150 new vapor-liquid equilibrium data sets; and includes 50 new tables with classical Henry’s coefficients. It also contains 250 new liquid-liquid equilibrium data sets, 350 new highpressure fluid phase equilibrium data sets; 70 new data sets describing PVT properties, densities, or excess volumes; as well as 40 new enthalpic data sets. A larger data table for values of second osmotic virial coefficients and topics such as vapor-liquid equilibrium data and gas solubitilities of copolymer solutions round out the coverage. CRC Press «Market: Chemical Engineering December 2010: 254x178: 551pp Hb: 978-1-4398-5038-1: £159.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5039-8: £159.00/17
Written for graduate students and analytical chemists, this text is part of a series designed to provide authoritative reviews on recent developments and applications of wellestablished techniques in the field. Allen Bard covers electrochemical electrospray ionization mass spectrometry, pentiotometry, and other recent topics important to the field of electrochemistry and analytical chemistry. The book discusses applications currently under investigation and covers techniques outside the scope of electrochemistry that can be applied to electrochemical problems. It also offers electroanalytical techniques available for use in areas such as electro-organic synthesis, fuel cell studies, and radical ion formation. CRC Press «Market: Analytical Chemistry March 2011: 229x152: 300pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3750-4: £108.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3751-1: £108.00/17
Due to safety concerns, energetic materials are rarely studied at research facilities. Therefore, theoretical and empirical models are needed for studying the behavior of these materials. This book provides insight into the depth and breadth of theoretical and empirical models and experimental techniques being developed for energetic materials. It presents the latest research by U.S. Department of Defense engineers and scientists, along with their academic and industrial research partners. Some of the topics and simulations discussed can be applied to other classes of chemical compounds, such as those used in the pharmaceutical industry. CRC Press «Market: Material Science December 2010: 235x156: 288pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3513-5: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3514-2: £95.00/17
2nd Edition
Handbook of Inorganic Compounds
textbook
Experimental Techniques in Mechanics and Materials Cury Suryanarayana, University of Central Florida, Orlando, USA The properties of materials are determined by their microstructure and, to some limited extent, by their crystal structure. Bridging the gap between lecture and lab, this book presents methods to evaluate these crystal structures, microstructures, and properties. The author includes the background material for all of the experiments, offers workedout examples to illustrate concepts, and provides suggestions for additional laboratory experiments. From theory to practice, the text provides complete coverage of x-ray diffraction, optical microscopy, scanning electron microscopy, steel microstructures, heat treatment, and various testing. CRC Press «Market: Material Science February 2011: 235x156: 480pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1904-3: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1905-0: £76.99/17
Edited by Veera Boddu, US Army ERDC-CERL, Champaign and Paul Redner, US Army, ARDEC, Picatinny Arsenal, New Jersey, USA
Dale L. Perry, Lawrence Berkeley Laboratory, California, USA For anyone that needs property data for compounds, CASRN numbers for searches, a consistent tabulation of molecular weights to synthesize inorganic materials on a laboratory scale, or information on commercial and other uses for various compounds, this volume is the perfect reference. Fully revised and updated, this second edition includes new data on optical inorganics, radiation detection inorganics, thermochromic compounds, piezochromic compounds, metal ion coordination complexes, expanded crystallographic and structural data for inorganics, catalysts, superconductors, and luminescent (fluorescent and phosphorescent) inorganics. CRC Press «Market: General Chemistry March 2011: 279x216: 500pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1461-1: £127.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1462-8: £127.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8493-8671-8
Hydrophilic Interaction Liquid Chromatography (HILIC) and Advanced Applications Edited by Perry G. Wang, U.S. FDA, College Park, Maryland, USA and Weixuan He, Meda Pharmaceuticals, North Brunswick, New Jersey, USA Series: Chromatographic Science Series
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
CRC Press «Market: Analytical Chemistry February 2011: 235x156: 720pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0753-8: £99.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0754-5: £99.00/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
310 physics, chemistry & materials science III-V Compound Semiconductors Integration with Silicon-Based Microelectronics Edited by Tingkai Li, Micron Technology Inc., Boise, Idaho, USA, Michael Mastro, U.S. Naval Research Laboratory, Washington, DC, USA and Armin Dadgar, Otto-von-Guericke-Universitaet Magdeburg, Germany A discussion of recent advances, this book covers the scientific and technological exploration of GaN, GaAs, and III-V compound semiconductor and devices with Si microelectronics. It includes a broad range of topics from fundamental material properties and materials integration to demonstration and industrial devices. The book also contains discussions of the basic physical and chemical properties and mechanisms of the materials and devices, how to measure the materials and device properties, how to fabricate the materials and devices, and the applications, properties, and processes of the typical Gan, GaAs, and III-V compound semiconductors and devices with Si microelectronics. CRC Press «Market: Material Science December 2010: 235x156: 616pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1522-9: £99.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1523-6: £99.00/17
Innovations in Materials Manufacturing, Fabrication, and Environmental Safety
Ion Exchange and Solvent Extraction
Mel Schwartz, Consultant, Clearwater, Florida, USA
Edited by Arup K. SenGupta, Lehigh University, Bethlehem, Pennsylvania, USA
With contributions from a panel of experts from industry, government, and academia, this volume is a practical guide to the latest innovations in materials processing and fabrication. It examines current and developing processes in the aerospace, industrial, commercial, military, and electronic industries. Coverage for each process describes the testing background, why and where it is being used, applications, potential to replace existing processes, and environmental and safety concerns. The various processes and fabrication methods include friction stir welding, infusion mold technologies, heat treatment processing, plasma brazing, diffusion and adhesive bonding, and laser processes. CRC Press «Market: Material Science December 2010: 235x156: 787pp Hb: 978-1-4200-8215-9: £99.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-8216-6: £99.00/17
Introduction to Fluorescence
Informatics in Radiation Oncology Edited by Bruce H. Curran, Rhode Island Hospital/Brown University, Providence, USA and George Starkschall, The University of Texas, Houston, USA Series: Imaging in Medical Diagnosis and Therapy A complete overview of the subject, this book discusses the role of information in the process of radiation oncology, acquisition, communication, and display of data; infrastructure requirements; and the use of data in clinical evaluation and research. It describes essential informatics tools, including various imaging techniques and image management systems, treatment planning systems, radiation oncology management systems, and the electronic medical record. Expert contributors explain how to obtain imaging and other diagnostic information as well as treatment prescriptions, treatment setup and delivery data, and outcome reviews.
David M. Jameson, University of Hawaii, Manoa, USA A concise introduction to fundamental principles, this book presents the most important aspects of fluorescence spectroscopy, particularly as they are applied to biology, biochemistry, and biophysics. The author focuses on the essential aspects of fluorescence to encourage readers to design experiments, begin their own fluorescence measurements, and access the literature with greater comprehension. After a general definition of the field and an overview of the nature of light and absorption by biomolecules, the text covers instrumentation, emission spectra, excitation spectra, polarization, anisotropy, quenching, timeresolved methods, and FRET. Taylor & Francis «Market: Material Science March 2011: 235x156: 200pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0604-3: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0605-0: £49.99/17
A Series of Advances, Volume 20
Series: Ion Exchange and Solvent Extraction Series Over the past four decades, many scientists have made notable advances in both the theory and application of ion exchange. Pioneers continue to break new ground by synthesizing novel materials and creating interdisciplinary connections across science and engineering. The seven chapters assembled in this latest volume reflect contributions from researchers across the globe. This volume testifies to the growth in the field and the synergies it has created with a myriad of scientific endeavors, from decontamination to deionization, mining to microelectronics, and drug delivery to desalination, to name just a few. CRC Press «Market: Material Science February 2011: 229x152: 430pp Hb: 978-1-4398-5539-3: £127.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-5540-9: £127.00/17
Materials Science of DNA Edited by Jung-II Jin, Korea University, Seoul As interest continues to grow, DNA is expected to occupy the central position in nanobiotechnology because of its structural and chemical characteristics. With chapters written by experts in their respective fields, this text is the first to address the materials science facet of DNA and chiefly focuses on the rapidly growing fields of nanoscience, nanotechnology, and biotechnology. It includes tables, graphs, equations, and an ancillary CD-ROM to provide understanding of DNA and the high potential of this biopolymer as advanced material. CRC Press «Market: Material Science June 2011: 235x156: 344pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2741-3: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2742-0: £76.99/17
Medical Equipment Management Keith Willson, Imperial College, UK, Keith Ison and Slavik Tabakov, both at King’s College London, UK
CRC Press «Market: Physics April 2011: 235x156: 450pp Hb: 978-1-4398-2582-2: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2583-9: £95.00/17
Series: Series in Medical Physics and Biomedical Engineering Offering insight into the problems and challenges of managing medical equipment within a healthcare system, this book helps readers develop an understanding of the business process and increase awareness of how maintenance of equipment is influenced by its design. It details the equipment management process: demonstration of need, funding, procurement, acceptance testing, asset register maintenance, user training and support, routine and breakdown maintenance, risk management, disinfection, incident reporting, device modifications and trials, and condemning and safe disposal of equipment.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
CRC Press «Market: Physics March 2011: 235x156: 288pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9958-4: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9959-1: £49.99/17
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
physics, chemistry & materials science 311 Metallic Systems
Multifunctional Polymer Nanocomposites
A QuantumChemists Perspective Edited by Orkid Coskuner, Thomas Allison and Carlos A. Gonzalez, both at NIST, Gaithersburg, USA Metal atoms produce a rich chemistry with unique properties and are of considerable interest in academic, government, commercial and regulatory sectors. Although there is considerable literature documenting the use of quantum chemistry calculations in the study of metallic systems, there are few books that collect and present this information in a comprehensive format. This volume focuses on state-of-the-art quantum chemical methodologies, emphasizing application to a wide variety of chemical systems containing metal atoms. The book explains the theory underpinning the methodologies, presents a practical set of modalities for studying metallic systems, assesses the current technological barriers, and examines future challenges and possibilities. CRC Press «Market: General Chemistry February 2011: 235x156: 608pp Hb: 978-1-4200-6077-5: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-6086-7: £95.00/17
Nanosensors
Edited by Jinsong Leng, Harbin Institute of Technology, People’s Republic of China and Alan Kin-tak Lau, University of Southern Queensland, Australia and The Hong Kong Polytechnic University, Kowloon A broad overview of multifunctional polymer nanocomposites, this book provides a systematic investigation of the topic. It brings to light their importance and the applications they offer. The book also examines new materials from the point of view of architects, interior designers, and designers, encouraging people to examine a new technology more closely, both critically and enthusiastically. This book is quite possibly the first of its kind to provide detailed and systemic progress on polymer nanocomposites from the multifunctional profile. CRC Press «Market: Material Science December 2010: 235x156: 462pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1682-0: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1683-7: £95.00/17
Design and Manufacture Michael Schaub, Schaub Optical, LLC, Jim Schwiegerling, University of Arizona, Tucson, USA, Eric Fest, Raytheon Missile Systems, Tucson, Arizona, USA, R. Hamilton Shepard, FLIR Systems, North Billerica, Massachusetts, USA and Alan Symmons, Light Path Technologies, Orlando, Florida, USA Series: Series in Optics and Optoelectronics Molded optical components allow for more costeffective production methods, mass production, and the creation of unique systems; this is all particularly true for the rapidly growing area of plastic optical systems and components. Written by recognized experts in molded and plastic optics from both academia and industry, this book provides an overview of the design and manufacture of molded glass and plastic optics. It presents a detailed discussion of the topics and issues involved in the design and manufacture of such elements and systems. The book covers such topics as optical design, visual optics, colorimetry, stray light, and molded infrared optics.
Edited by Teik-Cheng Lim, School of Science and Technology SIM University, Singapore Nanosensors, sensing devices with at least one sensing dimension less than 100nm, have become instrumental for monitoring physical and chemical phenomena, detecting biochemicals in cellular organelles, and measuring nanoscopic particles in industrial processes. This book provides a guide to nanosensors. Inspired by his own experience with nanofiber-based gas sensors, the author explains the principles and applications of nanosensors for industry, healthcare, and defense. Each chapter presents an overview of the specific type of nanosensor and then describes the fundamental science that forms the basis of the sensing mechanism, fabrication techniques, and the specific nanosensor’s detection. CRC Press «Market: Material Science December 2010: 235x156: 336pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0736-1: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0737-8: £76.99/17
Nanopatterning Materials Using DNA
Molded Optics
Theory and Applications in Industry, Healthcare and Defense
Edited by Hanadi F. Sleiman, McGill University, Montreal, Quebec, Canada and Hao Yan, Arizona State University, Tempe, USA
textbook
Optics for Engineers Charles A. Dimarzio, Northeastern University, Boston, Massachusetts, USA
A central challenge in nanoscience is how to achieve the precise organization of materials into deliberately designed patterns to create tailor-made functions. The biological polymer DNA has recently emerged as a promising template to achieve this goal, making DNA nanotechnology a vibrant area of research. This book features contributions from leading experts in DNA nanotechnology who outline the current state of the art as well as existing and future applications of this important field. The text helps the general scientific community learn DNAbased nanopatterning, one of the most promising bottom-up strategies in nanotechnology.
The increased importance of the field of optics has increased the need for engineers to understand its fundamental principles. Designed specifically for this purpose, this book present the underlying concepts and their applications for engineers who need a practical understanding of how the basic principles of optics affect design decisions. The two main sections cover geometric optics and physical optics. The author includes numerous problems drawn from his extensive experience in the design of laser radars, optical sensors, microscopes, and other optical devices and systems. These practical examples help readers connect the fundamentals with real world applications.
CRC Press «Market: Material Science January 2012: 235x156: 352pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1329-4: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1331-7: £76.99/17
CRC Press «Market: Physics February 2011: 254x178: 450pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0725-5: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0726-2: £57.99/17
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
CRC Press «Market: Physics March 2011: 235x156: 256pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3256-1: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3258-5: £82.00/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
312 physics, chemistry & materials science Polymers for Vascular and Urinogenital Applications
Polyurethane Shape-Memory Polymers
Resistive, Capacitive, and Inductive Based Sensing Technologies
Edited by Shalaby W. Shalaby, Poly-Med Inc., Anderson, South Carolina, USA and Karen J.L. Burg, Clemson University, Clemson, South Carolina, USA
W.M. Huang, Nanyang Techological University, Nanyang, Singapore and Yang Bin, Helvoet Rubber & Plastic Technologies Pte Ltd., Singapore
Winncy Du, San Jose State University, California, USA
CRC Press «Market: Material Science March 2011: 235x156: 280pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7694-3: £99.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7695-0: £99.00/17
CRC Press «Market: Material Science March 2011: 235x156: 296pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3800-6: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3801-3: £82.00/17
Quantum Optical Networks
2nd Edition textbook
Physics of Continuous Matter Exotic and Everyday Phenomena in the Macroscopic World Benny Lautrup, University of Copenhagen, Denmark Assuming only a basic knowledge of Newtonian mechanics, this textbook provides a unified, comprehensive, and coherent introduction to continuum mechanics from a modern perspective. It presents in-depth discussions of important topics, such as local thermodynamic equilibrium, existing models of turbulence, basic magnetohydrodrnamics, tsunamis, and explosions. With updated problems and solutions, this second edition features two new chapters addressing large-amplitude surface waves and aerodynamic theory. All online material – Mathematica® programs, images, additional problems, and brief biographies – have also been updated.
Igor Jex, FNSPE Czech Technical University, Czech Republic, Erika E. Andersson, Heriot-Watt University, UK and Tamas Kiss, Research Institute for Solid State Physics & Optics, Budapest, Hungary Series: Series in Optics and Optoelectronics In light of the growing interest in quantum and optical computing, this is one of the first books to bring together the various theoretical considerations in the area and provide a detailed exposé of the fundamental physics needed to work in the area. Written by leading researchers, the book covers the physics of linear optical elements, which are essential in the interface of quantum optics and quantum information processing. It also looks at experimental systems and applications in quantum computing and information theory. Chapman and Hall/CRC «Market: Physics March 2011: 235x156: 275pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9449-7: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9450-3: £63.99/17
CRC Press «Market: Physics February 2011: 279x216: 660pp Hb: 978-1-4200-7700-1: £36.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-7702-5: £36.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-75030-752-9
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
Series: Series in Sensors Based on design principles and exploited physical phenomena, this book presents a new approach to sensors and sensing technologies. The author discusses numerous modern sensor technologies and examines their applications in various industries. After reviewing the necessary physics, each subsequent chapter describes a range of sensors exploiting these phenomena – including a spectrum of applications – giving greater insight into the functioning and applications of the sensors. The text covers electronic circuitry, signal analysis, and material and manufacturing methods. It also includes problems, worked examples, exercises, and solutions. CRC Press «Market: Physics March 2011: 235x156: 275pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1244-0: £57.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1249-5: £57.99/17
Self-assembled Structures Properties and Applications in Solution and on Surfaces Edited by Jingcheng Hao, Shandong University, China Self-assembly is a process in which a disordered system forms an organized structure without external direction. Examples include the formation of molecular crystals, lipid bilayers, and polymer brushes. This book reviews the fabrication and use of various self-assembled materials. In particular, the author pays special attention to self-assembled structures when in solution and in contact with surfaces, as such interactions can have a pronounced impact on their properties and applications. The text covers bulk solution and surfaces, assembled structures, colloid particles, polymer capsules, carbon nanotubes, as well as layer-by-layer assembly techniques. CRC Press «Market: Material Science December 2010: 235x156: 304pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4083-2: £89.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4084-9: £89.00/17
çè
In a carefully crafted, multidisciplinary, skillfully focused format, this book covers attributes of polymers used for vascular, urological, and gynecological materials. It provides a brief analysis of how the use of polymers in vascular and urogenital applications has evolved in the past five decades and outlines their common and specific functional requirements. It features small, readable monographs that provide a brief description of the evolving role of a particular material, and present topics in highly integrated, well-balanced, authoritatively prepared segments on material, processing, in vitro and in vivo evaluation complete with case studies.
As an important member of the smart materials family, shape memory polymers have attracted serious attention as a result of their ability to recover their original shape after having a stimulus applied to them. From their history to the most recent developments, this book provides the full story of polyurethane-based shape memory polymers, including discussion of thermomechanical properties and behavior of the polymer and its composites. Next, it addresses the modification of the shape memory polymer and introduces novel actuation mechanisms. Finally, the author presents a spectrum of state-of-the-art and potential applications of this material and its composites.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
physics, chemistry & materials science 313 Self-Organizing Liquid Crystal Materials
Surfactants in Tribology, 2 Volume Set
Synthesis, Tactics and Mechanisms
Edited by Girma Biresaw, USDA, ARS, NCAUR, CPF, Peoria, Illinois, USA and Kash Mittal, USDA, Peoria, Illinois, USA
Alexander J. Seed, Kent State University, Ohio, USA Series: Liquid Crystals Book Series Aimed at liquid crystal researchers in synthetic chemistry, as well as graduate students studying related areas or research requiring similar protocols, this resource provides an in-depth overview of the tactics and the strategies that are required to synthesize liquid crystals and other materials. The book gathers currently scattered information into a single source to inform those researchers new to the process or those that are trying to synthesize a different type of liquid crystal. This text covers the preparation of all known ring systems, the tactics of synthetic approaches, and key organic reaction mechanisms used in the preparation of self-organizing materials. CRC Press «Market: General Chemistry June 2011: 235x156: 320pp Hb: 978-0-8493-7609-2: £99.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-0786-2: £99.00/17
Tutorials in Metamaterials
Surfactants play a critical role in tribology as they control friction, wear, and lubricant properties such as emulsification, demulsification, bioresistance, oxidation resistance, rust prevention, and corrosion resistance. The use of surfactants in tribology is a critical topic for scientists and engineers who are developing new materials and devices, in particular those built at the nanoscale. Edited by a well-known and respected leader in the field, this two-volume set features renowned international contributors who review the latest advances in the tribological aspects of microdevices and nanodevices, including MEMS, NEMS, biosurfactants, biolubricants, and bioemulsions. CRC Press «Market: General Chemistry February 2011: 235x156: 960pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4090-0: £229.00/17
Surfactants in Tribology, Volume 2 Edited by Girma Biresaw, USDA, ARS, NCAUR, CPF, Peoria, Illinois, USA and Kash Mittal, USDA, Peoria, Illinois, USA
Silicon Photonics for Telecommunications and Biomedicine Edited by Sasan Fathpour, University of Central Florida, Orlando, USA and Bahram Jalali, University of California, Los Angeles, USA Focusing on the important obstacles to be met in order to make silicon photonics a viable commercial reality, this book provide a concise introduction to major developments in the field. Worldwide experts provide clear explanations of the fundamentals and state-of-the-art approaches. After a historical review, the text discusses the critical areas of silicon wire waveguides and optical parametric effects in silicon, stress and piezoelectric tuning of silicon’s optical properties, and short pulse techniques in silicon photonics. It also addresses silicon-based optical resonators, mid-wavelength infrared applications, growth techniques, hybrid lasers on silicon, and energy harvesting.
Surfactants play a critical role in tribology, as they control friction, wear, and lubricant properties such as emulsification, demulsification, bioresistance, oxidation resistance, rust prevention, and corrosion resistance. Surfactants are a crucial topic for scientists and engineers who are developing new materials and devices, in particular those built at the nanoscale. Edited by a well-known and respected leader in the field, Volume Two of this set focuses on the emerging area of biosurfactants, biolubricants, and bioemulsions. It also covers essential new developments in the more traditional tribology areas.
Edited by Mikhail A. Noginov, Norfolk State University, Norfolk, Virginia, USA and Viktor A. Podolskiy, Oregon State University, Corvallis, Oregon, USA A comprehensive introduction to electromagnetism in metamaterials structures, this begins with an overview followed by coverage of the major challenges of improving fabrication approaches. Each chapter offers a tutorial on a specific metamaterials system, ranging from plasmonics and active systems to negative refraction and photonic crystals. Every tutorial provides a thorough treatment of basic theory, computer simulations, fabrication, and experimental studies of the physical properties. The light interaction with metallic nanostructures, theory and applications of negative refraction systems, chiral metamaterials, and anitostopic metamaterials. The final chapters focus on microwave applications of metamaterials and photonic crystals research. CRC Press «Market: Material Science March 2011: 235x156: 300pp Hb: 978-1-4200-9218-9: £49.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-9219-6: £49.99/17
2nd Edition
The Color of Metal Compounds Adam Bartecki, University of Technology, Wroclaw, Poland, John Burgess, University of Leicester, UK and Krzysztof Kurzak, University of Opole, Poland CRC Press «Market: General Chemistry January 2012: 235x156: 392pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3900-3: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4026-9: £95.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-9-0569-9250-7
CRC Press «Market: General Chemistry February 2011: 235x156: 480pp Hb: 978-1-4398-4064-1: £127.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-4065-8: £127.00/17
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
CRC Press March 2011: 235x156: 300pp Hb: 978-1-4398-0637-1: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-0638-8: £63.99/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
314 water management and technology 3rd Edition
2nd Edition
Biological Wastewater Treatment Practical Handbook for Wetland C.P. Leslie Grady, Jr., Clemson University, South Carolina, Identification and Delineation USA, Glen T. Daigger, CH2M Hill, Englewood, Colorado, USA, Nancy G. Love, University of Michigan, Ann Arbor, USA and Carlos D. M. Filipe, McMaster University, Canada
John G. Lyon and Lynn Krise Lyon, both at Clifton, Virginia, USA
Written by experts in the field, this thoroughly updated third edition covers commonly used and emerging suspended and attached growth reactors. Drawing on their extensive academic and industrial experience, the authors discuss combined carbon and ammonia oxidation, activated sludge, biological nutrient removal, aerobic digestion, anaerobic processes, lagoons, trickling filters, rotating biological contactors, fluidized beds, and biologically aerated filters. They integrate the principles of biochemical processes with applications in the real world, communicating approaches to the conception, design, operation, and optimization of biochemical unit operations in a comprehensive, yet lucid manner.
Series: Mapping Science
CRC Press «Market: Environmental Engineering April 2011: 254x178: 1064pp Hb: 978-0-8493-9679-3: £95.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-0963-7: £95.00/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8247-8919-0
CRC Press «Market: Water Science / Technology and Engineering March 2011: 235x156: 220pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3891-4: £76.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3892-1: £76.99/17 Prev. Ed: 978-0-8737-1590-4
From Water Scarcity to Sustainable Water Use in the West Bank, Palestine
Urban Water Conflicts *
Dima Wadi Nazer, UNESCO-IHE Institute for Water Education, Delft, the Netherlands
Series: Urban Water Series
UNESCO-IHP Bernard Barraque, CNRS, LATTS – Ecole Nationale des Ponts et Chaussées, France
Water scarcity is increasing all over the world because of growing population and increasing demands. Countries with limited water resources are urgently in need for a new approach towards water management by shifting from the ‘use and dispose’ approach to the ‘use, treat and reuse’ approach. The book proposes a framework for the sustainable management of scarce water resources. The approach is based on the application of Cleaner Production thinking to water management and is particularly focusing on the West Bank, Palestine.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
With the changing nature of urban water conflicts, there is an urgent need for a solid foundation of conflict solution guidelines. Presenting several historical urban water conflicts cases, this overview presents the nature of conflicts, either technological, economic, political or social, with a comparative approach to water services provision. It moreover provides a theoretical analysis of urban water conflicts with an ecological-economic approach. Intended to illustrate and develop urban water conflict solution guidelines, supported by history, geography, policital science, sociology, anthropology, law and economics. Includes case studies from Spain, USA, Portugal, Brazil, Argentina, Mexico, South Africa, Sub-Saharan Africa, Indonesia, India, Italy and Germany. Taylor & Francis «Market: Civil & Environmental Engineering / Water / Urban Water March 2011: 246x174: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-49862-3: £63.99/17 Pb: 978-0-415-49863-0: £31.99/17 eBook: 978-0-203-87702-9: £63.99/17
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Selected Contents: Introduction 2. Water footprint of the Palestinians in the West Bank 3. Financial, environmental and social evaluation of water mangement options 4. Optimizing irrigation water use 5. Saving water and reducing pollution in the unhairing-liming process in the leather industry 6. A strategy for sustainable water management in the West Bank, Palestine 7. Conclusions and recommendations CRC Press «Market: Water Sciences October 2010: 246x174: 170pp Pb: 978-0-415-57381-8: £44.99/17
This new edition of a bestseller further defines wetlands, describes their functions, and presents a variety of methods used to assess the extent of wetlands. It offers solutions to real-world problems and covers important subjects such as methods for identifying and delineating wetland boundaries and evaluating wetlands using aerial photography. It covers indicators of hydrological, chemical, and biological processes and information on soil surveys and plant measurements. Fully revised, this new edition has added content in the areas of wetland regulation and permitting, legal considerations, and includes updated mapping and surveying techniques.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
water management and technology 315 textbook
Groundwater Hydrology Engineering, Planning, and Management Mohammad Karamouz, Polytechnic Institute of New York University, Brooklyn, USA, Azadeh Ahmadi, Isfahan University of Technology, Iran and Masih Akhbari, Colorado State University, Fort Collins, USA Written by an internationally respected professor and consultant, this textbook provides a balanced treatment of theory and practice. It examines the interface between groundwater engineering and management with tools such as data collection, simulation modeling, and economic analysis. The chapters contain the latest developments in groundwater engineering and planning. The author presents relevant modeling software applications for numerous topics including hydrology, hydraulics, planning and management, conjunctive use, and climate change implications. The book includes figures, tables, and equations as well as examples, end of chapter questions, and case studies.
Advanced Simulation and Modelling for Urban Groundwater Management – UGROW UGROW - An Advanced Simulation and Modelling Tool Edited by Dubravka Pokrajac, University of Aberdeen, Scotland, UK and Ken W.F. Howard, University of Toronto, Ontario, Canada Series: Urban Water Series UGROW (UrbanGROundWater) represents one of the most advanced urban water management tools produced to date and fully integrates all urban water system components including groundwater. It will raise the awareness of the interaction between urban water system components, support management decision-making, and solve a wide range of urban water problems. The UGROW model has a sound scientific basis, is computationally efficient, and supported by outstanding graphics. Includes UGROW software CD-ROM and instruction manual.
CRC Press «Market: Water Science / Technology and Engineering March 2011: 235x156: 712pp Hb: 978-1-4398-3756-6: £63.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-3757-3: £63.99/17
Selected Contents: Preface; 1. Challenges in urban groundwater modeling 2. UGROW – the Urban GROundWater modeling system 3. UGROW applications – case studies 4. Conclusions; Appendix: UGROW instructions manual. UGROW CD-ROM Taylor & Francis «Market: Civil & Environmental Engineering / Water / Urban Water October 2010: 246x174: 280pp Hb: 978-0-415-45354-7: £63.99/17 Pb: 978-0-415-45355-4: £31.99/17
Operations in Food Refrigeration
Urban Storm Water Management for Practitioners
Rodolfo H. Mascheroni, CIDCA National University of La Plata, Argentina
Hormoz Pazwash, Boswell Engineering, South Hackensack, New Jersey, USA
Series: Contemporary Food Engineering
This book covers all aspects of storm water management. Numerous examples provide every hydrologic and hydraulic calculation involved in storm water management. The text also contains case studies that illustrate the methods and procedures for designing extended detention basins, infiltration basins, and underground retention/infiltration basins.
A new addition to the Contemporary Food Engineering Series, this resource provides professionals in the food industry with a thorough overview of issues involved in heat and mass transfer in refrigeration and freezing. In addition to covering the application of critical principles to the design and operation of equipment, this highly practical text also covers quality issues related to maintaining the most adequate operation conditions for a wide variety of processed foods. To this end, it includes tools to calculate process times and to assist with selecting the most efficient and cost effective industrial equipment as well as the best operation conditions.
CRC Press «Market: Environmental Engineering February 2011: 254x178: 584pp Hb: 978-1-4398-1035-4: £82.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-1036-1: £82.00/17
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
CRC Press «Market: Water Science / Technology and Engineering March 2011: 235x156: 376pp Hb: 978-1-4200-5548-1: £108.00/17 eBook: 978-1-4200-5551-1: £108.00/17
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
316 library reference
A Dictionary of International Relations *
IBSS: Economics: 2009 Vol.58 International Bibliography of the Social Sciences
Edited by George Kurian A Dictionary of International Relations is a comprehensive glossary of terms, issues, ideas, events, doctrines and policies relating to international relations in modern history since 1815. It covers over 500 nations (including 300 that have disappeared from history), the great and small wars that have punctuated modern history and the terms and ideas that have driven the tides of change, war and peace. This title also provides analysis of the alliances marking the rise and fall of great powers, the revolutions and regime changes, the growth and eventual disappearance of colonialism, the rise of globalism and globalization, and the social, political, cultural and technological changes that have heralded the end of modern history and the beginning of post-modern history. Routledge «Market: International Studies / Reference March 2011: 234x156: 450pp Hb: 978-1-85743-544-3: £190.00/16
This Handbook aims to give an overview of India’s international relations, given the development of India as a major economic power in the world, and the growing interest in the impact of Asia on the international system in the future. Edited by David Scott of Brunel University, and with chapters written by a variety of experts, the Handbook of India’s International Relations offers an up-to-date, unbiased and comprehensive resource to academics, students of international relations, business people, media professionals and the general reader.
Routledge «Market: Economics October 2010: 234x156: 696pp Hb: 978-0-415-59925-2: £325.00/12
Edited by Paul van den Noord and István P. Székely, both at The Economic and Financial Affairs Directorate-General of the European Commission The European economy is emerging from its deepest recession since the 1930s. This volume, which brings together economic analysis from the European Commission services, explains how swift policy response avoided a financial meltdown. Europe also needs an improved coordinated crisis-management framework to help it respond to any similar situations that may arise in the future. Economic Crisis in Europe is a much-anticipated volume which shows that the beginnings of such a crisis-management framework are emerging, building on existing institutions and legislation and complemented by new initiatives. Routledge «Market: Economics / European Studies February 2011: 246x174: 200pp Hb: 978-92-79-15363-1: £75.00/16
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
( +44 (0)1235 400524
The International Bibliography of the Social Sciences (Anthropology, Economics, Political Science, and Sociology) is a major bibliographic reference for academics, librarians and students.
Causes, Consequences and Responses
Edited by David Scott, Brunel University, UK
order now!
Series: IBSS Economics
Economic Crisis in Europe
Handbook of India’s International Relations
Routledge «Market: International Studies / Asian Studies / Reference February 2011: 246x174: 450pp Hb: 978-1-85743-552-8: £125.00/16
Edited by Compiled by the British Library of Political and Economic Science
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
library reference 317
Perspectives on Information Edited by Magnus Ramage and David Chapman, both at The Open University, UK Series: Routledge Studies in Library and Information Science The importance of information has been appreciated differently across many academic disciplines, and it is treated in different ways. There are many disciplines (including information and communication technologies, quantum physics, information systems, library and information science, and the sociology of the information society) for which information is foundational. Perspectives on Information both reflects the diversity of understanding of information within the disciplines, and brings clarity and coherence to the different perspectives through promoting information as a unifying concept across the disciplinary spectrum. Drawing from an unusually broad range of fields, each contributor presents an insider’s perspective on information. Routledge «Market: Information Science April 2011: 229x152: 144pp Hb: 978-0-415-88410-5: £70.00/08
The European Union and Global Governance * A Handbook Edited by Dr Jens-Uwe Wunderlich, Aston University, UK and David J. Bailey The European Union and Global Governance: A Handbook analyzes contemporary debates in European Studies in order to provide lessons for the development, design and normative evaluation of global governance. It brings together scholars of European Studies and International Relations, where much of the literature on regional and global governance is located, thereby providing interdisciplinary lessons from the study of the European Union and its governance that can be used to re-evaluate processes of global governance. Each chapter examines methodological, theoretical or empirical discussions within European Studies in order to draw insights into current developments in global governance. Routledge «Market: European Studies / Politics / Reference December 2010: 246x174: 300pp Hb: 978-1-85743-509-2: £150.00/16 eBook: 978-0-203-85050-3: £150.00/16
12th Edition
Territories of the Russian Federation 2011
13th Edition
Edited by Europa Publications
The International Who’s Who in Popular Music 2011
Series: Territories of the Russian Federation
Edited by Europa Publications
This excellent reference source brings together hard-to-find information on eighty-nine constituent uints of the Russian Federation. The introduction examines the Russian Federation as a whole, boasting an essay written by an acknowledged expert focusing on the evolution of the relationship between the central state and the regions, followed by a chronology, demographic and economic statistics, and a review of the Federal Government. The second section comprises detailed territorial surveys, with a chapter on each of Russia’s federal subjects, each of which includes a current map. The third and fourth parts comprise a select bibliography of books and indexes, listing the territories alphabetically, with a gazetteer of alternative names, covering both the Federal Okrug and the Economic Area.
Series: The International Who’s Who in Popular Music
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Routledge «Market: Music Studies / Reference March 2011: 279x211: 672pp Hb: 978-1-85743-599-3: £250.00/16
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: European Studies / Russian and Soviet Politics February 2011: 234x156: 348pp Hb: 978-1-85743-598-6: £190.00/16
The International Who’s Who in Popular Music 2011 provides biographical details on some of the most talented and influential artists and individuals from the world of popular music. Now in its thirteenth edition, it includes over 7,000 biographies charting the careers and achievements of pop, rock, folk, jazz, dance, world and country artists throughout the world. Each entry includes full biographical information on principal career details, recordings and compositions, honours and contact information.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
318 library reference 2nd Edition
27th Edition
The International Who’s Who in Classical/Popular Music Set 2011
International Who’s Who in Classical Music 2011
Edited by Europa Publications
Edited by Europa Publications
Combining The International Who’s Who in Classical Music 2011 and The International Who’s Who in Popular Music 2011, this two-volume set provides a complete view of the whole of the music world. Within The International Who’s Who in Classical Music, each biographical entry comprises personal information, principal career details, repertoire, recordings and compositions, and full contact details where available. Appendices provide contact details for national orchestras, opera companies, music festivals, music organizations and major competitions and awards. The International Who’s Who in Popular Music 2011 boasts detailed entries, including full biographical information, such as principal career details, recordings and compositions, honours and contact information.
Series: International Who’s Who in Classical Music
Routledge «Market: Music Studies / Reference March 2011: 279x211: 1960pp Hb: 978-1-85743-609-9: £445.00/16
The International Who’s Who in Classical Music 2011 is an unparalleled source of biographical information on singers, instrumentalists, composers, conductors and managers. The directory section lists orchestras, opera companies and other institutions connected with the classical music world. Each biographical entry comprises personal information, principal career details, repertoire, recordings and compositions, and full contact details where available. Appendices provide contact details for national orchestras, opera companies, music festivals, music organizations and major competitions and awards. Routledge «Market: Music Studies / Reference March 2011: 279x211: 992pp Hb: 978-1-85743-608-2: £275.00/16
2nd Edition
The Military Balance 2011
Scientists Must Speak *
Iiss Series: The Military Balance
D. Eric Walters and Gale C. Walters, both at The Chicago Medical School, North Chicago, USA
The Military Balance is The International Institute for Strategic Studies’ annual assessment of the military capabilities and defence economics of 170 countries worldwide. It is an essential resource for those involved in security policy making, analysis and research. The book is a region-by-region analysis of the major military and economic developments affecting defence and security policies, and the trade in weapons and other military equipment. Comprehensive tables detail major military training activities, UN and non-UN deployments, and give data on key equipment holdings and defence expenditure trends over a ten year period.
Having the ability to speak confidently; engage the audience; make a clear, well-argued case; and handle any tricky situations, is rarely a natural talent, and standing before an inquisitive audience or board can be a stressful experience. Scientists Must Speak: Bringing Presentations to Life helps readers do just that. The book addresses such topics as using visual aids, voice and body language, adapting material, question and answer sessions, and more. Written by authors with many years’ experience of teaching presentation techniques, this engaging text will help readers make the best of their presentations and remove some of the fear that makes them a daunting prospect.
Routledge «Market: Military Studies / Reference February 2011: 246x174: 488pp Pb: 978-1-85743-606-8: £255.00/16
CRC Press December 2010: 216x140: 158pp Pb: 978-1-4398-2603-4: £15.99/17 eBook: 978-1-4398-2604-1: £15.99/17
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
2nd Edition
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
library reference 319
11-VOLUME set
G.D.H. Cole: Selected Works * Edited by Noel Thompson, University of Swansea, UK G.D.H. Cole was one of the foremost British socialist thinkers of the twentieth century. His literary output was immense and encompassed works of social theory, economics, political economy, economic history, social and labour history, political theory, history of thought and sociology. The books and pamphlets chosen for this edition are amongst his most significant. They are representative of the different phases of his thinking and illustrative of an acute and inquiring socialist mind as it wrestled with the formidable political and intellect challenges confronted by socialists in this most turbulent of centuries. Routledge «Market: Politics November 2010: 234x156: 15884pp Set: 978-0-415-56651-3: £795.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83931-7: £795.00/14
Attempts at General Union G.D.H. Cole This volume traces the attempts made after the Napoleonic Wars to link up all the numerous local and sectional Trade Societies into a single comprehensive ‘General Trades Union’ – attempts which culminated in the short-lived Grand National Consolidated Trades Union formed under Robert Owen’s influence in 1833. Based on materials not previously used by historians, this book throws new light on the development of Trade Unionism, particularly in the North of England, during these critical years. Routledge «Market: Politics November 2010: 234x156: 232pp Hb: 978-0-415-59843-9: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83951-5: £70.00/14
Economic Tracts for the Times G.D.H. Cole Originally written as a series of pamphlets and at a time of high unemployment, this volume discusses free trade, monetary policy, wages and employment, economic theory and social legislation.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Edited by Noel Thompson, University of Wales, UK This set re-issues ten works of the well-known socialist thinker G.D.H. Cole and one volume of collected pamphlets, originally published between 1913 and 1965. A substantial introduction by Noel Thompson places the works in their social, political and historical context and illustrates their continued relevance.
Routledge «Market: Politics November 2010: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-59726-5: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83961-4: £70.00/14
Practical Economics G.D.H. Cole This volume compares the planning of economic conditions under the very different political systems of Soviet Russia, Fascist Germany and Italy and Democratic America, with some discussion of partial economic planning in Great Britain. It includes a broad survey of the successive phases of the Five Year Plans in the Soviet Union, the ‘New Deal’ in the United States, and the diversion of the German economic activity to war preparation under the Nazi Four Year Plan. The author discusses the essential conditions for successful economic planning. Routledge «Market: Politics November 2010: 234x156: 264pp Hb: 978-0-415-59840-8: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83954-6: £70.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Politics November 2010: 234x156: 344pp Hb: 978-0-415-59838-5: £80.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83955-3: £80.00/14
G.D.H. Cole: Early Pamphlets & Assessment
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
320 library reference
Guild Socialism Restated
Socialist Economics
G.D.H. Cole
G.D.H. Cole
Guild Socialism Restated is G.D.H. Cole’s fullest and most systematic account of his vision of industrial and political reorganization. The introductory chapters of the volume develop the theme of democratic citizenship in relation to industrial society. Cole contends that neither capitalism nor state socialism can adequately meet the fundamental requirements of democracy because neither provides institutions through which active citizenship can be achieved. He insists that the latter can only be realized in the realm of industrial relations. The central chapters of the book develop a view of socialist organization in which citizenship is a vital ingredient in every arena – from that of the workplace to national policymaking. Routledge «Market: Politics November 2010: 234x156: 222pp Hb: 978-0-415-59820-0: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83958-4: £70.00/14
This volume sets forth as simply as possible the theoretical foundations which underlie the practical policies of democratic Socialism. This involves both a repudiation and a refutation of the assumptions of the older classical economists who believed in laissez-faire, and a careful differentiation of the economics of democratic Socialism from the neo-classical doctrines associated with the name of Maynard Keynes.
Routledge «Market: Politics November 2010: 234x156: 160pp Hb: 978-0-415-59842-2: £60.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83952-2: £60.00/14
Self-Government in Industry
The Life of William Cobbett
G.D.H. Cole
G.D.H. Cole This book represents an important stage in the development of an indigenous theory. The argument is presented with the special qualities of cogency and perception which have given the author a lasting influence within the labour movement.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Routledge «Market: Politics November 2010: 234x156: 480pp Hb: 978-0-415-59834-7: £90.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83957-7: £90.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Politics November 2010: 234x156: 352pp Hb: 978-0-415-59730-2: £80.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83960-7: £80.00/14
This volume is representative of the historical works of a particular period (1923–29) when there was a hiatus in the output of Cole the theoretician. It is an extraordinary contribution to labour history and is among the finest of his historical works.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
library reference 321
The Meaning of Marxism
The World of Labour
G.D.H. Cole
G.D.H. Cole This book is largely based on What Marx Really Meant which was written by Cole and published in 1934. It is a revaluation of Marx’s essential ideas and methods in relation to contemporary social structures and developments and considers the bearing of Marx’s theories on the structure of social classes, which altered greatly since he formulated his account of them.
Cole saw the trade unions as being critical to progress, but to realise their role they needed to change and the issue of trade union structure therefore became fundamental. He considered in this volume that trade union structure was a central problem of the labour movement – he described British trade unionism as a movement bereft of ideas and policy. He discusses the evolution in the trade unions to cover not only wages and working conditions but the organisation and control of industry. Routledge «Market: Politics November 2010: 234x156: 480pp Hb: 978-0-415-59728-9: £90.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83959-1: £90.00/14
Routledge «Market: Politics November 2010: 234x156: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-59841-5: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83953-9: £70.00/14
The Next Ten Years G.D.H. Cole This volume was Cole’s first major work of political economy in almost a decade and it effectively positioned him as a mainstream Fabian who sought to stabilize capitalism before progressing socialism by essentially statist means. Influenced by J.A. Hobson and Maynard Keynes the imperative for Cole became the formulation of a strategy which would mitigate the suffering of the masses and lay the basis for socialist advance.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Politics November 2010: 234x156: 496pp Hb: 978-0-415-59836-1: £90.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83956-0: £90.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
322 library reference 5 Volume Set
4 Volume Set
Anthropological Linguistics
Critical Psychology
Theories and Practices
Edited by Ian Parker, Manchester Metropolitan University, UK
Edited by Bambi Schieffelin and Paul Garrett
Series: Critical Concepts in Psychology
Series: Critical Concepts in Language Studies
Viewing language as a dynamic semiotic system that shapes and is shaped by cultural, social and cognitive factors alike, the articles in this new Routledge Major Work explore how people in communities worldwide think about language, talk about language, use language, and change language. The articles illustrate the ways in which language practices are resources that participants use for creating social worlds and accomplishing a wide range of activities. They demonstrate how analysts use linguistic and cultural practices, and the ideologies that shape them, to provide insights into the complexities of everyday, as well as less commonly occurring, social encounters.
Critical psychology has emerged as a vibrant site of research and reflection on the assumptions and practices of its host discipline. In four volumes, Critical Psychology is an accessible database which brings together foundational and the best and most influential cutting-edge materials, including key works produced before the term ‘critical psychology’ gained wide currency but which anticipate approaches now included under that rubric. Selected Contents: Volume I: Dominant Models of Psychology and their Limits Volume II: Contradictions in Psychology and Elements of Resistance Volume III: Psychologization and Psychological Culture Volume IV: Alternatives and Visions for Change
Routledge «Market: Reference and Linguistics December 2010: 234x156: 1778pp Hb: 978-0-415-55178-6: £850.00/11
Routledge «Market: Psychology March 2011: 234x156: 1600pp Hb: 978-0-415-56859-3: £650.00/11
4 Volume Set
4 Volume Set
Book Publishing
Female Journalists of the Fin de Siècle *
Edited by John Feather, Loughborough University, UK Series: Critical Concepts in Media and Cultural Studies
Edited by Lorna Shelley Series: History of Feminism
As serious academic work on and around publishing and the printed book continues to flourish as never before, this new title in the Routledge Major Works series, Critical Concepts in Media and Cultural Studies, meets the need for an authoritative reference work to make sense of a growing and ever more complex corpus of literature, and to provide a map of the area as it has emerged and developed.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Routledge «Market: Women’s History / Gender Studies November 2010: 246x174: 1698pp Hb: 978-0-415-55949-2: £650.00/11
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Selected Contents: Volume I: Concepts and Theories: Issues in Book History Volume II: Publishing and the Book Trade Volume III: Publishers and Authors Volume IV: Printing and Book Production Routledge «Market: Publishing Studies / Librarian and Information Science / Literary Studies / History March 2011: 234x156: 1600pp Hb: 978-0-415-49009-2: £650.00/11
Co-published by Routledge and Edition Synapse, the History of Feminism series makes key archival source material readily available to scholars, researchers, and students of women’s and gender studies, women’s history, and women’s writing, as well as those working in allied and related fields. Selected and introduced by expert editors, the gathered materials are reproduced in facsimile, giving users a strong sense of immediacy to the texts and permitting citation to the original pagination. This new title in the series brings together a unique range of texts published between the 1800s and the early twentieth century different aspects of what it meant to be a female journalist at the turn of the nineteenth century.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
library reference 323 5 Volume Set
4 Volume Set
Higher Education
Islam and Education *
Edited by Malcolm Tight, University of Lancaster, UK
Edited by Tahir Abbas, University of Birmingham, UK
Series: Major Themes in Education
Series: Major Themes in Education
As serious thinking about and around higher education continues to flourish and develop, this new title in Routledge’s Major Themes in Education series meets the need for an authoritative reference work to make sense of the subject’s vast literature and the continuing explosion in research output. Edited by Malcolm Tight, a leading scholar in the field, it is a five-volume collection of foundational and cutting-edge contributions.
Volume I of this new Routledge collection focuses on theories of education. The gathered materials explore and analyze the impact of the classical Islamic period in history and the developments in education which have emanated from it. Volume II focuses on education in Eastern Europe and Muslim Asia, capturing the essential issues in each of the countries studied, and how they vary across a vast region. The impact of culture and modernization on traditional societies, as well as the ways in which westernized modes of education are introduced, and the aspirations of youth are in turn determined. Volume III looks at education in the Middle East and Muslim Africa. Islam has its origins in the Middle East, and today many of the challenges Muslims face in relation to Islam and education are concentrated in this region. Volume IV explores the education of Muslims in North America and Europe, and of minorities in advanced liberal secular democracies.
Selected Contents: Volume I: Teaching, Learning, and Course Design Volume II: The Student Experience Volume III: System Policy Volume IV: Insitutional Management and Quality Volume V: Academic Work, Knowledge and Research Routledge «Market: Education November 2010: 234x156: 2088pp Hb: 978-0-415-49775-6: £875.00/11
4 Volume Set
Islamic Political Thought and Governance * Edited by Abdullah Saeed, University of Melbourne, Australia Series: Critical Concepts in Political Science
Routledge «Market: Religion and Education November 2010: 234x156: 1625pp Hb: 978-0-415-47845-8: £650.00/11
2 Volume Set
John P. Kotter * Edited by John C. Wood Series: Critical Evaluations in Business and Management
Routledge «Market: Politics November 2010: 234x156: 1617pp Hb: 978-0-415-49868-5: £650.00/11
Routledge «Market: Business December 2010: 234x156: 795pp Hb: 978-0-415-32575-2: £325.00/11
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
John P. Kotter (b. 1947), a leading authority on business leadership and change, is the subject of this new collection from Routledge’s acclaimed Critical Evaluations in Business and Management series. It brings together in two volumes the best critical evaluations of his work. The collection is supplemented with the editors’ expert introduction which places the gathered scholarship in its historical and intellectual context.
çè
This new Routledge Major Work is concerned with the development of political thought in Islam. By political thought is meant, broadly, the study and interpretation of Islamic political culture, ideas, beliefs and institutions; the contribution of key political theorists and authorities to the understanding or practice of governance; what people and groups believed about political authority and institutions and their political convictions; and how politics in the Islamic world has related to and interacted with other disciplines, such as religion, law, ethics, philosophy and statehood.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
324 library reference 6 Volume Set
4 Volume Set
Second-Language Acquisition *
Social Psychology
Edited by Lourdes Ortega
Edited by Richard J. Crisp
Series: Critical Concepts in Linguistics
Series: Critical Concepts in Psychology
A six-volume set that offers a wide-encompassing survey of this burgeoning field, its accumulated findings and proposed theories, its developed research paradigms, and its pending questions for the future. The selection documents the impressive progress that SLA has made in its forty years of existence, setting current themes in their historical and intellectual context while at the same time orientating readers to the SLA of the 21st century.
As serious work in social psychology continues to flourish as never before, this new title from Psychology Press meets the need for an authoritative reference work to map and make sense of a vast body of literature and a continuing explosion in research output. Clearly delineating the subdiscipline’s key turning points and critical transitions, Social Psychology will provide users with a new and coherent understanding of the subdiscipline’s evolution. It is an essential resource and is destined to be valued by scholars and students as a vital one-stop research tool.
Routledge «Market: Linguisitics November 2010: 234x156: 2386pp Hb: 978-0-415-45020-1: £975.00/11
Psychology Press «Market: Psychology March 2011: 234x156: 1600pp Hb: 978-0-415-49940-8: £650.00/11
4 Volume Set
5 Volume Set
Multiculturalism
The Great Depression *
Edited by Gerd Baumann and Steven Vertovec, Max-Planck-Institute, Germany
Edited by Geoffrey E. Wood, City University, UK and Forrest Capie
Series: Critical Concepts in Sociology
Series: Critical Concepts in Economics
Edited by two leading scholars in the field, this new title in Routledge’s Major Works series, Critical Concepts in Sociology, is a four-volume collection of canonical and cutting-edge research. Serious work on multiculturalism flourishes as never before, and this ‘mini library’ meets the need for an authoritative reference work to make sense of the subject’s vast literature and the continuing explosion in research output. Perhaps more than other critical concepts, ‘multiculturalism’ is hotly contested; there are sharply different–and perhaps ultimately irreconcilable–approaches to a variety of multicultural conceptions and projects. Rather than seek to establish some kind of consensus on classic works, this collection explicitly brings together the best and most influential work to have emerged from all sides of the debate.
As research in and around the Great Depression flourishes as never before this new addition to Routledge’s Critical Concepts in Economics series meets the need for an authoritative reference work to make sense of the subject’s vast literature and the continuing explosion in scholarly output. Edited by two leading scholars in the field, this new Routledge Major Work is a five-volume collection of classic and cutting-edge contributions. Routledge «Market: Economic History November 2010: 234x156: 2187pp Hb: 978-0-415-57351-1: £850.00/11
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Sociology / Anthropology / Multiculturalism November 2010: 234x156: 1583pp Hb: 978-0-415-48608-8: £650.00/11
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
library reference 325 4 Volume Set
3 Volume Set
Women and Education *
The Tale of Genji *
Edited by Jane Martin, University of London, UK and Joyce Goodman, University of Winchester, UK
Edited by Richard H. Okada, Princeton University, USA
Series: Major Themes in Education
If a primary objective of feminism is to expose and challenge the social relations of power embedded in all spheres of life, then an exploration of the issues attached to female education is a vital aspect of such a project. Indeed, ‘women and education’ is now an established – and flourishing – domain of study. Edited by two leading scholars in the field, Women and Education is a four-volume collection of foundational and cutting-edge contributions further distinguished by the inclusion of autobiographical works to capture the experience of education as a broad societal process, and not simply as formal schooling. Selected Contents: Volume I: Space, Place, and Time Volume II: Pupils, Students, and Learning Volume III: Teachers and Teaching Volume IV: Politics and Policies Routledge «Market: Education December 2010: 234x156: 1630pp Hb: 978-0-415-54939-4: £650.00/11
4 Volume Set
Politics of Modern Iran Edited by Ali M. Ansari, University of St Andrews, UK Series: Critical Issues in Modern Politics
The monumental Japanese fictional narrative known as The Tale of Genji (Genji monogatari) appeared during the first decade or so of the eleventh century, CE. This vast narrative–which spans three-quarters of a century, and is made up of fifty-four chapters and 795 poems–has been attributed to a woman known only as Murasaki Shikibu. It has often been celebrated as ‘the world’s oldest novel’. The Tale of Genji has generated a huge scholarly literature, and this new collection, co-published by Routledge and Edition Synapse, meets the need for an authoritative reference work to help researchers and students navigate and make sense of it. The collection is made up of three volumes which bring together the best and most influential canonical and cutting-edge research. The first volume (Cultures of Reading The Tale of Genji) assembles the key work in narratology, aesthetics, and poetics. A narrative that can – and has – been read primarily as a ‘romance’ has much to say about the history, culture, and society of its time, and Volume II (Sexual Politics in The Tale of Genji) is organized around often contested themes such as gender, genre, and politics. The scholarship in the final volume (The Tale of Genji and its Others), meanwhile, gathers the best work on topics including Noh, visual art, ‘China’, and later literature. With a comprehensive introduction, newly written by the editor, which places the material in its historical and intellectual context, The Tale of Genji is an essential work of reference and is destined to be valued by scholars and students as a vital one-stop research resource. Routledge «Market: Japanese Literature / Japanese Studies December 2010: 234x156 Hb: 978-0-415-47900-4: £515.00/11
This four volume set brings together for the first time the best articles to be written on the politics of modern Iran. In so doing, the set will be an invaluable source of reference for both scholars and students alike and will allow those developing an interest in Iran to quickly and easily access the highest quality scholarship in the field.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Selected Contents: Volume I: History & Theory Volume II: Politics & History Volume III: Political Economy Volume IV: International Relations Routledge «Market: Politics March 2011: 234x156: 1416pp Hb: 978-0-415-40911-7: £650.00/11
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
326 library reference
111-VOLUME set
Routledge Library Editions: Development * Various Routledge Library Editions: Development will re-issue works which address economic, political and social aspects of development. Published over more than four decades these books trace the emergence of development as one of the most important contemporary issues and one of the key areas of study for modern social science. The books cover the most important themes within development and include studies of Latin America, Africa and Asia. Authors include Sir Alexander Cairncross, Lord Peter Bauer and Cristobal Kay. An extensive collection of previously hard to access or out of print books, this set presents an unrivalled opportunity to build up a wealth of material in the field of development studies, with a particular focus upon economic and political concerns. Routledge «Market: Development December 2010: 234x156 Set: 978-0-415-58414-2: £6420.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-84035-1: £6500.00/14
Mini Sets Also Sold Separately: Volumes 1–6
Volumes 23–25
Volumes 79–85
Development Mini-Set A: Agriculture, Food and Development
Development Mini-Set E: Development and the Environment
Development Mini-Set J: Politics and International Relations
Hb: 978-0-415-59717-3: £355.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-84031-3: £275.00/14
Hb: 978-0-415-59949-8: £175.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83878-5: £195.00/14
Volumes 7–12
Volumes 26–58
Development Mini-Set B: Aid
Development Mini-Set F: Development Economics
Hb: 978-0-415-60224-2: £415.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83571-5: £470.00/14 Volumes 86–89
Hb: 978-0-415-59780-7: £330.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-84010-8: £375.00/14
Hb: 978-0-415-60042-2: £1950.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83811-2: £1595.00/14
Volumes 13–16
Development Mini-Set K: Security and Development Hb: 978-0-415-60225-9: £260.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83562-3: £65.00/14 Volumes 90–98
Development Mini-Set C: Debt and Development Hb: 978-0-415-59867-5: £225.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83934-8: £180.00/14
Volumes 59–65
Development Mini-Set G: Education and Development Hb: 978-0-415-60066-8: £400.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83734-4: £450.00/14
Volumes 17–22
Development Mini-Set L: Sociology and Social Policy Hb: 978-0-415-60226-6: £525.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83520-3: £455.00/14 Volumes 99–111
Development Mini-Set D: Demography Hb: 978-0-415-59918-4: £375.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83903-4: £350.00/14
Volumes 66–73
Development Mini-Set H: Geography and Planning Hb: 978-0-415-60121-4: £500.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83669-9: £435.00/14
Development Mini-Set M: Theories of Development Hb: 978-0-415-60290-7: £795.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83513-5: £900.00/14
Volumes 74–78
Development Mini-Set I: Planning and Development
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Hb: 978-0-415-60163-4: £310.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83611-8: £350.00/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
library reference 327
Agrarian Reform in Contemporary Developing Countries A Study Prepared for the International Labour Office within the Framework of the World Employment Programme Edited by Ajit Kumar Ghose Initially published in 1983, in association with the International Labour Organisation (ILO), this book is about the meaning, relevance and process of agrarian reform in contemporary developing countries. It includes seven detailed case studies – one each on Ethiopia, Peru, Chile, Nicaragua, Iran, Kerala, (India) and West Bengal (India). In all the cases, serious contemporary efforts were made to implement agrarian reform programmes and the case studies focus upon selected aspects of this reform process – origins, basic characteristics, problems of implementation and immediate consequences. It is clear that agrarian reform is essentially a political process, requiring major social movements and that piecemeal reforms will not solve the grave problems of growth, distribution and poverty in the Third World. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 378pp Hb: 978-0-415-59240-6: £80.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-84046-7: £80.00/14
New Seeds and Poor People Michael Lipton and Richard Longhurst First published in 1989, this book deals with the impact of cereal production upon the Third World, specifically ‘Modern Varieties’ (MVs). Using evidence from plant breeding, economics and nutrition science, the authors seek to pinpoint what has been achieved, what has gone wrong and what needs to be done in future. Although the technical innovations of MVs mean more employment, cheaper food and less risk for small farmers, the reduction in crop diversity increases the risk of danger from pests and though MVs enlarge cereal stocks, many are too poor to afford them. The book concludes that technical breakthroughs alone won’t solve deep-rooted social problems and that only new policies and research priorities will increase the choices, assets and power of the rural poor. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 492pp Hb: 978-0-415-59537-7: £85.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-84043-6: £85.00/14
Food and Poverty The Political Economy of Confrontation Radha Sinha
The Green Revolution Revisited Critique and Alternatives Edited by Bernhard Glaeser The Green Revolution – the apparently miraculous increase in cereal crop yields achieved in the 1960s – came under severe criticism in the 1970s because of its demands for optimal irrigation, intensive use of fertilisers and pesticides; its damaging impact on social structures; and its monoculture approach. The early 1980s saw a concerted approach to many of these criticisms under the auspices of Consultative Group on International Agricultural Research (CGIAR). This book, first published in 1987, analyses the recent achievements of the CGIAR and examines the Green Revolution concept in South America, Asia and Africa, from an ‘ecodevelopment’ standpoint, with particular regard to the plight of the rural poor.
First published in 1976, this book deals with contemporary tensions between the West and the Third World, caused by hunger, malnutrition and poverty, perpetuated by an imbalance in the distribution of world resources. The book deals with the issue of malnutrition in the Third World, which owes much more to poverty and unemployment than to agricultural failure. The author also believes that population control can do little in the absence of a more equitable distribution of world resources and political power within and between countries involving a fundamental change in ideology and education. This is a challenging and critical book, whose arguments cannot be ignored by anyone concerned with the creation of a just and stable world order. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 210pp Hb: 978-0-415-59243-7: £65.00/11
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 222pp Hb: 978-0-415-59249-9: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-84044-3: £70.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
328 library reference
Food Aid and the Developing World Four African Case Studies Christopher Stevens, University of Sussex, UK Food aid is a controversial form of development assistance and this book, first published in 1979, seeks to counter allegations from critics by taking account of both direct and indirect affects. Based on field research in Tunisia, Botswana, Upper Volta and Lesotho, it considers aid from the UK, EEC, USAID, the World Food Programme, Canada and France, and draws a number of policyorientated conclusions about the impact of food aid on nutrition, consumer prices and agricultural production. In the light of the evidence from field studies it is shown that many of the claims advanced by food aid supporters and by critics cannot be sustained, and that the real impact of food aid is rather different from that assumed by the conventional wisdom on the subject. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 228pp Hb: 978-0-415-59246-8: £75.00/11
Agricultural Development and Economic Integration in Latin America Montague Yudelman and Frederic Howard First published in 1970, this study is concerned with both the theoretical and the practical problems involved with agricultural development and economic integration in Latin America, with particular emphasis on those countries which are embraced by the Latin American Free Trade Association. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 335pp Hb: 978-0-415-59436-3: £75.00/11
The Politics of United States Foreign Aid
The Economics of Aid J.M. Healey First published in 1971, this reissue considers the main aspects of foreign aid to developing countries in terms of economic concepts and principles. The author gives an economic definition of aid and considers the motives for giving aid and the principles on which it may be allocated. He looks at the effect on the economic growth of developing countries of both the aid given and the need to repay the debt, and the effect on trade patterns and resource allocation of tying aid to one particular project, or one source of goods. While economic analysis is only a first step in providing a basis for policy decisions on foreign aid, Dr Healey shows that many issues can be clarified by looking at them from the economists’ point of view. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 124pp Hb: 978-0-415-59267-3: £60.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-84017-7: £60.00/14
Aid and Inequality in Kenya British Development Assistance to Kenya Gerald Holtham and Arthur Hazelwood This reissue, first published in 1976, considers the rapid rate of economic growth in Kenya, combined with its apparent political stability, to determine whether or not this is indeed a case of ‘growth without development’ and, if so, where the responsibility for aid lies in this situation. The book concludes that while Kenyan growth has not been to an ideal pattern, accompanied by an increase in inequality, there is little or no reason to believe that living standards have not improved. It examines the impact of aid on Kenya’s progress at both the microeconomic and macroeconomic level and provides an institutional study of the impact of aid on Kenyan Government policy formation and administration and a discussion of British aid’s political purposes and influence in Kenya. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 268pp Hb: 978-0-415-59273-4: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-84016-0: £70.00/14
George M. Guess First published in 1987, this reissue explores contemporary United States foreign aid policies and thinking in the Reagan era. The author argues that aid policy is often confused as a result of bureaucratic decision-making processes. The book contrasts the experience of the many countries where aid-giving has produced unwished-for effects with the few countries where the desired results have occurred. The author concludes by arguing for a new approach to aid-giving by the United States.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 316pp Hb: 978-0-415-59276-5: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-84018-4: £75.00/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
library reference 329
Does Aid Work in India? A Country Study of the Impact of Official Development Assistance Michael Lipton and John Toye, Oxford University, UK ‘Lipton and Toye deploy their considerable expertise on agriculture and the Indian Economy in assessing the effects of aid, including food aid, on growth and equity in the agricultural sector.’ – The Economic Journal Much about India’s economy and aid flows has changed in the last two decades. India’s growth rate has quickened since economic liberalisation, the poverty head count has fallen and the volume and composition of its aid have changed as new issues of climate change and the environment have emerged.. Yet ‘Does Aid Work in India?’, first published in 1990, remains of great interest as a study of aid effectiveness in India’s preliberalisation era. It identifies those sectors where aid-funded interventions succeeded, and where they failed. It explains how India avoided problems of aid dependence, and managed the political tensions that are associated with aid policy dialogue. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 292pp Hb: 978-0-415-59269-7: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-84015-3: £75.00/14
Aid and Dependence British Aid to Malawi Kathryn Morton First published in 1975, in conjunction with the Overseas Development Institute, this study examines the case for and against aid for developing nations, taking the specific example of British aid to Malawi’s economic development since independence in 1964. Kathryn Morton suggests that without Britain’s aid, Malawi’s capacity to develop would have been severely undermined and that aid has not generally inhibited Malawi’s efforts to help itself. The rapid growth of both agricultural and industrial output alongside foreign exchange earnings and avoidance of large-scale urban unemployment and balance of payment problems do not bear out the critics gloomy predictions. This book does much to counter the critics’ case against aid and raises a number of vital questions in determining the future shape of aid policies for both Britain and other developed countries. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 202pp Hb: 978-0-415-59275-8: £65.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-84014-6: £65.00/14
The OPEC Fund for International Development The Formative Years Ibrahim F.I. Shihata The OPEC countries’ collective policy is to offer external development assistance free from political or commercial ties, with the purpose of expressing the solidarity of one group of developing countries with the rest. Since 1976, this policy has found vigorous practical expression in the operations and activities of the OPEC fund. First published in 1983, this book describes the Fund’s organisational evolution into a fully-fledged international body, detailing the fund’s achievements in providing loans and grants to over 80 countries with operations based on principles that have influenced the whole development movement. Concrete examples are outlined, such as where the fund has acted as a catalyst for development, or a spokesman for a group of countries in international negotiations. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-59270-3: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-84013-9: £75.00/14
International Indebtedness and the Developing Countries George C. Abbott First published in 1979, this study focuses upon two of the major economic problems faced by developing countries: massive foreign debts and the shortage of foreign funds offered on concessional terms for development purposes. The relationship between the two is highlighted in the effect that debt accumulation has on ministering the increase of debt service payments, and to lessen resources for development purposes. The study argues that not only is the impact and implications of these two problems more or less identical for debtor and creditor countries, but that it is the inappropriate techniques of rescheduling and refinancing that have failed to solve the problems of developing countries. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 316pp Hb: 978-0-415-59437-0: £75.00/11
Images and Behaviour of Private Bank Lending to Developing Countries Margee M. Ensign The primary questions addressed by this study, first published in 1988, focus on how private bankers made decisions on the creditworthiness of developing countries during the 1970s and what the implications of these decision rules are for the developing countries today. Based on interviews with senior bankers about their decision rules, the author has developed artificial intelligence-based simulations of their images of creditworthiness.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 126pp Hb: 978-0-415-59279-6: £60.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83991-1: £60.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
330 library reference
Development and the Debt Trap
Hungry People and Empty Lands
Economic Planning and External Borrowing in Ghana
An Essay on Population Problems and International Tensions
Andrzej Krassowski
Edited by S. Chandrasekhar
Ghana is one of the earliest and most serious examples of the build up of foreign debt by a developing country to support its policies for economic growth. This study, first published in 1974 in conjunction with the Overseas Development Institute, analyses Ghana’s economy over twenty years and highlights the problems of the debtor/creditor relationship between developed and developing countries.
‘A scholarly and scientific study of the very real difficulties of policies both to control and limit population growth and to relieve the pressures where they have become acute.’ – The Economic Journal
The study concludes with an assessment of the creditors’ contribution to Ghana’s critical debt position through their readiness to supply funds without adequately analysing the viability of the programmes they supported and through the repayment and interest terms they offered – terms which were too heavy for Ghana to meet. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 178pp Hb: 978-0-415-59282-6: £65.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83990-4: £65.00/14
The African Debt Crisis Trevor W. Parfitt and Stephen P. Riley Assessing both the macro- and micro-economic levels of the contemporary African Debt Crisis, this book, first published in 1989, begins by looking at the origins of the world debt crisis, and then looks closely at the problem as it affects Sub-Saharan Africa. The effects of debt on Africa’s position in international relations are considered, and the roles played by organisations such as the International Monetary Fund and the World Bank are assessed. The authors also examine the local effects in a series of case studies of various states including Nigeria, Ghana and Sierra Leone, the Francophone States and Zaire. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 238pp Hb: 978-0-415-59278-9: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83989-8: £70.00/14
Womens’ Roles and Population Trends in the Third World
First published in 1954, this reissue deals with the problem of international tensions arising from demographic and fertility differences, with special reference to such heavily populated Asian countries as China, Japan and India. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 308pp Hb: 978-0-415-59538-4: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83922-5: £75.00/14
Infant Mortality, Population Growth and Family Planning in India An Essay on Population Problems and International Tensions Edited by S. Chandrasekhar First published in 1972, this reissue deals with the crucial issue of population explosion, one of the most crucial problems facing the contemporary developing world. Written by a world-renowned demographer and family planning specialist, the book deals specifically with the Indian experience. Reviewing population change in India over the last century, Professor Chandrasekhar focuses on three key issues: the socioeconomic repercussions of reduced infant mortality in twentieth-century India; the rapid population growth from 1871 and its implications on India’s efforts to raise her standard of living; and finally India’s valiant efforts to promote family planning amongst her hundred million married couples. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 400pp Hb: 978-0-415-59544-5: £80.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83921-8: £80.00/14
Edited by Richard Anker, Marya Buvinic and Nadia H. Youssef First published in 1982, this collection was the result of an ambitious and wide-ranging, inter-disciplinary research programme conducted by the International Labour Office (ILO) on the relationship between women’s roles and demographic change, with a view to influencing contemporary government and non-government policy and future research in the field. The ILO held an informal gathering of leading researchers in the fields of economics, anthropology, sociology and demography and this volume represents a unique and practicallyorientated collection, offering valuable insights into contemporary perspectives on women’s studies and population dynamics.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 290pp Hb: 978-0-415-59284-0: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83923-2: £75.00/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
library reference 331
Population and Development High and Low Fertility in Poorer Countries Edited by Geoffrey Hawthorn First published in 1978, this book explores the vital global issue of high and low fertility in poorer countries through a series of case studies by contemporary experts in the fields of development and demography. These studies examine such issues as: the relations between fertility rates and income distributions in poor societies; the question of whether or not neo-classical macro-economics are sufficient to understand and to try to engineer relations between economies and populations; and the specifics of the relations between fertility and a variety of socio-economic factors in both South Asia and West Africa. The point of the collection is to explain how very far general models can be taken, and to suggest that they cannot be taken as far as those who have tended to ignore the structural complexities of, and differences between, various societies have implied.
The Politics of Family Planning in the Third World Edited by T.E. Smith First published in 1973, this book is an attempt to examine the political determinants (as opposed to the more usual emphasis upon consequences) of contemporary population policy formation and action in developing countries, with particular reference to policy relating to family limitation. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 354pp Hb: 978-0-415-59291-8: £80.00/11
Learning From China? Development and Environment in Third World Countries
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 218pp Hb: 978-0-415-59283-3: £65.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83920-1: £65.00/14
Edited by Bernhard Glaeser
Population, Health and Nutrition in the Sahel
The Chinese ‘autocentred’ strategy is assessed from both the developmental and the environmental viewpoints. Decision-making processes and the opportunities to implement environmental policy in other parts of the developing world are analysed and the volume concludes with the view that benefits to other countries are likely to arise out of increased co-operation and exchange with China, although the Chinese model is by no means a panacea.
First published in 1987, this volume was written to shed some light upon the nature and environmental consequences and wider relevance of development strategies in the Peoples’ Republic of China. It covers industrialisation, food production, energy use and landscape and settlement planning.
Issues in the Welfare of Selected West African Communities Edited by Allan G. Hill This collection of studies, first published in 1985, describes some contemporary problems of selected pastoral and agro-pastoral communities of the West African Sahel. Several important features of the Sahel are illustrated: the significance of seasonal factors in causing periodic stress amongst people and animals, the economic uncertainty introduced by interannual climactic variations, as well as the role of traditional systems of social and economic organisation in providing some support during periods of need. The findings presented here are published in co-operation with the Sahel Institute, a regional research organisation set up in the early 1970s with representation from eight Sahelian countries – Cape Verde, Chad, Gambia, Mali, Mauritania, Niger, Senegal and Upper Volta.
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 300pp Hb: 978-0-415-59296-3: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83892-1: £75.00/14
African Environments and Resources L.A. Lewis and L. Berry First published in 1988, this work provides a comprehensive picture of the range of physical environments in Africa, focusing upon those characteristics and issues central to the management of environmental resources.
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 432pp Hb: 978-0-415-59285-7: £85.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83918-8: £85.00/14
The book is designed to contribute to a better understanding of African environmental and resource-management problems and this reissue should be welcomed by students of Africa and of environmental resource management problems in general.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 420pp Hb: 978-0-415-59293-2: £80.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83891-4: £80.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
332 library reference
Development and the Environmental Crisis
Indian Economic Policy and Development
Red or Green Alternatives
P.T. Bauer
Michael Redclift, University of London, UK
Professor Bauer’s book, first published in 1961, reviews the major elements of contemporary official Indian development policy, considers their economic implications and their probable political and economic results. He then examines alternative approaches to the promotion of development. The development plans, notably the Second Five Year Plan and the official outlines of the Third Plan, receive major attention, but the author also considers other official policies and measures affecting economic development, which do not usually figure prominently in the formal development plans.
First published in 1984, Michael Redclift’s book makes the global environmental crisis a central concern of political economy and its structural causes a central concern of environmentalism. Michael Redclift argues that a close analysis of the environmental crisis in the South reveals the importance of the share of resources obtained by different social groups. The development strategies based on the experiences and interests of Western capitalist countries fail to recognise that environmental degradation in the South is a product of inequalities in both global and local economic relations and cannot be solved simply by applying solutions borrowed from environmentalism in the North. The key to understanding the South’s environmental problems lies in the recognition that structural processes are also a determining influence upon the way natural resources are used. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 162pp Hb: 978-0-415-59295-6: £65.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83890-7: £65.00/14
Fuat Andic, Suphan Andic and Douglas Dosser First published in 1971, this is a study of the application of the economic theory of integration in developing countries attempts to assess the development of common markets and free trade areas in the contemporary developing world. The book synthesises various revisions of the old theory of the customs union, tackling the process of elaborating an appropriate theory for developing countries. The reissue will be of interest to those concerned with International Trade and Development Economics, as well as those interested in the development of the Caribbean region. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-59381-6: £65.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83857-0: £65.00/14
West African Trade A Study of Competition, Oligopoly and Monopoly in a Changing Economy P.T. Bauer
A Theory of Economic Integration for Developing Countries Illustrated by Caribbean Countries
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 152pp Hb: 978-0-415-59387-8: £65.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83856-3: £65.00/14
This groundbreaking work from the hugely influential economist P. T. Bauer, first published in 1954 and reissued with a new introduction in 1963, is a thorough and detailed analysis of the findings of the Colonial Economic Research Committee, from their investigation into the structure of West African Trade and especially the monopolistic tendencies inherent within it. Materials for the study were collected and analysed between 1949 and 1952, offering an invaluable insight into dominant features of contemporary West African Economies and an analysis of their implications. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 474pp Hb: 978-0-415-59383-0: £85.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83855-6: £85.00/14
Theories of Economic Development and Growth Y.S. Brenner First published in 1966, this work summarises the theories of economic growth, both ancient and modern, and presents them in a form particularly suitable for university students, both in the developing world and elsewhere. The objective is to enable students to assess the major factors making for economic development and to encourage them to think about ways of applying their knowledge to the particular problems of their own countries. In addition there is a special survey of growth and of limiting factors in the economies of underdeveloped countries, with an important analysis of the economic results of planning in the USSR.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 286pp Hb: 978-0-415-59362-5: £75.00/11
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
library reference 333
Factors in Economic Development Black Africa 1945–1980 A. K. Cairncross
Economic Decolonization and Arrested Development
‘Extremely wide-ranging and refreshingly unparochial’ – The Observer, UK
D.K. Fieldhouse
‘Cairncross expounds his views on these issues of economic development with a wealth of illustrative material, all of it used with great skill and wisdom.’ - The Guardian, UK First published in 1961, this work is a compendium of essays written by esteemed economist Sir Alexander Cairncross, pertaining to the theme of economic development. A wide cross-section of factors are taken into account in this extensive collection of articles, amongst which are the importance of investment and technical progress; trade; administration and planning; and the role of education. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 348pp Hb: 978-0-415-59357-1: £80.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83854-9: £80.00/14
Fiscal Policy in Underdeveloped Countries With Special Reference to India Raja J. Chelliah Originally published in 1960, with a second edition in 1969, this book is of special interest for having been the first systematic attempt to discuss problems of fiscal policy from the point of view of promoting economic growth in underdeveloped countries. It deals mainly with problems of tax policy, and outlines the economic principles by which the structure of taxation in developing economies can be constructed and evaluated. The work made a distinct contribution in the field of Development studies by reorienting the theory of fiscal policy originally developed in the economically advanced countries to the problems, requirements and institutional structure of an underdeveloped, over-populated country with a mixed enterprise system.
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 218pp Hb: 978-0-415-59358-8: £65.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83853-2: £65.00/14
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
In what ways did economic considerations affect the decision by Britain and France to make their Black African colonies independent? Why were early expectations that independence would lead to rapid and sustained economic development in Africa for the most part disappointed? This title, originally published in 1986, seeks to tackle these two important and strongly debated issues. The main aim and value of the book is to take a broad view of this huge subject, pulling together material on most parts of Black Africa south of the Sahara and north of the Limpopo so that the problem can be seen as a whole. It takes account of a wide range of possible and actual factors which have influenced African economic development, weaving them into a single analysis, including the colonial inheritance, the impact of the fluctuating international economy, policies adopted by African governments and indigenous factors such as climate, drought and human resources. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 280pp Hb: 978-0-415-59361-8: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83852-5: £70.00/14
Money and Finance in Africa The Experience of Ghana, Morocco, Nigeria, the Rhodesias and Nyasaland, the Sudan and Tunisia from the establishment of their central banks until 1962 Erin E.J. Fleetwood This reissue, first published in 1964, describes the contemporary problems faced and solutions found by the monetary and financial authorities of six African countries: Ghana, Morocco, Nigeria, the Rhodesias, the Sudan and Tunisia, from the establishment of their central banks until 1962.This study explores the special economic and social factors of these African countries and places emphasis upon the atmosphere of rapid change, growth and development. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 336pp Hb: 978-0-415-59571-1: £75.00/11
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
‘It has the great merit that the difficult, delicate and often highly frustrating impediments to any theory of growth are not assumed out of the way.’ – The Financial Times, UK
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
334 library reference
The Theory and Experience of Economic Development
International Finance and Latin America
Essays in Honour of Sir Arthur Lewis
Stephany Griffith-Jones, University of Sussex, UK
Edited by Mark Gersovitz, Johns Hopkins University, USA, Carlos F. Diaz-Alejandro, Gustav Ranis, Yale University, USA and Mark R. Rosenzweig, University of California, Berkley, USA
This reissue, initially published in 1984, examines the evolution of international financial flows to Latin America since 1945, along with their implications for National Development . The book describes how, in each of the first three decades since the war, a new agency emerged (foreign investors in the 1950s, official aid agencies in the 1960s and multinational banks in the 1970s) which was willing to play a dynamic role in generating new financial flows to the region. The lack of such an agent in the 1980s, combined with a reluctance on the part of former investors to maintain their level of assistance culminated in an economic debt crisis in Latin America which this work seeks to address, asking the crucial question: what measures should be taken – both nationally and internationally – to deal with this critical issue , in a way that will both encourage Latin American Development and avoid a major international financial crisis?
This volume, first published in 1982, is a collection of original essays written to honour Professor W. Arthur Lewis, 1979 co-winner of the Nobel Prize in economics. The authors, an international group of distinguished scholars, address a varied set of specific issues reflecting Professor Lewis’ research interests, covering topics which include: technological change in agriculture, analyses of unemployment and income distribution, the role of government policy in the development process, the historical record of development, and the relationship between developed and developing nations. The book will be of interest to both the academic researcher and practicing professionals in the international organisations and national governments, and are particularly appropriate to graduate courses in economic development, cost-benefit analysis and economic history.
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 132pp Hb: 978-0-415-59386-1: £60.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83850-1: £60.00/14
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 416pp Hb: 978-0-415-59367-0: £80.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83851-8: £80.00/14
Finance and Economic Growth in Developing Countries K.L. Gupta
The Role of the International Financial Centres in Underdeveloped Countries Xabier Gorostiaga, Ludovico Alcorta and Vivianne Prochazka This reissue, first published in 1984, presents a study of the key phenomenon of global banking, carried out from special financial centres in underdeveloped countries, which contributed heavily to the contemporary debt crisis. This book gathers together previously disparate and unpublished data to give a detailed picture of the scope and the effects of transnational banking in the new international financial centres which have largely been set up since 1970. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 170pp Hb: 978-0-415-59459-2: £65.00/11
First published in 1984, this study analyses contemporary research into the role of financial development as a means of accelerating the economic growth of developing countries. The author analyses both the ‘financial structuralist’ and ‘financial repressionist’ schools of thought in order to determine both the direction of causality between financial and real growth and the accuracy of the repressionists’ assertion that real interest rates and their stability do matter in the economies of developing countries. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 258pp Hb: 978-0-415-59549-0: £70.00/11
Poverty, Progress and Development Edited by Paul-Marc Henry The studies of poverty, progress and development in this volume, first published in 1991, by a distinguished international roster of authors and researchers, aim to increase knowledge of the social mechanisms of pauperization, marginalization, and the exclusion of certain categories of society; to bring to light the potential and creative role of socio-cultural, intellectual, ethical, moral and spiritual values in progress and the development process; and to examine the links and contradictions between development and progress in order to propose ways of reducing social inequalities.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 348pp Hb: 978-0-415-59668-8: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83849-5: £75.00/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
library reference 335
Federalism and Economic Growth Economic Development in Underdeveloped Countries in East Asia Ursula Hicks
E. Stuart Kirby
First published in 1961, this reissue is based upon the proceedings of a working party conference held at Exeter in September 1959 and deals with the experiences of older federations, the constraints of the traditional social order, the stark economic needs of the contemporary economic situation, and the political ambitions of the newly-independent countries.
First published in 1967, this influential study reviews the economic development of 15 countries from East Asia in the period between 1945 and 1965. It deals with a wide variety of factors influencing the development of the region, including the influence of foreign governments (both international aid and foreign trade); population development; industrialisation; transport and communication infrastructure; and the impact of economic development upon the population of East Asia.
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 186pp Hb: 978-0-415-59595-7: £65.00/11
Economic Development in the Tropics B.W. Hodder First published in 1968, the central aim of this work is to examine the major problems of development confronting contemporary tropical countries. Adopting an interdisciplinary approach, the book examines the significance of natural and human resources in development planning in tropical countries; the effects of social and political institutions; the problems of aid and trade; markets and transport; and problems of agriculture and industry. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 274pp Hb: 978-0-415-59550-6: £75.00/11
Third World Industrialization in the 1980s Open Economies in a Closing World Edited by Raphie Kaplinsky, Open University, UK First published in 1984, this work explores the issues surrounding the industrialisation of the Third World at the beginning of the 1980s. The expectation that Newly Industrialising Countries would facilitate industrial growth via an outward-orientated strategy had begun to be the combination of growing recession, growing protectionism and the diffusion of radical microelectronics-related technical change. In addition, the high indebtedness of developing countries made them increasingly dependent on assistance from the IMF and IBRD, whose policies increased the tendency towards de-industrialisation. The papers in this volume explore all of these issues and their implication for LDC industrial strategy in the 1980s.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Industrial Structure and Policy in Less Developed Countries Colin Kirkpatrick, N. Lee and Fred Nixson, University of Manchester, UK First published in 1984, this textbook analyses, at both aggregate and micro economic levels, the contemporary industrial conditions in Third World countries and relates this to the process of economic growth and structural transformation. Drawing upon both industrial and development economics, the authors offer a comprehensive and integrated treatment of the different levels of industrial analysis in less developed countries, alongside a wealth of comparative data on industrial structure, business concentration and behaviour, and industrial policies in a cross-section of countries in Africa, Asia, the Far East and Latin America. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 280pp Hb: 978-0-415-59371-7: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83846-4: £75.00/14
Rich World, Poor World Geoffrey Lean This reissue, first published in 1978, confronts a whole range of international development issues: hunger, energy, supply, population growth, pollution, the state of the cities, nuclear proliferation. Geoffrey Lean explains the interdependent contemporary crises within developing nations and presents the facts behind them, alongside the practical solutions, new strategies and fresh thinking present in contemporary development thinking. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 352pp Hb: 978-0-415-59667-1: £80.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83845-7: £80.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 144pp Hb: 978-0-415-59388-5: £60.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83848-8: £60.00/14
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 256pp Hb: 978-0-415-59363-2: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83847-1: £70.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
336 library reference
Export Instability and Economic Development
Persistent Underdevelopment Change and Economic Modernization in the West Indies Jay Mandle, Colgate University, USA
Edited by Alasdair Macbean When this work was first published in 1966, there was much interest in various types of commodity agreements and compensatory financing as methods of reducing the effects of export fluctuations on the economies of developing countries. The book concluded that short term fluctuations in export earnings, though perhaps important for some countries, did not appear to be the general problem that had been assumed.This led to many published and unpublished studies on the issues: some supported, others contradicted the book’s conclusions. The data available now are vastly greater and probably more accurate than pre-1966. However, the work and the issues it raised remain important because most schemes proposed to reduce export instability would be costly and likely to divert resources from uses more obviously aimed at raising economic development in most developing countries. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 368pp Hb: 978-0-415-59390-8: £80.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83844-0: £80.00/14
Patterns of Caribbean Development An Interpretive Essay on Economic Change Jay Mandle, Colgate University, USA First published in 1982, this study attempts to put contemporary Caribbean development into historical perspective. By first constructing a Marxist framework for the study of development, Jay Mandle assesses the reasons why the region emerged underdeveloped and evaluates post-world-war two efforts to overcome the legacy of poverty through a strategy of ‘industrialization through invitation.’ Identifying the reasons why a Marxist framework yielded results which were unsatisfactory, the author then explores the requirements which must be met for a more reliable study of the Caribbean’s economic development. Case studies of Cuba, Jamaica, Guyana, Trinidad and Tobago examine the extent to which these requirements have been met. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 170pp Hb: 978-0-415-59366-3: £65.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83843-3: £65.00/14
First published in 1996, this insightful and informative text examines the post-emancipation and recent economic history of the Commonwealth Caribbean. Jay R. Mandle offers an explanation of the region’s continuing underdevelopment. Through the use of an analytical framework derived from the works of Marx and Kuznets, the book focuses attention on technological change as the driving force behind economic modernization. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 204pp Hb: 978-0-415-59364-9: £65.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83842-6: £65.00/14
The Economic and Social Structure of Mauritius James E. Meade First published in 1961, this reissue examines the contemporary economic problems of Mauritius alongside those social problems which have a bearing on economic development. As a small and isolated economy, marked by a very rapid rate of contemporary population growth, by an extreme concentration on a single product, and by a great diversity of racial, religious and linguistic groups within the population, Mauritius is a representative microcosm of the economic problems of a large part of the developing world. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 264pp Hb: 978-0-415-59438-7: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83841-9: £70.00/14
Export-Oriented Industrialisation The ASEAN Experience Mohammed Ariff and Hal Hill, Australian National University, Australia First published in 1985, this study is a comparative examination of industrialisation and industrial policy from the early 1960s to the early 1980s in the five original member countries of the Association of South-East Asian Nations (ASEAN): namely Indonesia, Malaysia, the Philippines, Singapore and Thailand. The work provides an integrated overview of industrial policies and performance in the five countries and forms essential reading for both those with a specialist interest in the ASEAN countries and their economic performance, and for students of industrialisation in developing countries the world over.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-59370-0: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83840-2: £75.00/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
library reference 337
Trade and Developing Countries Kathryn Morton and Peter Tulloch This reissue, initially published in 1977, is an introduction to contemporary trading positions and problems of developing countries. The authors examine the main export options of Third World countries and consider the roles of the key international organisations – GATT, UNCTAD, etc – and those of national governments and foreign investors. The authors complete their review with an examination of the way in which numbers of developing countries have tried to diversify their trade relations, particularly by creating Third World trading groups. Contemporary economic difficulties and their impact upon the Third World is also discussed, with the authors displaying a guarded optimism about real changes in world economic relations, citing factors such as the spread of trade among developing countries and the increase processing of raw materials as potential for the wider participation of developing countries in international trade. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 376pp Hb: 978-0-415-59382-3: £80.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83839-6: £80.00/14
Integration, Development and Equity: Economic Integration in West Africa Peter Robson This reissue, first published in 1983, is an authoritative study of economic integration among the states of West Africa, focusing upon the issues and experience of the four main initiatives for regional integration in West Africa, namely the Economic Community of West African States, the Mano River Union, the Communauté Economique de l’Afrique de l’Ouest, and the recent initiative for the establishment of an economic and monetary union between Senegal and the Gambia. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 276x219: 194pp Hb: 978-0-415-59572-8: £65.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83838-9: £65.00/14
The Economies of Africa Edited by Peter Robson and D.A. Lury
Towards Economic Recovery in Sub-Saharan Africa Essays in Honour of Robert Gardiner Edited by James Pickett and Hans Singer First published in 1990, this volume considers the question: is there any hope for economic recovery in Africa? Written by a team of leading development economists, the book takes a close look at the economic decline of Sub-Saharan Africa and provides a set of guidelines for promoting economic recovery. Stressing the need for greater co-operation between African states, the contributors outline the economic and social policies required to put this crisistorn region back on the road to sustained development. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 292pp Hb: 978-0-415-59375-5: £75.00/11
This reissue, first published in 1969 brings together structural and analytical studies of seven single African countries, together with two studies of groups of countries which, although politically separate, have in the past had close economic links. These countries are Algeria, Cameroon, Ghana, Ivory Coast, Liberia, Nigeria and the Sudan. The groups are East Africa, comprising Kenya, Uganda and Tanzania; and Central Africa, comprising Rhodesia, Malawi and Zambia.The countries have been chosen to bring out the main contemporary economic issues arising in the efforts of the independent African States to achieve economic growth. The book will be invaluable to students and practicing economists concerned with Africa and the developing economies generally. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 532pp Hb: 978-0-415-59594-0: £90.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83837-2: £90.00/14
Economic Integration in Africa Peter Robson, University of St. Andrews, UK First published in 1968, this reissue is a study of contemporary international economic policy, with particular emphasis upon economic integration as a means of bringing about a faster rate of economic progress and of helping to overcome poverty. Peter Robson’s book is a study of the rationale of common markets and other forms of economic integration among African states and of their operation in practice. The book will be of great value to those concerned with administering or assessing integration schemes in Africa and indeed in less developed areas throughout the world. In addition, it is an important contribution to the field of development economics.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 322pp Hb: 978-0-415-59373-1: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83836-5: £75.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
338 library reference
Capital Formation and Economic Development
The Wealth of Poor Nations C. Suriyakumaran Initially published in 1984, this book considers the contemporary condition of the Third World economy, investigating the structural factors and historical forces, mostly operating in the capitalist world, which underlie the experience of the Third World in the post-war era.
Studies in the Economic Development of India Edited by P.N. Rosenstein-Rodan First published in 1964, this series of studies, compiled by the India team of Centre of International Studies at MIT, represents an important contribution to methods in planning for development, which will be of relevance to all those working in the field, irrespective of country. The results are demonstrated on examples taken from the Third Five-Year Plan and from some of the papers which underlay it.
The book provides a powerful critique of many of the development strategies which have been employed during this period and suggests that the misconceptions inherent within them have done much to damage North-South relations in recent years, particularly the failure to relate analytically the so-called social factors to economic growth and productivity. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 342pp Hb: 978-0-415-59374-8: £75.00/11
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 162pp Hb: 978-0-415-59389-2: £65.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83835-8: £65.00/14
Growing-Up Modern
Development Policy in Small Countries
The Western State Builds Third-World Schools Bruce Fuller
Edited by Percy Selwyn First published in 1975, the main emphasis of this reissued collection is on the various aspects of dependence to which small countries as such are subject, and the policy options in the political and economic field which are open to them. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 210pp Hb: 978-0-415-59666-4: £65.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83834-1: £65.00/14
Towards Financial Independence in a Developing Economy R.A. Sowelem First published in 1967, this is a unique study of the establishment of the Bank of Rhodesia and Nyasland – a central bank and Londontype money market in a financially externally dependent economy.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Education and Development in Latin America Laurence Gale First published in 1969, this volume presents a survey of the contemporary national education system in Latin American countries. Laurence Gale describes the uneven provision of schools for different sections of the community and the problems which arise with the racial, cultural and geographical difficulties. He examines the main features in education throughout Latin America, areas of cooperation and agreement and differences of policy and provision. Routledge «Market: Education November 2010: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-59461-5: £65.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83750-4: £65.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 330pp Hb: 978-0-415-59372-4: £75.00/11
Bruce Fuller first delves into the motivations held by politicians, education bureaucrats and civic elites as they earnestly seek to spread schooling to younger children, older adults and previously disenfranchised groups. Fuller argues that the school provides an institutional stage on which political actors signal their ideals and the coming of greater modernity; broadening membership in the polity, promising mass opportunity in the wage sector, intensifying modern (bureaucratic) forms of school management, and deepening a presumed commitment to the child’s individual development. Routledge «Market: Education November 2010: 234x156: 194pp Hb: 978-0-415-59495-0: £65.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83751-1: £65.00/14
An Analysis of the Monetary Experience of the Federation of Rhodesia and Nyasaland, 1952–1963
The book deals with the adaptation and initiation of financial institutions in a developing country previously completely dependent on external financial centres and externally controlled financial institutions. Dr Sowelem’s authoritative and detailed study provides valuable information on the inter-related questions of central bank control and the development of specialist money markets in developing countries.
The modern state – First and Third worlds alike – pushes tirelessly to expand mass education and to deepen the schools’ effect upon children. First published in 1991, Growing-Up Modern explores why, how, and with what actual effects state actors so vehemently pursue this dual political agenda.
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
library reference 339
Education and Development Edited by Roger M. Garrett First published in 1984, this collection represents the combined contributions to an international conference held at the University of Bristol in April 1983. In assessing the complex relationship between education and development, it covers a wide range of countries in its appraisal and presents pictures both of optimism and pessimism. All, however, encourage the reader to re-examine long-held beliefs, and presents a new starting point for fresh discussion of this vital subject. Routledge «Market: Education November 2010: 234x156: 286pp Hb: 978-0-415-59494-3: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83749-8: £75.00/14
The Rural World Education and Development Louis Malassis First published in 1976, this book examines the issue of rural education, an all-important problem for the less developed countries in the world. Louis Malassis proposes that all citizens should be made aware of the role of agriculture in the economy and that, instead of placing rural education in a special category, education should be related to the rural world. Routledge «Market: Education November 2010: 234x156: 130pp Hb: 978-0-415-59493-6: £60.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83748-1: £60.00/14
Distance Teaching for the Third World The Lion and the Clockwork Mouse Michael Young, Hilary Perraton, Janet Jenkins and Tony Dodds This reissue, first published in 1980, is based on the experiences of the International Extension College in developing distance teaching. The volume begins by reviewing the world problems of educational quality and quantity, and then examines the ways in which print, broadcasts and group study have been used to train teachers, to improve classroom education, to teach by correspondence out of school, and to support rural development. It then considers how that experience can be used, perhaps by creating a network of radio colleges, to supplement and extend existing schools and colleges. Finally, the book includes a descriptive and annotated bibliography of over 100 distance teaching projects in 65 third world countries.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
African Perspectives J.C.S. Musaazi This reissue, first published in 1986, offers a comprehensive treatment of educational development in four countries in West and East Africa: Nigeria, Uganda, Kenya and Tanzania. The author focuses on the role of education in promoting or hindering national development; the way the educational system varies in response to societal and dialectical forces; the place of education in major theories of change and development; and the contribution made by education to economic, social and political development.Clearly and concisely written, the book will be of interest to teachers, administrators, educational planners and scholars in comparative education and the history of education. Routledge «Market: Education November 2010: 234x156: 394pp Hb: 978-0-415-59609-1: £80.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83746-7: £80.00/14
Education in the Third World Keith Watson This reissue examines the crucial question of how the education systems of Third World countries continue to be influenced by the former colonial powers, arguing that decisions and views made early in the twentieth century cannot always be so readily condemned from the standpoint of the 1980s. The study begins by placing the problem in its historical context and goes on to examine different regions of the Third World influenced by colonialism. It concludes with a contemporary global overview of current colonial dependency and provides a detailed and comprehensive bibliography on different facets of education and colonialism. Routledge «Market: Education November 2010: 234x156: 254pp Hb: 978-0-415-59460-8: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83745-0: £70.00/14
Urbanisation in the Developing World Edited by David Drakakis-Smith First published in 1986, this reissue is concerned with the increased social problems, regional imbalances, and economic dislocation resulting from the alarming growth rate of cities in the developing world. It considers theoretical questions and contains wide-ranging case studies to support the arguments made. It relates urbanisation in the developing world to changes in the broader global economic system, as well as looking at the urbanisation process over time. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 276pp Hb: 978-0-415-59497-4: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83683-5: £70.00/14
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Education November 2010: 234x156: 262pp Hb: 978-0-415-59492-9: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83747-4: £70.00/14
Planning and Development in Education
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
340 library reference
Urbanisation, Housing and the Development Process
Seaports and Development The Experience of Kenya and Tanzania B.S. Hoyle
David Drakakis-Smith
This book, originally published in 1983, demonstrates the importance of seaports in the growth of less-developed countries. The author focuses on the character of port activity within the context of transport systems and regional economic planning. General principles of port development are illustrated by detailed reference to one Third World port group, that of the Indian Ocean coasts of Kenya and Tanzania. The objective is not merely to illustrate the character of one specific group of ports, but to demonstrate methods of analysis and to underline the crucial role of ports in the development process.
Initially published in 1981, this book examines the problems of housing provision for the urban poor in developing countries, within the context of the development process as a whole. The investigation concentrates on the political economy of housing investment and illustrates how programmes and policies are often determined by broader development issues. Commencing with a discussion of urban growth in the Third World, the author then provides a general discussion on housing provision within contemporary development planning in the Third World. Four main types of accommodation – government construction, private sector, squatter housing and slum – are examined in terms of their contemporary and potential roles in meeting low cost housing needs.
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 274pp Hb: 978-0-415-59502-5: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83680-4: £70.00/14
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 250pp Hb: 978-0-415-59499-8: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83682-8: £70.00/14
Underdevelopment and Development in Brazil: Volume I
The Geography of Underdevelopment
Economic Structure and Change, 1822–1947 Nathaniel H. Leff
A Critical Survey
First published in 1982, this work offers an analysis Brazil’s longterm economic history and development, spanning the period from independence to post-war industrial growth. The book focuses upon the classic problem of why Brazil failed to develop economically during the nineteenth century in a manner similar to the United States and other regions of recent settlement.
First published in 1984, this title discusses the emergence of both the orthodox and political economy based approaches to underdevelopment in geography , critically assessing their strengths and weaknesses, and showing the relationship between intellectual developments and changing material conditions. The work is primarily concerned with theories, though it does contain much empirical material drawn from throughout the Third World. The book examines the emergence of theories of development historically and considers the various contemporary theoretical ‘schools’, both Marxist and non-Marxist. It goes on to consider four aspects of development which are of particular interest to geographers, namely the world economy, regional imbalances, the human-nature theme and the analysis of urban space, and concludes by suggesting some directions for future research. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 232pp Hb: 978-0-415-59505-6: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83681-1: £70.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
This volume discusses in detail the principle features of Brazil’s economic landscape between 1822 and 1947, containing special coverage of topics such as slavery and the elastic supply of low cost labour from overseas; the inelastic supply of domestic output; the critical importance of the domestic agricultural sector and the lack of low-cost transportation; the reasons for the failure of international trade to act as an engine for generalized economic development; and the central features of Brazilian development and industrialisation in the first half of the twentieth century. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 268pp Hb: 978-0-415-59507-0: £70.00/11
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Dean Forbes, Flinders University, Adelaide, Australia
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
library reference 341
Underdevelopment and Development in Brazil: Volume II Reassessing the Obstacles to Economic Development Nathaniel H. Leff First published in 1982, this work builds on the detailed economic history of Brazil in its companion volume: ‘Economic Structure and Change, 1822-1947’, assessing and challenging the established interpretations. The book covers in depth the causes of the Northeast’s poor economic experience and the emergence of significant regional inequality in Brazil’s development. In his analysis of the role of Government in Brazil’s economic development, the author offers a fresh perspective on the importance of public finance constraints and on the tensions between centralisation and federalism. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 156pp Hb: 978-0-415-59508-7: £65.00/11
The Geography of the Third World Progress and Prospect Michael Pacione First published in 1988, this reissue presents a comprehensive overview of contemporary developments and research into the geography of the Third World, at a time when economies and societies there were changing at a much more rapid rate than their counterparts in the developing world. It covers the topic both systematically and by region, showing how the unique background of each region affects developments there. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 488pp Hb: 978-0-415-59610-7: £90.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83679-8: £90.00/14
Circulation in Third World Countries Edited by R Mansell Prothero and Murray Chapman Circulation is common in Third World countries and involves reciprocal flows of people, goods and ideas. The essays in this volume, first published in1985, discuss concepts associated with circulation in its various forms, and they present empirical evidence based on field work from holistic, ecological, social, and economic points of view. Contributions from Latin America, the Caribbean, Africa, Asia and the Pacific come from an international group of authors representing a variety of disciplines in the social sciences. All who are concerned with social and economic development need to recognise the importance of circulation at all levels of society and polity. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 494pp Hb: 978-0-415-59496-7: £90.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83678-1: £90.00/14
Development and Planning Essays in Honour of Paul Rosenstein-Rodan Edited by Jagdish Bhagwati, Columbia University, USA and Richard Eckhaus, Massachusetts Institute of Technology, USA First published in 1972, this is a book of essays offered in honour of Paul Rosenstein-Rodan, the distinguished economist whose career started in mid-1920s Vienna and subsequently spanned Europe, Britain, the USA and many of the less developed countries of the world.The book includes reviews of past developments, chapters on development trade and value theory, an assessment of contemporary emerging economic patterns, development and trade policy, and investment policy. Further essays cover the intellectual history of development economics, general aspects of growth and economic policy in underdeveloped countries and the problems of income distribution and sectoral and regional development. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 344pp Hb: 978-0-415-59612-1: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83621-7: £75.00/14
Economic Planning and Social Justice in Third World Countries Ozay Mehmet, Carleton University, Canada First published in 1978, this book assess the impact post-war strategies of Gross National Product maximation upon the development of LDCs, arguing that development in LDCs cannot proceed in a sequential path – with income growth first first and distribution after. The author posits the need for a more egalitarian development strategy and decentralised economic planning, responsive to the needs of rural communities. The book is divided into three parts. Part I is devoted to a critical review of post-war growth and planning strategies; part II, based upon five case studies of Malaysia, Liberia, Pakistan, Brazil and Uganda, explores the influence of elites on economic planning and policy; and Part III offers elements of an egalitarian development planning. The book concludes with a brief summary on egalitarian planning as a non-violent revolution. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 284pp Hb: 978-0-415-59611-4: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83625-5: £70.00/14
Planning African Development Edited by Glen Norcliffe and Tom Pinfold First published in 1981, this book concerns specifically the Kenyan experience with regards to development planning but, given that the problems of hunger poverty and underdevelopment manifest themselves in slightly different forms across all African countries, this book has considerable relevance to development planning across the African continent.The first set of essays in this collection address the question of development which is undoubtedly Africa’s highest development priority. The second grouping of essays considers issues in project planning and asks questions concerning cost, method, outcome and evaluation of various projects in Kenya
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 204pp Hb: 978-0-415-59633-6: £65.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83623-1: £65.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
342 library reference
Urbanisation and Planning in the Third World
Political Change in the Third World
Spatial Perceptions and Public Participation
Charles Andrain
Robert Potter
In this informative and highly readable book, first published in 1988, Charles Andrain explores the ways in which public policies and socio-political beliefs and structures cause political change in the Third World. The author examines 3 types of political change: (1) transitions in political leaders and their policies, (2) fundamental transformations in political structures, policy priorities, and political strategies for dealing with policy issues; and (3) the impact of economic, education, and health care policies on the society itself (including changes in unemployment, inflation, economic growth, literacy and birth and death rates).
First published in 1985, this book reconsiders the whole question of urbanisation and planning in the Third World. It argues that public involvement, which is now an accepted part of Western planning, should be used more in Third World cities. It shows that many inhabitants of Third World cities are migrants from rural areas and have very definite ideas about what the function of the city should be and what it ought to offer; and it goes on to argue that therefore a planning process which involves more public participation would better serve local needs and would do much more to solve problems than the contemporary approach. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 308pp Hb: 978-0-415-59672-5: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83622-4: £75.00/14
America and the Third World
Rural Planning in Developing Countries
Revolution and Intervention John Girling
Report on the Second Rehovoth Conference Israel, August 1963 Edited by Raanan Weitz First published in 1985, this book reconsiders the whole question of urbanisation and planning in the Third World. It argues that public involvement, which is now an accepted part of Western planning, should be used more in Third World cities. It shows that many inhabitants of Third World cities are migrants from rural areas and have very definite ideas about what the function of the city should be and what it ought to offer; and it goes on to argue that therefore a planning process which involves more public participation would better serve local needs and would do much more to solve problems than the contemporary approach. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 454pp Hb: 978-0-415-59675-6: £85.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83620-0: £85.00/14
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 306pp Hb: 978-0-415-60129-0: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83578-4: £75.00/14
John Girling’s book, first published in 1980, investigates the relationship between America and the Third World, centring on three main themes: the nature of American involvement in the Third World, the challenge posed by the rival Super-Power; and the Changes both in US-Soviet relations (from containment to détente) and in the Third World. Three propositions are put forward: that the overriding interest of American foreign policy maker is in the stability of the global system of relationships; that this interest coincides with most Third World élites; and that the global system normally operates peacefully, although continually subject to internal and external challenges. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 290pp Hb: 978-0-415-60130-6: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83577-7: £75.00/14
An Introduction to the Politics of Tropical Africa Richard Hodder-Williams This wide-ranging and informative introduction to politics in tropical Africa, first published in 1984, is essential reading to students, businessmen, government officials and economic advisers alike. Situating the contemporary scene firmly in its historical context, which stresses both pre-colonial and colonial heritages, he emphasizes how politicians are constrained by the past, the physical environment and the world’s economy, yet still retain freedom of choice on a wide range of issues. The book is thematically organised and provides both an overview of the general similarities of the continent and also enough detail to flesh out the realities of tribalism and corruption, as well as illustrating the variations that inevitably occur in a continent of sovereign states.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-60131-3: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83576-0: £75.00/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
library reference 343
Ideology and Social Change in Latin America
Corruption in Developing Countries
Edited by June Nash, Juan Corradi and Hobart Spalding
Ronald Wraith and Edgar Simpkins
First published in 1977, this reissue contains original articles by contemporary leading scholars in the field Latin American politics on a range of topics including: working class organisation, populism and US labour imperialism. It will be of interest to anthropologists, students of political science and specialists in Latin American studies.
First published in 1963, this study of corruption in the developing countries of Africa takes as its point of comparison Britain, pre-1880, as the authors question whether Britain’s experience in overcoming corruption can throw any light the means of overcoming corruption in contemporary developing countries.
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 314pp Hb: 978-0-415-60132-0: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83575-3: £75.00/14
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 212pp Hb: 978-0-415-60145-0: £65.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83572-2: £65.00/14
The Afro-Asian States and their Problems
Conflict Intervention in the Third World
K.M. Panikkar
Edited by Mohammed Ayoob
This reissue of Sandar Panikkar’s 1959 book is based upon a series of lectures given at the Institut d’Etude de Development Economique et Social, which spotlights the problems faced by the multitude of African and Asian states which achieved independence between 1945 and 1957. From Asia, the author discusses the plight of India, Pakistan, Burma, Indonesia, Ceylon, Vietnam, Cambodia, laos, Syria and Lebanon whilst in Africa he assesses the independence of the Sudan, Tunisia, Morroco and Ghana. The problems faced by these countries have many similarities, not least the need to develop systems of political organisation, administrative services necessary for a modern government and the need to completely reorganise their economy.
First published in 1980, this volume brings together seven case studies of regional conflicts in the Third World and great, particularly super, power involvement in those conflicts. While a number of factors relating to the origins and course of such conflicts and great power motivations are bound to be unique to each conflict, the book illustrates that there are certain common denominators, both in terms of regional conflicts per se and great power involvements in them. The book contains considerable material for further argument and deals with many of the most important and complicated aspects of contemporary international relations.
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 104pp Hb: 978-0-415-60141-2: £60.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83574-6: £60.00/14
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 276pp Hb: 978-0-415-60179-5: £75.00/11
Africa and Europe
Regional Security in the Third World
From Partition to Independence or Dependence?
Case Studies from Southeast Asia and the Middle East
Edited by Amadu Sesay
Edited by Mohammed Ayoob
It is now over 100 years since the Berlin Conference of 1884 which started the ‘Scramble for Africa’ whereby the various European powers carved up the African Continent between themselves. During the last century the relationship between Africa and Europe has changed dramatically – from a colonial to a post-colonial relationship, with, more recently, new patterns emerging as the Communist bloc has developed increasingly strong links with some countries and as the EEC as an institution has got more involved. First published in 1986, this book explores how the relationship between Africa and Europe has changed over the last hundred years, assesses the current state of relations and discusses how the relationship may develop in the future.
This reissue, first published in 1986, argues that there is a radical difference between the use of the term ‘Regional Security’ when applied to the Third World rather than the developed world. It explores the concept of regional security and shows how items which make for regional security in the developed world – such as strong cohesive states or the linking of a state’s security to the international security system – are absent in the Third World. It goes on to analyse these arguments in relation to a series of case studies from the Middle East and South-East Asia, arguing that security in Third World states often means security for the prevailing regime, which is often narrowly based, and which sees clinging to power as its main objective. It concludes by examining organisations such as the ASEAN and the Arab League which were set up to strengthen regional security and attempts to assess the successes and failures of these organisations.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 296pp Hb: 978-0-415-60180-1: £75.00/11
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 264pp Hb: 978-0-415-60144-3: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83573-9: £70.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
344 library reference
Mark Katz First published in 1982, this study traces the development of Soviet military thinking on the Third World and assesses its importance for the conduct of Soviet foreign policy. Changes in Soviet military thought often reflect changes in Soviet attitudes towards and expectations from involvement in Third World conflicts. This work from Dr. Katz meditates upon the changing role of the USSR in postwar Third World conflicts, with particular emphasis upon the Brezhnev era and the way in which US setbacks in the Third World impacted upon Soviet foreign policy and changing attitudes to the Third World. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 190pp Hb: 978-0-415-60183-2: £65.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83564-7: £65.00/14
Military Regimes and Development A Comparative Analysis in African Societies Olatunde Odetola First published in 1982, this book aims to examine the role that ruling military governments have played in African development. Dr Odetola discusses military organisational values and skills in modernisation and argues that the evocation and application of these values and skills depends on the character of the leadership of individual ruling juntas, their degree of professional training, proximity to civilian society and so on. He also investigates the relationship between the ruling military and existing social classes. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 210pp Hb: 978-0-415-60184-9: £65.00/11
Social Policy in Developing Countries Arthur Livingstone This reissue, first published in 1969, is a study of contemporary social policy in developing countries, which places the emphasis upon the human needs and requirements for social change which confront any people and any government, wherever their political and international affiliations lie, whatever their economic and social convictions may be. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 130pp Hb: 978-0-415-60185-6: £60.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83552-4: £60.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
A Third World Proletariat? Peter C. Lloyd This reissue, first published in 1982, is concerned with the rapid contemporary metropolitan development in the Third World, at a time when manufacturing and public service sectors were expending at a terrific rate. Nevertheless, the phenomenal growth of the metropolitan cities brings with it an increase in social equalities, such that two thirds of the population of these cities may be described as the ‘urban poor’. This book concerns itself with the question: Can we describe these urban poor as a ‘proletariat’, or are such Western class terms totally inappropriate to the development of the Third World? Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 140pp Hb: 978-0-415-60186-3: £60.00/11
Power and Independence Urban Africans’ Perception of Social Inequality Peter C. Lloyd First published in 1974, this study, by a social anthropologist who has lived, taught and researched in Nigeria, explores how the Yoruba of Nigeria living in Ibadan and Lagos perceive the society in which they live. Their views on stratification and social inequality in particular are related to traditional Yoruba concepts and to their experiences in education, migration and present social and occupational relationships. It is shown that, in general, these recent migrants and city dwellers see their society as open; they emphasise achievement rather than class opposition. Recent protest – industrial strikes in Lagos, the Agbekoya peasant rebellion in Ibadan – are assessed in the light of these attitudes. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 266pp Hb: 978-0-415-60190-0: £70.00/11
Proletarianisation in the Third World Studies in the Creation of a Labour Force Under Dependent Capitalism Edited by Barry Munslow and Henry Finch First published in 1984, this collection of twelve case studies examines the emergence of a free wage-labour force in all regions of the third world. Although the struggle and conflict through which the proletariat has achieved a degree of class consciousness is not neglected, the more dominant theme is that of the process and techniques which have created a working class on the capitalist periphery. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 334pp Hb: 978-0-415-60192-4: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83551-7: £75.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
The Third World in Soviet Military Thought
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
library reference 345
Beyond the Sociology of Development
Poverty, Class and Gender in Rural Africa
Economy and Society in Latin America and Africa
A Tanzanian Case Study
Edited by Ivar Oxaal, Tony Barnett and David Booth
John Sender and Sheila Smith
Conceived as a response to the economic naïvety and implicit metropolitan bias of many 1950s and 60s studies of ‘the sociology of development’, this volume, first published in 1975, provides actual field studies and theoretical reviews to indicate the directions which a conceptually more adequate study of developing societies should take.
Focussing on a Fieldwork study of the West Usambaras in Tanzania, this study, first published in 1990, deals with processes of class formation and capitalist accumulation, and the dynamics of rural poverty and gender relations. Arguing that rural differentiation is systematically reinforced by the socialist state, the authors offer a critique of government intervention and discuss alternative, more effective forms of policy.
Much of the book reflects strongly the influence of Andre Gunder Frank, but the contributors adopt a critical attitude to his ideas, applying them in empirical situations within such African and American countries as Kenya, Guyana, Tanzania and Peru. Others pursue the lines of enquiry opened up by Latin American theories of economic ‘dependency’ and by the new school of French economic anthropology.
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 210pp Hb: 978-0-415-60195-5: £65.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83548-7: £65.00/14
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 310pp Hb: 978-0-415-60193-1: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83550-0: £75.00/14
The Development of Capitalism in Africa
Urban Social Movements in the Third World
‘Sender and Smith have provided much to argue about and their book can be recommended as a lively treatment of its subject and not least for its caustic rebukes to the fainthearted. Anyone wearied by the writings of neo-Marxists, dependency theorists and populists on Africa can find relief here.’ – Times Higher Education Supplement
John Sender and Sheila Smith
Edited by Frans Schuurman and Ton Van Naerssen, Radboud Nijmegen University, the Netherlands This reissue, initially published in 1989, considers the upsurge of locally-based movements attempting to improve living conditions in Third-World cities throughout the 1980s. The book presents qualitative, comparative research on the dynamics and constraints of these urban social movements, in a cross-cultural framework, using case studies from a variety of Latin American, African and Asian countries. As more democratic-type regimes establish themselves in the Third World, the possibilities for collective organisations and actions increase. Urban social movements therefore are playing an increasingly important role in the habitat of the poor. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 234pp Hb: 978-0-415-60194-8: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83549-4: £70.00/14
First published in 1986, this work challenges underdevelopment analyses of Africa’s past experiences and future prospects, and builds upon a very wide range of recent historical research to argue that the impact of Capitalism has resulted in economic progress and significant improvements in living standards. In marked contrast to the dependency approach, they propose that the important political and economic differences between the experiences of developing countries should be stressed and analysed. The argument is supported by a detailed look at the emergence since 1900 of capitalist social relations of production in nine different countries. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-60196-2: £65.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83547-0: £65.00/14
Assembling for Development The Maquila Industry in Mexico and the United States Leslie Sklair First published in 1989, this book focuses upon the phenomenon of export-led industrialisation fuelled by foreign investment and technology. He concentrates on Mexico, where US companies have been taking advantage of inexpensive labour to establish ‘maquila’ factories that assemble US parts for export. Through this detailed study of the maquila industry, Sklair charts the progress from the political imperialism of colonial days to the economic imperialism of today.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-60197-9: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83546-3: £75.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
346 library reference
Harold Brookfield Rather than being a book about ‘development’ per se, this work, first published in 1975, is instead a book about ideas about development, designed for those drawn by a concern over social injustice into the development field. In a selective review of theory, which gives particular emphasis to the spatial dimension in Western, Marxist and neo-Marxist thought, Harold Brookfield traces the evolution of ideas about world inequality and the problem of development from the days before the ‘underdeveloped countries’ were considered to be a major problem, through the years dominated by ‘economic growth’, to the more searching approaches of the contemporary era. The central argument of the book is that development is a ‘totality’, which cannot properly be understood by separation into parts. The ‘developed’ and ‘underdeveloped’ countries constitute one interdependent system, and change in one cannot be understood without consideration of the other. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 250pp Hb: 978-0-415-60203-7: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83545-6: £70.00/14
Development and Underdevelopment A Profile of the Third World John P. Cole Initially published in 1987, this work deals with crucial aspects of development, including disparities in global patterns of production and consumption. John Cole examines the exhaustion of nonrenewable resources and the destruction of the natural environment and, on the potentially positive side, the effects of international transactions both in the form of development aid and trade. Rather than offering clear and definite answers – of which there are none – the book is designed rather to serve as a basis for discussion and to provide guidelines to the further study of specific aspects of global development. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 114pp Hb: 978-0-415-60204-4: £60.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83543-2: £60.00/14
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
The Political Economy of Underdevelopment S.B.D. de Silva First published in 1982, this reissue deals with the theory of underdevelopment, as Dr. de Silva attempts a synthesis between the internal and external aspects of underdevelopment and, in the Marxist tradition, focuses on the impact of the external on the internal as the dominant reality. Viewing underdevelopment as a problem in the non-transformation to capitalism, this analysis is in terms of the character of the dominant capital and of the dominant classes. Underdevelopment thus encompasses the ‘traditional’ peasant economy and also the export sector where the ‘modernizing’ influence of colonialism was felt. The book finally considers how the contemporary internationalization of capital affected the economies of the Third World. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 656pp Hb: 978-0-415-60205-1: £110.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83542-5: £110.00/14
Latin American Theories of Development and Underdevelopment Cristóbal Kay, Institute of Social Studies, the Netherlands Upon its publication in 1989, this was the first systematic and comprehensive analysis of the Latin American School of Development and an invaluable guide to the major Third World contribution to development theory. The four major strands in the work of Latin American Theorists are: structuralism, internal colonialism, marginality and dependency. Exploring all four in detail, and the interconnections between them, Cristobal Kay highlights the developed world’s over-reliance on, and partial knowledge of, dependency theory in its approach to development issues, and analyses the first major challenges to neo-classical and modernisation theories from the Third World. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 316pp Hb: 978-0-415-60206-8: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83541-8: £75.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Interdependent Development
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
library reference 347
Development and Underdevelopment in Historical Perspective Populism, Nationalism and Industrialisation Gavin Kitching ‘This is an excellent book. It is very clearly written; students can and should read it. Perhaps its greatest virtue is to extend the range (both in time and conceptually) of what is to count as development theory, well beyond the narrow economistic concerns of both mainstream and much Marxist writing.’ – Journal of Development Studies How do the intellectual origins and historical background of western and other theories of development affect their relevance to contemporary Third-World conditions? This is the central question behind Gavin Kitching’s examination of ‘development studies’, first published in 1982, from its origins in the late 1940s through to the contemporary era. While presenting the contemporary ‘radical orthodoxy’ of development studies, Kitching argues that these theories are continuations of much older traditions of populist and neo-populist thought. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-60207-5: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83540-1: £70.00/14
A New Concept of Development Basic Tenets François Perroux First published in 1983, François Perroux’s A New Concept of Development analyses the major paradox of our era: the desire for progress and the mistrust of its consequences. The authors argues that the approach to the question of development may be the key to understanding both the present and what the future brings, representing a pattern which will seek to shape man’s potential to his designs. By analysing the ideas and theories propounded by the economic approach the author’s aim is to clarify both the meaning and direction of research in development. A scientific, oriented economy and efficient strategies should and must be the two components of one and the same momentum, required to go beyond the perilous paradox of our era. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 220pp Hb: 978-0-415-60210-5: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83538-8: £70.00/14
Socialism and Underdevelopment Ken Post and Philip Wright
Development Theory Four Critical Studies Edited by David Lehmann The studies in this book, first published in 1979, offer an all-encompassing contemporary critique of the sociology, politics and economics of development as they are ‘conventionally’ taught and disseminated. They also seek to outline the beginnings of a new approach, while not sparing from criticism the simplistic of contemporary radical theories. The reissue will prove of significant interest to the teaching of development studies at both undergraduate and post-graduate levels. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 116pp Hb: 978-0-415-60208-2: £60.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83539-5: £60.00/14
In this book, first published in 1989, Ken Post and Phil Wright provide a critical analysis of socialist construction in underdeveloped countries. Pointing out that all the socialist revolutions of the twentieth century have occurred in underdeveloped peripheral capitalist countries, they focus on the relationship between socialism and underdevelopment. They bring together the insights of both development theory and the political economy of socialism, and draw upon their direct experience of the state socialist societies as diverse as North Korea, Yugoslavia, Vietnam, and the Soviet Union. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 216pp Hb: 978-0-415-60214-3: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83537-1: £70.00/14
Theories of Development Peter Preston Dr Preston’s book, first published in 1982, presents a critical history of development studies since the Second World War, linking the recent, neo-Marxist, debate with the whole tradition in the field, going back to the work of economists like Arthur Lewis. He identifies a series of ‘schools’ and evaluates their contribution, supplying in each case a careful analysis, informed by the sociology of knowledge, of the work of its leading theorists. His final assessment draws on the critical theory of Habermas, arguing that social theorising is essentially practical; a matter of the construction, criticism and comparative ranking of ideologies, and that theorists should therefore consider what it makes sense for them to do or say, given their circumstances and the problems they address.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 312pp Hb: 978-0-415-60215-0: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83536-4: £75.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
348 library reference
New Trends in Development Theory
The Origins of Economic Inequality Between Nations
Essays in Development and Social Theory
A Critique of Western Theories on Development and Underdevelopment
Peter Preston The theme of this work, first published in 1985, is the exchange between issues of development and problems of social theory. They provide preliminary analysis of the multiplicity of social-theoretic arguments in development theory and their implications for social theory in general. The book will be of interest to all those interested in the contemporary ‘restructuring’ of social theory and to theorists of development who are rethinking their concerns in a period of pessimism and doubt. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 216pp Hb: 978-0-415-60216-7: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83535-7: £70.00/14
Rethinking Development Essays on Development and Southeast Asia Peter Preston First published in 1987, this volume stresses the importance of development studies for sociology, as P. W. Preston argues that this field of study is emerging from the technical social scientific ghetto back into the mainstream of the ‘classical tradition’ of social theorizing, represented by Marx, Weber and Durkheim. Preston discusses the position of development studies in relation to the wider group of the social sciences in general and to sociology in particular. Using examples mainly from the study of Southeast Asia, he looks at the diversity of available ‘modes of social theoretic engagement’ and considers the work of the colonial administrator scholar, the humanist academic scholar, and the scholar who theorises on behalf of the planners, discusses the mode of political writing, and Marxian analyses of development; and considers the particular problems surrounding the elites of post-colonial ‘nation states’. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 280pp Hb: 978-0-415-60217-4: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83534-0: £75.00/14
Carlos Ramirez-Faria First published in 1991 this text provides an incisive analysis of theories concerning the origins of economic inequality between nations. Central to the author’s investigation is the concept of underdevelopment, and a focus on successive Western ‘systems of conceptualisation’ of the relationship between the west and the rest of the world. The first part of the book concerns the Marx/Engels theory of the Asiatic mode of production, and the anti-Imperialist reaction against Eurocentrisim initiated by the theoretical synthesis of J. A. Hobson. This is followed by an examination of the postWorld War II era, particularly the evolution of development studies and the differing versions of dependency theory. The author concludes with an analysis of the most recent reactions against economic imperialism and dependency theory, and concludes with an assessment of their implications for the further economic development of today’s Third World. Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 334pp Hb: 978-0-415-60219-8: £75.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83533-3: £75.00/14
The Sociology and Politics of Development A Theoretical Study Baidya Nath Varma Originally published in 1980, this work answers the crucial question of how social change should be guided in the developing countries. Professor Varma begins by posing the problems of the general scope of modernization and the general criteria used in the modernization process. He examines carefully some of the models that have been used for this purpose in the past, providing extensive summaries of the views on modernization of theorists in various social science disciplines, including sociology, politics, economics, and anthropology, and stresses the importance of these views in guiding policy decisions. The book concludes with a comparison of the development processes of the United States, the Soviet Union, China, Japan and India.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Economics November 2010: 234x156: 238pp Hb: 978-0-415-60220-4: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83532-6: £70.00/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
library reference 349
30-VOLUME set
Routledge Library Editions: Iran Various Routledge Library Editions: Iran will re-issue works originally published between 1890 and 2005. Volumes will be available to purchase individually, or as sub-disciplinary mini-sets focussing on economics as well as the history, politics, sociology, literature and linguistics of Iran. Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 15884pp Hb: 978-0-415-57033-6: £2500.00/11
Mini-set a
Mini-set a
Iran Since the Revolution
Modern Iran
Sepehr Zabir
L.P. Elwell-Sutton
Since the turn of the century Iran has experienced three major political upheavals in the struggle to democratize her political systems. The last revolution inaugurated an era of unprecedented turmoil and instead of fulfilling its democratic aim, paved the way for an even more despotic theocracy. The domestic and external ramifications of the revolution are examined in detail; in particular the rise of the anti-American feeling which culminated in the hostage crisis. In conclusion, an analysis is offered of the instrumentalities of power available to the Islamic Republic, and several scenarios are explored in which Iran’s competing forces may converge to determine whether this third revolution will finally succeed in subordinating political authority to popular democratic consent.
This volume shows the progress and achievements of Iran up to the 1940s within the setting of her ancient history and her strategic position in the world today. The author discusses Iran’s vital position as the dividing line between the East and the West and how Iran drew from and contributed to both these cultures, without losing her own individuality. It is this cultural influence, the author argues, rather than any political strength that has enabled her to survive. Much of the information is taken from sources not available in English or any other language other than Persian.
Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 260pp Hb: 978-0-415-61069-8: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83196-0: £70.00/14
Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 250pp Hb: 978-0-415-60838-1: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83320-9: £70.00/14
Mini-set a
Persia
Mini-set a
Richard Frye
Iraq and Iran Jasim M. Abdulghani It focuses particularly on the period between 1969 and 1984, a time that saw both the rise of the Ba’th party in Iraq and Khomeini’s return to power in Iran. These changes did much to escalate tensions. The Ba’th party’s ideological, socialist regime and its emphasis on political secular concerns stood in marked contrast to Iran under Khomeini and his efforts to spread an Islamic revolution among the nation’s Shiite majority. The author discusses how these differences have affected three long-term problems: Iraq’s and Iran’s rivalry for dominance in the Arabian Gulf region; disputes over the Shatt al-Arab waterway, which serves as a boundary between the two nations; and the Kurdish rebellion in Iraq, supported by Iran. The volume also looks at the most recent episodes of crisis and analyzes the evolution of the Iran-Iraq war and its implications both regionally and globally.
This volume is a fascinating portrait of a part of the world uneasily balanced between many loyalties – East and West, European and Arabic. The coronation of the Shah in 1967 marked the end of the need for foreign aid, and Iran emerged from her struggles to become the leading nation in the Middle East. Written before the crippling Iran-Iraq war broke out, this book looked forward to Iran’s great future, which, in the author’s opinion, could only be achieved if she broke with her traditions to form a new material and spiritual synthesis. Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 126pp Hb: 978-0-415-60841-1: £60.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83319-3: £60.00/14
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 15884pp Hb: 978-0-415-60832-9: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83214-1: £70.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
350 library reference Mini-set a
Mini-set a
Persia and its People
The Iran-Iraq War
Ella C. Sykes
M.S. El-Azhary
This volume gives a popular description of Iran and was the result of the author’s extensive travelling in the country and close knowledge of its people and customs over a period of 3 years at the turn of the nineteenth century.
The Iran-Iraq war broke out in September 1980. It brought death and suffering to hundreds of thousands of people on both sides and devastated the economies of both countries. It also increased international tensions by precipitating new alliances and rearrangement of forces in the already turbulent Middle East. The focus of this book is on the historical, economic and political dimensions of the war between Iraq and Iran. It examines many aspects of what proved to be a very complex conflict; including its long history, its present economic and political setting, the different responses to the war by outside parties and its regional and world implications.
Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 370pp Hb: 978-0-415-60846-6: £90.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83314-8: £90.00/14
Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 154pp Hb: 978-0-415-60833-6: £60.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83322-3: £60.00/14
Mini-set a
Persia and the Victorians Marzieh Gail The impact of Persian life and literature upon Victorian England was tremendous. It found its public demonstration in the visit of the Shah, but the number of men of letters who turned to the Persian classics for inspiration were as numerous as they were great: William Jones, Charles Murray, Edward Browne, George Borrow, Richard Burton, Edward Palmer and, of course, Fitzgerald, translator of the Rubaiyat.
The Persian Gulf Arnold Wilson This volume records the history of the Persian Gulf from the very earliest records until the 1920s. It records the rise and fall of ancient Empires and discusses the rule of Turks and Arabs. It chronicles the Western maritime nations – the Portuguese, Dutch, French and British – outstrip one another in trade and influence.
Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 178pp Hb: 978-0-415-60842-8: £60.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83318-6: £60.00/14
Mini-set a
Studies in Ancient Persian History P. Kershasp
Mini-set a
Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 344pp Hb: 978-0-415-60849-7: £80.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83312-4: £80.00/14
This volume lays the foundation of a ‘correct’ view of ancient Persian history, which, in the author’s opinion, had hitherto been approached from a ‘biased standpoint.’ It presents a survey of ancient and modern historians such as Gibbon, Malcolm and Rawlinson and critiques their work – either for having too much partiality for Greek and Latin writers, not being conversant with the literature of the East or not doing justice to the ancient Persians. Arab and Persian historians are also discussed and social, literary, legal, religious, economic and political questions examined.
Mini-set a
Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 198pp Hb: 978-0-415-60843-5: £60.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83317-9: £60.00/14
Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 280pp Hb: 978-0-415-60844-2: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83315-5: £70.00/14
The Struggle for Persia Donald Stuart This volume is an account of the journey the author made between Eastern Russia (via Tabriz) to Teheran at the turn of the twentieth century. This is not just a travelogue, however, but a lament for the loss of British ‘prestige’ and power in the region to Russia.
Mini-set a
Persia History and Heritage Edited by John A. Boyle Series: Routledge Library Editions This book traces the history and culture of Persia, one of the world’s oldest civilisations, from pre-history down to the present time.
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 120pp Hb: 978-0-415-61335-4: £60.00/11
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
library reference 351 Mini-set B
Mini-set B
A Concise Dictionary of the Persian Language
In Search of Omar Khayyam
E.H. Palmer The aim of this dictionary was to provide reference of all the words in use in colloquial Persian, particularly for beginners. Especially for the candidates in the Indian Civil Service, all the words in the Gulistán and other prescribed text-books were also included. Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 15884pp Hb: 978-0-415-60856-5: £80.00/11
Mini-set B
A Persian Anthology Being Translations from the Persian Edward Granville Browne This volume contains thirty-five translations of Persian poetry, arranged in five groups as well as two examples of prose translations from Arabic, which offer examples of ‘rhymed prose’ of which the earliest examples are to be found in the Koran. To help the reader, a substantial introduction on Persian poetry is included, as well as a personal memoir of the author by J B Atkins. Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 176pp Hb: 978-0-415-60850-3: £60.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83310-0: £60.00/14
Ali Dashti Khayyam has been the subject of speculation on the part of literary critics ever since Edward Fitzgerald published his own version of the Rubaiyat in 1859. This edition represented the first opportunity to study in English the work of Khayyam by a Persian scholar. There is no conclusive evidence to prove which of the many quatrains attributed to Khayyam are authentic. Ali Dashti therefore constructs a likeness of the poet from references found in the works of writers of his day or immediately after, and from Khayyam’s own works on philosophy, mathematics and astronomy, of which the authenticity is not questioned. Khayyam emerges as a widely read and broadminded scholar, immersed in his own studies, cautious and moderate, averse to committing himself on controversial questions. Using this portrait Dashti draws up a list of some hundred quatrains which are in keeping with Khayyam’s character. Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 278pp Hb: 978-0-415-60851-0: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83309-4: £70.00/14
Mini-set B
Indo-Iranian Studies Being Commemorative Papers contributed by European, American and Indian Scholars Various Series: Routledge Library Editions
Mini-set B
Ibn Yamin 100 Short Poems The Persian Text With Paraphrase E.H. Rodwell This volume gives a brief outline of the life of Ibn Yamin (who died in 1367), based on the biography of Rashid-i-Yásimi and the background of his writing at a time when the Sultans of Khurásán at a time when they were constantly at war with one another. This version of the Qita’s was collated from the 1890 Bhopál edition with that of the Calcutta edition of 1865. The ‘Fragments’ are arranged alphabetically.
Throughout his life the Shams-ul-Ullema devoted himself to advancing the Zoroastrian Faith, not only as a priest and teacher, but also as a writer. This volume of papers is authored by an international group of scholars and covers the history, philosophy, literature and language of Persia and the Indo-Iranians. Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 312pp Hb: 978-0-415-60974-6: £80.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83239-4: £80.00/14
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 66pp Hb: 978-0-415-60945-6: £50.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83262-2: £50.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
352 library reference Mini-set B
Mini-set B
Javid-Nama
The Persian Language
Muhammad Iqbal
Reuben Levy
Sir Muhammad Iqbal (1873–1938) was not only amongst the leading political figures of his time, but regarded by many as the spiritual father of Pakistan and a great champion of the reform movement of modern Islam. He was also a poet, in both Urdu and Persian. The recurrent theme of his poems is the infinite potentiality of man, as partner with God in shaping the destiny of the universe. As an ardent Muslim, Iqbal saw the realization of mankind’s future in a union of Islamic peoples, unfettered by the bonds of separate nationhood, fully liberated from the chains of imperial domination. The Javid-nama, commonly acknowledged as his greatest work, develops this theme within the frame-work of the ‘Ascension’ story. In imitation of the Prophet of Islam, the poet soars through the spheres, encountering on his heavenly journey many great figures of history with whom he converses. The resemblance to Dante’s Divine Comedy is obvious.
This book describes the structure of modern Persia, showing the methods by which it conveys meaning in sentences and connected passages and illustrating its special characteristics. As an introduction there is a brief account of Persia, its inhabitants, their occupations and beliefs; some attempt is made also to show how the language has been modified by the events of Persian history. A section is devoted to representative writings.
Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 160pp Hb: 978-0-415-60853-4: £60.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83303-2: £60.00/14
Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 134pp Hb: 978-0-415-60855-8: £60.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83301-8: £60.00/14
Mini-set C
Christians in Persia Assyrians, Armenians, Roman Catholics and Protestants Robin Waterfield Series: Routledge Library Editions
Mini-set B
Papers from the Seminar on Fasahat and Balaghat in Classical Persian Literature Edited by Julie Meisami and Michael Beard This issue of Edebiyât discusses topics ranging from medieval grammar, prosody and rhetoric to computer-assisted techniques of analysis. It also features excerpts from Michael Cooperson’s translation of Abdelfattah Kilito’s L’Auteur et ses doubles. Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 166pp Hb: 978-0-415-61003-2: £60.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83235-6: £60.00/14
When it was originally published this book broke new ground in presenting one continuous narrative of the history of Christians in Persia from the second century A.D to the 1970s. The material gathered here was previously only to be found in obscure books, manuscripts and foreign periodicals. Christians in Persia shows the intricate history of the period concerned; the personalities of the rulers and the ruled; the difficult task of the missionaries; their successes and failures and the consequences of their efforts. All this is related to the wider history of the country and to the expansion of Christianity in the East. Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 196pp Hb: 978-0-415-61048-3: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83219-6: £70.00/14
Mini-set C
The Divine Songs of Zarathushtra
Mini-set B
The Epic of the Kings Shah-Nama the National Epic of Persia Ferdowsi ‘Among the many national poets of historical Persia, Ferdowsi is perhaps the greatest...In this superb translation of the epic, the Western reader would not fail to discern clear equivalents of chapters in Genesis, The Odyssey, Paradise Lost or the Canterbury Tales.’ Islamic Review The Shah-nama is the national epic poem of Persia. Written in the tenth century it contains the country’s myths, legends and historic reminiscences. This edition makes available a valuable prose translation selecting the most representative parts of the original including the stories of Rustum, the giant hero and his son Sohrab.
Cyprian Rice Zarathusthtra brought about important religious reform in Iran, giving a definitely moral character and direction to religion whilst at the same time preaching the doctrine of monotheism, which offered an eternal foundation of reality to goodness as an ideal of perfection. This volume provides a substantial introduction on the life and doctrines of Zarathushtra and compares the development of religion in India with that of Iran. Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 82pp Hb: 978-0-415-61448-1: £50.00/11
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 454pp Hb: 978-0-415-60852-7: £90.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83308-7: £90.00/14
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
library reference 353 Mini-set C
Mini-set D
The Nasirean Ethics
Iran and the International Community
Nasir ad-Din Tusi Series: Routledge Library Editions The Nasirean Ethics is the best known ethical digest to be composed in medieval Persia, if not in all mediaeval Islam. It appeared initially in 633/1235 when T?s? was already a celebrated scholar, scientist, politico-religious propagandist. The work has a special significance as being composed by an outstanding figure at a crucial time in the history he was himself helping to shape: some twenty years later T?s? was to cross the greatest psychological watershed in Islamic civilization, playing a leading part in the capture of Baghdad and the extinction of the generally acknowledged Caliphate there. In this work the author is primarily concerned with the criteria of human behaviour: first in terms of space and priority allotted, at the individual level, secondly, at the economic level and thirdly at the political level. Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 350pp Hb: 978-0-415-61047-6: £80.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83221-9: £80.00/14
Anoush Ehteshami Series: Routledge Library Editions In this book experts examine the main features of Iran’s foreign policy from 1980–1990, assessing relations with the UN, the superpowers, Europe, the GCC and Iraq. Although the Islamic revolution made Iran a significant force in the international arena, it is argued that the ending of the Cold War and the rise of Iraq as the dominant power in the Gulf are now creating a very different set of foreign policy challenges and options. Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 210pp Hb: 978-0-415-61051-3: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83216-5: £70.00/14
Mini-set D
The Persian Gulf and the West Charles Kupchan
Mini-set C
Series: Routledge Library Editions
The Persian Sufis Cyprian Rice Series: Routledge Library Editions The Sufi phenomenon is not easy to sum up or define. This book is concerned primarily with the Persian mystics and looks at the history of the S?fi movement, the mystical states, fundamentals of Persian mysticism and S?fi practices. Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 102pp Hb: 978-0-415-61026-1: £60.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83227-1: £60.00/14
This volume provides a broadly comparative and historical reexamination of the fundamental strategic dilemmas that confront the Western world in the Persian Gulf region. This systematic study of how the West has defined and dealt with its security interests in this region reveals three central strategic dilemmas: strategy versus capability, globalism versus regionalism, and unilateralism versus collectivism. The first part of the book focuses on US policy with particular emphasis on the Iranian Revolution and the Soviet invasion of Afghanistan. The author explains why there has been a persistent gap between American perceptions of the Middle East and the political and strategic realities of the region. The second part of the book examines the frustrated efforts of NATO members to form a cooperative response to their collective interests in the region. Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-61054-4: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83212-7: £70.00/14
Mini-set D
Iran The Illusion of Power Robert Graham Series: Routledge Library Editions This book examines the cycle of the oil boom and the years that led up to it – from the rural and essentially backward nature of the country to the euphoria of 1973 when the Shah seriously talked of Iran reaching the Great Civilisation, where by the 1990s Iran would be the world’s fifth power. And then finally through to the loss of control over expenditure, the cancellation of ambitious projects and eventual disillusionment with all the attendant problems of expectations and increased social and political tension. A comprehensive analysis of the system of government in Iran is provided in Part Three of the book, demonstrating that this has created a repressed stability, incapable of promoting social and economic progress.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 228pp Hb: 978-0-415-61053-7: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83215-8: £70.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
354 library reference Mini-set D
Mini-set D
The Security of the Persian Gulf
The State and Revolution in Iran
Edited by Hossein Amirsadeghi
Hossein Bashiriyeh
Series: Routledge Library Editions
Series: Routledge Library Editions
The Persian Gulf, important because of its vast energy resources, emerged into the limelight of geopolitics at the time of the British Labour government’s policy of withdrawal from East of Suez in 1968. Before 1968 it had been recognised that the Gulf lay in the legitimate sphere of influence of Britain, while the United States exerted its influence in the two pivotal littoral states of Iran and Saudi Arabia. The Soviets had been gaining influence in Iraq ever since the overthrow of the monarchy in 1958 and the Chinese were also fishing for influence by their support of the Popular Front for the Liberation of the Arabian Gulf. This book examines the political axes of the various super-powers with Iran and the Persian Gulf and discusses the implications of these problems for the issue of security in the region.
This book analyses the distant and proximate causes of the 1978 revolution in Iran as well as the dynamics of power which it set in motion. The volume explains the complex and far-reaching processes which produced the revolution, beginning in the late nineteenth century. In explaining the more proximate causes of the revolution, the book analyses the nature of the old regime and its internal contradictions; the emergence of some fundamental conflicts of interest between the state and the upper class; the economic crisis of 1975–8 which made possible a revolutionary mass immobilisation; and the emergence of a new religious interpretation of political authority and the unusual spread of the ideology of political Islam among a segment of the modern intelligentsia. The volume relates the diverse aspects of class, ideology and economic structure in order to provide an understanding of the political processes.
Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 314pp Hb: 978-0-415-61050-6: £80.00/11
Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 214pp Hb: 978-0-415-61336-1: £70.00/11
Mini-set D
The Soviet Union and Revolutionary Iran
Mini-set D
Tribe and State in Iran and Afghanistan
Aryeh Yodfat Series: Routledge Library Editions Relations between the USSR and Iran during the period from the overthrow of the Shah and the establishment of the Islamic Republic up to early 1983 are reviewed in this book. It begins with a brief survey of Russian-Persian relations in earlier years, with a focus on the developments that served as a background to the current events and examines Soviet attitudes and reactions to Iran’s foreign and internal policy and highlights the way in which the Soviets often raise events of which they do not approve in order to draw Iran closer to them. Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 178pp Hb: 978-0-415-61058-2: £60.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83206-6: £60.00/14
Series: Routledge Library Editions In 1978 and 1979 revolutions in Afghanistan and Iran marked a shift in the balance of power in South West Asia and the world. Then, as now, the world is once more aware that tribalism is no anachronism in a struggle for political and cultural self-determination. This books provides historical and anthropological perspectives necessary to the eventual understanding of the events surrounding the revolutions. Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 490pp Hb: 978-0-415-61056-8: £90.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83208-0: £90.00/14
Mini-set E
The Soviet Union and the Arabian Peninsula Aryeh Yodfat Series: Routledge Library Editions Contents: Preface. List of Abbreviations 1. Arabia and the Gulf – Soviet Approaches, Successes and Failures (1917–1975) 2. Soviet Retreats in the Region and Advances Around It (1975–1978) 3. Shadow Game in the Gulf (January 1979–September 1980) 4. Between Stability and Upheaval (September 1980–Early 1982). Bibliography. Index Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 204pp Hb: 978-0-415-61057-5: £70.00/11 eBook: 978-0-203-83207-3: £70.00/14
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Agriculture, Poverty and Reform in Iran Mohammad Amad This book assesses the economic consequences of land reform, focusing particularly on its effect on the living standards of the rural poor. Amid describes a ‘biomodal’ system of large and small farms that emerged after the reform. Large farms, with government support, modernized and grew more profitable cash crops, whereas small farms found difficulty in obtaining credit and continued to rely on traditional techniques and staple food crops. Land reform was not, the author argues, a success for the majority of the Iranian rural population who experienced virtually no improvement in living standards and a growth of rural inequality as a result. Routledge «Market: Middle Eastern Studies March 2011: 234x156: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-61438-2: £60.00/11
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Mini-set D
order now!
Richard Tapper
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
library reference 355
Armed Conflict Database from The International Institute for Strategic Studies (IISS) www.iiss.org/acd
The IISS Armed Conflict database (ACD) is an authoritative online source of data and independent analysis on current and recent conflicts. Compiled by the IISS Transnational Threats and Political Risk Programme, the ACD provides an interactive, objective and user-friendly source of information on more than seventy armed conflicts, including terrorist activities.
Coverage includes: • Quarterly Conflict Review – analyzes the latest developments in the conflict • Annual Update – a summary of the main events during the year • Political Status – examines whether combatants are in conflict or negotiations • Fatalities – maintains a check on the human cost of the conflict • Weapons – overviews acquisitions, the general military balance between combatants and more • Non-State Armed Groups – a selected list • Historical Background – a researched historical background paper • Timeline – a constantly updated timeline relating to the conflict • Links to citations of key articles on the conflict • Full-Text Access to major reports, NGO documents and other key materials.
30 day free trials available for libraries and institutions
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
For free trials, pricing information or to subscribe, email reference@routledge.com quoting ref: JFM11
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
356 Routledge Trade/General Interest – relegion 2nd Edition student reference
Islam: The Basics Colin Turner, Durham University, UK Series: The Basics This book provides an introduction to the Islamic faith, examining the doctrines of the religion, the practises of Muslims and the history and significance of Islam in modern contexts. Key topics covered include: • the Qur’an and its teachings • the life of the Prophet Muhammad • gender, women and Islam • Sufism and Shi’ism • Islam and the western world • non-Muslim approaches to Islam. With updated further reading and an expanded chronology of turning points in the Islamic world, this book is essential reading for students of religious studies and all those new to the subject of Islam. Routledge «Market: Religion / Islam March 2011: 198x129: 220pp Hb: 978-0-415-58491-3: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58492-0: £11.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-34106-6
Routledge Trade/General Interest – history
American History Goes to the Movies
Calvin Michael Mullett, Lancaster University, UK Series: Routledge Historical Biographies
W. Bryan Rommel Ruiz, The Colorado College in Colorado Springs, USA What should movies teach us about American history? A lesson about pristine American exceptionalism or a history that includes the tragedies as well as the triumphs that define the American experience? American History Goes to the Movies explores both of these questions to find the meaning of the American experience through the films that represent this history to a general audience such as JFK, The Exorcist, The Last of the Mohicans, The Crucible, Glory , and many more. Written in accessible language for students, scholars, and film history buffs, American History Goes to the Movies weaves historiography with cultural significance to show readers how historical narratives are built, and makes the perfect introduction to the study of American history on film. Routledge «Market: American History / Film Studies January 2011: 229x152: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-80219-2: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-80220-8: £18.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
John Calvin is one of the most important figures in religious history. Sitting at the cusp of the medieval and early modern world, he was centre stage during the huge schism that split the early modern church. This new biography not only ties his life together with that of Martin Luther, but also stresses his individual contribution and influence. In examining his life and work, Mullett also explores the many significant influences on Calvin and his work, and the relationships that he formed along his ‘reforming’ path. As well as exploring the impact of Calvin throughout the early modern period and the importance of his work to contemporaries, Mullett also assesses the impact that Calvin’s works have had in shaping the modern world, and the relevance that they still have today. Routledge «Market: European History / Religious Studies March 2011: 198x129: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-47698-0: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-47699-7: £14.99/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Hollywood and the American Experience
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
Routledge Trade/General Interest – history 357
Crime and the Rise of Modern America
The Routledge History of the Holocaust *
A History from 1865–1941
Edited by Jonathan C. Friedman, West Chester University, USA
Kristofer Allerfeldt, University of Exeter, UK
Series: Routledge Histories
Crime and the Rise of Modern America is a thematic history of crime in the USA from the time of Lee’s surrender at Appomattox to Japan’s attack on Pearl Harbor. Kristofer Allerfeldt takes the period of American history where the country was changing into a truly modern, unified nation, and examines the roles crime and criminality have played in the growth of the nation. He’s categorized crime into accessible, exciting, and concise chapters covering such topics as hate crime, crime in the American West, drink and drug related crimes, prostitution and sex crimes, political crime, business crime, and more. Crime and the Rise of Modern America provides a window into America’s past to show both how far the United States has come as a nation, and how some things never change.
The genocide of Jewish and non-Jewish civilians perpetrated by the German regime during World War Two continues to confront scholars with elusive questions even after nearly seventy years and hundreds of studies. This multi-contributory work is a landmark publication that sees experts renowned in their field addressing these questions in light of current research. Serving as a comprehensive introduction to the history of the Holocaust, this volume also adds depth to current debate, both geographically and topically, assessing the Final Solution as the German occupation instituted it across Europe and covering issues which have previously been under-investigated, such as the problem of prosecuting war crimes, gender and Holocaust experience, the persecution of non-Jewish victims, and the Holocaust in post-war culture.
Routledge «Market: American History / Criminology April 2011: 229x152: 240pp Hb: 978-0-415-80044-0: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-80045-7: £19.99/04
Routledge «Market: Jewish History / Modern History November 2010: 246x174: 512pp Hb: 978-0-415-77956-2: £120.00/03 eBook: 978-0-203-83744-3: £120.00/14
5th Edition student reference
Richard III * David Hipshon, St James Independent School, UK Series: Routledge Historical Biographies This new biography takes a nuanced view of the life and reign of one of England’s most controversial monarchs, placing the scandals and mysteries that are so readily associated with Richard III in the wider context of the period in which he lived, and of the ever growing debate over his character. Analysing the influences of those around him, his faith, literary interests and devotion to chivalric ideals, David Hipshon defines Richard’s character as being central to the analysis of his actions. Incorporating new research on the feud between the Stanley and the Harrington families and previously unpublished material from the Duchy of Lancaster archives, this biography sheds new light on a man who was very much a product of the time of change and complexity in which he lived. Routledge «Market: History / British History December 2010: 198x129: 264pp Hb: 978-0-415-46280-8: £60.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-46281-5: £15.99/04
The Routledge Atlas of British History Martin Gilbert Series: Routledge Historical Atlases This thoroughly updated Atlas charts the changing story of the British Isles from the eve of the Roman conquest to the aftermath of the 2010 general election. The key themes covered are: • Politics: from the Saxon kingdoms to the Jacobites, through to the political challenges of 2010 • War and Conflict – from Viking attacks to today’s Wars in Afghanistan and the War in Iraq • Trade and Industry – from the postNorman economy to the present day • Religion – from the Saxon Church to modern times • Society and Economics – from civilian life in Roman Britain to the General Strike, unemployment, homelessness, government expenditure and overseas aid • Immigration – the growth of immigrant communities; the wide range of countries from which immigrants came; how that is changing in contemporary Britain.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: History / British Politics January 2011: 246x174: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-60875-6: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-60876-3: £16.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-39551-9
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
358 Routledge Trade/General Interest – media & cultural studies textbook
Reframing Photography *
The Enchanted Screen
Theory and Practice
The Unknown History of Fairy-Tale Films
Rebekah Modrak, University of Michigan, USA and Bill Anthes, Pitzer College, USA
Jack Zipes, University of Minnesota, USA
Intended for both beginning and advanced students, and for both art and non-art majors, Reframing Photography provides an integrated introduction to the historical, theoretical and technical aspects of photography. • ‘How to’ sections provide students with illustrated, step by step guides to different photographic methods, alongside related theory • case studies: profiles of contemporary and historical artists • glossary: definitions of critical and technical vocabulary • a companion website will update information on equipment and provide further activities, information and links to related sites www.routledge.com/textbooks/reframingphotography • lavishly illustrated, including images depicting artists’ work and examples of photographic processes, many in colour. Routledge «Market: Photography November 2010: 246x189: 480pp Hb: 978-0-415-77919-7: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-77920-3: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-84759-6: £80.00/14
In The Enchanted Screen, Jack Zipes looks at the long history and special relationship between fairy tales and cinema, examining how and why so many films have adapted fairy tale narratives, whether directly or indirectly. Zipes guides us through this vast array of films by tracing the adaptations of major fairy tales, including Little Red Riding Hood, Cinderella, Snow White, Peter Pan, and many more, from their earliest cinematic appearances to today. Essential reading for fairy tale fans and cinema buffs alike, The Enchanted Screen is lavishly illustrated and features an extensive filmography and bibliography for future viewing and reading suggestions. Routledge «Market: Film Studies February 2011: 254x178: 496pp Hb: 978-0-415-99062-2: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-99061-5: £21.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-92749-6: £80.00/14
Routledge Trade/General Interest – literature
Poetry: The Basics Jeffrey Wainwright, Manchester Metropolitan University, UK
The Routledge Guide to William Shakespeare * Robert Shaughnessy, University of Kent, UK
Series: The Basics
William Shakespeare is perhaps the most culturally significant writer of all time, and his language and thought remain interwoven through popular reference and imaginings of the Western canon. This concise, structured guide:
This book demystifies the world of poetry, its traditions and forms for all those who find it daunting or bewildering. Covering a wide range of poetic voices from Chaucer to children’s rhymes, song lyrics and the words of contemporary poets, this book will help readers to appreciate poetry by examining: • how technical aspects such as rhythm and measure work • how different tones of voice affect a poem • how poetic language relates to everyday language • how different types of poetry work, from sonnets to free verse • how the form and ‘space’ of a poem contributes to its meaning. A must read for all those wishing to get to grips with reading and writing poetry. Routledge «Market: English Literature / Poetry February 2011: 198x129: 288pp Hb: 978-0-415-56615-5: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56616-2: £11.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-09286-6: £55.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-28763-0
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
• introduces Shakespeare’s life and works, providing crucial historical background • considers each play in terms of context, critical and performance history • discusses twentieth-century criticism and performance, exploring how our contemporary understanding of Shakespeare has been shaped • incorporates cross-references between sections of the guide to suggest links between texts, contexts and criticism • provides an annotated further reading section and detailed chronologies. Demystifying and contextualising Shakespeare for the twenty-first century, this book offers an introduction to the subject for beginners and an invaluable resource for more experienced scholars. Routledge «Market: Literary Studies December 2010: 246x174: 448pp Hb: 978-0-415-27539-2: £75.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-27540-8: £18.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83523-4: £75.00/14
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
2nd Edition student reference
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
Routledge Trade/General Interest – language learning 359 3rd Edition
3rd Edition
Colloquial Czech
Colloquial Hungarian
The Complete Course for Beginners
The Complete Course for Beginners
James Naughton, University of Oxford, UK
Carol Rounds, Columbia University, USA and Erika Sólyom, New York
Series: Colloquial Series Specially written by an experienced teacher for self-study or class use, the course offers a step-by-step approach to written and spoken Czech. No prior knowledge of the language is required. What makes Colloquial Czech your best choice in personal language learning?
Series: Colloquial Series Colloquial Hungarian is the ideal introduction to the Hungarian Language. Specially written by experienced teachers, the course offers a step-by-step approach to written and spoken Hungarian and covers a variety of modern everyday situations. Colloquial Hungarian provides:
• interactive – wide range of stimulating exercises for regular practice
• emphasis on up-to-date, conversational language
• clear – concise grammar notes
• comprehensive vocabulary lists (Hungarian-English and English-Hungarian)
• practical – useful vocabulary and pronunciation guide • complete – including answer key and reference section. By the end of this rewarding course, you will be able to communicate confidently and effectively in Czech in a broad range of everyday situations. Routledge «Market: Language Learning / East European Studies October 2010: 216x138: 480pp Pack: 978-0-415-49632-2: £29.99/06 Pb: 978-0-415-49631-5: £16.99/06 CD-ROM: 978-0-415-49633-9: £18.99/06 eBook: 978-0-203-87827-9: £33.99/06 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-16134-3
2nd Edition
Colloquial Lithuanian The Complete Course for Beginners Meilute Ramoniene and Ian Press
• interactive – lots of exercises for regular practice • clear – concise grammar notes • practical – useful vocabulary and pronunciation guide • complete – including answer key and reference section.
çè
Routledge «Market: Language Learning / Lithuanian October 2010: 216x138: 480pp Pack: 978-0-415-56092-4: £45.93/06 Pb: 978-0-415-56091-7: £24.99/06 CD-ROM: 978-0-415-56093-1: £23.99/06 eBook: 978-0-203-86549-1: £49.99/06 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-42708-1
@
Routledge «Market: Hungarian Language Learners March 2011: 216x138: 336pp Pack: 978-0-415-56741-1: £39.99/06 Pb: 978-0-415-56740-4: £21.99/06 CD-ROM: 978-0-415-56742-8: £23.99/06 eBook: 978-0-203-86035-9: £33.99/06 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-24256-1
3rd Edition
Colloquial Persian Abdi Rafiee Colloquial Persian is easy to use and completely up to date! Whether you’re a business traveller, or about to take up a daring challenge in adventure tourism, you may be studying to teach or even looking forward to a holiday – if you’d like to get up and running with Persian this rewarding course will take you from complete beginner to confidently putting your language skills to use in a wide range of everyday situations Two 60-minute CDs or MP3s are available to purchase separately or together with the paperback in the great value Colloquial Pack. Recorded by native speakers, these complement the book and will help develop your listening and pronunciation skills. Routledge «Market: Language Learning Persian November 2010: 216x138: 320pp Pack: 978-0-415-55409-1: £39.99/06 Pb: 978-0-415-56045-0: £19.99/06 CD-ROM: 978-0-415-56046-7: £23.99/06 eBook: 978-0-203-86589-7: £43.99/06
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Specially written by experienced teachers for self-study or class use, the course offers a step-by-step approach to written and spoken Lithuanian. No prior knowledge of the language is required. What makes Colloquial Lithuanian the best choice in personal language learning?
for e-mail updates in your field
By the end of this rewarding course students will be able to communicate confidently and effectively in Hungarian in a broad range of everyday situations, both formal and informal.
Series: Colloquial Series
Series: Colloquial Series
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
• useful reference grammar notes • dialogues and cultural notes provide an introduction to Hungarian culture.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
360 Roultlege Trade/General Interest – language learning 3rd Edition
Colloquial Polish The Complete Course for Beginners B.W. Mazur, formerly at SSEES, University of London Series: Colloquial Series This new edition of the best-selling Polish course for beginners has been completely rewritten to make learning the language easier and more enjoyable than before. Written by an experienced teacher and author, Colloquial Polish offers a step-bystep approach to the language as it is spoken and written today. No previous knowledge of Polish is required. Features include: • lively dialogues • lots of exercises with full answer key • jargon-free grammar notes and a quick reference grammar • extensive Polish-English and English-Polish word lists. Routledge «Market: Language Learning / Polish November 2010: 216x138: 352pp Pack: 978-0-415-58198-1: £27.63/06 Pb: 978-0-415-55947-8: £18.99/06 CD-ROM: 978-0-415-56046-7: £23.99/06 eBook: 978-0-203-84997-2: £33.99/06 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-15752-0
Roultlege Trade/General Interest – education
The Media Teacher’s Handbook * Bringing the Froebel Approach Edited by Elaine Scarratt and Jon Davison to Your Early Years Practice The Media Studies Teacher’s Handbook is Helen Tovey, Roehampton University, UK
an indispensible guide for all teachers delivering Media Studies and media education in school and college. Written by experts involved in the teaching, training and examination of media studies, chapters cover:
Series: Bringing ... to your Early Years Practice Bringing a Froebelian Approach to your Early Years Setting looks at the founder of the kindergarten and his profound influence on provision and practice for young children today. The Froebelian approach is not a method but includes distinctive principles which shape and guide practice. This book includes:
• the key concepts and pedagogy underpinning media education • practical ways into teaching and learning the key media concepts
• a discussion of key Froebelian principles such as play, imagination, creativity, learning through self activity and making connections
• using the internet and computer games in the classroom • an introduction to the A Level and GCSE specifications • the 14-19 Creative & Media Diploma and vocational media courses • taking your career further. This handbook is an essential guide to the theory, pedagogy, and practice of media education that will help ensure all trainee and practising teachers can deliver the curriculum with confidence. Routledge «Market: Education March 2011: 246x174: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-49993-4: £70.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-49994-1: £22.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
• an examination of block play and how this can be used in contemporary settings • Froebel’s ideas on nature and outdoor play and why these are fundamental to young children’s learning • examples of innovative practice and ideas for further reflection. Routledge «Market: Early Years February 2011: 210x148: 112pp Hb: 978-0-415-56730-5: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-56731-2: £12.99/04
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
• approaches to production and editing activities
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
Roultlege Trade/General Interest – education 361 7th Edition textbook
3rd Edition
Research Methods in Education
Academic Writing
Louis Cohen, Loughborough University, UK, Lawrence Manion and Keith Morrison, Macau University of Science and Technology, Macau
A Handbook for International Students
This rewritten, expanded and updated 7th edition of the long-running bestseller Research Methods in Education encompasses the whole range of methods currently employed by educational research at all stages. It offers plentiful and rich practical advice, underpinned by clear theoretical foundations, research evidence and up-to-date references. Research Methods in Education is essential reading for both the professional researcher and students of education at undergraduate and postgraduate level, who need to understand how to plan, conduct, analyse and use research. Routledge «Market: Education / Research Methods March 2011: 246x189: 768pp Hb: 978-0-415-58335-0: £90.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-58336-7: £28.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-36878-0
Stephen Bailey, University of Nottingham, UK Most international students need to write essays and reports for exams and coursework. Yet writing good academic English is one of the most demanding tasks students face. This new edition of Academic Writing has been fully revised to help students reach this goal. Clearly organised, the course explains the writing process from start to finish. Each stage of the writing process is demonstrated and practised, from selecting suitable sources, reading, note-making and planning through to re-writing and proofreading. The four main parts of Academic Writing allow teachers and students to find the help they need with all writing tasks easily. Each part is divided into short sections which contain examples, explanations and exercises, for use in the classroom or self-study. All international students wanting to maximise their academic potential will find this practical and easy-to-use book a valuable guide. Routledge «Market: Study Guides / Writing Skills January 2011: 246x189: 272pp Hb: 978-0-415-59580-3: £80.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59581-0: £19.99/04 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-38420-9
Roultlege Trade/General Interest – social sciences student reference
2nd Edition student reference
Terrorism: The Basics
Economics: The Basics *
James Lutz and Brenda J. Lutz, both at Indiana University-Purdue, USA
Tony Cleaver, University of Durham, UK Series: The Basics
Series: The Basics
Now in its second edition, Economics: The Basics provides an engaging and topical introduction to the key issues in contemporary economics. Fully updated to take into account the economic recession, changing patterns in world trade, housing and currency markets, this book covers: how economic systems function; the boom and bust cycle; the impact of emerging markets; how price, supply and demand interact; the role of the banking and finance industries; and the impact of economics on the environment.
An ideal starting point for anyone interested in one of the most discussed, written about and analysed aspects of modern life. This book dispels common misconceptions about the nature of terrorism and terrorists as the authors provide clear and jargon-free answers to the big questions: • What does terrorism involve? • Who can be classified as a terrorist? • What are terrorists trying to achieve? • Who are the supporters of terrorism? • Can there ever be an end to terrorist activity? Written with clarity and insight, this book is the a perfect introductory book on terrorism for students of all levels.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
Routledge «Market: Economics / Business / Management November 2010: 198x129: 320pp Hb: 978-0-415-57108-1: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57109-8: £11.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-09294-1: £55.00/14 Prev. Ed: 978-0-415-31412-1
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Routledge «Market: Politics / Terrorism March 2011: 198x129: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-57333-7: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-57334-4: £11.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83198-4: £55.00/14
With a glossary of terms, suggestions for further reading and new case studies covering subjects including the sub-prime mortgage crisis and changing gold prices, this comprehensive and accessible guide is essential reading for anyone who wants to understand how economics works.
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
362 Roultlege Trade/General Interest – social sciences student reference
student reference
Fifty Key Anthropologists *
Research Methods: The Basics *
Edited by Robert J. Gordon, University of Vermont, USA, Harriet Lyons, University of Waterloo, Canada and Andrew Lyons, Wilfrid Laurier University, Canada
Nicholas Walliman, Oxford Brookes University, UK Series: The Basics Research Methods: The Basics is an accessible, user-friendly introduction to the different aspects of research theory, methods and practice. Structured in two parts, the first covering the nature of knowledge and the reasons for research, and the second the specific methods used to carry out effective research, this book covers:
Series: Routledge Key Guides Fifty Key Anthropologists surveys the life and work of some of the most influential figures in anthropology. The entries, written by an international range of expert contributors, represent the diversity of thought within the subject, incorporating both classic theorists and more recent anthropological thinkers. Names discussed include: Clifford Geertz; Bronislaw Malinowski; Zora Neale Hurston; Sherry B. Ortner; Claude Lévi-Strauss; Rodney Needham; Mary Douglas; Marcel Mauss.
• structuring and planning a research project • the ethical issues involved in research • different types of data and data quality
This accessible A-Z guide contains helpful cross-referencing, a timeline of key dates and schools of thought, and suggestions for further reading. It will be of interest to students of anthropology and related subjects wanting a succinct overview of the ideas and impact of key anthropologists who have helped to shape the discipline.
• analysing and organising data to draw sound conclusions
Routledge «Market: Anthropology November 2010: 216x138: 304pp Hb: 978-0-415-46104-7: £65.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-46105-4: £15.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83879-2: £65.00/14
Routledge «Market: Social Science / Humanities / Research Methods November 2010: 198x129: 224pp Hb: 978-0-415-48991-1: £55.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-48994-2: £11.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83607-1: £55.00/14
• writing up and displaying data in effective ways. Complete with a glossary of key terms and guides to further reading, this book is an essential text for anyone coming to research for the first time, and is widely relevant across the social sciences and humanities.
Roultlege Trade/General Interest – architecture
Vernacular Architecture of West Africa
European Gardens History, Philosophy and Design Tom Turner, Greenwich University, UK
The living environments of hundreds of African ethnic groups offer a variety of ideas and construction practices which contradict the over-played image of primitive huts that have come to represent rural Africa. Each house or group of houses is conceived not only to shelter the family but also to facilitate communication with ancestors and the divinities and to be in tune with nature. This cultural dimension and its application using different architectural practices are fantastically illustrated in this work, with examples taken from the habitats of different ethnic groups of south and west Africa. Designs, plans, axonometrics, and photography make the beauty and complexity of this architecture abundantly clear, showing that it is as much a real life work of art as it is a place to live. Selected Contents: Part 1: Habitat and Living Environment Part 2: Architectural Practice Routledge «Market: Architecture March 2011: Special: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-58543-9: £49.99/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
arden design and usage has been a G feature of human civilisation as far back as Neolithic times, when the first gardens began to be used for residential, horticultural and sacred tasks. Tom Turner follows the entire history of the European garden from its prehistoric roots right up to the present day in this beautifully illustrated and insightful book featuring the author’s own plans and maps. An ideal companion to Asian Gardens. Selected Contents: Preface 1. Design Philosophy 2. Garden Origins 10,000–1,000 BCE 3. Egyptian Gardens 2,000 BCE–1000 BCE 4. Classical Gardens 1400 BCE–500 AD 5. Medieval Gardens 600 AD–1500 AD 6. Renaissance Gardens 1350–1650 7. Baroque Gardens 1600–1750 8. Neoclassical and Romantic Gardens 1700–1810 9. Eclectic Gardens 1800–1900 10. Abstract and Post-Abstract Gardens 1900–2000 Notes. Picture Credits. Index Routledge «Market: Gardening / Garden History March 2011: Special: 512pp Hb: 978-0-415-49684-1: £35.00/08
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Jean-Paul Bourdier and Trinh T. Minh-ha, both at University of California at Berkeley, USA
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
Roultlege Trade/General Interest – architecture 363
Short Stories: London in Two-and-a-Half Dimensions CJ Lim and Ed Liu, both at Bartlett School of Planning, UCL, UK Combining place and fiction in an imaginative interpretation of 12 sites in the city of London, CJ Lim and Ed Liu take familiar places, institutions and landmarks in the British capital and render them fantastic. The book is an intersection of paper assemblages with short stories. The stories have been exhibited at the Royal Academy of Arts and Victoria and Albert Museum but are collected for the first time in this single volume, laid out as they were designed to be seen as one phantasmogoric city vision. Beautifully illustrated, this collection designs a vision of London immoral, anarchic and unscientific and at the same time glorious, ravishing and a pleasure to behold. Selected Contents: 1. Introduction 2. Prologue 3. SW11 4. SE10 5. SE1: Living in the City 6. EC 1: Nocturnal Tower 7. E1 to W4 8. EC4 9. W1. The Baker’s Garden 10. W2 11. NW1: the Bunny Club 12. Any Public Square in London Routledge «Market: Architecture / Design February 2011: 186x123: 192pp Pb: 978-0-415-57358-0: £19.99/04
The Good City Reflections and Imaginations Allan B. Jacobs, Professor Emeritus, University of California, Berkeley, USA Jacobs is one of the world’s best know planners and urban design practitioners, with a long and distinguished career based initially in US cities, and then throughout the world. Featuring a wonderfully engaging, humorous tone and Jacobs’ own ink drawings, The Good City transfers lessons on city design, building and urban change to all those willing to help cities become the magnificent, beautiful places they should be – and encourages all inhabitants to learn to appreciate and explore their own cities. Selected Contents: Part 1: Experiencing Cities Part 2: Learning From Calcutta Part 3: Learning in Italy Part 4: City People – Fragments Part 5: Breaking and Making Community Part 6: World Class Cities Part 7: City Certainties Part 8: San Francisco Part 9: The Good City Routledge «Market: Planning / Urban Studies April 2011: 178x254: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-59350-2: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59353-3: £19.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83596-8: £95.00/14
Sunburnt Cities The Great Recession, Depopulation and Urban Planning in the American Sunbelt Justin B Hollander, Tufts University, USA The decline in sun-belt cities of America has followed on from the decline of those in the rust-belt. Hollander addresses the reasons and statistics behind these shrinking cities with a positive outlook, arguing that growth for growth’s sake is not beneficial for communities, suggesting instead that urban development could be achieved through shrinkage. Case studies include Phoenix, Fresno and Flint.
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Selected Contents: 1. Introduction 2. Perspectives on Growth and Decline 3. When People Leave – The Ruins of Urban Neighborhoods 4. Lessons From a Declining City: Flint, Michigan after 40 Years of Population Loss 5. A New Model for Neighborhood Change in Shrinking Cities 6. Unfamiliar Patterns in the Sun – What Postal Workers Already Know 7. Facing Change in the Central Valley: A Declining Fresno 8. Endless Growth in the Desert? The Fall of Phoenix 9. Abandonment Outside the Magic Kingdom: What Went Wrong in Orlando 10. Conclusion Routledge «Market: Planning January 2011: 246x174: 192pp Hb: 978-0-415-59211-6: £95.00/03 Pb: 978-0-415-59212-3: £24.99/04 eBook: 978-0-203-83438-1: £95.00/14
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
364 Routledge Paperbacks Direct Routledge Paperbacks Direct The Routledge Paperbacks Direct programme was created to make books that would otherwise have have been hardback only available in paperback for individual purchase. More specialised than typical Routledge paperbacks, Paperbacks Direct are produced Print on Demand, often with generic covers. A full list of live paperbacks direct is available at www.routledge.com/paperbacksdirect.
When Greeks think about Turks Edited by Dimitrios Theodossopoulos, University of Bristol, UK January 2011: 246x174: 222pp Pb: 978-0-415-56426-7: £23.50/04
Changing Visions of East Asia, 1943–93
Democracy in Occupied Japan
R.B. Smith Edited by Chad Mitcham, Independent Writer January 2011: 234x156: 276pp Pb: 978-0-415-59047-1: £23.50/18
Edited by Mark E. Caprio, Rikkyo University, Japan and Yoneyuki Sugita, Osaka University of Foreign Studies, Japan January 2011: 234x156: 260pp Pb: 978-0-415-56059-7: £23.50/18
China Along the Yellow River
Edited by Susan Lawrence January 2011: 234x156: 318pp Pb: 978-0-415-58905-5: £23.50/18
Cao Jinqing, East China University of Science and Technology, China Introduction by Rachel Murphy, University of Bristol, UK Translated by Nicky Harman, Imperial College, UK and Huang Ruhua January 2011: 234x156: 272pp Pb: 978-0-415-40614-7: £23.50/18
Experiments in Egyptian Archaeology
China and the New International Order
Denys A. Stocks Foreword by Mark Lehner January 2011: 240x163: 296pp Pb: 978-0-415-58894-2: £23.50/18
Edited by Wang Gungwu, National University of Singapore, Singapore and Zheng Yongnian, University of Nottingham, UK January 2011: 234x156: 330pp Pb: 978-0-415-54645-4: £23.50/04
Archaeology and Heritage Archaeologies of the British
Indigenous Archaeologies Edited by Claire Smith and H. Martin Wobst January 2011: 234x156: 432pp Pb: 978-0-415-58906-2: £23.50/18
Madness, Disability and Social Exclusion Edited by Jane Hubert January 2011: 234x156: 272pp Pb: 978-0-415-58907-9: £23.50/18
Natural Disasters and Cultural Change Edited by John Grattan and Robin Torrence January 2011: 234x156: 368pp Pb: 978-0-415-58908-6: £23.50/18
Time, Process and Structured Transformation in Archaeology Edited by James McGlade and Sander E. van der Leeuw January 2011: 234x156: 504pp Pb: 978-0-415-58909-3: £23.50/18
Asian Studies A Life Adrift
China’s Emerging Cities Edited by Fulong Wu, Cardiff University, UK January 2011: 234x156: 326pp Pb: 978-0-415-59043-3: £23.50/18
order now!
Edited by Marie Lall and Edward Vickers, both at University of London, UK January 2011: 234x156: 262pp Pb: 978-0-415-59536-0: £23.50/18
Ending the Vietnam War
Russell Ong, University of Manchester, UK January 2011: 234x156: 170pp Pb: 978-0-415-59044-0: £23.50/18
Edited by Richard Auty, Lancaster University, UK and Indra de Soysa, Norwegian University of Science and Technology, Norway January 2011: 234x156: 304pp Pb: 978-0-415-40577-5: £23.50/18
China’s State Enterprise Reform
Ethnic Politics in Burma
John Hassard, Manchester Business School, UK, Jackie Sheehan, University of Nottingham, UK, Meixiang Zhou, United Nations Development Programme in China, Jane Terpstra-Tong, University of Macau, Macau and Jonathan Morris, Cardiff University, UK January 2011: 234x156: 282pp Pb: 978-0-415-59053-2: £23.50/18
Ashley South, Independent Consultant, United Nations and Human Rights Watch January 2011: 234x156: 302pp Pb: 978-0-415-57269-9: £23.50/18
China’s Security Interests in the 21st Century
Chinese Big Business in Indonesia Christian Chua, Deutsche Bank, Germany January 2011: 234x156: 192pp Pb: 978-0-415-57424-2: £23.50/18
Edited by D.K. Nauriyal, Indian Institute of Technology, India, Michael S. Drummond, Library of Tibetan Works and Archives, India and Y.B. Lal, Indian Institute of Technology, India January 2011: 234x156: 558pp Pb: 978-0-415-59934-4: £23.50/18
Education as a Political Tool in Asia
Energy, Wealth and Governance in the Caucasus and Central Asia
Asian Regional Governance
Buddhist Thought and Applied Psychological Research
Edited by Peter J.M. Nas, Leiden University, the Netherlands January 2011: 234x156: 272pp Pb: 978-0-415-40587-4: £23.50/18
Edited by Edward Friedman, University of Wisconsin, USA January 2011: 234x156: 288pp Pb: 978-0-415-40578-2: £23.50/18
Edited by Ross Garnaut and Ligang Song January 2011: 234x156: 264pp Pb: 978-0-415-40588-1: £23.50/18
Thomas Scharping January 2011: 234x156: 424pp Pb: 978-0-415-38604-3: £23.50/18
Directors of Urban Change in Asia
Ang Cheng Guan January 2011: 216x138: 208pp Pb: 978-0-415-40619-2: £23.50/18
China’s Third Economic Transformation
Birth Control in China 1949–2000
Edited by Hae-kyung Um January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Pb: 978-0-415-40591-1: £23.50/18
China’s Rise, Taiwan’s Dilemma’s and International Peace
Soeda Azembo and Michael Lewis, Michigan State University, USA January 2011: 234x156: 326pp Pb: 978-0-415-59216-1: £23.50/18 Kanishka Jayasuriya January 2011: 234x156: 304pp Pb: 978-0-415-40586-7: £23.50/18
Diasporas and Interculturalism in Asian Performing Arts
Coalition Politics and Hindu Nationalism Edited by Katharine Adeney, University of Sheffield, UK and Lawrence Saez, University of London, UK January 2011: 234x156: 312pp Pb: 978-0-415-40600-0: £23.50/18
Exchange Rate Regimes in East Asia Edited by Masahiro Kawai and Gordon de Brouwer January 2011: 234x156: 488pp Pb: 978-0-415-40589-8: £23.50/18
Farmers and Village Life in Japan Edited by Yoshiaki Nishida and Ann Waswo January 2011: 234x156: 336pp Pb: 978-0-415-40623-9: £23.50/18
Federalism and Local Politics in Russia Edited by Cameron Ross, University of Dundee, UK and Adrian Campbell, University of Birmingham, UK January 2011: 234x156: 322pp Pb: 978-0-415-59018-1: £23.50/18
Financial Development and Economic Growth in Malaysia
Communal Violence and Democratization in Indonesia
James B. Ang, Monash University, Australia January 2011: 234x156: 214pp Pb: 978-0-415-59615-2: £23.50/18
Gerry van Klinken, KITLV, the Netherlands January 2011: 234x156: 204pp Pb: 978-0-415-49397-0: £23.50/04
Financial Fragility and Instability in Indonesia
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
Yasuyuki Matsumoto, Norinchukin Bank, UK January 2011: 234x156: 284pp Pb: 978-0-415-59046-4: £23.50/18
çè
Anthropology
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
Routledge Paperbacks Direct 365 Financial Governance in East Asia
India’s Partition
Local Politics and Democratization in Russia
Edited by Gordon De Brouwer and Yunjong Wang January 2011: 234x156: 312pp Pb: 978-0-415-40590-4: £23.50/18
Devendra Panigrahi January 2011: 234x156: 392pp Pb: 978-0-415-58615-3: £23.50/18
Cameron Ross, University of Dundee, UK January 2011: 234x156: 284pp Pb: 978-0-415-59030-3: £23.50/18
Gender, Household and State in Post-Revolutionary Vietnam
Industrial Relations in Korea
Locating China
Jooyeon Jeong, Korea University, Korea January 2011: 234x156: 190pp Pb: 978-0-415-54561-7: £23.50/04
Edited by Jing Wang, Massachusetts Institute of Technology, USA January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Pb: 978-0-415-40580-5: £23.50/18
Jayne Werner, Columbia University, USA January 2011: 234x156: 208pp Pb: 978-0-415-59019-8: £23.50/18
Iran-Europe Relations
Gender, Islam and Democracy in Indonesia Kathryn Robinson, Australian National University January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Pb: 978-0-415-59020-4: £23.50/18
Seyyed Hossein Mousavian, Centre for Strategic Research, Iran January 2011: 234x156: 288pp Pb: 978-0-415-59028-0: £23.50/18
Gender, State and Social Power in Contemporary Indonesia
Japanese Army Stragglers and Memories of the War in Japan, 1950–75
Media in China Edited by Stephanie Hemelryk Donald, Yin Hong and Michael Keane January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Pb: 978-0-415-40627-7: £23.50/18
Media, War and Terrorism
Kate O’Shaughnessy, University of Western Australia January 2011: 234x156: 300pp Pb: 978-0-415-59022-8: £23.50/18
Beatrice Trefalt January 2011: 234x156: 242pp Pb: 978-0-415-40628-4: £23.50/18
Edited by Shoma Munshi and Peter van der Veer January 2011: 234x156: 272pp Pb: 978-0-415-40594-2: £23.50/18
Genders, Transgenders and Sexualities in Japan
Japanese Capitals in Historical Perspective
Minority Rights in Central and Eastern Europe
Edited by Mark McLelland, University of Queensland, Australia and Romit Dasgupta, University of Western Australia January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Pb: 978-0-415-40585-0: £23.50/18
Global Media James D. White, Georgia Institute of Technology, USA January 2011: 229x152: 306pp Pb: 978-0-415-88404-4: £23.50/18
Global R&D in China Edited by Yifei Sun, California State University Northridge, USA, Max von Zedtwitz, Peking University, China and Denis Fred Simon, Pennsylvania State University, USA January 2011: 246x174: 180pp Pb: 978-0-415-56866-1: £24.50/04
Globalization and Competitiveness Edited by Chris Rowley, University of London, UK and Malcolm Warner, University of Cambridge, UK January 2011: 234x156: 280pp Pb: 978-0-415-56830-2: £23.50/04
Globalization and the State in Central and Eastern Europe Jan Drahokoupil, Max Planck Institute, Germany January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Pb: 978-0-415-59027-3: £23.50/18
Globalization, Culture and Society in Laos Boike Rehbein, University of Freiburg, Germany January 2011: 234x156: 190pp Pb: 978-0-415-59218-5: £23.50/18
Grassroots Pacifism in Post-War Japan Mari Yamamoto January 2011: 234x156: 320pp Pb: 978-0-415-40583-6: £23.50/18 Martin Ramstedt January 2011: 234x156: 304pp Pb: 978-0-415-40598-0: £23.50/18 Edited by Anne-Marie Hilsdon, Martha Macintyre, Vera Mackie and Maila Stivens January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Pb: 978-0-415-19174-6: £29.99/18
Japanese Religions at Home and Abroad Hirochika Nakamaki January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Pb: 978-0-415-40621-5: £23.50/18
Martin A. Mills January 2011: 234x156: 426pp Pb: 978-0-415-59138-6: £23.50/18
Takeshi Yuzawa, The Japan Institute of International Affairs, Japan January 2011: 234x156: 236pp Pb: 978-0-415-58998-7: £23.50/18
Japan’s Security Relations with China since 1989
Nationalism and Internationalism in Imperial Japan Dick Stegewerns January 2011: 234x156: 272pp Pb: 978-0-415-40596-6: £23.50/18
Edited by Garry Rodan, Murdoch University and Kevin Hewison, University of North Carolina at Chapel Hill, USA January 2011: 246x174: 262pp Pb: 978-0-415-56839-5: £24.50/04
Japonisme in Britain Ayako Ono January 2011: 234x156: 272pp Pb: 978-0-415-40584-3: £23.50/18
Pakistan’s Nuclear Weapons
Labour in Southeast Asia Edited by Becky Elmhirst and Ratna Saptari January 2011: 234x156: 416pp Pb: 978-0-415-40599-7: £23.50/18
Labour Migration and Social Development in Contemporary China
Edited by Debdas Banerjee, University of Calcutta, India and Michael Goldfield, Wayne State University, US January 2011: 234x156: 278pp Pb: 978-0-415-55890-7: £23.50/18
çè
Stefan Auer January 2011: 234x156: 248pp Pb: 978-0-415-40612-3: £23.50/18
Bhumitra Chakma, University of Hull, UK January 2011: 234x156: 208pp Pb: 978-0-415-59032-7: £23.50/18
Performing Russia Laura Olson January 2011: 234x156: 304pp Pb: 978-0-415-40617-8: £23.50/18
Political Philosophy in Japan Christopher Goto-Jones, Leiden University, the Netherlands January 2011: 234x156: 202pp Pb: 978-0-415-54661-4: £23.50/18
Political Transitions in Dominant Party Systems Edited by Joseph Wong, University of Toronto, Canada and Edward Friedman, University of Wisconsin-Madison, USA January 2011: 234x156: 314pp Pb: 978-0-415-55977-5: £23.50/18
Labour, Politics and the State in Industrialising Thailand
for more information
Bruce Elleman, US Naval War College, USA January 2011: 234x156: 254pp Pb: 978-0-415-59052-5: £23.50/18
Neoliberalism and Conflict In Asia After 9/11
Reinhard Drifte January 2011: 234x156: 264pp Pb: 978-0-415-40593-5: £23.50/18
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk
Moscow and the Emergence of Communist Power in China, 1925–30
Yoginder Sikand, formerly at Hamdard University, India January 2011: 234x156: 288pp Pb: 978-0-415-40604-8: £23.50/18
Japan’s Security Policy and the ASEAN Regional Forum
Liberal Nationalism in Central Europe
@
Edited by Bernd Rechel, University of Birmingham, UK January 2011: 234x156: 262pp Pb: 978-0-415-59031-0: £23.50/18
Muslims in India Since 1947
Andrew Brown January 2011: 234x156: 190pp Pb: 978-0-415-60004-0: £23.50/18
Identity, Ritual and State in Tibetan Buddhism
çè
Yuko Kikuchi January 2011: 234x156: 328pp Pb: 978-0-415-40582-9: £23.50/18
Labour, Globalization and the State
Human Rights and Gender Politics
for e-mail updates in your field
Japanese Modernisation and Mingei Theory
Edited by Rachel Murphy, University of Oxford, UK January 2011: 234x156: 218pp Pb: 978-0-415-59029-7: £23.50/18
Hinduism in Modern Indonesia
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
Edited by Nicolas Fiévé and Paul Waley January 2011: 234x156: 432pp Pb: 978-0-415-40581-2: £23.50/18
Postsocialist Cinema in Post-Mao China Chris Berry, University of London, UK January 2011: 229x152: 272pp Pb: 978-0-415-99893-2: £26.99/18
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
366 Routledge Paperbacks Direct The Rebuilding of Greater Russia
Ajit S. Bhalla, formerly at Sidney Sussex College, UK and Shufang Qiu January 2011: 234x156: 228pp Pb: 978-0-415-55523-4: £23.50/18
Rebellion and Reform in Indonesia
Bertil Nygren, University of Stockholm, Sweden January 2011: 234x156: 354pp Pb: 978-0-415-59045-7: £23.50/18
The Rise of the Corporate Economy in Southeast Asia
Michelle Ann Miller, National University of Singapore January 2011: 234x156: 234pp Pb: 978-0-415-59036-5: £23.50/18
Rajeswary Ampalavanar Brown, Royal Holloway University of London, UK January 2011: 234x156: 406pp Pb: 978-0-415-59048-8: £23.50/18
Russian Nationalism and the National Reassertion of Russia
The United Nations and the Indonesian Takeover of West Papua, 1962–1969
Edited by Marlene Laruelle, SAIS, John Hopkins University, USA January 2011: 234x156: 296pp Pb: 978-0-415-59049-5: £23.50/18
John Saltford, Department for Communities and Local Government (DCLG), European Co-operation Programmes (ESAD) January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Pb: 978-0-415-40625-3: £23.50/18
Samkara’s Advaita Vedanta Jacqueline G Suthren Hirst, University of Manchester, UK January 2011: 234x156: 264pp Pb: 978-0-415-40601-7: £23.50/18
Sex, Love and Feminism in the Asia Pacific Chilla Bulbeck, University of Adelaide, Australia January 2011: 234x156: 284pp Pb: 978-0-415-59037-2: £23.50/18
Sexual Cultures in East Asia Edited by Evelyne Micollier January 2011: 234x156: 312pp Pb: 978-0-415-40592-8: £23.50/18
The Vietnam War from the Other Side Cheng Guan Ang January 2011: 216x138: 208pp Pb: 978-0-415-40620-8: £23.50/18
The Women’s Movement in Postcolonial Indonesia Elizabeth Martyn January 2011: 234x156: 276pp Pb: 978-0-415-54623-2: £23.50/04
The Zen Arts
Taiwan’s Relations with Mainland China Chi Su, Taiwan’s Legislative Yuan and the Chairman of its National Defense Committee, Taiwan January 2011: 234x156: 362pp Pb: 978-0-415-58999-4: £23.50/18
Television and Culture in Putin’s Russia Stephen Hutchings, University of Manchester, UK and Natalia Rulyova, University of Birmingham, UK January 2011: 234x156: 266pp Pb: 978-0-415-59050-1: £23.50/18
Thailand Beyond the Crisis Peter Warr January 2011: 234x156: 368pp Pb: 978-0-415-40595-9: £23.50/18
Rupert Cox January 2011: 216x138: 296pp Pb: 978-0-415-40602-4: £23.50/18
Trade Unions in Asia Edited by John Benson, University of South Australia and Ying Zhu, University of Melbourne, Australia January 2011: 234x156: 298pp Pb: 978-0-415-59040-2: £23.50/18
Transitional Justice in Eastern Europe and the former Soviet Union Edited by Lavinia Stan, Concordia University, USA January 2011: 234x156: 326pp Pb: 978-0-415-59041-9: £23.50/18
US-China Relations Tao Xie, Beijing Foreign Studies University, China January 2011: 234x156: 220pp Pb: 978-0-415-59042-6: £23.50/18
The British Occupation of Indonesia: 1945-1946 Richard Mcmillan, Landsdowne College, UK and Royal Holloway, University of London, UK January 2011: 234x156: 264pp Pb: 978-0-415-40609-3: £23.50/18
Young Women in Japan
The Caspian
Zainichi Korean Identity and Ethnicity
Edited by Shirin Akiner January 2011: 234x156: 432pp Pb: 978-0-415-40574-4: £23.50/18
Kaori H. Okano, La Trobe University, Australia January 2011: 234x156: 306pp Pb: 978-0-415-59051-8: £23.50/18 David Chapman, University of South Australia, Australia January 2011: 234x156: 192pp Pb: 978-0-415-56110-5: £23.50/04
The Chinese Journalist
Business
Hugo de Burgh January 2011: 234x156: 264pp Pb: 978-0-415-40597-3: £23.50/18
Co-production
The Concept of the Buddha Guang Xing, The University of Hong Kong January 2011: 234x156: 266pp Pb: 978-0-415-60002-6: £23.50/18
The Khecarividya of Adinatha James Mallinson, Clay Sanskrit Library, UK January 2011: 234x156: 310pp Pb: 978-0-415-58613-9: £23.50/18
The Political Thought of Joseph Stalin
Edited by Victor Pestoff, Ersta-Skondal University, Sweden and Taco Brandsen, Nijmegen University, the Netherlands January 2011: 234x156: 120pp Pb: 978-0-415-56856-2: £23.50/04
Globalizing International Human Resource Management Edited by Chris Rowley, University of London, UK and Malcolm Warner, University of Cambridge, UK January 2011: 246x174: 264pp Pb: 978-0-415-56858-6: £23.50/04
Erik van Ree January 2011: 234x156: 384pp Pb: 978-0-415-40626-0: £23.50/18
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
The Changing Face of Vietnamese Management Edited by Chris Rowley, University of London, UK and Quang Truong, Maastricht School of Management, the Netherlands January 2011: 234x156: 304pp Pb: 978-0-415-59564-3: £23.50/04
The Foundations of Small Business Enterprise Gavin Reid, University of St. Andrews, UK January 2011: 234x156: 426pp Pb: 978-0-415-59829-3: £23.50/18
Classical Studies Augustus and the Family at the Birth of the Roman Empire Beth Severy January 2011: 234x156: 294pp Pb: 978-0-415-58891-1: £23.50/18
Being a Roman Citizen Jane F. Gardner January 2011: 216x138: 252pp Pb: 978-0-415-58902-4: £23.50/18
Domitian Pat Southern January 2011: 234x156: 172pp Pb: 978-0-415-55506-7: £23.50/04
From Feasting To Fasting Veronika Grimm January 2011: 216x138: 304pp Pb: 978-0-415-58904-8: £23.50/18
Pliny on Art and Society Jacob Isager January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Pb: 978-0-415-58901-7: £23.50/18
Ptolemy of Egypt Walter M. Ellis January 2011: 216x138: 124pp Pb: 978-0-415-58898-0: £23.50/18
The Roman House in Britain Dominic Perring January 2011: 234x156: 267pp Pb: 978-0-415-48878-5: £23.50/04
The Roman Remains of Northern and Eastern France James Bromwich January 2011: 234x156: 474pp Pb: 978-0-415-48881-5: £23.50/04
Economics A ‘Second Edition’ of The General Theory Edited by Professor Geoffrey Harcourt, University of Cambridge, UK and Peter Riach, Office of Manpower Economics, UK January 2011: 234x156: 504pp Pb: 978-0-415-40699-4: £23.50/18
A ‘Second Edition’ of The General Theory Edited by Professor Geoffrey Harcourt, University of Cambridge, UK and Peter Riach, Office of Manpower Economics, UK January 2011: 234x156: 400pp Pb: 978-0-415-40700-7: £23.50/18
Alternatives for Environmental Valuation Michael Getzner, Clive Spash, Macaulay Institute, Aberdeen, UK and Sigrid Stagl January 2011: 234x156: 306pp Pb: 978-0-415-40636-9: £23.50/18
çè
Poverty and Inequality among Chinese Minorities
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
Routledge Paperbacks Direct 367 An Economic History of London 1800–1914
Ethical Codes and Income Distribution
Keynes’ Economics
Michael Ball, University of Reading, UK and David Sunderland, University of Greenwich Business School, UK January 2011: 234x156: 470pp Pb: 978-0-415-40640-6: £23.50/18
Guglielmo Forges Davanzati, University of Lecce, Italy January 2011: 234x156: 160pp Pb: 978-0-415-49411-3: £23.50/04
Edited by Tony Lawson and Hashem Pesaran, both at University of Cambridge, UK January 2011: 216x138: 270pp Pb: 978-0-415-55651-4: £23.50/04
At the Origins of Mathematical Economics Richard Van Den Berg, Kingston Business School, UK January 2011: 234x156: 480pp Pb: 978-0-415-54763-5: £23.50/08
Capital, Time and Transitional Dynamics Edited by Harald Hagemann, Universität Hohenheim, Stuttgart, Germany and Roberto Scazzieri, University of Bologna, Italy January 2011: 234x156: 286pp Pb: 978-0-415-58863-8: £23.50/18
Central Banking, Asset Prices and Financial Fragility
Competitiveness of New Industries Edited by Cornelia Storz, University of Marburg, Germany and Andreas Moerke January 2011: 234x156: 328pp Pb: 978-0-415-54781-9: £23.50/08
Currencies, Capital Flows and Crises John T. Harvey, Texas Christian University, USA January 2011: 234x156: 166pp Pb: 978-0-415-78120-6: £23.50/18 Edited by Margaret Schabas, University of British Columbia, Canada and Carl Wennerlind, Barnard College, New York, USA January 2011: 234x156: 392pp Pb: 978-0-415-49413-7: £23.50/04
Food Fights
Money Doctors
Renée Marlin-Bennett January 2011: 234x156: 206pp Pb: 978-0-415-56820-3: £23.50/04
Edited by Marc Flandreau January 2011: 234x156: 332pp Pb: 978-0-415-40691-8: £23.50/18
Free Market Conservatism Edited by Edward Nell, New School University, USA January 2011: 216x138: 274pp Pb: 978-0-415-57047-3: £23.50/04
Edited by Mathew Forstater, University of Missouri at Kansas City, USA, Gary Mongiovi, St. John’s University, USA and Steven Pressman, Monmouth University, USA January 2011: 234x156: 252pp Pb: 978-0-415-54783-3: £23.50/18
Health, Economic Development and Household Poverty Edited by Sara Bennett, Lucy Gilson, University of the Witwatersrand and Anne Mills, London School of Hygiene, UK January 2011: 234x156: 298pp Pb: 978-0-415-49374-1: £23.50/04
Economics, Rational Choice and Normative Philosophy
Imagining Economics Otherwise
Edited by Thomas Boylan and Ruvin Gekker, both at National University of Ireland, Galway January 2011: 234x156: 210pp Pb: 978-0-415-58870-6: £23.50/18
Nitasha Kaul, University of the West of England, UK January 2011: 234x156: 302pp Pb: 978-0-415-58949-9: £23.50/18
Immigrant Enterprise in Europe and the USA
Economies of Network Industries Hans Werner Gottinger, Kwansei Gakuin University, Japan January 2011: 234x156: 230pp Pb: 978-0-415-40644-4: £23.50/18
Entrepreneurship
Prodromos Ioannou Panayiotopoulos (aka Mike Pany), University of Swansea, UK January 2011: 234x156: 280pp Pb: 978-0-415-49418-2: £23.50/04 2nd edition
Industrialization and Globalization
Thomas Grebel January 2011: 234x156: 224pp Pb: 978-0-415-40647-5: £23.50/18
John Weiss, University of Bradford, UK January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Pb: 978-0-415-45863-4: £23.50/18
Environmental Economics, Experimental Methods
Edited by Michael Freeden January 2011: 216x138: 196pp Pb: 978-0-415-56429-8: £23.50/04 Tyler Cowen, George Mason University, USA January 2011: 234x156: 182pp Pb: 978-0-415-78129-9: £23.50/18
Sublime Economy Edited by Jack Amariglio, Merrimack College, USA, Joseph W. Childers and Stephen E. Cullenberg, both at University of California Riverside, USA January 2011: 234x156: 336pp Pb: 978-0-415-78121-3: £23.50/18
The Adam Smith Review Volume 4 Vivienne Brown, The Open University, UK January 2011: 234x156: 336pp Pb: 978-0-415-58860-7: £23.50/18
The Economics of Innovation, New Technologies and Structural Change Cristiano Antonelli, University of Turin, Italy January 2011: 234x156: 210pp Pb: 978-0-415-40643-7: £23.50/18
The Fortunes of Liberalism F.A. Hayek January 2011: 234x156: 292pp Pb: 978-0-415-40649-9: £23.50/18 Ailsa McKay, Glasgow Caledonian University, UK January 2011: 234x156: 288pp Pb: 978-0-415-54764-2: £23.50/18
Edited by Marcello Musto, University of Naples ‘L’Orientale’, Italy January 2011: 234x156: 320pp Pb: 978-0-415-58871-3: £23.50/18
The IMF and the Future Graham Bird, University of Surrey, UK January 2011: 234x156: 318pp Pb: 978-0-415-40687-1: £23.50/18
Keynes and Hayek G.R. Steele January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Pb: 978-0-415-40689-5: £23.50/18
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
@
Reappraising J.A. Hobson
The Future of Social Security Policy
Karl Marx’s Grundrisse
Todd L. Cherry, Appalachian State University, North Carolina, USA, Stephan Kroll, Colorado State University, Fort Collins, USA and Jason F. Shogren, University of Wyoming, USA January 2011: 234x156: 508pp Pb: 978-0-415-77992-0: £23.50/04
Post-Keynesian Macroeconomics
Risk and Business Cycles
Jeremy Shearmur, Australian National University January 2011: 234x156: 268pp Pb: 978-0-415-40684-0: £23.50/18
Denis Goulet, University of Notre Dame, USA January 2011: 234x156: 282pp Pb: 978-0-415-49404-5: £23.50/04
Peasants and Globalization
Growth and Development in the Global Political Economy
Hayek and After
Development Ethics at Work
Giuseppe Fontana, University of Leeds, UK January 2011: 216x138: 160pp Pb: 978-0-415-58873-7: £23.50/18 Edited by A. Haroon Akram-Lodhi, Trent University, Canada and Cristóbal Kay, Institute of Social Studies, the Netherlands January 2011: 234x156: 360pp Pb: 978-0-415-58875-1: £23.50/18
W. Arthur Lewis January 2011: 234x156: 334pp Pb: 978-0-415-56783-1: £23.50/04
David M. Kennedy, John Jay College of Criminal Justice, USA January 2011: 234x156: 236pp Pb: 978-0-415-58867-6: £23.50/18
Money, Uncertainty and Time
Edited by Ariel Dinar, The World Bank, Washington DC, USA, José Albiac, Unidad Economía Agraria, Spain and Joaquín Sánchez-Soriano, Universitas Miguel Hernández, Spain January 2011: 234x156: 366pp Pb: 978-0-415-77993-7: £23.50/04
Growth and Fluctuations 1870–1913
Deterrence and Crime Prevention
çè
Wei-Bin Zhang, Ritsumeikan Asia Pacific University, Japan January 2011: 234x156: 396pp Pb: 978-0-415-58872-0: £23.50/18
Phillip O’Hara, Curtin University of Technology, Australia January 2011: 234x156: 272pp Pb: 978-0-415-54765-9: £23.50/08
David Hume’s Political Economy
for e-mail updates in your field
Monetary Growth Theory
Edited by J. Stanley Metcalfe January 2011: 234x156: 168pp Pb: 978-0-415-40648-2: £23.50/18
Game Theory and Policy Making in Natural Resources and the Environment
Eric Tymoigne, Lewis and Clark College, USA January 2011: 234x156: 336pp Pb: 978-0-415-78119-0: £23.50/18
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
Evolutionary Economics and Creative Destruction
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
368 Routledge Paperbacks Direct The New Economy and Macroeconomic Stability Dario Togati, Università di Torino, Italy January 2011: 234x156: 330pp Pb: 978-0-415-54772-7: £23.50/18
Policy Discourses, Gender, and Education
Culture-Led Urban Regeneration
Elizabeth J. Allan, University of Maine, USA January 2011: 234x156: 234pp Pb: 978-0-415-88606-2: £23.50/18
Edited by Ronan Paddison, University of Glasgow, UK and Steven Miles, University of Brighton, UK January 2011: 246x174: 202pp Pb: 978-0-415-56852-4: £23.50/04
Towards the Virtuous University
The New Famines Stephen Devereux, University of Sussex, UK January 2011: 234x156: 390pp Pb: 978-0-415-54787-1: £23.50/18
Jon Nixon, Liverpool Hope University, UK January 2011: 234x156: 176pp Pb: 978-0-415-87514-1: £23.50/04 2nd Edition
The Pattern of Aid Giving
World Bank Financing of Education
Eric Neumayer January 2011: 234x156: 132pp Pb: 978-0-415-40695-6: £23.50/18
Phillip W. Jones, University of Sydney, Australia January 2011: 234x156: 318pp Pb: 978-0-415-56707-7: £23.50/04
The Political Economy of Rural Livelihoods in Transition Economies
English Language and Linguistics
Global Perspectives on Rural Childhood and Youth Edited by Ruth Panelli, University College London, UK, Samantha Punch, Stirling University, UK and Elsbeth Robson, University of Keele, UK January 2011: 229x152: 282pp Pb: 978-0-415-88296-5: £23.50/18 volume 1
The History of the Study of Landforms: Geomorphology Before Davis Richard J. Chorley, Antony J. Dunn and Robert P. Beckinsale January 2011: 216x138: 698pp Pb: 978-0-415-55994-2: £25.00/04
Edited by Max Spoor, Institute of Social Studies, the Netherlands January 2011: 234x156: 282pp Pb: 978-0-415-58878-2: £23.50/18
Catalan
The Science of Wealth
Japanese
The History of the Study of Landforms
John Hinds January 2011: 216x138: 512pp Pb: 978-0-415-59384-7: £35.00/18
R.P. Beckinsale, R.J. Chorley and A.J. Dunn January 2011: 234x156: 900pp Pb: 978-0-415-56795-4: £35.00/04
Punjabi
volume 3
Tej Bhatia January 2011: 234x156: 458pp Pb: 978-0-415-58993-2: £35.00/18
The History of the Study of Landforms
The ‘Uncertain’ Foundations of Post Keynesian Economics Stephen Dunn, NHS East of England, Cambridge January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Pb: 978-0-415-58879-9: £23.50/18
Trade, Growth and Inequality in the Era of Globalization Edited by Kishor Sharma, Charles Sturt University, Australia and Oliver Morrissey, University of Nottingham, UK January 2011: 234x156: 298pp Pb: 978-0-415-49405-2: £23.50/04
Understanding FDI-Assisted Economic Development Edited by Sanjaya Lall and Rajneesh Narula, University of Reading, UK January 2011: 234x156: 306pp Pb: 978-0-415-56837-1: £23.50/04
Education Changing Identities in Higher Education Edited by Ronald Barnett, University of London, UK and Roberto Di Napoli, Imperial College London, UK January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Pb: 978-0-415-56708-4: £23.50/04
Citizenship and Higher Education Edited by James Arthur, Canterbury Christ Church University, UK and Karen Bohlin, Boston University, USA January 2011: 234x156: 208pp Pb: 978-0-415-56710-7: £23.50/04
Constructing Education for Development Colette Chabbott January 2011: 214pp Pb: 978-0-415-87499-1: £23.50/04
Tony McEnery, University of Lancaster, UK January 2011: 234x156: 294pp Pb: 978-0-415-54404-7: £23.50/04
The Linguistics of Laughter Alan Partington, University of Bologna, Italy January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Pb: 978-0-415-54407-8: £23.50/04
The Role of Formal Features in Second Language Acquisition Edited by Juana Liceras, University of Ottawa, Canada, Helmut Zobl, Carleton University, Canada and Helen Goodluck, University of York, UK January 2011: 229x152: 588pp Pb: 978-0-415-88218-7: £27.99/18
Towards a ‘Natural’ Narratology Monika Fludernik January 2011: 234x156: 470pp Pb: 978-0-415-58563-7: £25.00/18
Edited by Brian Chalkley, University of Plymouth, UK, Martin Haigh, Oxford Brookes University, UK and David Higgitt, National University of Singapore, Singapore January 2011: 246x174: 316pp Pb: 978-0-415-59084-6: £22.99/18
Learning from the Margins Edited by Julie McLeod, University of Melbourne, Australia and Andrea C. Allard, Deakin University, Australia January 2011: 234x156: 206pp Pb: 978-0-415-56709-1: £23.50/04
Robert P. Beckinsale and Richard J. Chorley January 2011: 524pp Pb: 978-0-415-56801-2: £28.99/04
Water Management in Megacities Edited by Cecilia Tortajada, Olli Varis, Helsinki University of Technology, Finland, Asit Biswas and Jan Lundqvist, University of Linkoping, Sweden January 2011: 234x156: 222pp Pb: 978-0-415-56849-4: £23.50/04
World City Syndrome David A. McDonald, Queen’s University, Canada January 2011: 229x152: 382pp Pb: 978-0-415-87500-4: £23.50/04
History Chivalry Edgar Prestage January 2011: 234x156: 248pp Pb: 978-0-415-56905-7: £27.99/04
Discourse and Culture
Geography
Alun Munslow, University of Chichester, UK January 2011: 216x138: 230pp Pb: 978-0-415-55303-2: £23.50/04
Ageing and Place
Female Prostitution in Costa Rica
Edited by Gavin J. Andrews, McMaster University, Canada and David R. Phillips, Lingnan University, Hong Kong January 2011: 234x156: 272pp Pb: 978-0-415-48165-6: £26.99/18
Clusters in Urban and Regional Development
Education for Sustainable Development
order now!
Swearing in English
volume 2
Edited by Andrew Cumbers, University of Glasgow, UK and Danny McKinnon, University of Aberdeen, UK January 2011: 246x174: 262pp Pb: 978-0-415-56841-8: £23.50/04
Critical Perspectives in Rural Development Studies Edited by Saturnino M. Borras Jr., St Mary’s University, Canada January 2011: 234x156: 266pp Pb: 978-0-415-59177-5: £22.95/18
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
Anne Hayes, Fordham University, USA January 2011: 229x152: 244pp Pb: 978-0-415-88258-3: £23.50/18
Feminist Revolution in Literacy Junko Onosaka, University of Illinois Urbana-Champaign, USA January 2011: 229x152: 296pp Pb: 978-0-415-88260-6: £23.50/18
Mediterranean Paradigms and Classical Antiquity Irad Malkin, Tel Aviv University, Israel January 2011: 234x156: 156pp Pb: 978-0-415-56834-0: £24.50/04
Mourning Dress Lou Taylor, University of Brighton, UK January 2011: 234x156: 336pp Pb: 978-0-415-55654-5: £23.50/04
çè
Tony Aspromourgos, University of Sydney, Australia January 2011: 234x156: 416pp Pb: 978-0-415-58877-5: £23.50/18
Jose Ignacio Hualde January 2011: 234x156: 482pp Pb: 978-0-415-59640-4: £35.00/18
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
Routledge Paperbacks Direct 369 My Pen and My Soul Have Ever Gone Together Vikki Vickers, Weber State University, Ogden, USA January 2011: 229x152: 196pp Pb: 978-0-415-99645-7: £26.99/18
Popular Culture and the Enduring Myth of Chicago, 1871–1968 Lisa Krissoff Boehm, Worcester State College, USA January 2011: 229x152: 262pp Pb: 978-0-415-99665-5: £26.99/18
Slavery and Resistance in Africa and Asia
Everybody’s America
Critical Heritage series
David Witzling, University of Montana, USA January 2011: 229x152: 236pp Pb: 978-0-415-88388-7: £23.50/18
Alexander Pope
Hamlet Edited by Arthur F. Kinney, University of Massachusetts, Amherst, USA January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Pb: 978-0-415-41098-4: £23.50/18
Latin American Writers and the Rise of Hollywood Cinema
Edited by John Barnard January 2011: 216x138: 560pp Pb: 978-0-415-56891-3: £27.99/04
Anton Chekhov Edited by Victor Emeljanow January 2011: 216x138: 496pp Pb: 978-0-415-56900-2: £27.99/04
Charles Dickens
Edited by Edward A. Alpers, Gwyn Campbell, McGill University, Canada and Michael Salman January 2011: 234x156: 154pp Pb: 978-0-415-87581-3: £23.50/04
Jason Borge, Vanderbilt University, USA January 2011: 229x152: 222pp Pb: 978-0-415-88396-2: £23.50/18
Edited by Philip Collins January 2011: 216x138: 664pp Pb: 978-0-415-56875-3: £27.99/04
Mexican American Literature
Ernest Hemingway
State of ‘The Union’
Elizabeth Jacobs, Oxford Univerisity, UK January 2011: 234x156: 186pp Pb: 978-0-415-54406-1: £23.50/04
Edited by Jeffrey Meyers January 2011: 234x156: 626pp Pb: 978-0-415-56892-0: £27.99/04
Modern Confessional Writing
Geoffrey Chaucer
Sandra Schroer, Muskingum College, USA January 2011: 229x152: 134pp Pb: 978-0-415-80569-8: £26.99/04
The History of Witchcraft and Demonology Montague Summers January 2011: 216x138: 370pp Pb: 978-0-415-56874-6: £24.50/04
Women, Clubs and Associations in Britain David Doughan, formerly at The Women’s Library and Peter Gordon, University of London, UK January 2011: 234x156: 174pp Pb: 978-0-415-55135-9: £23.50/04
Literature As You Like It from 1600 to the Present Edited by Edward Tomarken January 2011: 229x152: 660pp Pb: 978-0-415-87432-8: £23.50/04
Edited by Jo Gill, University of Exeter, UK January 2011: 234x156: 206pp Pb: 978-0-415-54414-6: £23.50/04
Derek Brewer January 2011: 216x138: 354pp Pb: 978-0-415-56887-6: £27.99/04
Native American Literature
Geoffrey Chaucer
Helen May Dennis, The University of Warwick, UK January 2011: 234x156: 246pp Pb: 978-0-415-54416-0: £23.50/04
Derek Brewer January 2011: 216x138: 520pp Pb: 978-0-415-56888-3: £27.99/04
Othello
George Eliot
Edited by Philip C. Kolin, University of Southern Mississippi, USA January 2011: 234x156: 470pp Pb: 978-0-415-41101-1: £23.50/18
Edited by David Carroll January 2011: 216x138: 528pp Pb: 978-0-415-56883-8: £27.99/04
Our Scene is London
Edited by Michael Egan January 2011: 216x138: 524pp Pb: 978-0-415-56902-6: £27.99/04
Henrik Ibsen
James D. Mardock, University of Nevada, Reno, USA January 2011: 229x152: 174pp Pb: 978-0-415-87554-7: £23.50/18
Boys in Children’s Literature and Popular Culture Annette Wannamaker, Eastern Michigan University, USA January 2011: 229x152: 196pp Pb: 978-0-415-87551-6: £23.50/04
City/Stage/Globe
Ayanna Thompson, Arizona State University, USA January 2011: 229x152: 186pp Pb: 978-0-415-87568-4: £23.50/18
Cold War Literature Edited by Andrew Hammond, Swansea Institute of Higher Education January 2011: 234x156: 284pp Pb: 978-0-415-54402-3: £23.50/04
Cormac McCarthy and the Myth of American Exceptionalism
Edited by Mr B.C. Southam and B.C. Southam January 2011: 216x138: 320pp Pb: 978-0-415-56877-7: £27.99/04
Shakespeare and the Cultural Colonization of Ireland
Edited by G.M. Matthews January 2011: 216x138: 444pp Pb: 978-0-415-56890-6: £27.99/04
Robin Bates, Lynchburg College, USA January 2011: 229x152: 178pp Pb: 978-0-415-87576-9: £23.50/18
Edith Wharton’s Evolutionary Conception Paul J. Ohler, Kwantlen University College, Canada January 2011: 234x156: 230pp Pb: 978-0-415-88006-0: £23.50/18
Edited by Kathleen Williams January 2011: 216x138: 360pp Pb: 978-0-415-56886-9: £27.99/04
Sylvia Plath
The Gothic in Children’s Literature
John Butt & Kathleen Tillotson January 2011: 246x174: 246pp Pb: 978-0-415-56909-5: £23.50/04
John Keats
Jonathan Swift
Joe Bray, University of Sheffield, UK January 2011: 229x152: 208pp Pb: 978-0-415-88401-3: £23.50/18
Dickens at Work
volume 2
Edited by Annalisa Oboe, University of Padua, Italy and Anna Scacchi January 2011: 229x152: 438pp Pb: 978-0-415-88393-1: £23.50/18
The Female Reader in the English Novel
John Cant, Essex University, UK January 2011: 229x152: 380pp Pb: 978-0-415-87567-7: £23.50/18
Edited by Mr B.C. Southam and B.C. Southam January 2011: 216x138: 286pp Pb: 978-0-415-56876-0: £27.99/04
Jane Austen
Recharting the Black Atlantic
D.J. Hopkins, San Diego State University, USA January 2011: 229x152: 250pp Pb: 978-0-415-87552-3: £23.50/18
volume 1
Jane Austen
Performing Race and Torture on the Early Modern Stage
Edited by Anna Jackson, Victoria University of Wellington, New Zealand, Roderick McGillis, University of Calgary, Canada and Karen Coats, Illinois State University, USA January 2011: 229x152: 262pp Pb: 978-0-415-87574-5: £23.50/18
Edited by Linda Wagner-Martin January 2011: 216x138: 346pp Pb: 978-0-415-56895-1: £27.99/04
T.S. Eliot Volume I Edited by Michael Grant January 2011: 216x138: 408pp Pb: 978-0-415-56896-8: £27.99/04
T.S. Eliot Volume 2
The Merchant of Venice Edited by John W. Mahon and Ellen Macleod Mahon January 2011: 234x156: 470pp Pb: 978-0-415-41100-4: £23.50/18
Edited by Michael Grant January 2011: 216x138: 424pp Pb: 978-0-415-56897-5: £27.99/04
Virginia Woolf
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Edited by Robin Majumdar and Allen McLaurin January 2011: 216x138: 484pp Pb: 978-0-415-56899-9: £27.99/04
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
370 Routledge Paperbacks Direct Media and Cultural Studies American Icons Benedikt Feldges January 2011: 234x156: 298pp Pb: 978-0-415-87550-9: £23.50/04
Middle East Studies Arab Culture and the Novel Muhammad Siddiq, University of California, Berkeley, USA January 2011: 234x156: 254pp Pb: 978-0-415-59743-2: £23.50/18
Arabic Poetry Muhsin J. al-Musawi, Columbia University, USA January 2011: 234x156: 350pp Pb: 978-0-415-59591-9: £23.50/18
Art in Zion Dalia Manor, University of London, UK January 2011: 234x156: 278pp Pb: 978-0-415-59308-3: £23.50/18
Islamic Culture Through Jewish Eyes
The Jews of Ethiopia
Esperanza Alfonso, Universidad Complutense de Madrid, Spain January 2011: 234x156: 212pp Pb: 978-0-415-59938-2: £23.50/18
Edited by Tudor Parfitt, University of London, UK and Emanuela Trevisan Semi, University of Venice, Italy January 2011: 216x138: 232pp Pb: 978-0-415-59305-2: £23.50/18
Israel and the Family of Nations
The Trans-Saharan Slave Trade
Alexander Yakobson, Hebrew University of Jerusalem, Israel and Amnon Rubinstein, Columbia University, USA January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Pb: 978-0-415-78137-4: £23.50/18
John Wright, Formerly Chief Political Analyst and Commentator of the BBC Arabic Service January 2011: 234x156: 254pp Pb: 978-0-415-58947-5: £23.50/18
Jewish Cultural Nationalism
The Turkish Economy
David Aberbach, McGill University, Canada January 2011: 234x156: 140pp Pb: 978-0-415-78148-0: £23.50/18
Edited by Sumru G. Altug, Koç University, Turkey and Alpay Filiztekin, Sabanci University, Turkey January 2011: 234x156: 324pp Pb: 978-0-415-59447-9: £23.50/18
Jewish Mysticism and Magic Maureen Bloom, Royal Anthropological Institute, UK January 2011: 234x156: 250pp Pb: 978-0-415-59338-0: £23.50/18
Maimonides’ Guide for the Perplexed
Britain and Morocco During the Embassy of John Drummond Hay Khalid Ben-Srhir January 2011: 234x156: 368pp Pb: 978-0-415-58944-4: £23.50/18
Donald McCallum, Civil Service January 2011: 234x156: 198pp Pb: 978-0-415-59339-7: £23.50/18
Medieval Islamic Pragmatics Muhammad M. Yunis Ali January 2011: 234x156: 284pp Pb: 978-0-415-56777-0: £23.50/04
Contemporary Arab Fiction Fabio Caiani, University of St Andrews, UK January 2011: 234x156: 192pp Pb: 978-0-415-59937-5: £23.50/18
Contemporary Jewish Philosophy Irene Kajon, University of Rome, Italy January 2011: 234x156: 188pp Pb: 978-0-415-59337-3: £23.50/18
Palestinian Civil Society Benoit Challand, University of Bologna and Graduate Institute for International and Development Studies, Geneva January 2011: 234x156: 14pp Pb: 978-0-415-59241-3: £23.50/18
Palestinian Political Prisoners Esmail Nashif, Birzeit University, Israel January 2011: 234x156: 244pp Pb: 978-0-415-58933-8: £23.50/18
Democratization in Morocco Lise Storm, University of Exeter, UK January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Pb: 978-0-415-59939-9: £23.50/18
Philosophy in a Time of Crisis
Gender and Self in Islam Etin Anwar, Binghamton University, USA January 2011: 234x156: 206pp Pb: 978-0-415-77880-0: £23.50/04
Hebrew Language and Jewish Thought David Patterson January 2011: 234x156: 252pp Pb: 978-0-415-55887-7: £23.50/18
Seymour Feldman January 2011: 234x156: 220pp Pb: 978-0-415-59304-5: £23.50/18
Religion and Politics in Turkey Edited by Barry Rubin, Interdisciplinary Center Herzliya, Israel and Ali Carkoglu, Sabanci University, Turkey January 2011: 234x156: 192pp Pb: 978-0-415-56836-4: £24.50/04
The Birth of The Prophet Muhammad Marion Holmes Katz, New York University, USA January 2011: 234x156: 284pp Pb: 978-0-415-55187-8: £23.50/04
Historians, State and Politics in Twentieth Century Egypt Anthony Gorman January 2011: 234x156: 288pp Pb: 978-0-415-58934-5: £23.50/18
The Egyptian Economy, 1952–2000 Khalid Ikram January 2011: 234x156: 320pp Pb: 978-0-415-48995-9: £23.50/04
Human Conscience and Muslim-Christian Relations Oddbjørn Leirvik, University of Oslo, Norway January 2011: 234x156: 320pp Pb: 978-0-415-58936-9: £23.50/18
Interest in Islamic Economics
The Image of the Black in Jewish Culture Abraham Melamed January 2011: 234x156: 304pp Pb: 978-0-415-59302-1: £23.50/18
The Jewish-Chinese Nexus
Abdulkader Thomas January 2011: 234x156: 158pp Pb: 978-0-415-58935-2: £23.50/18
Edited by M. Avrum Ehrlich, University of Shandong, China January 2011: 234x156: 326pp Pb: 978-0-415-59341-0: £23.50/18
International Assistance to the Palestinians after Oslo
Turkish Accession to the EU Eric Faucompret, University of Antwerp, Belgium and Jozef Konings, Katholieke Universiteit Leuven, Belgium January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Pb: 978-0-415-59449-3: £23.50/18
Nursing/Allied Health Arguing about Disability Edited by Kristjana Kristiansen, Norwegian University of Science and Technology, Norway, Simo Vehmas, University of Jyvaskyla, Finland and Tom Shakespeare, Newcastle University, UK January 2011: 234x156: 232pp Pb: 978-0-415-58853-9: £23.50/18
Art, Creativity and Imagination in Social Work Practice Edited by Prue Chamberlayne, Open University, UK and Martin Smith, Buckinghamshire Social Services, UK January 2011: 246x174: 172pp Pb: 978-0-415-59081-5: £22.99/18
Performance and Theatre Studies Crossing Cultural Borders Through the Actor’s Work Cláudia Tatinge Nascimento, Wesleyan University, USA January 2011: 229x152: 194pp Pb: 978-0-415-88400-6: £23.50/18
Ritual and Event Edited by Mark Franko, University of California, Santa Cruz January 2011: 234x156: 200pp Pb: 978-0-415-54411-5: £23.50/04
Science and the Stanislavsky Tradition of Acting Jonathan Pitches, Leeds University, UK January 2011: 234x156: 236pp Pb: 978-0-415-54403-0: £23.50/04
The Politics of New Media Theatre Gabriella Giannachi, University of Exeter, UK January 2011: 234x156: 164pp Pb: 978-0-415-54409-2: £23.50/04
Theatre and Performance in Digital Culture Matthew Causey, Trinity College, Ireland January 2011: 234x156: 230pp Pb: 978-0-415-54410-8: £23.50/04
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Anne Le More, United Nations, New York, USA January 2011: 234x156: 270pp Pb: 978-0-415-58838-6: £23.50/18
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
Routledge Paperbacks Direct 371 Philosophy
Politics
A Sense of the World
A Global Union for Global Workers
Edited by John Gibson, Temple University, Philadelphia, USA, Wolfgang Huemer, Universitat Erfurt, Germany and Luca Pocci January 2011: 235x156: 358pp Pb: 978-0-415-87553-0: £23.50/18
Nathan Lillie, University of Groningen, the Netherlands January 2011: 229x152: 230pp Pb: 978-0-415-88297-2: £23.50/18
A Truer Liberty Laurence A. Blum and Victor Seidler January 2011: 216x138: 376pp Pb: 978-0-415-56754-1: £23.50/04
Antonio Gramsci
Edited by Jesse C. Ribot, University of Illinois, USA and Anne M. Larson, Center for International Forestry Research, Indonesia January 2011: 216x138: 268pp Pb: 978-0-415-56826-5: £23.50/04
Democratic Innovation
Harold Entwistle January 2011: 216x138: 220pp Pb: 978-0-415-56116-7: £23.50/04
Centre-Right Parties in Post-Communist East-Central Europe
An Examination of Sir William Hamilton’s Philosopy
Democratic Decentralisation through a Natural Resource Lens
Edited by Michael Saward, The Open University, UK January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Pb: 978-0-415-40657-4: £23.50/18
Democratic Politics and Party Competition
Edited by Sean Hanley, University College London, UK and Aleks Szczerbiak, University of Sussex, UK January 2011: 216x138: 164pp Pb: 978-0-415-56833-3: £23.50/04
Edited by Judith Bara, Queen Mary, university of London, UK and Albert Weale, University of Essex, UK January 2011: 234x156: 338pp Pb: 978-0-415-59947-4: £23.50/18
Citizens and the State
Democratic Revolutions
Nick Bostrom January 2011: 229x152: 238pp Pb: 978-0-415-88394-8: £23.50/18
Takashi Inoguchi, Chuo University, Tokyo, Japan and Jean Blondel, European University Institute, Italy January 2011: 234x156: 196pp Pb: 978-0-415-59942-9: £23.50/18
Mark K. Thompson, Universität Erlangen-Nürnberg, Germany January 2011: 234x156: 192pp Pb: 978-0-415-40682-6: £23.50/18
Autobiography and Literary Essays
Communities Across Borders
Development and Democracy
John Stuart Mill January 2011: 234x156: 820pp Pb: 978-0-415-48748-1: £25.00/04
Edited by Paul Kennedy and Victor Roudometof January 2011: 234x156: 224pp Pb: 978-0-415-40672-7: £23.50/18
Cause and Chance
Comparative Politics
Edited by Ole Elgström, University of Lund, Sweden and Goran Hyden, University of Florida, USA January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Pb: 978-0-415-40671-0: £23.50/18
Phil Dowe and Paul Noordhof January 2011: 234x156: 224pp Pb: 978-0-415-40848-6: £23.50/18
Jan-Erik Lane, University of Freiburg, Germany January 2011: 234x156: 332pp Pb: 978-0-415-58678-8: £23.50/18
Donald Davidson
Comparing and Classifying Legislatures
Edited by Ursula M. Zeglen January 2011: 234x156: 208pp Pb: 978-0-415-40836-3: £23.50/18
Edited by David Arter, University of Aberdeen, UK January 2011: 234x156: 262pp Pb: 978-0-415-56864-7: £23.50/04
Foundations of Mathematics and other Logical Essays
Constituting Human Rights
John Stuart Mill January 2011: 234x156: 728pp Pb: 978-0-415-56873-9: £25.00/04
Anthropic Bias
Mervyn Frost January 2011: 234x156: 168pp Pb: 978-0-415-40654-3: £23.50/18
Frank Plumpton Ramsey January 2011: 216x138: 310pp Pb: 978-0-415-40852-3: £23.50/18
Lauren M. McLaren, University of Nottingham, UK January 2011: 234x156: 336pp Pb: 978-0-415-59161-4: £23.50/18
Tony Pitson January 2011: 234x156: 262pp Pb: 978-0-415-24802-0: £26.99/18
Edited by David M. Farrell and Rüdiger Schmitt-Beck January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Pb: 978-0-415-40660-4: £23.50/18
E-government in Europe Edited by Paul G. Nixon, The Hague University of Professional Education, the Netherlands and Vassiliki N. Koutrakou, University of East Anglia, UK January 2011: 234x156: 248pp Pb: 978-0-415-59948-1: £23.50/18
Engendering the State
Constructing Democracy in Southern Europe
Humes Philosophy of the Self
Do Political Campaigns Matter?
Lynn Savery, Australian National University, Australia January 2011: 234x156: 292pp Pb: 978-0-415-56870-8: £24.50/04
Ethics, Justice and International Relations
Lukács and Heidegger
Constructing Post-Soviet Geopolitics in Estonia
Peter Sutch, Cardiff University, UK January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Pb: 978-0-415-40656-7: £23.50/18
Lucien Goldmann January 2011: 216x138: 140pp Pb: 978-0-415-56459-5: £23.50/18
Pami Aalto, University of Helsinki, Finland January 2011: 241X164: 190pp Pb: 978-0-7146-8349-2: £23.99/18
Ethics, Liberalism and Realism in International Relations
Man in the Modern Age
Croatia
Karl Jaspers January 2011: 216x138: 208pp Pb: 978-0-415-57282-8: £23.50/18
William Bartlett, University of Bristol, UK January 2011: 234x156: 192pp Pb: 978-0-415-40659-8: £23.50/18
The Analytic Turn
Decision Making Within International Organisations
Edited by Michael Beaney, University of York, UK January 2011: 235x156: 304pp Pb: 978-0-415-87575-2: £23.50/18
The Foundation and Construction of Ethics Franz Brentano January 2011: 216x138: 406pp Pb: 978-0-415-55792-4: £23.50/04
Deliberation, Social Choice and Absolutist Democracy David van Mill, University of Western Australia, Australia January 2011: 216x138: 200pp Pb: 978-0-415-59165-2: £23.50/18
The Origin of Our Knowledge of Right and Wrong Franz Brentano January 2011: 216x138: 188pp Pb: 978-0-415-55790-0: £23.50/04
Democracy and Political Change in the Third World
çè
Lucien Goldmann January 2011: 216x138: 114pp Pb: 978-0-415-57625-3: £19.99/18
for e-mail updates in your field
@
Edited by Jeff Haynes, London Metropolitan University, UK January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Pb: 978-0-415-40670-3: £23.50/18
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
The Philosophy of the Enlightenment
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
Edited by Bob Reinalda and Bertjan Verbeek, both at Radboud University Nijmegen, the Netherlands January 2011: 234x156: 272pp Pb: 978-0-415-40678-9: £23.50/18
Mark D. Gismondi, Northwest Nazarene University, Nampa, USA January 2011: 234x156: 288pp Pb: 978-0-415-59950-4: £23.50/18
EU Enlargement and Referendums Edited by Aleks Szczerbiak and Paul Taggart, both at University of Sussex, UK January 2011: 234x156: 236pp Pb: 978-0-415-56829-6: £23.50/04
European Approaches to International Relations Theory Jörg Friedrichs, International University Bremen, Germany January 2011: 234x156: 224pp Pb: 978-0-415-45988-4: £23.50/18
European Governance and Supranational Institutions Jonas Talberg, Lund University, Sweden January 2011: 234x156: 192pp Pb: 978-0-415-40665-9: £23.50/18
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
372 Routledge Paperbacks Direct Explaining Federalism
Political Philosophy and Social Welfare
Jan Erk, Leiden University, the Netherlands January 2011: 234x156: 182pp Pb: 978-0-415-59955-9: £23.50/18
Raymond Plant, Peter Taylor-Gooby and Harry Lessor January 2011: 216x138: 266pp Pb: 978-0-415-55793-1: £23.50/04
Gendered Peace
Political Theory and the European Constitution
Globalisation and Migration Edited by Ronaldo Munck, Dublin City University, Ireland January 2011: 246x174: 250pp Pb: 978-0-415-59087-7: £23.50/18
Globalization, Prostitution and Sex Trafficking Elina Penttinen, University of Tampere, Finland January 2011: 234x156: 198pp Pb: 978-0-415-59958-0: £23.50/18
Governments, NGOs and Anti-Corruption Edited by Luís de Sousa, CIES-ISCTE, Portugal, Barry Hindess and Peter Larmour, both at Australian National University, Australia January 2011: 234x156: 268pp Pb: 978-0-415-59961-0: £23.50/18
International Environmental Treaties and State Behavior Denise DeGarmo, Southern Illinois University Edwardsville, USA January 2011: 229x152: 194pp Pb: 978-0-415-99868-0: £26.99/18
International Organizations and Implementation Edited by Jutta Joachim, University of Hannover, Germany, Bob Reinalda and Bertjan Verbeek, both at Radboud University Nijmegen, the Netherlands January 2011: 234x156: 220pp Pb: 978-0-415-59966-5: £23.50/18
Islam, Democracy and the Status of Women Helen M. Rizzo, The American University in Cairo, Egypt January 2011: 229x152: 134pp Pb: 978-0-415-99895-6: £26.99/04
Managing Modernity
Edited by Lynn Dobson, University of Edinburgh, UK and Andreas Follesdal, University of Oslo, Norway January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Pb: 978-0-415-40674-1: £23.50/18
Politicians, Bureaucrats and Administrative Reform
Politics and Social Insight
Understanding the European Union’s External Relations
Francis Castles January 2011: 216x138: 152pp Pb: 978-0-415-56114-3: £23.50/04
Pressure Groups and Political Culture Francis Castles January 2011: 198x129: 116pp Pb: 978-0-415-56117-4: £23.50/04
Social and Foreign Affairs in Iraq Saddam Hussein January 2011: 216x138: 128pp Pb: 978-0-415-56798-5: £23.50/04
State and Business Groups in Mexico Arnulfo Valdivia-Machuca January 2011: 229x152: 304pp Pb: 978-0-415-80570-4: £26.99/04
The Constitutionalization of the European Union Edited by Berthold Rittberger, University of Mannheim, Germany and Frank Schimmelfennig, Zurich University, Switzerland January 2011: 234x156: 188pp Pb: 978-0-415-56865-4: £23.50/04
The European Union and International Organizations
Mediating International Crises
The Fall
Max Beloff January 2011: 216x138: 212pp Pb: 978-0-415-55797-9: £23.50/04 Edited by Nicola Piper, University of Wales, UK January 2011: 229x152: 364pp Pb: 978-0-415-87449-6: £23.50/04
Peacekeeping in the Middle East as an International Regime Kenneth Dombroski, Naval Postgraduate School, Monterey, USA Telik, Inc., San Francisco, California, USA January 2011: 229x152: 208pp Pb: 978-0-415-88253-8: £23.50/18
order now!
Steven Saxonberg January 2011: 234x156: 456pp Pb: 978-0-415-36420-1: £27.99/18
The Foreign Office and British Diplomacy in the Twentieth Century Edited by Gaynor Johnson January 2011: 234x156: 252pp Pb: 978-0-415-56831-9: £23.50/04
New Perspectives on Gender and Migration
Edited by Kenneth Dyson, University of Cardiff, UK and Stephen Padgett, University of Strathclyde, UK January 2011: 234x156: 176pp Pb: 978-0-415-56840-1: £23.50/04
The Social Democratic Image of Society
Edited by Matt Matravers, University of York, UK January 2011: 234x156: 210pp Pb: 978-0-415-56828-9: £23.50/04
New Dimensions in Foreign Policy
The Politics of Economic Reform in Germany
Edited by Guy Peters, University of Pittsburgh, USA and Jon Pierre January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Pb: 978-0-415-40667-3: £23.50/18
Edited by Knud Erik Jørgensen, University of Aarhus, Denmark January 2011: 234x156: 218pp Pb: 978-0-415-59953-5: £23.50/18
Victor Asal, David Quinn, Jonathan Wilkenfeld and Kathleen Young January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Pb: 978-0-415-40677-2: £23.50/18
Edited by Xiudian Dai and Philip Norton, both at University of Hull, UK January 2011: 234x156: 158pp Pb: 978-0-415-57222-4: £23.50/04
The Global Governance of Food Edited by Sara R. Curran, University of Washington, USA, April Linton, University of California, San Diego, USA, Abigail Cooke, University of California, Los Angeles, USA and Andrew Schrank, University of New Mexico, USA January 2011: 246x189: 238pp Pb: 978-0-415-59085-3: £23.50/18
The Great Powers Max Beloff January 2011: 216x138: 244pp Pb: 978-0-415-55652-1: £23.50/04
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
Francis Castles January 2011: 216x138: 180pp Pb: 978-0-415-56115-0: £23.50/04
Edited by Michele Knodt, University of Mannheim, Germany and Sebastiaan Princen, Utrecht University, the Netherlands January 2011: 234x156: 240pp Pb: 978-0-415-40664-2: £23.50/18
War and Democratization Edited by Wolfgang Merkel and Sonja Grimm, both at Social Science Research Center (WZB), Germany January 2011: 234x156: 226pp Pb: 978-0-415-59086-0: £23.50/18
Law and Religion Edited by Peter Radan January 2011: 234x156: 338pp Pb: 978-0-415-54415-3: £23.50/04
Security Studies Britain, America and Anti-Communist Propaganda 1945–53 Dr Andrew Defty January 2011: 234x156: 312pp Pb: 978-0-7146-8361-4: £25.99/18
Civilian or Military Power? Edited by Helene Sjursen, ARENA, University of Oslo, Norway January 2011: 234x156: 172pp Pb: 978-0-415-56853-1: £24.50/04
Clinton’s Foreign Policy John Dumbrell, University of Durham, UK January 2011: 234x156: 228pp Pb: 978-0-415-59575-9: £23.50/18
Cossacks in the German Army 1941–1945 Samuel J. Newland January 2011: 234x156: 218pp Pb: 978-0-7146-8199-3: £25.99/18
Napoleon and the World War of 1813 J.P. Riley January 2011 Pb: 978-0-7146-4444-8: £23.50/18
NATO, Security and Risk Management M.J. Williams, Royal United Services Institute for Defence and Security Studies, UK January 2011: 234x156: 160pp Pb: 978-0-415-59248-2: £23.50/18
Political Ethics and The United Nations Manuel Froehlich, Friedrich-Schiller University of Jena, Germany January 2011: 234x156: 272pp Pb: 978-0-415-58833-1: £23.50/18
çè
Edited by Donna Pankhurst, University of Bradford, UK January 2011: 229x152: 352pp Pb: 978-0-415-87448-9: £23.50/04
The Internet and Parliamentary Democracy in Europe
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
Routledge Paperbacks Direct 373 Punishment, Justice and International Relations
Life in Poverty Neighbourhoods
Anthony F. Lang Jr., University of St Andrews, UK January 2011: 234x156: 206pp Pb: 978-0-415-57031-2: £23.50/04
The De-Radicalization of Jihadists Omar Ashour, Exter University, UK January 2011: 234x156: 222pp Pb: 978-0-415-58834-8: £23.50/18
UN Peace Operations and Asian Security Edited by Mely Cabellero-Anthony and Amitav Acharya, American University, USA January 2011: 234x156: 160pp Pb: 978-0-415-56825-8: £24.50/04
Edited by Jurgen Friedrichs, University of Cologne, Germany, George Galster, Wayne State University, USA and Sako Musterd, Amsterdam University, the Netherlands January 2011: 234x156: 152pp Pb: 978-0-415-56835-7: £24.50/04
Beijing 2008: Preparing for Glory Edited by J.A. Mangan, formerly at the University of Strathclyde, UK and Dong Jinxia, Beijing University, China January 2011: 246x174: 234pp Pb: 978-0-415-48456-5: £23.50/04
Radicalism and the Revolt Against Reason Irving Louis Horowitz, Rutgers University, USA January 2011: 216x138: 292pp Pb: 978-0-415-55779-5: £23.50/04
Sociology
Revitalizing Causality
A Philosophical History of German Sociology
Edited by Ruth Groff January 2011: 234x156: 284pp Pb: 978-0-415-56871-5: £24.50/04
Frédéric Vandenberghe, IUPERJ, Rio De Janeiro, Brazil January 2011: 234x156: 352pp Pb: 978-0-415-56872-2: £24.50/04
Are We Thinking Straight? Daniel K. Cortese, Governors State University, USA January 2011: 229x152: 228pp Pb: 978-0-415-88295-8: £23.50/18
Cause and Meaning in the Social Sciences Ernest Gellner January 2011: 216x138: 240pp Pb: 978-0-415-43454-6: £24.50/18
Collective Rights of Indigenous Peoples Jolan Hsieh, National Dong Hwa University, Taiwan January 2011: 229x152: 154pp Pb: 978-0-415-88252-1: £23.50/18 Raymond Plant January 2011: 198x129: 98pp Pb: 978-0-415-56430-4: £23.50/04
Helena Flam, University of Leipzig, Germany and Debra King, University of Flinders, Australia January 2011: 234x156: 208pp Pb: 978-0-415-48187-8: £26.99/18
Freedom Power & Democ Plan Volume 4 Edited by Karl Mannheim January 2011: 216x138: 408pp Pb: 978-0-415-43665-6: £24.50/18
Gary Armstrong, Brunel University, UK and Jon P. Mitchell, University of Sussex, UK January 2011: 234x156: 224pp Pb: 978-0-415-56491-5: £24.99/18
Social and Moral Theory in Casework
Nutrition and Football
Raymond Plant January 2011: 198x129: 116pp Pb: 978-0-415-55794-8: £23.50/04
Edited by Ron Maughan, Loughborough University, UK January 2011: 234x156: 254pp Pb: 978-0-415-48494-7: £24.99/04
Social and Political Thought of Mahatma Gandhi
Sport in South Asian Society
Bidyut Chakrabarty, Delhi University, India January 2011: 234x156: 208pp Pb: 978-0-415-48209-7: £26.99/18
The African Origins of Rhetoric
Edited by Boria Majumdar, La Trobe University, Australia and J.A. Mangan, formerly at the University of Strathclyde, UK January 2011: 234x156: 356pp Pb: 978-0-415-56827-2: £24.50/04
Sport, Nationalism and Orientalism Edited by Fan Hong, University College Cork, Ireland January 2011: 246x174: 154pp Pb: 978-0-415-56850-0: £24.50/04
Transnational and Comparative Research in Sport
The Evolution of Educational Thought
Emotions and Social Movements
Global and Local Football
Sharon D. Lang, University of Redlands, USA January 2011: 229x152: 276pp Pb: 978-0-415-88407-5: £23.50/18
L.T. Hobhouse January 2011: 216x138: 212pp Pb: 978-0-415-55782-5: £23.50/04
Edited by W.S.F Pickering January 2011: 216x138: 228pp Pb: 978-0-415-56907-1: £24.50/04
Edited by Paul Dimeo, University of Stirling, UK January 2011: 234x156: 198pp Pb: 978-0-415-56848-7: £24.50/04
Edited by Boria Majumdar, La Trobe University, Australia and Fan Hong, University College Cork, Ireland January 2011: 246x174: 296pp Pb: 978-0-415-56851-7: £24.50/04
Sharaf Politics
The Elements of Social Justice
Durkheim
Drugs, Alcohol and Sport
Modern Sport – The Global Obsession
Cecil Blake, University of Pittsburgh, USA January 2011: 229x152: 156pp Pb: 978-0-415-88387-0: £23.50/18
Community and Ideology
John Bale, Keele University, UK and Aarhuus University, Denmark January 2011: 234x156: 218pp Pb: 978-0-415-59625-1: £23.50/18
Janet M. Conway, Brock University, Canada January 2011: 229x152: 200pp Pb: 978-0-415-88245-3: £23.50/18 John Smith and Chris Jenks, Brunel University, UK January 2011: 234x156: 320pp Pb: 978-0-415-43967-1: £23.50/18
Miranda Alison, University of Warwick, UK January 2011: 234x156: 292pp Pb: 978-0-415-59242-0: £23.50/18
Anti-Sport Sentiments in Literature
Praxis and Politics
Qualitative Complexity
Women and Political Violence
Sports Studies
Emile Durkheim January 2011: 216x138: 384pp Pb: 978-0-415-56906-4: £24.50/04
Edited by Ian Henry, Loughborough University, UK January 2011: 234x156: 256pp Pb: 978-0-415-57508-9: £24.99/18
The Metaphysical Theory of the State L.T. Hobhouse January 2011: 216x138: 160pp Pb: 978-0-415-55786-3: £23.50/04
Gypsy Identities 1500–2000 David Mayall January 2011: 234x156: 324pp Pb: 978-0-415-56637-7: £23.50/04
Hermeneutics and Social Science
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
@
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Zygmunt Bauman January 2011: 216x138: 267pp Pb: 978-0-415-58272-8: £23.50/18
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
374 index
a A. Sweeney, James 127 A2 Media Studies 18 A3 Workbook, The 154 Abandoned Japanese in Postwar Manchuria 106 Abbas, Tahir 323 Abbey, Duane C. 148 Abbott, George C. 329 Abdelrahim, Khalid 242 Abdou, Ashraf 116 Abdulghani, Jasim M. 349 Aboriginal Customary Law 125 Abrams, Jeff 188 Abruzzo, James 145 Abu-Laban, Yasmeen 117 Academic Skills Problems 210 Academic Writing 70, 361 Acceptance and Commitment Therapy 204 Acharya U, Rajendra 296 Ackley, Craig N. 125 Adams, Jesse 265 Adams, Rob 246 Adamson, Glenn 19 Adaptive Radiation Therapy 307 Adaptive Security Management Architecture 295 Adelkhah, Fariba 117 Adi, Hakim 14 Adler, Joanna R. 133 Adl-Tabatabai, Ali-Reza 292 Adolescent Rationality and Development 192 Adolphs, Svenja 35 Advanced Concepts in Defensive Tactics 118 Advanced Particle Physics 307 Advanced Particle Physics Volume 1 303 Advanced Particle Physics Volume 2 304 Advanced Play Therapy 210 Advanced Simulation and Modelling for Urban Groundwater Management – UGROW 315 Advanced Thermodynamics Engineering 263 Advanced Waste Treatment in the Food Processing Industry 257
order now!
Advances in Chromatography, Volume 49 304 Advances in Environmental Remote Sensing 262 Advances in Fluid Catalytic Cracking 268 Advances in Polyolefin Nanocomposites 307 Advertising and Public Relations Law 18 Aesthetic Constructions of Korean Nationalism 106 Africa and Europe 343 African Debt Crisis, The 330 African Environments and Resources 331 African Natural Plant Products 225 Afro-Asian States and their Problems, The 343 Agarwal, Ravi 257 Agbaria, Ayman K. 80 Age of Imprisonment 130 Ageing and Older Adult Mental Health 199 Aging Intellect, The 200 Agrarian Reform in Contemporary Developing Countries 327 Agricultural and Biological Engineering Education 240 Agricultural Development and Economic Integration in Latin America 328 Agriculture, Poverty and Reform in Iran 354 Ahmadi, Azadeh 315 Ahmed, Ishtiaq 113 Ahson, Syed A. 273 Aid and Dependence 329 Aid and Inequality in Kenya 328 Aikin, Scott 6 Air and Missile Defense Systems Engineering 276 Akhbari, Masih 315 Akram, Susan M. 114 Alam, Shawkat 126 Alampalli, Sreenivas 252 Alapuro, Risto 110 Albertson, Kevin 131 Albrecht, James F. 237 Alcohol, Tobacco and Obesity 218 Alcorta, Ludovico 334 Al-Deek, Haitham 252 Alderson, Dawn 217 Aldridge, Judith 194 Alexander, Hanan 80 Alexander, Kern 66 Alexander, Klinton 66 Alexander, Patricia A. 74 Alfano, Candice A. 212
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Algebraic Number Theory 277 Aliyu, M.D.S. 272 Allen, Christopher 122 Allen, Keith 6 Allen, Linda J.S. 278 Allen, Randal 266 Allerfeldt, Kristofer 10, 357 Allison, Thomas 311 Allnutt, Susann 81 Alonso, Eduardo E. 298 Alonso, Gregorio 14 Alred, Deborah 139 Alternative Approaches to Second Language Acquisition 34 Alternatives to Privatization in the Global South 185 Alves-Filho, Odilio 271 Amad, Mohammad 354 Amann, Edmund 167 Amason, Allen 153 Amatori, Franco 158 America and the Third World 342 American Government 83 American History Goes to the Movies 9, 356 Amiard-Triquet, Claude 258 Amin, Moeness G. 267 Amirsadeghi, Hossein 354 Anarchism and Sexuality 125 Ancient Cities 16 Andersen, Birgitte 168 Anderson, John J.B. 241 Anderson, Peggy L. 65 Anderson, Sharon K. 202 Anderson, Stewart 278 Andersson, Erika E. 312 Andic, Fuat 332 Andic, Suphan 332 Andrain, Charles 342 Andre Gunder Frank and Global Development 83 Andreou, George 92 Andresen, Steinar 93 Andrews, Gavin P. 232 Andrews, Tim 146 Andy & Me 145 Ang, Simon 272 Animal Behavior Desk Reference 223 Anker, Richard 330 Annamalai, Kalyan 263 Ansari, Ali M. 325 Anstey, Peter 6 Anthes, Bill 23 Anthropological Linguistics 322 Anti Money Laundering Complex and the Compliance Industry, The 169
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
35 Strategies for Guiding Readers through Informational Texts 52 3D Graphics for Game Programming 290 500 Common Chinese Idioms 40
Appel, Edward J. 294 Applications of Field-Programmable Gate Arrays in Scientific Research 308 Applications of Lie Groups to Difference Equations 284 Applications of Surface-Enhanced Raman Spectroscopy 308 Applied Concept Mapping 145 Applied Semantic Web Technologies 296 Applied Statistics for Economists 163 AQA Religious Ethics for AS and A2 7 Arabic Idioms 116 Arberry, A.J. 352 Archaeology of Materials, An 15 Archer, Dawn 37 Architectural Design Patterns in C# 296 Architecture, Crisis and Resuscitation 244 Ariff, Mohammed 336 Armour, Kathleen 191 Armstrong, David 88 Art Of Art Therapy, The 213 Art of Structures, The 247 Arthritis 240 Artificial Neural Networks in Biological and Environmental Analysis 308 Arts Leadership 145 Ascione, Alfred 226 Ash, Robert 105 Asif Syed, Erfan 230 Asmussen, Kirsten 217 Assael, Marc J. 300 Assembling for Development 345 Assessment, Measurement, and Prediction for Personnel Decisions 192 Assumption of Agency Theory, The 6 Athletics Challenges 52 Atkinson, Dwight 34 Atkinson, F.V. 286 Atmospheric Remote Sounding 257 Attachment, Trauma and Multiplicity 201 Attempts at General Union 319 Attridge, Derek 31 Audiobooks, Literature, and Sound Studies 32 Aung-Thwin, Michael Arthur 110 Austin, Gareth 168 Austrian and German Economic Thought 166
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
index 375
83 289 253 185 269 166 281 206 246 206 343 271 302
b
çè
Bache, Ian 92 Bader, David A. 290 Badescu, Cristina G. 101 Badilescu, Simona 226 Baer, Charlotte Kirk 223 Baer, Werner 167 Baert, Patrick 186 Baffelli, Erica 7 Bagchi, Debasis 240 Bagetta, Giacinto 219 Baglia, Jay 22 Bahramitash, Roksana 116 Bai, Jinhe 241 Bailey, David J. 317 Bailey, Stephen 70, 361 Bailliet, Cecilia 125 Baird, Norman 121 Bairner, Alan 189 Baker, Mona 44 Baker, Simon 222 Balasinki, Artur 266 Baldry, Anna Costanza 144 Baldwin, Elizabeth A. 241 Baligar, Virupax C. 224 Balmer, John 152 Banana Breeding 224 Banerjee, Partha P. 269 Bannelier, Karine 128 Barack Obama and the Politics of Redemption 83 Baranyi, Peter 273 Barber, Jacques P. 204 Barbosa-Canovas, Gustavo V. 242 Bar-Cohen, Yoseph 227 Bard, Allen J. 309 Bardhan, Nilanjana 22
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
Barillot, Emmanuel Barker, Jamie Barker, Michelle Barnes, Frank S. Barnes, Philip Barnett, Jonathan Barnett, Michael Barnett, Tony Barnett, Vincent Barone, Diane M. Barraque, Bernard Barrett, Karen C. Barrouillet, Pierre Barrows, Edward M. Bartecki, Adam Barton, Adrian Barton, Keith C Barton, Robert Bas, Ralph Basham, Victoria Bashiriyeh, Hossein Basics of Process Mapping Bass, Alan Bassel, Leah Bassetti, Benedetta Bassi, Shaul Basterra, Maria del Rosario Bateman, Antony Bates, Richard Baudin, Michel Bauer, Gretchen Bauer, P.T. Baumann, Gerd Baumeister, Roy F. Bayard-Sakai, Anne Bayens, Gerald J. Bazemore, Gordon Beach, Nick Beaman, Jim Beard, Michael Beaty, Carole Beaverstock, J.V. Beaverstock, Jonathan V. Beck, Clive Beckett, Gulbahar Becoming a Teacher Researcher in Literacy Teaching and Learning Beebee, Helen Beers, CLI, Dean A. Beever, Erik Alan Behaviour in the Early Years Beidel, Deborah C. Being Human in Islam Belant, Jerrold L. Bell, Jeffrey T. Bell, Kirsten
@
289 188 106 271 72 248 85 345 166 53 314 196 193 223 313 180 55 47 132 96 354 145 208 187 194 28 62 18 76 151 96 332 324 195 109 118 143 57 20 352 75 175 175 59 106
53 3 237 261 51 212 116 261 151 218
Bellafaire, Judith 14 Bellamy, Alex J. 98 Bello, Manuel 78 Belonging in Europe – The African Diaspora and Work 14 Benckendorff, Pierre 176 Bengal Industries and the British Industrial Revolution (1757–1857) 166 Benin, Samuel E. 168 Benjamin for Architects 244 Bennett, Brian 111 Bennett, Peter 18 Bennett, Trevor 133 Bentham, Susan 52 Benzie, Iris F.F. 219 Berdal, Mats 98 Berge, Torkil 199 Berger, Michele T. 183 Berger, Sebastian 169 Bergoffen, Debra 178 Berg-Weger, Marla 178 Berik, Günseli 163 Berman, Maria 161 Bernasco, Wim 136 Bernecker, Sven 4 Bernell, David 92 Berridge, Damon M. 286 Berry, L. 331 Berry, Lynne D. 231 Bertozzi, Davide 292 Besnoy, Amy 26 Besomi, Daniele 166 Between Winnicott and Lacan 206 Beulen, Erik 150 Beyens, Kristel 132 Beyer, Kristen 125 Beyer, W. Nelson 260 Beyond Binaries in Education Research 80 Beyond the School Gates 70 Beyond the Sociology of Development 345 Bhagwati, Jagdish 341 Bhaskar, Roy 182 Bhuyan, Manabendra 271 Bielenberg, Andy 166 Bien, Thomas 202 Biesta, Gert J.J. 56 Biggs, Simon 217 Bijective Combinatorics 278 Bilgin, Fevzi 117 Bilgrami, Akeel 107 Bilimoria, Diane 160 Billings, Andrew C. 27 Bin, Yang 312 Bindner, Donald 277
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Autobiographical International Relations Automated Physical Database Design and Tuning Automatic Fire Detection and Alarm Systems Automobility in Transition? Autonomous Underwater Vehicles Autonomy and Formalism in Economics Avanzi, Roberto Awakening the Dreamer Awan, Nishat Ayers, Mary Y. Ayoob, Mohammed Ayub, Zahid H. Aznar, Miquel F.
Bioethics 125 Bio-inspired Computing and Networking 269 Biological Basis of Mental Health Nursing, The 216 Biological Wastewater Treatment 314 Biomass Energy 257 Biomechanics of the Upper Limbs 226 Biomedical Engineering Principles 226 Biomedical Transducers and Instruments 226 BioMEMS 226 Biomimetics 227 Bionanotechnology II 227 BIOS Instant Notes in Biochemistry 222 BIOS Instant Notes in Immunology 222 BIOS Instant Notes in Microbiology 222 BIOS Instant Notes in Neuroscience 222 Biosensors in Food Processing, Safety, and Quality Control 239 Biostatistics: A Computing Approach 278 Biotechnology Operations 227 Bipolar Disorder Survival Guide, The 203 Biresaw, Girma 313 Birkenmaier, Julie 178 Birkle, Peter 261 Bissell, David 187 Biswas, Asit K. 175 Bitemark Evidence 236 Blaauw, Martijn 6 Black Africa 1945–1980 333 Black and Asian Theatre In Britain 45 Black, Jay 19 Black, Jeremy 12 Black, S.M. 237 Black, Sue 234 Blackledge, J.T. 204 Blanchett, Wanda J. 68 Blazejowski, Krzysztof 252 Bloom, David 167 Blows, William T. 216 Blumi, Isa 14 Boasson, Elin Lerum 93 Boddu, Veera 309 Bogdanske, John J. 228 Boggs, James E. 304 Bogusz, Maciej J. 237 Boje, David M. 162 Bonaiuti, Mauro 167
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
376 index
order now!
British Civilization 9 Broad, C.D. 3 Broadband Optical Modulators 308 Brodbar, Dorith 177 Bromberg, Philip M. 206 Brooke, David 123 Brookfield, Harold 346 Brookman, Fiona 133 Brooks, Ann 154 Brooks, Kenneth 260 Brooks, Steve 281 Brown, James W. 162 Brown, Jennifer 144 Brown, Lawrence J. 207 Brown, Lucien 43 Brown, Nina W. 203 Brown, Robert G.W. 312 Brown, Rockell A. 23 Brown, Sally 179 Brown-Chidsey, Rachel 211 Browne, Edward Granville 351 Browne, Stephen 89 Browning, Deborah L. 208 Bruhn, Allison L. 211 Bruno, Nicolas 289 Bryden, Kenneth M. 263 Bryson, John R. 175 Bubbles, Law and Financial Regulation 166 Buchanan, Ruth 127 Buchwalter, Andrew 6 Buckley, Peter 159 Bucknor, Michael A. 30 Buckwalter, Tim 40 Buddhism in Australia 106 Buddhist Practice and Visual Culture 106 Building Brands in Asia 146 Building Competences for Spatial Planners 248 Building Performance Simulation for Design and Operation 254 Building Relationships and Communicating with Young Children 220 Bulkeley, Harriet A. 175 Bullock, Jane A. 92 Bullock, Karen 140 Burdsey, Daniel 191 Burg, Karen J.L. 312 Burgess, John 313 Burke, Lol 129 Burki, Shahid Javed 111 Burley, Suzanne 57 Burney, Elizabeth 143 Burnham, June 167 Business Ethics and the Austrian Tradition in Economics 166
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Business History Business History and International Business Business of Sports, The Business Practices in Higher Education Business, Marketing, and Management Principles for IT and Engineering Bustos Flores, Belinda Buvinic, Marya Bynner, John
158 159 25 66
159 63 330 177
c Cabrini, Stefano 302 Cahill, Ann J. 186 Cahill-Ripley, Amanda 128 Caird, Jeffrey 259 Cairncross, A.K. 333 Çakır, Armagan Emre 93 Calcutt, Andrew 20 Calder, Gideon 93 Caldwell, Lesley 207 Calvin 9 Calzone, Laurence 289 Campaigning in the Twenty-First Century 84 Campbell, Christopher P. 23 Campbell, George L. 42 Canary, Daniel J. 24 Canas, Alberto 145 Canjels, Rudmer 26 Canning, David 167 Cannon, John B. 232 Canton, Rob 143 Cantonese: A Comprehensive Grammar 41 Capie, Forrest 324 Capital Formation and Economic Development 338 Capital, Exploitation and Economic Crisis 166 Caplehorn, Peter 255 Carbon Management in Tourism 171 Carbon Nanotubes for Polymer Reinforcement 308 Carl, Thompson 31 Carless, David 80 Carlin, Bradley P. 280 Carlson, Matt 27 Caron H. St. John, 146 Carpenter, Belinda 139 Carr, Neil 175 Carreira da Silva, Filipe 186 Carrigan, Anthony 32
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Bond, Frank W. 204 Bondarenko, Volodymyr 299 Bonilla, Jose V. 305 Book Publishing 322 Boord, Warren 276 Booth, David 345 Booth, Ken 98 Boothroyd, Geoffrey 275 Borch, Christian 181 Borda, Aldo Zammit 126 Borgmann-Prebil, Yuri 124 Boron Science 308 Borrego, Espiridion 160 Bose, Sugata 11 Boskou, Dimitrios 241 Bott Spillius, Elizabeth 208 Bottici, Chiara 128 Bottoms, Anthony 135 Bouillon, Hardy 166 Bould, Mark 30 Bounous, Denise 229 Bourbeau, Philippe 96 Bourdier, Jean-Paul 248, 362 Boutron, Isabelle 286 Bowie, Vaughan 144 Bowkett, Steve 53 Boyarchenko, Svetlana 286 Boyarkin, Oleg 303 Boyd-Caine, Tessa 143 Boylan, Thomas 166 Boyle, John A. 350 Boys’ Experience of Schooling 80 Boys, Jos 247 Bradford, Ben 135 Bradnock, Robert W. 105 Brancaccio, Emiliano 169 Brans, Marleen 95 Bratton, Patrick 101 Braun, Hans-Joachim 165 Bray, George A. 240 Brayford, Jo 142 Breen, Louise A. 10 Bremser, Martha 46 Brenner, Y.S. 332 Brent, David A. 212 Bresler, Liora 78 Bressey, Caroline 14 Breyley, Gay 116 Brick, Lyndean L. 154 Bridel, Pascal 167 Bridging the Transition from Primary to Secondary School 52 Brincat, Shannon 84 Bringing the Froebel Approach to Your Early Years Practice 50, 360 Bristow, Joseph 29 British and the Grand Tour, The 12
Carroll, Maggie Case Management Workbook, The Case Studies in Language Curriculum Design Case, Stephen Casey Benyahia, Sarah Casey, Sharon Caspari, Volker Caspersen, Nina Cassell, Catherine Castan-Broto, Vanesa Castro, Gerardo Angeles Causation and Modern Philosophy Cazeaux, Clive CBT for Psychosis Cermak, Frantisek Cerone, Pietro Certain Share of Low Cunning, A Cerutti, Furio Ceva, Emanuela Chakraborti, Neil Chakraborty, Chandan Challand, Benoît Challenges and Controversies in Management Research Challenges of Being a Rural Gay Man, The Chambers, Colin Chambers, Donna Chambers, Gary Chambliss, William J. Chan, Elaine Chan, Janet Chan, Joseph Chan, Joseph M. Chan, Kam-Wah Chan, Yeeshan Chance and Intent Chandrasekhar, S. Chang, Felix Chang, Wei-Tze Chang, Zenghu Changing Power Relations in Northeast Asia Changing Schools Changing the News Chapin, Rosemary Chapman, Christopher Chapman, David Chapman, Jane Chapman, Murray Charles Gates, Charlesworth, Esther Chartrand, Gary Chatfield, Chris
54 154 53 144 18 141 169 117 159 175 168 6 4 199 40 283 129 92 93 134 271 128 159 187 45 171 274 140 60 160 111 110 250 106 146 330 107 290 300 106 70 19 182 76 317 20 341 16 246 281 278
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
index 377
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
Chow, Shein-Chung 286 Christakis, Théodore 128 Christian, Johnna 143 Christianity and Party Politics 92 Christians in Persia 352 Chung, Christopher A. 276 Circulation in Third World Countries 341 Cities and Low Carbon Transitions 175 Citizens in the Making in Post-Soviet States 107 City Design 248 City Reader 171 Clancy, Brian 35 Clark, Anna 12 Clarke, Linda 147 Clarke, Michael E. 113 Clarke, Ronald V. 140 Classical Literature 16 Clay, David 262 Clay, Sharon A. 262 Cleaver, Tony 163, 361 Cleminson, Richard 125 Clinical Trial Data Analysis using R 279 Clinician’s Guide to Effective Career Counseling for Individuals with Psychiatric Disabilities, A 201 Clohesy, Anthony M. 94 Close Relationships 192 Cluttering 192 Coaching Emotional Intelligence in the Classroom 53 Coaching Process, The 190 Coal Industry in China’s Political Economy, The 112 Coates, Elizabeth 50 Cobb, George P. 258 Cobham, David 116 Cochrane, John 179 Coes, Don 167 Coffee Culture 177 Cognitive Development and Working Memory 193 Cognitive-Behavioural Therapy 219 Cohen, Benjamin J. 89 Cohen, Henri 281 Cohen, Hillel 115 Cohen, Louis 69, 361 Cohen, Neal 218 Cohesion Policy and Multi-level Governance in South East Europe 92 Cole, Eugene C. 261 Cole, G.D.H. 320, 321 Cole, John P. 346 Coleman, John C. 197
@
College Geometry 279 Colli, Andrea 158 Collinge, Chris 186 Collins, Erik L. 18 Colloquial Czech 41, 359 Colloquial Hungarian 41, 359 Colloquial Lithuanian 41, 359 Colloquial Persian 42, 359 Colloquial Polish 42, 360 Color of Metal Compounds, The 313 Colosi, Rachela 143 Colverd, Sue 50 Combustion Engineering 263 Commitment, Character, and Citizenship 80 Commodity Risk Management 146 Commonly Asked Questions in Thermodynamics 300 Commonsense Methods for Children with Special Educational Needs 64 Commonwealth Caribbean Property Law 118 Communalism and Globalization in South Asia and its Diaspora 107 Companion to Life Course Studies, A 177 Comparative Criminal Justice 130 Compliance in Today’s Global Supply Chain 158 Comprehensive Children’s Mental Health Services in Schools and Communities 212 Computability Theory 284 Computational Methods for Electromagnetic and Optical Systems 269 Computational Methods in Finance 279 Computational Quantum Mechanics for Nuclear Physics 309 Computational Systems Biology of Cancer 289 Computer Misuse 130 Comrie, Bernard 44 Concise Compendium of the World’s Languages 42 Concise Dictionary of the Persian Language, A 351 Concise Guide to Workplace Safety and Health 274 Concussive Brain Trauma 221 Condry, Rachel 143 Conermann, Stephan 112 Configurational Forces 270 Conflict and Peacebuilding in Sri Lanka 107
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Chau, Tom 230 Chaudhuri, Arijit 286 Chaudhuri, Uttam Ray 298 Chelliah, Raja J. 333 Chemical Warfare during the Vietnam War 9 Chemicals, Environment, Health 257 Chemistry of Discotic Liquid Crystals 308 Chen, Antao 308 Chen, Ding-Geng 279 Chen, Homer H. 292 Chen, Hsieh-Ching 259 Chen, Wai-Fah 252 Cheng, Khoo Siau 293 Cherry, Sally 144 Cheung, Peter 111 Cheung, Ying Kuen 280 Chew, Wilson 146 Chi, Hung-Lin 290 Chicano School Failure and Success 71 Child Anxiety Disorders 212 Child Pornography 125 Child-Centered Play Therapy 210 Child-Centred Pharmacology 215 Childhood in World History 10 Children, Youth and the City 171 Children’s and Families’ Holiday Experience 175 Children’s Literature in the Classroom 53 Chin, C.Y. 298 China Development Research Foundation 106, 107 China’s Integrationist Language Policy 106 China’s One-Child Policy and Multiple Caregiving 106 China’s Southern Tang Dynasty, 937–976 107 Chinese Economists on Economic Reform – Collected Works of Guo Shuqing 106 Chinese Economists on Economic Reform – Collected Works of Xue Muqiao 106 Chinese Migrants in Russia, Central Asia and Eastern Europe 107 Chinowsky, Paul 255 Chipman, John 170 Cho, Joonmo 170 Choi, Taeryon 285 Chong, Terence 113 Chongvilaivan, Aekapol 168 Chorafas, Dimitris N. 159 Choral Music 49
Conflict and Peacemaking in Israel-Palestine 116 Conflict Intervention in the Third World 343 Conflict Resolution 84 Confronting Climate Change 177 Confronting Global Gender Justice 178 Connectivity for Seamless Mobility 270 Connell, Ann 196 Conneller, Chantal 15 Conrad, Mark 25 Conrad, Tim 157 Constitution of Liberty, The 169 Constructing a Social Welfare System for All in China 107 Constructing Global Enemies 92 Constructing US Foreign Policy 92 Contemporary English-Language Indian Children’s Literature 32 Contemporary French Philosophy 2 Contemporary Vietnam 107 Contesting Global Order 84 Continental Aesthetics Reader, The 4 Contradictions of Archaeological Theory 185 Contrastivism in Philosophy 6 Contributions to the History of Economic Thought 166 Control and Mechatronics 263 Control Handbook, The 267 Control Handbook, The 273 Control Systems Handbook, Second Edition, The 273 Controversial Issues in Clinical Trials 284 Converging Worlds 10 Cook, Thomas A. 158 Cook, Vivian 194 Cooke, Fang Lee 104 Cooper, Cary L. 144 Cooper, S. Barry 284 Coppola, Damon P. 92 Corasaniti, Marie Tiziana 219 Corbridge, Stuart 105 Cordner, Christopher 6 Cornell, Sarah 170 Corradi, Juan 343 Corrections 178 Corrosion Mechanisms in Theory and Practice 300 Corruption in Developing Countries 343 Cosentino, Marco 219 Coskuner, Orkid 311 Cosmopolitan Justice and its Discontents 125
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
378 index
order now!
Critical Curriculum Leadership 71 Critical Perspectives on the Responsibility to Protect 101 Critical Psychology 322 Critical Readings in Bodybuilding 191 Critical Realism and Creativity 185 Critical Theory in International Relations and Security Studies 84 Critical Thinking 2 Crnobori, Mary 211 Croall, Hazel 142 Croally, Neil 16 Crompvoets, Joep 258 Crook, Thomas H. 14 Crook, Tim 25 Cross, Julie 32 Cross-Cultural Issues in Art 18 Cross-Curricular Teaching and Learning in the Secondary School... Mathematics 54 Cross-Curricular Teaching and Learning in the Secondary School... The Arts 54 Crouchley, Robert 286 Cruvellier, Mark R. 247 Crystal, David 35 Csaszar, Attila G. 304 CSI for the First Responder 233 Cubitt, Geoff 15 Cudney, Elizabeth A. 148 Cultural Competence for Public Managers 160 Cultural Expertise and Litigation 125 Cultural Politics of Post 9/11 American Sport, The 191 Cultural Validity in Assessment 62 Culture of Management, The 183 Cultures of Curriculum 62 Cumberland, John H. 284 Cummings, Colleen 70 Cummings, Nicholas A. 200 Cumulative Effects in Wildlife Management 261 Cunliffe, Philip 101 Cunningham, Ian 162 Curran, Bruce H. 310 Cushion, Chris 190 Cushman, Thomas 180 Cuthbert, Michael 122 Cwiklik, Chesterene 236 Cyber Criminology 237 Cyber Security Essentials 293 Czinkota, Michael 155
( +44 (0)1235 400524
d Daczkowska-Kozon, Elzbieta G. 239 Dadgar, Armin 310 Dagkas, Symeon 191 Daigger, Glen T. 314 Dakolias, Maria 170 dal Vera, Rocco 47 Daly, Caroline 71 Daly, Herman 284 Dame, Richard F. 225 Damelio, Robert 145 Danaher, Patrick Alan 80 Daniels, Stephen 172 Dargush, Gary F. 252 Darnell, Connie 234 Das, Dilip K. 237 Dasgupta, Sangeeta 113 Dashti, Ali 351 Data Analysis and Knowledge Discovery 292 Data Mining and Machine Learning in Cybersecurity 293 Data Mining in Biomedical Imaging, Signaling, and Systems 296 Data Storage Management, Implementation, and Strategies 297 D’Augelli, Anthony R. 187 David L. Bodde, 146 David, Gamage 74 Davidson, Karina W. 194 Davies, Dan 60 Davies, Ian 71 Davis, John W. 151 Davis, Larry E. 218 Davis, Tracy 67 Davison, Jon 61, 360 Day, Alison 55 Day, Andrew 141 Daylighting 244 DC Power Supplies 270 De Lima, Joao Jose 306 De Negri, Victor J. 270 de Silva, Chamindra 289 de Silva, S.B.D. 346 Dealing With Drugs 132 Dean, David J. 309 Dear, Michael 173 Debates in English Teaching 71 Debates in History Teaching 71 Debates in Religious Education Teaching 72 Debating Political Identity and Legitimacy in the European Union 92
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Costa, Heloise 250 Costanza, Robert 284 Cotula, Lorenzo 126 Coughlan, Barry J. 199 Coulombe, Joseph L. 28 Counter-Terrorism and State Political Violence 101 Cousins, Jacquie 51 Couve, Cyril 208 Cowe, Francis 142 Cox Han, Lori 87 Cox, David J. 129 Coyne, Richard 244 Craker, Lyle 225 Cramer, Jane K. 100 Crane, Joseph T. 155 Crawford, Adam 142 Crawford, Robert 254 Crawley, Elaine M. 130 CRC Handbook of Phase Equilibria and Thermodynamic Data of Copolymer Solutions 309 Creating Cultural Monsters 233 Creating Second Lives 26 Creativity and Innovation in Business and Beyond 160 Cree, Viviene E. 220 Crime 131 Crime and Criminal Justice 179 Crime and Economics 131 Crime and the Rise of Modern America 10, 357 Crime Prevention 131 Crime Prevention Policies in Comparative Perspective 142 Crimes Against Nature 142 Criminal Behaviour in Context 142 Criminal Investigation 142 Criminal Justice 142 Criminal Justice in Scotland 142 Criminal Justice Research Methods 118 Criminal Law 142 Criminal Law, Procedure, and Evidence 118 Criminal Psychology 142 Criminal Recidivism 131 Criminology 142 Criminology and Criminal Justice 142 Crises and Cycles in Economic Dictionaries and Encyclopaedias 166 Crisp, Richard J. 324 Critical Cleaning Agents and Systems 276 Critical Cleaning Applications, Processes, and Controls 276
Deception 193 DeChurch, Leslie 195 Decline of Regionalism in Putin’s Russia, The 112 Decoding Boundaries in Contemporary Japan 107 Deering, John 142 Definitive Guide to Emergency Department Operational Improvement, The 155 Delanty, Gerard 182 Deleuze & Guattari: Emergent Law 125 Deleuze and World Politics 92 DeLyser, Dydia 172 Demaison, Jean 304 DeMarco, William J. 221 Demmers, Jolle 100 Democracy and Famine 93 Democratic Culture 107 Dennis, Pascal 145 Dermatokinetics of Therapeutic Agents 232 Derrida for Architects 244 Design Economies and the Changing World Economy 175 Designing Better Schools for Culturally and Linguistically Diverse Children 72 Designing History in East Asian Textbooks 108 Designing Network On-Chip Architectures in the Nanoscale Era 292 Designing Public Policies 85 Desistance from Sex Offending 199 Devasahayam, Theresa 108 Developing Cultural Capability in International Higher Education 66 Developing Emotional Intelligence in the Primary School 50 Developing Inquiry for Learning 66 Developing Physical Health and Well-being through Gymnastic Activity (5–7) 54 Developing Your Portfolio – Enhancing Your Learning and Showing Your Stuff 79 Development and Planning 341 Development and the Debt Trap 330 Development and the Environmental Crisis 332 Development and Underdevelopment 346 Development and Underdevelopment in Historical Perspective 347 Development of Capitalism in Africa, The 345
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
index 379
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
Doing Ethics in Media 19 Doing History 55 Doing Justice to Young People 143 Doing Multicultural Education for Achievement and Equity 72 Domesticity and Design in American Women’s Lives and Literature 32 Dongarra, Jack 290 Donnell, Alison 30 Donovan, Jerome 117 Dorion, Robert B.J. 236 Dorodnitsyn, Vladimir 284 Dose Finding by the Continual Reassessment Method 280 Dosser, Douglas 332 Douglas, Ian 173 Downey, Christopher 79 Doyle, Michael W. 99 Dragomir, Silvestru Sever 283 Drakakis-Smith, David 340 Drake, Deborah 142 Drama Sessions for Primary Schools and Drama Clubs 55 Drennan, Gerard 139 Dropping the Baby and Other Scary Thoughts 201 Drug Delivery Systems 232 Drugs, Crime and Public Health 119 D’sa, Raechelle A. 229 Du, Winncy 312 Du, Xian 293 Dua, Sumeet 296 Dudley, Geoff 185 Dudley, R. 253 Dumper, Michael 114 Dunbar, Julie C. 48 Dunn, John 43 Durkheim, Bernard and Epistemology 179 Durrant, Joan E. 81 Durrant, Sam 32 Durukal, Eser 252 Dünkel, Frieder 138 Dür, Andreas 94 Düwell, Marcus 125 Dwyer, Angela 139 Dychkovskiy, Roman 299 Dynamic Capacity Management for Healthcare 146 Dynamic Embodiment for Social Theory 185 Dynamical Tunneling 304 Dynamics and Bioavailability of Heavy Metals in the Rootzone 257 Dynamics of Desistance, The 141 Dyson, Alan 70
@
e E.E. Slutsky as Economist and Mathematician 166 Eagle, Antony 3 Eagle, Morris N. 208 Earle, Rod 144 Earley, Penelope 77 Easson, Angus 28 East Asian Transformation 104 Easton, Susan 138 Eccleston, Charles 261 Eckhaus, Richard 341 Ecks, Stefan 111 EcoEdge, The 246 Ecological Consequences of Climate Change 261 Ecological Modernisation and Environmental Compliance 108 Ecology of Marine Bivalves 225 Economic and Social Structure of Mauritius, The 336 Economic Crisis in Europe 318 Economic Development in East Asia 335 Economic Development in the Tropics 335 Economic Developments in Contemporary Russia 108 Economic Governance in the EU 166 Economic History of Ireland Since Independence, An 166 Economic Integration in Africa 337 Economic Planning and Social Justice in Third World Countries 341 Economic Tracts for the Times 319 Economics and Diversity 166 Economics of Aid, The 328 Economics: The Basics 163, 361 Economies of Africa, The 337 Edge, Julian 63 Edible Coatings and Films to Improve Food Quality 241 Education and Development 339 Education and Development in Latin America 338 Education and Sustainability 80 Education in the Third World 339 Education, Professionalism and the Quest for Accountability 80 Educational Psychology: Concepts, Research and Challenges 72 Edwards, Anne 56 Edwards, Brian 246 Edwards, Kathy 154 Edwards, Lee 23 Edwards, Sylvia 64
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Development Policy in Small Countries 338 Development Theory 347 Development–induced Displacement, Rehabilitation and Resettlement in India 108 Developmental Cognitive Science Goes to School 54 Dew, Nick 147 Dewees, Martha P. 178 Dewhurst, Peter 275 Dhillon, B.S. 275 Dialectics, Politics, and the Contemporary Value of Hegel’s Practical Philosophy 6 Dialogues in Urban and Regional Planning 250 Diamond, Larry 86 Diaz-Alejandro, Carlos F. 334 Dibeh, Ghassan 116 Dictionary of International Relations, A 316 Dictionary of Policing 142 Diekmann, Anya 176 Diet and Nutrition in Palliative Care 241 Diet, Nutrients, and Bone Health 241 Digital Development in Korea 108 Digital Signal Processing with 263 Examples in MATLAB® Dimarzio, Charles A. 311 Dinkin, Steven 154 D’Ippoliti, Carlo 166 Dirty Dancing 143 Disability and New Media 26 Disaster Victim Identification 237 Discourse and Democracy 38 Discrete Structures with Contemporary Applications 279 Discrete Variational Derivative Method 284 Discrete-Event Modeling and Simulation 270 Distance Teaching for the Third World 339 Distillers Grains 225 Distributing Silent Film Serials 26 Diversity in Europe 93 Divine Songs of Zarathushtra, The 352 Dixon, Kerryn 63 Dixon, Martin J. 123 Doche, Christophe 281 Dodds, Tony 339 Dodson, Michael 113 Does Aid Work in India? 329 Dogramatzis, Dimitris 228 Doig, Alan 144
Edwards, Tim 18 Effective Crime Reduction Strategies 237 Effective Practice in Youth Justice 179 Effective Teacher’s Guide, The 61 Effective Teacher’s Guide to Behavioural and Emotional Disorders, The 65 Effective Teacher’s Guide to Sensory and Physical Impairments, The 65 Effectual Entrepreneurship 147 Effingham, Nikk 3 Efremov, German 271 Ege, Ragip 167 Eggen, Arne P. 247 Eguchi, Shigeru 43 Ehteshami, Anoush 353 Eickelman, Dale 117 EL-Azhary, M.S. 350 E-Learning in the 21st Century 68 Electroanalytical Chemistry 309 Electronically Monitored Punishment 132 Elements of Differential Topology 284 Elements of Industrial Hazards 299 Eleven Exercises in the Art of Architectural Drawing 245 Elizabethan Dumb Show, The 29 Elleman, Bruce A. 101 Elliott, Brian 244 Elliott, Jane 31 Ellis, Katie 26 Ellison, D. Hank 9 Ellison, Gordon 276 Elmadfa, Ibrahim 241 El-Metwally, Salah El-Din E. 252 Elwell-Sutton, L.P. 349 Emergence of Daoism, The 112 Emerging Practices in Science and Technology Librarianship 26 Emery, Paul 190 Emotion, Genre, and Justice in Film and Television 27 Enabling Technologies for Seamless Mobility 270 Enchanted Screen, The 25, 358 Encyclopedia of Animal Science, (Online Version) 223 Encyclopedia of Information Assurance – 4 Volume Set 294 Ending Forced Labour in Myanmar 108 Energetic Materials 309 Energy Efficiency in New and Existing Buildings 253 Energy Policy in the U.S. 160
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
380 index
order now!
Ethics of Sports Coaching, The 190 Ethnicity and Religion 93 Ethnography and Language Policy 73 Ettouney, Mohammed M. 252 EU Foreign Policy and Post-Soviet Conflicts 93 Eurocentrism 186 Europa Publications 317 European Court of Human Rights in the Post-Cold War Era, The 127 European Foreign Policy and the Challenges of Balkan Accession 93 European Gardens 249, 362 European Skills and Qualifications 147 European Union and Global Governance, The 317 Europeanization and Foreign Policy 93 Evans, Elizabeth 27 Evans, Julie 57 Evans, Scott 280 Event Policy 172 Evidence-based Care for Breastfeeding Mothers 215 Evidence-based Care for Normal Labour and Birth 216 Evidence-based Parenting Support 217 Evolution and Crime 132 Evolution of Economic Theory, The 169 Evolving Firm in the Evolving Context, The 169 Evolving Structure of the East Asian Economic System since 1700, The 169 eWork and eBusiness in Architecture, Engineering and Construction 251 Exchange, The 154 Exercises and Solutions in Biostatistical Theory 280 Exercises for Rebel Artists 46 Experiences of Freedom in Postcolonial Literatures and Cultures 28 Experimental Techniques in Mechanics and Materials 309 Experts 186 Explaining Pakistan’s Foreign Policy 108 Exploratory Data Analysis with MATLAB 280 Exploratory Multivariate Analysis by Example Using R 284 Exploring Children’s Creative Narratives 50
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Exploring Classroom Discourse 34 Exploring English Language Teaching 34 Export Instability and Economic Development 336 Export-Oriented Industrialisation 336 External Impact of International Environmental Law and Principle, The 127 Extreme Value Methods with Applications to Finance 285 Eyers, Kerrie 204 Eylon, Bat-Sheva 62 Ezzell, Edna Z. 251
f Facer, Keri 75 Facos, Michelle 19 Factors in Economic Development 333 Fafinski, Stefan 134 Fagel, Michael J. 92 Fageria, Nand Kumar 224 Fairley, Jillian 230 Fake Stuff 181 Fallin, Jana 48 Families Shamed 143 Fan, Lida 111 Fanger, Michael 222 Fantina, Robert 158 Farnell, Brenda 185 Farooki, Masuma 170 Farquharson, Stuart 308 Farr, John V. 275 Farrall, Stephen 125 Farrell, Michael 65 Farrelly, Michael 38 Farrington, David P. 135 Fashion In Focus 18 Fatemi, Sasan 116 Fathpour, Sasan 313 Faulconbridge, J.R. 175 Faulconbridge, James R. 175 Faulkner, Dorothy 50 Fautley, Martin 54 Favorite Counseling and Therapy Homework Assignments 202 Favorite Counseling and Therapy Techniques 202 Feather, John 322 Federalism and Economic Growth in Underdeveloped Countries 335 Fedor, Julie 101 Feedback Toolkit 148 Feelings 179
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Energy, Bio Fuels and Development 167 Engøy Henriksen, Berit 36 Engaging Boys in Treatment 210 Engelskirchen, Howard 170 Engendering Curriculum History 73 English Press in the Eighteenth Century, The 12 English: An Essential Grammar 42 Ennaji, Moha 114 Ensign, Margee M. 329 Ensslin, Astrid 26 Entrepreneurship 147 Entrepreneurship Marketing 147 Entrikin, J. Nicholas 172 Environment and Economy 172 Environment and Food 172 Environmental Contaminants in Biota 260 Environmental Crime 143 Environmental Criticism for the Twenty-First Century 32 Environmental Effects on Seafood Availability, Safety, and Quality 239 Environmental Impact Assessment 261 Envisioning Landscapes, Making Worlds 172 Epic of the Kings, The 352 Epistemology and Science Education 73 Epistemology and the Regress Problem 6 Eppler, Eva 36 Epstein, Eliot 258 Equilibrium Molecular Structures 304 Equity and Excellence in Education 80 Erdberg, Philip 125 Erdik, Mustafa 252 Ergonomic Trends from the East 259 Ergonomics for All: Celebrating PPCOE’s 20 Years of Excellence 259 Erickson, Martin 277 Ericson, David F. 90 Eriksson, Anna 143 Ermarth, Elizabeth Deeds 11 Escape Routes: Contemporary Perspectives on Life after Punishment 125 Essential Guide to Online Course Design, The 61 Essentials of Physical Chemistry 300 Esser, Frank 20 Ethics 2 Ethics of Forgiveness, The 6
Fell, Dafydd 104 Female Journalists of the Fin de Siècle 322 Female Romantics, The 33 Feminist Advocacy and Gender Equity in the Anglophone Caribbean 175 Feminist Security Studies 98 Feng, Wu-chun 289 Feng, Xia-Ting 299 Fenton, Rachel Anne 125 Fenwick, Helen 120 Ferdowsi, 352 Ferguson, Eilidh 234 Fernández de Castro, Rafael 91 Fernando de Paula, Luiz 167 Ferrari, Fabrizio 109 Ferrari, Joseph R 218 Ferrari, Michel 73 Ferris, Kerry O. 183 Fest, Eric 311 Fiber and Fabric Reinforced Cement Composites 252 Field, John 56 Fieldhouse, D.K. 333 Fields, Forces, and Flows in Biological Systems 223 FIFA (Fédération Internationale de Football Association) 85 Fifty Contemporary Choreographers 46 Fifty Key Anthropologists 176, 362 Fifty Years of EU-Turkey Relations 93 Fighting Market Failure 167 Filipe, Carlos D.M. 314 Filming the Nation 209 Filner, Barbara 154 Finance and Accounting for Energy Engineers 270 Finance and Economic Growth in Developing Countries 334 Financial Investigation and Forensic Accounting 234 Financial Liberalization and Economic Performance 167 Financial Structure and Income Distribution 167 Finch, Emily 134 Finch, Henry 344 Finnegan, Loretta P. 218 Fiore, Stephen M. 197 Firearms, the Law, and Forensic Ballistics 234 Fire Safety and Security in Retail Premises 253 Fiscal Policy in Underdeveloped Countries 333 Fischer, Eugen 6
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
index 381
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
Fourier Series in Several Variables with Applications to Partial Differential Equations 285 Fouseki, Kalliopi 15 Fowler, Corinne 33 Fox, Chris 131 Francis, Brian 144 Franklin, Bob 27 Franklin, Caroline 33 Franko Aas, Katja 125 Frascari, Marco 245 Fraser, Jim 143 Freedom and Happiness in Economic Thought and Philosophy 167 Freeman, Richard B. 170 Freight Transport and the Modern Economy 167 Freivalds, Andris 226 French, Duncan 127 Frequency Dictionary of Arabic, A 40 Frequency Dictionary of Czech, A 40 Frequency Dictionary of Mandarin Chinese, A 40 Frew, Elspeth 176 Frey, Gerhard 281 Frey, Nancy 61 Fricke, Christel 6 Fridman, Alexander 302 Friedman, Jonathan C. 13, 357 Friedmann, John 249 Fritsch, Juliette 15 From Bioeconomics to Degrowth 167 From Classical to Contemporary Psychoanalysis 208 From MEMS to Bio-MEMS and Bio-NEMS 305 From Testing to Productive Student Learning 80 From Water Scarcity to Sustainable Water Use in the West Bank, Palestine 314 Frosh, Stephen 179 Fruit and Cereal Bioactives 241 Frydenberg, Morten 278 Frye, Richard 349 Fryer, Peter J. 242 Frying of Food 241 Fuchs, Christian 186 Fudge, Bruce 117 Fuel Cell Technology Handbook 264 Fuller, Alison 67 Fuller, Bruce 338 Fuller, Gillian 187 Fuller, Gordon W. 238
@
Fullerton, Rosemary 155 Fundamental Concepts for Clinical Trial Statisticians 280 Fundamentals and Applications in Aerosol Spectroscopy 257 Fundamentals of Attosecond Optics 300 Fundamentals of Civil Engineering 251 Fundamentals of FourierTransform Infrared Spectroscopy 301 Fundamentals of Geomorphology 173 Fundamentals of Industrial Electronics 264 Fundamentals of Microfabrication and Nanotechnology, Three-Volume Set 264 Fundamentals of Multicore Software Development 292 Fundamentals of Natural Gas Processing 265 Fundamentals of Nonlinear Optics 301 Fundamentals of Petroleum and Petrochemical Engineering 298 Fundamentals of Workplace Learning, The 68 Furht, Borko 273 Furihata, Daisuke 284 Furlong, Paul 95 Fussey, Peter 102 Future of Global Business, The 155 Future of Global Currency, The 89
g G.D.H. Cole: Early Pamphlets & Assessment G.D.H.Cole: Selected Works G.H. Mead Gabbay, John Gabriel Faure Gade, Peter J. Gail, Marzieh Gaillard, Vinciane Gale, Laurence Galea, Sandro Galloway, John Ganßmann, Heiner Garbage Collection Handbook, The Gardner, Leslie Gardner, Sheena Garner, Sanford C. Garrett, Paul Garrett, Roger M. Garrison, D. Randy Garver, John W.
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Fischer, Nancy 181 Fish, Jacqueline T. 235 Fisher, Bonnie S. 144 Fisher, Donald L. 259 FISMA Principles and Best Practices 297 Fitzpatrick, Claire 144 Flannigan, Brian 274 Flashback 132 Flaxman, Paul E. 204 Fleetwood, Erin E.J. 333 Fletcher, Richard B. 57 Flich, Jose 292 Flint, Nerilee R.A. 68 Flood, John 33 Floyd, James Michael 49 Flynn, Nick 142 Foley, Malcolm 172 Fontana, Giuseppe 169 Food Aid and the Developing World 328 Food Allergens 239 Food and Poverty 327 Food Culture in Colonial Asia 108 Food in a Sustainable World 186 Food Process Engineering Operations 238 Forbes, Dean 340 Forbes-Pitt, Kate 6 Forensic Anthropology 234 Forensic Psychology 133 Forensic Psychology in Context 133 Forensic Science in Healthcare 234 Forsdick, Charles 33 Forum on China- Africa Cooperation (FOCAC), The 95 Foster, Robert 257 Fotos, Sandra S. 59 Foucault and Educational Leadership 81 Found, Pauline 153 Foundations of Critical Media and Information Studies 186 Foundations of Ethical Practice, Research, and Teaching in Psychology and Counseling 202 Foundations of Institutional Economics, The 169 Foundations of Modernity 14 Founding Figures and Commentators in Arabic Mathematics 116 Four Stages of Highly Effective Crisis Management, The 155 Fourie, Robert J. 197 Fourier Modal Method and Its Applications in Computational Nanophotonics 270
319 319 186 217 49 19 350 193 338 218 56 168 291 209 38 241 322 339 68 105
Garvey, Penelope 208 Gates Foundation and the Future of US ‘Public’ Schools, The 81 Gaussian Process Regression Analysis for Functional Data 285 Gbadamosi, Tunji 147 Geberth, Vernon J. 236 Gebhardt, Albrecht 286 Gee, James Paul 35 Geels, Frank 185 Gelman, Andrew 281 Gender and U.S. Foreign Policy 101 Gender and Violence in the Middle East 114 Gender Equity and Institutional Transformation 160 Gender in Contemporary Iran 116 Gender, Emotions and Labour Markets – Asian and Western Perspectives 108 Gender, Sexualities and Law 125 General Equilibrium Analysis 167 Generational Intelligence 217 Gens, Antonio 298 Gensler, Harry J. 2 Geographies of Children, Youth and Families 180 Geographies of Globalization 173 Geography of the Third World, The 341 Geography of Underdevelopment, The 340 GeoHumanities 173 Geologically Active 298 Georgescu-Roegen, Nicolas 167 Georgiadou, Yola 258 Geostatistics 256 Gerard Manley Hopkins 28 Gerding, Erik F. 166 Geri, Laurance R. 160 German Economy in the Twentieth Century, The 165 Gersovitz, Mark 334 Gertler, Brie 3 Gevorkyan, Aleksandr V. 168 Ghassemi, Abbas 257 Ghassemi, Majid 257 Ghaye, Tony 58 Ghirann, Gordon 152 Ghose, Ajit Kumar 327 Ghosh, Somnath 272 Gibbons, Alison 38 Gibbs, Jessica 96 Gibney, John 186 Giddings, Seth 25 Gifford, Julie 106 Giger, Nathalie 96 Gilbert, Martin 13, 357
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
382 index
order now!
Goode, David 173 Goode, J. Paul 112 Goodhand, Jonathan 107 Goodland, Robert 284 Goodman, Diane J. 76 Goodman, Joyce 325 Goodson, Ivor F. 56 Goodwin, Anthony R.H. 300 Goodwin, Harold 174 Goodwin, Prue 77 Goold, Benjamin J. 143 Gordon, Robert J. 176, 362 Gorman, Sarah 47 Gorostiaga, Xabier 334 Gossling, Stefan 171 Gottfried, Jay A. 233 Goulart, Pedro 169 Gould, Marty 47 Governance and Regulation in the Third Sector 160 Government and Politics in Taiwan 104 Government of Chronic Poverty, The 176 Gozna, Lynsey 193 Gråwe, Rolf W. 199 Gracyk, Theodore 5 Grady, Jr., C.P. Leslie 314 Graham, Gordon 4 Graham, Hannah 144 Graham, Robert 353 Grainger, Roy Gordan 257 Grand Strategy and the Presidency 101 Granhag, Par Anders 133 Grant, Carl A. 72 Grant, David 161 Graphs & Digraphs 281 Graupp, Patrick 149 Gray, Dennis J. 224 Gray, George W. 313 Gray, Jacqueline M. 133 Grear, Anna 125 Great Depression, The 324 Greek World 479–323 BC, The 16 Green Business, Green Values, and Sustainability 160 Green Computing 289 Green IT Strategies and Applications 294 Green Lister, Pam 220 Green Revolution Revisited, The 327 Green, Jane 80 Green, Mick 188 Green, Sandy 50 Green, Simon 90
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Green’s Functions and Linear Differential Equations 283 Greene, Beverly A. 177 Greene, Roberta R 187 Greenhalgh, Brian 254 Gregoriou, Christiana 38 Greyser, Stephen 152 Grieve, John 143 Griffith-Jones, Stephany 334 Griffiths, Caroline 222 Griffiths, Gary 153 Griffiths, Gerwyn 123 Grinberg, Nelu 304 Grodzinsky, Alan J. 223 Grote, James 310 Groundwater Hydrology 315 Growing-Up Modern 338 Growth and Mineral Nutrition of Field Crops 224 Grumet, Madeleine 79 Grundmann, Reiner 186 Grundy, Peter 37 Grushka, Eli 304 Gu, Kai-Yuan 290 Guanglong, Dai 299 Guess, George M. 328 Guide to Obesity and the Metabolic Syndrome, A 240 Guild Socialism Restated 320 Guion, Robert M. 192 Gulla, Jon Atle 296 Gunaratna, Rohan 102 Gupta, K.L. 334 Gustav Holst 49 Guy, Josephine 30
h Hackman, L. Haddow, George Hadfield, Amelia Haen, Craig Hagan, Pat Hagen, Roger Hagenmaier, Robert Haider, Syed Imtiaz Haines, Kevin Halevi, Joseph Hall III, Clifford A. Hall, Christopher Hall, Graham Hall, Kenneth R. Hall, Matthew Hall, Michael Hall, Nathan Hames, David
D +44 (0)1235 400525
237 92 86 210 149 199 241 230 144 164 241 36 34 110 144 174 143 222
çè
Gilbert, Paula Ruth 178 Giles, David E.A. 285 Giller, Henri 179 Gillespie, Alisdair A. 125 Gills, Barry K. 83 Gilthorpe, Mark S 282 Gilyard, Keith 37 Giri, Chandra P. 262 Girling, John 342 GIS Applications in Agriculture, Volume Three 262 GIS Applications in Agriculture, Volume Two 262 GIS Programming 262 Glaeser, Bernhard 327 Glenn, Angela 51 Global Contamination Trends of Persistent Organic Chemicals 261 Global Design History 19 Global Economic Crisis, The 169 Global Environment Policy 260 Global Environmental Harm 133 Global Ideologies and Urban Landscapes 93 Global Innovation in Emerging Economies 160 Global Pathways to Abolishing Physical Punishment 81 Global Politico-Economic Crises 167 Global Politics and the Responsibility to Protect 98 Global Population Ageing and Migration in Europe 167 Globalisation and the Quest for Social and Environmental Justice 126 Globalization of Advertising, The 175 Globalization, Labor Export and Resistance 93 Globalization, Outsourcing and Labour Development in ASEAN 168 Godehardt, Nadine 95 Goff, Philip 3 Goh, Esther 106 Gokhale, Balchandra V. 299 Goldsmith, Andrew 111 Goldson, Barry 184 Goldstein, Dennis H. 302 Goldstein, Sam 194 Goldstein, Tina R. 212 Golombek, Paula R. 58 Gomery, Douglas 22 Gomez-Pena, Guillermo 46 Gonzalez, Carlos A. 311 Good City, The 250, 363 Goodby, John W. 313
Hamilton, Jerome 150 Hammond, Philip 20 Hamowy, Ronald 169 Han, Jiawei 293 Han, JungHyun 290 Hanafi, Sari 117 Handa, Yuichi 62 Handbook for Critical Cleaning 274 Handbook of Adolescent Transition Education 73 Handbook of Analysis of Oligonucleotides and Related Products 305 Handbook of Asian Education 74 Handbook of Clinical Issues in Couple Therapy 205 Handbook of Comparative Communication Research 20 Handbook of Criminal Investigation 143 Handbook of Driving Simulation for Engineering, Medicine, and Psychology 259 Handbook of Ecological Models used in Ecosystem and Environmental Management 260 Handbook of Elliptic and Hyperelliptic Curve Cryptography 281 Handbook of Empirical Economics and Finance 285 Handbook of Ethics in Quantitative Methodology 193 Handbook of Food Process Modeling and Statistical Quality Control 238 Handbook of Forensic Science 143 Handbook of Health Psychology and Behavioral Medicine 194 Handbook of Healthcare Delivery Systems 274 Handbook of Human Rights 180 Handbook of Hydraulic Fluid Technology 270 Handbook of India’s International Relations 316 Handbook of Indoor Air Contaminants 261 Handbook of Inorganic Compounds 309 Handbook of Internet Crime 143 Handbook of Laboratory Animal Science, Volume I 227 Handbook of Markov Chain Monte Carlo 281 Handbook of Medical Tourism Development 148 Handbook of Mobile Systems Applications and Services 297 Handbook of Neurodevelopmental and Genetic Disorders in Children 194
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
index 383
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
Harvey, Lisa H. Harvey, Tamara Hassan, David Hassler, Christ Andri Hatcher, Brian Hate Crime Hattie, John Hau, Jann Hawkins, Cyndy Hawthorn, Geoffrey Hayek, F.A. Hayes, Caroline C. Hayes, Elisabeth Hayes, Sharon Haynes, Jo Haynes, Stephen N. Hazarika, Hemanta Hazelwood, Arthur Hazelwood, Vikki He, Ming Fang He, Weixuan Healey, J.M. Health and Religious Rituals in South Asia Healthcare Biotechnology Healthcare Crime Healthcare Payment Systems Healy, Deirdre Hearing the Victim Heat Exchangers for Refrigeration Applications Heat Pipe Design and Technology Heat Pump Drying Heath, Deana Heath, Sue Heathcote, Sarah Heckert, Jamie Hedeager, Lotte Hehir, Aidan Heimberg, Richard G. Heinrich, Ansgard Heinz, Gary H. Hejduk, Renata Hellman, Caroline Helmsing, Bert Helps, Alicia Hema, Ramanathan Henderson, Jeffrey Hendricks, John Allen Hendry, Petra Henry, Paul-Marc Hensen, Jan L.M. Herbal Medicine Herbal Medicines Heritage of Soviet Oriental Studies, The
@
221 178 188 273 113 134 57 227 66 331 169 291 35 139 186 200 251 328 226 74 309 328 109 228 235 148 141 134 271 268 271 107 67 128 125 15 101 201 27 260 247 32 170 51 74 104 24 73 334 254 219 219 112
Hernández Sheets, Rosa 63 Herold, Rebecca 294 Herring, Jonathan 123 Herschinger, Eva 92 Hersen, Michel 200 Hess, Robyn S. 212 Hesse, Brian J. 95 Hess-Kosa, Kathleen 261 Hester, Richard 144 Hettmansperger, Thomas P. 287 Heuer, Gottfried 207 Hibbard, Michael 250 Hick, Steven F. 202 Hickey, Sam 176 Hicks, Ursula 335 High Performance Computing 292 Higher Education 323 Higher Education Law 66 Hildebrandt, Mireille 128 Hill, Allan G. 331 Hill, Annette 22 Hill, Christopher 94 Hill, Hal 336 Hiltner, Ken 32 Hines, Peter 153 Hinkel, Eli 74 Hino, Ryutaro 265 Hipshon, David 11, 357 Hirata, Johannes 168 Hirsa, Ali 279 Hirsch, Alexander 96 Hirst, Paul Q. 179 Historical Revolution, The 12 History of Sexuality in Europe, The 12 Hiyaku: An Intermediate Japanese Course 43 Hjelm, Titus 186 Hjorth-Jensen, Mortin 309 Ho, Wai Yip 109 Hobson, J.A. 165 Hobson, John M. 95 Hockley, Luke 209 Hodder, B.W. 335 Hodder-Williams, Richard 342 Hodges, Caroline E.M. 23 Hodges, Donald 48 Hodgkin, Bernard 50 Hodkinson, Phil 56 Hodson, Mike 175 Hoffman, John B. 276 Hoffman, Marie T. 206 Hoffman, Robert R. 145 Hohl, Katrin 135 Holden, Livia 125 Hollander, Justin B. 249, 363 Hollingshead, Andrea 24
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Handbook of Nutraceuticals 241 Handbook of Pain Assessment 199 Handbook of Phase II Clinical Trial Design 231 Handbook of Plant and Crop Stress 223 Handbook of Police Psychology 193 Handbook of Public Protection 143 Handbook of Research in Second Language Teaching and Learning 74 Handbook of Research on Learning and Instruction 74 Handbook of Research on Teaching the English Language Arts 74 Handbook of Restorative Justice 143 Handbook of Self-Regulation 195 Handbook of Self-Regulation of Learning and Performance 75 Handbook of Spatial Point Pattern Analysis in Ecology 281 Handbook of Surface and Nanometrology 301 Handbook on Crime 133 Handelman, Sapir 116 Hanitzsch, Thomas 20 Hannam, Kevin 176 Hannay, Jackie 54 Hanrahan, Grady 308 Hanrahan, Stephanie J. 190 Hansen, Birthe 102 Hansen, Randall 94 Hansen, Shirley J. 162 Hanson, Marta 111 Hao, Jingcheng 312 Happiness, Ethics and Economics 168 Harcourt, Deborah 76 Harder, Hans 112 Hardman, Alun R 190 Hargrave, Terry D. 205 Harney, Stefano 183 Harper, Claudia 224 Harper, Douglas 185 Harper, Thomas L. 250 Harris, Lisa K. 261 Harris, Scott R. 183 Harris, Vandra 111 Harrison, Karen 136 Harrison, Michael 164 Harrison, Richard 153 Harriss, John 105 Hartley, Keith 165 Harvesting and Managing Knowledge in Construction 254 Harvey, Joel 143
Hollywood Melodrama and the New Deal 27 Holocaust and Representations of Jews, The 117 Holt, Louise 180 Holt, Richard 189 Holtham, Gerald 328 Holtschneider, K. Hannah 117 Home Birth 215 Homeyer, Linda 211 Hønneland, Geir 93 Hoogers, Gregor 264 Hooglund, Eric 116 Hook, Glenn D. 107 Hook, Steven W. 88 Hooper, Nigel 222 Hopeful Girls, Troubled Boys 180 Hopkins-Burke, Roger 130 Hordeski, Michael Frank 258 Hornberger, Julia 127 Hornblower, Simon 16 Hornyak, Gabor L. 229 Horror Noire 21 Horschelmann, Kathrin 171 Horsey, Richard 108 Horvath, Miranda 144 Hosking, Antony 291 Hosmane, Narayan S. 308 Hostettler, Nick 186 Houck, Mike 173 Hough, Dan 90 Hough, Mike 125 Houlihan, Barrie 188 House: The Wounded Healer on Television 209 How Offenders Transform Their Lives 143 How Science Works 55 How the Law Works 119 How to Teach Poetry Writing: Workshops for Ages 5–9 55 Howard, Damian 116 Howard, Erica 126 Howard, Frederic 328 Howard, Justine 217 Howard, Ken W.F. 315 Howard, Patrick D. 297 Howard, Rick 293 Howe, Alan 52 Howell, Alison 94 Howells, Kevin 141 Howlett, Michael 85 Hoyle, B.S. 340 HRM in the Sport and Leisure Industry 188 Hua, Zhu 36 Huang, W.M. 312 Huang, Xiaoming 112
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
384 index
i Ibarz, Albert 242 IBM SPSS for Intermediate Statistics 196 Ibn Yamin 351 IBSS: Economics: 2009 Vol.58 316 ICJ and the Development of International Law, The 128 ICT for Teaching Assistants 56 Idea of World Government 85 Ideas of Ronald H. Coase, The 169 Identity Theft 134 Identity, Feeling and Sociality at Work 161 Ideology and Social Change in Latin America 343 Iedema, Rick 161 Igersheim, Herrade 167 III-V Compound Semiconductors 310
order now!
Iiss 318 Illegal Leisure Revisited 194 Illeris, Knud 68 Illicit Drugs 180 Ilyas, Mohammad 273 Image and Video Processing in the Compressed Domain 271 Image Processing Handbook, The 267 Images and Behaviour of Private Bank Lending to Developing Countries 329 Imagining Business 161 Imig, David G. 77 Impact of China on Global Commodity Prices, The 170 Implementing and Developing Cloud Computing Applications 297 Implementing Lean Six Sigma throughout the Supply Chain 148 Implementing Sustainability 250 Implementing TWI 149 Improving Learning through the Lifecourse 56 Improving Research through User Engagement 56 Improving Water Policy and Governance 175 In Other Words 34 In Search of Democracy 86 In Search of Omar Khayyam 351 Inayatullah, Naeem 83 Inclusion and Exclusion Through Youth Sport 191 Incredible Complexity of the Social Sciences, The 170 Indian Economic Policy and Development 332 Indo-Iranian Studies 351 Indoor Air Quality 261 Induction Motor Drives 271 Industrial Communication Systems 264 Industrial Composting 258 Industrial Electronics Handbook – Five Volume Slip Case Set, The 267 Industrial Structure and Policy in Less Developed Countries 335 Inequality and Power 168 Inequality, Development, and Growth 163 Infant Mortality, Population Growth and Family Planning in India 330 Informatics in Radiation Oncology 310 Information Security Management Handbook, 2011 CD-ROM 294
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Infrastructure Health in Civil Engineering 252 Inman, Keith 236 Innovations in Lifelong Learning 67 Innovations in Materials Manufacturing, Fabrication, and Environmental Safety 310 Innovative Fiscal Policy and Economic Development in Transition Economies 168 Institutional Diversity and Innovation 109 Institutional Dynamics of China’s Great Transformation, The 112 Instructional Strategies for Middle and Secondary Social Studies 56 Insurgencies: Essays in Planning Theory 249 Insurgent Sepoys 109 Integrated Children’s Centres 75 Integrating Social Work Theory and Practice 220 Integration of European Financial Markets, The 128 Integration, development and equity: Economic Integration in West Africa 337 Intellectual Property Rights in Contemporary Capitalism 168 Intelligence and Intelligence Analysis 134 Intelligence and Intelligence Testing 57 Intelligence-led Policing 143 Intelligent Instrumentation 271 Intelligent Systems 265 Intelligent Transportation Systems 252 Interdependent Development 346 International Case Studies of Dyslexia 65 International Developments in Investigative Interviewing 143 International Economic Relations since 1945 11 International Environmental Agreements 93 International Finance and Latin America 334 International History & International Relations 86 International Indebtedness and the Developing Countries 329 International Law and the Israeli-Palestinian Conflict 114 International Migration 86 International Police Cooperation 135 International Politics of the Asia Pacific, The 104 International Trade Centre, The 89
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Hubbard-Van Stelle, Scott 228 Hudson, Joe 143 Hudson, John A. 299 Huggins, Richard 132 Hughes, Claire 196 Huismann, Mary Christison 49 Human Resource Management in China 104 Human Right to Water, The 128 Human Rights Discourse in North Korea 109 Human Rights in the Asia-Pacific Region 126 Human-Computer Etiquette 291 Humanitarian Intervention and the Responsibility to Protect 101 Humanitarianism Contested 85 Humor in Contemporary Junior Literature 32 Humphreys, Matthew 127 Hung, Yung-Tse 257 Hungry People and Empty Lands 330 Hunsley, John 200 Hupe, Philippe 289 Husby, Paul C. 150 Hush, Donald R. 263 Husson, Francois 284 Hyde, Roy 16 Hydroelectric Energy 258 Hydrophilic Interaction Liquid Chromatography (HILIC) and Advanced Applications 309 Hypnosis and Hypnotherapy with Children 212 Hysler-Rubin, Noah 249
International Who’s Who in Classical Music 2011, The 318 International Who’s Who in Classical/Popular Music Set 2011, The 318 International Who’s Who in Popular Music 2011, The 317 Internet Linguistics 35 Internet Retail Operations 161 Internet Searches for Vetting, Investigations, and Open-Source Intelligence 294 Interpretive Approaches to Research Design 86 Interrogating International Relations 109 Intersubjective Processes and the Unconscious 207 Interviewing for Radio 20 Introducing Bruner 50 Introducing Pragmatics in Use 35 Introducing Sociolinguistics 35 Introducing the New Sexuality Studies 181 Introduction to Building Procurement 254 Introduction to Closure Systems 285 Introduction to Complexity and Complex Systems 228 Introduction to Criminological Theory, An 130 Introduction to Critical Discourse Analysis in Education, An 70 Introduction to Ecological Economics, An 284 Introduction to Estimating Economic Models 163 Introduction to Fluorescence 310 Introduction to Food Process Engineering 242 Introduction to Forecasting Time Series Using Stata, An 277 Introduction to Functional Equations 285 Introduction to Nineteenth Century Art, An 19 Introduction to Stata for Health Researchers, An 278 Introduction to Statistical Limit Theory 283 Introduction to Stochastic Processes with Applications to Biology, An 278 Introduction to the Politics of Tropical Africa, An 342 Introduction to Visual Research Methods in Tourism, An 171 Investigation and Prevention of Officer-Involved Deaths 235 Investigative and Forensic Interviewing 125
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
index 385
j
çè
J. Michael Rona Consulting Group LLC 153 Jackson, Jonathan 135 Jackson, Shannon 46 Jackson, Sue 67 Jacobs, Allan B. 250, 363 Jacobs, Vicki 57 Jäger, Jill 170 Jaguaribe, Beatriz 186 Jaishankar, K. 237 Jalal, Ayesha 11 Jalali, Bahram 313 Jalobeanu, Dana 6 James, Philip 162 Jameson, David M. 310
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
Jamison, Robert E. Japanese Pharmaceutical Industry, The Japanese Religions on the Internet Japan’s Post-War Jarem, John M. Jarvie, Grant Jason, Leonard A. Javid-Nama Jeffries, Howard Jeffries, Ian Jenkins, Cheryl D. Jenkins, Janet Jerard, Jolene Anne R. Jewkes, Yvonne Jex, Igor Jiao, Liwei Jillson, Cal Jin, Jung-II Jobard, Fabien Jog, Milind A. Johal, Malkiat S. Johannes Brahms John P. Kotter John, Tim Johnson lll, Richard Greggory Johnson, Bruce Johnson, Dennis W. Johnson, Howard Johnson, Karen E. Johnston, Brenda Johnstone, Gerry Johnstone, Lorraine Jokela, Juha Jones, Byron Jones, Carwyn Jones, Charles Allan Jones, Christopher M. Jones, Erick C. Jones, Galin Jones, Jackie Jones, Ken Jones, Marc Jones, Marianne Jones, Patrick Jones, Richard Jones, Robyn L. Jordan-Meier, Jane Jorgensen, Sven Erik Joseph, Pamela Bolotin Journalism Education, Training and Employment Journalism Studies Journalists, Sources, and Credibility Joyce, Angela
@
285 112 7 109 269 189 218 352 149 110 23 339 102 143 312 40 83 310 144 263 303 49 323 137 160 68 84 120 58 67 143 136 93 286 190 224 88 276 281 125 78 188 79 236 291 190 155 260 62 27 20 27 207
Joyce, Peter Joyner, Chuck Juliani, Rodolfo Just Authority? Justice in Transition Juul, Svend Juvenile Justice Reform and Restorative Justice
Kachroo, Pushkin Kaid, Lynda Lee Kaiser, Alan Kal, Hong Kalkhan, Mohammed A. Kallestrup, Jesper Kaminer, Tahl Kaminski, Dan Kanarek, Marty S. Kandall, Stephen R. Kanegsberg, Barbara Kanegsberg, Ed Kanellopoulos, Nick Kang, Shih-Chung Kania, Andrew Kanjilal, Joydip Kannappan, Palaniappan Kapardis, Andreas Kaplan, Robert M. Kaplan, Steven Kaplinsky, Raphael Kaplinsky, Raphie Kapp, K. William Karakiewicz, Justyna Karamouz, Mohammad Kariv, Dafna Karki, Ajoy Kasabov, Nikola K. Kato, Isao Katz, Mark Kawakatsu, Heita Kawata, Satoshi Kay, Cristóbal Kay, David Keenan, Jack Keiper, Timothy A. Kelly, Anthony Kelly, David Kemp, René Kemper, Michael Kendler, Jonathan Kennedy, Frances Kennett, Patricia Kenney, Charles
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
142 118 225 135 143 278 143
k
çè
Ion Exchange and Solvent Extraction 310 Iqbal, Muhammad 352 Iran 353 Iran and the International Community 353 Iran Since the Revolution 349 Irani, D.J. 352 Iranian Music and Popular Entertainment 116 Iran-Iraq War, The 350 Iran-Iraq War, The 117 Iraq and Iran 349 Irgens, Eirik 162 Iris Murdoch, Gender and Philosophy 2 Iron Age Myth and Materiality 15 Irregular School, The 64 Irwin, Anthea 36 Irwin, J. David 267 Ishibashi, Isao 251 Islam and China’s Hong Kong 109 Islam and Education 323 Islam: The Basics 7, 356 Islamic Education and Indoctrination 81 Islamic Political Thought and Governance 323 Islamic Radicalism and Multicultural Politics 114 Islamic Revivalism in Syria 116 Islamization of Turkey under the AKP Rule 94 Ison, Keith 310 Israel-Palestine Conflict, The 115 IT Development in Korea 109 Italo Calvino’s Architecture of Lightness 32 ITIL 295
269 24 16 106 256 4 244 132 261 218 274 274 305 290 5 296 285 144 194 45 170 335 169 250 315 147 258 292 156 344 169 302 346 279 160 56 79 121 185 112 230 155 250 157
Kennish, Michael J. 225 Kent, Mike 26 Kerpchar, Joyce 150 Kerrigan, Kevin 120 Kershasp, P. 350 Keshavamurthy, Srihari 304 Kestle, Rodney 148 Ketchum, Jim 173 Keum, Jaeho 170 Key Readings in Criminology 135 Key Readings in Journalism 20 Keynes and Modern Economics 168 Khairov, Shamil 43 Kharkhordin, Oleg 110 Khatib, Line 116 Khattak, Asad J. 252 Kicki, Jerzy 299 Kidman, Lynn 190 Kidnay, Arthur J. 265 Kilfeather, Robert F. 119 Kim, Hwi 270 Kim, Jang-Kyo 308 Kim, Jubok 290 Kim, Sunwoong 170 King, Elliot 20 King, Gareth 42 King, Mike 144 Kingstone, Peter 90 Kirby, E. Stuart 335 Kirkpatrick, Colin 335 Kirshner, Lewis A. 206 Kiss, Tamas 312 Kitaeff, Jack 193 Kitchen, Nicholas 95 Kitchener, Karen Strohm 202 Kitching, Gavin 347 Klee, Harold 266 Kleiman, Karen 201 Klein, Natalie 126 Klemmer, Philip J. 241 Kline, Kimberly N. 22 Knapp, Clifford E. 77 Knight, Winston A. 275 Knowledge Science 292 Knowledge That Counts in a Global Community 75 Knudsen, Are 117 Kodilinye, Gilbert 118 Koehler, Jobst 94 Kohen, Daniel P. 212 Kolka, Randall 260 Komatsu, Keiichiro 167 Kong, Hyunjoon 231 Korea’s Occupied Cinemas 27 Korean Labour Market after the 1997 Economic Crisis, The 170
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
386 index 43 107 86 79 59 33 81 299 140 330 261 266 266 40 66 161 27 40 272 101 253 270 297 291 308 259 94 353 280 158 316 168 229 107 290 313 250 283
l L. McCarty, Teresa 73 LaBelle, Suzanne 36 Labor Law 119 Laboratory Mouse and Laboratory Rat Procedural Techniques 228 Laboratory Mouse Procedural Techniques 228 Laboratory Rat Procedural Techniques 228 Laboratory Zebrafish, The 224 Labour-Intensive Industrialization in Global History 168 Lai, Choi-Hong 293 Lai, Lawrence W.C. 169 Lai, Yuk-Ming 273
order now!
Laird, Sam 89 Laker, Jason 67 Lakey, Sandra 24 Lal, Rattan 225 Lam, Paul Kwan-Sing 261 Lam, Wai Fung 111 Lam, Wai Man 111 Lambe, Jennifer 21 Lamberts, Roberto 254 Landoll, Douglas 296 Lane, Kathleen Lynne 211 Lane, Richard J. 30 Lange, Tanja 281 Language and Bilingual Cognition 194 Language and Intercultural Communication Reader, The 36 Language and Learning in the Digital Age 35 Language of Colour, The 36 Language of Displayed Art, The 37 Language, Ideology and Identity in Serial Killer Narratives 38 Language, Society and Power 36 Lapp, Diane 74 Lapping, Claudia 186 Large Energy Storage Systems Handbook 271 Larkin, Craig 116 Larson, Bruce E. 56 Larson, James F. 108 Laseter, Timothy M. 161 Latham, A.J.H. 169 Latin American Economic Development 164 Latin American Theories of Development and Underdevelopment 346 Latta, Margaret Macintyre 60 Lau, Alan Kin-tak 311 Lautrup, Benny 312 Lavenex, Sandra 94 Law and Ecology 126 Law and Power in Foreign Investment in Africa 126 Law and the Wearing of Religious Symbols 126 Law, Complexity and Globalisation 126 Law, Corporate Governance, and Accounting 161 Law, Ethics and Security 101 Law, Ethics and the Biopolitical 126 Lawrence OBE, Doreen 143 Lawrence, Christian 224 Laws, D. Richard 199 Lawson, Karen G. 27 Laycock, Gloria 140 Le Blanc, Paul 13
( +44 (0)1235 400524
le May, Andrée 217 Le Messurier, Mark 64 Le, Sebastien 284 Leach, Rosemary 189 Leadership and Place 186 Leading the Lean Healthcare Journey 149 Lean Accounting Handbook, The 155 Lean Culture for the Construction Industry 149 Lean for the Public Sector 149 Lean Office and Service Simplified 150 Lean, Geoffrey 335 Learning From China? 331 Learning Futures 75 Learning to Labour in Post-Soviet Russia 110 Lectures on Political Economy 164 Lectures on Psychical Research 3 Ledley, Deborah Roth 201 LeDuff, Kim 23 Ledwidge, Mark 94 Lee, Bill 159 Lee, Byoungho 270 Lee, Chun-Yi 112 Lee, Eliza 111 Lee, Francis L.F. 110 Lee, George C. 252 Lee, Henry C. 235 Lee, John D. 259 Lee, Kwang-Suk 109 Lee, Mordecai 162 Lee, N. 335 Lee, Trisha 59 Leech, Nancy L. 196 Leeuwen, Theo Van 36 Leff, Nathaniel H. 340 Legal Architecture 126 LeGates, Richard T. 171 Legg, Stephen 95 Legislative Drafting 126 Lehmann, David 347 Lei, Jing 74 Lei, Tianhu 287 Leisure and Power in Urban China 110 LeMay, Jan 233 LeMenager, Stephanie 32 Lemieux, Frederic 135 Lenco, Peter 92 Leng, Jinsong 311 Leong-Salobir, Cecilia 108 Lerner, Leonid 306 Leroux, Robert 168 Lesniak, Linda 281 Letsky, Michael 197
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Korean: A Comprehensive Grammar Korf, Benedikt Koser, Khalid Koshy, Valsa Kosnik, Clare Kostova, Ludmilla Kovacs, Philip E. Kovalevska, Irina Kramer, Ronald C. Krassowski, Andrzej Krausman, Paul R. Kreider, Jan F. Kreith, Frank Kren, Michal Kretovics, Mark A. Krivogorsky, Victoria Kruckeberg, Dean Kubler, Cornelius C. Kudo, Keiei Kuhrt, Natasha Kukadia, Vina Kularatna, Nihal Kumar, Anup Kumar, Sameer Kumar, Sandeep Kumashiro, Masaharu Kunz, Rahel Kupchan, Charles Kupper, Lawrence L. Kureemun, Baboo Kurian, George Kuroki, Ryuzo Kurtz, David M. Kurz, Johannes L. Kurzak, Jakub Kurzak, Krzysztof Kvan, Thomas Kythe, Prem K.
Leuthold, Steven 18 Levendorskiy, Sergey 286 Leveraging Lean in Healthcare 150 Lever-Tracy, Constance 177 Levesque, John 292 Levin, Ginger 295 Levin, Yigal 117 Levine, Jonah G. 271 Levine, Michael 245 Levine, William S. 267 Levinson, William A. 276 Levstik, Linda S. 55 Levy, Reuben 352 Lewis, James R. 259 Lewis, L.A. 331 Lewis, Margaret 163 Lewis, Rhobert 137 Li, Guofang 74 Li, Linda Chelan 111 Li, Tingkai 310 Li, X. Allen 307 Liang, Xiangfen 160 Liang, Yizeng 307 Liang, Zach 252 Liberal Peace 99 Libya 114 Lidbury, Alan 142 Liebert, Ulrike 95 Liebling, Alison 144 Life Cycle Assessment in the Built Environment 254 Life of William Cobbett, The 320 Light Feather, Judith 302 Lim, C.J. 245, 363 Lim, Teik-Cheng 311 Lima, Laura 84 Limitation of Liability in International Maritime Conventions 126 Lin, Dyi-Yih Michael 259 Lin, Yi-Chieh Jessica 181 Lindio-McGovern, Ligaya 93 Lindsay, Beverly 68 Lingard, Robert 70 Linn, Marcia C. 62 Linneman, Thomas J. 183 Lipton, Michael 329 Lister, Martin 25 Literacy, Power, and the Schooled Body 63 Literate Classroom, The 77 Liu, Chao 293 Liu, Ed 245, 363 Liu, Fengshu 187 Liu, Jen-pei 286 Liu, Keshun 225 Liu, Lei 291 Liu, Zhi-Jun 262
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
index 387
m
çè
Ma, Peng-Cheng Mabey, Chris Macalister, John Macartney, Huw Macbean, Alasdair
308 186 53 96 336
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
Mack, Shannon M. 125 MacKenzie, Fiona 253 Macleod, Flora J. 56 MacPherson, Seonaigh 80 Macroeconomics 165 Madness in International Relations 94 Madou, Marc J. 306 Magid, Andy R. 287 Maguire, Mike 133 Mahgoub, Imad 273 Mair, George 129 Maiti, Suman 271 Maitra, Subhamoy 287 Make Your Business a Lean Business 150 Maki, Atsushi 163 Making Cognitive-Behavioral Therapy Work 201 Making Music in the Primary School 57 Making of Hong Kong, The 250 Making People Behave 143 Making Sense of Media and Politics 87 Malaev-Babel, Andrei 46 Malassis, Louis 339 Malici, Akan 88 Mallet, X. 237 Malmberg, Bo 167 Management-Based Quality Systems in the Food Industry 242 Managhan, Tina 101 Managing and Coordinating Major Criminal Investigations 119 Managing and Preparing Environmental Assessments 261 Managing Challenging Behaviors in Schools 211 Managing Children in Disasters 92 Managing Clinical Risk 136 Managing High Risk Sex Offenders in the Community 136 Managing IT Outsourcing 150 Managing Spontaneous Community Volunteers in Disasters 158 Managing Sport Business 188 Managing the Entrepreneurial University 67 Mancini, Peter 297 Mandel, David R. 195 Mander, Alison 80 Mandle, Jay 336 Manheim, Jarol B. 89 Manion, Lawrence 69, 361 Manley, Donna M. 295 Mann, Leon 160 Manning, Patrick 83
@
Manning, George A. 234 Manufacturing Intelligence 151 Manufacturing Techniques for Microfabrication and Nanotechnology 275 Mapping Applied Linguistics 36 March, Federic 260 Marcotte, Michele 242 Marcus, Philippe 300 Marcuzzo, Maria Cristina 167 Marine Polysaccharides 242 Market Liberalism, Growth, and Economic Development in Latin America 168 Marks, Michelle A. 195 Maroulis, Zacharias B. 238 Marsh, Ian 179 Marshall, Katherine 87 Marshall, Stephen 250 Martínez Gutiérrez, Norman A. 126 Martin, Jane 325 Martin, Lee 185 Martin, Timothy D. 151 Martinez, Angel 280 Martinez, Damian J. 143 Martinez, Wendy L. 280 Martin-Jones, Marilyn 38 Maruna, Shadd 125 Marvin, Simon 175 Marx, Brian P. 201 Mascheroni, Rodolfo H. 315 Masculine Shame 206 Masculinities in Higher Education 67 Massey, C.I. 298 Mastering Your Business Dissertation 151 Mastro, Michael 310 Mateo, Gemma 94 Materials Science of DNA 310 Mathematical Inequalities 283 Mathematical Look at Politics, A 277 Mathematics for Economics and Finance 164 Mathematics for the Environment 282 Mathematics Teacher Noticing 57 Mathew, Penelope 127 Mathur, Chandana 107 Matsuo, Takayasu 284 Matthewman, Sasha 60 Matthews, Daniel D. 154 Matthews, Elizabeth 115 Matthews, Stephen 41 Maugin, Gerard A. 270 Maulik, Gautam 240
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Livingston, Paisley 5 Livingstone, Arthur 344 Lloyd, Peter C. 344 Lo, David 293 Locher, Drew 150 Locks, Adam 191 Lockton, Deborah 121 Loeb and Quimby’s Clinical Chemistry of Laboratory Animals 229 Loeber, A.M. 186 Loehr, Nicholas 278 Loftus, Professor Elizabeth 133 Logan, Caroline 136 Loganathan, Bommanna G. 261 Loh, Virginia S. 52 Lomas, Robert 151 Longhurst, Richard 327 Longstaff, Alan 222 Looking for Work in Post-Socialist China 110 Lopez, Nancy 180 Lösel, Friedrich 135 Lost in Transition 135 Love, Nancy G. 314 Lovibond, Sabina 2 Lowe, Rodney 102 Lowenstein, Ariela 217 Lowrey, Wilson 19 Lowther, Jason 123 Lozerand, Emmanuel 109 Lubbe, Trevor 207 Lucarelli, Sonia 92 Lucken, Michael 109 Lunar Regolith Simulant 272 Luria, Sarah 173 Lury, D.A. 337 Lutz, Brenda J. 89, 361 Lutz, James 89, 361 Lycra 181 Lydyard, Peter 222 Lynk, Michael 114 Lyon, David 117 Lyon, John G. 314 Lyon, Lynn Krise 314 Lyons, Andrew 176, 362 Lyons, Glenn 185 Lyons, Harriet 176, 362
Maulik, Nilanjana 240 Maurer, Rick 148 Mawby, Rob 138 Maxwell, Lisa 154 Maye, Carmen 18 Mayer, Richard E. 74 Mayled, Jon 7 Maynard, Sally 59 Mayzell, George 150 Mazumdar, Shaswati 109 Mazur, B.W. 42, 360 Mazur, Boleslaw W. 42 McBride, Dorothy E. 91 McCarthy, Paul 188 McCartney, Daniel G. 265 McCartney, Matthew 110 McCoy, Colin P. 232 McCuen, Richard H. 251 McCulloch, Gary 78 McDonald, David 185 McEnery, Tony 40 McEvoy, Kieran 141 Mcgillvray, David 172 McGlynn, Clare 124 McGregor, Kim 144 McGuire, Mike 140 McHarg, Aileen 128 McKean, Joseph W. 287 Mclean, Chris 161 McLyman, Colonel Wm. T. 268 McMorran, T.J. 298 McNabb, David E. 160 McNaughton, Darlene 218 McNaughton, Stuart 72 McNeely, Connie L. 178 McNeill, Fergus 143 McNevin, Anne 93 McPherson, Gayle 172 McVay, Gloria 155 Meade, James E. 336 Meador, James 260 Meaning of Marxism, The 321 Means Coleman, Robin R. 21 Measham, Fiona 194 Measurement Nightmare, The 156 Measures of Interobserver Agreement and Reliability 285 Mechanical Design 268 Mechanics of Impression Evidence 236 Mechanobiology Handbook 229 Media Effects and Society 21 Media Perspectives for the 21st Century 21 Media Teacher’s Handbook, The 61, 360 Media Today 21
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
388 index
order now!
Miller, David 102 Miller, David J. 274 Mills, Tom 102 Millsap, Roger 196 Millward, Robert 162 Milne, Becky 143 Milton, Jane 208 Mimbela, Luz Elena 257 Mindful Way Through Anxiety, The 203 Mindfulness- and AcceptanceBased Behavioral Therapies in Practice 203 Mindfulness and the Therapeutic Relationship 202 Mine Safety and Efficient Exploitation Facing Challenges of the 21st Century 299 Mingarelli, Angelo B. 286 Minh-ha, Trinh T. 248, 362 Mining Software Specifications 293 Minten, Sue 188 Minyan of Women, A 177 Mire, Scott 124 Miskimmon, Alister 90 Mitchell, Claudia 81 Mittal, Kash 313 Mittal, Vikas 307 Mittelman, James H. 84 Mobasher, Barzin 252 Mobile Web 2.0 269 Model, Suzanne 187 Modena, Letizia 32 Modern Brazilian Portuguese Grammar Workbook 43 Modern Iran 349 Modern Political Economics 164 Modern Russian Grammar Workbook 43 Modern South Asia 11 Modernity’s End 11 Modrak, Rebekah 23, 358 Mogues, Tewodaj 168 Mohanty, Kaustubha 272 Mohapatra, Asish 257 Moher, David 286 Molded Optics 311 Molle, Willem 166 Mollin, Richard A. 277 Moloney, Kirk A. 281 Momsen, Janet Henshall 176 Money and Finance in Africa 333 Money in the Middle East and North Africa 116 Money, Jeannette 94 Moon, Bob 81 Moon, Brian 145 Mooney, Annabelle 36
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Mooney, Gerry 142 Moore, Faron 231 Moore, Roy l. 18 Moral Economy of the Madrasa, The 117 Moral Play and Counterpublic 32 Moran, Aidan 188 Morelli, Ralph 289 Morgan, George A. 196 Morgan, John 60 Morgan, Keith 179 Morgan, Kevin 52 Morgan, Michaela 55 Moriyama, Hiroyoshi 240 Morrison, Keith 69, 361 Mortiboys, Alan 61 Morton, Kathryn 329 Moscardo, Gianna 176 Mosedale, Jan 175 Moshman, David 192 Moss, Barbara 52 Moss, Eliot 291 Moss, John 71 Mosterman, Pieter J. 270 Moston, Stephen 137 Motha, Stewart 127 Mou, Beiquan 225 Mould, MIchael 45 Movie History: A Survey 22 Mueller, John 100 Mukhopadhyay, Jayanta 271 Mulcahy, Linda 126 Müller, Gotelind 108 Mullett, Michael 9 Multiculturalism 324 Multifunctional Polymer Nanocomposites 311 Multilateralism and Regionalism in Global Economic Governance 168 Multilayered Migration Governance 94 Multilingualism, Discourse, and Ethnography 38 Multimodal Studies 38 Multimodality, Cognition, and Experimental Literature 38 Multiparameter Eigenvalue Problems 286 Multi-Team Systems 195 Multivariate Generalized Linear Mixed Models Using R 286 Mumford, Andrew 101 Muncie, John 142 Munro, Mary 142 Munro, Vanessa E. 124 Munslow, Barry 344 Munz, Rainer 167
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Media, Social Mobilisation and Mass Protests in Post-colonial Hong Kong 110 Medical Equipment Management 310 Medical Tourism Facilitator’s Handbook 161 Meeks, Chet 181 Megatrends for Energy Efficiency and Renewable Energy 258 Mehl, Dieter 29 Mehmet, Ozay 341 Meier-Hedde, Regine 65 Meisami, Julie 352 Melatonin in the Promotion of Health 242 Melville, Gaynor 179 Melzack, Ronald 199 Membrane Technologies and Applications 272 Memory and Conflict in Lebanon 116 Memory and Pedagogy 81 Memory, Myth, and Seduction 208 Meng, Xiao-Li 281 Mensing, Donica 27 Mentoring and Coaching in Schools 57 Menzel, Karsten 251 Menzies, Holly Mariah 211 Metallic Systems 311 Metaphysics: The Key Concepts 3 Methods of Analysis of Food Components and Additives 242 Meyerhoff, Miriam 35 Meyers, Arlen D. 229 Michalowski, Raymond 140 Michelli, Nicholas M. 77 Micro Reaction Technology in Organic Synthesis 305 Micromechanical Analysis and Multi-Scale Modeling Using the Voronoi Cell Finite Element Method 272 Microorganisms in Home and Indoor Work Environments 274 Middle English Romances of the Thirteenth and Fourteenth Centuries, The 29 Midgley, Warren 80 Migration, Nation States, and International Cooperation 94 Miklowitz, David J. 203 Miles, John 254 Military Balance 2011, The 318 Military Regimes and Development 344 Milivojevic, Sanja 144 Miller, Caroline 250 Miller, Christopher A. 291
Muqiao, Xue 106 Murakami, Ineke 32 Muran, J. Christopher 204 Murer, Cherilyn G. 154 Murer, Michael A. 154 Muro, Diego 14 Murphy, Anne 113 Murphy, Edmond 308 Murphy, Laurie 176 Murray, Jamie 125 Murray, Jean 79 Murray, Warwick 173 Murshed, Syed Mansoob 169 Murthy, S. Narasimha 232 Musaazi, J.C.S. 339 Muse, Eben 26 Museum Gallery Interpretation and Material Culture 15 Music and Globalization in History 14 Music Emotion Recognition 292 Music in the Human Experience 48 Music, Difference and the Residue of Race 186 Mutlu, Mehmet 239 Muttoni, Aurelio 247
n Nabers, Dirk 95 Nadia Revisited 195 Naerssen, Ton Van 345 Nagatomi, Jiro 229 Nagwa, Megahed 74 Nair, G.B. 239 Nakagawa, Junji 168 Nakamori, Yashiteru 292 Nanobiomaterials Handbook 301 Nanofabrication Handbook 302 Nanopatterning Materials Using DNA 311 Nanoporous Materials 305 Nanoscience Education, Workforce Training, and K-12 Resources 302 Nanosensors 311 Nanotechnology 265 Nanotechnology For the Life Sciences 229 Nash, June 343 Nash, Mike 143 Nashed, Zuhair 287 Nasirean Ethics, The 353 Nassaji, Hossein 59 Nasu, Hitoshi 126 Nation, I.S.P. 53 National and European Foreign Policy 94
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
index 389
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
Nicholas, Louise 144 Nicklin, Jane 222 Nicolelis, Miguel A.L. 233 Niesche, Richard 81 Night Clubbing 136 Niklas Luhmann 181 Nikolayenko, Olena 107 Nineteenth-Century Theatre and the Imperial Encounter 47 Nittono, Miharu 43 Nixson, Fred 335 No-Arbitrage Pricing 286 Noginov, Mikhail A. 313 Nolan, Mary 215 Nollet, Leo M.L. 239 Non-Governmental Organizations in World Politics 87 Nonlinear H-Infinity Control, Hamiltonian Systems and Hamilton-Jacobi Equations 272 Noon, Charles E. 155 Norcliffe, Glen 341 Nord, Walter 196 Nordlund, Thomas M. 303 Norgaard, Richard B. 284 Norris, Gareth 179 Northrop, Robert B. 228 Norton, Hilary 56 Noutcheva, Gergana 93 Novak, Barbara 215 Novak, Joseph 145 Novak, Serguei Y. 285 Nuclear Hydrogen Production Handbook 265 Nuclear Medicine Physics 306 Nunes, Joao 84 Nussbaum, Jon F. 24 Nutrition, Epigenetic Mechanisms, and Human Disease 240 Nwankwo, Sonny 147
o Oakland, John Oberg, P. Ake Object Relations in Depression Oboe, Annalisa O’Brien, Kate O’Brien, Sean M. Occelli, Mario L. O’Connell, Paul O’Connor, Kaori Odden, Allan R. Odetola, Olatunde O’Donohue, William T. Offender Supervision Offenders on Offending
@
9 226 207 28 140 280 268 128 181 77 344 200 143 136
Offenders or Citizens? 137 Offending Girls 137 Official (ISC)2 Guide to the SSCP CBK 290 Official (ISC)2® Guide 295 to the ISSMP® CBK® Official History of the British Civil Service, The 102 O’Gorman, Paschal 166 Oh, Myung 108 O’Halloran, Kay 38 O’Hara, Glen 14 Ohlsson, Anne-Valérie 147 Ohmic Heating in Food Processing 242 Oinas, Päivi 169 Okada, Richard H. 325 Okamoto, Keiko 43 Okano, Kaori 74 O’Keeffe, Anne 35 Okker, Patricia 33 Olesen, Thomas 94 Oliphant, Jill 7 Oliva, Alejandro 272 Olness, Karen 212 On the Right of Exclusion: Law, Ethics and Immigration Policy 126 Oosterveer, Peter 186 Opara, Umezuruike Linus 240 OPEC Fund for International Development, The 329 Operating Systems and Development Platforms for Seamless Mobility 272 Operations in Food Refrigeration 315 Opposition and Legitimacy in the Ottoman Empire 116 Optical Materials and Applications 272 Optical Techniques for Solid-State Materials Characterization 272 Optics for Engineers 311 Optimal Experimental Design with R 286 Organization Management in Construction 255 Organization of European Security Governance, The 93 Origins of Economic Inequality Between Nations, The 348 Orloff, Lisa 158 Orsillo, Susan M. 203 Ortega, Lourdes 324 Ortiz, Chris A. 157 Otles, Semih 242 O’Toole, Michael 37 Ottley, Mike 120 Ovens, Peter 66
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Nativel, C. 175 Nativel, Corrine 175 Nature of Adolescence, The 197 Naughton, James 41, 359 Naval Power and Expeditionary Wars 101 Navigating Art Therapy 213 Nawana Parker, Madhavi 64 Nazer, Dima Wadi 314 Nazikian, Fumiko 43 Nedovic-Budic, Zorica 258 Neeley, Grant 162 Neelon, Brian H. 280 Negotiation Theory and the EU 94 Nellis, Mike 132 Nelson, Gerald 42 Nelson, Vaughn C. 257 Network Journalism 27 Neurobiology of Sensation and Reward 233 Neuroscience of Decision Making 195 New Approaches to Monetary Economics and Theory 168 New Concept of Development, A 347 New Cultural Identitarian Political Movements in Developing Societies 110 New Dictionary of Kleinian Thought, The 208 New Directions in Surveillance and Privacy 143 New Directions in the American Presidency 87 New Food Product Development 238 New Horizons in Standardized Work 151 New Media and Technocultures Reader, The 25 New Perspectives on the History and Historiography of Southeast Asia 110 New Politics of European Civil Society, The 95 New Response to Youth Crime, A 129 New Seeds and Poor People 327 New Techniques and Technologies in Mining 299 New Trends in Development Theory 348 Newburn, Tim 143 Newman, Mark 273 Newslow, Debby 242 Next Ten Years, The 321 Neyland, Daniel 143 Neyroud, Peter 142 Nguyen, Kim 281
Overcoming Objectification Overland, Juliette Oxaal, Ivar Oxner, Sandra E Ozilgen, Mustafa
186 126 345 170 238
p Pacione, Michael 341 Packirisamy, Muthukumaran 226 Padfield, Nicola 138 Paediatric Rehabilitation Engineering 230 Pafort-Overduin, Clara 22 Pages, Jerome 284 Pahuja, Sundhya 127 Paine, S.C.M. 101 Pakes, Francis 130 Pakes, Suzanne 142 Pakistan – the Political Economy of Growth, Stagnation and the State, 1991–2008 110 Palestinian Refugees 117 Palmer, E.H. 351 Pamela, Regan 192 Pande, Aparna 108 Pandey, Bikash 258 Panikkar, K.M. 343 Panizzon, Marion 94 Pankratius, Victor 292 Panter, A.T. 193 Papathanassopoulos, Stylianos 21 Papers from the Seminar on Fasahat and Balaghat in Classical Persian Literature 352 Pappas, Christine C. 53 Parallel Learning of Reading and Writing in Early Childhood 51 Paranormal Media 22 Parfitt, Trevor W. 330 Park, Jisuk 43 Park, Murry 157 Park, Roberta J 191 Parker AO, Gordon 204 Parker, Howard 194 Parker, Ian 322 Parker, Richard 218 Parker, Rolland S. 221 Parkinson, Dilworth 40 Parody and Taste in Postwar American Television Culture 27 Parrish, William R. 265 Parrott, Roxanne 24 Parry, Janine A. 91 Particle Swarm Optimisation 293 Patel, Kalpana 258 Pathak, Yashwant Vishnupant 241
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
390 index
order now!
Philosophy of Law Meets the Philosophy of Technology, The 128 Philosophy of Probability: Contemporary Readings 3 Philosophy, Ethics and A Common Humanity 6 Physician Employment Contract Handbook, The 156 Physician Integration 162 Physics of Continuous Matter 312 Physics of Medical Imaging, The 303 Physiology of Bioelectricity in Development, Tissue Regeneration and Cancer, The 231 Pichler, Pia 36 Picken, Gavin 117 Pickering, Sharon 144 Pickett, James 337 Pierce, David 236 Pierpoint, Harriet 133 Pike, Roy 312 Pilgrimage Tourism of Diaspora Africans to Ghana 176 Pillay, Michael 224 Pilz, Jurgen 286 Pinches, G.M. 298 Pinfold, Tom 341 Pitelis, Christos 160 Pithouse, Kathleen 81 Planet in 2050, The 170 Planning African Development 341 Planning an Appropriate Curriculum in the Early Years 51 Planning and Development in Education 339 Plant Tissue Culture, Development, and Biotechnology 224 Plantinga, Carl 5 Plasma Physics and Engineering 302 Platt, Heather 49 Play in Early Childhood 217 Plea Bargaining in National and International Law 127 Pluralism in Management 162 Pocket Dictionary of Food Safety 238 Podolskiy, Viktor A. 313 Poetry: The Basics 28, 358 Poitras, Geoffrey 146 Pokrajac, Dubravka 315 Polansky, Alan M. 283 Polarized Light 302 Police Corruption 143 Police Custody 143 Police Interviewing 137
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Police Work 137 Policing and Human Rights 127 Policing and the Legacy of Lawrence 143 Policing: An introduction 138 Policing: Key Readings 143 Poling, Kimberly D. 212 Polish: A Comprehensive Grammar 44 Political Developments in Contemporary Russia 110 Political Economy and Liberalism in France 168 Political Economy and Tourism 175 Political Economy of Bureaucracy, The 170 Political Economy of Capital, The 170 Political Economy of Latin America, The 90 Political Economy of Peacemaking, The 102 Political Economy of Statebuilding 98 Political Economy of Underdevelopment, The 346 Political Liberalism in Muslim Societies 117 Political Theory and Community Building in Post-Soviet Russia 110 Politics and Memory of Democratic Transition, The 14 Politics of Adjudication, The 128 Politics of American Education, The 78 Politics of Belonging in India, The 113 Politics of Bioethics, The 187 Politics of Empathy 94 Politics of Family Planning in the Third World, The 331 Politics of Imagination, The 128 Politics of Inclusion and Exclusion, The 90 Politics of Knowledge 186 Politics of Loss and Trauma in Contemporary Israeli Cinema, The 26 Politics of Modern Iran 325 Politics of Religion in South and Southeast Asia, The 113 Politics of Terrorism Expertise, The 102 Politics of the New Germany, The 90 Politics of United States Foreign Aid, The 328 Politics of Women’s Integration, The 187
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Paton, G.J. 169 Patrick Geddes and Town Planning 249 Patterns of Caribbean Development 336 Paul, Goutam 287 Pazwash, Hormoz 315 Peace In Between, The 99 Peace, Karl E. 286 Pearce, Philip L. 176 Pearton, Stephen J. 306 Pease, Ken 132 Peatland Biogeochemistry and Watershed Hydrology at the Marcell Experimental Forest 260 Peccei, Jean Stilwell 36 Pennathur, Sumita 265 People Skills at Work 161 Percival, Simon 53 Percy, David 262 Perdicoulis, Anastassios 248 Pérez-Stable, Marifeli 91 Performance Based Medicine 221 Performing Remains 45 Perraton, Hilary 339 Perrotini-Hernández, Ignacio 168 Perroux, François 347 Perry, Bob 76 Perry, Dale L. 309 Perry, Jr., Fred L. 69 Perse, Elizabeth M. 21 Persia 349 Persia and its People 350 Persia and the Victorians 350 Persian Anthology, A 351 Persian Gulf, The 350 Persian Gulf and the West, The 353 Persian Language, The 352 Persian Sufis, The 353 Persistent Underdevelopment 336 Perspectives on Information 317 Pessarakli, Mohammad 223 Peters, B.Guy 95 Petersen, Alan 187 Pfeiffer, Steven I. 211 Pharmacy Fits 231 Philipp, Randy 57 Philippopoulos-Mihalopoulos, Andreas 126 Phillips, Edward R. 49 Phillips, Susan 160 Phillipson, Gavin 120 Philosophical Delusion and its Therapy 6 Philosophy and the Idea of Freedom 182
Pollard, Maria 215 Poltiical Change in the Third World 342 Polyanin, Andrei D. 284 Polymers for Vascular and Urinogenital Applications 312 Polyurethane Shape-Memory Polymers 312 Pomphrey, Cathy 57 Pond, Wilson G. 223 Poole, Marshall Scott 24 Popescu, Nicu 93 Popular Media and Health Communication 22 Population and Development 331 Population Mental Health 218 Population, Health and Nutrition in the Sahel 331 Post, Ken 347 Postapartheid Literature 32 Postcolonial City and Its Subjects, The 33 Postcolonial Tourism 32 Postiglione, Gerard 106 Potrac, Paul 190 Potter, Robert 342 Pound, Linda 59 Poverty, Class and Gender in Rural Africa 345 Poverty, Progress and Development 334 Powell, Douglas 200 Power and Independence 344 Power and Transnational Activism 94 Power Electronics and Motor Drives 266 Powers, Peter E. 301 Power-Switching Converters 272 Poynting, Scott 101 Practical Application of the Process Capability Study, The 157 Practical Bomb Scene Investigation 235 Practical Crime Scene Investigations for Hot Zones 235 Practical Economics 319 Practical Forensic Digital Imaging 236 Practical Handbook for Wetland Identification and Delineation 314 Practical Methods for Legal Investigations 237 Practical Speech User Interface Design 259 Practice of Generalist Social Work, The 178 Practice of Government Public Relations, The 162
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
index 391
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
Public Expenditures for Agricultural and Rural Development in Africa Public Policymaking in Hong Kong Public Relations in Global Cultural Contexts Public Relations, Society & Culture Pullar, Christine E. Punch, Maurice Puri, Ishwar K. Purkait, Mihir K. Putnam, Andrew Puyou, Francois-Regis Pyrek, Kelly M.
r 168 111 22 23 231 143 263 272 231 161 235
q Q&A Civil Liberties & Human Rights 2011–2012 Q&A Commercial Law 2011–2012 Q&A Company Law 2011–2012 Q&A Constitutional & Administrative Law 2011–2012 Q&A Contract Law 2011–2012 Q&A Criminal Law 2011–2012 Q&A Employment Law 2011–2012 Q&A English Legal System 2011–2012 Q&A Equity & Trusts 2011–2012 Q&A European Union Law 2011–2012 Q&A Evidence 2011–2012 Q&A Family Law 2011–2012 Q&A Jurisprudence 2011–2012 Q&A Land Law 2011–2012 Q&A Medical Law 2011–2012 Q&A Torts 2011–2012 Quality Assurance in the Pathology Laboratory Quality Control Training Manual Quantitative Understanding of Biosystems Quantum Optical Networks Quattrone, Paolo Quigley, Jon M. Qur’anic Hermeneutics
@
120 120 120
120 121 121 121 121 122 122 122 122 123 123 123 123 237 230 303 312 161 269 117
R Insights 282 Rabinovich, Elliot 161 Race and News 23 Race and US Foreign Policy 94 Race, Ethnicity and Football 191 Racial Disparity in Mental Health Services 218 Radeloff, Cheryl 183 Rafiee, Abdi 42, 359 Ragland, Kenneth W. 263 Raheja, Dev 152 Rainbow, Philip S. 258 Rajasekaran, K.S. 297 Rakic, Tijana 171 Ramage, Magnus 317 Ramaswamy, Hosahalli S. 242 Ramcharan, Bertrand G 91 Ramirez-Faria, Carlos 348 Ramjohn, Mohamed 122 Ramkumar, Seshadri S. 258 Ramoniene, Meilute 41, 359 Ranade, Vasant V. 232 Randomized Clinical Trials of Nonpharmacologic Treatments 286 Randomized Response and Indirect Questioning Techniques in Surveys 286 Ranis, Gustav 334 Rankin-Riley, Margaret 228 Rao, Anil K. 229 Ríos-Bolivar, Humberto 168 Rape 144 Rasch, Bjorn Erik 96 Rasch, Dieter 286 Rashed, Roshdi 116 Ratcliffe, Jerry H. 143 Raudenbush, Stephen 54 Rauf, S. Bobby 270 Rauxloh, Regina 127 Ravaud, Philippe 286 Rawle, Robert J. 303 Ray, Dee 210 Ray, Indrajit 166 Raychaudhuri, Siba P. 240 Raynor, Peter 143 Rayson, Paul 40 Raz, Gil 112 RC4 Stream Cipher and Its Variants 287 Rea, William J. 258 Read, Stuart 147 Read, Tim 137 Reader, Ian 7
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
çè
Practice-based Evidence for Healthcare 217 Pragmatics Reader, The 37 Prasankumar, Rohit P. 272 Preece, Sian 36 Preedy, Victor R. 241 Prescott, Judith S. 229 Press, Ian 41, 359 Preston, Deborah Bray 187 Preston, Peter 347 Pribram, Deidre 27 Price, David 144 Pries, Kim H. 269 Priestley, Philip 137 Priezkalns, Eric 159 Prime, Penelope 105 Principles of Emergency Management and Emergency Operations Centers (EOC) 92 Principles of Sustainable Energy 266 Prison Officer, The 144 Prisoners’ Rights 138 Pritchard, Duncan 4 Probation 143 Probiotic Foods in Health and Disease 239 Problems of Economic Policy 165 Prochazka, Vivianne 334 Product Design for Manufacture and Assembly 275 Program Management Complexity 295 Progressive Kaizen 151 Proletarianisation in the Third World 344 Promise of Integrated Healthcare, The 200 Promoting Diversity and Social Justice 76 Prospects for an Ethics of Architecture 245 Protecting the Property Rights of Refugees and Internally Displaced Persons 127 Protecting the Public? 143 Prothero, R. Mansell 341 Protzman, Charlie 150 Provenzo, Jr., Eugene F. 78 Psychoanalysis in Social Research 186 Psychoeducational Groups 203 Psychological Criminology 138 Psychological Therapy in Prisons and other Settings 143 Psychology for the Classroom: E-Learning 58 Psychopharmaceuticals in India 111
Reading Modern Law: Critical Methodologies and Sovereign Formations 127 Reading Native American Literature 28 Reading the Cantos 29 Reading Winnicott 207 Realism and World Politics 98 Reappraising State-Owned Enterprise 162 Rebecca Schneider, 45 Reconciliation after Terrorism 101 Recovery from Addiction in Communal Living Settings 218 Redclift, Michael 332 Reddy, J.N. 272 Reddy, Jo 120 Reddy, Prasada 160 Reddy, Sanjay 105 Redmon, Amy Walters 260 Redner, Paul 309 Reed, Ann 176 Reflexive Teacher Educator in TESOL, The 63 Reframing Photography 23, 358 Regimes of Derivation in Syntax and Morphology 38 Regional Orders and Regional Powers 95 Regional Security in the Third World 343 Reid, Jonathan P. 257 Reisner, David E. 227 Release from Prison 138 Religion and Language in Post-Soviet Russia 111 Religion and Social Problems 186 Religious Imagination in Modern and Contemporary Architecture, The 247 Religious Institutions and Global Politics 87 Relyea, Douglas B. 157 Remer, Sven 169 Remote Sensing of Land Use and Land Cover 262 Ren, Fan 306 Renner, Judith 101 Rennie, Leonie 75 Renshon, Stanley A. 83 Repositioning Restorative Justice 144 Representations of Eve in Antiquity and the English Middle Ages 33 Representing Enslavement and Abolition in Museums 15 Research in Applied Linguistics 69 Research Methods for Studying Groups 24, 362
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
392 index
order now!
Riedi, Martin 273 Riedler, Florian 116 Riello, Giorgio 19 Right to Religious Freedom in International Law, The 128 Riley, Stephen P. 330 Rio de Janeiro 186 Riojas Clark, Ellen 63 Rioting in the UK and France 144 Rise and Fall of Arab Jerusalem, The 115 Risitano, Antonino 268 Risk Assessment for Juvenile Violent Offending 144 Risk Management in Organizations 152 Risk of Social Policy?, The 96 Rizzo, Matthew 259 Roach, Jason 132 Roberson, Cliff 124 Roberts, Chris 19 Roberts, Julian 134 Robinson, Gwen 139 Robinson, Jr., E. Arthur 277 Robot Development Using Microsoft Robotics Developer Studio 290 Robson, Peter 337 Robson, Stephen 189 Robust Nonparametric Statistical Methods 287 Rocha, Cristina 106 Rock Engineering Design 299 Rock Stress and Earthquakes 298 Rodwell, E.H. 351 Roemer, Lizabeth 203 Rofe, Simon 86 Roger, Rosemary 51 Rogers, Ben 265 Rogers, Colin 137 Rogers, Marcus K. 294 Rogers, Rebecca 70 Rolandsen, Unn Målfrid 110 Role of Governments in Legislative Agenda Setting, The 96 Role of the International Financial Centres in Underdeveloped Countries, The 334 Roman Urban Street Networks 16 Romeo, Michele 258 Rommel Ruiz, W. Bryan 9, 356 Ronglan, Lars Tore 190 Ronkainen, Ilkka 155 Rooks, Robyn 157 Roos, Jan 150 Rosenfeld, Jean 102 Rosenstein-Rodan, P.N. 338 Rosenthal, Howard 202
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Rosentrater, Kurt. A. 225 Rosenzweig, Mark R. 334 Rossana, Robert J. 165 Rotary Drilling and Blasting in Large Surface Mines 299 Rounds, Carol 41, 359 Routledge Atlas of British History, The 13, 357 Routledge Atlas of South Asian Affairs, The 105 Routledge Companion to Anglophone Caribbean Literature, The 30 Routledge Companion to Epistemology, The 4 Routledge Companion to Philosophy and Film, The 5 Routledge Companion to Philosophy and Music, The 5 Routledge Concise History of Canadian Literature, The 30 Routledge Concise History of Nineteenth-Century Literature, The 30 Routledge Concise History of Science Fiction, The 30 Routledge Contemporary Turkish Reader, The 44 Routledge Dictionary of Cultural References in Modern French, The 45 Routledge Encyclopedia of Translation Studies 44 Routledge Guide to William Shakespeare, The 31, 358 Routledge Handbook of American Foreign Policy 88 Routledge Handbook of Applied Linguistics, The 37 Routledge Handbook of Energy Security, The 100 Routledge Handbook of Global Public Health 218 Routledge Handbook of Health Communication 24 Routledge Handbook of International Law 88 Routledge Handbook of Sports Development 188 Routledge Handbook of Urban Ecology, The 173 Routledge History of the Holocaust, The 13, 357 Routledge International Handbook of Contemporary Social and Political Theory 182 Routledge International Handbook of Creative Learning, The 78 Routledge Library Editions: Development 326
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Research Methods in Education 69, 361 Research Methods: The Basics 182 Research on Second Language Teacher Education 58 Researching Crime and Justice 139 Researching Young Children’s Perspectives 76 Resilient Practitioner, The 204 Resistive, Capacitive, and Inductive Based Sensing Technologies 312 Response to Intervention 211 Responsibility to Protect, The 99 Responsible Tourism 174 Restoration Therapy 205 Restorative Justice in Practice 139 Restorative Justice Reader, A 129 Rethinking American Electoral Democracy 88 Rethinking Development 348 Rethinking Foreign Policy Analysis 88 Rethinking Rape Law 124 Rethinking Schools 76 Rethinking the Knowledge Controversy in Organization Studies 196 Rethinking the Liberal Peace 101 Rethinking Widening Participation in Higher Education 67 Revealing the Corporation 152 Revenue Assurance 159 Reversibility of Chronic Degenerative Disease and Hypersensitivity, Volume 2 258 Rewards for High Public Office in Europe and North America 95 Reworking the Relationship between Asylum and Employment 127 Reyes, Javier A. 164 Reynolds, Cecil R. 194 Reynolds, Tracey 187 Rezgui, Yacine 254 RFID and Auto-ID in Planning and Logistics 276 Rhodes, Carl 161 Ribbers, Pieter 150 Rice, Cyprian 353 Rich World, Poor World 335 Richard III 11, 357 Richards, Anthony 102 Richards, Val 52 Richardson, Doug 172 Richardson, Douglas 173 Richardson, Niall 191 Richardson, Steven O. 170 Rickinson, Mark 56 Rickman, Douglas 272
Routledge Library Editions: Development Mini-Set A: Agriculture, Food and Development 326 Routledge Library Editions: Development Mini-Set B: Aid 326 Routledge Library Editions: Development Mini-Set C: Debt and Development 326 Routledge Library Editions: Development Mini-Set D: Demography 326 Routledge Library Editions: Development Mini-Set E: Development and the Environment 326 Routledge Library Editions: Development Mini-Set F: Development Economics 326 Routledge Library Editions: Development Mini-Set G: Education and Development 326 Routledge Library Editions: Development Mini-Set H: Geography and Planning 326 Routledge Library Editions: Development Mini-Set I: Planning and Development 326 Routledge Library Editions: Development Mini-Set J: Politics and International Relations 326 Routledge Library Editions: Development Mini-Set K: Security and Development 326 Routledge Library Editions: Development Mini-Set L: Sociology and Social Policy 326 Routledge Library Editions: Development Mini-Set M: Theories of Development 326 Routledge Library Editions: Iran: 37 Volume-Set 349 Routledge Spanish Bilingual Dictionary of Psychology and Psychiatry, The 45 Rouvroy, Antoinette 128 Rowley, Michelle V. 175 Roy, Michael J. 227 Ruane, Joseph B. 93 Rubery, Matthew 32 Rubie-Davies, Christine 72 Rubin, Barry 94 Rubin, Judith Aron 213 Rubin, Lawrence 102 Rubin, Olivier 93 Rubio, Fernando Domínguez 186 Rucker-Chang, Sunnie 107 Rudin, Norah 236 Ruiters, Greg 185 Rule of Law, The 170
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
index 393
124 105 342 111 339 267 101 175 102 255 199 166 113
s
çè
Saari, Donald 170 Sadiqi, Fatima 114 Sadowska, Iwona 44 Sadrozinski, Hartmut F.-W. 308 Saeed, Abdullah 323 Safer Hospital Care 152 Safety Professional’s Reference and Study Guide 276 Sage, Colin 172 Sahoo, Prasanna K. 285 Sakurada, Shinobu 219 Sakurai, Keiko 117 Salas, Eduardo 197 Saldanha, Gabriela 44 Salmon, Amy 218 Samson, Robert A. 274 Sandaker, Bjorn N. 247 Sanders, Lorna 46 Sandiford, Keith 33 Sandtray Therapy 211 Santorella, Gary 149 Sarasvathy, Saras 147 Saravacos, George D. 238 Sarna, David E.Y. 297 Sastry, Sudhir 242 Saul, Ben 126 Savage, Jonathan 54 Savage, Stephen P. 143 Savy, Michel 167 Sawyer, W. Charles 164 Scaler Scott, Kathleen 192 Scarratt, Elaine 61, 360 Schäfer, Sebastian 109 Schafer, Mark 88 Schapiro, Steven 227 Schaub, Michael 311
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
Scheeres, Hermine 161 Schefer, Guy 144 Schefold, Bertram 166 Schenk, Catherine 11 Scherer, Raimar 251 Schieffelin, Bambi 322 Schiff, Mara 143 Schiffman, Beth M. 228 Schimek, Jean-Georges 208 Schlagheck, Peter 304 Schmidt, Vivien A. 92 Schneider, Tatjana 246 Schook, Lawrence B. 231 Schooling Internationally 76 Schotel, Bas 126 Schrader, Christian 272 Schroeder, Ursula 93 Schug, Mark C. 58 Schunk, Dale H. 75 Schutz, Eric A. 168 Schuurman, Frans 345 Schwartz, Mel 310 Schwartz-Shea, Peregrine 86 Schwecke, Sebastian 110 Schweitzer, P.E., Philip A. 300 Schwiegerling, Jim 311 Science Learning and Instruction 62 Scientific Computing with Multicore and Accelerators 290 Scientific Foundations of Clinical Assessment 200 Scientific Protocols for Forensic Examination of Clothing 236 Scientists Must Speak 318 Scobbie, Iain 114 Scolnicov, Anat 128 Scorza, Ralph 225 Scott Cato, Molly 172 Scott, David 316 Sea Power and the Asia-Pacific 101 Seamless Mobility 273 Seaports and Development 340 Sebald, David Conrad 48 Sebba, Judy 56 Sebestyen, Stephen 260 Secher, Ulla 125 Second-Language Acquisition 324 Secure Recovery 139 Securitization of Migration 96 Securitization of Migration in the Post-Cold War Era, The 96 Security & Policy Driven Computing 291 Security of the Persian Gulf, The 354 Security Risk Assessment Handbook, The 296
@
Security, Development and Nation-Building in Timor-Leste 111 Seed, Alexander J. 313 Seeking Sustainability 169 Sefton-Green, Julian 78 Segrave, Marie 144 Seguino, Stephanie 163 Seidman, Steven 181 Selected Writings of John A. Hobson 1932–1938 95 Self-assembled Structures 312 Self-Balancing Processes 152 Selfe, Lorna 195 Self-Government in Industry 320 Self-Knowledge 3 Self-Organizing Liquid Crystal Materials 313 Selim, H. Magdi 257 Selim, Shahpar 108 Selwyn, Percy 338 Semantic Externalism 4 Semiconductor Device-Based Sensors for Gas, Chemical, and Biomedical Applications 306 Semiconductors 266 SENCO Survival Guide, The 64 Sender, John 345 SenGupta, Arup K. 310 Separable Galois Theory of Commutative Rings 287 Serials Collection Management in Recessionary Times 27 Serino, Leandro 169 Service Delivery Platforms 297 Serving the Gifted 211 Sesay, Amadu 343 Sex Trafficking 144 Sex, Crime and Morality 139 Sexual Revolutions 207 Sexuality 29 Shakespeare, Trauma and Contemporary Performance 33 Shalaby, Shalaby W. 312 Shalev, Sharon 144 Shammas, Nazih K. 257 Shanahan, John F. 262 Shapira, Amnon 117 Shapiro, Edward S. 210 Shapiro, Victor 285 Shapland, Joanna 139 Sharkey, Nolan 112 Sharma, Varum 297 Sharma, Vivek 297 Sharp, Avery T. 49 Sharpe, Gilly 137 Shastri, Anant R. 284 Shaughnessy, Robert 31, 358 Shaver, Annis N. 78
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Rule of Reason in European Constitutionalism and Citizenship, The Ruparelia, Sanjay Rural Planning in Developing Countries Rural Tax Reform in China Rural World, The Russ, John C. Russia and the Cult of State Security Rusten, Grete Ryan, Barry Ryan, Carole Ryan, Patrick Ryan, Raymond Rycroft, Daniel J.
Shea, Mary 51 Sheldon, Brian 219 Shelley, Lorna 322 Shelton, Barrie 250 Shelton, Marilyn 79 Shepard, R. Hamilton 311 Sheridan, Mary D. 217 Sherin, Miriam 57 Shewry, Teresa 32 Shi, Jian Qing 285 Shibuya, Takehisa 272 Shihata, Ibrahim F.I. 329 Shillady, Donald 300 Shim, Ae-Gyung 27 Short History of Probation, A 129 Short Stories: London in Two-and-a-half Dimensions 245, 363 Short, Rick Jay 212 Shoukri, Mohamed M. 285 Shujie, Yuan 299 Shujing, Guo 106 Shyr, Yu 231 Sifuentes, Roberto 46 Signorell, Ruth 257 Signorelli, Walter P. 118 Sikorski, Zdzislaw Z.E. 239 Silicon Photonics for Telecommunications and Biomedicine 313 Silk, Michael L. 191 Silke, Andrew 102 Silverstone, Catherine 33 Silverstone, Daniel 136 Simon, James 225 Simon, Sidney A. 233 Simonton, Deborah 13 Simpkins, Edgar 343 Simpson, James 37 Simpson, Kirstie 189 Simsek, Senel 44 Simulation of Dynamic Systems with MATLAB and Simulink 266 Sinason, Valerie 201 Singer, Hans 337 Single Case Research Methods in Sport and Exercise 188 Sinha, Radha 327 Siomopoulos, Anna 27 Sitharaman, Balaji 301 Situational Prevention of Organised Crimes 140 Skidmore II, David G. 90 Skinns, Layla 143 Sklair, Leslie 345 Skovholt, Thomas 204 Slapper, Gary 121 Slee, Roger 64
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
394 index
order now!
Sociology of Sports Coaching, The 190 Soden, Satori 36 Soderberg, Marie 106 Soft Power in Japan-China Relations 111 Software Development 289 Software Engineering Reviews and Audits 296 Soil Mechanics Fundamentals 251 Solano-Flores, Guillermo 62 Solate, Jeffrey T. 238 Solid-State Physics, Fluidics, and Analytical Techniques in Micro- and Nanotechnology 306 Solka, Jeffrey 280 Sólyom, Erika 41, 359 Somalia: Too Dangerous, Too Important to Ignore 95 Somayaji, Sakarama 108 Sommer, Marni 218 Song, Haiyan 174 Song, Jianwei 252 Song, Jiyoung 109 Songer, Anthony 255 Soothill, Keith 144 Sorsby, Angela 139 Sosulski, Kristen 61 Sound Handbook, The 25 Sourcebook of Experiential Education 77 South Asia in the New World Order 111 South-South Globalization 169 Sovacool, Benjamin K. 100 Soviet Union and Revolutionary Iran, The 354 Soviet Union and the Arabian Peninsula, The 354 Sowelem, R.A. 338 Spaargaren, Gert 186 Spalding, Hobart 343 Sparks, Richard 125 Spatial Agency: Other Ways of Doing Architecture 246 Spatial Data Infrastructures 258 Spatiality, Sovereignty and Carl Schmitt 95 Speaking of Epidemics in Chinese Medicine 111 Speight, James G. 268 Spencer, Alexander 101 Spencer, Jonathan 107 Spencer, Stephen 184 Spier, Steven 47 Spinelli Coleman, Donatella 209 Spiritual Purification in Islam 117 Spirou, Costas 184 Spline Smoothing 282
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Sport and Politics 189 Sport and the Transformation of Modern Europe 189 Sport, Culture and Society 189 Sports Management Toolkit, The 190 Sports Media 27 Spread of Tibetan Buddhism in China, The 113 Spring, Joel 78 Spruce, Gary 57 Squires, Graham 254 Srivatsa, G. Susan 305 St John, Ronald Bruce 114 Staemmler, Birgit 7 Stamatoudis, Michael 300 Standard Work for Lean Healthcare 153 Stanislawski, Larry V. 262 Stanko, Betsy 135 Stanoyevitch, Alexander 279 Stansfield, Gareth 117 Stargazing 183 Starkschall, George 310 State Accountability under International Law 127 State and Revolution in Iran, The 354 State Crime 144 State Crime in the Global Age 140 Statebuilding, Security-Sector Reform and the Liberal Peace 102 Statistical Approaches to Measurement Invariance 196 Statistical Process Control for Real-World Applications 276 Statistical Thinking in Epidemiology 282 Statistics and the Public Sphere, 1750–2000 14 Statistics of Medical Imaging 287 Staying Lean 153 Stearns, Peter N. 10 Stearns, Samuel D. 263 Steege, Mark W. 211 Steen, Mary 215 Steger, Manfred B. 93 Stehr, Nico 186 Stein, Nancy L. 54 Steiner, Deborah 208 Stelfox, Peter 142 Stem Cell Engineering Handbook 229 Stem Cells and Neovascularization in Tissue Engineering 231 Stephenson, Martin 179 Steppacher, Rolf 169 Sterba, Sonya K. 193 Steven, Martin 92
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Sleeter, Christine E. 72 Sleiman, Hanadi F. 311 Sliding Mode Control of Switching Power Converters 273 Small, Ian 30 Smalley, Art 156 Small-Scale Synthesis of Laboratory Reagents with Reaction Modeling 306 Smedley, Kirsty 143 Smidt, Sandra 50 Smit, Anneke 127 Smith Fussner, Frank 12 Smith, Anne B. 81 Smith, Bradley A. 38 Smith, Brian C. 301 Smith, Colin 2 Smith, David 129 Smith, Debra 156 Smith, Greg 200 Smith, Hubbert 297 Smith, Laurajane 15 Smith, Matthew 170 Smith, Patrick H. 36 Smith, Richard L. 281 Smith, Roger 143 Smith, Sheila 345 Smith, Steven Rathgeb 160 Smith, T.E. 331 Smith, Thomas E. 77 Smyer Yü, Dan 113 Sniscak, Cynthia Caparosa 210 Sobczyk, Eugeniusz J. 299 Social and Political Thought of Julius Evola 95 Social Banks and the Future of Sustainable Finance 169 Social Media, Crisis Communication and Emergency Management 153 Social Policy and Migration in China 111 Social Policy for Effective Practice 182 Social Policy in Developing Countries 344 Social Psychology 324 Social Statistics 183 Social Understanding and Social Lives 196 Social Work 220 Social Work with Children and Families 220 Social Works 46 Socialism and Underdevelopment 347 Socialist Economics 320 Sociology and Politics of Development, The 348
Stevens, Alex 119 Stevens, Christopher 328 Stevenson, Kim 125 Stewart, B.A. 225 Stewart, John 156 Stewart, Kendra B. 162 Stillness in a Mobile World 187 Stinchcomb, Jeanne B. 178 Stock, Noel 29 109 Stockwin, Arthur Stone Matrix Asphalt 252 Stone, Richard 121 Stoneham, Tom 6 Storey, Tony 142 Story, Pierce 146 Storytelling and the Future of Organizations 162 Storz, Cornelia 109 Stout, Frederic 171 Stout, Robert N. 235 Strategic Conflict 24 Strategic Management 153 Strategic Management of Human Capital in Education 77 Strategic Sports Development 189 Strategic Text Analytics 297 Strategy in Information and Influence Campaigns 89 Strategy in US Foreign Policy After the Cold War 95 Streb, Matthew J. 88 Strecker, David E. 119 Stretch, Rachael 122 Strong Earthquake Ground Motion 252 Strong-Wilson, Teresa 81 Structural Basis of Architecture, The 247 Structural Damping 252 Struggle for Persia, The 350 Struggle for the History of Education, The 78 Stuart, Donald 350 Student’s Guide to the Study, Practice, and Tools of Modern Mathematics, A 277 Studies in Ancient Persian History 350 Studies of the Holocaust 187 Study of Violent Crime, The 124 Successful Business Consulting in a Changing World 154 Sufism and Saint Veneration in Contemporary Bangladesh 112 Sugihara, Kaoru 168 Sugumaran, Vijayan 296 Suhrke, Astri 99 Suls, Jerry M. 194 Summers, Boyd L. 296
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
index 395
t
çè
Tabakov, Slavik Tac Tackling Depression at Work Tadjbakhsh, Shahrbanou Taft, Earl Tagawa, Tatsuo Taiwanese Business or Chinese Security Asset Taiwan’s Democracy Takeda, Yoshifumi Talbot, Deborah Tale of Genji, The Talwar, Smrithi Tamas, Kristof Tamura, Toshiyo Tan, Charlene Tan, Kim H. Tan, Siew-Chong
310 140 204 101 287 226 112 105 239 131 325 108 167 226 81 223 273
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
Tanner, Martin A. 280 Tapper, Richard 354 Tatiya, Ratan Raj 299 Taupin, Jane Moira 236 Taxation in ASEAN and China 112 Taylor, Antoinette J. 272 Taylor, Ian 95 Taylor, Peter J. 175 Taylor, Rachel 193 Taylor, Roger 73 Taylor, Wayne 144 Taylor, William 245 Teacher Education and the Challenge of Development 81 Teacher Education Policy in the United States 77 Teacher Preparation for Bilingual Student Populations 63 Teaching and Learning through Reflective Practice 58 Teaching Assistant’s Guide to Child Development and Psychology in the Classroom, A 52 Teaching Economics in Troubled Times 58 Teaching Grammar in Second Language Classrooms 59 Teaching in a Nutshell 59 Teaching Mathematics Creatively 59 Teaching Modern Foreign Languages in the Primary School 59 Teaching Science Creatively 60 Teaching Secondary English as if the Planet Matters 60 Teaching Secondary Geography as if the Planet Matters 60 Teaching the Arts to Engage English Language Learners 60 Teaching the Literature of Today’s Middle East 63 Teaching with Emotional Intelligence 61 Teasley, Sarah 19 Techno Politics in Presidential Campaigning 24 Technology, Crime and Justice 140 Teeuwen, Bert 149 Tenkouano, Abdou 224 Tensor Product Model Transformation in Polytopic Model-Based Control 273 Territories of the Russian Federation 2011 317 Terrorism and the Olympics 102 Terrorism Versus Democracy 99 Terrorism, Identity, and Legitimacy 102 Terrorism: The Basics 89, 361
@
Terrorist Rehabilitation and Counter-radicalisation 102 Testing Complex and Embedded Systems 269 Textbook as Discourse, The 78 Thakur, Ramesh 99 Thangavelu, Shandre 168 The China Development Research Foundation 106 Theatre and the State in Singapore, The 113 Theatre of Richard Maxwell and the New York City Players, The 47 Theocarakis, Nicholas 164 Theories and Practices of Development 174 Theories of Development 347 Theories of Economic Development and Growth 332 Theories of Ethics 4 Theories of Team Cognition 197 Theories of Violent Conflict 100 Theorising Post-Conflict Reconciliation 96 Theorizing a Colonial Caribbean-Atlantic Imaginary 33 Theory After ‘Theory’ 31 Theory and Experience of Economic Development, The 334 Theory of Economic Integration for Developing Countries, A 332 Therapeutic Alliance, The 204 Therapeutic Processes for Communication Disorders 197 Thermal Computations for Electronics 276 Thin-Film Organic Photonics 307 Thinking about Global Governance 91 Third World in Soviet Military Thought, The 344 Third World Industrialization in the 1980s 335 Third World Proletariat?, A 344 Thomas Tooke and the Monetary Thought of Classical Economics 170 Thomas, Daniel C. 94 Thomas, Jay C. 200 Thompson, Ethan 27 Thompson, Noel 319 Thompson, Teresa L. 24 Thomson, Pat 78 Thrall, A. Trevor 100 Thrift, Nigel 161 Through-the-Wall Radar Imaging 267 Thurman, James T. 235 Tichy, Walter 292 Tight, Malcolm 323
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
çè
Sun, Da-Wen 315 Sun, Jun 293 Sunburnt Cities 249, 363 Sunderland, G. 237 Sun-Pan, Bonnie 239 Superle, Michelle 32 Supermax 144 Support Vector Machines and Their Application in Chemistry and Biotechnology 307 Supporting Women to Give Birth at Home 215 Surface Modeling 256 Surfactants in Tribology, 2 Volume Set 313 Surfactants in Tribology, Volume 2 313 Suriyakumaran, C. 338 Surveillance and Control in Israel/Palestine 117 Surviving and Moving On 144 Suryanarayana, Cury 309 Sustainability and the Design of Transport Interchanges 246 Sustainability in European Transport Policy 127 Sustainability Management Handbook 162 Suter, Penelope S. 221 Sweeney, Daniel 211 Swiffen, Amy 126 Sykes, Ella C. 350 Symmons, Alan 311 Systems Life Cycle Costing 275 Sywulak, Andrea E. 210 Székely, István P. 316
Till, Geoffrey 101 Till, Jeremy 246 Tiller, James S. 295 Tilley, Nick 131, 140 Time, History and the Religious Imaginary in South Asia 113 Ting, Naitee 280 Tipton, Harold F. 290 Tittle, Peg 2 Todd, Jennifer 93 Todd, Liz 70 Todd, Maria 161 Tokusoglu, Ozlem 241 Tolerance to Environmental Contaminants 258 Toma, J. Douglas 67 Tomlinson, Alan 85 Tompkins, Dean T. 261 Toninelli, Pier Angelo 162 Tonry, Michael 136 Toplis, Rob 55 Torres Alvarado, Ignacio Salvador 261 Torres, Rebecca Maria 176 Tortajada, Cecilia 175 Totten, George E. 270 Tourism and Agriculture 176 Tourism and India 176 Tourism and National Identities 176 Tourism and Social Marketing 174 Tourism Supply Chain Management 174 Tourist Shopping Villages 176 Tovey, Helen 50, 360 Toward Mutual Recognition 206 Towards Creative Learning Spaces 247 Towards Economic Recovery in Sub-Saharan Africa 337 Towards Fairer University Assessment 68 Towards Financial Independence in a Developing Economy 338 Tower, Mollie Gregory 48 Towl, Graham 143 Toye, John 329 Toyota Kaizen Continuum, The 156 Toyota Kaizen Methods 156 Trade and Developing Countries 337 Traditional Construction for a Sustainable Future 255 Trahar, Sheila 66 Trans-Colonial Modernities in Asia 113 Transformer and Inductor Design Handbook 268 Transforming Behaviour 144 Transforming Healthcare 157
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
396 index
order now!
Turow, Joseph Tusi, Nasir ad-Din Tutorials in Metamaterials Tyler, Colin Tyler, Mark A. Tymoigne, Eric
21 353 313 95 80 167
u Ullah, Aman 285 Ullman, Daniel H. 277 Ullrey, Duane E. 223 Umemura, Maki 112 UN Human Rights Council 91 Underdevelopment and Development in Brazil: Volume I 340 Underdevelopment and Development in Brazil: Volume II 341 Understanding Criminal Careers 144 Understanding India’s New Political Economy 105 Understanding Nanomaterials 303 Understanding Research in Clinical and Counseling Psychology 200 Understanding Structural Engineering 252 Understanding Youth Offending 144 Unequal Educations 184 Unhelkar, Bhuvan 294 Unilateralist Temptation in American Foreign Policy, The 90 Unipolarity and World Politics 102 Unit Operations in Food Engineering 242 United States and Cuba, The 91 Universities and Global Diversity 68 Unlocking Mathematics Teaching 79 Unrecognized States in the International System 117 Unsaturated Soils 298 Urban Coding and Planning 250 Urban Social Movements in the Third World 345 Urban Storm Water Management for Practitioners 315 Urban Tourism and Urban Change 184 Urban Water Conflicts 314 Urban Youth in China 187 Urbanek, Simon 282 Urbanisation and Planning in the Third World 342 Urbanisation in the Developing World 339
( +44 (0)1235 400524
Urbanisation, Housing and the Development Process 340 US Policy Towards Cuba 96 Usability Testing of Medical Devices 230 User Interfaces and Applications for Seamless Mobility 273 Using Effectiveness Data for School Improvement 79 Using Music to Enhance Student Learning 48 Utility Theory 170
v Vai, Marjorie 61 Vakhtangov Sourcebook, The 46 Valdevit, Antonio 226 Valencia, Richard R. 71 Value Chains, Social Inclusion and Economic Development 170 Van Avermaet, Piet 80 van Blaricom, D.P. 235 van Blerk, Lorraine 171 Van den Branden, Kris 80 van den Noord, Paul 318 van der Kolk, Jan 257 van der Meulen Rodgers, Yana 163 van Hengel, Arjon J. 239 Van Houtte, Mieke 80 Van Ness, Daniel W. 143 Van Zyl Smit, Dirk 138 VanFleet, Risë 210 Vanishing Matter and the Laws of Nature 6 Vanstone, Maurice 137 Vardi, Noah 128 Variegated Neoliberalism 96 Various, 349 Varlaki, Peter 273 Varma, Baidya Nath 348 Varma, Rashmi 33 Varoufakis, Yanis 164 Vartanian, Oshin 195 Varvogli, Aliki 33 Vellema, Sietze 170 Ventilation for Healthy Buildings: Reducing the Impact of Urban Air Pollution 253 Venugopal, Vazhiyil 242 Venville, Grady 75 Vercauteren, Frederik 281 Verdooren, L.R. 286 Verhage, Antoinette 169 Vernacular Architecture of West Africa 248, 362 Verry, Elon S. 260
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Transforming Scholarship: Why Women’s and Gender Studies Students are Changing Themselves and the World 183 Transgenic Horticultural Crops 225 Transitions to Better Lives 141 Transmedia Television 27 Transnational Environmental Crime 141 Transnationalism and American Serial Fiction 33 Transparency, Public Relations and the Mass Media 27 Transportable Off-Grid Power Solutions Based on Alternative Energy Sources 273 Transportation Systems Reliability and Safety 275 Trans-ungual Drug Delivery 232 Travel and Dislocation in Contemporary American Fiction 33 Travel Writing 31 Travel Writing and Ethics 33 Travlos, Gregory S. 229 Treating Depressed and Suicidal Adolescents 212 Tregenza, Peter 244 Tremblay, Manon 96 Trenberth, Linda 188 Trenz, Hans-Jörg 95 Tribe and State in Iran and Afghanistan 354 Triggered Drug Delivery 232 Trigiano, Robert N. 224 Trotter, Chris 143 Trotter-Mathison, Michelle 204 Trouble With Truth, The 141 TRP Channels 225 True to the Language Game 37 Trumbull, Elise 62 Tse, Chi-Kong 273 Tsebelis, George 96 Tsetsura, Katerina 27 Tu, Yu-Kang 282 Tucker, Allen 289 Tucker, Catherine M. 177 Tucker, Lee 189 Tucker, Mel 235 Tucker-Raymond, Eli 53 Tulloch, Peter 337 Tunley, Anne 7 Turbo Flow 157 Turk, Dennis C. 199 Turkington, Douglas 199 Turnbull, Bruce W. 280 Turner, Colin 7, 356 Turner, Stephen P. 182 Turner, Tom 249, 362
Vert, Jean-Philippe Vertinsky, Patricia Vertovec, Steven Vess, James Veysey, Bonita Victims Victims and Policy-Making Victims of Crime Vindicating Socio-Economic Rights Vint, Sherryl Vision Rehabilitation Visual Controls Visual Research Methods in the Social Sciences Visual Sociology Vivekanandan, Jayashree Vohs, Kathleen D. Voice: Onstage and Off Voluntary Organizations and Public Service Delivery Vyas, Utpal
289 191 324 141 143 142 144 144 128 30 221 157 184 185 109 195 47 162 111
w Wachtel-Galor, Sissie 219 Waddington, David 144 Wadoo, Sabiha 269 Wadsworth, Michael E.J. 177 Wagenbreth, Gene 292 Wainer, Gabriel A. 270 Wainwright, Jeffrey 28, 358 Wakaki, Moriaki 272 Wakeham, William A. 300 Waldron, Patrick 164 Walgrave, Lode 144 Walker, Charles 110 Walker, Stephen G. 88 Walklate, Sandra 142 Wall, Peter 18 Wallace, Edward 235 Wallace, John 75 Wallace, Sandra 185 Waller, Tim 76 Walliman, Nicholas 182, 362 Wallis, Patricia 66 Walsh, Denis 216 Walsh, Michael J. 201 Walsh, Patrick F. 134 Walsh, Steve 34 Walter, Martin 282 Walters, D. Eric 318 Walters, Gale C. 318 Walters, Reece 131 Walton, C. Dale 101 Wang, Lawrence K. 257
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
index 397 309 173 282 100 117 96 192 295 132 199 54 258 234 352 261 339 242 292 305 338 22 63 126 73 303 297 169 306 235 166 73 85 342 220 178 149 66 229 262 102 201 332 187 26 139 64 205 14 257
62 142 64 222
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates for e-mail updates in your field
Whelen, John White, Connie White, John White, Leanne White, Rob Whitehouse, David J. Whitlam, John Whole Life Costing Why Did the US Invade Iraq? Whyte, David Wibben, Annick Wicaksono, Rachel Wickens, G.M. Wicksell, Knut Wiegand, Thorsten Wiest, Julie B. Wiklund, Michael E. Wilamowski, Bodgan Wiles, Charlotte Wilkinson, Paul Will, Stefan Willetts, Peter William Forsythe and the Practice of Choreography Williams, A.L. Williams, Andrew Williams, Andy Williams, Edwin Williams, Lisa Williams, Robin Williamson, Jim Williamson, Tom Willis, Katie Willson, Keith Wilson, Arnold Wilson, Michael Wilson, Ross Wiltbank, Robert Winch, Christopher Winter, Karen Witcher, James Wohlfarth, Christian Wolff, Stefan Wolfsfeld, Gadi Wolsey, Chris Women and Education Women and Housing Women in European Culture and Society Women in Executive Power Women in the United States Military Women, Children, and Addiction Women, Music, Culture Women, Sport, Society Women’s Rights in the USA
@
80 153 26 176 144 301 43 255 100 101 98 36 353 164 281 233 230 267 305 99 300 87 47 298 86 143 38 194 143 247 143 174 310 350 244 15 147 147 220 257 309 84 87 188 325 250 13 96 14 218 48 191 91
Womens’ Roles and Population Trends in the Third World 330 Wong, Melanie K. 251 Wong, Reuben 94 Wood, Chris 213 Wood, Geoffrey E. 324 Wood, John C. 323 Wood, William C. 58 Woodford, Brendon J. 292 Woods, Margaret 152 Woollard, John 58 Work and Struggle 13 Work and Wealth 165 Working With Offenders 144 Workplace Violence 144 World of Labour, The 321 World Soil Resources and Food Security 225 World Yearbook of Education 2011 79 World’s Major Languages, The 44 Wortley, Richard 138 Wraith, Ronald 343 Wray, L. Randall 167 Wright, Alan 143 Wright, Philip 347 Wright, Tim 112 Wrigley, Terry 70 Wrona, Robert J. 149 Wu, Jinyuan 308 Wu, Xiao-Jun 293 Wunderlich, Dr Jens-Uwe 317 XI Zhu, Michael 225
x Xiao, Richard Xiao, Yang Xie, Bin Xie, Furen Xinjiang and China’s Rise in Central Asia, 1949–2009 Xinzhu, Hua Xu, Feng Xu, Qing-Song
40 269 297 298 113 299 110 307
y Yaffee, Robert Yagi, Kiichiro Yahuda, Michael Yakinthou, Christalla Yale, Allison S.
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
Yam, Yeung Yan, Hao Yan, Xing L. Yang, Yi-Hsuan Yanow, Dvora Yar, Majid Yarwood, Lisa Yates, Lyn Yates, W. David Yecies, Brian Yeh, Anthony Yeon, Jaehoon Yesilada, Birol Yih, Yuehwern Yip, Virginia Ylimaki, Rose M. Yodfat, Aryeh Yosef, Raz Yoshimura, Tetsuzo Young People, Social Capital and Ethnic Identity Young, Christopher Young, Michael Your Customers’ Perception of Quality Youssef, Nadia H. Youth in Crisis? Youth Justice Handbook Yudelman, Montague Yue, Tian-Xiang Yunker, James
273 311 265 292 86 143 127 79 276 27 250 43 94 274 41 71 354 26 307 187 189 339 158 330 184 144 328 256 85
z
çè
çè
Wang, Perry G. Wang, Rusong Wang, Yuedong War and Ideas War and Peace in Jewish Tradition War, Identity and the Liberal State Ward, David Ward, J. LeRoy Ward, Jennifer Ward, Tony Ward-Penny, Robert Warfare Decontamination Warlow, Tom Waterfield, Robin Water-Rock Interaction XIII Watson, Keith Watson, Ronald Ross Watts, Michael J. Watts, Paul Wealth of Poor Nations, The Weaver, C. Kay Webb, Allen Webb, Julian Webb, Kristine W. Webb, S. Web-Based Outsourcing Weber, Olaf Webster, John G. Wecht, Cyril H. Weeks, John Wehmeyer, Michael L. Weiss, Thomas G. Weitz, Raanan Welbourne, Penelope Welch, Michael Wellman, Joan Wells, Frances Wen, Xuejun Weng, Qihao Wennmann, Achim Wenzel, Amy West African Trade West Indian Diaspora, The Westerns Westmarland, Louise Westwood, Peter Wetchler, Joseph L. Wetzel, Richard Wexler, Philip What Does Understanding Mathematics Mean for Teachers? What Else Works? What’s the Buzz? Whelan, Alex
277 166 104 84 230
Zabir, Sepehr Zaccaro, Stephen J. Zara, Georgia Zaum, Dominik Zegong, Liu Zhang, Ping Zhang, Weiguo Zhao, Yong Zidek, James V. Zimmerman, Barry J. Zinovyev, Andrei Zipes, Jack Zohuri, Bahman Zoski, Cynthia Zureik, Elia
349 195 131 98 299 281 40 74 280 75 289 25 268 309 117
N.B. Routledge Paperbacks Direct titles are not included in the Index
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
398 Sales representatives, agents and distribution Milton Park Sales Office Taylor & Francis Group (Books Ltd)
International Enquiries Joanne Blackford (Maternity cover for Kate Pearce) International Sales Support Manager (Books) Tel: +44 (0) 20 7017 6053 Fax: +44 (0) 20 7017 6748 E-mail: joanne.blackford@tandf.co.uk
2 Park Square, Milton Park, Abingdon Oxon OX14 4RN UK Group Sales Director Christoph Chesher Tel: +44 (0) 20 7017 6194 Fax: +44 (0) 20 7017 6748 E-mail: christoph.chesher@tandf.co.uk
European and Japanese Enquiries Lucy Astone International Sales Support Coordinator Tel: +44 (0) 20 7017 6149 Fax: +44 (0) 20 7017 6748 E-mail: lucy.astone@tandf.co.uk
International Sales Director Graham Crossley Tel: +44 (0) 20 7017 6048 Fax: +44 (0) 20 7017 6748 E-mail: graham.crossley@tandf.co.uk
South Asian, Middle Eastern and African Enquiries Reanna Young International Sales Support Coordinator Tel: +44 (0) 20 7017 6114 Fax: +44 (0) 20 7017 6748 E-mail: reanna.young@tandf.co.uk
Head of UK Sales Nick Perry Tel: +44 (0) 20 7017 6132 Fax: +44 (0) 20 7017 6732 E-mail: nick.perry@tandf.co.uk
China Liaison Office Yan Pei Manager Taylor & Francis Room 523 Resource Building No.151 North Street Zhongguancun Beijing China 100080 P.O. Box: 8762 Tel/Fax: +86 (10) 58876523 E-mail: yanpei@tandf.com.sg
Corporate and Institutional Sales Alfred Lea Tel: +44 (0) 20 7017 6273 Fax: +44 (0) 20 7017 6732 E-mail: cis@tandf.co.uk UK Sales Administrator Judith Cavell Tel: +44 (0) 20 7017 6191 Fax: +44 (0) 20 7017 6732 E-mail: judith.cavell@tandf.co.uk Academic Representatives (UK)
London (EC, SE, SW, W and WC)
London (East, Northwest, North) and Eastern England
Daphne Edwards Area Representative Mobile: 07802 536 233 Tel: +44 (0) 20 7017 6259 E-mail: daphne.edwards@tandf.co.uk
Oxfordshire, West Midlands and South Wales John Blake Area Representative Mobile:07889 263 857 Fax: 01608 685 933 E-mail: john.blake@tandf.co.uk
Peter Havinga European Sales Manager A. Hofmanweg 5a, 2031 BH Haarlem The Netherlands Tel: +31 (0) 23 750 5730 Fax: +31 (0) 23 750 5701 Mobile: +31 (0) 6 515 69560 E-mail: peter.havinga@tandf.co.uk
Customer Services Book orders should be addressed to the appropriate overseas agent or the Customer Service Department at our new distributor Bookpoint:
Belgium, The Netherlands, France and Luxembourg Liza Walraven Sales Representative A. Hofmanweg 5a, 2031 BH Haarlem The Netherlands Tel: +31 (0) 23 750 5731 Fax: +31 (0) 23 750 5701 Mobile: +31 (0) 6 238 49668 E-mail: liza.walraven@informa.com
Taylor & Francis Customer Services, Bookpoint 130 Milton Park, Abingdon, Oxon OX14 4SB Tel: +44 (0) 1235 400 524 Fax: +44 (0)1235 400 525 E-mail (UK): uktrade@tandf.co.uk
Greece
Ryan Cooper, Area Sales Manager Milton Park Sales Office Tel: +44 (0) 20 7017 6113 Fax: +44 (0) 20 7017 6748 E-mail: ryan.cooper@tandf.co.uk
E-mail (international): international@tandf.co.uk
Standing Orders If you would like to receive books on our improved pre-selective standing order system, or if you would like to have further information about this service, please contact your area manager or Customer Services Department.
Nordic Countries
Lisa Hetherington, Sales Representative Taylor & Francis 2 Park Square, Milton Park OX14 4RN UK Tel: +44 20337 73895 Mobile: +46 76222 0300 E-mail: lisa.hetherington@tandf.co.uk
Germany, Austria and Switzerland Gabriela Mauch, Area Sales Manager Anna-Peters-Str. 49 70597 Stuttgart, Germany Tel: +49 (0) 711 7207231 Fax: +49 (0) 711 7220668 Mobile: +49 (0) 173905 9469 E-mail: gabriela.mauch@tandf.co.uk
Adele Parker E-mail: adele.parker@tandf.co.uk
England and Wales
Southern England
Katie Gilbert Exhibitions Manager Tel: +44 (0) 20 7017 6310 E-mail: katie.gilbert@tandf.co.uk
Foreign Rights
Tim Page Higher Education Sales Manager Mobile: 07824 690646 E-mail: tim.page@tandf.co.uk
Bob Davis Senior Area Representative Mobile: 07889 263 856 Fax: 01621 819 833 E-mail: bob.davis@tandf.co.uk
Europe
Exhibitions
Library Supply
Charlotte Russell Area Representative Mobile: 07917 648040 E-mail: charlotte.russell@tandf.co.uk
Nigel Berkeley Library Supply and London Key Accounts Manager Mobile: 07795 968206 E-mail: nigel.berkeley@tandf.co.uk
Scotland and North of England
Online retailers
Nick Pepper Mobile: +44 (0) 7825 748476 E-mail: nick.pepper@tandf.co.uk
Rod Abraham Assistant UK Sales Manager Mobile: 07860 380 814 Fax: 01372 273 744 E-mail: rod.abraham@tandf.co.uk
Ireland and northern ireland
Spain, Portugal and Italy
Philip Veysey, Area Sales Manager Príncipe de Vergara 109, 28002 Madrid, Spain Tel: +34 91 700 0688 Fax: +34 91 141 2304 Mobile: +34 68 777 3678 E-mail: philip.veysey@informa.com
Eastern Europe
Marek Lewinson, Humanities and Social Sciences Bohaterewicza 3/45, 03-982 Warsaw, Poland Tel/Fax: +48 (0) 22 6714819 Mobile: +48 (0) 602 707 037 E-mail: mlewinso@it.com.pl Radek Janousek, Science and Technology Pod Nouzovem 972/21 197 00 Prague Czech Republic Tel: +42 (0) 28 658 49888 Mobile: +42 (0) 602294014 E-mail: radek@mareklewinson.com
Conor Graham/Michael Darcy Brookside Publishing Services 2 Brookside, Dundrum Road, Dublin 14 Tel: 00 353 1 298 9937 Fax: 00 353 1 298 7912 E-mail: sales@brookside.ie
North and Northwest England
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
D +44 (0)1235 400525
çè
Lucy Greaves Area Representative Mobile: 07860 633156 Fax: 01663 746682 E-mail: lucy.greaves@tandf.co.uk
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
Sales representatives, agents and distribution 399 Middle East and North Africa Jasmina Basic, Area Sales Manager – Middle East and Africa Milton Park Sales Office Tel: +44 (0) 20 7017 6187 Fax: +44 (0) 20 7017 6748 E-mail: jasmina.basic@tandf.co.uk Zoe Kaviani IPS (Middle East) Ltd P. O. Box 27533 Dubai, UAE Tel: +971 4 282 8801 Fax: +971 4 282 8804 E-mail: itpme@emirates.net.ae Website: http://www.ipsme.com
Rest of Africa Jasmina Basic, Area Sales Manager – Middle East and Africa Milton Park Sales Office
Nigeria
Chinke Ojiji Publishers Support Services Ltd Plot 2 Adewunmi Estate Oregun Road (Near First Bank Oregun) PO Box 9270, Ikeja, Lagos State Tel: +234 1 774 1073 Fax: +234 1 493 0419
Botswana
Arthur Oageng Book Promotions/Horizon Books Botswana Gaborone International Finance Park Plot 113-114, Unit 33 Kgale Mews 2, Suite 3 Gaborone, Botswana Tel: +267 393 1194 Fax: +267 392 4908 E-mail: arthur.oageng@online.co.bw
South Africa, Namibia, Lesotho and Swaziland
Michelle Symington Book Promotions Ltd BMD Office Park, 108 De Waal Road Diep River, 7800 Cape Town South Africa Tel: +27 21 707 5700 General Fax: +27 21 707 5795 Orders Fax: +27 21 707 5794 E-mail: msymington@bookpro.co.za
Korea
Japan
Australasia
Hans Van Ess, Book Sales and Marketing Executive Taylor & Francis Group 7F Koshin Bldg. 2-23-4 Kanda-Jimbocho Chiyoda, Tokyo 101-0051 Japan Tel: +81 (0) 35848 7061 Mobile: +81 (0) 80 5426 3552 E-mail: hans.vaness@informa.com
Joanne Blackford (Maternity cover for Kate Pearce) Milton Park Sales Office Tel: +44 (0) 7017 6053 Fax: +44 (0) 20 7017 6748 E-mail: joanne.blackford@tandf.co.uk
United Publishers Services Limited 1-32-5 Higashi-shinagawa Shinagawa-ku, Tokyo 140-0002 Tel: +81 (0) 3 5479 7251 Fax: +81 (0) 3 5479 7307 E-mail: info@ups.co.jp Editorial Office Takahiko Kaneko Edition Synapse Yamaguchi Bldg. 3F 2-8-5 Uchikanda Chiyoda-ku, Tokyo 101-0047, Japan Tel: +81 (0) 3 5296 9186 Fax: +81 (0) 3 3252 1822 E-mail: edsynapse@nifty.ne.jp
Australia
Palgrave Macmillan Level 1, 15-19 Claremont Street South Yarra Vic 3141 Australia Tel: +61 (0) 3 9825 1111 Fax: +61 (0) 3 9825 1010 E-mail: palgrave@macmillan.com.au www.palgravemacmillan.com.au
New Zealand
Macmillan Publishers NZ Ltd Victoria Johnson 6 Ride Way, Albany Auckland, NZ Tel: +64 9 414 0350 Fax: +64 9 414 0357 E-mail: vicki@macmillan.co.nz
Australia and New Zealand
Ryan Cooper Area Sales Manager Milton Park Sales Office Tel: +44 (0) 20 7017 6113 Fax: +44 (0) 20 7017 6748 E-mail: ryan.cooper@tandf.co.uk
CRC Press and Marcel Dekker only Libraries may wish to order from their local bookseller, Palgrave Macmillan or DA Information Services Pty Ltd 648 Whitehorse Road, Mitcham Victoria Australia Tel: +61 3 9210 7804 Fax: +61 3 9210 7788 www.dadirect.com.au
India
Australia
South Asia
Taylor & Francis India 912, Tolstoy House 15-17, Tolstoy Marg Connaught Place New Delhi – 110 001 Tel: +91 (0) 11 43155100 Fax: +91 (0) 11 23712132 E-mail: inquiry@tandfindia.com
Pakistan
M. Anwer Iqbal Book Bird Mian Chambers, 3 Temple Road PO Box 518, Lahore, Pakistan Tel: +92 42 636 7275 Fax: +92 42 636 1370 E-mail: bookbird@brain.net.pk
Sri Lanka
Nirosha Saravanapavan E-mail: niroshas@sltnet.lk Mobile: 0094 714 750911
Se-Yung Jun ICK (Information & Culture Korea) 473-19 Seokyo-dong , Mapo-ku Seoul, Korea 121-842 Tel: +82 2 3141-4791 Fax: +82 2 3141-7733 E-mail: cs.ick@ick.co.kr
Europa Publications (non-exclusive) James Bennett 3 Narabang Way, Belrose, NSW 2085 Australia Tel: +02 9986 7064 Fax: +02 9986 7030 www.bennett.com.au
East and Southeast Asia For all Taylor & Francis Group imprints please order from our Singapore Sales Office
çè
çè
Malaysia and Brunei
David Yeong, General Manager Taylor & Francis Publishing Services Taylor & Francis Asia Pacific No. 23-2, Jalan PJS 8/18, Dataran Mentari 46150 Petaling Jaya, Selangor Darul Ehsan Malaysia Tel: +60 (3) 5630 1361 Fax: +60 (3) 5630 1732 Mobile: +60 (0) 16 3319912 E-mail: david.yeong@tandf.com.sg
Taiwan
Taylor & Francis Asia Pacific Tel: +886 (2) 2578 6106 ext.125 Fax: +886 (2) 2578 6507 Mobile: +886 (9) 7216 9672 Jeffrey Lim, Books Sales Director E-mail: jeffrey.lim@tandf.com.sg Sara Cheng, Sales Executive E-mail: Sara.Cheng@tandf.com.sg
China
Room 1108B, Culture Square No. 59 Jia, Zhongguancun St. Haidian District Beijing 100872 P.R. China Tel: +86 (10) 82502670 Fax: +86 (10) 82502566 Jeffrey Lim, Books Sales Director E-mail: jeffrey.lim@tandf.com.sg Cynthia Ji, Sales Manager Email: cynthia.ji@tandf.com.sg
Ryan Cooper Area Sales Manager Milton Park Sales Office Tel: +44 (0) 20 7017 6113 Fax: +44 (0) 20 7017 6748 E-mail: ryan.cooper@tandf.co.uk
E-mail: info@taylorandfrancis.co.uk for more information
Taylor & Francis Asia Pacific Tel: +66 (2) 6427954-6 ext. 406 Fax: +66 (2) 6427677 Jeffrey Lim, Books Sales Director E-mail: jeffrey.lim@tandf.com.sg Nonglak Sawaithong Sales Executive Email: s.nonglak@tandf.com.sg
Vietnam
Jeffrey Lim, Books Sales Director Singapore Sales Office E-mail: jeffrey.lim@tandf.com.sg
@
Thailand
Shanghai Region
Taylor & Francis Asia Pacific Tel: +852 91796613 Jeffrey Lim, Books Sales Director E-mail: jeffrey.lim@tandf.com.sg Jolly Chan, Account Manager E-mail: jolly.chan@tandf.com.sg
for e-mail updates in your field
Francis Chua, Sales Manager Singapore Sales Office E-mail: francis.chua@tandf.com.sg
Singapore Sales Office Taylor & Francis Asia Pacific 240 Macpherson Road #08–01 Pines Industrial Building Singapore 348574 Tel: +65 6741 5166 Fax: +65 6742 9356 E-mail: sales@tandf.com.sg
Hong Kong
www.tandf.co.uk/eupdates
Singapore, Philippines and Indonesia
Chris Ye, Senior Sales Executive Tel: +86 135 64618686 Email: chris.ye@tandf.com.sg
Israel and the Palestinian Territories
and Rodney Franklin Franklin’s International PO BOX 3772 7 Tel Aviv 61376, Israel Tel: +972 356 00724 Fax: +972 356 00479 E-mail: rodneyf@netvision.net.il
http://www.ebooksubscriptions.com/ eBooks are only available to order online
400 Sales representatives, agents and distribution
Sales Department
Susie Carlisle Academic Sales Manager phone: 561-998-2538 susie.carlisle@ taylorandfrancis.com
6000 Broken Sound Parkway NW, Suite 300 Boca Raton, FL 33487
Evelyn Elias Director, Retail, Institutional & Special Sales phone: 561-361-6010 evelyn.elias@ taylorandfrancis.com
north america Sales Office Dennis Weiss Vice President Sales Taylor and Francis 6000 Broken Sound Parkway N.W. Suite 300 Boca Raton, FL 33487, USA Within the Continental USA: Tel: 800-272-7737 Fax: 800-374-3401 E-mail: orders@taylorandfrancis. com Outside USA: Tel: +1 561-994-0555 Fax: +1 561-361-6018 E-mail: International.orders @taylorandfrancis.com
Rosa Perez Director of Online Sales phone: 917-351-7115 rosa.perez@ taylorandfrancis.com
Caribbean and the West Indies Jasmina Basic Area Sales Manager Milton Park Sales Office Tel: +44 (0) 20 7017 6187 Fax: +44 (0) 20 7017 6748 E-mail: jasmina.basic@tandf.co.uk
orders & customer service (north & south america)
Central and South America and mexico
CREDIT DEPARTMENT
Michael Dulisse Sales Office, Boca Raton, FL Taylor & Francis Tel: +1 561 998 2582 Fax: +1 561 361 6049 E-mail: Michael.Dulisse@taylorandfrancis. com
toll free 800-272-7737
phone 561-361-6000
toll free fax 800-374-3401 fax: 561-631-6075 pubnet: SAN# 213 196X www.routledge.com
Ethan E Atkin Cranbury International LLC 7 Clarendon Ave, Suite 2 Montpelier, VT 05602 USA Tel: +1 802 223 6565 Fax: +1 802 223 6824 E-mail: eatkin@cranburyinternational.com
Returns (north & south america):
For established accounts:
TOLL-FREE FAX
Taylor & Francis 7625 Empire Drive Florence, KY 41042
1-800-248-4724
Taylor & Francis 7625 Empire Drive Florence, KY 41042
FAX
Attn: Returns
TOLL-FREE PHONE
859-647-4028
Please reference original invoice #
1-800-634-7064
Joshua Walls Customer Service Manager
TELEPHONE
phone: 1-800-634-7064 fax: 859-647-4029
Note: • Books must be in resalable condition • Dated materials must be returned within 90 days of expiration date
859-727-5000
LIBRARIES, Bookstores, and special sales Contact Evelyn Elias to be put in touch with the appropriate Sales Rep.
Standing Orders
Evelyn Elias Director, Retail, Institutional & Special Sales phone: 561-361-6010 evelyn.elias@taylorandfrancis.com
If you would like to receive books on our improved pre-selective standing order system, or if you would like to have further information about this service, please contact Evelyn Elias.
credit department
Login Canada is our distributor of choice
Sharon Olynick sho@lb.ca
Sales inquiries Login Canada 204-837-2987
order now!
( +44 (0)1235 400524
orders & customer service
returns in canada
Login Canada 300 Saulteaux Crescent Winnipeg, Manitoba R3J 3T2 phone: 800-665-1148 (204-837-2987) fax: 800-665-0103 (204-837-3116) website: www.lb.ca email: orders@lb.ca booknet: S1196049
(ThunderBay and West) Winnipeg Location Login Canada 300 Saulteaux Crescent Winnipeg, Manitoba R3J 3T2
D +44 (0)1235 400525
Western Canada
Eastern Canada (East of ThunderBay) Mississauga Location Login Canada East Unit 1, 6255 Cantay Rd. Mississauga, ON L5R 3Z5
çè
CANADA
www.taylorandfrancis.co.uk/books
R
o
u
t
l
e
10
d
g
e
C
l
a
s
s
i
C
s
years of publishing
established
modern classics
Cel e Ro brat ut e w led ith ge !
Contact us for details of the 2011 Promotion Campaign
routledge.com/classics Frankfurt Classics Lightbox.indd 1
17/9/10 09:56:47
Page 3
Page 35
Page 57
Page 83
Page 123
Page 149
Page 165
Page 193
Page 213
Page 222
Page 250
Page 255
Page 281
Page 295
Page 300
Taylor & Francis Group 2 Park Square Milton Park Abingdon Oxon OX14 4RN Tel: 020 7017 6000 Fax: 020 7017 6699 e-mail: info@tandf.co.uk www.tandf.co.uk/books
Paper used in this catalogue is chlorine free and environmentally friendly. It is manufactured with pulp supplied from sustainable managed forests.
MKBK1013
978-0-418-24752-5